Add Python support for GDB events.
[deliverable/binutils-gdb.git] / gdb / doc / gdb.texinfo
1 \input texinfo @c -*-texinfo-*-
2 @c Copyright (C) 1988, 1989, 1990, 1991, 1992, 1993, 1994, 1995, 1996,
3 @c 1998, 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002, 2003, 2004, 2005, 2006, 2007, 2008, 2009,
4 @c 2010, 2011 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
5 @c
6 @c %**start of header
7 @c makeinfo ignores cmds prev to setfilename, so its arg cannot make use
8 @c of @set vars. However, you can override filename with makeinfo -o.
9 @setfilename gdb.info
10 @c
11 @include gdb-cfg.texi
12 @c
13 @settitle Debugging with @value{GDBN}
14 @setchapternewpage odd
15 @c %**end of header
16
17 @iftex
18 @c @smallbook
19 @c @cropmarks
20 @end iftex
21
22 @finalout
23 @syncodeindex ky cp
24 @syncodeindex tp cp
25
26 @c readline appendices use @vindex, @findex and @ftable,
27 @c annotate.texi and gdbmi use @findex.
28 @syncodeindex vr cp
29 @syncodeindex fn cp
30
31 @c !!set GDB manual's edition---not the same as GDB version!
32 @c This is updated by GNU Press.
33 @set EDITION Ninth
34
35 @c !!set GDB edit command default editor
36 @set EDITOR /bin/ex
37
38 @c THIS MANUAL REQUIRES TEXINFO 4.0 OR LATER.
39
40 @c This is a dir.info fragment to support semi-automated addition of
41 @c manuals to an info tree.
42 @dircategory Software development
43 @direntry
44 * Gdb: (gdb). The GNU debugger.
45 @end direntry
46
47 @copying
48 Copyright @copyright{} 1988, 1989, 1990, 1991, 1992, 1993, 1994, 1995, 1996,
49 1998, 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002, 2003, 2004, 2005, 2006, 2007, 2008, 2009, 2010
50 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
51
52 Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
53 under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.3 or
54 any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with the
55 Invariant Sections being ``Free Software'' and ``Free Software Needs
56 Free Documentation'', with the Front-Cover Texts being ``A GNU Manual,''
57 and with the Back-Cover Texts as in (a) below.
58
59 (a) The FSF's Back-Cover Text is: ``You are free to copy and modify
60 this GNU Manual. Buying copies from GNU Press supports the FSF in
61 developing GNU and promoting software freedom.''
62 @end copying
63
64 @ifnottex
65 This file documents the @sc{gnu} debugger @value{GDBN}.
66
67 This is the @value{EDITION} Edition, of @cite{Debugging with
68 @value{GDBN}: the @sc{gnu} Source-Level Debugger} for @value{GDBN}
69 @ifset VERSION_PACKAGE
70 @value{VERSION_PACKAGE}
71 @end ifset
72 Version @value{GDBVN}.
73
74 @insertcopying
75 @end ifnottex
76
77 @titlepage
78 @title Debugging with @value{GDBN}
79 @subtitle The @sc{gnu} Source-Level Debugger
80 @sp 1
81 @subtitle @value{EDITION} Edition, for @value{GDBN} version @value{GDBVN}
82 @ifset VERSION_PACKAGE
83 @sp 1
84 @subtitle @value{VERSION_PACKAGE}
85 @end ifset
86 @author Richard Stallman, Roland Pesch, Stan Shebs, et al.
87 @page
88 @tex
89 {\parskip=0pt
90 \hfill (Send bugs and comments on @value{GDBN} to @value{BUGURL}.)\par
91 \hfill {\it Debugging with @value{GDBN}}\par
92 \hfill \TeX{}info \texinfoversion\par
93 }
94 @end tex
95
96 @vskip 0pt plus 1filll
97 Published by the Free Software Foundation @*
98 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor,
99 Boston, MA 02110-1301, USA@*
100 ISBN 1-882114-77-9 @*
101
102 @insertcopying
103 @page
104 This edition of the GDB manual is dedicated to the memory of Fred
105 Fish. Fred was a long-standing contributor to GDB and to Free
106 software in general. We will miss him.
107 @end titlepage
108 @page
109
110 @ifnottex
111 @node Top, Summary, (dir), (dir)
112
113 @top Debugging with @value{GDBN}
114
115 This file describes @value{GDBN}, the @sc{gnu} symbolic debugger.
116
117 This is the @value{EDITION} Edition, for @value{GDBN}
118 @ifset VERSION_PACKAGE
119 @value{VERSION_PACKAGE}
120 @end ifset
121 Version @value{GDBVN}.
122
123 Copyright (C) 1988-2010 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
124
125 This edition of the GDB manual is dedicated to the memory of Fred
126 Fish. Fred was a long-standing contributor to GDB and to Free
127 software in general. We will miss him.
128
129 @menu
130 * Summary:: Summary of @value{GDBN}
131 * Sample Session:: A sample @value{GDBN} session
132
133 * Invocation:: Getting in and out of @value{GDBN}
134 * Commands:: @value{GDBN} commands
135 * Running:: Running programs under @value{GDBN}
136 * Stopping:: Stopping and continuing
137 * Reverse Execution:: Running programs backward
138 * Process Record and Replay:: Recording inferior's execution and replaying it
139 * Stack:: Examining the stack
140 * Source:: Examining source files
141 * Data:: Examining data
142 * Optimized Code:: Debugging optimized code
143 * Macros:: Preprocessor Macros
144 * Tracepoints:: Debugging remote targets non-intrusively
145 * Overlays:: Debugging programs that use overlays
146
147 * Languages:: Using @value{GDBN} with different languages
148
149 * Symbols:: Examining the symbol table
150 * Altering:: Altering execution
151 * GDB Files:: @value{GDBN} files
152 * Targets:: Specifying a debugging target
153 * Remote Debugging:: Debugging remote programs
154 * Configurations:: Configuration-specific information
155 * Controlling GDB:: Controlling @value{GDBN}
156 * Extending GDB:: Extending @value{GDBN}
157 * Interpreters:: Command Interpreters
158 * TUI:: @value{GDBN} Text User Interface
159 * Emacs:: Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs
160 * GDB/MI:: @value{GDBN}'s Machine Interface.
161 * Annotations:: @value{GDBN}'s annotation interface.
162 * JIT Interface:: Using the JIT debugging interface.
163
164 * GDB Bugs:: Reporting bugs in @value{GDBN}
165
166 @ifset SYSTEM_READLINE
167 * Command Line Editing: (rluserman). Command Line Editing
168 * Using History Interactively: (history). Using History Interactively
169 @end ifset
170 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
171 * Command Line Editing:: Command Line Editing
172 * Using History Interactively:: Using History Interactively
173 @end ifclear
174 * Formatting Documentation:: How to format and print @value{GDBN} documentation
175 * Installing GDB:: Installing GDB
176 * Maintenance Commands:: Maintenance Commands
177 * Remote Protocol:: GDB Remote Serial Protocol
178 * Agent Expressions:: The GDB Agent Expression Mechanism
179 * Target Descriptions:: How targets can describe themselves to
180 @value{GDBN}
181 * Operating System Information:: Getting additional information from
182 the operating system
183 * Trace File Format:: GDB trace file format
184 * Copying:: GNU General Public License says
185 how you can copy and share GDB
186 * GNU Free Documentation License:: The license for this documentation
187 * Index:: Index
188 @end menu
189
190 @end ifnottex
191
192 @contents
193
194 @node Summary
195 @unnumbered Summary of @value{GDBN}
196
197 The purpose of a debugger such as @value{GDBN} is to allow you to see what is
198 going on ``inside'' another program while it executes---or what another
199 program was doing at the moment it crashed.
200
201 @value{GDBN} can do four main kinds of things (plus other things in support of
202 these) to help you catch bugs in the act:
203
204 @itemize @bullet
205 @item
206 Start your program, specifying anything that might affect its behavior.
207
208 @item
209 Make your program stop on specified conditions.
210
211 @item
212 Examine what has happened, when your program has stopped.
213
214 @item
215 Change things in your program, so you can experiment with correcting the
216 effects of one bug and go on to learn about another.
217 @end itemize
218
219 You can use @value{GDBN} to debug programs written in C and C@t{++}.
220 For more information, see @ref{Supported Languages,,Supported Languages}.
221 For more information, see @ref{C,,C and C++}.
222
223 Support for D is partial. For information on D, see
224 @ref{D,,D}.
225
226 @cindex Modula-2
227 Support for Modula-2 is partial. For information on Modula-2, see
228 @ref{Modula-2,,Modula-2}.
229
230 Support for OpenCL C is partial. For information on OpenCL C, see
231 @ref{OpenCL C,,OpenCL C}.
232
233 @cindex Pascal
234 Debugging Pascal programs which use sets, subranges, file variables, or
235 nested functions does not currently work. @value{GDBN} does not support
236 entering expressions, printing values, or similar features using Pascal
237 syntax.
238
239 @cindex Fortran
240 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Fortran, although
241 it may be necessary to refer to some variables with a trailing
242 underscore.
243
244 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Objective-C,
245 using either the Apple/NeXT or the GNU Objective-C runtime.
246
247 @menu
248 * Free Software:: Freely redistributable software
249 * Contributors:: Contributors to GDB
250 @end menu
251
252 @node Free Software
253 @unnumberedsec Free Software
254
255 @value{GDBN} is @dfn{free software}, protected by the @sc{gnu}
256 General Public License
257 (GPL). The GPL gives you the freedom to copy or adapt a licensed
258 program---but every person getting a copy also gets with it the
259 freedom to modify that copy (which means that they must get access to
260 the source code), and the freedom to distribute further copies.
261 Typical software companies use copyrights to limit your freedoms; the
262 Free Software Foundation uses the GPL to preserve these freedoms.
263
264 Fundamentally, the General Public License is a license which says that
265 you have these freedoms and that you cannot take these freedoms away
266 from anyone else.
267
268 @unnumberedsec Free Software Needs Free Documentation
269
270 The biggest deficiency in the free software community today is not in
271 the software---it is the lack of good free documentation that we can
272 include with the free software. Many of our most important
273 programs do not come with free reference manuals and free introductory
274 texts. Documentation is an essential part of any software package;
275 when an important free software package does not come with a free
276 manual and a free tutorial, that is a major gap. We have many such
277 gaps today.
278
279 Consider Perl, for instance. The tutorial manuals that people
280 normally use are non-free. How did this come about? Because the
281 authors of those manuals published them with restrictive terms---no
282 copying, no modification, source files not available---which exclude
283 them from the free software world.
284
285 That wasn't the first time this sort of thing happened, and it was far
286 from the last. Many times we have heard a GNU user eagerly describe a
287 manual that he is writing, his intended contribution to the community,
288 only to learn that he had ruined everything by signing a publication
289 contract to make it non-free.
290
291 Free documentation, like free software, is a matter of freedom, not
292 price. The problem with the non-free manual is not that publishers
293 charge a price for printed copies---that in itself is fine. (The Free
294 Software Foundation sells printed copies of manuals, too.) The
295 problem is the restrictions on the use of the manual. Free manuals
296 are available in source code form, and give you permission to copy and
297 modify. Non-free manuals do not allow this.
298
299 The criteria of freedom for a free manual are roughly the same as for
300 free software. Redistribution (including the normal kinds of
301 commercial redistribution) must be permitted, so that the manual can
302 accompany every copy of the program, both on-line and on paper.
303
304 Permission for modification of the technical content is crucial too.
305 When people modify the software, adding or changing features, if they
306 are conscientious they will change the manual too---so they can
307 provide accurate and clear documentation for the modified program. A
308 manual that leaves you no choice but to write a new manual to document
309 a changed version of the program is not really available to our
310 community.
311
312 Some kinds of limits on the way modification is handled are
313 acceptable. For example, requirements to preserve the original
314 author's copyright notice, the distribution terms, or the list of
315 authors, are ok. It is also no problem to require modified versions
316 to include notice that they were modified. Even entire sections that
317 may not be deleted or changed are acceptable, as long as they deal
318 with nontechnical topics (like this one). These kinds of restrictions
319 are acceptable because they don't obstruct the community's normal use
320 of the manual.
321
322 However, it must be possible to modify all the @emph{technical}
323 content of the manual, and then distribute the result in all the usual
324 media, through all the usual channels. Otherwise, the restrictions
325 obstruct the use of the manual, it is not free, and we need another
326 manual to replace it.
327
328 Please spread the word about this issue. Our community continues to
329 lose manuals to proprietary publishing. If we spread the word that
330 free software needs free reference manuals and free tutorials, perhaps
331 the next person who wants to contribute by writing documentation will
332 realize, before it is too late, that only free manuals contribute to
333 the free software community.
334
335 If you are writing documentation, please insist on publishing it under
336 the GNU Free Documentation License or another free documentation
337 license. Remember that this decision requires your approval---you
338 don't have to let the publisher decide. Some commercial publishers
339 will use a free license if you insist, but they will not propose the
340 option; it is up to you to raise the issue and say firmly that this is
341 what you want. If the publisher you are dealing with refuses, please
342 try other publishers. If you're not sure whether a proposed license
343 is free, write to @email{licensing@@gnu.org}.
344
345 You can encourage commercial publishers to sell more free, copylefted
346 manuals and tutorials by buying them, and particularly by buying
347 copies from the publishers that paid for their writing or for major
348 improvements. Meanwhile, try to avoid buying non-free documentation
349 at all. Check the distribution terms of a manual before you buy it,
350 and insist that whoever seeks your business must respect your freedom.
351 Check the history of the book, and try to reward the publishers that
352 have paid or pay the authors to work on it.
353
354 The Free Software Foundation maintains a list of free documentation
355 published by other publishers, at
356 @url{http://www.fsf.org/doc/other-free-books.html}.
357
358 @node Contributors
359 @unnumberedsec Contributors to @value{GDBN}
360
361 Richard Stallman was the original author of @value{GDBN}, and of many
362 other @sc{gnu} programs. Many others have contributed to its
363 development. This section attempts to credit major contributors. One
364 of the virtues of free software is that everyone is free to contribute
365 to it; with regret, we cannot actually acknowledge everyone here. The
366 file @file{ChangeLog} in the @value{GDBN} distribution approximates a
367 blow-by-blow account.
368
369 Changes much prior to version 2.0 are lost in the mists of time.
370
371 @quotation
372 @emph{Plea:} Additions to this section are particularly welcome. If you
373 or your friends (or enemies, to be evenhanded) have been unfairly
374 omitted from this list, we would like to add your names!
375 @end quotation
376
377 So that they may not regard their many labors as thankless, we
378 particularly thank those who shepherded @value{GDBN} through major
379 releases:
380 Andrew Cagney (releases 6.3, 6.2, 6.1, 6.0, 5.3, 5.2, 5.1 and 5.0);
381 Jim Blandy (release 4.18);
382 Jason Molenda (release 4.17);
383 Stan Shebs (release 4.14);
384 Fred Fish (releases 4.16, 4.15, 4.13, 4.12, 4.11, 4.10, and 4.9);
385 Stu Grossman and John Gilmore (releases 4.8, 4.7, 4.6, 4.5, and 4.4);
386 John Gilmore (releases 4.3, 4.2, 4.1, 4.0, and 3.9);
387 Jim Kingdon (releases 3.5, 3.4, and 3.3);
388 and Randy Smith (releases 3.2, 3.1, and 3.0).
389
390 Richard Stallman, assisted at various times by Peter TerMaat, Chris
391 Hanson, and Richard Mlynarik, handled releases through 2.8.
392
393 Michael Tiemann is the author of most of the @sc{gnu} C@t{++} support
394 in @value{GDBN}, with significant additional contributions from Per
395 Bothner and Daniel Berlin. James Clark wrote the @sc{gnu} C@t{++}
396 demangler. Early work on C@t{++} was by Peter TerMaat (who also did
397 much general update work leading to release 3.0).
398
399 @value{GDBN} uses the BFD subroutine library to examine multiple
400 object-file formats; BFD was a joint project of David V.
401 Henkel-Wallace, Rich Pixley, Steve Chamberlain, and John Gilmore.
402
403 David Johnson wrote the original COFF support; Pace Willison did
404 the original support for encapsulated COFF.
405
406 Brent Benson of Harris Computer Systems contributed DWARF 2 support.
407
408 Adam de Boor and Bradley Davis contributed the ISI Optimum V support.
409 Per Bothner, Noboyuki Hikichi, and Alessandro Forin contributed MIPS
410 support.
411 Jean-Daniel Fekete contributed Sun 386i support.
412 Chris Hanson improved the HP9000 support.
413 Noboyuki Hikichi and Tomoyuki Hasei contributed Sony/News OS 3 support.
414 David Johnson contributed Encore Umax support.
415 Jyrki Kuoppala contributed Altos 3068 support.
416 Jeff Law contributed HP PA and SOM support.
417 Keith Packard contributed NS32K support.
418 Doug Rabson contributed Acorn Risc Machine support.
419 Bob Rusk contributed Harris Nighthawk CX-UX support.
420 Chris Smith contributed Convex support (and Fortran debugging).
421 Jonathan Stone contributed Pyramid support.
422 Michael Tiemann contributed SPARC support.
423 Tim Tucker contributed support for the Gould NP1 and Gould Powernode.
424 Pace Willison contributed Intel 386 support.
425 Jay Vosburgh contributed Symmetry support.
426 Marko Mlinar contributed OpenRISC 1000 support.
427
428 Andreas Schwab contributed M68K @sc{gnu}/Linux support.
429
430 Rich Schaefer and Peter Schauer helped with support of SunOS shared
431 libraries.
432
433 Jay Fenlason and Roland McGrath ensured that @value{GDBN} and GAS agree
434 about several machine instruction sets.
435
436 Patrick Duval, Ted Goldstein, Vikram Koka and Glenn Engel helped develop
437 remote debugging. Intel Corporation, Wind River Systems, AMD, and ARM
438 contributed remote debugging modules for the i960, VxWorks, A29K UDI,
439 and RDI targets, respectively.
440
441 Brian Fox is the author of the readline libraries providing
442 command-line editing and command history.
443
444 Andrew Beers of SUNY Buffalo wrote the language-switching code, the
445 Modula-2 support, and contributed the Languages chapter of this manual.
446
447 Fred Fish wrote most of the support for Unix System Vr4.
448 He also enhanced the command-completion support to cover C@t{++} overloaded
449 symbols.
450
451 Hitachi America (now Renesas America), Ltd. sponsored the support for
452 H8/300, H8/500, and Super-H processors.
453
454 NEC sponsored the support for the v850, Vr4xxx, and Vr5xxx processors.
455
456 Mitsubishi (now Renesas) sponsored the support for D10V, D30V, and M32R/D
457 processors.
458
459 Toshiba sponsored the support for the TX39 Mips processor.
460
461 Matsushita sponsored the support for the MN10200 and MN10300 processors.
462
463 Fujitsu sponsored the support for SPARClite and FR30 processors.
464
465 Kung Hsu, Jeff Law, and Rick Sladkey added support for hardware
466 watchpoints.
467
468 Michael Snyder added support for tracepoints.
469
470 Stu Grossman wrote gdbserver.
471
472 Jim Kingdon, Peter Schauer, Ian Taylor, and Stu Grossman made
473 nearly innumerable bug fixes and cleanups throughout @value{GDBN}.
474
475 The following people at the Hewlett-Packard Company contributed
476 support for the PA-RISC 2.0 architecture, HP-UX 10.20, 10.30, and 11.0
477 (narrow mode), HP's implementation of kernel threads, HP's aC@t{++}
478 compiler, and the Text User Interface (nee Terminal User Interface):
479 Ben Krepp, Richard Title, John Bishop, Susan Macchia, Kathy Mann,
480 Satish Pai, India Paul, Steve Rehrauer, and Elena Zannoni. Kim Haase
481 provided HP-specific information in this manual.
482
483 DJ Delorie ported @value{GDBN} to MS-DOS, for the DJGPP project.
484 Robert Hoehne made significant contributions to the DJGPP port.
485
486 Cygnus Solutions has sponsored @value{GDBN} maintenance and much of its
487 development since 1991. Cygnus engineers who have worked on @value{GDBN}
488 fulltime include Mark Alexander, Jim Blandy, Per Bothner, Kevin
489 Buettner, Edith Epstein, Chris Faylor, Fred Fish, Martin Hunt, Jim
490 Ingham, John Gilmore, Stu Grossman, Kung Hsu, Jim Kingdon, John Metzler,
491 Fernando Nasser, Geoffrey Noer, Dawn Perchik, Rich Pixley, Zdenek
492 Radouch, Keith Seitz, Stan Shebs, David Taylor, and Elena Zannoni. In
493 addition, Dave Brolley, Ian Carmichael, Steve Chamberlain, Nick Clifton,
494 JT Conklin, Stan Cox, DJ Delorie, Ulrich Drepper, Frank Eigler, Doug
495 Evans, Sean Fagan, David Henkel-Wallace, Richard Henderson, Jeff
496 Holcomb, Jeff Law, Jim Lemke, Tom Lord, Bob Manson, Michael Meissner,
497 Jason Merrill, Catherine Moore, Drew Moseley, Ken Raeburn, Gavin
498 Romig-Koch, Rob Savoye, Jamie Smith, Mike Stump, Ian Taylor, Angela
499 Thomas, Michael Tiemann, Tom Tromey, Ron Unrau, Jim Wilson, and David
500 Zuhn have made contributions both large and small.
501
502 Andrew Cagney, Fernando Nasser, and Elena Zannoni, while working for
503 Cygnus Solutions, implemented the original @sc{gdb/mi} interface.
504
505 Jim Blandy added support for preprocessor macros, while working for Red
506 Hat.
507
508 Andrew Cagney designed @value{GDBN}'s architecture vector. Many
509 people including Andrew Cagney, Stephane Carrez, Randolph Chung, Nick
510 Duffek, Richard Henderson, Mark Kettenis, Grace Sainsbury, Kei
511 Sakamoto, Yoshinori Sato, Michael Snyder, Andreas Schwab, Jason
512 Thorpe, Corinna Vinschen, Ulrich Weigand, and Elena Zannoni, helped
513 with the migration of old architectures to this new framework.
514
515 Andrew Cagney completely re-designed and re-implemented @value{GDBN}'s
516 unwinder framework, this consisting of a fresh new design featuring
517 frame IDs, independent frame sniffers, and the sentinel frame. Mark
518 Kettenis implemented the @sc{dwarf 2} unwinder, Jeff Johnston the
519 libunwind unwinder, and Andrew Cagney the dummy, sentinel, tramp, and
520 trad unwinders. The architecture-specific changes, each involving a
521 complete rewrite of the architecture's frame code, were carried out by
522 Jim Blandy, Joel Brobecker, Kevin Buettner, Andrew Cagney, Stephane
523 Carrez, Randolph Chung, Orjan Friberg, Richard Henderson, Daniel
524 Jacobowitz, Jeff Johnston, Mark Kettenis, Theodore A. Roth, Kei
525 Sakamoto, Yoshinori Sato, Michael Snyder, Corinna Vinschen, and Ulrich
526 Weigand.
527
528 Christian Zankel, Ross Morley, Bob Wilson, and Maxim Grigoriev from
529 Tensilica, Inc.@: contributed support for Xtensa processors. Others
530 who have worked on the Xtensa port of @value{GDBN} in the past include
531 Steve Tjiang, John Newlin, and Scott Foehner.
532
533 Michael Eager and staff of Xilinx, Inc., contributed support for the
534 Xilinx MicroBlaze architecture.
535
536 @node Sample Session
537 @chapter A Sample @value{GDBN} Session
538
539 You can use this manual at your leisure to read all about @value{GDBN}.
540 However, a handful of commands are enough to get started using the
541 debugger. This chapter illustrates those commands.
542
543 @iftex
544 In this sample session, we emphasize user input like this: @b{input},
545 to make it easier to pick out from the surrounding output.
546 @end iftex
547
548 @c FIXME: this example may not be appropriate for some configs, where
549 @c FIXME...primary interest is in remote use.
550
551 One of the preliminary versions of @sc{gnu} @code{m4} (a generic macro
552 processor) exhibits the following bug: sometimes, when we change its
553 quote strings from the default, the commands used to capture one macro
554 definition within another stop working. In the following short @code{m4}
555 session, we define a macro @code{foo} which expands to @code{0000}; we
556 then use the @code{m4} built-in @code{defn} to define @code{bar} as the
557 same thing. However, when we change the open quote string to
558 @code{<QUOTE>} and the close quote string to @code{<UNQUOTE>}, the same
559 procedure fails to define a new synonym @code{baz}:
560
561 @smallexample
562 $ @b{cd gnu/m4}
563 $ @b{./m4}
564 @b{define(foo,0000)}
565
566 @b{foo}
567 0000
568 @b{define(bar,defn(`foo'))}
569
570 @b{bar}
571 0000
572 @b{changequote(<QUOTE>,<UNQUOTE>)}
573
574 @b{define(baz,defn(<QUOTE>foo<UNQUOTE>))}
575 @b{baz}
576 @b{Ctrl-d}
577 m4: End of input: 0: fatal error: EOF in string
578 @end smallexample
579
580 @noindent
581 Let us use @value{GDBN} to try to see what is going on.
582
583 @smallexample
584 $ @b{@value{GDBP} m4}
585 @c FIXME: this falsifies the exact text played out, to permit smallbook
586 @c FIXME... format to come out better.
587 @value{GDBN} is free software and you are welcome to distribute copies
588 of it under certain conditions; type "show copying" to see
589 the conditions.
590 There is absolutely no warranty for @value{GDBN}; type "show warranty"
591 for details.
592
593 @value{GDBN} @value{GDBVN}, Copyright 1999 Free Software Foundation, Inc...
594 (@value{GDBP})
595 @end smallexample
596
597 @noindent
598 @value{GDBN} reads only enough symbol data to know where to find the
599 rest when needed; as a result, the first prompt comes up very quickly.
600 We now tell @value{GDBN} to use a narrower display width than usual, so
601 that examples fit in this manual.
602
603 @smallexample
604 (@value{GDBP}) @b{set width 70}
605 @end smallexample
606
607 @noindent
608 We need to see how the @code{m4} built-in @code{changequote} works.
609 Having looked at the source, we know the relevant subroutine is
610 @code{m4_changequote}, so we set a breakpoint there with the @value{GDBN}
611 @code{break} command.
612
613 @smallexample
614 (@value{GDBP}) @b{break m4_changequote}
615 Breakpoint 1 at 0x62f4: file builtin.c, line 879.
616 @end smallexample
617
618 @noindent
619 Using the @code{run} command, we start @code{m4} running under @value{GDBN}
620 control; as long as control does not reach the @code{m4_changequote}
621 subroutine, the program runs as usual:
622
623 @smallexample
624 (@value{GDBP}) @b{run}
625 Starting program: /work/Editorial/gdb/gnu/m4/m4
626 @b{define(foo,0000)}
627
628 @b{foo}
629 0000
630 @end smallexample
631
632 @noindent
633 To trigger the breakpoint, we call @code{changequote}. @value{GDBN}
634 suspends execution of @code{m4}, displaying information about the
635 context where it stops.
636
637 @smallexample
638 @b{changequote(<QUOTE>,<UNQUOTE>)}
639
640 Breakpoint 1, m4_changequote (argc=3, argv=0x33c70)
641 at builtin.c:879
642 879 if (bad_argc(TOKEN_DATA_TEXT(argv[0]),argc,1,3))
643 @end smallexample
644
645 @noindent
646 Now we use the command @code{n} (@code{next}) to advance execution to
647 the next line of the current function.
648
649 @smallexample
650 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
651 882 set_quotes((argc >= 2) ? TOKEN_DATA_TEXT(argv[1])\
652 : nil,
653 @end smallexample
654
655 @noindent
656 @code{set_quotes} looks like a promising subroutine. We can go into it
657 by using the command @code{s} (@code{step}) instead of @code{next}.
658 @code{step} goes to the next line to be executed in @emph{any}
659 subroutine, so it steps into @code{set_quotes}.
660
661 @smallexample
662 (@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
663 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<QUOTE>", rq=0x34c88 "<UNQUOTE>")
664 at input.c:530
665 530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
666 @end smallexample
667
668 @noindent
669 The display that shows the subroutine where @code{m4} is now
670 suspended (and its arguments) is called a stack frame display. It
671 shows a summary of the stack. We can use the @code{backtrace}
672 command (which can also be spelled @code{bt}), to see where we are
673 in the stack as a whole: the @code{backtrace} command displays a
674 stack frame for each active subroutine.
675
676 @smallexample
677 (@value{GDBP}) @b{bt}
678 #0 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<QUOTE>", rq=0x34c88 "<UNQUOTE>")
679 at input.c:530
680 #1 0x6344 in m4_changequote (argc=3, argv=0x33c70)
681 at builtin.c:882
682 #2 0x8174 in expand_macro (sym=0x33320) at macro.c:242
683 #3 0x7a88 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=209696, td=0xf7fffa30)
684 at macro.c:71
685 #4 0x79dc in expand_input () at macro.c:40
686 #5 0x2930 in main (argc=0, argv=0xf7fffb20) at m4.c:195
687 @end smallexample
688
689 @noindent
690 We step through a few more lines to see what happens. The first two
691 times, we can use @samp{s}; the next two times we use @code{n} to avoid
692 falling into the @code{xstrdup} subroutine.
693
694 @smallexample
695 (@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
696 0x3b5c 532 if (rquote != def_rquote)
697 (@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
698 0x3b80 535 lquote = (lq == nil || *lq == '\0') ? \
699 def_lquote : xstrdup(lq);
700 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
701 536 rquote = (rq == nil || *rq == '\0') ? def_rquote\
702 : xstrdup(rq);
703 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
704 538 len_lquote = strlen(rquote);
705 @end smallexample
706
707 @noindent
708 The last line displayed looks a little odd; we can examine the variables
709 @code{lquote} and @code{rquote} to see if they are in fact the new left
710 and right quotes we specified. We use the command @code{p}
711 (@code{print}) to see their values.
712
713 @smallexample
714 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p lquote}
715 $1 = 0x35d40 "<QUOTE>"
716 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p rquote}
717 $2 = 0x35d50 "<UNQUOTE>"
718 @end smallexample
719
720 @noindent
721 @code{lquote} and @code{rquote} are indeed the new left and right quotes.
722 To look at some context, we can display ten lines of source
723 surrounding the current line with the @code{l} (@code{list}) command.
724
725 @smallexample
726 (@value{GDBP}) @b{l}
727 533 xfree(rquote);
728 534
729 535 lquote = (lq == nil || *lq == '\0') ? def_lquote\
730 : xstrdup (lq);
731 536 rquote = (rq == nil || *rq == '\0') ? def_rquote\
732 : xstrdup (rq);
733 537
734 538 len_lquote = strlen(rquote);
735 539 len_rquote = strlen(lquote);
736 540 @}
737 541
738 542 void
739 @end smallexample
740
741 @noindent
742 Let us step past the two lines that set @code{len_lquote} and
743 @code{len_rquote}, and then examine the values of those variables.
744
745 @smallexample
746 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
747 539 len_rquote = strlen(lquote);
748 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
749 540 @}
750 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_lquote}
751 $3 = 9
752 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_rquote}
753 $4 = 7
754 @end smallexample
755
756 @noindent
757 That certainly looks wrong, assuming @code{len_lquote} and
758 @code{len_rquote} are meant to be the lengths of @code{lquote} and
759 @code{rquote} respectively. We can set them to better values using
760 the @code{p} command, since it can print the value of
761 any expression---and that expression can include subroutine calls and
762 assignments.
763
764 @smallexample
765 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_lquote=strlen(lquote)}
766 $5 = 7
767 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_rquote=strlen(rquote)}
768 $6 = 9
769 @end smallexample
770
771 @noindent
772 Is that enough to fix the problem of using the new quotes with the
773 @code{m4} built-in @code{defn}? We can allow @code{m4} to continue
774 executing with the @code{c} (@code{continue}) command, and then try the
775 example that caused trouble initially:
776
777 @smallexample
778 (@value{GDBP}) @b{c}
779 Continuing.
780
781 @b{define(baz,defn(<QUOTE>foo<UNQUOTE>))}
782
783 baz
784 0000
785 @end smallexample
786
787 @noindent
788 Success! The new quotes now work just as well as the default ones. The
789 problem seems to have been just the two typos defining the wrong
790 lengths. We allow @code{m4} exit by giving it an EOF as input:
791
792 @smallexample
793 @b{Ctrl-d}
794 Program exited normally.
795 @end smallexample
796
797 @noindent
798 The message @samp{Program exited normally.} is from @value{GDBN}; it
799 indicates @code{m4} has finished executing. We can end our @value{GDBN}
800 session with the @value{GDBN} @code{quit} command.
801
802 @smallexample
803 (@value{GDBP}) @b{quit}
804 @end smallexample
805
806 @node Invocation
807 @chapter Getting In and Out of @value{GDBN}
808
809 This chapter discusses how to start @value{GDBN}, and how to get out of it.
810 The essentials are:
811 @itemize @bullet
812 @item
813 type @samp{@value{GDBP}} to start @value{GDBN}.
814 @item
815 type @kbd{quit} or @kbd{Ctrl-d} to exit.
816 @end itemize
817
818 @menu
819 * Invoking GDB:: How to start @value{GDBN}
820 * Quitting GDB:: How to quit @value{GDBN}
821 * Shell Commands:: How to use shell commands inside @value{GDBN}
822 * Logging Output:: How to log @value{GDBN}'s output to a file
823 @end menu
824
825 @node Invoking GDB
826 @section Invoking @value{GDBN}
827
828 Invoke @value{GDBN} by running the program @code{@value{GDBP}}. Once started,
829 @value{GDBN} reads commands from the terminal until you tell it to exit.
830
831 You can also run @code{@value{GDBP}} with a variety of arguments and options,
832 to specify more of your debugging environment at the outset.
833
834 The command-line options described here are designed
835 to cover a variety of situations; in some environments, some of these
836 options may effectively be unavailable.
837
838 The most usual way to start @value{GDBN} is with one argument,
839 specifying an executable program:
840
841 @smallexample
842 @value{GDBP} @var{program}
843 @end smallexample
844
845 @noindent
846 You can also start with both an executable program and a core file
847 specified:
848
849 @smallexample
850 @value{GDBP} @var{program} @var{core}
851 @end smallexample
852
853 You can, instead, specify a process ID as a second argument, if you want
854 to debug a running process:
855
856 @smallexample
857 @value{GDBP} @var{program} 1234
858 @end smallexample
859
860 @noindent
861 would attach @value{GDBN} to process @code{1234} (unless you also have a file
862 named @file{1234}; @value{GDBN} does check for a core file first).
863
864 Taking advantage of the second command-line argument requires a fairly
865 complete operating system; when you use @value{GDBN} as a remote
866 debugger attached to a bare board, there may not be any notion of
867 ``process'', and there is often no way to get a core dump. @value{GDBN}
868 will warn you if it is unable to attach or to read core dumps.
869
870 You can optionally have @code{@value{GDBP}} pass any arguments after the
871 executable file to the inferior using @code{--args}. This option stops
872 option processing.
873 @smallexample
874 @value{GDBP} --args gcc -O2 -c foo.c
875 @end smallexample
876 This will cause @code{@value{GDBP}} to debug @code{gcc}, and to set
877 @code{gcc}'s command-line arguments (@pxref{Arguments}) to @samp{-O2 -c foo.c}.
878
879 You can run @code{@value{GDBP}} without printing the front material, which describes
880 @value{GDBN}'s non-warranty, by specifying @code{-silent}:
881
882 @smallexample
883 @value{GDBP} -silent
884 @end smallexample
885
886 @noindent
887 You can further control how @value{GDBN} starts up by using command-line
888 options. @value{GDBN} itself can remind you of the options available.
889
890 @noindent
891 Type
892
893 @smallexample
894 @value{GDBP} -help
895 @end smallexample
896
897 @noindent
898 to display all available options and briefly describe their use
899 (@samp{@value{GDBP} -h} is a shorter equivalent).
900
901 All options and command line arguments you give are processed
902 in sequential order. The order makes a difference when the
903 @samp{-x} option is used.
904
905
906 @menu
907 * File Options:: Choosing files
908 * Mode Options:: Choosing modes
909 * Startup:: What @value{GDBN} does during startup
910 @end menu
911
912 @node File Options
913 @subsection Choosing Files
914
915 When @value{GDBN} starts, it reads any arguments other than options as
916 specifying an executable file and core file (or process ID). This is
917 the same as if the arguments were specified by the @samp{-se} and
918 @samp{-c} (or @samp{-p}) options respectively. (@value{GDBN} reads the
919 first argument that does not have an associated option flag as
920 equivalent to the @samp{-se} option followed by that argument; and the
921 second argument that does not have an associated option flag, if any, as
922 equivalent to the @samp{-c}/@samp{-p} option followed by that argument.)
923 If the second argument begins with a decimal digit, @value{GDBN} will
924 first attempt to attach to it as a process, and if that fails, attempt
925 to open it as a corefile. If you have a corefile whose name begins with
926 a digit, you can prevent @value{GDBN} from treating it as a pid by
927 prefixing it with @file{./}, e.g.@: @file{./12345}.
928
929 If @value{GDBN} has not been configured to included core file support,
930 such as for most embedded targets, then it will complain about a second
931 argument and ignore it.
932
933 Many options have both long and short forms; both are shown in the
934 following list. @value{GDBN} also recognizes the long forms if you truncate
935 them, so long as enough of the option is present to be unambiguous.
936 (If you prefer, you can flag option arguments with @samp{--} rather
937 than @samp{-}, though we illustrate the more usual convention.)
938
939 @c NOTE: the @cindex entries here use double dashes ON PURPOSE. This
940 @c way, both those who look for -foo and --foo in the index, will find
941 @c it.
942
943 @table @code
944 @item -symbols @var{file}
945 @itemx -s @var{file}
946 @cindex @code{--symbols}
947 @cindex @code{-s}
948 Read symbol table from file @var{file}.
949
950 @item -exec @var{file}
951 @itemx -e @var{file}
952 @cindex @code{--exec}
953 @cindex @code{-e}
954 Use file @var{file} as the executable file to execute when appropriate,
955 and for examining pure data in conjunction with a core dump.
956
957 @item -se @var{file}
958 @cindex @code{--se}
959 Read symbol table from file @var{file} and use it as the executable
960 file.
961
962 @item -core @var{file}
963 @itemx -c @var{file}
964 @cindex @code{--core}
965 @cindex @code{-c}
966 Use file @var{file} as a core dump to examine.
967
968 @item -pid @var{number}
969 @itemx -p @var{number}
970 @cindex @code{--pid}
971 @cindex @code{-p}
972 Connect to process ID @var{number}, as with the @code{attach} command.
973
974 @item -command @var{file}
975 @itemx -x @var{file}
976 @cindex @code{--command}
977 @cindex @code{-x}
978 Execute commands from file @var{file}. The contents of this file is
979 evaluated exactly as the @code{source} command would.
980 @xref{Command Files,, Command files}.
981
982 @item -eval-command @var{command}
983 @itemx -ex @var{command}
984 @cindex @code{--eval-command}
985 @cindex @code{-ex}
986 Execute a single @value{GDBN} command.
987
988 This option may be used multiple times to call multiple commands. It may
989 also be interleaved with @samp{-command} as required.
990
991 @smallexample
992 @value{GDBP} -ex 'target sim' -ex 'load' \
993 -x setbreakpoints -ex 'run' a.out
994 @end smallexample
995
996 @item -directory @var{directory}
997 @itemx -d @var{directory}
998 @cindex @code{--directory}
999 @cindex @code{-d}
1000 Add @var{directory} to the path to search for source and script files.
1001
1002 @item -r
1003 @itemx -readnow
1004 @cindex @code{--readnow}
1005 @cindex @code{-r}
1006 Read each symbol file's entire symbol table immediately, rather than
1007 the default, which is to read it incrementally as it is needed.
1008 This makes startup slower, but makes future operations faster.
1009
1010 @end table
1011
1012 @node Mode Options
1013 @subsection Choosing Modes
1014
1015 You can run @value{GDBN} in various alternative modes---for example, in
1016 batch mode or quiet mode.
1017
1018 @table @code
1019 @item -nx
1020 @itemx -n
1021 @cindex @code{--nx}
1022 @cindex @code{-n}
1023 Do not execute commands found in any initialization files. Normally,
1024 @value{GDBN} executes the commands in these files after all the command
1025 options and arguments have been processed. @xref{Command Files,,Command
1026 Files}.
1027
1028 @item -quiet
1029 @itemx -silent
1030 @itemx -q
1031 @cindex @code{--quiet}
1032 @cindex @code{--silent}
1033 @cindex @code{-q}
1034 ``Quiet''. Do not print the introductory and copyright messages. These
1035 messages are also suppressed in batch mode.
1036
1037 @item -batch
1038 @cindex @code{--batch}
1039 Run in batch mode. Exit with status @code{0} after processing all the
1040 command files specified with @samp{-x} (and all commands from
1041 initialization files, if not inhibited with @samp{-n}). Exit with
1042 nonzero status if an error occurs in executing the @value{GDBN} commands
1043 in the command files. Batch mode also disables pagination, sets unlimited
1044 terminal width and height @pxref{Screen Size}, and acts as if @kbd{set confirm
1045 off} were in effect (@pxref{Messages/Warnings}).
1046
1047 Batch mode may be useful for running @value{GDBN} as a filter, for
1048 example to download and run a program on another computer; in order to
1049 make this more useful, the message
1050
1051 @smallexample
1052 Program exited normally.
1053 @end smallexample
1054
1055 @noindent
1056 (which is ordinarily issued whenever a program running under
1057 @value{GDBN} control terminates) is not issued when running in batch
1058 mode.
1059
1060 @item -batch-silent
1061 @cindex @code{--batch-silent}
1062 Run in batch mode exactly like @samp{-batch}, but totally silently. All
1063 @value{GDBN} output to @code{stdout} is prevented (@code{stderr} is
1064 unaffected). This is much quieter than @samp{-silent} and would be useless
1065 for an interactive session.
1066
1067 This is particularly useful when using targets that give @samp{Loading section}
1068 messages, for example.
1069
1070 Note that targets that give their output via @value{GDBN}, as opposed to
1071 writing directly to @code{stdout}, will also be made silent.
1072
1073 @item -return-child-result
1074 @cindex @code{--return-child-result}
1075 The return code from @value{GDBN} will be the return code from the child
1076 process (the process being debugged), with the following exceptions:
1077
1078 @itemize @bullet
1079 @item
1080 @value{GDBN} exits abnormally. E.g., due to an incorrect argument or an
1081 internal error. In this case the exit code is the same as it would have been
1082 without @samp{-return-child-result}.
1083 @item
1084 The user quits with an explicit value. E.g., @samp{quit 1}.
1085 @item
1086 The child process never runs, or is not allowed to terminate, in which case
1087 the exit code will be -1.
1088 @end itemize
1089
1090 This option is useful in conjunction with @samp{-batch} or @samp{-batch-silent},
1091 when @value{GDBN} is being used as a remote program loader or simulator
1092 interface.
1093
1094 @item -nowindows
1095 @itemx -nw
1096 @cindex @code{--nowindows}
1097 @cindex @code{-nw}
1098 ``No windows''. If @value{GDBN} comes with a graphical user interface
1099 (GUI) built in, then this option tells @value{GDBN} to only use the command-line
1100 interface. If no GUI is available, this option has no effect.
1101
1102 @item -windows
1103 @itemx -w
1104 @cindex @code{--windows}
1105 @cindex @code{-w}
1106 If @value{GDBN} includes a GUI, then this option requires it to be
1107 used if possible.
1108
1109 @item -cd @var{directory}
1110 @cindex @code{--cd}
1111 Run @value{GDBN} using @var{directory} as its working directory,
1112 instead of the current directory.
1113
1114 @item -data-directory @var{directory}
1115 @cindex @code{--data-directory}
1116 Run @value{GDBN} using @var{directory} as its data directory.
1117 The data directory is where @value{GDBN} searches for its
1118 auxiliary files. @xref{Data Files}.
1119
1120 @item -fullname
1121 @itemx -f
1122 @cindex @code{--fullname}
1123 @cindex @code{-f}
1124 @sc{gnu} Emacs sets this option when it runs @value{GDBN} as a
1125 subprocess. It tells @value{GDBN} to output the full file name and line
1126 number in a standard, recognizable fashion each time a stack frame is
1127 displayed (which includes each time your program stops). This
1128 recognizable format looks like two @samp{\032} characters, followed by
1129 the file name, line number and character position separated by colons,
1130 and a newline. The Emacs-to-@value{GDBN} interface program uses the two
1131 @samp{\032} characters as a signal to display the source code for the
1132 frame.
1133
1134 @item -epoch
1135 @cindex @code{--epoch}
1136 The Epoch Emacs-@value{GDBN} interface sets this option when it runs
1137 @value{GDBN} as a subprocess. It tells @value{GDBN} to modify its print
1138 routines so as to allow Epoch to display values of expressions in a
1139 separate window.
1140
1141 @item -annotate @var{level}
1142 @cindex @code{--annotate}
1143 This option sets the @dfn{annotation level} inside @value{GDBN}. Its
1144 effect is identical to using @samp{set annotate @var{level}}
1145 (@pxref{Annotations}). The annotation @var{level} controls how much
1146 information @value{GDBN} prints together with its prompt, values of
1147 expressions, source lines, and other types of output. Level 0 is the
1148 normal, level 1 is for use when @value{GDBN} is run as a subprocess of
1149 @sc{gnu} Emacs, level 3 is the maximum annotation suitable for programs
1150 that control @value{GDBN}, and level 2 has been deprecated.
1151
1152 The annotation mechanism has largely been superseded by @sc{gdb/mi}
1153 (@pxref{GDB/MI}).
1154
1155 @item --args
1156 @cindex @code{--args}
1157 Change interpretation of command line so that arguments following the
1158 executable file are passed as command line arguments to the inferior.
1159 This option stops option processing.
1160
1161 @item -baud @var{bps}
1162 @itemx -b @var{bps}
1163 @cindex @code{--baud}
1164 @cindex @code{-b}
1165 Set the line speed (baud rate or bits per second) of any serial
1166 interface used by @value{GDBN} for remote debugging.
1167
1168 @item -l @var{timeout}
1169 @cindex @code{-l}
1170 Set the timeout (in seconds) of any communication used by @value{GDBN}
1171 for remote debugging.
1172
1173 @item -tty @var{device}
1174 @itemx -t @var{device}
1175 @cindex @code{--tty}
1176 @cindex @code{-t}
1177 Run using @var{device} for your program's standard input and output.
1178 @c FIXME: kingdon thinks there is more to -tty. Investigate.
1179
1180 @c resolve the situation of these eventually
1181 @item -tui
1182 @cindex @code{--tui}
1183 Activate the @dfn{Text User Interface} when starting. The Text User
1184 Interface manages several text windows on the terminal, showing
1185 source, assembly, registers and @value{GDBN} command outputs
1186 (@pxref{TUI, ,@value{GDBN} Text User Interface}). Alternatively, the
1187 Text User Interface can be enabled by invoking the program
1188 @samp{@value{GDBTUI}}. Do not use this option if you run @value{GDBN} from
1189 Emacs (@pxref{Emacs, ,Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs}).
1190
1191 @c @item -xdb
1192 @c @cindex @code{--xdb}
1193 @c Run in XDB compatibility mode, allowing the use of certain XDB commands.
1194 @c For information, see the file @file{xdb_trans.html}, which is usually
1195 @c installed in the directory @code{/opt/langtools/wdb/doc} on HP-UX
1196 @c systems.
1197
1198 @item -interpreter @var{interp}
1199 @cindex @code{--interpreter}
1200 Use the interpreter @var{interp} for interface with the controlling
1201 program or device. This option is meant to be set by programs which
1202 communicate with @value{GDBN} using it as a back end.
1203 @xref{Interpreters, , Command Interpreters}.
1204
1205 @samp{--interpreter=mi} (or @samp{--interpreter=mi2}) causes
1206 @value{GDBN} to use the @dfn{@sc{gdb/mi} interface} (@pxref{GDB/MI, ,
1207 The @sc{gdb/mi} Interface}) included since @value{GDBN} version 6.0. The
1208 previous @sc{gdb/mi} interface, included in @value{GDBN} version 5.3 and
1209 selected with @samp{--interpreter=mi1}, is deprecated. Earlier
1210 @sc{gdb/mi} interfaces are no longer supported.
1211
1212 @item -write
1213 @cindex @code{--write}
1214 Open the executable and core files for both reading and writing. This
1215 is equivalent to the @samp{set write on} command inside @value{GDBN}
1216 (@pxref{Patching}).
1217
1218 @item -statistics
1219 @cindex @code{--statistics}
1220 This option causes @value{GDBN} to print statistics about time and
1221 memory usage after it completes each command and returns to the prompt.
1222
1223 @item -version
1224 @cindex @code{--version}
1225 This option causes @value{GDBN} to print its version number and
1226 no-warranty blurb, and exit.
1227
1228 @end table
1229
1230 @node Startup
1231 @subsection What @value{GDBN} Does During Startup
1232 @cindex @value{GDBN} startup
1233
1234 Here's the description of what @value{GDBN} does during session startup:
1235
1236 @enumerate
1237 @item
1238 Sets up the command interpreter as specified by the command line
1239 (@pxref{Mode Options, interpreter}).
1240
1241 @item
1242 @cindex init file
1243 Reads the system-wide @dfn{init file} (if @option{--with-system-gdbinit} was
1244 used when building @value{GDBN}; @pxref{System-wide configuration,
1245 ,System-wide configuration and settings}) and executes all the commands in
1246 that file.
1247
1248 @item
1249 Reads the init file (if any) in your home directory@footnote{On
1250 DOS/Windows systems, the home directory is the one pointed to by the
1251 @code{HOME} environment variable.} and executes all the commands in
1252 that file.
1253
1254 @item
1255 Processes command line options and operands.
1256
1257 @item
1258 Reads and executes the commands from init file (if any) in the current
1259 working directory. This is only done if the current directory is
1260 different from your home directory. Thus, you can have more than one
1261 init file, one generic in your home directory, and another, specific
1262 to the program you are debugging, in the directory where you invoke
1263 @value{GDBN}.
1264
1265 @item
1266 If the command line specified a program to debug, or a process to
1267 attach to, or a core file, @value{GDBN} loads any auto-loaded
1268 scripts provided for the program or for its loaded shared libraries.
1269 @xref{Auto-loading}.
1270
1271 If you wish to disable the auto-loading during startup,
1272 you must do something like the following:
1273
1274 @smallexample
1275 $ gdb -ex "set auto-load-scripts off" -ex "file myprogram"
1276 @end smallexample
1277
1278 The following does not work because the auto-loading is turned off too late:
1279
1280 @smallexample
1281 $ gdb -ex "set auto-load-scripts off" myprogram
1282 @end smallexample
1283
1284 @item
1285 Reads command files specified by the @samp{-x} option. @xref{Command
1286 Files}, for more details about @value{GDBN} command files.
1287
1288 @item
1289 Reads the command history recorded in the @dfn{history file}.
1290 @xref{Command History}, for more details about the command history and the
1291 files where @value{GDBN} records it.
1292 @end enumerate
1293
1294 Init files use the same syntax as @dfn{command files} (@pxref{Command
1295 Files}) and are processed by @value{GDBN} in the same way. The init
1296 file in your home directory can set options (such as @samp{set
1297 complaints}) that affect subsequent processing of command line options
1298 and operands. Init files are not executed if you use the @samp{-nx}
1299 option (@pxref{Mode Options, ,Choosing Modes}).
1300
1301 To display the list of init files loaded by gdb at startup, you
1302 can use @kbd{gdb --help}.
1303
1304 @cindex init file name
1305 @cindex @file{.gdbinit}
1306 @cindex @file{gdb.ini}
1307 The @value{GDBN} init files are normally called @file{.gdbinit}.
1308 The DJGPP port of @value{GDBN} uses the name @file{gdb.ini}, due to
1309 the limitations of file names imposed by DOS filesystems. The Windows
1310 ports of @value{GDBN} use the standard name, but if they find a
1311 @file{gdb.ini} file, they warn you about that and suggest to rename
1312 the file to the standard name.
1313
1314
1315 @node Quitting GDB
1316 @section Quitting @value{GDBN}
1317 @cindex exiting @value{GDBN}
1318 @cindex leaving @value{GDBN}
1319
1320 @table @code
1321 @kindex quit @r{[}@var{expression}@r{]}
1322 @kindex q @r{(@code{quit})}
1323 @item quit @r{[}@var{expression}@r{]}
1324 @itemx q
1325 To exit @value{GDBN}, use the @code{quit} command (abbreviated
1326 @code{q}), or type an end-of-file character (usually @kbd{Ctrl-d}). If you
1327 do not supply @var{expression}, @value{GDBN} will terminate normally;
1328 otherwise it will terminate using the result of @var{expression} as the
1329 error code.
1330 @end table
1331
1332 @cindex interrupt
1333 An interrupt (often @kbd{Ctrl-c}) does not exit from @value{GDBN}, but rather
1334 terminates the action of any @value{GDBN} command that is in progress and
1335 returns to @value{GDBN} command level. It is safe to type the interrupt
1336 character at any time because @value{GDBN} does not allow it to take effect
1337 until a time when it is safe.
1338
1339 If you have been using @value{GDBN} to control an attached process or
1340 device, you can release it with the @code{detach} command
1341 (@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an Already-running Process}).
1342
1343 @node Shell Commands
1344 @section Shell Commands
1345
1346 If you need to execute occasional shell commands during your
1347 debugging session, there is no need to leave or suspend @value{GDBN}; you can
1348 just use the @code{shell} command.
1349
1350 @table @code
1351 @kindex shell
1352 @cindex shell escape
1353 @item shell @var{command string}
1354 Invoke a standard shell to execute @var{command string}.
1355 If it exists, the environment variable @code{SHELL} determines which
1356 shell to run. Otherwise @value{GDBN} uses the default shell
1357 (@file{/bin/sh} on Unix systems, @file{COMMAND.COM} on MS-DOS, etc.).
1358 @end table
1359
1360 The utility @code{make} is often needed in development environments.
1361 You do not have to use the @code{shell} command for this purpose in
1362 @value{GDBN}:
1363
1364 @table @code
1365 @kindex make
1366 @cindex calling make
1367 @item make @var{make-args}
1368 Execute the @code{make} program with the specified
1369 arguments. This is equivalent to @samp{shell make @var{make-args}}.
1370 @end table
1371
1372 @node Logging Output
1373 @section Logging Output
1374 @cindex logging @value{GDBN} output
1375 @cindex save @value{GDBN} output to a file
1376
1377 You may want to save the output of @value{GDBN} commands to a file.
1378 There are several commands to control @value{GDBN}'s logging.
1379
1380 @table @code
1381 @kindex set logging
1382 @item set logging on
1383 Enable logging.
1384 @item set logging off
1385 Disable logging.
1386 @cindex logging file name
1387 @item set logging file @var{file}
1388 Change the name of the current logfile. The default logfile is @file{gdb.txt}.
1389 @item set logging overwrite [on|off]
1390 By default, @value{GDBN} will append to the logfile. Set @code{overwrite} if
1391 you want @code{set logging on} to overwrite the logfile instead.
1392 @item set logging redirect [on|off]
1393 By default, @value{GDBN} output will go to both the terminal and the logfile.
1394 Set @code{redirect} if you want output to go only to the log file.
1395 @kindex show logging
1396 @item show logging
1397 Show the current values of the logging settings.
1398 @end table
1399
1400 @node Commands
1401 @chapter @value{GDBN} Commands
1402
1403 You can abbreviate a @value{GDBN} command to the first few letters of the command
1404 name, if that abbreviation is unambiguous; and you can repeat certain
1405 @value{GDBN} commands by typing just @key{RET}. You can also use the @key{TAB}
1406 key to get @value{GDBN} to fill out the rest of a word in a command (or to
1407 show you the alternatives available, if there is more than one possibility).
1408
1409 @menu
1410 * Command Syntax:: How to give commands to @value{GDBN}
1411 * Completion:: Command completion
1412 * Help:: How to ask @value{GDBN} for help
1413 @end menu
1414
1415 @node Command Syntax
1416 @section Command Syntax
1417
1418 A @value{GDBN} command is a single line of input. There is no limit on
1419 how long it can be. It starts with a command name, which is followed by
1420 arguments whose meaning depends on the command name. For example, the
1421 command @code{step} accepts an argument which is the number of times to
1422 step, as in @samp{step 5}. You can also use the @code{step} command
1423 with no arguments. Some commands do not allow any arguments.
1424
1425 @cindex abbreviation
1426 @value{GDBN} command names may always be truncated if that abbreviation is
1427 unambiguous. Other possible command abbreviations are listed in the
1428 documentation for individual commands. In some cases, even ambiguous
1429 abbreviations are allowed; for example, @code{s} is specially defined as
1430 equivalent to @code{step} even though there are other commands whose
1431 names start with @code{s}. You can test abbreviations by using them as
1432 arguments to the @code{help} command.
1433
1434 @cindex repeating commands
1435 @kindex RET @r{(repeat last command)}
1436 A blank line as input to @value{GDBN} (typing just @key{RET}) means to
1437 repeat the previous command. Certain commands (for example, @code{run})
1438 will not repeat this way; these are commands whose unintentional
1439 repetition might cause trouble and which you are unlikely to want to
1440 repeat. User-defined commands can disable this feature; see
1441 @ref{Define, dont-repeat}.
1442
1443 The @code{list} and @code{x} commands, when you repeat them with
1444 @key{RET}, construct new arguments rather than repeating
1445 exactly as typed. This permits easy scanning of source or memory.
1446
1447 @value{GDBN} can also use @key{RET} in another way: to partition lengthy
1448 output, in a way similar to the common utility @code{more}
1449 (@pxref{Screen Size,,Screen Size}). Since it is easy to press one
1450 @key{RET} too many in this situation, @value{GDBN} disables command
1451 repetition after any command that generates this sort of display.
1452
1453 @kindex # @r{(a comment)}
1454 @cindex comment
1455 Any text from a @kbd{#} to the end of the line is a comment; it does
1456 nothing. This is useful mainly in command files (@pxref{Command
1457 Files,,Command Files}).
1458
1459 @cindex repeating command sequences
1460 @kindex Ctrl-o @r{(operate-and-get-next)}
1461 The @kbd{Ctrl-o} binding is useful for repeating a complex sequence of
1462 commands. This command accepts the current line, like @key{RET}, and
1463 then fetches the next line relative to the current line from the history
1464 for editing.
1465
1466 @node Completion
1467 @section Command Completion
1468
1469 @cindex completion
1470 @cindex word completion
1471 @value{GDBN} can fill in the rest of a word in a command for you, if there is
1472 only one possibility; it can also show you what the valid possibilities
1473 are for the next word in a command, at any time. This works for @value{GDBN}
1474 commands, @value{GDBN} subcommands, and the names of symbols in your program.
1475
1476 Press the @key{TAB} key whenever you want @value{GDBN} to fill out the rest
1477 of a word. If there is only one possibility, @value{GDBN} fills in the
1478 word, and waits for you to finish the command (or press @key{RET} to
1479 enter it). For example, if you type
1480
1481 @c FIXME "@key" does not distinguish its argument sufficiently to permit
1482 @c complete accuracy in these examples; space introduced for clarity.
1483 @c If texinfo enhancements make it unnecessary, it would be nice to
1484 @c replace " @key" by "@key" in the following...
1485 @smallexample
1486 (@value{GDBP}) info bre @key{TAB}
1487 @end smallexample
1488
1489 @noindent
1490 @value{GDBN} fills in the rest of the word @samp{breakpoints}, since that is
1491 the only @code{info} subcommand beginning with @samp{bre}:
1492
1493 @smallexample
1494 (@value{GDBP}) info breakpoints
1495 @end smallexample
1496
1497 @noindent
1498 You can either press @key{RET} at this point, to run the @code{info
1499 breakpoints} command, or backspace and enter something else, if
1500 @samp{breakpoints} does not look like the command you expected. (If you
1501 were sure you wanted @code{info breakpoints} in the first place, you
1502 might as well just type @key{RET} immediately after @samp{info bre},
1503 to exploit command abbreviations rather than command completion).
1504
1505 If there is more than one possibility for the next word when you press
1506 @key{TAB}, @value{GDBN} sounds a bell. You can either supply more
1507 characters and try again, or just press @key{TAB} a second time;
1508 @value{GDBN} displays all the possible completions for that word. For
1509 example, you might want to set a breakpoint on a subroutine whose name
1510 begins with @samp{make_}, but when you type @kbd{b make_@key{TAB}} @value{GDBN}
1511 just sounds the bell. Typing @key{TAB} again displays all the
1512 function names in your program that begin with those characters, for
1513 example:
1514
1515 @smallexample
1516 (@value{GDBP}) b make_ @key{TAB}
1517 @exdent @value{GDBN} sounds bell; press @key{TAB} again, to see:
1518 make_a_section_from_file make_environ
1519 make_abs_section make_function_type
1520 make_blockvector make_pointer_type
1521 make_cleanup make_reference_type
1522 make_command make_symbol_completion_list
1523 (@value{GDBP}) b make_
1524 @end smallexample
1525
1526 @noindent
1527 After displaying the available possibilities, @value{GDBN} copies your
1528 partial input (@samp{b make_} in the example) so you can finish the
1529 command.
1530
1531 If you just want to see the list of alternatives in the first place, you
1532 can press @kbd{M-?} rather than pressing @key{TAB} twice. @kbd{M-?}
1533 means @kbd{@key{META} ?}. You can type this either by holding down a
1534 key designated as the @key{META} shift on your keyboard (if there is
1535 one) while typing @kbd{?}, or as @key{ESC} followed by @kbd{?}.
1536
1537 @cindex quotes in commands
1538 @cindex completion of quoted strings
1539 Sometimes the string you need, while logically a ``word'', may contain
1540 parentheses or other characters that @value{GDBN} normally excludes from
1541 its notion of a word. To permit word completion to work in this
1542 situation, you may enclose words in @code{'} (single quote marks) in
1543 @value{GDBN} commands.
1544
1545 The most likely situation where you might need this is in typing the
1546 name of a C@t{++} function. This is because C@t{++} allows function
1547 overloading (multiple definitions of the same function, distinguished
1548 by argument type). For example, when you want to set a breakpoint you
1549 may need to distinguish whether you mean the version of @code{name}
1550 that takes an @code{int} parameter, @code{name(int)}, or the version
1551 that takes a @code{float} parameter, @code{name(float)}. To use the
1552 word-completion facilities in this situation, type a single quote
1553 @code{'} at the beginning of the function name. This alerts
1554 @value{GDBN} that it may need to consider more information than usual
1555 when you press @key{TAB} or @kbd{M-?} to request word completion:
1556
1557 @smallexample
1558 (@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble( @kbd{M-?}
1559 bubble(double,double) bubble(int,int)
1560 (@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble(
1561 @end smallexample
1562
1563 In some cases, @value{GDBN} can tell that completing a name requires using
1564 quotes. When this happens, @value{GDBN} inserts the quote for you (while
1565 completing as much as it can) if you do not type the quote in the first
1566 place:
1567
1568 @smallexample
1569 (@value{GDBP}) b bub @key{TAB}
1570 @exdent @value{GDBN} alters your input line to the following, and rings a bell:
1571 (@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble(
1572 @end smallexample
1573
1574 @noindent
1575 In general, @value{GDBN} can tell that a quote is needed (and inserts it) if
1576 you have not yet started typing the argument list when you ask for
1577 completion on an overloaded symbol.
1578
1579 For more information about overloaded functions, see @ref{C Plus Plus
1580 Expressions, ,C@t{++} Expressions}. You can use the command @code{set
1581 overload-resolution off} to disable overload resolution;
1582 see @ref{Debugging C Plus Plus, ,@value{GDBN} Features for C@t{++}}.
1583
1584 @cindex completion of structure field names
1585 @cindex structure field name completion
1586 @cindex completion of union field names
1587 @cindex union field name completion
1588 When completing in an expression which looks up a field in a
1589 structure, @value{GDBN} also tries@footnote{The completer can be
1590 confused by certain kinds of invalid expressions. Also, it only
1591 examines the static type of the expression, not the dynamic type.} to
1592 limit completions to the field names available in the type of the
1593 left-hand-side:
1594
1595 @smallexample
1596 (@value{GDBP}) p gdb_stdout.@kbd{M-?}
1597 magic to_delete to_fputs to_put to_rewind
1598 to_data to_flush to_isatty to_read to_write
1599 @end smallexample
1600
1601 @noindent
1602 This is because the @code{gdb_stdout} is a variable of the type
1603 @code{struct ui_file} that is defined in @value{GDBN} sources as
1604 follows:
1605
1606 @smallexample
1607 struct ui_file
1608 @{
1609 int *magic;
1610 ui_file_flush_ftype *to_flush;
1611 ui_file_write_ftype *to_write;
1612 ui_file_fputs_ftype *to_fputs;
1613 ui_file_read_ftype *to_read;
1614 ui_file_delete_ftype *to_delete;
1615 ui_file_isatty_ftype *to_isatty;
1616 ui_file_rewind_ftype *to_rewind;
1617 ui_file_put_ftype *to_put;
1618 void *to_data;
1619 @}
1620 @end smallexample
1621
1622
1623 @node Help
1624 @section Getting Help
1625 @cindex online documentation
1626 @kindex help
1627
1628 You can always ask @value{GDBN} itself for information on its commands,
1629 using the command @code{help}.
1630
1631 @table @code
1632 @kindex h @r{(@code{help})}
1633 @item help
1634 @itemx h
1635 You can use @code{help} (abbreviated @code{h}) with no arguments to
1636 display a short list of named classes of commands:
1637
1638 @smallexample
1639 (@value{GDBP}) help
1640 List of classes of commands:
1641
1642 aliases -- Aliases of other commands
1643 breakpoints -- Making program stop at certain points
1644 data -- Examining data
1645 files -- Specifying and examining files
1646 internals -- Maintenance commands
1647 obscure -- Obscure features
1648 running -- Running the program
1649 stack -- Examining the stack
1650 status -- Status inquiries
1651 support -- Support facilities
1652 tracepoints -- Tracing of program execution without
1653 stopping the program
1654 user-defined -- User-defined commands
1655
1656 Type "help" followed by a class name for a list of
1657 commands in that class.
1658 Type "help" followed by command name for full
1659 documentation.
1660 Command name abbreviations are allowed if unambiguous.
1661 (@value{GDBP})
1662 @end smallexample
1663 @c the above line break eliminates huge line overfull...
1664
1665 @item help @var{class}
1666 Using one of the general help classes as an argument, you can get a
1667 list of the individual commands in that class. For example, here is the
1668 help display for the class @code{status}:
1669
1670 @smallexample
1671 (@value{GDBP}) help status
1672 Status inquiries.
1673
1674 List of commands:
1675
1676 @c Line break in "show" line falsifies real output, but needed
1677 @c to fit in smallbook page size.
1678 info -- Generic command for showing things
1679 about the program being debugged
1680 show -- Generic command for showing things
1681 about the debugger
1682
1683 Type "help" followed by command name for full
1684 documentation.
1685 Command name abbreviations are allowed if unambiguous.
1686 (@value{GDBP})
1687 @end smallexample
1688
1689 @item help @var{command}
1690 With a command name as @code{help} argument, @value{GDBN} displays a
1691 short paragraph on how to use that command.
1692
1693 @kindex apropos
1694 @item apropos @var{args}
1695 The @code{apropos} command searches through all of the @value{GDBN}
1696 commands, and their documentation, for the regular expression specified in
1697 @var{args}. It prints out all matches found. For example:
1698
1699 @smallexample
1700 apropos reload
1701 @end smallexample
1702
1703 @noindent
1704 results in:
1705
1706 @smallexample
1707 @c @group
1708 set symbol-reloading -- Set dynamic symbol table reloading
1709 multiple times in one run
1710 show symbol-reloading -- Show dynamic symbol table reloading
1711 multiple times in one run
1712 @c @end group
1713 @end smallexample
1714
1715 @kindex complete
1716 @item complete @var{args}
1717 The @code{complete @var{args}} command lists all the possible completions
1718 for the beginning of a command. Use @var{args} to specify the beginning of the
1719 command you want completed. For example:
1720
1721 @smallexample
1722 complete i
1723 @end smallexample
1724
1725 @noindent results in:
1726
1727 @smallexample
1728 @group
1729 if
1730 ignore
1731 info
1732 inspect
1733 @end group
1734 @end smallexample
1735
1736 @noindent This is intended for use by @sc{gnu} Emacs.
1737 @end table
1738
1739 In addition to @code{help}, you can use the @value{GDBN} commands @code{info}
1740 and @code{show} to inquire about the state of your program, or the state
1741 of @value{GDBN} itself. Each command supports many topics of inquiry; this
1742 manual introduces each of them in the appropriate context. The listings
1743 under @code{info} and under @code{show} in the Index point to
1744 all the sub-commands. @xref{Index}.
1745
1746 @c @group
1747 @table @code
1748 @kindex info
1749 @kindex i @r{(@code{info})}
1750 @item info
1751 This command (abbreviated @code{i}) is for describing the state of your
1752 program. For example, you can show the arguments passed to a function
1753 with @code{info args}, list the registers currently in use with @code{info
1754 registers}, or list the breakpoints you have set with @code{info breakpoints}.
1755 You can get a complete list of the @code{info} sub-commands with
1756 @w{@code{help info}}.
1757
1758 @kindex set
1759 @item set
1760 You can assign the result of an expression to an environment variable with
1761 @code{set}. For example, you can set the @value{GDBN} prompt to a $-sign with
1762 @code{set prompt $}.
1763
1764 @kindex show
1765 @item show
1766 In contrast to @code{info}, @code{show} is for describing the state of
1767 @value{GDBN} itself.
1768 You can change most of the things you can @code{show}, by using the
1769 related command @code{set}; for example, you can control what number
1770 system is used for displays with @code{set radix}, or simply inquire
1771 which is currently in use with @code{show radix}.
1772
1773 @kindex info set
1774 To display all the settable parameters and their current
1775 values, you can use @code{show} with no arguments; you may also use
1776 @code{info set}. Both commands produce the same display.
1777 @c FIXME: "info set" violates the rule that "info" is for state of
1778 @c FIXME...program. Ck w/ GNU: "info set" to be called something else,
1779 @c FIXME...or change desc of rule---eg "state of prog and debugging session"?
1780 @end table
1781 @c @end group
1782
1783 Here are three miscellaneous @code{show} subcommands, all of which are
1784 exceptional in lacking corresponding @code{set} commands:
1785
1786 @table @code
1787 @kindex show version
1788 @cindex @value{GDBN} version number
1789 @item show version
1790 Show what version of @value{GDBN} is running. You should include this
1791 information in @value{GDBN} bug-reports. If multiple versions of
1792 @value{GDBN} are in use at your site, you may need to determine which
1793 version of @value{GDBN} you are running; as @value{GDBN} evolves, new
1794 commands are introduced, and old ones may wither away. Also, many
1795 system vendors ship variant versions of @value{GDBN}, and there are
1796 variant versions of @value{GDBN} in @sc{gnu}/Linux distributions as well.
1797 The version number is the same as the one announced when you start
1798 @value{GDBN}.
1799
1800 @kindex show copying
1801 @kindex info copying
1802 @cindex display @value{GDBN} copyright
1803 @item show copying
1804 @itemx info copying
1805 Display information about permission for copying @value{GDBN}.
1806
1807 @kindex show warranty
1808 @kindex info warranty
1809 @item show warranty
1810 @itemx info warranty
1811 Display the @sc{gnu} ``NO WARRANTY'' statement, or a warranty,
1812 if your version of @value{GDBN} comes with one.
1813
1814 @end table
1815
1816 @node Running
1817 @chapter Running Programs Under @value{GDBN}
1818
1819 When you run a program under @value{GDBN}, you must first generate
1820 debugging information when you compile it.
1821
1822 You may start @value{GDBN} with its arguments, if any, in an environment
1823 of your choice. If you are doing native debugging, you may redirect
1824 your program's input and output, debug an already running process, or
1825 kill a child process.
1826
1827 @menu
1828 * Compilation:: Compiling for debugging
1829 * Starting:: Starting your program
1830 * Arguments:: Your program's arguments
1831 * Environment:: Your program's environment
1832
1833 * Working Directory:: Your program's working directory
1834 * Input/Output:: Your program's input and output
1835 * Attach:: Debugging an already-running process
1836 * Kill Process:: Killing the child process
1837
1838 * Inferiors and Programs:: Debugging multiple inferiors and programs
1839 * Threads:: Debugging programs with multiple threads
1840 * Forks:: Debugging forks
1841 * Checkpoint/Restart:: Setting a @emph{bookmark} to return to later
1842 @end menu
1843
1844 @node Compilation
1845 @section Compiling for Debugging
1846
1847 In order to debug a program effectively, you need to generate
1848 debugging information when you compile it. This debugging information
1849 is stored in the object file; it describes the data type of each
1850 variable or function and the correspondence between source line numbers
1851 and addresses in the executable code.
1852
1853 To request debugging information, specify the @samp{-g} option when you run
1854 the compiler.
1855
1856 Programs that are to be shipped to your customers are compiled with
1857 optimizations, using the @samp{-O} compiler option. However, some
1858 compilers are unable to handle the @samp{-g} and @samp{-O} options
1859 together. Using those compilers, you cannot generate optimized
1860 executables containing debugging information.
1861
1862 @value{NGCC}, the @sc{gnu} C/C@t{++} compiler, supports @samp{-g} with or
1863 without @samp{-O}, making it possible to debug optimized code. We
1864 recommend that you @emph{always} use @samp{-g} whenever you compile a
1865 program. You may think your program is correct, but there is no sense
1866 in pushing your luck. For more information, see @ref{Optimized Code}.
1867
1868 Older versions of the @sc{gnu} C compiler permitted a variant option
1869 @w{@samp{-gg}} for debugging information. @value{GDBN} no longer supports this
1870 format; if your @sc{gnu} C compiler has this option, do not use it.
1871
1872 @value{GDBN} knows about preprocessor macros and can show you their
1873 expansion (@pxref{Macros}). Most compilers do not include information
1874 about preprocessor macros in the debugging information if you specify
1875 the @option{-g} flag alone, because this information is rather large.
1876 Version 3.1 and later of @value{NGCC}, the @sc{gnu} C compiler,
1877 provides macro information if you specify the options
1878 @option{-gdwarf-2} and @option{-g3}; the former option requests
1879 debugging information in the Dwarf 2 format, and the latter requests
1880 ``extra information''. In the future, we hope to find more compact
1881 ways to represent macro information, so that it can be included with
1882 @option{-g} alone.
1883
1884 @need 2000
1885 @node Starting
1886 @section Starting your Program
1887 @cindex starting
1888 @cindex running
1889
1890 @table @code
1891 @kindex run
1892 @kindex r @r{(@code{run})}
1893 @item run
1894 @itemx r
1895 Use the @code{run} command to start your program under @value{GDBN}.
1896 You must first specify the program name (except on VxWorks) with an
1897 argument to @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Invocation, ,Getting In and Out of
1898 @value{GDBN}}), or by using the @code{file} or @code{exec-file} command
1899 (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}).
1900
1901 @end table
1902
1903 If you are running your program in an execution environment that
1904 supports processes, @code{run} creates an inferior process and makes
1905 that process run your program. In some environments without processes,
1906 @code{run} jumps to the start of your program. Other targets,
1907 like @samp{remote}, are always running. If you get an error
1908 message like this one:
1909
1910 @smallexample
1911 The "remote" target does not support "run".
1912 Try "help target" or "continue".
1913 @end smallexample
1914
1915 @noindent
1916 then use @code{continue} to run your program. You may need @code{load}
1917 first (@pxref{load}).
1918
1919 The execution of a program is affected by certain information it
1920 receives from its superior. @value{GDBN} provides ways to specify this
1921 information, which you must do @emph{before} starting your program. (You
1922 can change it after starting your program, but such changes only affect
1923 your program the next time you start it.) This information may be
1924 divided into four categories:
1925
1926 @table @asis
1927 @item The @emph{arguments.}
1928 Specify the arguments to give your program as the arguments of the
1929 @code{run} command. If a shell is available on your target, the shell
1930 is used to pass the arguments, so that you may use normal conventions
1931 (such as wildcard expansion or variable substitution) in describing
1932 the arguments.
1933 In Unix systems, you can control which shell is used with the
1934 @code{SHELL} environment variable.
1935 @xref{Arguments, ,Your Program's Arguments}.
1936
1937 @item The @emph{environment.}
1938 Your program normally inherits its environment from @value{GDBN}, but you can
1939 use the @value{GDBN} commands @code{set environment} and @code{unset
1940 environment} to change parts of the environment that affect
1941 your program. @xref{Environment, ,Your Program's Environment}.
1942
1943 @item The @emph{working directory.}
1944 Your program inherits its working directory from @value{GDBN}. You can set
1945 the @value{GDBN} working directory with the @code{cd} command in @value{GDBN}.
1946 @xref{Working Directory, ,Your Program's Working Directory}.
1947
1948 @item The @emph{standard input and output.}
1949 Your program normally uses the same device for standard input and
1950 standard output as @value{GDBN} is using. You can redirect input and output
1951 in the @code{run} command line, or you can use the @code{tty} command to
1952 set a different device for your program.
1953 @xref{Input/Output, ,Your Program's Input and Output}.
1954
1955 @cindex pipes
1956 @emph{Warning:} While input and output redirection work, you cannot use
1957 pipes to pass the output of the program you are debugging to another
1958 program; if you attempt this, @value{GDBN} is likely to wind up debugging the
1959 wrong program.
1960 @end table
1961
1962 When you issue the @code{run} command, your program begins to execute
1963 immediately. @xref{Stopping, ,Stopping and Continuing}, for discussion
1964 of how to arrange for your program to stop. Once your program has
1965 stopped, you may call functions in your program, using the @code{print}
1966 or @code{call} commands. @xref{Data, ,Examining Data}.
1967
1968 If the modification time of your symbol file has changed since the last
1969 time @value{GDBN} read its symbols, @value{GDBN} discards its symbol
1970 table, and reads it again. When it does this, @value{GDBN} tries to retain
1971 your current breakpoints.
1972
1973 @table @code
1974 @kindex start
1975 @item start
1976 @cindex run to main procedure
1977 The name of the main procedure can vary from language to language.
1978 With C or C@t{++}, the main procedure name is always @code{main}, but
1979 other languages such as Ada do not require a specific name for their
1980 main procedure. The debugger provides a convenient way to start the
1981 execution of the program and to stop at the beginning of the main
1982 procedure, depending on the language used.
1983
1984 The @samp{start} command does the equivalent of setting a temporary
1985 breakpoint at the beginning of the main procedure and then invoking
1986 the @samp{run} command.
1987
1988 @cindex elaboration phase
1989 Some programs contain an @dfn{elaboration} phase where some startup code is
1990 executed before the main procedure is called. This depends on the
1991 languages used to write your program. In C@t{++}, for instance,
1992 constructors for static and global objects are executed before
1993 @code{main} is called. It is therefore possible that the debugger stops
1994 before reaching the main procedure. However, the temporary breakpoint
1995 will remain to halt execution.
1996
1997 Specify the arguments to give to your program as arguments to the
1998 @samp{start} command. These arguments will be given verbatim to the
1999 underlying @samp{run} command. Note that the same arguments will be
2000 reused if no argument is provided during subsequent calls to
2001 @samp{start} or @samp{run}.
2002
2003 It is sometimes necessary to debug the program during elaboration. In
2004 these cases, using the @code{start} command would stop the execution of
2005 your program too late, as the program would have already completed the
2006 elaboration phase. Under these circumstances, insert breakpoints in your
2007 elaboration code before running your program.
2008
2009 @kindex set exec-wrapper
2010 @item set exec-wrapper @var{wrapper}
2011 @itemx show exec-wrapper
2012 @itemx unset exec-wrapper
2013 When @samp{exec-wrapper} is set, the specified wrapper is used to
2014 launch programs for debugging. @value{GDBN} starts your program
2015 with a shell command of the form @kbd{exec @var{wrapper}
2016 @var{program}}. Quoting is added to @var{program} and its
2017 arguments, but not to @var{wrapper}, so you should add quotes if
2018 appropriate for your shell. The wrapper runs until it executes
2019 your program, and then @value{GDBN} takes control.
2020
2021 You can use any program that eventually calls @code{execve} with
2022 its arguments as a wrapper. Several standard Unix utilities do
2023 this, e.g.@: @code{env} and @code{nohup}. Any Unix shell script ending
2024 with @code{exec "$@@"} will also work.
2025
2026 For example, you can use @code{env} to pass an environment variable to
2027 the debugged program, without setting the variable in your shell's
2028 environment:
2029
2030 @smallexample
2031 (@value{GDBP}) set exec-wrapper env 'LD_PRELOAD=libtest.so'
2032 (@value{GDBP}) run
2033 @end smallexample
2034
2035 This command is available when debugging locally on most targets, excluding
2036 @sc{djgpp}, Cygwin, MS Windows, and QNX Neutrino.
2037
2038 @kindex set disable-randomization
2039 @item set disable-randomization
2040 @itemx set disable-randomization on
2041 This option (enabled by default in @value{GDBN}) will turn off the native
2042 randomization of the virtual address space of the started program. This option
2043 is useful for multiple debugging sessions to make the execution better
2044 reproducible and memory addresses reusable across debugging sessions.
2045
2046 This feature is implemented only on @sc{gnu}/Linux. You can get the same
2047 behavior using
2048
2049 @smallexample
2050 (@value{GDBP}) set exec-wrapper setarch `uname -m` -R
2051 @end smallexample
2052
2053 @item set disable-randomization off
2054 Leave the behavior of the started executable unchanged. Some bugs rear their
2055 ugly heads only when the program is loaded at certain addresses. If your bug
2056 disappears when you run the program under @value{GDBN}, that might be because
2057 @value{GDBN} by default disables the address randomization on platforms, such
2058 as @sc{gnu}/Linux, which do that for stand-alone programs. Use @kbd{set
2059 disable-randomization off} to try to reproduce such elusive bugs.
2060
2061 The virtual address space randomization is implemented only on @sc{gnu}/Linux.
2062 It protects the programs against some kinds of security attacks. In these
2063 cases the attacker needs to know the exact location of a concrete executable
2064 code. Randomizing its location makes it impossible to inject jumps misusing
2065 a code at its expected addresses.
2066
2067 Prelinking shared libraries provides a startup performance advantage but it
2068 makes addresses in these libraries predictable for privileged processes by
2069 having just unprivileged access at the target system. Reading the shared
2070 library binary gives enough information for assembling the malicious code
2071 misusing it. Still even a prelinked shared library can get loaded at a new
2072 random address just requiring the regular relocation process during the
2073 startup. Shared libraries not already prelinked are always loaded at
2074 a randomly chosen address.
2075
2076 Position independent executables (PIE) contain position independent code
2077 similar to the shared libraries and therefore such executables get loaded at
2078 a randomly chosen address upon startup. PIE executables always load even
2079 already prelinked shared libraries at a random address. You can build such
2080 executable using @command{gcc -fPIE -pie}.
2081
2082 Heap (malloc storage), stack and custom mmap areas are always placed randomly
2083 (as long as the randomization is enabled).
2084
2085 @item show disable-randomization
2086 Show the current setting of the explicit disable of the native randomization of
2087 the virtual address space of the started program.
2088
2089 @end table
2090
2091 @node Arguments
2092 @section Your Program's Arguments
2093
2094 @cindex arguments (to your program)
2095 The arguments to your program can be specified by the arguments of the
2096 @code{run} command.
2097 They are passed to a shell, which expands wildcard characters and
2098 performs redirection of I/O, and thence to your program. Your
2099 @code{SHELL} environment variable (if it exists) specifies what shell
2100 @value{GDBN} uses. If you do not define @code{SHELL}, @value{GDBN} uses
2101 the default shell (@file{/bin/sh} on Unix).
2102
2103 On non-Unix systems, the program is usually invoked directly by
2104 @value{GDBN}, which emulates I/O redirection via the appropriate system
2105 calls, and the wildcard characters are expanded by the startup code of
2106 the program, not by the shell.
2107
2108 @code{run} with no arguments uses the same arguments used by the previous
2109 @code{run}, or those set by the @code{set args} command.
2110
2111 @table @code
2112 @kindex set args
2113 @item set args
2114 Specify the arguments to be used the next time your program is run. If
2115 @code{set args} has no arguments, @code{run} executes your program
2116 with no arguments. Once you have run your program with arguments,
2117 using @code{set args} before the next @code{run} is the only way to run
2118 it again without arguments.
2119
2120 @kindex show args
2121 @item show args
2122 Show the arguments to give your program when it is started.
2123 @end table
2124
2125 @node Environment
2126 @section Your Program's Environment
2127
2128 @cindex environment (of your program)
2129 The @dfn{environment} consists of a set of environment variables and
2130 their values. Environment variables conventionally record such things as
2131 your user name, your home directory, your terminal type, and your search
2132 path for programs to run. Usually you set up environment variables with
2133 the shell and they are inherited by all the other programs you run. When
2134 debugging, it can be useful to try running your program with a modified
2135 environment without having to start @value{GDBN} over again.
2136
2137 @table @code
2138 @kindex path
2139 @item path @var{directory}
2140 Add @var{directory} to the front of the @code{PATH} environment variable
2141 (the search path for executables) that will be passed to your program.
2142 The value of @code{PATH} used by @value{GDBN} does not change.
2143 You may specify several directory names, separated by whitespace or by a
2144 system-dependent separator character (@samp{:} on Unix, @samp{;} on
2145 MS-DOS and MS-Windows). If @var{directory} is already in the path, it
2146 is moved to the front, so it is searched sooner.
2147
2148 You can use the string @samp{$cwd} to refer to whatever is the current
2149 working directory at the time @value{GDBN} searches the path. If you
2150 use @samp{.} instead, it refers to the directory where you executed the
2151 @code{path} command. @value{GDBN} replaces @samp{.} in the
2152 @var{directory} argument (with the current path) before adding
2153 @var{directory} to the search path.
2154 @c 'path' is explicitly nonrepeatable, but RMS points out it is silly to
2155 @c document that, since repeating it would be a no-op.
2156
2157 @kindex show paths
2158 @item show paths
2159 Display the list of search paths for executables (the @code{PATH}
2160 environment variable).
2161
2162 @kindex show environment
2163 @item show environment @r{[}@var{varname}@r{]}
2164 Print the value of environment variable @var{varname} to be given to
2165 your program when it starts. If you do not supply @var{varname},
2166 print the names and values of all environment variables to be given to
2167 your program. You can abbreviate @code{environment} as @code{env}.
2168
2169 @kindex set environment
2170 @item set environment @var{varname} @r{[}=@var{value}@r{]}
2171 Set environment variable @var{varname} to @var{value}. The value
2172 changes for your program only, not for @value{GDBN} itself. @var{value} may
2173 be any string; the values of environment variables are just strings, and
2174 any interpretation is supplied by your program itself. The @var{value}
2175 parameter is optional; if it is eliminated, the variable is set to a
2176 null value.
2177 @c "any string" here does not include leading, trailing
2178 @c blanks. Gnu asks: does anyone care?
2179
2180 For example, this command:
2181
2182 @smallexample
2183 set env USER = foo
2184 @end smallexample
2185
2186 @noindent
2187 tells the debugged program, when subsequently run, that its user is named
2188 @samp{foo}. (The spaces around @samp{=} are used for clarity here; they
2189 are not actually required.)
2190
2191 @kindex unset environment
2192 @item unset environment @var{varname}
2193 Remove variable @var{varname} from the environment to be passed to your
2194 program. This is different from @samp{set env @var{varname} =};
2195 @code{unset environment} removes the variable from the environment,
2196 rather than assigning it an empty value.
2197 @end table
2198
2199 @emph{Warning:} On Unix systems, @value{GDBN} runs your program using
2200 the shell indicated
2201 by your @code{SHELL} environment variable if it exists (or
2202 @code{/bin/sh} if not). If your @code{SHELL} variable names a shell
2203 that runs an initialization file---such as @file{.cshrc} for C-shell, or
2204 @file{.bashrc} for BASH---any variables you set in that file affect
2205 your program. You may wish to move setting of environment variables to
2206 files that are only run when you sign on, such as @file{.login} or
2207 @file{.profile}.
2208
2209 @node Working Directory
2210 @section Your Program's Working Directory
2211
2212 @cindex working directory (of your program)
2213 Each time you start your program with @code{run}, it inherits its
2214 working directory from the current working directory of @value{GDBN}.
2215 The @value{GDBN} working directory is initially whatever it inherited
2216 from its parent process (typically the shell), but you can specify a new
2217 working directory in @value{GDBN} with the @code{cd} command.
2218
2219 The @value{GDBN} working directory also serves as a default for the commands
2220 that specify files for @value{GDBN} to operate on. @xref{Files, ,Commands to
2221 Specify Files}.
2222
2223 @table @code
2224 @kindex cd
2225 @cindex change working directory
2226 @item cd @var{directory}
2227 Set the @value{GDBN} working directory to @var{directory}.
2228
2229 @kindex pwd
2230 @item pwd
2231 Print the @value{GDBN} working directory.
2232 @end table
2233
2234 It is generally impossible to find the current working directory of
2235 the process being debugged (since a program can change its directory
2236 during its run). If you work on a system where @value{GDBN} is
2237 configured with the @file{/proc} support, you can use the @code{info
2238 proc} command (@pxref{SVR4 Process Information}) to find out the
2239 current working directory of the debuggee.
2240
2241 @node Input/Output
2242 @section Your Program's Input and Output
2243
2244 @cindex redirection
2245 @cindex i/o
2246 @cindex terminal
2247 By default, the program you run under @value{GDBN} does input and output to
2248 the same terminal that @value{GDBN} uses. @value{GDBN} switches the terminal
2249 to its own terminal modes to interact with you, but it records the terminal
2250 modes your program was using and switches back to them when you continue
2251 running your program.
2252
2253 @table @code
2254 @kindex info terminal
2255 @item info terminal
2256 Displays information recorded by @value{GDBN} about the terminal modes your
2257 program is using.
2258 @end table
2259
2260 You can redirect your program's input and/or output using shell
2261 redirection with the @code{run} command. For example,
2262
2263 @smallexample
2264 run > outfile
2265 @end smallexample
2266
2267 @noindent
2268 starts your program, diverting its output to the file @file{outfile}.
2269
2270 @kindex tty
2271 @cindex controlling terminal
2272 Another way to specify where your program should do input and output is
2273 with the @code{tty} command. This command accepts a file name as
2274 argument, and causes this file to be the default for future @code{run}
2275 commands. It also resets the controlling terminal for the child
2276 process, for future @code{run} commands. For example,
2277
2278 @smallexample
2279 tty /dev/ttyb
2280 @end smallexample
2281
2282 @noindent
2283 directs that processes started with subsequent @code{run} commands
2284 default to do input and output on the terminal @file{/dev/ttyb} and have
2285 that as their controlling terminal.
2286
2287 An explicit redirection in @code{run} overrides the @code{tty} command's
2288 effect on the input/output device, but not its effect on the controlling
2289 terminal.
2290
2291 When you use the @code{tty} command or redirect input in the @code{run}
2292 command, only the input @emph{for your program} is affected. The input
2293 for @value{GDBN} still comes from your terminal. @code{tty} is an alias
2294 for @code{set inferior-tty}.
2295
2296 @cindex inferior tty
2297 @cindex set inferior controlling terminal
2298 You can use the @code{show inferior-tty} command to tell @value{GDBN} to
2299 display the name of the terminal that will be used for future runs of your
2300 program.
2301
2302 @table @code
2303 @item set inferior-tty /dev/ttyb
2304 @kindex set inferior-tty
2305 Set the tty for the program being debugged to /dev/ttyb.
2306
2307 @item show inferior-tty
2308 @kindex show inferior-tty
2309 Show the current tty for the program being debugged.
2310 @end table
2311
2312 @node Attach
2313 @section Debugging an Already-running Process
2314 @kindex attach
2315 @cindex attach
2316
2317 @table @code
2318 @item attach @var{process-id}
2319 This command attaches to a running process---one that was started
2320 outside @value{GDBN}. (@code{info files} shows your active
2321 targets.) The command takes as argument a process ID. The usual way to
2322 find out the @var{process-id} of a Unix process is with the @code{ps} utility,
2323 or with the @samp{jobs -l} shell command.
2324
2325 @code{attach} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} a second time after
2326 executing the command.
2327 @end table
2328
2329 To use @code{attach}, your program must be running in an environment
2330 which supports processes; for example, @code{attach} does not work for
2331 programs on bare-board targets that lack an operating system. You must
2332 also have permission to send the process a signal.
2333
2334 When you use @code{attach}, the debugger finds the program running in
2335 the process first by looking in the current working directory, then (if
2336 the program is not found) by using the source file search path
2337 (@pxref{Source Path, ,Specifying Source Directories}). You can also use
2338 the @code{file} command to load the program. @xref{Files, ,Commands to
2339 Specify Files}.
2340
2341 The first thing @value{GDBN} does after arranging to debug the specified
2342 process is to stop it. You can examine and modify an attached process
2343 with all the @value{GDBN} commands that are ordinarily available when
2344 you start processes with @code{run}. You can insert breakpoints; you
2345 can step and continue; you can modify storage. If you would rather the
2346 process continue running, you may use the @code{continue} command after
2347 attaching @value{GDBN} to the process.
2348
2349 @table @code
2350 @kindex detach
2351 @item detach
2352 When you have finished debugging the attached process, you can use the
2353 @code{detach} command to release it from @value{GDBN} control. Detaching
2354 the process continues its execution. After the @code{detach} command,
2355 that process and @value{GDBN} become completely independent once more, and you
2356 are ready to @code{attach} another process or start one with @code{run}.
2357 @code{detach} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after
2358 executing the command.
2359 @end table
2360
2361 If you exit @value{GDBN} while you have an attached process, you detach
2362 that process. If you use the @code{run} command, you kill that process.
2363 By default, @value{GDBN} asks for confirmation if you try to do either of these
2364 things; you can control whether or not you need to confirm by using the
2365 @code{set confirm} command (@pxref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional Warnings and
2366 Messages}).
2367
2368 @node Kill Process
2369 @section Killing the Child Process
2370
2371 @table @code
2372 @kindex kill
2373 @item kill
2374 Kill the child process in which your program is running under @value{GDBN}.
2375 @end table
2376
2377 This command is useful if you wish to debug a core dump instead of a
2378 running process. @value{GDBN} ignores any core dump file while your program
2379 is running.
2380
2381 On some operating systems, a program cannot be executed outside @value{GDBN}
2382 while you have breakpoints set on it inside @value{GDBN}. You can use the
2383 @code{kill} command in this situation to permit running your program
2384 outside the debugger.
2385
2386 The @code{kill} command is also useful if you wish to recompile and
2387 relink your program, since on many systems it is impossible to modify an
2388 executable file while it is running in a process. In this case, when you
2389 next type @code{run}, @value{GDBN} notices that the file has changed, and
2390 reads the symbol table again (while trying to preserve your current
2391 breakpoint settings).
2392
2393 @node Inferiors and Programs
2394 @section Debugging Multiple Inferiors and Programs
2395
2396 @value{GDBN} lets you run and debug multiple programs in a single
2397 session. In addition, @value{GDBN} on some systems may let you run
2398 several programs simultaneously (otherwise you have to exit from one
2399 before starting another). In the most general case, you can have
2400 multiple threads of execution in each of multiple processes, launched
2401 from multiple executables.
2402
2403 @cindex inferior
2404 @value{GDBN} represents the state of each program execution with an
2405 object called an @dfn{inferior}. An inferior typically corresponds to
2406 a process, but is more general and applies also to targets that do not
2407 have processes. Inferiors may be created before a process runs, and
2408 may be retained after a process exits. Inferiors have unique
2409 identifiers that are different from process ids. Usually each
2410 inferior will also have its own distinct address space, although some
2411 embedded targets may have several inferiors running in different parts
2412 of a single address space. Each inferior may in turn have multiple
2413 threads running in it.
2414
2415 To find out what inferiors exist at any moment, use @w{@code{info
2416 inferiors}}:
2417
2418 @table @code
2419 @kindex info inferiors
2420 @item info inferiors
2421 Print a list of all inferiors currently being managed by @value{GDBN}.
2422
2423 @value{GDBN} displays for each inferior (in this order):
2424
2425 @enumerate
2426 @item
2427 the inferior number assigned by @value{GDBN}
2428
2429 @item
2430 the target system's inferior identifier
2431
2432 @item
2433 the name of the executable the inferior is running.
2434
2435 @end enumerate
2436
2437 @noindent
2438 An asterisk @samp{*} preceding the @value{GDBN} inferior number
2439 indicates the current inferior.
2440
2441 For example,
2442 @end table
2443 @c end table here to get a little more width for example
2444
2445 @smallexample
2446 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
2447 Num Description Executable
2448 2 process 2307 hello
2449 * 1 process 3401 goodbye
2450 @end smallexample
2451
2452 To switch focus between inferiors, use the @code{inferior} command:
2453
2454 @table @code
2455 @kindex inferior @var{infno}
2456 @item inferior @var{infno}
2457 Make inferior number @var{infno} the current inferior. The argument
2458 @var{infno} is the inferior number assigned by @value{GDBN}, as shown
2459 in the first field of the @samp{info inferiors} display.
2460 @end table
2461
2462
2463 You can get multiple executables into a debugging session via the
2464 @code{add-inferior} and @w{@code{clone-inferior}} commands. On some
2465 systems @value{GDBN} can add inferiors to the debug session
2466 automatically by following calls to @code{fork} and @code{exec}. To
2467 remove inferiors from the debugging session use the
2468 @w{@code{remove-inferior}} command.
2469
2470 @table @code
2471 @kindex add-inferior
2472 @item add-inferior [ -copies @var{n} ] [ -exec @var{executable} ]
2473 Adds @var{n} inferiors to be run using @var{executable} as the
2474 executable. @var{n} defaults to 1. If no executable is specified,
2475 the inferiors begins empty, with no program. You can still assign or
2476 change the program assigned to the inferior at any time by using the
2477 @code{file} command with the executable name as its argument.
2478
2479 @kindex clone-inferior
2480 @item clone-inferior [ -copies @var{n} ] [ @var{infno} ]
2481 Adds @var{n} inferiors ready to execute the same program as inferior
2482 @var{infno}. @var{n} defaults to 1. @var{infno} defaults to the
2483 number of the current inferior. This is a convenient command when you
2484 want to run another instance of the inferior you are debugging.
2485
2486 @smallexample
2487 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
2488 Num Description Executable
2489 * 1 process 29964 helloworld
2490 (@value{GDBP}) clone-inferior
2491 Added inferior 2.
2492 1 inferiors added.
2493 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
2494 Num Description Executable
2495 2 <null> helloworld
2496 * 1 process 29964 helloworld
2497 @end smallexample
2498
2499 You can now simply switch focus to inferior 2 and run it.
2500
2501 @kindex remove-inferior
2502 @item remove-inferior @var{infno}
2503 Removes the inferior @var{infno}. It is not possible to remove an
2504 inferior that is running with this command. For those, use the
2505 @code{kill} or @code{detach} command first.
2506
2507 @end table
2508
2509 To quit debugging one of the running inferiors that is not the current
2510 inferior, you can either detach from it by using the @w{@code{detach
2511 inferior}} command (allowing it to run independently), or kill it
2512 using the @w{@code{kill inferior}} command:
2513
2514 @table @code
2515 @kindex detach inferior @var{infno}
2516 @item detach inferior @var{infno}
2517 Detach from the inferior identified by @value{GDBN} inferior number
2518 @var{infno}. Note that the inferior's entry still stays on the list
2519 of inferiors shown by @code{info inferiors}, but its Description will
2520 show @samp{<null>}.
2521
2522 @kindex kill inferior @var{infno}
2523 @item kill inferior @var{infno}
2524 Kill the inferior identified by @value{GDBN} inferior number
2525 @var{infno}. Note that the inferior's entry still stays on the list
2526 of inferiors shown by @code{info inferiors}, but its Description will
2527 show @samp{<null>}.
2528 @end table
2529
2530 After the successful completion of a command such as @code{detach},
2531 @code{detach inferior}, @code{kill} or @code{kill inferior}, or after
2532 a normal process exit, the inferior is still valid and listed with
2533 @code{info inferiors}, ready to be restarted.
2534
2535
2536 To be notified when inferiors are started or exit under @value{GDBN}'s
2537 control use @w{@code{set print inferior-events}}:
2538
2539 @table @code
2540 @kindex set print inferior-events
2541 @cindex print messages on inferior start and exit
2542 @item set print inferior-events
2543 @itemx set print inferior-events on
2544 @itemx set print inferior-events off
2545 The @code{set print inferior-events} command allows you to enable or
2546 disable printing of messages when @value{GDBN} notices that new
2547 inferiors have started or that inferiors have exited or have been
2548 detached. By default, these messages will not be printed.
2549
2550 @kindex show print inferior-events
2551 @item show print inferior-events
2552 Show whether messages will be printed when @value{GDBN} detects that
2553 inferiors have started, exited or have been detached.
2554 @end table
2555
2556 Many commands will work the same with multiple programs as with a
2557 single program: e.g., @code{print myglobal} will simply display the
2558 value of @code{myglobal} in the current inferior.
2559
2560
2561 Occasionaly, when debugging @value{GDBN} itself, it may be useful to
2562 get more info about the relationship of inferiors, programs, address
2563 spaces in a debug session. You can do that with the @w{@code{maint
2564 info program-spaces}} command.
2565
2566 @table @code
2567 @kindex maint info program-spaces
2568 @item maint info program-spaces
2569 Print a list of all program spaces currently being managed by
2570 @value{GDBN}.
2571
2572 @value{GDBN} displays for each program space (in this order):
2573
2574 @enumerate
2575 @item
2576 the program space number assigned by @value{GDBN}
2577
2578 @item
2579 the name of the executable loaded into the program space, with e.g.,
2580 the @code{file} command.
2581
2582 @end enumerate
2583
2584 @noindent
2585 An asterisk @samp{*} preceding the @value{GDBN} program space number
2586 indicates the current program space.
2587
2588 In addition, below each program space line, @value{GDBN} prints extra
2589 information that isn't suitable to display in tabular form. For
2590 example, the list of inferiors bound to the program space.
2591
2592 @smallexample
2593 (@value{GDBP}) maint info program-spaces
2594 Id Executable
2595 2 goodbye
2596 Bound inferiors: ID 1 (process 21561)
2597 * 1 hello
2598 @end smallexample
2599
2600 Here we can see that no inferior is running the program @code{hello},
2601 while @code{process 21561} is running the program @code{goodbye}. On
2602 some targets, it is possible that multiple inferiors are bound to the
2603 same program space. The most common example is that of debugging both
2604 the parent and child processes of a @code{vfork} call. For example,
2605
2606 @smallexample
2607 (@value{GDBP}) maint info program-spaces
2608 Id Executable
2609 * 1 vfork-test
2610 Bound inferiors: ID 2 (process 18050), ID 1 (process 18045)
2611 @end smallexample
2612
2613 Here, both inferior 2 and inferior 1 are running in the same program
2614 space as a result of inferior 1 having executed a @code{vfork} call.
2615 @end table
2616
2617 @node Threads
2618 @section Debugging Programs with Multiple Threads
2619
2620 @cindex threads of execution
2621 @cindex multiple threads
2622 @cindex switching threads
2623 In some operating systems, such as HP-UX and Solaris, a single program
2624 may have more than one @dfn{thread} of execution. The precise semantics
2625 of threads differ from one operating system to another, but in general
2626 the threads of a single program are akin to multiple processes---except
2627 that they share one address space (that is, they can all examine and
2628 modify the same variables). On the other hand, each thread has its own
2629 registers and execution stack, and perhaps private memory.
2630
2631 @value{GDBN} provides these facilities for debugging multi-thread
2632 programs:
2633
2634 @itemize @bullet
2635 @item automatic notification of new threads
2636 @item @samp{thread @var{threadno}}, a command to switch among threads
2637 @item @samp{info threads}, a command to inquire about existing threads
2638 @item @samp{thread apply [@var{threadno}] [@var{all}] @var{args}},
2639 a command to apply a command to a list of threads
2640 @item thread-specific breakpoints
2641 @item @samp{set print thread-events}, which controls printing of
2642 messages on thread start and exit.
2643 @item @samp{set libthread-db-search-path @var{path}}, which lets
2644 the user specify which @code{libthread_db} to use if the default choice
2645 isn't compatible with the program.
2646 @end itemize
2647
2648 @quotation
2649 @emph{Warning:} These facilities are not yet available on every
2650 @value{GDBN} configuration where the operating system supports threads.
2651 If your @value{GDBN} does not support threads, these commands have no
2652 effect. For example, a system without thread support shows no output
2653 from @samp{info threads}, and always rejects the @code{thread} command,
2654 like this:
2655
2656 @smallexample
2657 (@value{GDBP}) info threads
2658 (@value{GDBP}) thread 1
2659 Thread ID 1 not known. Use the "info threads" command to
2660 see the IDs of currently known threads.
2661 @end smallexample
2662 @c FIXME to implementors: how hard would it be to say "sorry, this GDB
2663 @c doesn't support threads"?
2664 @end quotation
2665
2666 @cindex focus of debugging
2667 @cindex current thread
2668 The @value{GDBN} thread debugging facility allows you to observe all
2669 threads while your program runs---but whenever @value{GDBN} takes
2670 control, one thread in particular is always the focus of debugging.
2671 This thread is called the @dfn{current thread}. Debugging commands show
2672 program information from the perspective of the current thread.
2673
2674 @cindex @code{New} @var{systag} message
2675 @cindex thread identifier (system)
2676 @c FIXME-implementors!! It would be more helpful if the [New...] message
2677 @c included GDB's numeric thread handle, so you could just go to that
2678 @c thread without first checking `info threads'.
2679 Whenever @value{GDBN} detects a new thread in your program, it displays
2680 the target system's identification for the thread with a message in the
2681 form @samp{[New @var{systag}]}. @var{systag} is a thread identifier
2682 whose form varies depending on the particular system. For example, on
2683 @sc{gnu}/Linux, you might see
2684
2685 @smallexample
2686 [New Thread 46912507313328 (LWP 25582)]
2687 @end smallexample
2688
2689 @noindent
2690 when @value{GDBN} notices a new thread. In contrast, on an SGI system,
2691 the @var{systag} is simply something like @samp{process 368}, with no
2692 further qualifier.
2693
2694 @c FIXME!! (1) Does the [New...] message appear even for the very first
2695 @c thread of a program, or does it only appear for the
2696 @c second---i.e.@: when it becomes obvious we have a multithread
2697 @c program?
2698 @c (2) *Is* there necessarily a first thread always? Or do some
2699 @c multithread systems permit starting a program with multiple
2700 @c threads ab initio?
2701
2702 @cindex thread number
2703 @cindex thread identifier (GDB)
2704 For debugging purposes, @value{GDBN} associates its own thread
2705 number---always a single integer---with each thread in your program.
2706
2707 @table @code
2708 @kindex info threads
2709 @item info threads
2710 Display a summary of all threads currently in your
2711 program. @value{GDBN} displays for each thread (in this order):
2712
2713 @enumerate
2714 @item
2715 the thread number assigned by @value{GDBN}
2716
2717 @item
2718 the target system's thread identifier (@var{systag})
2719
2720 @item
2721 the thread's name, if one is known. A thread can either be named by
2722 the user (see @code{thread name}, below), or, in some cases, by the
2723 program itself.
2724
2725 @item
2726 the current stack frame summary for that thread
2727 @end enumerate
2728
2729 @noindent
2730 An asterisk @samp{*} to the left of the @value{GDBN} thread number
2731 indicates the current thread.
2732
2733 For example,
2734 @end table
2735 @c end table here to get a little more width for example
2736
2737 @smallexample
2738 (@value{GDBP}) info threads
2739 Id Target Id Frame
2740 3 process 35 thread 27 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
2741 2 process 35 thread 23 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
2742 * 1 process 35 thread 13 main (argc=1, argv=0x7ffffff8)
2743 at threadtest.c:68
2744 @end smallexample
2745
2746 On Solaris, you can display more information about user threads with a
2747 Solaris-specific command:
2748
2749 @table @code
2750 @item maint info sol-threads
2751 @kindex maint info sol-threads
2752 @cindex thread info (Solaris)
2753 Display info on Solaris user threads.
2754 @end table
2755
2756 @table @code
2757 @kindex thread @var{threadno}
2758 @item thread @var{threadno}
2759 Make thread number @var{threadno} the current thread. The command
2760 argument @var{threadno} is the internal @value{GDBN} thread number, as
2761 shown in the first field of the @samp{info threads} display.
2762 @value{GDBN} responds by displaying the system identifier of the thread
2763 you selected, and its current stack frame summary:
2764
2765 @smallexample
2766 (@value{GDBP}) thread 2
2767 [Switching to thread 2 (Thread 0xb7fdab70 (LWP 12747))]
2768 #0 some_function (ignore=0x0) at example.c:8
2769 8 printf ("hello\n");
2770 @end smallexample
2771
2772 @noindent
2773 As with the @samp{[New @dots{}]} message, the form of the text after
2774 @samp{Switching to} depends on your system's conventions for identifying
2775 threads.
2776
2777 @vindex $_thread@r{, convenience variable}
2778 The debugger convenience variable @samp{$_thread} contains the number
2779 of the current thread. You may find this useful in writing breakpoint
2780 conditional expressions, command scripts, and so forth. See
2781 @xref{Convenience Vars,, Convenience Variables}, for general
2782 information on convenience variables.
2783
2784 @kindex thread apply
2785 @cindex apply command to several threads
2786 @item thread apply [@var{threadno} | all] @var{command}
2787 The @code{thread apply} command allows you to apply the named
2788 @var{command} to one or more threads. Specify the numbers of the
2789 threads that you want affected with the command argument
2790 @var{threadno}. It can be a single thread number, one of the numbers
2791 shown in the first field of the @samp{info threads} display; or it
2792 could be a range of thread numbers, as in @code{2-4}. To apply a
2793 command to all threads, type @kbd{thread apply all @var{command}}.
2794
2795 @kindex thread name
2796 @cindex name a thread
2797 @item thread name [@var{name}]
2798 This command assigns a name to the current thread. If no argument is
2799 given, any existing user-specified name is removed. The thread name
2800 appears in the @samp{info threads} display.
2801
2802 On some systems, such as @sc{gnu}/Linux, @value{GDBN} is able to
2803 determine the name of the thread as given by the OS. On these
2804 systems, a name specified with @samp{thread name} will override the
2805 system-give name, and removing the user-specified name will cause
2806 @value{GDBN} to once again display the system-specified name.
2807
2808 @kindex set print thread-events
2809 @cindex print messages on thread start and exit
2810 @item set print thread-events
2811 @itemx set print thread-events on
2812 @itemx set print thread-events off
2813 The @code{set print thread-events} command allows you to enable or
2814 disable printing of messages when @value{GDBN} notices that new threads have
2815 started or that threads have exited. By default, these messages will
2816 be printed if detection of these events is supported by the target.
2817 Note that these messages cannot be disabled on all targets.
2818
2819 @kindex show print thread-events
2820 @item show print thread-events
2821 Show whether messages will be printed when @value{GDBN} detects that threads
2822 have started and exited.
2823 @end table
2824
2825 @xref{Thread Stops,,Stopping and Starting Multi-thread Programs}, for
2826 more information about how @value{GDBN} behaves when you stop and start
2827 programs with multiple threads.
2828
2829 @xref{Set Watchpoints,,Setting Watchpoints}, for information about
2830 watchpoints in programs with multiple threads.
2831
2832 @table @code
2833 @kindex set libthread-db-search-path
2834 @cindex search path for @code{libthread_db}
2835 @item set libthread-db-search-path @r{[}@var{path}@r{]}
2836 If this variable is set, @var{path} is a colon-separated list of
2837 directories @value{GDBN} will use to search for @code{libthread_db}.
2838 If you omit @var{path}, @samp{libthread-db-search-path} will be reset to
2839 an empty list.
2840
2841 On @sc{gnu}/Linux and Solaris systems, @value{GDBN} uses a ``helper''
2842 @code{libthread_db} library to obtain information about threads in the
2843 inferior process. @value{GDBN} will use @samp{libthread-db-search-path}
2844 to find @code{libthread_db}. If that fails, @value{GDBN} will continue
2845 with default system shared library directories, and finally the directory
2846 from which @code{libpthread} was loaded in the inferior process.
2847
2848 For any @code{libthread_db} library @value{GDBN} finds in above directories,
2849 @value{GDBN} attempts to initialize it with the current inferior process.
2850 If this initialization fails (which could happen because of a version
2851 mismatch between @code{libthread_db} and @code{libpthread}), @value{GDBN}
2852 will unload @code{libthread_db}, and continue with the next directory.
2853 If none of @code{libthread_db} libraries initialize successfully,
2854 @value{GDBN} will issue a warning and thread debugging will be disabled.
2855
2856 Setting @code{libthread-db-search-path} is currently implemented
2857 only on some platforms.
2858
2859 @kindex show libthread-db-search-path
2860 @item show libthread-db-search-path
2861 Display current libthread_db search path.
2862
2863 @kindex set debug libthread-db
2864 @kindex show debug libthread-db
2865 @cindex debugging @code{libthread_db}
2866 @item set debug libthread-db
2867 @itemx show debug libthread-db
2868 Turns on or off display of @code{libthread_db}-related events.
2869 Use @code{1} to enable, @code{0} to disable.
2870 @end table
2871
2872 @node Forks
2873 @section Debugging Forks
2874
2875 @cindex fork, debugging programs which call
2876 @cindex multiple processes
2877 @cindex processes, multiple
2878 On most systems, @value{GDBN} has no special support for debugging
2879 programs which create additional processes using the @code{fork}
2880 function. When a program forks, @value{GDBN} will continue to debug the
2881 parent process and the child process will run unimpeded. If you have
2882 set a breakpoint in any code which the child then executes, the child
2883 will get a @code{SIGTRAP} signal which (unless it catches the signal)
2884 will cause it to terminate.
2885
2886 However, if you want to debug the child process there is a workaround
2887 which isn't too painful. Put a call to @code{sleep} in the code which
2888 the child process executes after the fork. It may be useful to sleep
2889 only if a certain environment variable is set, or a certain file exists,
2890 so that the delay need not occur when you don't want to run @value{GDBN}
2891 on the child. While the child is sleeping, use the @code{ps} program to
2892 get its process ID. Then tell @value{GDBN} (a new invocation of
2893 @value{GDBN} if you are also debugging the parent process) to attach to
2894 the child process (@pxref{Attach}). From that point on you can debug
2895 the child process just like any other process which you attached to.
2896
2897 On some systems, @value{GDBN} provides support for debugging programs that
2898 create additional processes using the @code{fork} or @code{vfork} functions.
2899 Currently, the only platforms with this feature are HP-UX (11.x and later
2900 only?) and @sc{gnu}/Linux (kernel version 2.5.60 and later).
2901
2902 By default, when a program forks, @value{GDBN} will continue to debug
2903 the parent process and the child process will run unimpeded.
2904
2905 If you want to follow the child process instead of the parent process,
2906 use the command @w{@code{set follow-fork-mode}}.
2907
2908 @table @code
2909 @kindex set follow-fork-mode
2910 @item set follow-fork-mode @var{mode}
2911 Set the debugger response to a program call of @code{fork} or
2912 @code{vfork}. A call to @code{fork} or @code{vfork} creates a new
2913 process. The @var{mode} argument can be:
2914
2915 @table @code
2916 @item parent
2917 The original process is debugged after a fork. The child process runs
2918 unimpeded. This is the default.
2919
2920 @item child
2921 The new process is debugged after a fork. The parent process runs
2922 unimpeded.
2923
2924 @end table
2925
2926 @kindex show follow-fork-mode
2927 @item show follow-fork-mode
2928 Display the current debugger response to a @code{fork} or @code{vfork} call.
2929 @end table
2930
2931 @cindex debugging multiple processes
2932 On Linux, if you want to debug both the parent and child processes, use the
2933 command @w{@code{set detach-on-fork}}.
2934
2935 @table @code
2936 @kindex set detach-on-fork
2937 @item set detach-on-fork @var{mode}
2938 Tells gdb whether to detach one of the processes after a fork, or
2939 retain debugger control over them both.
2940
2941 @table @code
2942 @item on
2943 The child process (or parent process, depending on the value of
2944 @code{follow-fork-mode}) will be detached and allowed to run
2945 independently. This is the default.
2946
2947 @item off
2948 Both processes will be held under the control of @value{GDBN}.
2949 One process (child or parent, depending on the value of
2950 @code{follow-fork-mode}) is debugged as usual, while the other
2951 is held suspended.
2952
2953 @end table
2954
2955 @kindex show detach-on-fork
2956 @item show detach-on-fork
2957 Show whether detach-on-fork mode is on/off.
2958 @end table
2959
2960 If you choose to set @samp{detach-on-fork} mode off, then @value{GDBN}
2961 will retain control of all forked processes (including nested forks).
2962 You can list the forked processes under the control of @value{GDBN} by
2963 using the @w{@code{info inferiors}} command, and switch from one fork
2964 to another by using the @code{inferior} command (@pxref{Inferiors and
2965 Programs, ,Debugging Multiple Inferiors and Programs}).
2966
2967 To quit debugging one of the forked processes, you can either detach
2968 from it by using the @w{@code{detach inferior}} command (allowing it
2969 to run independently), or kill it using the @w{@code{kill inferior}}
2970 command. @xref{Inferiors and Programs, ,Debugging Multiple Inferiors
2971 and Programs}.
2972
2973 If you ask to debug a child process and a @code{vfork} is followed by an
2974 @code{exec}, @value{GDBN} executes the new target up to the first
2975 breakpoint in the new target. If you have a breakpoint set on
2976 @code{main} in your original program, the breakpoint will also be set on
2977 the child process's @code{main}.
2978
2979 On some systems, when a child process is spawned by @code{vfork}, you
2980 cannot debug the child or parent until an @code{exec} call completes.
2981
2982 If you issue a @code{run} command to @value{GDBN} after an @code{exec}
2983 call executes, the new target restarts. To restart the parent
2984 process, use the @code{file} command with the parent executable name
2985 as its argument. By default, after an @code{exec} call executes,
2986 @value{GDBN} discards the symbols of the previous executable image.
2987 You can change this behaviour with the @w{@code{set follow-exec-mode}}
2988 command.
2989
2990 @table @code
2991 @kindex set follow-exec-mode
2992 @item set follow-exec-mode @var{mode}
2993
2994 Set debugger response to a program call of @code{exec}. An
2995 @code{exec} call replaces the program image of a process.
2996
2997 @code{follow-exec-mode} can be:
2998
2999 @table @code
3000 @item new
3001 @value{GDBN} creates a new inferior and rebinds the process to this
3002 new inferior. The program the process was running before the
3003 @code{exec} call can be restarted afterwards by restarting the
3004 original inferior.
3005
3006 For example:
3007
3008 @smallexample
3009 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
3010 (gdb) info inferior
3011 Id Description Executable
3012 * 1 <null> prog1
3013 (@value{GDBP}) run
3014 process 12020 is executing new program: prog2
3015 Program exited normally.
3016 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
3017 Id Description Executable
3018 * 2 <null> prog2
3019 1 <null> prog1
3020 @end smallexample
3021
3022 @item same
3023 @value{GDBN} keeps the process bound to the same inferior. The new
3024 executable image replaces the previous executable loaded in the
3025 inferior. Restarting the inferior after the @code{exec} call, with
3026 e.g., the @code{run} command, restarts the executable the process was
3027 running after the @code{exec} call. This is the default mode.
3028
3029 For example:
3030
3031 @smallexample
3032 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
3033 Id Description Executable
3034 * 1 <null> prog1
3035 (@value{GDBP}) run
3036 process 12020 is executing new program: prog2
3037 Program exited normally.
3038 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
3039 Id Description Executable
3040 * 1 <null> prog2
3041 @end smallexample
3042
3043 @end table
3044 @end table
3045
3046 You can use the @code{catch} command to make @value{GDBN} stop whenever
3047 a @code{fork}, @code{vfork}, or @code{exec} call is made. @xref{Set
3048 Catchpoints, ,Setting Catchpoints}.
3049
3050 @node Checkpoint/Restart
3051 @section Setting a @emph{Bookmark} to Return to Later
3052
3053 @cindex checkpoint
3054 @cindex restart
3055 @cindex bookmark
3056 @cindex snapshot of a process
3057 @cindex rewind program state
3058
3059 On certain operating systems@footnote{Currently, only
3060 @sc{gnu}/Linux.}, @value{GDBN} is able to save a @dfn{snapshot} of a
3061 program's state, called a @dfn{checkpoint}, and come back to it
3062 later.
3063
3064 Returning to a checkpoint effectively undoes everything that has
3065 happened in the program since the @code{checkpoint} was saved. This
3066 includes changes in memory, registers, and even (within some limits)
3067 system state. Effectively, it is like going back in time to the
3068 moment when the checkpoint was saved.
3069
3070 Thus, if you're stepping thru a program and you think you're
3071 getting close to the point where things go wrong, you can save
3072 a checkpoint. Then, if you accidentally go too far and miss
3073 the critical statement, instead of having to restart your program
3074 from the beginning, you can just go back to the checkpoint and
3075 start again from there.
3076
3077 This can be especially useful if it takes a lot of time or
3078 steps to reach the point where you think the bug occurs.
3079
3080 To use the @code{checkpoint}/@code{restart} method of debugging:
3081
3082 @table @code
3083 @kindex checkpoint
3084 @item checkpoint
3085 Save a snapshot of the debugged program's current execution state.
3086 The @code{checkpoint} command takes no arguments, but each checkpoint
3087 is assigned a small integer id, similar to a breakpoint id.
3088
3089 @kindex info checkpoints
3090 @item info checkpoints
3091 List the checkpoints that have been saved in the current debugging
3092 session. For each checkpoint, the following information will be
3093 listed:
3094
3095 @table @code
3096 @item Checkpoint ID
3097 @item Process ID
3098 @item Code Address
3099 @item Source line, or label
3100 @end table
3101
3102 @kindex restart @var{checkpoint-id}
3103 @item restart @var{checkpoint-id}
3104 Restore the program state that was saved as checkpoint number
3105 @var{checkpoint-id}. All program variables, registers, stack frames
3106 etc.@: will be returned to the values that they had when the checkpoint
3107 was saved. In essence, gdb will ``wind back the clock'' to the point
3108 in time when the checkpoint was saved.
3109
3110 Note that breakpoints, @value{GDBN} variables, command history etc.
3111 are not affected by restoring a checkpoint. In general, a checkpoint
3112 only restores things that reside in the program being debugged, not in
3113 the debugger.
3114
3115 @kindex delete checkpoint @var{checkpoint-id}
3116 @item delete checkpoint @var{checkpoint-id}
3117 Delete the previously-saved checkpoint identified by @var{checkpoint-id}.
3118
3119 @end table
3120
3121 Returning to a previously saved checkpoint will restore the user state
3122 of the program being debugged, plus a significant subset of the system
3123 (OS) state, including file pointers. It won't ``un-write'' data from
3124 a file, but it will rewind the file pointer to the previous location,
3125 so that the previously written data can be overwritten. For files
3126 opened in read mode, the pointer will also be restored so that the
3127 previously read data can be read again.
3128
3129 Of course, characters that have been sent to a printer (or other
3130 external device) cannot be ``snatched back'', and characters received
3131 from eg.@: a serial device can be removed from internal program buffers,
3132 but they cannot be ``pushed back'' into the serial pipeline, ready to
3133 be received again. Similarly, the actual contents of files that have
3134 been changed cannot be restored (at this time).
3135
3136 However, within those constraints, you actually can ``rewind'' your
3137 program to a previously saved point in time, and begin debugging it
3138 again --- and you can change the course of events so as to debug a
3139 different execution path this time.
3140
3141 @cindex checkpoints and process id
3142 Finally, there is one bit of internal program state that will be
3143 different when you return to a checkpoint --- the program's process
3144 id. Each checkpoint will have a unique process id (or @var{pid}),
3145 and each will be different from the program's original @var{pid}.
3146 If your program has saved a local copy of its process id, this could
3147 potentially pose a problem.
3148
3149 @subsection A Non-obvious Benefit of Using Checkpoints
3150
3151 On some systems such as @sc{gnu}/Linux, address space randomization
3152 is performed on new processes for security reasons. This makes it
3153 difficult or impossible to set a breakpoint, or watchpoint, on an
3154 absolute address if you have to restart the program, since the
3155 absolute location of a symbol will change from one execution to the
3156 next.
3157
3158 A checkpoint, however, is an @emph{identical} copy of a process.
3159 Therefore if you create a checkpoint at (eg.@:) the start of main,
3160 and simply return to that checkpoint instead of restarting the
3161 process, you can avoid the effects of address randomization and
3162 your symbols will all stay in the same place.
3163
3164 @node Stopping
3165 @chapter Stopping and Continuing
3166
3167 The principal purposes of using a debugger are so that you can stop your
3168 program before it terminates; or so that, if your program runs into
3169 trouble, you can investigate and find out why.
3170
3171 Inside @value{GDBN}, your program may stop for any of several reasons,
3172 such as a signal, a breakpoint, or reaching a new line after a
3173 @value{GDBN} command such as @code{step}. You may then examine and
3174 change variables, set new breakpoints or remove old ones, and then
3175 continue execution. Usually, the messages shown by @value{GDBN} provide
3176 ample explanation of the status of your program---but you can also
3177 explicitly request this information at any time.
3178
3179 @table @code
3180 @kindex info program
3181 @item info program
3182 Display information about the status of your program: whether it is
3183 running or not, what process it is, and why it stopped.
3184 @end table
3185
3186 @menu
3187 * Breakpoints:: Breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints
3188 * Continuing and Stepping:: Resuming execution
3189 * Signals:: Signals
3190 * Thread Stops:: Stopping and starting multi-thread programs
3191 @end menu
3192
3193 @node Breakpoints
3194 @section Breakpoints, Watchpoints, and Catchpoints
3195
3196 @cindex breakpoints
3197 A @dfn{breakpoint} makes your program stop whenever a certain point in
3198 the program is reached. For each breakpoint, you can add conditions to
3199 control in finer detail whether your program stops. You can set
3200 breakpoints with the @code{break} command and its variants (@pxref{Set
3201 Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}), to specify the place where your program
3202 should stop by line number, function name or exact address in the
3203 program.
3204
3205 On some systems, you can set breakpoints in shared libraries before
3206 the executable is run. There is a minor limitation on HP-UX systems:
3207 you must wait until the executable is run in order to set breakpoints
3208 in shared library routines that are not called directly by the program
3209 (for example, routines that are arguments in a @code{pthread_create}
3210 call).
3211
3212 @cindex watchpoints
3213 @cindex data breakpoints
3214 @cindex memory tracing
3215 @cindex breakpoint on memory address
3216 @cindex breakpoint on variable modification
3217 A @dfn{watchpoint} is a special breakpoint that stops your program
3218 when the value of an expression changes. The expression may be a value
3219 of a variable, or it could involve values of one or more variables
3220 combined by operators, such as @samp{a + b}. This is sometimes called
3221 @dfn{data breakpoints}. You must use a different command to set
3222 watchpoints (@pxref{Set Watchpoints, ,Setting Watchpoints}), but aside
3223 from that, you can manage a watchpoint like any other breakpoint: you
3224 enable, disable, and delete both breakpoints and watchpoints using the
3225 same commands.
3226
3227 You can arrange to have values from your program displayed automatically
3228 whenever @value{GDBN} stops at a breakpoint. @xref{Auto Display,,
3229 Automatic Display}.
3230
3231 @cindex catchpoints
3232 @cindex breakpoint on events
3233 A @dfn{catchpoint} is another special breakpoint that stops your program
3234 when a certain kind of event occurs, such as the throwing of a C@t{++}
3235 exception or the loading of a library. As with watchpoints, you use a
3236 different command to set a catchpoint (@pxref{Set Catchpoints, ,Setting
3237 Catchpoints}), but aside from that, you can manage a catchpoint like any
3238 other breakpoint. (To stop when your program receives a signal, use the
3239 @code{handle} command; see @ref{Signals, ,Signals}.)
3240
3241 @cindex breakpoint numbers
3242 @cindex numbers for breakpoints
3243 @value{GDBN} assigns a number to each breakpoint, watchpoint, or
3244 catchpoint when you create it; these numbers are successive integers
3245 starting with one. In many of the commands for controlling various
3246 features of breakpoints you use the breakpoint number to say which
3247 breakpoint you want to change. Each breakpoint may be @dfn{enabled} or
3248 @dfn{disabled}; if disabled, it has no effect on your program until you
3249 enable it again.
3250
3251 @cindex breakpoint ranges
3252 @cindex ranges of breakpoints
3253 Some @value{GDBN} commands accept a range of breakpoints on which to
3254 operate. A breakpoint range is either a single breakpoint number, like
3255 @samp{5}, or two such numbers, in increasing order, separated by a
3256 hyphen, like @samp{5-7}. When a breakpoint range is given to a command,
3257 all breakpoints in that range are operated on.
3258
3259 @menu
3260 * Set Breaks:: Setting breakpoints
3261 * Set Watchpoints:: Setting watchpoints
3262 * Set Catchpoints:: Setting catchpoints
3263 * Delete Breaks:: Deleting breakpoints
3264 * Disabling:: Disabling breakpoints
3265 * Conditions:: Break conditions
3266 * Break Commands:: Breakpoint command lists
3267 * Save Breakpoints:: How to save breakpoints in a file
3268 * Error in Breakpoints:: ``Cannot insert breakpoints''
3269 * Breakpoint-related Warnings:: ``Breakpoint address adjusted...''
3270 @end menu
3271
3272 @node Set Breaks
3273 @subsection Setting Breakpoints
3274
3275 @c FIXME LMB what does GDB do if no code on line of breakpt?
3276 @c consider in particular declaration with/without initialization.
3277 @c
3278 @c FIXME 2 is there stuff on this already? break at fun start, already init?
3279
3280 @kindex break
3281 @kindex b @r{(@code{break})}
3282 @vindex $bpnum@r{, convenience variable}
3283 @cindex latest breakpoint
3284 Breakpoints are set with the @code{break} command (abbreviated
3285 @code{b}). The debugger convenience variable @samp{$bpnum} records the
3286 number of the breakpoint you've set most recently; see @ref{Convenience
3287 Vars,, Convenience Variables}, for a discussion of what you can do with
3288 convenience variables.
3289
3290 @table @code
3291 @item break @var{location}
3292 Set a breakpoint at the given @var{location}, which can specify a
3293 function name, a line number, or an address of an instruction.
3294 (@xref{Specify Location}, for a list of all the possible ways to
3295 specify a @var{location}.) The breakpoint will stop your program just
3296 before it executes any of the code in the specified @var{location}.
3297
3298 When using source languages that permit overloading of symbols, such as
3299 C@t{++}, a function name may refer to more than one possible place to break.
3300 @xref{Ambiguous Expressions,,Ambiguous Expressions}, for a discussion of
3301 that situation.
3302
3303 It is also possible to insert a breakpoint that will stop the program
3304 only if a specific thread (@pxref{Thread-Specific Breakpoints})
3305 or a specific task (@pxref{Ada Tasks}) hits that breakpoint.
3306
3307 @item break
3308 When called without any arguments, @code{break} sets a breakpoint at
3309 the next instruction to be executed in the selected stack frame
3310 (@pxref{Stack, ,Examining the Stack}). In any selected frame but the
3311 innermost, this makes your program stop as soon as control
3312 returns to that frame. This is similar to the effect of a
3313 @code{finish} command in the frame inside the selected frame---except
3314 that @code{finish} does not leave an active breakpoint. If you use
3315 @code{break} without an argument in the innermost frame, @value{GDBN} stops
3316 the next time it reaches the current location; this may be useful
3317 inside loops.
3318
3319 @value{GDBN} normally ignores breakpoints when it resumes execution, until at
3320 least one instruction has been executed. If it did not do this, you
3321 would be unable to proceed past a breakpoint without first disabling the
3322 breakpoint. This rule applies whether or not the breakpoint already
3323 existed when your program stopped.
3324
3325 @item break @dots{} if @var{cond}
3326 Set a breakpoint with condition @var{cond}; evaluate the expression
3327 @var{cond} each time the breakpoint is reached, and stop only if the
3328 value is nonzero---that is, if @var{cond} evaluates as true.
3329 @samp{@dots{}} stands for one of the possible arguments described
3330 above (or no argument) specifying where to break. @xref{Conditions,
3331 ,Break Conditions}, for more information on breakpoint conditions.
3332
3333 @kindex tbreak
3334 @item tbreak @var{args}
3335 Set a breakpoint enabled only for one stop. @var{args} are the
3336 same as for the @code{break} command, and the breakpoint is set in the same
3337 way, but the breakpoint is automatically deleted after the first time your
3338 program stops there. @xref{Disabling, ,Disabling Breakpoints}.
3339
3340 @kindex hbreak
3341 @cindex hardware breakpoints
3342 @item hbreak @var{args}
3343 Set a hardware-assisted breakpoint. @var{args} are the same as for the
3344 @code{break} command and the breakpoint is set in the same way, but the
3345 breakpoint requires hardware support and some target hardware may not
3346 have this support. The main purpose of this is EPROM/ROM code
3347 debugging, so you can set a breakpoint at an instruction without
3348 changing the instruction. This can be used with the new trap-generation
3349 provided by SPARClite DSU and most x86-based targets. These targets
3350 will generate traps when a program accesses some data or instruction
3351 address that is assigned to the debug registers. However the hardware
3352 breakpoint registers can take a limited number of breakpoints. For
3353 example, on the DSU, only two data breakpoints can be set at a time, and
3354 @value{GDBN} will reject this command if more than two are used. Delete
3355 or disable unused hardware breakpoints before setting new ones
3356 (@pxref{Disabling, ,Disabling Breakpoints}).
3357 @xref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}.
3358 For remote targets, you can restrict the number of hardware
3359 breakpoints @value{GDBN} will use, see @ref{set remote
3360 hardware-breakpoint-limit}.
3361
3362 @kindex thbreak
3363 @item thbreak @var{args}
3364 Set a hardware-assisted breakpoint enabled only for one stop. @var{args}
3365 are the same as for the @code{hbreak} command and the breakpoint is set in
3366 the same way. However, like the @code{tbreak} command,
3367 the breakpoint is automatically deleted after the
3368 first time your program stops there. Also, like the @code{hbreak}
3369 command, the breakpoint requires hardware support and some target hardware
3370 may not have this support. @xref{Disabling, ,Disabling Breakpoints}.
3371 See also @ref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}.
3372
3373 @kindex rbreak
3374 @cindex regular expression
3375 @cindex breakpoints at functions matching a regexp
3376 @cindex set breakpoints in many functions
3377 @item rbreak @var{regex}
3378 Set breakpoints on all functions matching the regular expression
3379 @var{regex}. This command sets an unconditional breakpoint on all
3380 matches, printing a list of all breakpoints it set. Once these
3381 breakpoints are set, they are treated just like the breakpoints set with
3382 the @code{break} command. You can delete them, disable them, or make
3383 them conditional the same way as any other breakpoint.
3384
3385 The syntax of the regular expression is the standard one used with tools
3386 like @file{grep}. Note that this is different from the syntax used by
3387 shells, so for instance @code{foo*} matches all functions that include
3388 an @code{fo} followed by zero or more @code{o}s. There is an implicit
3389 @code{.*} leading and trailing the regular expression you supply, so to
3390 match only functions that begin with @code{foo}, use @code{^foo}.
3391
3392 @cindex non-member C@t{++} functions, set breakpoint in
3393 When debugging C@t{++} programs, @code{rbreak} is useful for setting
3394 breakpoints on overloaded functions that are not members of any special
3395 classes.
3396
3397 @cindex set breakpoints on all functions
3398 The @code{rbreak} command can be used to set breakpoints in
3399 @strong{all} the functions in a program, like this:
3400
3401 @smallexample
3402 (@value{GDBP}) rbreak .
3403 @end smallexample
3404
3405 @item rbreak @var{file}:@var{regex}
3406 If @code{rbreak} is called with a filename qualification, it limits
3407 the search for functions matching the given regular expression to the
3408 specified @var{file}. This can be used, for example, to set breakpoints on
3409 every function in a given file:
3410
3411 @smallexample
3412 (@value{GDBP}) rbreak file.c:.
3413 @end smallexample
3414
3415 The colon separating the filename qualifier from the regex may
3416 optionally be surrounded by spaces.
3417
3418 @kindex info breakpoints
3419 @cindex @code{$_} and @code{info breakpoints}
3420 @item info breakpoints @r{[}@var{n}@r{]}
3421 @itemx info break @r{[}@var{n}@r{]}
3422 Print a table of all breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints set and
3423 not deleted. Optional argument @var{n} means print information only
3424 about the specified breakpoint (or watchpoint or catchpoint). For
3425 each breakpoint, following columns are printed:
3426
3427 @table @emph
3428 @item Breakpoint Numbers
3429 @item Type
3430 Breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint.
3431 @item Disposition
3432 Whether the breakpoint is marked to be disabled or deleted when hit.
3433 @item Enabled or Disabled
3434 Enabled breakpoints are marked with @samp{y}. @samp{n} marks breakpoints
3435 that are not enabled.
3436 @item Address
3437 Where the breakpoint is in your program, as a memory address. For a
3438 pending breakpoint whose address is not yet known, this field will
3439 contain @samp{<PENDING>}. Such breakpoint won't fire until a shared
3440 library that has the symbol or line referred by breakpoint is loaded.
3441 See below for details. A breakpoint with several locations will
3442 have @samp{<MULTIPLE>} in this field---see below for details.
3443 @item What
3444 Where the breakpoint is in the source for your program, as a file and
3445 line number. For a pending breakpoint, the original string passed to
3446 the breakpoint command will be listed as it cannot be resolved until
3447 the appropriate shared library is loaded in the future.
3448 @end table
3449
3450 @noindent
3451 If a breakpoint is conditional, @code{info break} shows the condition on
3452 the line following the affected breakpoint; breakpoint commands, if any,
3453 are listed after that. A pending breakpoint is allowed to have a condition
3454 specified for it. The condition is not parsed for validity until a shared
3455 library is loaded that allows the pending breakpoint to resolve to a
3456 valid location.
3457
3458 @noindent
3459 @code{info break} with a breakpoint
3460 number @var{n} as argument lists only that breakpoint. The
3461 convenience variable @code{$_} and the default examining-address for
3462 the @code{x} command are set to the address of the last breakpoint
3463 listed (@pxref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}).
3464
3465 @noindent
3466 @code{info break} displays a count of the number of times the breakpoint
3467 has been hit. This is especially useful in conjunction with the
3468 @code{ignore} command. You can ignore a large number of breakpoint
3469 hits, look at the breakpoint info to see how many times the breakpoint
3470 was hit, and then run again, ignoring one less than that number. This
3471 will get you quickly to the last hit of that breakpoint.
3472 @end table
3473
3474 @value{GDBN} allows you to set any number of breakpoints at the same place in
3475 your program. There is nothing silly or meaningless about this. When
3476 the breakpoints are conditional, this is even useful
3477 (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}).
3478
3479 @cindex multiple locations, breakpoints
3480 @cindex breakpoints, multiple locations
3481 It is possible that a breakpoint corresponds to several locations
3482 in your program. Examples of this situation are:
3483
3484 @itemize @bullet
3485 @item
3486 For a C@t{++} constructor, the @value{NGCC} compiler generates several
3487 instances of the function body, used in different cases.
3488
3489 @item
3490 For a C@t{++} template function, a given line in the function can
3491 correspond to any number of instantiations.
3492
3493 @item
3494 For an inlined function, a given source line can correspond to
3495 several places where that function is inlined.
3496 @end itemize
3497
3498 In all those cases, @value{GDBN} will insert a breakpoint at all
3499 the relevant locations@footnote{
3500 As of this writing, multiple-location breakpoints work only if there's
3501 line number information for all the locations. This means that they
3502 will generally not work in system libraries, unless you have debug
3503 info with line numbers for them.}.
3504
3505 A breakpoint with multiple locations is displayed in the breakpoint
3506 table using several rows---one header row, followed by one row for
3507 each breakpoint location. The header row has @samp{<MULTIPLE>} in the
3508 address column. The rows for individual locations contain the actual
3509 addresses for locations, and show the functions to which those
3510 locations belong. The number column for a location is of the form
3511 @var{breakpoint-number}.@var{location-number}.
3512
3513 For example:
3514
3515 @smallexample
3516 Num Type Disp Enb Address What
3517 1 breakpoint keep y <MULTIPLE>
3518 stop only if i==1
3519 breakpoint already hit 1 time
3520 1.1 y 0x080486a2 in void foo<int>() at t.cc:8
3521 1.2 y 0x080486ca in void foo<double>() at t.cc:8
3522 @end smallexample
3523
3524 Each location can be individually enabled or disabled by passing
3525 @var{breakpoint-number}.@var{location-number} as argument to the
3526 @code{enable} and @code{disable} commands. Note that you cannot
3527 delete the individual locations from the list, you can only delete the
3528 entire list of locations that belong to their parent breakpoint (with
3529 the @kbd{delete @var{num}} command, where @var{num} is the number of
3530 the parent breakpoint, 1 in the above example). Disabling or enabling
3531 the parent breakpoint (@pxref{Disabling}) affects all of the locations
3532 that belong to that breakpoint.
3533
3534 @cindex pending breakpoints
3535 It's quite common to have a breakpoint inside a shared library.
3536 Shared libraries can be loaded and unloaded explicitly,
3537 and possibly repeatedly, as the program is executed. To support
3538 this use case, @value{GDBN} updates breakpoint locations whenever
3539 any shared library is loaded or unloaded. Typically, you would
3540 set a breakpoint in a shared library at the beginning of your
3541 debugging session, when the library is not loaded, and when the
3542 symbols from the library are not available. When you try to set
3543 breakpoint, @value{GDBN} will ask you if you want to set
3544 a so called @dfn{pending breakpoint}---breakpoint whose address
3545 is not yet resolved.
3546
3547 After the program is run, whenever a new shared library is loaded,
3548 @value{GDBN} reevaluates all the breakpoints. When a newly loaded
3549 shared library contains the symbol or line referred to by some
3550 pending breakpoint, that breakpoint is resolved and becomes an
3551 ordinary breakpoint. When a library is unloaded, all breakpoints
3552 that refer to its symbols or source lines become pending again.
3553
3554 This logic works for breakpoints with multiple locations, too. For
3555 example, if you have a breakpoint in a C@t{++} template function, and
3556 a newly loaded shared library has an instantiation of that template,
3557 a new location is added to the list of locations for the breakpoint.
3558
3559 Except for having unresolved address, pending breakpoints do not
3560 differ from regular breakpoints. You can set conditions or commands,
3561 enable and disable them and perform other breakpoint operations.
3562
3563 @value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling what
3564 happens when the @samp{break} command cannot resolve breakpoint
3565 address specification to an address:
3566
3567 @kindex set breakpoint pending
3568 @kindex show breakpoint pending
3569 @table @code
3570 @item set breakpoint pending auto
3571 This is the default behavior. When @value{GDBN} cannot find the breakpoint
3572 location, it queries you whether a pending breakpoint should be created.
3573
3574 @item set breakpoint pending on
3575 This indicates that an unrecognized breakpoint location should automatically
3576 result in a pending breakpoint being created.
3577
3578 @item set breakpoint pending off
3579 This indicates that pending breakpoints are not to be created. Any
3580 unrecognized breakpoint location results in an error. This setting does
3581 not affect any pending breakpoints previously created.
3582
3583 @item show breakpoint pending
3584 Show the current behavior setting for creating pending breakpoints.
3585 @end table
3586
3587 The settings above only affect the @code{break} command and its
3588 variants. Once breakpoint is set, it will be automatically updated
3589 as shared libraries are loaded and unloaded.
3590
3591 @cindex automatic hardware breakpoints
3592 For some targets, @value{GDBN} can automatically decide if hardware or
3593 software breakpoints should be used, depending on whether the
3594 breakpoint address is read-only or read-write. This applies to
3595 breakpoints set with the @code{break} command as well as to internal
3596 breakpoints set by commands like @code{next} and @code{finish}. For
3597 breakpoints set with @code{hbreak}, @value{GDBN} will always use hardware
3598 breakpoints.
3599
3600 You can control this automatic behaviour with the following commands::
3601
3602 @kindex set breakpoint auto-hw
3603 @kindex show breakpoint auto-hw
3604 @table @code
3605 @item set breakpoint auto-hw on
3606 This is the default behavior. When @value{GDBN} sets a breakpoint, it
3607 will try to use the target memory map to decide if software or hardware
3608 breakpoint must be used.
3609
3610 @item set breakpoint auto-hw off
3611 This indicates @value{GDBN} should not automatically select breakpoint
3612 type. If the target provides a memory map, @value{GDBN} will warn when
3613 trying to set software breakpoint at a read-only address.
3614 @end table
3615
3616 @value{GDBN} normally implements breakpoints by replacing the program code
3617 at the breakpoint address with a special instruction, which, when
3618 executed, given control to the debugger. By default, the program
3619 code is so modified only when the program is resumed. As soon as
3620 the program stops, @value{GDBN} restores the original instructions. This
3621 behaviour guards against leaving breakpoints inserted in the
3622 target should gdb abrubptly disconnect. However, with slow remote
3623 targets, inserting and removing breakpoint can reduce the performance.
3624 This behavior can be controlled with the following commands::
3625
3626 @kindex set breakpoint always-inserted
3627 @kindex show breakpoint always-inserted
3628 @table @code
3629 @item set breakpoint always-inserted off
3630 All breakpoints, including newly added by the user, are inserted in
3631 the target only when the target is resumed. All breakpoints are
3632 removed from the target when it stops.
3633
3634 @item set breakpoint always-inserted on
3635 Causes all breakpoints to be inserted in the target at all times. If
3636 the user adds a new breakpoint, or changes an existing breakpoint, the
3637 breakpoints in the target are updated immediately. A breakpoint is
3638 removed from the target only when breakpoint itself is removed.
3639
3640 @cindex non-stop mode, and @code{breakpoint always-inserted}
3641 @item set breakpoint always-inserted auto
3642 This is the default mode. If @value{GDBN} is controlling the inferior
3643 in non-stop mode (@pxref{Non-Stop Mode}), gdb behaves as if
3644 @code{breakpoint always-inserted} mode is on. If @value{GDBN} is
3645 controlling the inferior in all-stop mode, @value{GDBN} behaves as if
3646 @code{breakpoint always-inserted} mode is off.
3647 @end table
3648
3649 @cindex negative breakpoint numbers
3650 @cindex internal @value{GDBN} breakpoints
3651 @value{GDBN} itself sometimes sets breakpoints in your program for
3652 special purposes, such as proper handling of @code{longjmp} (in C
3653 programs). These internal breakpoints are assigned negative numbers,
3654 starting with @code{-1}; @samp{info breakpoints} does not display them.
3655 You can see these breakpoints with the @value{GDBN} maintenance command
3656 @samp{maint info breakpoints} (@pxref{maint info breakpoints}).
3657
3658
3659 @node Set Watchpoints
3660 @subsection Setting Watchpoints
3661
3662 @cindex setting watchpoints
3663 You can use a watchpoint to stop execution whenever the value of an
3664 expression changes, without having to predict a particular place where
3665 this may happen. (This is sometimes called a @dfn{data breakpoint}.)
3666 The expression may be as simple as the value of a single variable, or
3667 as complex as many variables combined by operators. Examples include:
3668
3669 @itemize @bullet
3670 @item
3671 A reference to the value of a single variable.
3672
3673 @item
3674 An address cast to an appropriate data type. For example,
3675 @samp{*(int *)0x12345678} will watch a 4-byte region at the specified
3676 address (assuming an @code{int} occupies 4 bytes).
3677
3678 @item
3679 An arbitrarily complex expression, such as @samp{a*b + c/d}. The
3680 expression can use any operators valid in the program's native
3681 language (@pxref{Languages}).
3682 @end itemize
3683
3684 You can set a watchpoint on an expression even if the expression can
3685 not be evaluated yet. For instance, you can set a watchpoint on
3686 @samp{*global_ptr} before @samp{global_ptr} is initialized.
3687 @value{GDBN} will stop when your program sets @samp{global_ptr} and
3688 the expression produces a valid value. If the expression becomes
3689 valid in some other way than changing a variable (e.g.@: if the memory
3690 pointed to by @samp{*global_ptr} becomes readable as the result of a
3691 @code{malloc} call), @value{GDBN} may not stop until the next time
3692 the expression changes.
3693
3694 @cindex software watchpoints
3695 @cindex hardware watchpoints
3696 Depending on your system, watchpoints may be implemented in software or
3697 hardware. @value{GDBN} does software watchpointing by single-stepping your
3698 program and testing the variable's value each time, which is hundreds of
3699 times slower than normal execution. (But this may still be worth it, to
3700 catch errors where you have no clue what part of your program is the
3701 culprit.)
3702
3703 On some systems, such as HP-UX, PowerPC, @sc{gnu}/Linux and most other
3704 x86-based targets, @value{GDBN} includes support for hardware
3705 watchpoints, which do not slow down the running of your program.
3706
3707 @table @code
3708 @kindex watch
3709 @item watch @r{[}-l@r{|}-location@r{]} @var{expr} @r{[}thread @var{threadnum}@r{]}
3710 Set a watchpoint for an expression. @value{GDBN} will break when the
3711 expression @var{expr} is written into by the program and its value
3712 changes. The simplest (and the most popular) use of this command is
3713 to watch the value of a single variable:
3714
3715 @smallexample
3716 (@value{GDBP}) watch foo
3717 @end smallexample
3718
3719 If the command includes a @code{@r{[}thread @var{threadnum}@r{]}}
3720 clause, @value{GDBN} breaks only when the thread identified by
3721 @var{threadnum} changes the value of @var{expr}. If any other threads
3722 change the value of @var{expr}, @value{GDBN} will not break. Note
3723 that watchpoints restricted to a single thread in this way only work
3724 with Hardware Watchpoints.
3725
3726 Ordinarily a watchpoint respects the scope of variables in @var{expr}
3727 (see below). The @code{-location} argument tells @value{GDBN} to
3728 instead watch the memory referred to by @var{expr}. In this case,
3729 @value{GDBN} will evaluate @var{expr}, take the address of the result,
3730 and watch the memory at that address. The type of the result is used
3731 to determine the size of the watched memory. If the expression's
3732 result does not have an address, then @value{GDBN} will print an
3733 error.
3734
3735 @kindex rwatch
3736 @item rwatch @r{[}-l@r{|}-location@r{]} @var{expr} @r{[}thread @var{threadnum}@r{]}
3737 Set a watchpoint that will break when the value of @var{expr} is read
3738 by the program.
3739
3740 @kindex awatch
3741 @item awatch @r{[}-l@r{|}-location@r{]} @var{expr} @r{[}thread @var{threadnum}@r{]}
3742 Set a watchpoint that will break when @var{expr} is either read from
3743 or written into by the program.
3744
3745 @kindex info watchpoints @r{[}@var{n}@r{]}
3746 @item info watchpoints
3747 This command prints a list of watchpoints, using the same format as
3748 @code{info break} (@pxref{Set Breaks}).
3749 @end table
3750
3751 If you watch for a change in a numerically entered address you need to
3752 dereference it, as the address itself is just a constant number which will
3753 never change. @value{GDBN} refuses to create a watchpoint that watches
3754 a never-changing value:
3755
3756 @smallexample
3757 (@value{GDBP}) watch 0x600850
3758 Cannot watch constant value 0x600850.
3759 (@value{GDBP}) watch *(int *) 0x600850
3760 Watchpoint 1: *(int *) 6293584
3761 @end smallexample
3762
3763 @value{GDBN} sets a @dfn{hardware watchpoint} if possible. Hardware
3764 watchpoints execute very quickly, and the debugger reports a change in
3765 value at the exact instruction where the change occurs. If @value{GDBN}
3766 cannot set a hardware watchpoint, it sets a software watchpoint, which
3767 executes more slowly and reports the change in value at the next
3768 @emph{statement}, not the instruction, after the change occurs.
3769
3770 @cindex use only software watchpoints
3771 You can force @value{GDBN} to use only software watchpoints with the
3772 @kbd{set can-use-hw-watchpoints 0} command. With this variable set to
3773 zero, @value{GDBN} will never try to use hardware watchpoints, even if
3774 the underlying system supports them. (Note that hardware-assisted
3775 watchpoints that were set @emph{before} setting
3776 @code{can-use-hw-watchpoints} to zero will still use the hardware
3777 mechanism of watching expression values.)
3778
3779 @table @code
3780 @item set can-use-hw-watchpoints
3781 @kindex set can-use-hw-watchpoints
3782 Set whether or not to use hardware watchpoints.
3783
3784 @item show can-use-hw-watchpoints
3785 @kindex show can-use-hw-watchpoints
3786 Show the current mode of using hardware watchpoints.
3787 @end table
3788
3789 For remote targets, you can restrict the number of hardware
3790 watchpoints @value{GDBN} will use, see @ref{set remote
3791 hardware-breakpoint-limit}.
3792
3793 When you issue the @code{watch} command, @value{GDBN} reports
3794
3795 @smallexample
3796 Hardware watchpoint @var{num}: @var{expr}
3797 @end smallexample
3798
3799 @noindent
3800 if it was able to set a hardware watchpoint.
3801
3802 Currently, the @code{awatch} and @code{rwatch} commands can only set
3803 hardware watchpoints, because accesses to data that don't change the
3804 value of the watched expression cannot be detected without examining
3805 every instruction as it is being executed, and @value{GDBN} does not do
3806 that currently. If @value{GDBN} finds that it is unable to set a
3807 hardware breakpoint with the @code{awatch} or @code{rwatch} command, it
3808 will print a message like this:
3809
3810 @smallexample
3811 Expression cannot be implemented with read/access watchpoint.
3812 @end smallexample
3813
3814 Sometimes, @value{GDBN} cannot set a hardware watchpoint because the
3815 data type of the watched expression is wider than what a hardware
3816 watchpoint on the target machine can handle. For example, some systems
3817 can only watch regions that are up to 4 bytes wide; on such systems you
3818 cannot set hardware watchpoints for an expression that yields a
3819 double-precision floating-point number (which is typically 8 bytes
3820 wide). As a work-around, it might be possible to break the large region
3821 into a series of smaller ones and watch them with separate watchpoints.
3822
3823 If you set too many hardware watchpoints, @value{GDBN} might be unable
3824 to insert all of them when you resume the execution of your program.
3825 Since the precise number of active watchpoints is unknown until such
3826 time as the program is about to be resumed, @value{GDBN} might not be
3827 able to warn you about this when you set the watchpoints, and the
3828 warning will be printed only when the program is resumed:
3829
3830 @smallexample
3831 Hardware watchpoint @var{num}: Could not insert watchpoint
3832 @end smallexample
3833
3834 @noindent
3835 If this happens, delete or disable some of the watchpoints.
3836
3837 Watching complex expressions that reference many variables can also
3838 exhaust the resources available for hardware-assisted watchpoints.
3839 That's because @value{GDBN} needs to watch every variable in the
3840 expression with separately allocated resources.
3841
3842 If you call a function interactively using @code{print} or @code{call},
3843 any watchpoints you have set will be inactive until @value{GDBN} reaches another
3844 kind of breakpoint or the call completes.
3845
3846 @value{GDBN} automatically deletes watchpoints that watch local
3847 (automatic) variables, or expressions that involve such variables, when
3848 they go out of scope, that is, when the execution leaves the block in
3849 which these variables were defined. In particular, when the program
3850 being debugged terminates, @emph{all} local variables go out of scope,
3851 and so only watchpoints that watch global variables remain set. If you
3852 rerun the program, you will need to set all such watchpoints again. One
3853 way of doing that would be to set a code breakpoint at the entry to the
3854 @code{main} function and when it breaks, set all the watchpoints.
3855
3856 @cindex watchpoints and threads
3857 @cindex threads and watchpoints
3858 In multi-threaded programs, watchpoints will detect changes to the
3859 watched expression from every thread.
3860
3861 @quotation
3862 @emph{Warning:} In multi-threaded programs, software watchpoints
3863 have only limited usefulness. If @value{GDBN} creates a software
3864 watchpoint, it can only watch the value of an expression @emph{in a
3865 single thread}. If you are confident that the expression can only
3866 change due to the current thread's activity (and if you are also
3867 confident that no other thread can become current), then you can use
3868 software watchpoints as usual. However, @value{GDBN} may not notice
3869 when a non-current thread's activity changes the expression. (Hardware
3870 watchpoints, in contrast, watch an expression in all threads.)
3871 @end quotation
3872
3873 @xref{set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit}.
3874
3875 @node Set Catchpoints
3876 @subsection Setting Catchpoints
3877 @cindex catchpoints, setting
3878 @cindex exception handlers
3879 @cindex event handling
3880
3881 You can use @dfn{catchpoints} to cause the debugger to stop for certain
3882 kinds of program events, such as C@t{++} exceptions or the loading of a
3883 shared library. Use the @code{catch} command to set a catchpoint.
3884
3885 @table @code
3886 @kindex catch
3887 @item catch @var{event}
3888 Stop when @var{event} occurs. @var{event} can be any of the following:
3889 @table @code
3890 @item throw
3891 @cindex stop on C@t{++} exceptions
3892 The throwing of a C@t{++} exception.
3893
3894 @item catch
3895 The catching of a C@t{++} exception.
3896
3897 @item exception
3898 @cindex Ada exception catching
3899 @cindex catch Ada exceptions
3900 An Ada exception being raised. If an exception name is specified
3901 at the end of the command (eg @code{catch exception Program_Error}),
3902 the debugger will stop only when this specific exception is raised.
3903 Otherwise, the debugger stops execution when any Ada exception is raised.
3904
3905 When inserting an exception catchpoint on a user-defined exception whose
3906 name is identical to one of the exceptions defined by the language, the
3907 fully qualified name must be used as the exception name. Otherwise,
3908 @value{GDBN} will assume that it should stop on the pre-defined exception
3909 rather than the user-defined one. For instance, assuming an exception
3910 called @code{Constraint_Error} is defined in package @code{Pck}, then
3911 the command to use to catch such exceptions is @kbd{catch exception
3912 Pck.Constraint_Error}.
3913
3914 @item exception unhandled
3915 An exception that was raised but is not handled by the program.
3916
3917 @item assert
3918 A failed Ada assertion.
3919
3920 @item exec
3921 @cindex break on fork/exec
3922 A call to @code{exec}. This is currently only available for HP-UX
3923 and @sc{gnu}/Linux.
3924
3925 @item syscall
3926 @itemx syscall @r{[}@var{name} @r{|} @var{number}@r{]} @dots{}
3927 @cindex break on a system call.
3928 A call to or return from a system call, a.k.a.@: @dfn{syscall}. A
3929 syscall is a mechanism for application programs to request a service
3930 from the operating system (OS) or one of the OS system services.
3931 @value{GDBN} can catch some or all of the syscalls issued by the
3932 debuggee, and show the related information for each syscall. If no
3933 argument is specified, calls to and returns from all system calls
3934 will be caught.
3935
3936 @var{name} can be any system call name that is valid for the
3937 underlying OS. Just what syscalls are valid depends on the OS. On
3938 GNU and Unix systems, you can find the full list of valid syscall
3939 names on @file{/usr/include/asm/unistd.h}.
3940
3941 @c For MS-Windows, the syscall names and the corresponding numbers
3942 @c can be found, e.g., on this URL:
3943 @c http://www.metasploit.com/users/opcode/syscalls.html
3944 @c but we don't support Windows syscalls yet.
3945
3946 Normally, @value{GDBN} knows in advance which syscalls are valid for
3947 each OS, so you can use the @value{GDBN} command-line completion
3948 facilities (@pxref{Completion,, command completion}) to list the
3949 available choices.
3950
3951 You may also specify the system call numerically. A syscall's
3952 number is the value passed to the OS's syscall dispatcher to
3953 identify the requested service. When you specify the syscall by its
3954 name, @value{GDBN} uses its database of syscalls to convert the name
3955 into the corresponding numeric code, but using the number directly
3956 may be useful if @value{GDBN}'s database does not have the complete
3957 list of syscalls on your system (e.g., because @value{GDBN} lags
3958 behind the OS upgrades).
3959
3960 The example below illustrates how this command works if you don't provide
3961 arguments to it:
3962
3963 @smallexample
3964 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall
3965 Catchpoint 1 (syscall)
3966 (@value{GDBP}) r
3967 Starting program: /tmp/catch-syscall
3968
3969 Catchpoint 1 (call to syscall 'close'), \
3970 0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall ()
3971 (@value{GDBP}) c
3972 Continuing.
3973
3974 Catchpoint 1 (returned from syscall 'close'), \
3975 0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall ()
3976 (@value{GDBP})
3977 @end smallexample
3978
3979 Here is an example of catching a system call by name:
3980
3981 @smallexample
3982 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall chroot
3983 Catchpoint 1 (syscall 'chroot' [61])
3984 (@value{GDBP}) r
3985 Starting program: /tmp/catch-syscall
3986
3987 Catchpoint 1 (call to syscall 'chroot'), \
3988 0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall ()
3989 (@value{GDBP}) c
3990 Continuing.
3991
3992 Catchpoint 1 (returned from syscall 'chroot'), \
3993 0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall ()
3994 (@value{GDBP})
3995 @end smallexample
3996
3997 An example of specifying a system call numerically. In the case
3998 below, the syscall number has a corresponding entry in the XML
3999 file, so @value{GDBN} finds its name and prints it:
4000
4001 @smallexample
4002 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall 252
4003 Catchpoint 1 (syscall(s) 'exit_group')
4004 (@value{GDBP}) r
4005 Starting program: /tmp/catch-syscall
4006
4007 Catchpoint 1 (call to syscall 'exit_group'), \
4008 0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall ()
4009 (@value{GDBP}) c
4010 Continuing.
4011
4012 Program exited normally.
4013 (@value{GDBP})
4014 @end smallexample
4015
4016 However, there can be situations when there is no corresponding name
4017 in XML file for that syscall number. In this case, @value{GDBN} prints
4018 a warning message saying that it was not able to find the syscall name,
4019 but the catchpoint will be set anyway. See the example below:
4020
4021 @smallexample
4022 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall 764
4023 warning: The number '764' does not represent a known syscall.
4024 Catchpoint 2 (syscall 764)
4025 (@value{GDBP})
4026 @end smallexample
4027
4028 If you configure @value{GDBN} using the @samp{--without-expat} option,
4029 it will not be able to display syscall names. Also, if your
4030 architecture does not have an XML file describing its system calls,
4031 you will not be able to see the syscall names. It is important to
4032 notice that these two features are used for accessing the syscall
4033 name database. In either case, you will see a warning like this:
4034
4035 @smallexample
4036 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall
4037 warning: Could not open "syscalls/i386-linux.xml"
4038 warning: Could not load the syscall XML file 'syscalls/i386-linux.xml'.
4039 GDB will not be able to display syscall names.
4040 Catchpoint 1 (syscall)
4041 (@value{GDBP})
4042 @end smallexample
4043
4044 Of course, the file name will change depending on your architecture and system.
4045
4046 Still using the example above, you can also try to catch a syscall by its
4047 number. In this case, you would see something like:
4048
4049 @smallexample
4050 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall 252
4051 Catchpoint 1 (syscall(s) 252)
4052 @end smallexample
4053
4054 Again, in this case @value{GDBN} would not be able to display syscall's names.
4055
4056 @item fork
4057 A call to @code{fork}. This is currently only available for HP-UX
4058 and @sc{gnu}/Linux.
4059
4060 @item vfork
4061 A call to @code{vfork}. This is currently only available for HP-UX
4062 and @sc{gnu}/Linux.
4063
4064 @end table
4065
4066 @item tcatch @var{event}
4067 Set a catchpoint that is enabled only for one stop. The catchpoint is
4068 automatically deleted after the first time the event is caught.
4069
4070 @end table
4071
4072 Use the @code{info break} command to list the current catchpoints.
4073
4074 There are currently some limitations to C@t{++} exception handling
4075 (@code{catch throw} and @code{catch catch}) in @value{GDBN}:
4076
4077 @itemize @bullet
4078 @item
4079 If you call a function interactively, @value{GDBN} normally returns
4080 control to you when the function has finished executing. If the call
4081 raises an exception, however, the call may bypass the mechanism that
4082 returns control to you and cause your program either to abort or to
4083 simply continue running until it hits a breakpoint, catches a signal
4084 that @value{GDBN} is listening for, or exits. This is the case even if
4085 you set a catchpoint for the exception; catchpoints on exceptions are
4086 disabled within interactive calls.
4087
4088 @item
4089 You cannot raise an exception interactively.
4090
4091 @item
4092 You cannot install an exception handler interactively.
4093 @end itemize
4094
4095 @cindex raise exceptions
4096 Sometimes @code{catch} is not the best way to debug exception handling:
4097 if you need to know exactly where an exception is raised, it is better to
4098 stop @emph{before} the exception handler is called, since that way you
4099 can see the stack before any unwinding takes place. If you set a
4100 breakpoint in an exception handler instead, it may not be easy to find
4101 out where the exception was raised.
4102
4103 To stop just before an exception handler is called, you need some
4104 knowledge of the implementation. In the case of @sc{gnu} C@t{++}, exceptions are
4105 raised by calling a library function named @code{__raise_exception}
4106 which has the following ANSI C interface:
4107
4108 @smallexample
4109 /* @var{addr} is where the exception identifier is stored.
4110 @var{id} is the exception identifier. */
4111 void __raise_exception (void **addr, void *id);
4112 @end smallexample
4113
4114 @noindent
4115 To make the debugger catch all exceptions before any stack
4116 unwinding takes place, set a breakpoint on @code{__raise_exception}
4117 (@pxref{Breakpoints, ,Breakpoints; Watchpoints; and Exceptions}).
4118
4119 With a conditional breakpoint (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions})
4120 that depends on the value of @var{id}, you can stop your program when
4121 a specific exception is raised. You can use multiple conditional
4122 breakpoints to stop your program when any of a number of exceptions are
4123 raised.
4124
4125
4126 @node Delete Breaks
4127 @subsection Deleting Breakpoints
4128
4129 @cindex clearing breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints
4130 @cindex deleting breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints
4131 It is often necessary to eliminate a breakpoint, watchpoint, or
4132 catchpoint once it has done its job and you no longer want your program
4133 to stop there. This is called @dfn{deleting} the breakpoint. A
4134 breakpoint that has been deleted no longer exists; it is forgotten.
4135
4136 With the @code{clear} command you can delete breakpoints according to
4137 where they are in your program. With the @code{delete} command you can
4138 delete individual breakpoints, watchpoints, or catchpoints by specifying
4139 their breakpoint numbers.
4140
4141 It is not necessary to delete a breakpoint to proceed past it. @value{GDBN}
4142 automatically ignores breakpoints on the first instruction to be executed
4143 when you continue execution without changing the execution address.
4144
4145 @table @code
4146 @kindex clear
4147 @item clear
4148 Delete any breakpoints at the next instruction to be executed in the
4149 selected stack frame (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}). When
4150 the innermost frame is selected, this is a good way to delete a
4151 breakpoint where your program just stopped.
4152
4153 @item clear @var{location}
4154 Delete any breakpoints set at the specified @var{location}.
4155 @xref{Specify Location}, for the various forms of @var{location}; the
4156 most useful ones are listed below:
4157
4158 @table @code
4159 @item clear @var{function}
4160 @itemx clear @var{filename}:@var{function}
4161 Delete any breakpoints set at entry to the named @var{function}.
4162
4163 @item clear @var{linenum}
4164 @itemx clear @var{filename}:@var{linenum}
4165 Delete any breakpoints set at or within the code of the specified
4166 @var{linenum} of the specified @var{filename}.
4167 @end table
4168
4169 @cindex delete breakpoints
4170 @kindex delete
4171 @kindex d @r{(@code{delete})}
4172 @item delete @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
4173 Delete the breakpoints, watchpoints, or catchpoints of the breakpoint
4174 ranges specified as arguments. If no argument is specified, delete all
4175 breakpoints (@value{GDBN} asks confirmation, unless you have @code{set
4176 confirm off}). You can abbreviate this command as @code{d}.
4177 @end table
4178
4179 @node Disabling
4180 @subsection Disabling Breakpoints
4181
4182 @cindex enable/disable a breakpoint
4183 Rather than deleting a breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint, you might
4184 prefer to @dfn{disable} it. This makes the breakpoint inoperative as if
4185 it had been deleted, but remembers the information on the breakpoint so
4186 that you can @dfn{enable} it again later.
4187
4188 You disable and enable breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints with
4189 the @code{enable} and @code{disable} commands, optionally specifying
4190 one or more breakpoint numbers as arguments. Use @code{info break} to
4191 print a list of all breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints if you
4192 do not know which numbers to use.
4193
4194 Disabling and enabling a breakpoint that has multiple locations
4195 affects all of its locations.
4196
4197 A breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint can have any of four different
4198 states of enablement:
4199
4200 @itemize @bullet
4201 @item
4202 Enabled. The breakpoint stops your program. A breakpoint set
4203 with the @code{break} command starts out in this state.
4204 @item
4205 Disabled. The breakpoint has no effect on your program.
4206 @item
4207 Enabled once. The breakpoint stops your program, but then becomes
4208 disabled.
4209 @item
4210 Enabled for deletion. The breakpoint stops your program, but
4211 immediately after it does so it is deleted permanently. A breakpoint
4212 set with the @code{tbreak} command starts out in this state.
4213 @end itemize
4214
4215 You can use the following commands to enable or disable breakpoints,
4216 watchpoints, and catchpoints:
4217
4218 @table @code
4219 @kindex disable
4220 @kindex dis @r{(@code{disable})}
4221 @item disable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
4222 Disable the specified breakpoints---or all breakpoints, if none are
4223 listed. A disabled breakpoint has no effect but is not forgotten. All
4224 options such as ignore-counts, conditions and commands are remembered in
4225 case the breakpoint is enabled again later. You may abbreviate
4226 @code{disable} as @code{dis}.
4227
4228 @kindex enable
4229 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
4230 Enable the specified breakpoints (or all defined breakpoints). They
4231 become effective once again in stopping your program.
4232
4233 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} once @var{range}@dots{}
4234 Enable the specified breakpoints temporarily. @value{GDBN} disables any
4235 of these breakpoints immediately after stopping your program.
4236
4237 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} delete @var{range}@dots{}
4238 Enable the specified breakpoints to work once, then die. @value{GDBN}
4239 deletes any of these breakpoints as soon as your program stops there.
4240 Breakpoints set by the @code{tbreak} command start out in this state.
4241 @end table
4242
4243 @c FIXME: I think the following ``Except for [...] @code{tbreak}'' is
4244 @c confusing: tbreak is also initially enabled.
4245 Except for a breakpoint set with @code{tbreak} (@pxref{Set Breaks,
4246 ,Setting Breakpoints}), breakpoints that you set are initially enabled;
4247 subsequently, they become disabled or enabled only when you use one of
4248 the commands above. (The command @code{until} can set and delete a
4249 breakpoint of its own, but it does not change the state of your other
4250 breakpoints; see @ref{Continuing and Stepping, ,Continuing and
4251 Stepping}.)
4252
4253 @node Conditions
4254 @subsection Break Conditions
4255 @cindex conditional breakpoints
4256 @cindex breakpoint conditions
4257
4258 @c FIXME what is scope of break condition expr? Context where wanted?
4259 @c in particular for a watchpoint?
4260 The simplest sort of breakpoint breaks every time your program reaches a
4261 specified place. You can also specify a @dfn{condition} for a
4262 breakpoint. A condition is just a Boolean expression in your
4263 programming language (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). A breakpoint with
4264 a condition evaluates the expression each time your program reaches it,
4265 and your program stops only if the condition is @emph{true}.
4266
4267 This is the converse of using assertions for program validation; in that
4268 situation, you want to stop when the assertion is violated---that is,
4269 when the condition is false. In C, if you want to test an assertion expressed
4270 by the condition @var{assert}, you should set the condition
4271 @samp{! @var{assert}} on the appropriate breakpoint.
4272
4273 Conditions are also accepted for watchpoints; you may not need them,
4274 since a watchpoint is inspecting the value of an expression anyhow---but
4275 it might be simpler, say, to just set a watchpoint on a variable name,
4276 and specify a condition that tests whether the new value is an interesting
4277 one.
4278
4279 Break conditions can have side effects, and may even call functions in
4280 your program. This can be useful, for example, to activate functions
4281 that log program progress, or to use your own print functions to
4282 format special data structures. The effects are completely predictable
4283 unless there is another enabled breakpoint at the same address. (In
4284 that case, @value{GDBN} might see the other breakpoint first and stop your
4285 program without checking the condition of this one.) Note that
4286 breakpoint commands are usually more convenient and flexible than break
4287 conditions for the
4288 purpose of performing side effects when a breakpoint is reached
4289 (@pxref{Break Commands, ,Breakpoint Command Lists}).
4290
4291 Break conditions can be specified when a breakpoint is set, by using
4292 @samp{if} in the arguments to the @code{break} command. @xref{Set
4293 Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}. They can also be changed at any time
4294 with the @code{condition} command.
4295
4296 You can also use the @code{if} keyword with the @code{watch} command.
4297 The @code{catch} command does not recognize the @code{if} keyword;
4298 @code{condition} is the only way to impose a further condition on a
4299 catchpoint.
4300
4301 @table @code
4302 @kindex condition
4303 @item condition @var{bnum} @var{expression}
4304 Specify @var{expression} as the break condition for breakpoint,
4305 watchpoint, or catchpoint number @var{bnum}. After you set a condition,
4306 breakpoint @var{bnum} stops your program only if the value of
4307 @var{expression} is true (nonzero, in C). When you use
4308 @code{condition}, @value{GDBN} checks @var{expression} immediately for
4309 syntactic correctness, and to determine whether symbols in it have
4310 referents in the context of your breakpoint. If @var{expression} uses
4311 symbols not referenced in the context of the breakpoint, @value{GDBN}
4312 prints an error message:
4313
4314 @smallexample
4315 No symbol "foo" in current context.
4316 @end smallexample
4317
4318 @noindent
4319 @value{GDBN} does
4320 not actually evaluate @var{expression} at the time the @code{condition}
4321 command (or a command that sets a breakpoint with a condition, like
4322 @code{break if @dots{}}) is given, however. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
4323
4324 @item condition @var{bnum}
4325 Remove the condition from breakpoint number @var{bnum}. It becomes
4326 an ordinary unconditional breakpoint.
4327 @end table
4328
4329 @cindex ignore count (of breakpoint)
4330 A special case of a breakpoint condition is to stop only when the
4331 breakpoint has been reached a certain number of times. This is so
4332 useful that there is a special way to do it, using the @dfn{ignore
4333 count} of the breakpoint. Every breakpoint has an ignore count, which
4334 is an integer. Most of the time, the ignore count is zero, and
4335 therefore has no effect. But if your program reaches a breakpoint whose
4336 ignore count is positive, then instead of stopping, it just decrements
4337 the ignore count by one and continues. As a result, if the ignore count
4338 value is @var{n}, the breakpoint does not stop the next @var{n} times
4339 your program reaches it.
4340
4341 @table @code
4342 @kindex ignore
4343 @item ignore @var{bnum} @var{count}
4344 Set the ignore count of breakpoint number @var{bnum} to @var{count}.
4345 The next @var{count} times the breakpoint is reached, your program's
4346 execution does not stop; other than to decrement the ignore count, @value{GDBN}
4347 takes no action.
4348
4349 To make the breakpoint stop the next time it is reached, specify
4350 a count of zero.
4351
4352 When you use @code{continue} to resume execution of your program from a
4353 breakpoint, you can specify an ignore count directly as an argument to
4354 @code{continue}, rather than using @code{ignore}. @xref{Continuing and
4355 Stepping,,Continuing and Stepping}.
4356
4357 If a breakpoint has a positive ignore count and a condition, the
4358 condition is not checked. Once the ignore count reaches zero,
4359 @value{GDBN} resumes checking the condition.
4360
4361 You could achieve the effect of the ignore count with a condition such
4362 as @w{@samp{$foo-- <= 0}} using a debugger convenience variable that
4363 is decremented each time. @xref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
4364 Variables}.
4365 @end table
4366
4367 Ignore counts apply to breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints.
4368
4369
4370 @node Break Commands
4371 @subsection Breakpoint Command Lists
4372
4373 @cindex breakpoint commands
4374 You can give any breakpoint (or watchpoint or catchpoint) a series of
4375 commands to execute when your program stops due to that breakpoint. For
4376 example, you might want to print the values of certain expressions, or
4377 enable other breakpoints.
4378
4379 @table @code
4380 @kindex commands
4381 @kindex end@r{ (breakpoint commands)}
4382 @item commands @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
4383 @itemx @dots{} @var{command-list} @dots{}
4384 @itemx end
4385 Specify a list of commands for the given breakpoints. The commands
4386 themselves appear on the following lines. Type a line containing just
4387 @code{end} to terminate the commands.
4388
4389 To remove all commands from a breakpoint, type @code{commands} and
4390 follow it immediately with @code{end}; that is, give no commands.
4391
4392 With no argument, @code{commands} refers to the last breakpoint,
4393 watchpoint, or catchpoint set (not to the breakpoint most recently
4394 encountered). If the most recent breakpoints were set with a single
4395 command, then the @code{commands} will apply to all the breakpoints
4396 set by that command. This applies to breakpoints set by
4397 @code{rbreak}, and also applies when a single @code{break} command
4398 creates multiple breakpoints (@pxref{Ambiguous Expressions,,Ambiguous
4399 Expressions}).
4400 @end table
4401
4402 Pressing @key{RET} as a means of repeating the last @value{GDBN} command is
4403 disabled within a @var{command-list}.
4404
4405 You can use breakpoint commands to start your program up again. Simply
4406 use the @code{continue} command, or @code{step}, or any other command
4407 that resumes execution.
4408
4409 Any other commands in the command list, after a command that resumes
4410 execution, are ignored. This is because any time you resume execution
4411 (even with a simple @code{next} or @code{step}), you may encounter
4412 another breakpoint---which could have its own command list, leading to
4413 ambiguities about which list to execute.
4414
4415 @kindex silent
4416 If the first command you specify in a command list is @code{silent}, the
4417 usual message about stopping at a breakpoint is not printed. This may
4418 be desirable for breakpoints that are to print a specific message and
4419 then continue. If none of the remaining commands print anything, you
4420 see no sign that the breakpoint was reached. @code{silent} is
4421 meaningful only at the beginning of a breakpoint command list.
4422
4423 The commands @code{echo}, @code{output}, and @code{printf} allow you to
4424 print precisely controlled output, and are often useful in silent
4425 breakpoints. @xref{Output, ,Commands for Controlled Output}.
4426
4427 For example, here is how you could use breakpoint commands to print the
4428 value of @code{x} at entry to @code{foo} whenever @code{x} is positive.
4429
4430 @smallexample
4431 break foo if x>0
4432 commands
4433 silent
4434 printf "x is %d\n",x
4435 cont
4436 end
4437 @end smallexample
4438
4439 One application for breakpoint commands is to compensate for one bug so
4440 you can test for another. Put a breakpoint just after the erroneous line
4441 of code, give it a condition to detect the case in which something
4442 erroneous has been done, and give it commands to assign correct values
4443 to any variables that need them. End with the @code{continue} command
4444 so that your program does not stop, and start with the @code{silent}
4445 command so that no output is produced. Here is an example:
4446
4447 @smallexample
4448 break 403
4449 commands
4450 silent
4451 set x = y + 4
4452 cont
4453 end
4454 @end smallexample
4455
4456 @node Save Breakpoints
4457 @subsection How to save breakpoints to a file
4458
4459 To save breakpoint definitions to a file use the @w{@code{save
4460 breakpoints}} command.
4461
4462 @table @code
4463 @kindex save breakpoints
4464 @cindex save breakpoints to a file for future sessions
4465 @item save breakpoints [@var{filename}]
4466 This command saves all current breakpoint definitions together with
4467 their commands and ignore counts, into a file @file{@var{filename}}
4468 suitable for use in a later debugging session. This includes all
4469 types of breakpoints (breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints,
4470 tracepoints). To read the saved breakpoint definitions, use the
4471 @code{source} command (@pxref{Command Files}). Note that watchpoints
4472 with expressions involving local variables may fail to be recreated
4473 because it may not be possible to access the context where the
4474 watchpoint is valid anymore. Because the saved breakpoint definitions
4475 are simply a sequence of @value{GDBN} commands that recreate the
4476 breakpoints, you can edit the file in your favorite editing program,
4477 and remove the breakpoint definitions you're not interested in, or
4478 that can no longer be recreated.
4479 @end table
4480
4481 @c @ifclear BARETARGET
4482 @node Error in Breakpoints
4483 @subsection ``Cannot insert breakpoints''
4484
4485 If you request too many active hardware-assisted breakpoints and
4486 watchpoints, you will see this error message:
4487
4488 @c FIXME: the precise wording of this message may change; the relevant
4489 @c source change is not committed yet (Sep 3, 1999).
4490 @smallexample
4491 Stopped; cannot insert breakpoints.
4492 You may have requested too many hardware breakpoints and watchpoints.
4493 @end smallexample
4494
4495 @noindent
4496 This message is printed when you attempt to resume the program, since
4497 only then @value{GDBN} knows exactly how many hardware breakpoints and
4498 watchpoints it needs to insert.
4499
4500 When this message is printed, you need to disable or remove some of the
4501 hardware-assisted breakpoints and watchpoints, and then continue.
4502
4503 @node Breakpoint-related Warnings
4504 @subsection ``Breakpoint address adjusted...''
4505 @cindex breakpoint address adjusted
4506
4507 Some processor architectures place constraints on the addresses at
4508 which breakpoints may be placed. For architectures thus constrained,
4509 @value{GDBN} will attempt to adjust the breakpoint's address to comply
4510 with the constraints dictated by the architecture.
4511
4512 One example of such an architecture is the Fujitsu FR-V. The FR-V is
4513 a VLIW architecture in which a number of RISC-like instructions may be
4514 bundled together for parallel execution. The FR-V architecture
4515 constrains the location of a breakpoint instruction within such a
4516 bundle to the instruction with the lowest address. @value{GDBN}
4517 honors this constraint by adjusting a breakpoint's address to the
4518 first in the bundle.
4519
4520 It is not uncommon for optimized code to have bundles which contain
4521 instructions from different source statements, thus it may happen that
4522 a breakpoint's address will be adjusted from one source statement to
4523 another. Since this adjustment may significantly alter @value{GDBN}'s
4524 breakpoint related behavior from what the user expects, a warning is
4525 printed when the breakpoint is first set and also when the breakpoint
4526 is hit.
4527
4528 A warning like the one below is printed when setting a breakpoint
4529 that's been subject to address adjustment:
4530
4531 @smallexample
4532 warning: Breakpoint address adjusted from 0x00010414 to 0x00010410.
4533 @end smallexample
4534
4535 Such warnings are printed both for user settable and @value{GDBN}'s
4536 internal breakpoints. If you see one of these warnings, you should
4537 verify that a breakpoint set at the adjusted address will have the
4538 desired affect. If not, the breakpoint in question may be removed and
4539 other breakpoints may be set which will have the desired behavior.
4540 E.g., it may be sufficient to place the breakpoint at a later
4541 instruction. A conditional breakpoint may also be useful in some
4542 cases to prevent the breakpoint from triggering too often.
4543
4544 @value{GDBN} will also issue a warning when stopping at one of these
4545 adjusted breakpoints:
4546
4547 @smallexample
4548 warning: Breakpoint 1 address previously adjusted from 0x00010414
4549 to 0x00010410.
4550 @end smallexample
4551
4552 When this warning is encountered, it may be too late to take remedial
4553 action except in cases where the breakpoint is hit earlier or more
4554 frequently than expected.
4555
4556 @node Continuing and Stepping
4557 @section Continuing and Stepping
4558
4559 @cindex stepping
4560 @cindex continuing
4561 @cindex resuming execution
4562 @dfn{Continuing} means resuming program execution until your program
4563 completes normally. In contrast, @dfn{stepping} means executing just
4564 one more ``step'' of your program, where ``step'' may mean either one
4565 line of source code, or one machine instruction (depending on what
4566 particular command you use). Either when continuing or when stepping,
4567 your program may stop even sooner, due to a breakpoint or a signal. (If
4568 it stops due to a signal, you may want to use @code{handle}, or use
4569 @samp{signal 0} to resume execution. @xref{Signals, ,Signals}.)
4570
4571 @table @code
4572 @kindex continue
4573 @kindex c @r{(@code{continue})}
4574 @kindex fg @r{(resume foreground execution)}
4575 @item continue @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
4576 @itemx c @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
4577 @itemx fg @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
4578 Resume program execution, at the address where your program last stopped;
4579 any breakpoints set at that address are bypassed. The optional argument
4580 @var{ignore-count} allows you to specify a further number of times to
4581 ignore a breakpoint at this location; its effect is like that of
4582 @code{ignore} (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}).
4583
4584 The argument @var{ignore-count} is meaningful only when your program
4585 stopped due to a breakpoint. At other times, the argument to
4586 @code{continue} is ignored.
4587
4588 The synonyms @code{c} and @code{fg} (for @dfn{foreground}, as the
4589 debugged program is deemed to be the foreground program) are provided
4590 purely for convenience, and have exactly the same behavior as
4591 @code{continue}.
4592 @end table
4593
4594 To resume execution at a different place, you can use @code{return}
4595 (@pxref{Returning, ,Returning from a Function}) to go back to the
4596 calling function; or @code{jump} (@pxref{Jumping, ,Continuing at a
4597 Different Address}) to go to an arbitrary location in your program.
4598
4599 A typical technique for using stepping is to set a breakpoint
4600 (@pxref{Breakpoints, ,Breakpoints; Watchpoints; and Catchpoints}) at the
4601 beginning of the function or the section of your program where a problem
4602 is believed to lie, run your program until it stops at that breakpoint,
4603 and then step through the suspect area, examining the variables that are
4604 interesting, until you see the problem happen.
4605
4606 @table @code
4607 @kindex step
4608 @kindex s @r{(@code{step})}
4609 @item step
4610 Continue running your program until control reaches a different source
4611 line, then stop it and return control to @value{GDBN}. This command is
4612 abbreviated @code{s}.
4613
4614 @quotation
4615 @c "without debugging information" is imprecise; actually "without line
4616 @c numbers in the debugging information". (gcc -g1 has debugging info but
4617 @c not line numbers). But it seems complex to try to make that
4618 @c distinction here.
4619 @emph{Warning:} If you use the @code{step} command while control is
4620 within a function that was compiled without debugging information,
4621 execution proceeds until control reaches a function that does have
4622 debugging information. Likewise, it will not step into a function which
4623 is compiled without debugging information. To step through functions
4624 without debugging information, use the @code{stepi} command, described
4625 below.
4626 @end quotation
4627
4628 The @code{step} command only stops at the first instruction of a source
4629 line. This prevents the multiple stops that could otherwise occur in
4630 @code{switch} statements, @code{for} loops, etc. @code{step} continues
4631 to stop if a function that has debugging information is called within
4632 the line. In other words, @code{step} @emph{steps inside} any functions
4633 called within the line.
4634
4635 Also, the @code{step} command only enters a function if there is line
4636 number information for the function. Otherwise it acts like the
4637 @code{next} command. This avoids problems when using @code{cc -gl}
4638 on MIPS machines. Previously, @code{step} entered subroutines if there
4639 was any debugging information about the routine.
4640
4641 @item step @var{count}
4642 Continue running as in @code{step}, but do so @var{count} times. If a
4643 breakpoint is reached, or a signal not related to stepping occurs before
4644 @var{count} steps, stepping stops right away.
4645
4646 @kindex next
4647 @kindex n @r{(@code{next})}
4648 @item next @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
4649 Continue to the next source line in the current (innermost) stack frame.
4650 This is similar to @code{step}, but function calls that appear within
4651 the line of code are executed without stopping. Execution stops when
4652 control reaches a different line of code at the original stack level
4653 that was executing when you gave the @code{next} command. This command
4654 is abbreviated @code{n}.
4655
4656 An argument @var{count} is a repeat count, as for @code{step}.
4657
4658
4659 @c FIX ME!! Do we delete this, or is there a way it fits in with
4660 @c the following paragraph? --- Vctoria
4661 @c
4662 @c @code{next} within a function that lacks debugging information acts like
4663 @c @code{step}, but any function calls appearing within the code of the
4664 @c function are executed without stopping.
4665
4666 The @code{next} command only stops at the first instruction of a
4667 source line. This prevents multiple stops that could otherwise occur in
4668 @code{switch} statements, @code{for} loops, etc.
4669
4670 @kindex set step-mode
4671 @item set step-mode
4672 @cindex functions without line info, and stepping
4673 @cindex stepping into functions with no line info
4674 @itemx set step-mode on
4675 The @code{set step-mode on} command causes the @code{step} command to
4676 stop at the first instruction of a function which contains no debug line
4677 information rather than stepping over it.
4678
4679 This is useful in cases where you may be interested in inspecting the
4680 machine instructions of a function which has no symbolic info and do not
4681 want @value{GDBN} to automatically skip over this function.
4682
4683 @item set step-mode off
4684 Causes the @code{step} command to step over any functions which contains no
4685 debug information. This is the default.
4686
4687 @item show step-mode
4688 Show whether @value{GDBN} will stop in or step over functions without
4689 source line debug information.
4690
4691 @kindex finish
4692 @kindex fin @r{(@code{finish})}
4693 @item finish
4694 Continue running until just after function in the selected stack frame
4695 returns. Print the returned value (if any). This command can be
4696 abbreviated as @code{fin}.
4697
4698 Contrast this with the @code{return} command (@pxref{Returning,
4699 ,Returning from a Function}).
4700
4701 @kindex until
4702 @kindex u @r{(@code{until})}
4703 @cindex run until specified location
4704 @item until
4705 @itemx u
4706 Continue running until a source line past the current line, in the
4707 current stack frame, is reached. This command is used to avoid single
4708 stepping through a loop more than once. It is like the @code{next}
4709 command, except that when @code{until} encounters a jump, it
4710 automatically continues execution until the program counter is greater
4711 than the address of the jump.
4712
4713 This means that when you reach the end of a loop after single stepping
4714 though it, @code{until} makes your program continue execution until it
4715 exits the loop. In contrast, a @code{next} command at the end of a loop
4716 simply steps back to the beginning of the loop, which forces you to step
4717 through the next iteration.
4718
4719 @code{until} always stops your program if it attempts to exit the current
4720 stack frame.
4721
4722 @code{until} may produce somewhat counterintuitive results if the order
4723 of machine code does not match the order of the source lines. For
4724 example, in the following excerpt from a debugging session, the @code{f}
4725 (@code{frame}) command shows that execution is stopped at line
4726 @code{206}; yet when we use @code{until}, we get to line @code{195}:
4727
4728 @smallexample
4729 (@value{GDBP}) f
4730 #0 main (argc=4, argv=0xf7fffae8) at m4.c:206
4731 206 expand_input();
4732 (@value{GDBP}) until
4733 195 for ( ; argc > 0; NEXTARG) @{
4734 @end smallexample
4735
4736 This happened because, for execution efficiency, the compiler had
4737 generated code for the loop closure test at the end, rather than the
4738 start, of the loop---even though the test in a C @code{for}-loop is
4739 written before the body of the loop. The @code{until} command appeared
4740 to step back to the beginning of the loop when it advanced to this
4741 expression; however, it has not really gone to an earlier
4742 statement---not in terms of the actual machine code.
4743
4744 @code{until} with no argument works by means of single
4745 instruction stepping, and hence is slower than @code{until} with an
4746 argument.
4747
4748 @item until @var{location}
4749 @itemx u @var{location}
4750 Continue running your program until either the specified location is
4751 reached, or the current stack frame returns. @var{location} is any of
4752 the forms described in @ref{Specify Location}.
4753 This form of the command uses temporary breakpoints, and
4754 hence is quicker than @code{until} without an argument. The specified
4755 location is actually reached only if it is in the current frame. This
4756 implies that @code{until} can be used to skip over recursive function
4757 invocations. For instance in the code below, if the current location is
4758 line @code{96}, issuing @code{until 99} will execute the program up to
4759 line @code{99} in the same invocation of factorial, i.e., after the inner
4760 invocations have returned.
4761
4762 @smallexample
4763 94 int factorial (int value)
4764 95 @{
4765 96 if (value > 1) @{
4766 97 value *= factorial (value - 1);
4767 98 @}
4768 99 return (value);
4769 100 @}
4770 @end smallexample
4771
4772
4773 @kindex advance @var{location}
4774 @itemx advance @var{location}
4775 Continue running the program up to the given @var{location}. An argument is
4776 required, which should be of one of the forms described in
4777 @ref{Specify Location}.
4778 Execution will also stop upon exit from the current stack
4779 frame. This command is similar to @code{until}, but @code{advance} will
4780 not skip over recursive function calls, and the target location doesn't
4781 have to be in the same frame as the current one.
4782
4783
4784 @kindex stepi
4785 @kindex si @r{(@code{stepi})}
4786 @item stepi
4787 @itemx stepi @var{arg}
4788 @itemx si
4789 Execute one machine instruction, then stop and return to the debugger.
4790
4791 It is often useful to do @samp{display/i $pc} when stepping by machine
4792 instructions. This makes @value{GDBN} automatically display the next
4793 instruction to be executed, each time your program stops. @xref{Auto
4794 Display,, Automatic Display}.
4795
4796 An argument is a repeat count, as in @code{step}.
4797
4798 @need 750
4799 @kindex nexti
4800 @kindex ni @r{(@code{nexti})}
4801 @item nexti
4802 @itemx nexti @var{arg}
4803 @itemx ni
4804 Execute one machine instruction, but if it is a function call,
4805 proceed until the function returns.
4806
4807 An argument is a repeat count, as in @code{next}.
4808 @end table
4809
4810 @node Signals
4811 @section Signals
4812 @cindex signals
4813
4814 A signal is an asynchronous event that can happen in a program. The
4815 operating system defines the possible kinds of signals, and gives each
4816 kind a name and a number. For example, in Unix @code{SIGINT} is the
4817 signal a program gets when you type an interrupt character (often @kbd{Ctrl-c});
4818 @code{SIGSEGV} is the signal a program gets from referencing a place in
4819 memory far away from all the areas in use; @code{SIGALRM} occurs when
4820 the alarm clock timer goes off (which happens only if your program has
4821 requested an alarm).
4822
4823 @cindex fatal signals
4824 Some signals, including @code{SIGALRM}, are a normal part of the
4825 functioning of your program. Others, such as @code{SIGSEGV}, indicate
4826 errors; these signals are @dfn{fatal} (they kill your program immediately) if the
4827 program has not specified in advance some other way to handle the signal.
4828 @code{SIGINT} does not indicate an error in your program, but it is normally
4829 fatal so it can carry out the purpose of the interrupt: to kill the program.
4830
4831 @value{GDBN} has the ability to detect any occurrence of a signal in your
4832 program. You can tell @value{GDBN} in advance what to do for each kind of
4833 signal.
4834
4835 @cindex handling signals
4836 Normally, @value{GDBN} is set up to let the non-erroneous signals like
4837 @code{SIGALRM} be silently passed to your program
4838 (so as not to interfere with their role in the program's functioning)
4839 but to stop your program immediately whenever an error signal happens.
4840 You can change these settings with the @code{handle} command.
4841
4842 @table @code
4843 @kindex info signals
4844 @kindex info handle
4845 @item info signals
4846 @itemx info handle
4847 Print a table of all the kinds of signals and how @value{GDBN} has been told to
4848 handle each one. You can use this to see the signal numbers of all
4849 the defined types of signals.
4850
4851 @item info signals @var{sig}
4852 Similar, but print information only about the specified signal number.
4853
4854 @code{info handle} is an alias for @code{info signals}.
4855
4856 @kindex handle
4857 @item handle @var{signal} @r{[}@var{keywords}@dots{}@r{]}
4858 Change the way @value{GDBN} handles signal @var{signal}. @var{signal}
4859 can be the number of a signal or its name (with or without the
4860 @samp{SIG} at the beginning); a list of signal numbers of the form
4861 @samp{@var{low}-@var{high}}; or the word @samp{all}, meaning all the
4862 known signals. Optional arguments @var{keywords}, described below,
4863 say what change to make.
4864 @end table
4865
4866 @c @group
4867 The keywords allowed by the @code{handle} command can be abbreviated.
4868 Their full names are:
4869
4870 @table @code
4871 @item nostop
4872 @value{GDBN} should not stop your program when this signal happens. It may
4873 still print a message telling you that the signal has come in.
4874
4875 @item stop
4876 @value{GDBN} should stop your program when this signal happens. This implies
4877 the @code{print} keyword as well.
4878
4879 @item print
4880 @value{GDBN} should print a message when this signal happens.
4881
4882 @item noprint
4883 @value{GDBN} should not mention the occurrence of the signal at all. This
4884 implies the @code{nostop} keyword as well.
4885
4886 @item pass
4887 @itemx noignore
4888 @value{GDBN} should allow your program to see this signal; your program
4889 can handle the signal, or else it may terminate if the signal is fatal
4890 and not handled. @code{pass} and @code{noignore} are synonyms.
4891
4892 @item nopass
4893 @itemx ignore
4894 @value{GDBN} should not allow your program to see this signal.
4895 @code{nopass} and @code{ignore} are synonyms.
4896 @end table
4897 @c @end group
4898
4899 When a signal stops your program, the signal is not visible to the
4900 program until you
4901 continue. Your program sees the signal then, if @code{pass} is in
4902 effect for the signal in question @emph{at that time}. In other words,
4903 after @value{GDBN} reports a signal, you can use the @code{handle}
4904 command with @code{pass} or @code{nopass} to control whether your
4905 program sees that signal when you continue.
4906
4907 The default is set to @code{nostop}, @code{noprint}, @code{pass} for
4908 non-erroneous signals such as @code{SIGALRM}, @code{SIGWINCH} and
4909 @code{SIGCHLD}, and to @code{stop}, @code{print}, @code{pass} for the
4910 erroneous signals.
4911
4912 You can also use the @code{signal} command to prevent your program from
4913 seeing a signal, or cause it to see a signal it normally would not see,
4914 or to give it any signal at any time. For example, if your program stopped
4915 due to some sort of memory reference error, you might store correct
4916 values into the erroneous variables and continue, hoping to see more
4917 execution; but your program would probably terminate immediately as
4918 a result of the fatal signal once it saw the signal. To prevent this,
4919 you can continue with @samp{signal 0}. @xref{Signaling, ,Giving your
4920 Program a Signal}.
4921
4922 @cindex extra signal information
4923 @anchor{extra signal information}
4924
4925 On some targets, @value{GDBN} can inspect extra signal information
4926 associated with the intercepted signal, before it is actually
4927 delivered to the program being debugged. This information is exported
4928 by the convenience variable @code{$_siginfo}, and consists of data
4929 that is passed by the kernel to the signal handler at the time of the
4930 receipt of a signal. The data type of the information itself is
4931 target dependent. You can see the data type using the @code{ptype
4932 $_siginfo} command. On Unix systems, it typically corresponds to the
4933 standard @code{siginfo_t} type, as defined in the @file{signal.h}
4934 system header.
4935
4936 Here's an example, on a @sc{gnu}/Linux system, printing the stray
4937 referenced address that raised a segmentation fault.
4938
4939 @smallexample
4940 @group
4941 (@value{GDBP}) continue
4942 Program received signal SIGSEGV, Segmentation fault.
4943 0x0000000000400766 in main ()
4944 69 *(int *)p = 0;
4945 (@value{GDBP}) ptype $_siginfo
4946 type = struct @{
4947 int si_signo;
4948 int si_errno;
4949 int si_code;
4950 union @{
4951 int _pad[28];
4952 struct @{...@} _kill;
4953 struct @{...@} _timer;
4954 struct @{...@} _rt;
4955 struct @{...@} _sigchld;
4956 struct @{...@} _sigfault;
4957 struct @{...@} _sigpoll;
4958 @} _sifields;
4959 @}
4960 (@value{GDBP}) ptype $_siginfo._sifields._sigfault
4961 type = struct @{
4962 void *si_addr;
4963 @}
4964 (@value{GDBP}) p $_siginfo._sifields._sigfault.si_addr
4965 $1 = (void *) 0x7ffff7ff7000
4966 @end group
4967 @end smallexample
4968
4969 Depending on target support, @code{$_siginfo} may also be writable.
4970
4971 @node Thread Stops
4972 @section Stopping and Starting Multi-thread Programs
4973
4974 @cindex stopped threads
4975 @cindex threads, stopped
4976
4977 @cindex continuing threads
4978 @cindex threads, continuing
4979
4980 @value{GDBN} supports debugging programs with multiple threads
4981 (@pxref{Threads,, Debugging Programs with Multiple Threads}). There
4982 are two modes of controlling execution of your program within the
4983 debugger. In the default mode, referred to as @dfn{all-stop mode},
4984 when any thread in your program stops (for example, at a breakpoint
4985 or while being stepped), all other threads in the program are also stopped by
4986 @value{GDBN}. On some targets, @value{GDBN} also supports
4987 @dfn{non-stop mode}, in which other threads can continue to run freely while
4988 you examine the stopped thread in the debugger.
4989
4990 @menu
4991 * All-Stop Mode:: All threads stop when GDB takes control
4992 * Non-Stop Mode:: Other threads continue to execute
4993 * Background Execution:: Running your program asynchronously
4994 * Thread-Specific Breakpoints:: Controlling breakpoints
4995 * Interrupted System Calls:: GDB may interfere with system calls
4996 * Observer Mode:: GDB does not alter program behavior
4997 @end menu
4998
4999 @node All-Stop Mode
5000 @subsection All-Stop Mode
5001
5002 @cindex all-stop mode
5003
5004 In all-stop mode, whenever your program stops under @value{GDBN} for any reason,
5005 @emph{all} threads of execution stop, not just the current thread. This
5006 allows you to examine the overall state of the program, including
5007 switching between threads, without worrying that things may change
5008 underfoot.
5009
5010 Conversely, whenever you restart the program, @emph{all} threads start
5011 executing. @emph{This is true even when single-stepping} with commands
5012 like @code{step} or @code{next}.
5013
5014 In particular, @value{GDBN} cannot single-step all threads in lockstep.
5015 Since thread scheduling is up to your debugging target's operating
5016 system (not controlled by @value{GDBN}), other threads may
5017 execute more than one statement while the current thread completes a
5018 single step. Moreover, in general other threads stop in the middle of a
5019 statement, rather than at a clean statement boundary, when the program
5020 stops.
5021
5022 You might even find your program stopped in another thread after
5023 continuing or even single-stepping. This happens whenever some other
5024 thread runs into a breakpoint, a signal, or an exception before the
5025 first thread completes whatever you requested.
5026
5027 @cindex automatic thread selection
5028 @cindex switching threads automatically
5029 @cindex threads, automatic switching
5030 Whenever @value{GDBN} stops your program, due to a breakpoint or a
5031 signal, it automatically selects the thread where that breakpoint or
5032 signal happened. @value{GDBN} alerts you to the context switch with a
5033 message such as @samp{[Switching to Thread @var{n}]} to identify the
5034 thread.
5035
5036 On some OSes, you can modify @value{GDBN}'s default behavior by
5037 locking the OS scheduler to allow only a single thread to run.
5038
5039 @table @code
5040 @item set scheduler-locking @var{mode}
5041 @cindex scheduler locking mode
5042 @cindex lock scheduler
5043 Set the scheduler locking mode. If it is @code{off}, then there is no
5044 locking and any thread may run at any time. If @code{on}, then only the
5045 current thread may run when the inferior is resumed. The @code{step}
5046 mode optimizes for single-stepping; it prevents other threads
5047 from preempting the current thread while you are stepping, so that
5048 the focus of debugging does not change unexpectedly.
5049 Other threads only rarely (or never) get a chance to run
5050 when you step. They are more likely to run when you @samp{next} over a
5051 function call, and they are completely free to run when you use commands
5052 like @samp{continue}, @samp{until}, or @samp{finish}. However, unless another
5053 thread hits a breakpoint during its timeslice, @value{GDBN} does not change
5054 the current thread away from the thread that you are debugging.
5055
5056 @item show scheduler-locking
5057 Display the current scheduler locking mode.
5058 @end table
5059
5060 @cindex resume threads of multiple processes simultaneously
5061 By default, when you issue one of the execution commands such as
5062 @code{continue}, @code{next} or @code{step}, @value{GDBN} allows only
5063 threads of the current inferior to run. For example, if @value{GDBN}
5064 is attached to two inferiors, each with two threads, the
5065 @code{continue} command resumes only the two threads of the current
5066 inferior. This is useful, for example, when you debug a program that
5067 forks and you want to hold the parent stopped (so that, for instance,
5068 it doesn't run to exit), while you debug the child. In other
5069 situations, you may not be interested in inspecting the current state
5070 of any of the processes @value{GDBN} is attached to, and you may want
5071 to resume them all until some breakpoint is hit. In the latter case,
5072 you can instruct @value{GDBN} to allow all threads of all the
5073 inferiors to run with the @w{@code{set schedule-multiple}} command.
5074
5075 @table @code
5076 @kindex set schedule-multiple
5077 @item set schedule-multiple
5078 Set the mode for allowing threads of multiple processes to be resumed
5079 when an execution command is issued. When @code{on}, all threads of
5080 all processes are allowed to run. When @code{off}, only the threads
5081 of the current process are resumed. The default is @code{off}. The
5082 @code{scheduler-locking} mode takes precedence when set to @code{on},
5083 or while you are stepping and set to @code{step}.
5084
5085 @item show schedule-multiple
5086 Display the current mode for resuming the execution of threads of
5087 multiple processes.
5088 @end table
5089
5090 @node Non-Stop Mode
5091 @subsection Non-Stop Mode
5092
5093 @cindex non-stop mode
5094
5095 @c This section is really only a place-holder, and needs to be expanded
5096 @c with more details.
5097
5098 For some multi-threaded targets, @value{GDBN} supports an optional
5099 mode of operation in which you can examine stopped program threads in
5100 the debugger while other threads continue to execute freely. This
5101 minimizes intrusion when debugging live systems, such as programs
5102 where some threads have real-time constraints or must continue to
5103 respond to external events. This is referred to as @dfn{non-stop} mode.
5104
5105 In non-stop mode, when a thread stops to report a debugging event,
5106 @emph{only} that thread is stopped; @value{GDBN} does not stop other
5107 threads as well, in contrast to the all-stop mode behavior. Additionally,
5108 execution commands such as @code{continue} and @code{step} apply by default
5109 only to the current thread in non-stop mode, rather than all threads as
5110 in all-stop mode. This allows you to control threads explicitly in
5111 ways that are not possible in all-stop mode --- for example, stepping
5112 one thread while allowing others to run freely, stepping
5113 one thread while holding all others stopped, or stepping several threads
5114 independently and simultaneously.
5115
5116 To enter non-stop mode, use this sequence of commands before you run
5117 or attach to your program:
5118
5119 @smallexample
5120 # Enable the async interface.
5121 set target-async 1
5122
5123 # If using the CLI, pagination breaks non-stop.
5124 set pagination off
5125
5126 # Finally, turn it on!
5127 set non-stop on
5128 @end smallexample
5129
5130 You can use these commands to manipulate the non-stop mode setting:
5131
5132 @table @code
5133 @kindex set non-stop
5134 @item set non-stop on
5135 Enable selection of non-stop mode.
5136 @item set non-stop off
5137 Disable selection of non-stop mode.
5138 @kindex show non-stop
5139 @item show non-stop
5140 Show the current non-stop enablement setting.
5141 @end table
5142
5143 Note these commands only reflect whether non-stop mode is enabled,
5144 not whether the currently-executing program is being run in non-stop mode.
5145 In particular, the @code{set non-stop} preference is only consulted when
5146 @value{GDBN} starts or connects to the target program, and it is generally
5147 not possible to switch modes once debugging has started. Furthermore,
5148 since not all targets support non-stop mode, even when you have enabled
5149 non-stop mode, @value{GDBN} may still fall back to all-stop operation by
5150 default.
5151
5152 In non-stop mode, all execution commands apply only to the current thread
5153 by default. That is, @code{continue} only continues one thread.
5154 To continue all threads, issue @code{continue -a} or @code{c -a}.
5155
5156 You can use @value{GDBN}'s background execution commands
5157 (@pxref{Background Execution}) to run some threads in the background
5158 while you continue to examine or step others from @value{GDBN}.
5159 The MI execution commands (@pxref{GDB/MI Program Execution}) are
5160 always executed asynchronously in non-stop mode.
5161
5162 Suspending execution is done with the @code{interrupt} command when
5163 running in the background, or @kbd{Ctrl-c} during foreground execution.
5164 In all-stop mode, this stops the whole process;
5165 but in non-stop mode the interrupt applies only to the current thread.
5166 To stop the whole program, use @code{interrupt -a}.
5167
5168 Other execution commands do not currently support the @code{-a} option.
5169
5170 In non-stop mode, when a thread stops, @value{GDBN} doesn't automatically make
5171 that thread current, as it does in all-stop mode. This is because the
5172 thread stop notifications are asynchronous with respect to @value{GDBN}'s
5173 command interpreter, and it would be confusing if @value{GDBN} unexpectedly
5174 changed to a different thread just as you entered a command to operate on the
5175 previously current thread.
5176
5177 @node Background Execution
5178 @subsection Background Execution
5179
5180 @cindex foreground execution
5181 @cindex background execution
5182 @cindex asynchronous execution
5183 @cindex execution, foreground, background and asynchronous
5184
5185 @value{GDBN}'s execution commands have two variants: the normal
5186 foreground (synchronous) behavior, and a background
5187 (asynchronous) behavior. In foreground execution, @value{GDBN} waits for
5188 the program to report that some thread has stopped before prompting for
5189 another command. In background execution, @value{GDBN} immediately gives
5190 a command prompt so that you can issue other commands while your program runs.
5191
5192 You need to explicitly enable asynchronous mode before you can use
5193 background execution commands. You can use these commands to
5194 manipulate the asynchronous mode setting:
5195
5196 @table @code
5197 @kindex set target-async
5198 @item set target-async on
5199 Enable asynchronous mode.
5200 @item set target-async off
5201 Disable asynchronous mode.
5202 @kindex show target-async
5203 @item show target-async
5204 Show the current target-async setting.
5205 @end table
5206
5207 If the target doesn't support async mode, @value{GDBN} issues an error
5208 message if you attempt to use the background execution commands.
5209
5210 To specify background execution, add a @code{&} to the command. For example,
5211 the background form of the @code{continue} command is @code{continue&}, or
5212 just @code{c&}. The execution commands that accept background execution
5213 are:
5214
5215 @table @code
5216 @kindex run&
5217 @item run
5218 @xref{Starting, , Starting your Program}.
5219
5220 @item attach
5221 @kindex attach&
5222 @xref{Attach, , Debugging an Already-running Process}.
5223
5224 @item step
5225 @kindex step&
5226 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, step}.
5227
5228 @item stepi
5229 @kindex stepi&
5230 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, stepi}.
5231
5232 @item next
5233 @kindex next&
5234 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, next}.
5235
5236 @item nexti
5237 @kindex nexti&
5238 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, nexti}.
5239
5240 @item continue
5241 @kindex continue&
5242 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, continue}.
5243
5244 @item finish
5245 @kindex finish&
5246 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, finish}.
5247
5248 @item until
5249 @kindex until&
5250 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, until}.
5251
5252 @end table
5253
5254 Background execution is especially useful in conjunction with non-stop
5255 mode for debugging programs with multiple threads; see @ref{Non-Stop Mode}.
5256 However, you can also use these commands in the normal all-stop mode with
5257 the restriction that you cannot issue another execution command until the
5258 previous one finishes. Examples of commands that are valid in all-stop
5259 mode while the program is running include @code{help} and @code{info break}.
5260
5261 You can interrupt your program while it is running in the background by
5262 using the @code{interrupt} command.
5263
5264 @table @code
5265 @kindex interrupt
5266 @item interrupt
5267 @itemx interrupt -a
5268
5269 Suspend execution of the running program. In all-stop mode,
5270 @code{interrupt} stops the whole process, but in non-stop mode, it stops
5271 only the current thread. To stop the whole program in non-stop mode,
5272 use @code{interrupt -a}.
5273 @end table
5274
5275 @node Thread-Specific Breakpoints
5276 @subsection Thread-Specific Breakpoints
5277
5278 When your program has multiple threads (@pxref{Threads,, Debugging
5279 Programs with Multiple Threads}), you can choose whether to set
5280 breakpoints on all threads, or on a particular thread.
5281
5282 @table @code
5283 @cindex breakpoints and threads
5284 @cindex thread breakpoints
5285 @kindex break @dots{} thread @var{threadno}
5286 @item break @var{linespec} thread @var{threadno}
5287 @itemx break @var{linespec} thread @var{threadno} if @dots{}
5288 @var{linespec} specifies source lines; there are several ways of
5289 writing them (@pxref{Specify Location}), but the effect is always to
5290 specify some source line.
5291
5292 Use the qualifier @samp{thread @var{threadno}} with a breakpoint command
5293 to specify that you only want @value{GDBN} to stop the program when a
5294 particular thread reaches this breakpoint. @var{threadno} is one of the
5295 numeric thread identifiers assigned by @value{GDBN}, shown in the first
5296 column of the @samp{info threads} display.
5297
5298 If you do not specify @samp{thread @var{threadno}} when you set a
5299 breakpoint, the breakpoint applies to @emph{all} threads of your
5300 program.
5301
5302 You can use the @code{thread} qualifier on conditional breakpoints as
5303 well; in this case, place @samp{thread @var{threadno}} before or
5304 after the breakpoint condition, like this:
5305
5306 @smallexample
5307 (@value{GDBP}) break frik.c:13 thread 28 if bartab > lim
5308 @end smallexample
5309
5310 @end table
5311
5312 @node Interrupted System Calls
5313 @subsection Interrupted System Calls
5314
5315 @cindex thread breakpoints and system calls
5316 @cindex system calls and thread breakpoints
5317 @cindex premature return from system calls
5318 There is an unfortunate side effect when using @value{GDBN} to debug
5319 multi-threaded programs. If one thread stops for a
5320 breakpoint, or for some other reason, and another thread is blocked in a
5321 system call, then the system call may return prematurely. This is a
5322 consequence of the interaction between multiple threads and the signals
5323 that @value{GDBN} uses to implement breakpoints and other events that
5324 stop execution.
5325
5326 To handle this problem, your program should check the return value of
5327 each system call and react appropriately. This is good programming
5328 style anyways.
5329
5330 For example, do not write code like this:
5331
5332 @smallexample
5333 sleep (10);
5334 @end smallexample
5335
5336 The call to @code{sleep} will return early if a different thread stops
5337 at a breakpoint or for some other reason.
5338
5339 Instead, write this:
5340
5341 @smallexample
5342 int unslept = 10;
5343 while (unslept > 0)
5344 unslept = sleep (unslept);
5345 @end smallexample
5346
5347 A system call is allowed to return early, so the system is still
5348 conforming to its specification. But @value{GDBN} does cause your
5349 multi-threaded program to behave differently than it would without
5350 @value{GDBN}.
5351
5352 Also, @value{GDBN} uses internal breakpoints in the thread library to
5353 monitor certain events such as thread creation and thread destruction.
5354 When such an event happens, a system call in another thread may return
5355 prematurely, even though your program does not appear to stop.
5356
5357 @node Observer Mode
5358 @subsection Observer Mode
5359
5360 If you want to build on non-stop mode and observe program behavior
5361 without any chance of disruption by @value{GDBN}, you can set
5362 variables to disable all of the debugger's attempts to modify state,
5363 whether by writing memory, inserting breakpoints, etc. These operate
5364 at a low level, intercepting operations from all commands.
5365
5366 When all of these are set to @code{off}, then @value{GDBN} is said to
5367 be @dfn{observer mode}. As a convenience, the variable
5368 @code{observer} can be set to disable these, plus enable non-stop
5369 mode.
5370
5371 Note that @value{GDBN} will not prevent you from making nonsensical
5372 combinations of these settings. For instance, if you have enabled
5373 @code{may-insert-breakpoints} but disabled @code{may-write-memory},
5374 then breakpoints that work by writing trap instructions into the code
5375 stream will still not be able to be placed.
5376
5377 @table @code
5378
5379 @kindex observer
5380 @item set observer on
5381 @itemx set observer off
5382 When set to @code{on}, this disables all the permission variables
5383 below (except for @code{insert-fast-tracepoints}), plus enables
5384 non-stop debugging. Setting this to @code{off} switches back to
5385 normal debugging, though remaining in non-stop mode.
5386
5387 @item show observer
5388 Show whether observer mode is on or off.
5389
5390 @kindex may-write-registers
5391 @item set may-write-registers on
5392 @itemx set may-write-registers off
5393 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to alter the values of
5394 registers, such as with assignment expressions in @code{print}, or the
5395 @code{jump} command. It defaults to @code{on}.
5396
5397 @item show may-write-registers
5398 Show the current permission to write registers.
5399
5400 @kindex may-write-memory
5401 @item set may-write-memory on
5402 @itemx set may-write-memory off
5403 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to alter the contents
5404 of memory, such as with assignment expressions in @code{print}. It
5405 defaults to @code{on}.
5406
5407 @item show may-write-memory
5408 Show the current permission to write memory.
5409
5410 @kindex may-insert-breakpoints
5411 @item set may-insert-breakpoints on
5412 @itemx set may-insert-breakpoints off
5413 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to insert breakpoints.
5414 This affects all breakpoints, including internal breakpoints defined
5415 by @value{GDBN}. It defaults to @code{on}.
5416
5417 @item show may-insert-breakpoints
5418 Show the current permission to insert breakpoints.
5419
5420 @kindex may-insert-tracepoints
5421 @item set may-insert-tracepoints on
5422 @itemx set may-insert-tracepoints off
5423 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to insert (regular)
5424 tracepoints at the beginning of a tracing experiment. It affects only
5425 non-fast tracepoints, fast tracepoints being under the control of
5426 @code{may-insert-fast-tracepoints}. It defaults to @code{on}.
5427
5428 @item show may-insert-tracepoints
5429 Show the current permission to insert tracepoints.
5430
5431 @kindex may-insert-fast-tracepoints
5432 @item set may-insert-fast-tracepoints on
5433 @itemx set may-insert-fast-tracepoints off
5434 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to insert fast
5435 tracepoints at the beginning of a tracing experiment. It affects only
5436 fast tracepoints, regular (non-fast) tracepoints being under the
5437 control of @code{may-insert-tracepoints}. It defaults to @code{on}.
5438
5439 @item show may-insert-fast-tracepoints
5440 Show the current permission to insert fast tracepoints.
5441
5442 @kindex may-interrupt
5443 @item set may-interrupt on
5444 @itemx set may-interrupt off
5445 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to interrupt or stop
5446 program execution. When this variable is @code{off}, the
5447 @code{interrupt} command will have no effect, nor will
5448 @kbd{Ctrl-c}. It defaults to @code{on}.
5449
5450 @item show may-interrupt
5451 Show the current permission to interrupt or stop the program.
5452
5453 @end table
5454
5455 @node Reverse Execution
5456 @chapter Running programs backward
5457 @cindex reverse execution
5458 @cindex running programs backward
5459
5460 When you are debugging a program, it is not unusual to realize that
5461 you have gone too far, and some event of interest has already happened.
5462 If the target environment supports it, @value{GDBN} can allow you to
5463 ``rewind'' the program by running it backward.
5464
5465 A target environment that supports reverse execution should be able
5466 to ``undo'' the changes in machine state that have taken place as the
5467 program was executing normally. Variables, registers etc.@: should
5468 revert to their previous values. Obviously this requires a great
5469 deal of sophistication on the part of the target environment; not
5470 all target environments can support reverse execution.
5471
5472 When a program is executed in reverse, the instructions that
5473 have most recently been executed are ``un-executed'', in reverse
5474 order. The program counter runs backward, following the previous
5475 thread of execution in reverse. As each instruction is ``un-executed'',
5476 the values of memory and/or registers that were changed by that
5477 instruction are reverted to their previous states. After executing
5478 a piece of source code in reverse, all side effects of that code
5479 should be ``undone'', and all variables should be returned to their
5480 prior values@footnote{
5481 Note that some side effects are easier to undo than others. For instance,
5482 memory and registers are relatively easy, but device I/O is hard. Some
5483 targets may be able undo things like device I/O, and some may not.
5484
5485 The contract between @value{GDBN} and the reverse executing target
5486 requires only that the target do something reasonable when
5487 @value{GDBN} tells it to execute backwards, and then report the
5488 results back to @value{GDBN}. Whatever the target reports back to
5489 @value{GDBN}, @value{GDBN} will report back to the user. @value{GDBN}
5490 assumes that the memory and registers that the target reports are in a
5491 consistant state, but @value{GDBN} accepts whatever it is given.
5492 }.
5493
5494 If you are debugging in a target environment that supports
5495 reverse execution, @value{GDBN} provides the following commands.
5496
5497 @table @code
5498 @kindex reverse-continue
5499 @kindex rc @r{(@code{reverse-continue})}
5500 @item reverse-continue @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
5501 @itemx rc @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
5502 Beginning at the point where your program last stopped, start executing
5503 in reverse. Reverse execution will stop for breakpoints and synchronous
5504 exceptions (signals), just like normal execution. Behavior of
5505 asynchronous signals depends on the target environment.
5506
5507 @kindex reverse-step
5508 @kindex rs @r{(@code{step})}
5509 @item reverse-step @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
5510 Run the program backward until control reaches the start of a
5511 different source line; then stop it, and return control to @value{GDBN}.
5512
5513 Like the @code{step} command, @code{reverse-step} will only stop
5514 at the beginning of a source line. It ``un-executes'' the previously
5515 executed source line. If the previous source line included calls to
5516 debuggable functions, @code{reverse-step} will step (backward) into
5517 the called function, stopping at the beginning of the @emph{last}
5518 statement in the called function (typically a return statement).
5519
5520 Also, as with the @code{step} command, if non-debuggable functions are
5521 called, @code{reverse-step} will run thru them backward without stopping.
5522
5523 @kindex reverse-stepi
5524 @kindex rsi @r{(@code{reverse-stepi})}
5525 @item reverse-stepi @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
5526 Reverse-execute one machine instruction. Note that the instruction
5527 to be reverse-executed is @emph{not} the one pointed to by the program
5528 counter, but the instruction executed prior to that one. For instance,
5529 if the last instruction was a jump, @code{reverse-stepi} will take you
5530 back from the destination of the jump to the jump instruction itself.
5531
5532 @kindex reverse-next
5533 @kindex rn @r{(@code{reverse-next})}
5534 @item reverse-next @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
5535 Run backward to the beginning of the previous line executed in
5536 the current (innermost) stack frame. If the line contains function
5537 calls, they will be ``un-executed'' without stopping. Starting from
5538 the first line of a function, @code{reverse-next} will take you back
5539 to the caller of that function, @emph{before} the function was called,
5540 just as the normal @code{next} command would take you from the last
5541 line of a function back to its return to its caller
5542 @footnote{Unless the code is too heavily optimized.}.
5543
5544 @kindex reverse-nexti
5545 @kindex rni @r{(@code{reverse-nexti})}
5546 @item reverse-nexti @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
5547 Like @code{nexti}, @code{reverse-nexti} executes a single instruction
5548 in reverse, except that called functions are ``un-executed'' atomically.
5549 That is, if the previously executed instruction was a return from
5550 another function, @code{reverse-nexti} will continue to execute
5551 in reverse until the call to that function (from the current stack
5552 frame) is reached.
5553
5554 @kindex reverse-finish
5555 @item reverse-finish
5556 Just as the @code{finish} command takes you to the point where the
5557 current function returns, @code{reverse-finish} takes you to the point
5558 where it was called. Instead of ending up at the end of the current
5559 function invocation, you end up at the beginning.
5560
5561 @kindex set exec-direction
5562 @item set exec-direction
5563 Set the direction of target execution.
5564 @itemx set exec-direction reverse
5565 @cindex execute forward or backward in time
5566 @value{GDBN} will perform all execution commands in reverse, until the
5567 exec-direction mode is changed to ``forward''. Affected commands include
5568 @code{step, stepi, next, nexti, continue, and finish}. The @code{return}
5569 command cannot be used in reverse mode.
5570 @item set exec-direction forward
5571 @value{GDBN} will perform all execution commands in the normal fashion.
5572 This is the default.
5573 @end table
5574
5575
5576 @node Process Record and Replay
5577 @chapter Recording Inferior's Execution and Replaying It
5578 @cindex process record and replay
5579 @cindex recording inferior's execution and replaying it
5580
5581 On some platforms, @value{GDBN} provides a special @dfn{process record
5582 and replay} target that can record a log of the process execution, and
5583 replay it later with both forward and reverse execution commands.
5584
5585 @cindex replay mode
5586 When this target is in use, if the execution log includes the record
5587 for the next instruction, @value{GDBN} will debug in @dfn{replay
5588 mode}. In the replay mode, the inferior does not really execute code
5589 instructions. Instead, all the events that normally happen during
5590 code execution are taken from the execution log. While code is not
5591 really executed in replay mode, the values of registers (including the
5592 program counter register) and the memory of the inferior are still
5593 changed as they normally would. Their contents are taken from the
5594 execution log.
5595
5596 @cindex record mode
5597 If the record for the next instruction is not in the execution log,
5598 @value{GDBN} will debug in @dfn{record mode}. In this mode, the
5599 inferior executes normally, and @value{GDBN} records the execution log
5600 for future replay.
5601
5602 The process record and replay target supports reverse execution
5603 (@pxref{Reverse Execution}), even if the platform on which the
5604 inferior runs does not. However, the reverse execution is limited in
5605 this case by the range of the instructions recorded in the execution
5606 log. In other words, reverse execution on platforms that don't
5607 support it directly can only be done in the replay mode.
5608
5609 When debugging in the reverse direction, @value{GDBN} will work in
5610 replay mode as long as the execution log includes the record for the
5611 previous instruction; otherwise, it will work in record mode, if the
5612 platform supports reverse execution, or stop if not.
5613
5614 For architecture environments that support process record and replay,
5615 @value{GDBN} provides the following commands:
5616
5617 @table @code
5618 @kindex target record
5619 @kindex record
5620 @kindex rec
5621 @item target record
5622 This command starts the process record and replay target. The process
5623 record and replay target can only debug a process that is already
5624 running. Therefore, you need first to start the process with the
5625 @kbd{run} or @kbd{start} commands, and then start the recording with
5626 the @kbd{target record} command.
5627
5628 Both @code{record} and @code{rec} are aliases of @code{target record}.
5629
5630 @cindex displaced stepping, and process record and replay
5631 Displaced stepping (@pxref{Maintenance Commands,, displaced stepping})
5632 will be automatically disabled when process record and replay target
5633 is started. That's because the process record and replay target
5634 doesn't support displaced stepping.
5635
5636 @cindex non-stop mode, and process record and replay
5637 @cindex asynchronous execution, and process record and replay
5638 If the inferior is in the non-stop mode (@pxref{Non-Stop Mode}) or in
5639 the asynchronous execution mode (@pxref{Background Execution}), the
5640 process record and replay target cannot be started because it doesn't
5641 support these two modes.
5642
5643 @kindex record stop
5644 @kindex rec s
5645 @item record stop
5646 Stop the process record and replay target. When process record and
5647 replay target stops, the entire execution log will be deleted and the
5648 inferior will either be terminated, or will remain in its final state.
5649
5650 When you stop the process record and replay target in record mode (at
5651 the end of the execution log), the inferior will be stopped at the
5652 next instruction that would have been recorded. In other words, if
5653 you record for a while and then stop recording, the inferior process
5654 will be left in the same state as if the recording never happened.
5655
5656 On the other hand, if the process record and replay target is stopped
5657 while in replay mode (that is, not at the end of the execution log,
5658 but at some earlier point), the inferior process will become ``live''
5659 at that earlier state, and it will then be possible to continue the
5660 usual ``live'' debugging of the process from that state.
5661
5662 When the inferior process exits, or @value{GDBN} detaches from it,
5663 process record and replay target will automatically stop itself.
5664
5665 @kindex record save
5666 @item record save @var{filename}
5667 Save the execution log to a file @file{@var{filename}}.
5668 Default filename is @file{gdb_record.@var{process_id}}, where
5669 @var{process_id} is the process ID of the inferior.
5670
5671 @kindex record restore
5672 @item record restore @var{filename}
5673 Restore the execution log from a file @file{@var{filename}}.
5674 File must have been created with @code{record save}.
5675
5676 @kindex set record insn-number-max
5677 @item set record insn-number-max @var{limit}
5678 Set the limit of instructions to be recorded. Default value is 200000.
5679
5680 If @var{limit} is a positive number, then @value{GDBN} will start
5681 deleting instructions from the log once the number of the record
5682 instructions becomes greater than @var{limit}. For every new recorded
5683 instruction, @value{GDBN} will delete the earliest recorded
5684 instruction to keep the number of recorded instructions at the limit.
5685 (Since deleting recorded instructions loses information, @value{GDBN}
5686 lets you control what happens when the limit is reached, by means of
5687 the @code{stop-at-limit} option, described below.)
5688
5689 If @var{limit} is zero, @value{GDBN} will never delete recorded
5690 instructions from the execution log. The number of recorded
5691 instructions is unlimited in this case.
5692
5693 @kindex show record insn-number-max
5694 @item show record insn-number-max
5695 Show the limit of instructions to be recorded.
5696
5697 @kindex set record stop-at-limit
5698 @item set record stop-at-limit
5699 Control the behavior when the number of recorded instructions reaches
5700 the limit. If ON (the default), @value{GDBN} will stop when the limit
5701 is reached for the first time and ask you whether you want to stop the
5702 inferior or continue running it and recording the execution log. If
5703 you decide to continue recording, each new recorded instruction will
5704 cause the oldest one to be deleted.
5705
5706 If this option is OFF, @value{GDBN} will automatically delete the
5707 oldest record to make room for each new one, without asking.
5708
5709 @kindex show record stop-at-limit
5710 @item show record stop-at-limit
5711 Show the current setting of @code{stop-at-limit}.
5712
5713 @kindex set record memory-query
5714 @item set record memory-query
5715 Control the behavior when @value{GDBN} is unable to record memory
5716 changes caused by an instruction. If ON, @value{GDBN} will query
5717 whether to stop the inferior in that case.
5718
5719 If this option is OFF (the default), @value{GDBN} will automatically
5720 ignore the effect of such instructions on memory. Later, when
5721 @value{GDBN} replays this execution log, it will mark the log of this
5722 instruction as not accessible, and it will not affect the replay
5723 results.
5724
5725 @kindex show record memory-query
5726 @item show record memory-query
5727 Show the current setting of @code{memory-query}.
5728
5729 @kindex info record
5730 @item info record
5731 Show various statistics about the state of process record and its
5732 in-memory execution log buffer, including:
5733
5734 @itemize @bullet
5735 @item
5736 Whether in record mode or replay mode.
5737 @item
5738 Lowest recorded instruction number (counting from when the current execution log started recording instructions).
5739 @item
5740 Highest recorded instruction number.
5741 @item
5742 Current instruction about to be replayed (if in replay mode).
5743 @item
5744 Number of instructions contained in the execution log.
5745 @item
5746 Maximum number of instructions that may be contained in the execution log.
5747 @end itemize
5748
5749 @kindex record delete
5750 @kindex rec del
5751 @item record delete
5752 When record target runs in replay mode (``in the past''), delete the
5753 subsequent execution log and begin to record a new execution log starting
5754 from the current address. This means you will abandon the previously
5755 recorded ``future'' and begin recording a new ``future''.
5756 @end table
5757
5758
5759 @node Stack
5760 @chapter Examining the Stack
5761
5762 When your program has stopped, the first thing you need to know is where it
5763 stopped and how it got there.
5764
5765 @cindex call stack
5766 Each time your program performs a function call, information about the call
5767 is generated.
5768 That information includes the location of the call in your program,
5769 the arguments of the call,
5770 and the local variables of the function being called.
5771 The information is saved in a block of data called a @dfn{stack frame}.
5772 The stack frames are allocated in a region of memory called the @dfn{call
5773 stack}.
5774
5775 When your program stops, the @value{GDBN} commands for examining the
5776 stack allow you to see all of this information.
5777
5778 @cindex selected frame
5779 One of the stack frames is @dfn{selected} by @value{GDBN} and many
5780 @value{GDBN} commands refer implicitly to the selected frame. In
5781 particular, whenever you ask @value{GDBN} for the value of a variable in
5782 your program, the value is found in the selected frame. There are
5783 special @value{GDBN} commands to select whichever frame you are
5784 interested in. @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}.
5785
5786 When your program stops, @value{GDBN} automatically selects the
5787 currently executing frame and describes it briefly, similar to the
5788 @code{frame} command (@pxref{Frame Info, ,Information about a Frame}).
5789
5790 @menu
5791 * Frames:: Stack frames
5792 * Backtrace:: Backtraces
5793 * Selection:: Selecting a frame
5794 * Frame Info:: Information on a frame
5795
5796 @end menu
5797
5798 @node Frames
5799 @section Stack Frames
5800
5801 @cindex frame, definition
5802 @cindex stack frame
5803 The call stack is divided up into contiguous pieces called @dfn{stack
5804 frames}, or @dfn{frames} for short; each frame is the data associated
5805 with one call to one function. The frame contains the arguments given
5806 to the function, the function's local variables, and the address at
5807 which the function is executing.
5808
5809 @cindex initial frame
5810 @cindex outermost frame
5811 @cindex innermost frame
5812 When your program is started, the stack has only one frame, that of the
5813 function @code{main}. This is called the @dfn{initial} frame or the
5814 @dfn{outermost} frame. Each time a function is called, a new frame is
5815 made. Each time a function returns, the frame for that function invocation
5816 is eliminated. If a function is recursive, there can be many frames for
5817 the same function. The frame for the function in which execution is
5818 actually occurring is called the @dfn{innermost} frame. This is the most
5819 recently created of all the stack frames that still exist.
5820
5821 @cindex frame pointer
5822 Inside your program, stack frames are identified by their addresses. A
5823 stack frame consists of many bytes, each of which has its own address; each
5824 kind of computer has a convention for choosing one byte whose
5825 address serves as the address of the frame. Usually this address is kept
5826 in a register called the @dfn{frame pointer register}
5827 (@pxref{Registers, $fp}) while execution is going on in that frame.
5828
5829 @cindex frame number
5830 @value{GDBN} assigns numbers to all existing stack frames, starting with
5831 zero for the innermost frame, one for the frame that called it,
5832 and so on upward. These numbers do not really exist in your program;
5833 they are assigned by @value{GDBN} to give you a way of designating stack
5834 frames in @value{GDBN} commands.
5835
5836 @c The -fomit-frame-pointer below perennially causes hbox overflow
5837 @c underflow problems.
5838 @cindex frameless execution
5839 Some compilers provide a way to compile functions so that they operate
5840 without stack frames. (For example, the @value{NGCC} option
5841 @smallexample
5842 @samp{-fomit-frame-pointer}
5843 @end smallexample
5844 generates functions without a frame.)
5845 This is occasionally done with heavily used library functions to save
5846 the frame setup time. @value{GDBN} has limited facilities for dealing
5847 with these function invocations. If the innermost function invocation
5848 has no stack frame, @value{GDBN} nevertheless regards it as though
5849 it had a separate frame, which is numbered zero as usual, allowing
5850 correct tracing of the function call chain. However, @value{GDBN} has
5851 no provision for frameless functions elsewhere in the stack.
5852
5853 @table @code
5854 @kindex frame@r{, command}
5855 @cindex current stack frame
5856 @item frame @var{args}
5857 The @code{frame} command allows you to move from one stack frame to another,
5858 and to print the stack frame you select. @var{args} may be either the
5859 address of the frame or the stack frame number. Without an argument,
5860 @code{frame} prints the current stack frame.
5861
5862 @kindex select-frame
5863 @cindex selecting frame silently
5864 @item select-frame
5865 The @code{select-frame} command allows you to move from one stack frame
5866 to another without printing the frame. This is the silent version of
5867 @code{frame}.
5868 @end table
5869
5870 @node Backtrace
5871 @section Backtraces
5872
5873 @cindex traceback
5874 @cindex call stack traces
5875 A backtrace is a summary of how your program got where it is. It shows one
5876 line per frame, for many frames, starting with the currently executing
5877 frame (frame zero), followed by its caller (frame one), and on up the
5878 stack.
5879
5880 @table @code
5881 @kindex backtrace
5882 @kindex bt @r{(@code{backtrace})}
5883 @item backtrace
5884 @itemx bt
5885 Print a backtrace of the entire stack: one line per frame for all
5886 frames in the stack.
5887
5888 You can stop the backtrace at any time by typing the system interrupt
5889 character, normally @kbd{Ctrl-c}.
5890
5891 @item backtrace @var{n}
5892 @itemx bt @var{n}
5893 Similar, but print only the innermost @var{n} frames.
5894
5895 @item backtrace -@var{n}
5896 @itemx bt -@var{n}
5897 Similar, but print only the outermost @var{n} frames.
5898
5899 @item backtrace full
5900 @itemx bt full
5901 @itemx bt full @var{n}
5902 @itemx bt full -@var{n}
5903 Print the values of the local variables also. @var{n} specifies the
5904 number of frames to print, as described above.
5905 @end table
5906
5907 @kindex where
5908 @kindex info stack
5909 The names @code{where} and @code{info stack} (abbreviated @code{info s})
5910 are additional aliases for @code{backtrace}.
5911
5912 @cindex multiple threads, backtrace
5913 In a multi-threaded program, @value{GDBN} by default shows the
5914 backtrace only for the current thread. To display the backtrace for
5915 several or all of the threads, use the command @code{thread apply}
5916 (@pxref{Threads, thread apply}). For example, if you type @kbd{thread
5917 apply all backtrace}, @value{GDBN} will display the backtrace for all
5918 the threads; this is handy when you debug a core dump of a
5919 multi-threaded program.
5920
5921 Each line in the backtrace shows the frame number and the function name.
5922 The program counter value is also shown---unless you use @code{set
5923 print address off}. The backtrace also shows the source file name and
5924 line number, as well as the arguments to the function. The program
5925 counter value is omitted if it is at the beginning of the code for that
5926 line number.
5927
5928 Here is an example of a backtrace. It was made with the command
5929 @samp{bt 3}, so it shows the innermost three frames.
5930
5931 @smallexample
5932 @group
5933 #0 m4_traceon (obs=0x24eb0, argc=1, argv=0x2b8c8)
5934 at builtin.c:993
5935 #1 0x6e38 in expand_macro (sym=0x2b600, data=...) at macro.c:242
5936 #2 0x6840 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=177664, td=0xf7fffb08)
5937 at macro.c:71
5938 (More stack frames follow...)
5939 @end group
5940 @end smallexample
5941
5942 @noindent
5943 The display for frame zero does not begin with a program counter
5944 value, indicating that your program has stopped at the beginning of the
5945 code for line @code{993} of @code{builtin.c}.
5946
5947 @noindent
5948 The value of parameter @code{data} in frame 1 has been replaced by
5949 @code{@dots{}}. By default, @value{GDBN} prints the value of a parameter
5950 only if it is a scalar (integer, pointer, enumeration, etc). See command
5951 @kbd{set print frame-arguments} in @ref{Print Settings} for more details
5952 on how to configure the way function parameter values are printed.
5953
5954 @cindex optimized out, in backtrace
5955 @cindex function call arguments, optimized out
5956 If your program was compiled with optimizations, some compilers will
5957 optimize away arguments passed to functions if those arguments are
5958 never used after the call. Such optimizations generate code that
5959 passes arguments through registers, but doesn't store those arguments
5960 in the stack frame. @value{GDBN} has no way of displaying such
5961 arguments in stack frames other than the innermost one. Here's what
5962 such a backtrace might look like:
5963
5964 @smallexample
5965 @group
5966 #0 m4_traceon (obs=0x24eb0, argc=1, argv=0x2b8c8)
5967 at builtin.c:993
5968 #1 0x6e38 in expand_macro (sym=<optimized out>) at macro.c:242
5969 #2 0x6840 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=<optimized out>, td=0xf7fffb08)
5970 at macro.c:71
5971 (More stack frames follow...)
5972 @end group
5973 @end smallexample
5974
5975 @noindent
5976 The values of arguments that were not saved in their stack frames are
5977 shown as @samp{<optimized out>}.
5978
5979 If you need to display the values of such optimized-out arguments,
5980 either deduce that from other variables whose values depend on the one
5981 you are interested in, or recompile without optimizations.
5982
5983 @cindex backtrace beyond @code{main} function
5984 @cindex program entry point
5985 @cindex startup code, and backtrace
5986 Most programs have a standard user entry point---a place where system
5987 libraries and startup code transition into user code. For C this is
5988 @code{main}@footnote{
5989 Note that embedded programs (the so-called ``free-standing''
5990 environment) are not required to have a @code{main} function as the
5991 entry point. They could even have multiple entry points.}.
5992 When @value{GDBN} finds the entry function in a backtrace
5993 it will terminate the backtrace, to avoid tracing into highly
5994 system-specific (and generally uninteresting) code.
5995
5996 If you need to examine the startup code, or limit the number of levels
5997 in a backtrace, you can change this behavior:
5998
5999 @table @code
6000 @item set backtrace past-main
6001 @itemx set backtrace past-main on
6002 @kindex set backtrace
6003 Backtraces will continue past the user entry point.
6004
6005 @item set backtrace past-main off
6006 Backtraces will stop when they encounter the user entry point. This is the
6007 default.
6008
6009 @item show backtrace past-main
6010 @kindex show backtrace
6011 Display the current user entry point backtrace policy.
6012
6013 @item set backtrace past-entry
6014 @itemx set backtrace past-entry on
6015 Backtraces will continue past the internal entry point of an application.
6016 This entry point is encoded by the linker when the application is built,
6017 and is likely before the user entry point @code{main} (or equivalent) is called.
6018
6019 @item set backtrace past-entry off
6020 Backtraces will stop when they encounter the internal entry point of an
6021 application. This is the default.
6022
6023 @item show backtrace past-entry
6024 Display the current internal entry point backtrace policy.
6025
6026 @item set backtrace limit @var{n}
6027 @itemx set backtrace limit 0
6028 @cindex backtrace limit
6029 Limit the backtrace to @var{n} levels. A value of zero means
6030 unlimited.
6031
6032 @item show backtrace limit
6033 Display the current limit on backtrace levels.
6034 @end table
6035
6036 @node Selection
6037 @section Selecting a Frame
6038
6039 Most commands for examining the stack and other data in your program work on
6040 whichever stack frame is selected at the moment. Here are the commands for
6041 selecting a stack frame; all of them finish by printing a brief description
6042 of the stack frame just selected.
6043
6044 @table @code
6045 @kindex frame@r{, selecting}
6046 @kindex f @r{(@code{frame})}
6047 @item frame @var{n}
6048 @itemx f @var{n}
6049 Select frame number @var{n}. Recall that frame zero is the innermost
6050 (currently executing) frame, frame one is the frame that called the
6051 innermost one, and so on. The highest-numbered frame is the one for
6052 @code{main}.
6053
6054 @item frame @var{addr}
6055 @itemx f @var{addr}
6056 Select the frame at address @var{addr}. This is useful mainly if the
6057 chaining of stack frames has been damaged by a bug, making it
6058 impossible for @value{GDBN} to assign numbers properly to all frames. In
6059 addition, this can be useful when your program has multiple stacks and
6060 switches between them.
6061
6062 On the SPARC architecture, @code{frame} needs two addresses to
6063 select an arbitrary frame: a frame pointer and a stack pointer.
6064
6065 On the MIPS and Alpha architecture, it needs two addresses: a stack
6066 pointer and a program counter.
6067
6068 On the 29k architecture, it needs three addresses: a register stack
6069 pointer, a program counter, and a memory stack pointer.
6070
6071 @kindex up
6072 @item up @var{n}
6073 Move @var{n} frames up the stack. For positive numbers @var{n}, this
6074 advances toward the outermost frame, to higher frame numbers, to frames
6075 that have existed longer. @var{n} defaults to one.
6076
6077 @kindex down
6078 @kindex do @r{(@code{down})}
6079 @item down @var{n}
6080 Move @var{n} frames down the stack. For positive numbers @var{n}, this
6081 advances toward the innermost frame, to lower frame numbers, to frames
6082 that were created more recently. @var{n} defaults to one. You may
6083 abbreviate @code{down} as @code{do}.
6084 @end table
6085
6086 All of these commands end by printing two lines of output describing the
6087 frame. The first line shows the frame number, the function name, the
6088 arguments, and the source file and line number of execution in that
6089 frame. The second line shows the text of that source line.
6090
6091 @need 1000
6092 For example:
6093
6094 @smallexample
6095 @group
6096 (@value{GDBP}) up
6097 #1 0x22f0 in main (argc=1, argv=0xf7fffbf4, env=0xf7fffbfc)
6098 at env.c:10
6099 10 read_input_file (argv[i]);
6100 @end group
6101 @end smallexample
6102
6103 After such a printout, the @code{list} command with no arguments
6104 prints ten lines centered on the point of execution in the frame.
6105 You can also edit the program at the point of execution with your favorite
6106 editing program by typing @code{edit}.
6107 @xref{List, ,Printing Source Lines},
6108 for details.
6109
6110 @table @code
6111 @kindex down-silently
6112 @kindex up-silently
6113 @item up-silently @var{n}
6114 @itemx down-silently @var{n}
6115 These two commands are variants of @code{up} and @code{down},
6116 respectively; they differ in that they do their work silently, without
6117 causing display of the new frame. They are intended primarily for use
6118 in @value{GDBN} command scripts, where the output might be unnecessary and
6119 distracting.
6120 @end table
6121
6122 @node Frame Info
6123 @section Information About a Frame
6124
6125 There are several other commands to print information about the selected
6126 stack frame.
6127
6128 @table @code
6129 @item frame
6130 @itemx f
6131 When used without any argument, this command does not change which
6132 frame is selected, but prints a brief description of the currently
6133 selected stack frame. It can be abbreviated @code{f}. With an
6134 argument, this command is used to select a stack frame.
6135 @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}.
6136
6137 @kindex info frame
6138 @kindex info f @r{(@code{info frame})}
6139 @item info frame
6140 @itemx info f
6141 This command prints a verbose description of the selected stack frame,
6142 including:
6143
6144 @itemize @bullet
6145 @item
6146 the address of the frame
6147 @item
6148 the address of the next frame down (called by this frame)
6149 @item
6150 the address of the next frame up (caller of this frame)
6151 @item
6152 the language in which the source code corresponding to this frame is written
6153 @item
6154 the address of the frame's arguments
6155 @item
6156 the address of the frame's local variables
6157 @item
6158 the program counter saved in it (the address of execution in the caller frame)
6159 @item
6160 which registers were saved in the frame
6161 @end itemize
6162
6163 @noindent The verbose description is useful when
6164 something has gone wrong that has made the stack format fail to fit
6165 the usual conventions.
6166
6167 @item info frame @var{addr}
6168 @itemx info f @var{addr}
6169 Print a verbose description of the frame at address @var{addr}, without
6170 selecting that frame. The selected frame remains unchanged by this
6171 command. This requires the same kind of address (more than one for some
6172 architectures) that you specify in the @code{frame} command.
6173 @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}.
6174
6175 @kindex info args
6176 @item info args
6177 Print the arguments of the selected frame, each on a separate line.
6178
6179 @item info locals
6180 @kindex info locals
6181 Print the local variables of the selected frame, each on a separate
6182 line. These are all variables (declared either static or automatic)
6183 accessible at the point of execution of the selected frame.
6184
6185 @kindex info catch
6186 @cindex catch exceptions, list active handlers
6187 @cindex exception handlers, how to list
6188 @item info catch
6189 Print a list of all the exception handlers that are active in the
6190 current stack frame at the current point of execution. To see other
6191 exception handlers, visit the associated frame (using the @code{up},
6192 @code{down}, or @code{frame} commands); then type @code{info catch}.
6193 @xref{Set Catchpoints, , Setting Catchpoints}.
6194
6195 @end table
6196
6197
6198 @node Source
6199 @chapter Examining Source Files
6200
6201 @value{GDBN} can print parts of your program's source, since the debugging
6202 information recorded in the program tells @value{GDBN} what source files were
6203 used to build it. When your program stops, @value{GDBN} spontaneously prints
6204 the line where it stopped. Likewise, when you select a stack frame
6205 (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}), @value{GDBN} prints the line where
6206 execution in that frame has stopped. You can print other portions of
6207 source files by explicit command.
6208
6209 If you use @value{GDBN} through its @sc{gnu} Emacs interface, you may
6210 prefer to use Emacs facilities to view source; see @ref{Emacs, ,Using
6211 @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs}.
6212
6213 @menu
6214 * List:: Printing source lines
6215 * Specify Location:: How to specify code locations
6216 * Edit:: Editing source files
6217 * Search:: Searching source files
6218 * Source Path:: Specifying source directories
6219 * Machine Code:: Source and machine code
6220 @end menu
6221
6222 @node List
6223 @section Printing Source Lines
6224
6225 @kindex list
6226 @kindex l @r{(@code{list})}
6227 To print lines from a source file, use the @code{list} command
6228 (abbreviated @code{l}). By default, ten lines are printed.
6229 There are several ways to specify what part of the file you want to
6230 print; see @ref{Specify Location}, for the full list.
6231
6232 Here are the forms of the @code{list} command most commonly used:
6233
6234 @table @code
6235 @item list @var{linenum}
6236 Print lines centered around line number @var{linenum} in the
6237 current source file.
6238
6239 @item list @var{function}
6240 Print lines centered around the beginning of function
6241 @var{function}.
6242
6243 @item list
6244 Print more lines. If the last lines printed were printed with a
6245 @code{list} command, this prints lines following the last lines
6246 printed; however, if the last line printed was a solitary line printed
6247 as part of displaying a stack frame (@pxref{Stack, ,Examining the
6248 Stack}), this prints lines centered around that line.
6249
6250 @item list -
6251 Print lines just before the lines last printed.
6252 @end table
6253
6254 @cindex @code{list}, how many lines to display
6255 By default, @value{GDBN} prints ten source lines with any of these forms of
6256 the @code{list} command. You can change this using @code{set listsize}:
6257
6258 @table @code
6259 @kindex set listsize
6260 @item set listsize @var{count}
6261 Make the @code{list} command display @var{count} source lines (unless
6262 the @code{list} argument explicitly specifies some other number).
6263
6264 @kindex show listsize
6265 @item show listsize
6266 Display the number of lines that @code{list} prints.
6267 @end table
6268
6269 Repeating a @code{list} command with @key{RET} discards the argument,
6270 so it is equivalent to typing just @code{list}. This is more useful
6271 than listing the same lines again. An exception is made for an
6272 argument of @samp{-}; that argument is preserved in repetition so that
6273 each repetition moves up in the source file.
6274
6275 In general, the @code{list} command expects you to supply zero, one or two
6276 @dfn{linespecs}. Linespecs specify source lines; there are several ways
6277 of writing them (@pxref{Specify Location}), but the effect is always
6278 to specify some source line.
6279
6280 Here is a complete description of the possible arguments for @code{list}:
6281
6282 @table @code
6283 @item list @var{linespec}
6284 Print lines centered around the line specified by @var{linespec}.
6285
6286 @item list @var{first},@var{last}
6287 Print lines from @var{first} to @var{last}. Both arguments are
6288 linespecs. When a @code{list} command has two linespecs, and the
6289 source file of the second linespec is omitted, this refers to
6290 the same source file as the first linespec.
6291
6292 @item list ,@var{last}
6293 Print lines ending with @var{last}.
6294
6295 @item list @var{first},
6296 Print lines starting with @var{first}.
6297
6298 @item list +
6299 Print lines just after the lines last printed.
6300
6301 @item list -
6302 Print lines just before the lines last printed.
6303
6304 @item list
6305 As described in the preceding table.
6306 @end table
6307
6308 @node Specify Location
6309 @section Specifying a Location
6310 @cindex specifying location
6311 @cindex linespec
6312
6313 Several @value{GDBN} commands accept arguments that specify a location
6314 of your program's code. Since @value{GDBN} is a source-level
6315 debugger, a location usually specifies some line in the source code;
6316 for that reason, locations are also known as @dfn{linespecs}.
6317
6318 Here are all the different ways of specifying a code location that
6319 @value{GDBN} understands:
6320
6321 @table @code
6322 @item @var{linenum}
6323 Specifies the line number @var{linenum} of the current source file.
6324
6325 @item -@var{offset}
6326 @itemx +@var{offset}
6327 Specifies the line @var{offset} lines before or after the @dfn{current
6328 line}. For the @code{list} command, the current line is the last one
6329 printed; for the breakpoint commands, this is the line at which
6330 execution stopped in the currently selected @dfn{stack frame}
6331 (@pxref{Frames, ,Frames}, for a description of stack frames.) When
6332 used as the second of the two linespecs in a @code{list} command,
6333 this specifies the line @var{offset} lines up or down from the first
6334 linespec.
6335
6336 @item @var{filename}:@var{linenum}
6337 Specifies the line @var{linenum} in the source file @var{filename}.
6338
6339 @item @var{function}
6340 Specifies the line that begins the body of the function @var{function}.
6341 For example, in C, this is the line with the open brace.
6342
6343 @item @var{filename}:@var{function}
6344 Specifies the line that begins the body of the function @var{function}
6345 in the file @var{filename}. You only need the file name with a
6346 function name to avoid ambiguity when there are identically named
6347 functions in different source files.
6348
6349 @item @var{label}
6350 Specifies the line at which the label named @var{label} appears.
6351 @value{GDBN} searches for the label in the function corresponding to
6352 the currently selected stack frame. If there is no current selected
6353 stack frame (for instance, if the inferior is not running), then
6354 @value{GDBN} will not search for a label.
6355
6356 @item *@var{address}
6357 Specifies the program address @var{address}. For line-oriented
6358 commands, such as @code{list} and @code{edit}, this specifies a source
6359 line that contains @var{address}. For @code{break} and other
6360 breakpoint oriented commands, this can be used to set breakpoints in
6361 parts of your program which do not have debugging information or
6362 source files.
6363
6364 Here @var{address} may be any expression valid in the current working
6365 language (@pxref{Languages, working language}) that specifies a code
6366 address. In addition, as a convenience, @value{GDBN} extends the
6367 semantics of expressions used in locations to cover the situations
6368 that frequently happen during debugging. Here are the various forms
6369 of @var{address}:
6370
6371 @table @code
6372 @item @var{expression}
6373 Any expression valid in the current working language.
6374
6375 @item @var{funcaddr}
6376 An address of a function or procedure derived from its name. In C,
6377 C@t{++}, Java, Objective-C, Fortran, minimal, and assembly, this is
6378 simply the function's name @var{function} (and actually a special case
6379 of a valid expression). In Pascal and Modula-2, this is
6380 @code{&@var{function}}. In Ada, this is @code{@var{function}'Address}
6381 (although the Pascal form also works).
6382
6383 This form specifies the address of the function's first instruction,
6384 before the stack frame and arguments have been set up.
6385
6386 @item '@var{filename}'::@var{funcaddr}
6387 Like @var{funcaddr} above, but also specifies the name of the source
6388 file explicitly. This is useful if the name of the function does not
6389 specify the function unambiguously, e.g., if there are several
6390 functions with identical names in different source files.
6391 @end table
6392
6393 @end table
6394
6395
6396 @node Edit
6397 @section Editing Source Files
6398 @cindex editing source files
6399
6400 @kindex edit
6401 @kindex e @r{(@code{edit})}
6402 To edit the lines in a source file, use the @code{edit} command.
6403 The editing program of your choice
6404 is invoked with the current line set to
6405 the active line in the program.
6406 Alternatively, there are several ways to specify what part of the file you
6407 want to print if you want to see other parts of the program:
6408
6409 @table @code
6410 @item edit @var{location}
6411 Edit the source file specified by @code{location}. Editing starts at
6412 that @var{location}, e.g., at the specified source line of the
6413 specified file. @xref{Specify Location}, for all the possible forms
6414 of the @var{location} argument; here are the forms of the @code{edit}
6415 command most commonly used:
6416
6417 @table @code
6418 @item edit @var{number}
6419 Edit the current source file with @var{number} as the active line number.
6420
6421 @item edit @var{function}
6422 Edit the file containing @var{function} at the beginning of its definition.
6423 @end table
6424
6425 @end table
6426
6427 @subsection Choosing your Editor
6428 You can customize @value{GDBN} to use any editor you want
6429 @footnote{
6430 The only restriction is that your editor (say @code{ex}), recognizes the
6431 following command-line syntax:
6432 @smallexample
6433 ex +@var{number} file
6434 @end smallexample
6435 The optional numeric value +@var{number} specifies the number of the line in
6436 the file where to start editing.}.
6437 By default, it is @file{@value{EDITOR}}, but you can change this
6438 by setting the environment variable @code{EDITOR} before using
6439 @value{GDBN}. For example, to configure @value{GDBN} to use the
6440 @code{vi} editor, you could use these commands with the @code{sh} shell:
6441 @smallexample
6442 EDITOR=/usr/bin/vi
6443 export EDITOR
6444 gdb @dots{}
6445 @end smallexample
6446 or in the @code{csh} shell,
6447 @smallexample
6448 setenv EDITOR /usr/bin/vi
6449 gdb @dots{}
6450 @end smallexample
6451
6452 @node Search
6453 @section Searching Source Files
6454 @cindex searching source files
6455
6456 There are two commands for searching through the current source file for a
6457 regular expression.
6458
6459 @table @code
6460 @kindex search
6461 @kindex forward-search
6462 @item forward-search @var{regexp}
6463 @itemx search @var{regexp}
6464 The command @samp{forward-search @var{regexp}} checks each line,
6465 starting with the one following the last line listed, for a match for
6466 @var{regexp}. It lists the line that is found. You can use the
6467 synonym @samp{search @var{regexp}} or abbreviate the command name as
6468 @code{fo}.
6469
6470 @kindex reverse-search
6471 @item reverse-search @var{regexp}
6472 The command @samp{reverse-search @var{regexp}} checks each line, starting
6473 with the one before the last line listed and going backward, for a match
6474 for @var{regexp}. It lists the line that is found. You can abbreviate
6475 this command as @code{rev}.
6476 @end table
6477
6478 @node Source Path
6479 @section Specifying Source Directories
6480
6481 @cindex source path
6482 @cindex directories for source files
6483 Executable programs sometimes do not record the directories of the source
6484 files from which they were compiled, just the names. Even when they do,
6485 the directories could be moved between the compilation and your debugging
6486 session. @value{GDBN} has a list of directories to search for source files;
6487 this is called the @dfn{source path}. Each time @value{GDBN} wants a source file,
6488 it tries all the directories in the list, in the order they are present
6489 in the list, until it finds a file with the desired name.
6490
6491 For example, suppose an executable references the file
6492 @file{/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}, and our source path is
6493 @file{/mnt/cross}. The file is first looked up literally; if this
6494 fails, @file{/mnt/cross/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c} is tried; if this
6495 fails, @file{/mnt/cross/foo.c} is opened; if this fails, an error
6496 message is printed. @value{GDBN} does not look up the parts of the
6497 source file name, such as @file{/mnt/cross/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}.
6498 Likewise, the subdirectories of the source path are not searched: if
6499 the source path is @file{/mnt/cross}, and the binary refers to
6500 @file{foo.c}, @value{GDBN} would not find it under
6501 @file{/mnt/cross/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib}.
6502
6503 Plain file names, relative file names with leading directories, file
6504 names containing dots, etc.@: are all treated as described above; for
6505 instance, if the source path is @file{/mnt/cross}, and the source file
6506 is recorded as @file{../lib/foo.c}, @value{GDBN} would first try
6507 @file{../lib/foo.c}, then @file{/mnt/cross/../lib/foo.c}, and after
6508 that---@file{/mnt/cross/foo.c}.
6509
6510 Note that the executable search path is @emph{not} used to locate the
6511 source files.
6512
6513 Whenever you reset or rearrange the source path, @value{GDBN} clears out
6514 any information it has cached about where source files are found and where
6515 each line is in the file.
6516
6517 @kindex directory
6518 @kindex dir
6519 When you start @value{GDBN}, its source path includes only @samp{cdir}
6520 and @samp{cwd}, in that order.
6521 To add other directories, use the @code{directory} command.
6522
6523 The search path is used to find both program source files and @value{GDBN}
6524 script files (read using the @samp{-command} option and @samp{source} command).
6525
6526 In addition to the source path, @value{GDBN} provides a set of commands
6527 that manage a list of source path substitution rules. A @dfn{substitution
6528 rule} specifies how to rewrite source directories stored in the program's
6529 debug information in case the sources were moved to a different
6530 directory between compilation and debugging. A rule is made of
6531 two strings, the first specifying what needs to be rewritten in
6532 the path, and the second specifying how it should be rewritten.
6533 In @ref{set substitute-path}, we name these two parts @var{from} and
6534 @var{to} respectively. @value{GDBN} does a simple string replacement
6535 of @var{from} with @var{to} at the start of the directory part of the
6536 source file name, and uses that result instead of the original file
6537 name to look up the sources.
6538
6539 Using the previous example, suppose the @file{foo-1.0} tree has been
6540 moved from @file{/usr/src} to @file{/mnt/cross}, then you can tell
6541 @value{GDBN} to replace @file{/usr/src} in all source path names with
6542 @file{/mnt/cross}. The first lookup will then be
6543 @file{/mnt/cross/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c} in place of the original location
6544 of @file{/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}. To define a source path
6545 substitution rule, use the @code{set substitute-path} command
6546 (@pxref{set substitute-path}).
6547
6548 To avoid unexpected substitution results, a rule is applied only if the
6549 @var{from} part of the directory name ends at a directory separator.
6550 For instance, a rule substituting @file{/usr/source} into
6551 @file{/mnt/cross} will be applied to @file{/usr/source/foo-1.0} but
6552 not to @file{/usr/sourceware/foo-2.0}. And because the substitution
6553 is applied only at the beginning of the directory name, this rule will
6554 not be applied to @file{/root/usr/source/baz.c} either.
6555
6556 In many cases, you can achieve the same result using the @code{directory}
6557 command. However, @code{set substitute-path} can be more efficient in
6558 the case where the sources are organized in a complex tree with multiple
6559 subdirectories. With the @code{directory} command, you need to add each
6560 subdirectory of your project. If you moved the entire tree while
6561 preserving its internal organization, then @code{set substitute-path}
6562 allows you to direct the debugger to all the sources with one single
6563 command.
6564
6565 @code{set substitute-path} is also more than just a shortcut command.
6566 The source path is only used if the file at the original location no
6567 longer exists. On the other hand, @code{set substitute-path} modifies
6568 the debugger behavior to look at the rewritten location instead. So, if
6569 for any reason a source file that is not relevant to your executable is
6570 located at the original location, a substitution rule is the only
6571 method available to point @value{GDBN} at the new location.
6572
6573 @cindex @samp{--with-relocated-sources}
6574 @cindex default source path substitution
6575 You can configure a default source path substitution rule by
6576 configuring @value{GDBN} with the
6577 @samp{--with-relocated-sources=@var{dir}} option. The @var{dir}
6578 should be the name of a directory under @value{GDBN}'s configured
6579 prefix (set with @samp{--prefix} or @samp{--exec-prefix}), and
6580 directory names in debug information under @var{dir} will be adjusted
6581 automatically if the installed @value{GDBN} is moved to a new
6582 location. This is useful if @value{GDBN}, libraries or executables
6583 with debug information and corresponding source code are being moved
6584 together.
6585
6586 @table @code
6587 @item directory @var{dirname} @dots{}
6588 @item dir @var{dirname} @dots{}
6589 Add directory @var{dirname} to the front of the source path. Several
6590 directory names may be given to this command, separated by @samp{:}
6591 (@samp{;} on MS-DOS and MS-Windows, where @samp{:} usually appears as
6592 part of absolute file names) or
6593 whitespace. You may specify a directory that is already in the source
6594 path; this moves it forward, so @value{GDBN} searches it sooner.
6595
6596 @kindex cdir
6597 @kindex cwd
6598 @vindex $cdir@r{, convenience variable}
6599 @vindex $cwd@r{, convenience variable}
6600 @cindex compilation directory
6601 @cindex current directory
6602 @cindex working directory
6603 @cindex directory, current
6604 @cindex directory, compilation
6605 You can use the string @samp{$cdir} to refer to the compilation
6606 directory (if one is recorded), and @samp{$cwd} to refer to the current
6607 working directory. @samp{$cwd} is not the same as @samp{.}---the former
6608 tracks the current working directory as it changes during your @value{GDBN}
6609 session, while the latter is immediately expanded to the current
6610 directory at the time you add an entry to the source path.
6611
6612 @item directory
6613 Reset the source path to its default value (@samp{$cdir:$cwd} on Unix systems). This requires confirmation.
6614
6615 @c RET-repeat for @code{directory} is explicitly disabled, but since
6616 @c repeating it would be a no-op we do not say that. (thanks to RMS)
6617
6618 @item set directories @var{path-list}
6619 @kindex set directories
6620 Set the source path to @var{path-list}.
6621 @samp{$cdir:$cwd} are added if missing.
6622
6623 @item show directories
6624 @kindex show directories
6625 Print the source path: show which directories it contains.
6626
6627 @anchor{set substitute-path}
6628 @item set substitute-path @var{from} @var{to}
6629 @kindex set substitute-path
6630 Define a source path substitution rule, and add it at the end of the
6631 current list of existing substitution rules. If a rule with the same
6632 @var{from} was already defined, then the old rule is also deleted.
6633
6634 For example, if the file @file{/foo/bar/baz.c} was moved to
6635 @file{/mnt/cross/baz.c}, then the command
6636
6637 @smallexample
6638 (@value{GDBP}) set substitute-path /usr/src /mnt/cross
6639 @end smallexample
6640
6641 @noindent
6642 will tell @value{GDBN} to replace @samp{/usr/src} with
6643 @samp{/mnt/cross}, which will allow @value{GDBN} to find the file
6644 @file{baz.c} even though it was moved.
6645
6646 In the case when more than one substitution rule have been defined,
6647 the rules are evaluated one by one in the order where they have been
6648 defined. The first one matching, if any, is selected to perform
6649 the substitution.
6650
6651 For instance, if we had entered the following commands:
6652
6653 @smallexample
6654 (@value{GDBP}) set substitute-path /usr/src/include /mnt/include
6655 (@value{GDBP}) set substitute-path /usr/src /mnt/src
6656 @end smallexample
6657
6658 @noindent
6659 @value{GDBN} would then rewrite @file{/usr/src/include/defs.h} into
6660 @file{/mnt/include/defs.h} by using the first rule. However, it would
6661 use the second rule to rewrite @file{/usr/src/lib/foo.c} into
6662 @file{/mnt/src/lib/foo.c}.
6663
6664
6665 @item unset substitute-path [path]
6666 @kindex unset substitute-path
6667 If a path is specified, search the current list of substitution rules
6668 for a rule that would rewrite that path. Delete that rule if found.
6669 A warning is emitted by the debugger if no rule could be found.
6670
6671 If no path is specified, then all substitution rules are deleted.
6672
6673 @item show substitute-path [path]
6674 @kindex show substitute-path
6675 If a path is specified, then print the source path substitution rule
6676 which would rewrite that path, if any.
6677
6678 If no path is specified, then print all existing source path substitution
6679 rules.
6680
6681 @end table
6682
6683 If your source path is cluttered with directories that are no longer of
6684 interest, @value{GDBN} may sometimes cause confusion by finding the wrong
6685 versions of source. You can correct the situation as follows:
6686
6687 @enumerate
6688 @item
6689 Use @code{directory} with no argument to reset the source path to its default value.
6690
6691 @item
6692 Use @code{directory} with suitable arguments to reinstall the
6693 directories you want in the source path. You can add all the
6694 directories in one command.
6695 @end enumerate
6696
6697 @node Machine Code
6698 @section Source and Machine Code
6699 @cindex source line and its code address
6700
6701 You can use the command @code{info line} to map source lines to program
6702 addresses (and vice versa), and the command @code{disassemble} to display
6703 a range of addresses as machine instructions. You can use the command
6704 @code{set disassemble-next-line} to set whether to disassemble next
6705 source line when execution stops. When run under @sc{gnu} Emacs
6706 mode, the @code{info line} command causes the arrow to point to the
6707 line specified. Also, @code{info line} prints addresses in symbolic form as
6708 well as hex.
6709
6710 @table @code
6711 @kindex info line
6712 @item info line @var{linespec}
6713 Print the starting and ending addresses of the compiled code for
6714 source line @var{linespec}. You can specify source lines in any of
6715 the ways documented in @ref{Specify Location}.
6716 @end table
6717
6718 For example, we can use @code{info line} to discover the location of
6719 the object code for the first line of function
6720 @code{m4_changequote}:
6721
6722 @c FIXME: I think this example should also show the addresses in
6723 @c symbolic form, as they usually would be displayed.
6724 @smallexample
6725 (@value{GDBP}) info line m4_changequote
6726 Line 895 of "builtin.c" starts at pc 0x634c and ends at 0x6350.
6727 @end smallexample
6728
6729 @noindent
6730 @cindex code address and its source line
6731 We can also inquire (using @code{*@var{addr}} as the form for
6732 @var{linespec}) what source line covers a particular address:
6733 @smallexample
6734 (@value{GDBP}) info line *0x63ff
6735 Line 926 of "builtin.c" starts at pc 0x63e4 and ends at 0x6404.
6736 @end smallexample
6737
6738 @cindex @code{$_} and @code{info line}
6739 @cindex @code{x} command, default address
6740 @kindex x@r{(examine), and} info line
6741 After @code{info line}, the default address for the @code{x} command
6742 is changed to the starting address of the line, so that @samp{x/i} is
6743 sufficient to begin examining the machine code (@pxref{Memory,
6744 ,Examining Memory}). Also, this address is saved as the value of the
6745 convenience variable @code{$_} (@pxref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
6746 Variables}).
6747
6748 @table @code
6749 @kindex disassemble
6750 @cindex assembly instructions
6751 @cindex instructions, assembly
6752 @cindex machine instructions
6753 @cindex listing machine instructions
6754 @item disassemble
6755 @itemx disassemble /m
6756 @itemx disassemble /r
6757 This specialized command dumps a range of memory as machine
6758 instructions. It can also print mixed source+disassembly by specifying
6759 the @code{/m} modifier and print the raw instructions in hex as well as
6760 in symbolic form by specifying the @code{/r}.
6761 The default memory range is the function surrounding the
6762 program counter of the selected frame. A single argument to this
6763 command is a program counter value; @value{GDBN} dumps the function
6764 surrounding this value. When two arguments are given, they should
6765 be separated by a comma, possibly surrounded by whitespace. The
6766 arguments specify a range of addresses to dump, in one of two forms:
6767
6768 @table @code
6769 @item @var{start},@var{end}
6770 the addresses from @var{start} (inclusive) to @var{end} (exclusive)
6771 @item @var{start},+@var{length}
6772 the addresses from @var{start} (inclusive) to
6773 @code{@var{start}+@var{length}} (exclusive).
6774 @end table
6775
6776 @noindent
6777 When 2 arguments are specified, the name of the function is also
6778 printed (since there could be several functions in the given range).
6779
6780 The argument(s) can be any expression yielding a numeric value, such as
6781 @samp{0x32c4}, @samp{&main+10} or @samp{$pc - 8}.
6782
6783 If the range of memory being disassembled contains current program counter,
6784 the instruction at that location is shown with a @code{=>} marker.
6785 @end table
6786
6787 The following example shows the disassembly of a range of addresses of
6788 HP PA-RISC 2.0 code:
6789
6790 @smallexample
6791 (@value{GDBP}) disas 0x32c4, 0x32e4
6792 Dump of assembler code from 0x32c4 to 0x32e4:
6793 0x32c4 <main+204>: addil 0,dp
6794 0x32c8 <main+208>: ldw 0x22c(sr0,r1),r26
6795 0x32cc <main+212>: ldil 0x3000,r31
6796 0x32d0 <main+216>: ble 0x3f8(sr4,r31)
6797 0x32d4 <main+220>: ldo 0(r31),rp
6798 0x32d8 <main+224>: addil -0x800,dp
6799 0x32dc <main+228>: ldo 0x588(r1),r26
6800 0x32e0 <main+232>: ldil 0x3000,r31
6801 End of assembler dump.
6802 @end smallexample
6803
6804 Here is an example showing mixed source+assembly for Intel x86, when the
6805 program is stopped just after function prologue:
6806
6807 @smallexample
6808 (@value{GDBP}) disas /m main
6809 Dump of assembler code for function main:
6810 5 @{
6811 0x08048330 <+0>: push %ebp
6812 0x08048331 <+1>: mov %esp,%ebp
6813 0x08048333 <+3>: sub $0x8,%esp
6814 0x08048336 <+6>: and $0xfffffff0,%esp
6815 0x08048339 <+9>: sub $0x10,%esp
6816
6817 6 printf ("Hello.\n");
6818 => 0x0804833c <+12>: movl $0x8048440,(%esp)
6819 0x08048343 <+19>: call 0x8048284 <puts@@plt>
6820
6821 7 return 0;
6822 8 @}
6823 0x08048348 <+24>: mov $0x0,%eax
6824 0x0804834d <+29>: leave
6825 0x0804834e <+30>: ret
6826
6827 End of assembler dump.
6828 @end smallexample
6829
6830 Here is another example showing raw instructions in hex for AMD x86-64,
6831
6832 @smallexample
6833 (gdb) disas /r 0x400281,+10
6834 Dump of assembler code from 0x400281 to 0x40028b:
6835 0x0000000000400281: 38 36 cmp %dh,(%rsi)
6836 0x0000000000400283: 2d 36 34 2e 73 sub $0x732e3436,%eax
6837 0x0000000000400288: 6f outsl %ds:(%rsi),(%dx)
6838 0x0000000000400289: 2e 32 00 xor %cs:(%rax),%al
6839 End of assembler dump.
6840 @end smallexample
6841
6842 Some architectures have more than one commonly-used set of instruction
6843 mnemonics or other syntax.
6844
6845 For programs that were dynamically linked and use shared libraries,
6846 instructions that call functions or branch to locations in the shared
6847 libraries might show a seemingly bogus location---it's actually a
6848 location of the relocation table. On some architectures, @value{GDBN}
6849 might be able to resolve these to actual function names.
6850
6851 @table @code
6852 @kindex set disassembly-flavor
6853 @cindex Intel disassembly flavor
6854 @cindex AT&T disassembly flavor
6855 @item set disassembly-flavor @var{instruction-set}
6856 Select the instruction set to use when disassembling the
6857 program via the @code{disassemble} or @code{x/i} commands.
6858
6859 Currently this command is only defined for the Intel x86 family. You
6860 can set @var{instruction-set} to either @code{intel} or @code{att}.
6861 The default is @code{att}, the AT&T flavor used by default by Unix
6862 assemblers for x86-based targets.
6863
6864 @kindex show disassembly-flavor
6865 @item show disassembly-flavor
6866 Show the current setting of the disassembly flavor.
6867 @end table
6868
6869 @table @code
6870 @kindex set disassemble-next-line
6871 @kindex show disassemble-next-line
6872 @item set disassemble-next-line
6873 @itemx show disassemble-next-line
6874 Control whether or not @value{GDBN} will disassemble the next source
6875 line or instruction when execution stops. If ON, @value{GDBN} will
6876 display disassembly of the next source line when execution of the
6877 program being debugged stops. This is @emph{in addition} to
6878 displaying the source line itself, which @value{GDBN} always does if
6879 possible. If the next source line cannot be displayed for some reason
6880 (e.g., if @value{GDBN} cannot find the source file, or there's no line
6881 info in the debug info), @value{GDBN} will display disassembly of the
6882 next @emph{instruction} instead of showing the next source line. If
6883 AUTO, @value{GDBN} will display disassembly of next instruction only
6884 if the source line cannot be displayed. This setting causes
6885 @value{GDBN} to display some feedback when you step through a function
6886 with no line info or whose source file is unavailable. The default is
6887 OFF, which means never display the disassembly of the next line or
6888 instruction.
6889 @end table
6890
6891
6892 @node Data
6893 @chapter Examining Data
6894
6895 @cindex printing data
6896 @cindex examining data
6897 @kindex print
6898 @kindex inspect
6899 @c "inspect" is not quite a synonym if you are using Epoch, which we do not
6900 @c document because it is nonstandard... Under Epoch it displays in a
6901 @c different window or something like that.
6902 The usual way to examine data in your program is with the @code{print}
6903 command (abbreviated @code{p}), or its synonym @code{inspect}. It
6904 evaluates and prints the value of an expression of the language your
6905 program is written in (@pxref{Languages, ,Using @value{GDBN} with
6906 Different Languages}). It may also print the expression using a
6907 Python-based pretty-printer (@pxref{Pretty Printing}).
6908
6909 @table @code
6910 @item print @var{expr}
6911 @itemx print /@var{f} @var{expr}
6912 @var{expr} is an expression (in the source language). By default the
6913 value of @var{expr} is printed in a format appropriate to its data type;
6914 you can choose a different format by specifying @samp{/@var{f}}, where
6915 @var{f} is a letter specifying the format; see @ref{Output Formats,,Output
6916 Formats}.
6917
6918 @item print
6919 @itemx print /@var{f}
6920 @cindex reprint the last value
6921 If you omit @var{expr}, @value{GDBN} displays the last value again (from the
6922 @dfn{value history}; @pxref{Value History, ,Value History}). This allows you to
6923 conveniently inspect the same value in an alternative format.
6924 @end table
6925
6926 A more low-level way of examining data is with the @code{x} command.
6927 It examines data in memory at a specified address and prints it in a
6928 specified format. @xref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}.
6929
6930 If you are interested in information about types, or about how the
6931 fields of a struct or a class are declared, use the @code{ptype @var{exp}}
6932 command rather than @code{print}. @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol
6933 Table}.
6934
6935 @menu
6936 * Expressions:: Expressions
6937 * Ambiguous Expressions:: Ambiguous Expressions
6938 * Variables:: Program variables
6939 * Arrays:: Artificial arrays
6940 * Output Formats:: Output formats
6941 * Memory:: Examining memory
6942 * Auto Display:: Automatic display
6943 * Print Settings:: Print settings
6944 * Pretty Printing:: Python pretty printing
6945 * Value History:: Value history
6946 * Convenience Vars:: Convenience variables
6947 * Registers:: Registers
6948 * Floating Point Hardware:: Floating point hardware
6949 * Vector Unit:: Vector Unit
6950 * OS Information:: Auxiliary data provided by operating system
6951 * Memory Region Attributes:: Memory region attributes
6952 * Dump/Restore Files:: Copy between memory and a file
6953 * Core File Generation:: Cause a program dump its core
6954 * Character Sets:: Debugging programs that use a different
6955 character set than GDB does
6956 * Caching Remote Data:: Data caching for remote targets
6957 * Searching Memory:: Searching memory for a sequence of bytes
6958 @end menu
6959
6960 @node Expressions
6961 @section Expressions
6962
6963 @cindex expressions
6964 @code{print} and many other @value{GDBN} commands accept an expression and
6965 compute its value. Any kind of constant, variable or operator defined
6966 by the programming language you are using is valid in an expression in
6967 @value{GDBN}. This includes conditional expressions, function calls,
6968 casts, and string constants. It also includes preprocessor macros, if
6969 you compiled your program to include this information; see
6970 @ref{Compilation}.
6971
6972 @cindex arrays in expressions
6973 @value{GDBN} supports array constants in expressions input by
6974 the user. The syntax is @{@var{element}, @var{element}@dots{}@}. For example,
6975 you can use the command @code{print @{1, 2, 3@}} to create an array
6976 of three integers. If you pass an array to a function or assign it
6977 to a program variable, @value{GDBN} copies the array to memory that
6978 is @code{malloc}ed in the target program.
6979
6980 Because C is so widespread, most of the expressions shown in examples in
6981 this manual are in C. @xref{Languages, , Using @value{GDBN} with Different
6982 Languages}, for information on how to use expressions in other
6983 languages.
6984
6985 In this section, we discuss operators that you can use in @value{GDBN}
6986 expressions regardless of your programming language.
6987
6988 @cindex casts, in expressions
6989 Casts are supported in all languages, not just in C, because it is so
6990 useful to cast a number into a pointer in order to examine a structure
6991 at that address in memory.
6992 @c FIXME: casts supported---Mod2 true?
6993
6994 @value{GDBN} supports these operators, in addition to those common
6995 to programming languages:
6996
6997 @table @code
6998 @item @@
6999 @samp{@@} is a binary operator for treating parts of memory as arrays.
7000 @xref{Arrays, ,Artificial Arrays}, for more information.
7001
7002 @item ::
7003 @samp{::} allows you to specify a variable in terms of the file or
7004 function where it is defined. @xref{Variables, ,Program Variables}.
7005
7006 @cindex @{@var{type}@}
7007 @cindex type casting memory
7008 @cindex memory, viewing as typed object
7009 @cindex casts, to view memory
7010 @item @{@var{type}@} @var{addr}
7011 Refers to an object of type @var{type} stored at address @var{addr} in
7012 memory. @var{addr} may be any expression whose value is an integer or
7013 pointer (but parentheses are required around binary operators, just as in
7014 a cast). This construct is allowed regardless of what kind of data is
7015 normally supposed to reside at @var{addr}.
7016 @end table
7017
7018 @node Ambiguous Expressions
7019 @section Ambiguous Expressions
7020 @cindex ambiguous expressions
7021
7022 Expressions can sometimes contain some ambiguous elements. For instance,
7023 some programming languages (notably Ada, C@t{++} and Objective-C) permit
7024 a single function name to be defined several times, for application in
7025 different contexts. This is called @dfn{overloading}. Another example
7026 involving Ada is generics. A @dfn{generic package} is similar to C@t{++}
7027 templates and is typically instantiated several times, resulting in
7028 the same function name being defined in different contexts.
7029
7030 In some cases and depending on the language, it is possible to adjust
7031 the expression to remove the ambiguity. For instance in C@t{++}, you
7032 can specify the signature of the function you want to break on, as in
7033 @kbd{break @var{function}(@var{types})}. In Ada, using the fully
7034 qualified name of your function often makes the expression unambiguous
7035 as well.
7036
7037 When an ambiguity that needs to be resolved is detected, the debugger
7038 has the capability to display a menu of numbered choices for each
7039 possibility, and then waits for the selection with the prompt @samp{>}.
7040 The first option is always @samp{[0] cancel}, and typing @kbd{0 @key{RET}}
7041 aborts the current command. If the command in which the expression was
7042 used allows more than one choice to be selected, the next option in the
7043 menu is @samp{[1] all}, and typing @kbd{1 @key{RET}} selects all possible
7044 choices.
7045
7046 For example, the following session excerpt shows an attempt to set a
7047 breakpoint at the overloaded symbol @code{String::after}.
7048 We choose three particular definitions of that function name:
7049
7050 @c FIXME! This is likely to change to show arg type lists, at least
7051 @smallexample
7052 @group
7053 (@value{GDBP}) b String::after
7054 [0] cancel
7055 [1] all
7056 [2] file:String.cc; line number:867
7057 [3] file:String.cc; line number:860
7058 [4] file:String.cc; line number:875
7059 [5] file:String.cc; line number:853
7060 [6] file:String.cc; line number:846
7061 [7] file:String.cc; line number:735
7062 > 2 4 6
7063 Breakpoint 1 at 0xb26c: file String.cc, line 867.
7064 Breakpoint 2 at 0xb344: file String.cc, line 875.
7065 Breakpoint 3 at 0xafcc: file String.cc, line 846.
7066 Multiple breakpoints were set.
7067 Use the "delete" command to delete unwanted
7068 breakpoints.
7069 (@value{GDBP})
7070 @end group
7071 @end smallexample
7072
7073 @table @code
7074 @kindex set multiple-symbols
7075 @item set multiple-symbols @var{mode}
7076 @cindex multiple-symbols menu
7077
7078 This option allows you to adjust the debugger behavior when an expression
7079 is ambiguous.
7080
7081 By default, @var{mode} is set to @code{all}. If the command with which
7082 the expression is used allows more than one choice, then @value{GDBN}
7083 automatically selects all possible choices. For instance, inserting
7084 a breakpoint on a function using an ambiguous name results in a breakpoint
7085 inserted on each possible match. However, if a unique choice must be made,
7086 then @value{GDBN} uses the menu to help you disambiguate the expression.
7087 For instance, printing the address of an overloaded function will result
7088 in the use of the menu.
7089
7090 When @var{mode} is set to @code{ask}, the debugger always uses the menu
7091 when an ambiguity is detected.
7092
7093 Finally, when @var{mode} is set to @code{cancel}, the debugger reports
7094 an error due to the ambiguity and the command is aborted.
7095
7096 @kindex show multiple-symbols
7097 @item show multiple-symbols
7098 Show the current value of the @code{multiple-symbols} setting.
7099 @end table
7100
7101 @node Variables
7102 @section Program Variables
7103
7104 The most common kind of expression to use is the name of a variable
7105 in your program.
7106
7107 Variables in expressions are understood in the selected stack frame
7108 (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}); they must be either:
7109
7110 @itemize @bullet
7111 @item
7112 global (or file-static)
7113 @end itemize
7114
7115 @noindent or
7116
7117 @itemize @bullet
7118 @item
7119 visible according to the scope rules of the
7120 programming language from the point of execution in that frame
7121 @end itemize
7122
7123 @noindent This means that in the function
7124
7125 @smallexample
7126 foo (a)
7127 int a;
7128 @{
7129 bar (a);
7130 @{
7131 int b = test ();
7132 bar (b);
7133 @}
7134 @}
7135 @end smallexample
7136
7137 @noindent
7138 you can examine and use the variable @code{a} whenever your program is
7139 executing within the function @code{foo}, but you can only use or
7140 examine the variable @code{b} while your program is executing inside
7141 the block where @code{b} is declared.
7142
7143 @cindex variable name conflict
7144 There is an exception: you can refer to a variable or function whose
7145 scope is a single source file even if the current execution point is not
7146 in this file. But it is possible to have more than one such variable or
7147 function with the same name (in different source files). If that
7148 happens, referring to that name has unpredictable effects. If you wish,
7149 you can specify a static variable in a particular function or file,
7150 using the colon-colon (@code{::}) notation:
7151
7152 @cindex colon-colon, context for variables/functions
7153 @ifnotinfo
7154 @c info cannot cope with a :: index entry, but why deprive hard copy readers?
7155 @cindex @code{::}, context for variables/functions
7156 @end ifnotinfo
7157 @smallexample
7158 @var{file}::@var{variable}
7159 @var{function}::@var{variable}
7160 @end smallexample
7161
7162 @noindent
7163 Here @var{file} or @var{function} is the name of the context for the
7164 static @var{variable}. In the case of file names, you can use quotes to
7165 make sure @value{GDBN} parses the file name as a single word---for example,
7166 to print a global value of @code{x} defined in @file{f2.c}:
7167
7168 @smallexample
7169 (@value{GDBP}) p 'f2.c'::x
7170 @end smallexample
7171
7172 @cindex C@t{++} scope resolution
7173 This use of @samp{::} is very rarely in conflict with the very similar
7174 use of the same notation in C@t{++}. @value{GDBN} also supports use of the C@t{++}
7175 scope resolution operator in @value{GDBN} expressions.
7176 @c FIXME: Um, so what happens in one of those rare cases where it's in
7177 @c conflict?? --mew
7178
7179 @cindex wrong values
7180 @cindex variable values, wrong
7181 @cindex function entry/exit, wrong values of variables
7182 @cindex optimized code, wrong values of variables
7183 @quotation
7184 @emph{Warning:} Occasionally, a local variable may appear to have the
7185 wrong value at certain points in a function---just after entry to a new
7186 scope, and just before exit.
7187 @end quotation
7188 You may see this problem when you are stepping by machine instructions.
7189 This is because, on most machines, it takes more than one instruction to
7190 set up a stack frame (including local variable definitions); if you are
7191 stepping by machine instructions, variables may appear to have the wrong
7192 values until the stack frame is completely built. On exit, it usually
7193 also takes more than one machine instruction to destroy a stack frame;
7194 after you begin stepping through that group of instructions, local
7195 variable definitions may be gone.
7196
7197 This may also happen when the compiler does significant optimizations.
7198 To be sure of always seeing accurate values, turn off all optimization
7199 when compiling.
7200
7201 @cindex ``No symbol "foo" in current context''
7202 Another possible effect of compiler optimizations is to optimize
7203 unused variables out of existence, or assign variables to registers (as
7204 opposed to memory addresses). Depending on the support for such cases
7205 offered by the debug info format used by the compiler, @value{GDBN}
7206 might not be able to display values for such local variables. If that
7207 happens, @value{GDBN} will print a message like this:
7208
7209 @smallexample
7210 No symbol "foo" in current context.
7211 @end smallexample
7212
7213 To solve such problems, either recompile without optimizations, or use a
7214 different debug info format, if the compiler supports several such
7215 formats. For example, @value{NGCC}, the @sc{gnu} C/C@t{++} compiler,
7216 usually supports the @option{-gstabs+} option. @option{-gstabs+}
7217 produces debug info in a format that is superior to formats such as
7218 COFF. You may be able to use DWARF 2 (@option{-gdwarf-2}), which is also
7219 an effective form for debug info. @xref{Debugging Options,,Options
7220 for Debugging Your Program or GCC, gcc.info, Using the @sc{gnu}
7221 Compiler Collection (GCC)}.
7222 @xref{C, ,C and C@t{++}}, for more information about debug info formats
7223 that are best suited to C@t{++} programs.
7224
7225 If you ask to print an object whose contents are unknown to
7226 @value{GDBN}, e.g., because its data type is not completely specified
7227 by the debug information, @value{GDBN} will say @samp{<incomplete
7228 type>}. @xref{Symbols, incomplete type}, for more about this.
7229
7230 Strings are identified as arrays of @code{char} values without specified
7231 signedness. Arrays of either @code{signed char} or @code{unsigned char} get
7232 printed as arrays of 1 byte sized integers. @code{-fsigned-char} or
7233 @code{-funsigned-char} @value{NGCC} options have no effect as @value{GDBN}
7234 defines literal string type @code{"char"} as @code{char} without a sign.
7235 For program code
7236
7237 @smallexample
7238 char var0[] = "A";
7239 signed char var1[] = "A";
7240 @end smallexample
7241
7242 You get during debugging
7243 @smallexample
7244 (gdb) print var0
7245 $1 = "A"
7246 (gdb) print var1
7247 $2 = @{65 'A', 0 '\0'@}
7248 @end smallexample
7249
7250 @node Arrays
7251 @section Artificial Arrays
7252
7253 @cindex artificial array
7254 @cindex arrays
7255 @kindex @@@r{, referencing memory as an array}
7256 It is often useful to print out several successive objects of the
7257 same type in memory; a section of an array, or an array of
7258 dynamically determined size for which only a pointer exists in the
7259 program.
7260
7261 You can do this by referring to a contiguous span of memory as an
7262 @dfn{artificial array}, using the binary operator @samp{@@}. The left
7263 operand of @samp{@@} should be the first element of the desired array
7264 and be an individual object. The right operand should be the desired length
7265 of the array. The result is an array value whose elements are all of
7266 the type of the left argument. The first element is actually the left
7267 argument; the second element comes from bytes of memory immediately
7268 following those that hold the first element, and so on. Here is an
7269 example. If a program says
7270
7271 @smallexample
7272 int *array = (int *) malloc (len * sizeof (int));
7273 @end smallexample
7274
7275 @noindent
7276 you can print the contents of @code{array} with
7277
7278 @smallexample
7279 p *array@@len
7280 @end smallexample
7281
7282 The left operand of @samp{@@} must reside in memory. Array values made
7283 with @samp{@@} in this way behave just like other arrays in terms of
7284 subscripting, and are coerced to pointers when used in expressions.
7285 Artificial arrays most often appear in expressions via the value history
7286 (@pxref{Value History, ,Value History}), after printing one out.
7287
7288 Another way to create an artificial array is to use a cast.
7289 This re-interprets a value as if it were an array.
7290 The value need not be in memory:
7291 @smallexample
7292 (@value{GDBP}) p/x (short[2])0x12345678
7293 $1 = @{0x1234, 0x5678@}
7294 @end smallexample
7295
7296 As a convenience, if you leave the array length out (as in
7297 @samp{(@var{type}[])@var{value}}) @value{GDBN} calculates the size to fill
7298 the value (as @samp{sizeof(@var{value})/sizeof(@var{type})}:
7299 @smallexample
7300 (@value{GDBP}) p/x (short[])0x12345678
7301 $2 = @{0x1234, 0x5678@}
7302 @end smallexample
7303
7304 Sometimes the artificial array mechanism is not quite enough; in
7305 moderately complex data structures, the elements of interest may not
7306 actually be adjacent---for example, if you are interested in the values
7307 of pointers in an array. One useful work-around in this situation is
7308 to use a convenience variable (@pxref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
7309 Variables}) as a counter in an expression that prints the first
7310 interesting value, and then repeat that expression via @key{RET}. For
7311 instance, suppose you have an array @code{dtab} of pointers to
7312 structures, and you are interested in the values of a field @code{fv}
7313 in each structure. Here is an example of what you might type:
7314
7315 @smallexample
7316 set $i = 0
7317 p dtab[$i++]->fv
7318 @key{RET}
7319 @key{RET}
7320 @dots{}
7321 @end smallexample
7322
7323 @node Output Formats
7324 @section Output Formats
7325
7326 @cindex formatted output
7327 @cindex output formats
7328 By default, @value{GDBN} prints a value according to its data type. Sometimes
7329 this is not what you want. For example, you might want to print a number
7330 in hex, or a pointer in decimal. Or you might want to view data in memory
7331 at a certain address as a character string or as an instruction. To do
7332 these things, specify an @dfn{output format} when you print a value.
7333
7334 The simplest use of output formats is to say how to print a value
7335 already computed. This is done by starting the arguments of the
7336 @code{print} command with a slash and a format letter. The format
7337 letters supported are:
7338
7339 @table @code
7340 @item x
7341 Regard the bits of the value as an integer, and print the integer in
7342 hexadecimal.
7343
7344 @item d
7345 Print as integer in signed decimal.
7346
7347 @item u
7348 Print as integer in unsigned decimal.
7349
7350 @item o
7351 Print as integer in octal.
7352
7353 @item t
7354 Print as integer in binary. The letter @samp{t} stands for ``two''.
7355 @footnote{@samp{b} cannot be used because these format letters are also
7356 used with the @code{x} command, where @samp{b} stands for ``byte'';
7357 see @ref{Memory,,Examining Memory}.}
7358
7359 @item a
7360 @cindex unknown address, locating
7361 @cindex locate address
7362 Print as an address, both absolute in hexadecimal and as an offset from
7363 the nearest preceding symbol. You can use this format used to discover
7364 where (in what function) an unknown address is located:
7365
7366 @smallexample
7367 (@value{GDBP}) p/a 0x54320
7368 $3 = 0x54320 <_initialize_vx+396>
7369 @end smallexample
7370
7371 @noindent
7372 The command @code{info symbol 0x54320} yields similar results.
7373 @xref{Symbols, info symbol}.
7374
7375 @item c
7376 Regard as an integer and print it as a character constant. This
7377 prints both the numerical value and its character representation. The
7378 character representation is replaced with the octal escape @samp{\nnn}
7379 for characters outside the 7-bit @sc{ascii} range.
7380
7381 Without this format, @value{GDBN} displays @code{char},
7382 @w{@code{unsigned char}}, and @w{@code{signed char}} data as character
7383 constants. Single-byte members of vectors are displayed as integer
7384 data.
7385
7386 @item f
7387 Regard the bits of the value as a floating point number and print
7388 using typical floating point syntax.
7389
7390 @item s
7391 @cindex printing strings
7392 @cindex printing byte arrays
7393 Regard as a string, if possible. With this format, pointers to single-byte
7394 data are displayed as null-terminated strings and arrays of single-byte data
7395 are displayed as fixed-length strings. Other values are displayed in their
7396 natural types.
7397
7398 Without this format, @value{GDBN} displays pointers to and arrays of
7399 @code{char}, @w{@code{unsigned char}}, and @w{@code{signed char}} as
7400 strings. Single-byte members of a vector are displayed as an integer
7401 array.
7402
7403 @item r
7404 @cindex raw printing
7405 Print using the @samp{raw} formatting. By default, @value{GDBN} will
7406 use a Python-based pretty-printer, if one is available (@pxref{Pretty
7407 Printing}). This typically results in a higher-level display of the
7408 value's contents. The @samp{r} format bypasses any Python
7409 pretty-printer which might exist.
7410 @end table
7411
7412 For example, to print the program counter in hex (@pxref{Registers}), type
7413
7414 @smallexample
7415 p/x $pc
7416 @end smallexample
7417
7418 @noindent
7419 Note that no space is required before the slash; this is because command
7420 names in @value{GDBN} cannot contain a slash.
7421
7422 To reprint the last value in the value history with a different format,
7423 you can use the @code{print} command with just a format and no
7424 expression. For example, @samp{p/x} reprints the last value in hex.
7425
7426 @node Memory
7427 @section Examining Memory
7428
7429 You can use the command @code{x} (for ``examine'') to examine memory in
7430 any of several formats, independently of your program's data types.
7431
7432 @cindex examining memory
7433 @table @code
7434 @kindex x @r{(examine memory)}
7435 @item x/@var{nfu} @var{addr}
7436 @itemx x @var{addr}
7437 @itemx x
7438 Use the @code{x} command to examine memory.
7439 @end table
7440
7441 @var{n}, @var{f}, and @var{u} are all optional parameters that specify how
7442 much memory to display and how to format it; @var{addr} is an
7443 expression giving the address where you want to start displaying memory.
7444 If you use defaults for @var{nfu}, you need not type the slash @samp{/}.
7445 Several commands set convenient defaults for @var{addr}.
7446
7447 @table @r
7448 @item @var{n}, the repeat count
7449 The repeat count is a decimal integer; the default is 1. It specifies
7450 how much memory (counting by units @var{u}) to display.
7451 @c This really is **decimal**; unaffected by 'set radix' as of GDB
7452 @c 4.1.2.
7453
7454 @item @var{f}, the display format
7455 The display format is one of the formats used by @code{print}
7456 (@samp{x}, @samp{d}, @samp{u}, @samp{o}, @samp{t}, @samp{a}, @samp{c},
7457 @samp{f}, @samp{s}), and in addition @samp{i} (for machine instructions).
7458 The default is @samp{x} (hexadecimal) initially. The default changes
7459 each time you use either @code{x} or @code{print}.
7460
7461 @item @var{u}, the unit size
7462 The unit size is any of
7463
7464 @table @code
7465 @item b
7466 Bytes.
7467 @item h
7468 Halfwords (two bytes).
7469 @item w
7470 Words (four bytes). This is the initial default.
7471 @item g
7472 Giant words (eight bytes).
7473 @end table
7474
7475 Each time you specify a unit size with @code{x}, that size becomes the
7476 default unit the next time you use @code{x}. For the @samp{i} format,
7477 the unit size is ignored and is normally not written. For the @samp{s} format,
7478 the unit size defaults to @samp{b}, unless it is explicitly given.
7479 Use @kbd{x /hs} to display 16-bit char strings and @kbd{x /ws} to display
7480 32-bit strings. The next use of @kbd{x /s} will again display 8-bit strings.
7481 Note that the results depend on the programming language of the
7482 current compilation unit. If the language is C, the @samp{s}
7483 modifier will use the UTF-16 encoding while @samp{w} will use
7484 UTF-32. The encoding is set by the programming language and cannot
7485 be altered.
7486
7487 @item @var{addr}, starting display address
7488 @var{addr} is the address where you want @value{GDBN} to begin displaying
7489 memory. The expression need not have a pointer value (though it may);
7490 it is always interpreted as an integer address of a byte of memory.
7491 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}, for more information on expressions. The default for
7492 @var{addr} is usually just after the last address examined---but several
7493 other commands also set the default address: @code{info breakpoints} (to
7494 the address of the last breakpoint listed), @code{info line} (to the
7495 starting address of a line), and @code{print} (if you use it to display
7496 a value from memory).
7497 @end table
7498
7499 For example, @samp{x/3uh 0x54320} is a request to display three halfwords
7500 (@code{h}) of memory, formatted as unsigned decimal integers (@samp{u}),
7501 starting at address @code{0x54320}. @samp{x/4xw $sp} prints the four
7502 words (@samp{w}) of memory above the stack pointer (here, @samp{$sp};
7503 @pxref{Registers, ,Registers}) in hexadecimal (@samp{x}).
7504
7505 Since the letters indicating unit sizes are all distinct from the
7506 letters specifying output formats, you do not have to remember whether
7507 unit size or format comes first; either order works. The output
7508 specifications @samp{4xw} and @samp{4wx} mean exactly the same thing.
7509 (However, the count @var{n} must come first; @samp{wx4} does not work.)
7510
7511 Even though the unit size @var{u} is ignored for the formats @samp{s}
7512 and @samp{i}, you might still want to use a count @var{n}; for example,
7513 @samp{3i} specifies that you want to see three machine instructions,
7514 including any operands. For convenience, especially when used with
7515 the @code{display} command, the @samp{i} format also prints branch delay
7516 slot instructions, if any, beyond the count specified, which immediately
7517 follow the last instruction that is within the count. The command
7518 @code{disassemble} gives an alternative way of inspecting machine
7519 instructions; see @ref{Machine Code,,Source and Machine Code}.
7520
7521 All the defaults for the arguments to @code{x} are designed to make it
7522 easy to continue scanning memory with minimal specifications each time
7523 you use @code{x}. For example, after you have inspected three machine
7524 instructions with @samp{x/3i @var{addr}}, you can inspect the next seven
7525 with just @samp{x/7}. If you use @key{RET} to repeat the @code{x} command,
7526 the repeat count @var{n} is used again; the other arguments default as
7527 for successive uses of @code{x}.
7528
7529 When examining machine instructions, the instruction at current program
7530 counter is shown with a @code{=>} marker. For example:
7531
7532 @smallexample
7533 (@value{GDBP}) x/5i $pc-6
7534 0x804837f <main+11>: mov %esp,%ebp
7535 0x8048381 <main+13>: push %ecx
7536 0x8048382 <main+14>: sub $0x4,%esp
7537 => 0x8048385 <main+17>: movl $0x8048460,(%esp)
7538 0x804838c <main+24>: call 0x80482d4 <puts@@plt>
7539 @end smallexample
7540
7541 @cindex @code{$_}, @code{$__}, and value history
7542 The addresses and contents printed by the @code{x} command are not saved
7543 in the value history because there is often too much of them and they
7544 would get in the way. Instead, @value{GDBN} makes these values available for
7545 subsequent use in expressions as values of the convenience variables
7546 @code{$_} and @code{$__}. After an @code{x} command, the last address
7547 examined is available for use in expressions in the convenience variable
7548 @code{$_}. The contents of that address, as examined, are available in
7549 the convenience variable @code{$__}.
7550
7551 If the @code{x} command has a repeat count, the address and contents saved
7552 are from the last memory unit printed; this is not the same as the last
7553 address printed if several units were printed on the last line of output.
7554
7555 @cindex remote memory comparison
7556 @cindex verify remote memory image
7557 When you are debugging a program running on a remote target machine
7558 (@pxref{Remote Debugging}), you may wish to verify the program's image in the
7559 remote machine's memory against the executable file you downloaded to
7560 the target. The @code{compare-sections} command is provided for such
7561 situations.
7562
7563 @table @code
7564 @kindex compare-sections
7565 @item compare-sections @r{[}@var{section-name}@r{]}
7566 Compare the data of a loadable section @var{section-name} in the
7567 executable file of the program being debugged with the same section in
7568 the remote machine's memory, and report any mismatches. With no
7569 arguments, compares all loadable sections. This command's
7570 availability depends on the target's support for the @code{"qCRC"}
7571 remote request.
7572 @end table
7573
7574 @node Auto Display
7575 @section Automatic Display
7576 @cindex automatic display
7577 @cindex display of expressions
7578
7579 If you find that you want to print the value of an expression frequently
7580 (to see how it changes), you might want to add it to the @dfn{automatic
7581 display list} so that @value{GDBN} prints its value each time your program stops.
7582 Each expression added to the list is given a number to identify it;
7583 to remove an expression from the list, you specify that number.
7584 The automatic display looks like this:
7585
7586 @smallexample
7587 2: foo = 38
7588 3: bar[5] = (struct hack *) 0x3804
7589 @end smallexample
7590
7591 @noindent
7592 This display shows item numbers, expressions and their current values. As with
7593 displays you request manually using @code{x} or @code{print}, you can
7594 specify the output format you prefer; in fact, @code{display} decides
7595 whether to use @code{print} or @code{x} depending your format
7596 specification---it uses @code{x} if you specify either the @samp{i}
7597 or @samp{s} format, or a unit size; otherwise it uses @code{print}.
7598
7599 @table @code
7600 @kindex display
7601 @item display @var{expr}
7602 Add the expression @var{expr} to the list of expressions to display
7603 each time your program stops. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
7604
7605 @code{display} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after using it.
7606
7607 @item display/@var{fmt} @var{expr}
7608 For @var{fmt} specifying only a display format and not a size or
7609 count, add the expression @var{expr} to the auto-display list but
7610 arrange to display it each time in the specified format @var{fmt}.
7611 @xref{Output Formats,,Output Formats}.
7612
7613 @item display/@var{fmt} @var{addr}
7614 For @var{fmt} @samp{i} or @samp{s}, or including a unit-size or a
7615 number of units, add the expression @var{addr} as a memory address to
7616 be examined each time your program stops. Examining means in effect
7617 doing @samp{x/@var{fmt} @var{addr}}. @xref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}.
7618 @end table
7619
7620 For example, @samp{display/i $pc} can be helpful, to see the machine
7621 instruction about to be executed each time execution stops (@samp{$pc}
7622 is a common name for the program counter; @pxref{Registers, ,Registers}).
7623
7624 @table @code
7625 @kindex delete display
7626 @kindex undisplay
7627 @item undisplay @var{dnums}@dots{}
7628 @itemx delete display @var{dnums}@dots{}
7629 Remove item numbers @var{dnums} from the list of expressions to display.
7630
7631 @code{undisplay} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
7632 (Otherwise you would just get the error @samp{No display number @dots{}}.)
7633
7634 @kindex disable display
7635 @item disable display @var{dnums}@dots{}
7636 Disable the display of item numbers @var{dnums}. A disabled display
7637 item is not printed automatically, but is not forgotten. It may be
7638 enabled again later.
7639
7640 @kindex enable display
7641 @item enable display @var{dnums}@dots{}
7642 Enable display of item numbers @var{dnums}. It becomes effective once
7643 again in auto display of its expression, until you specify otherwise.
7644
7645 @item display
7646 Display the current values of the expressions on the list, just as is
7647 done when your program stops.
7648
7649 @kindex info display
7650 @item info display
7651 Print the list of expressions previously set up to display
7652 automatically, each one with its item number, but without showing the
7653 values. This includes disabled expressions, which are marked as such.
7654 It also includes expressions which would not be displayed right now
7655 because they refer to automatic variables not currently available.
7656 @end table
7657
7658 @cindex display disabled out of scope
7659 If a display expression refers to local variables, then it does not make
7660 sense outside the lexical context for which it was set up. Such an
7661 expression is disabled when execution enters a context where one of its
7662 variables is not defined. For example, if you give the command
7663 @code{display last_char} while inside a function with an argument
7664 @code{last_char}, @value{GDBN} displays this argument while your program
7665 continues to stop inside that function. When it stops elsewhere---where
7666 there is no variable @code{last_char}---the display is disabled
7667 automatically. The next time your program stops where @code{last_char}
7668 is meaningful, you can enable the display expression once again.
7669
7670 @node Print Settings
7671 @section Print Settings
7672
7673 @cindex format options
7674 @cindex print settings
7675 @value{GDBN} provides the following ways to control how arrays, structures,
7676 and symbols are printed.
7677
7678 @noindent
7679 These settings are useful for debugging programs in any language:
7680
7681 @table @code
7682 @kindex set print
7683 @item set print address
7684 @itemx set print address on
7685 @cindex print/don't print memory addresses
7686 @value{GDBN} prints memory addresses showing the location of stack
7687 traces, structure values, pointer values, breakpoints, and so forth,
7688 even when it also displays the contents of those addresses. The default
7689 is @code{on}. For example, this is what a stack frame display looks like with
7690 @code{set print address on}:
7691
7692 @smallexample
7693 @group
7694 (@value{GDBP}) f
7695 #0 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<<", rq=0x34c88 ">>")
7696 at input.c:530
7697 530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
7698 @end group
7699 @end smallexample
7700
7701 @item set print address off
7702 Do not print addresses when displaying their contents. For example,
7703 this is the same stack frame displayed with @code{set print address off}:
7704
7705 @smallexample
7706 @group
7707 (@value{GDBP}) set print addr off
7708 (@value{GDBP}) f
7709 #0 set_quotes (lq="<<", rq=">>") at input.c:530
7710 530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
7711 @end group
7712 @end smallexample
7713
7714 You can use @samp{set print address off} to eliminate all machine
7715 dependent displays from the @value{GDBN} interface. For example, with
7716 @code{print address off}, you should get the same text for backtraces on
7717 all machines---whether or not they involve pointer arguments.
7718
7719 @kindex show print
7720 @item show print address
7721 Show whether or not addresses are to be printed.
7722 @end table
7723
7724 When @value{GDBN} prints a symbolic address, it normally prints the
7725 closest earlier symbol plus an offset. If that symbol does not uniquely
7726 identify the address (for example, it is a name whose scope is a single
7727 source file), you may need to clarify. One way to do this is with
7728 @code{info line}, for example @samp{info line *0x4537}. Alternately,
7729 you can set @value{GDBN} to print the source file and line number when
7730 it prints a symbolic address:
7731
7732 @table @code
7733 @item set print symbol-filename on
7734 @cindex source file and line of a symbol
7735 @cindex symbol, source file and line
7736 Tell @value{GDBN} to print the source file name and line number of a
7737 symbol in the symbolic form of an address.
7738
7739 @item set print symbol-filename off
7740 Do not print source file name and line number of a symbol. This is the
7741 default.
7742
7743 @item show print symbol-filename
7744 Show whether or not @value{GDBN} will print the source file name and
7745 line number of a symbol in the symbolic form of an address.
7746 @end table
7747
7748 Another situation where it is helpful to show symbol filenames and line
7749 numbers is when disassembling code; @value{GDBN} shows you the line
7750 number and source file that corresponds to each instruction.
7751
7752 Also, you may wish to see the symbolic form only if the address being
7753 printed is reasonably close to the closest earlier symbol:
7754
7755 @table @code
7756 @item set print max-symbolic-offset @var{max-offset}
7757 @cindex maximum value for offset of closest symbol
7758 Tell @value{GDBN} to only display the symbolic form of an address if the
7759 offset between the closest earlier symbol and the address is less than
7760 @var{max-offset}. The default is 0, which tells @value{GDBN}
7761 to always print the symbolic form of an address if any symbol precedes it.
7762
7763 @item show print max-symbolic-offset
7764 Ask how large the maximum offset is that @value{GDBN} prints in a
7765 symbolic address.
7766 @end table
7767
7768 @cindex wild pointer, interpreting
7769 @cindex pointer, finding referent
7770 If you have a pointer and you are not sure where it points, try
7771 @samp{set print symbol-filename on}. Then you can determine the name
7772 and source file location of the variable where it points, using
7773 @samp{p/a @var{pointer}}. This interprets the address in symbolic form.
7774 For example, here @value{GDBN} shows that a variable @code{ptt} points
7775 at another variable @code{t}, defined in @file{hi2.c}:
7776
7777 @smallexample
7778 (@value{GDBP}) set print symbol-filename on
7779 (@value{GDBP}) p/a ptt
7780 $4 = 0xe008 <t in hi2.c>
7781 @end smallexample
7782
7783 @quotation
7784 @emph{Warning:} For pointers that point to a local variable, @samp{p/a}
7785 does not show the symbol name and filename of the referent, even with
7786 the appropriate @code{set print} options turned on.
7787 @end quotation
7788
7789 Other settings control how different kinds of objects are printed:
7790
7791 @table @code
7792 @item set print array
7793 @itemx set print array on
7794 @cindex pretty print arrays
7795 Pretty print arrays. This format is more convenient to read,
7796 but uses more space. The default is off.
7797
7798 @item set print array off
7799 Return to compressed format for arrays.
7800
7801 @item show print array
7802 Show whether compressed or pretty format is selected for displaying
7803 arrays.
7804
7805 @cindex print array indexes
7806 @item set print array-indexes
7807 @itemx set print array-indexes on
7808 Print the index of each element when displaying arrays. May be more
7809 convenient to locate a given element in the array or quickly find the
7810 index of a given element in that printed array. The default is off.
7811
7812 @item set print array-indexes off
7813 Stop printing element indexes when displaying arrays.
7814
7815 @item show print array-indexes
7816 Show whether the index of each element is printed when displaying
7817 arrays.
7818
7819 @item set print elements @var{number-of-elements}
7820 @cindex number of array elements to print
7821 @cindex limit on number of printed array elements
7822 Set a limit on how many elements of an array @value{GDBN} will print.
7823 If @value{GDBN} is printing a large array, it stops printing after it has
7824 printed the number of elements set by the @code{set print elements} command.
7825 This limit also applies to the display of strings.
7826 When @value{GDBN} starts, this limit is set to 200.
7827 Setting @var{number-of-elements} to zero means that the printing is unlimited.
7828
7829 @item show print elements
7830 Display the number of elements of a large array that @value{GDBN} will print.
7831 If the number is 0, then the printing is unlimited.
7832
7833 @item set print frame-arguments @var{value}
7834 @kindex set print frame-arguments
7835 @cindex printing frame argument values
7836 @cindex print all frame argument values
7837 @cindex print frame argument values for scalars only
7838 @cindex do not print frame argument values
7839 This command allows to control how the values of arguments are printed
7840 when the debugger prints a frame (@pxref{Frames}). The possible
7841 values are:
7842
7843 @table @code
7844 @item all
7845 The values of all arguments are printed.
7846
7847 @item scalars
7848 Print the value of an argument only if it is a scalar. The value of more
7849 complex arguments such as arrays, structures, unions, etc, is replaced
7850 by @code{@dots{}}. This is the default. Here is an example where
7851 only scalar arguments are shown:
7852
7853 @smallexample
7854 #1 0x08048361 in call_me (i=3, s=@dots{}, ss=0xbf8d508c, u=@dots{}, e=green)
7855 at frame-args.c:23
7856 @end smallexample
7857
7858 @item none
7859 None of the argument values are printed. Instead, the value of each argument
7860 is replaced by @code{@dots{}}. In this case, the example above now becomes:
7861
7862 @smallexample
7863 #1 0x08048361 in call_me (i=@dots{}, s=@dots{}, ss=@dots{}, u=@dots{}, e=@dots{})
7864 at frame-args.c:23
7865 @end smallexample
7866 @end table
7867
7868 By default, only scalar arguments are printed. This command can be used
7869 to configure the debugger to print the value of all arguments, regardless
7870 of their type. However, it is often advantageous to not print the value
7871 of more complex parameters. For instance, it reduces the amount of
7872 information printed in each frame, making the backtrace more readable.
7873 Also, it improves performance when displaying Ada frames, because
7874 the computation of large arguments can sometimes be CPU-intensive,
7875 especially in large applications. Setting @code{print frame-arguments}
7876 to @code{scalars} (the default) or @code{none} avoids this computation,
7877 thus speeding up the display of each Ada frame.
7878
7879 @item show print frame-arguments
7880 Show how the value of arguments should be displayed when printing a frame.
7881
7882 @item set print repeats
7883 @cindex repeated array elements
7884 Set the threshold for suppressing display of repeated array
7885 elements. When the number of consecutive identical elements of an
7886 array exceeds the threshold, @value{GDBN} prints the string
7887 @code{"<repeats @var{n} times>"}, where @var{n} is the number of
7888 identical repetitions, instead of displaying the identical elements
7889 themselves. Setting the threshold to zero will cause all elements to
7890 be individually printed. The default threshold is 10.
7891
7892 @item show print repeats
7893 Display the current threshold for printing repeated identical
7894 elements.
7895
7896 @item set print null-stop
7897 @cindex @sc{null} elements in arrays
7898 Cause @value{GDBN} to stop printing the characters of an array when the first
7899 @sc{null} is encountered. This is useful when large arrays actually
7900 contain only short strings.
7901 The default is off.
7902
7903 @item show print null-stop
7904 Show whether @value{GDBN} stops printing an array on the first
7905 @sc{null} character.
7906
7907 @item set print pretty on
7908 @cindex print structures in indented form
7909 @cindex indentation in structure display
7910 Cause @value{GDBN} to print structures in an indented format with one member
7911 per line, like this:
7912
7913 @smallexample
7914 @group
7915 $1 = @{
7916 next = 0x0,
7917 flags = @{
7918 sweet = 1,
7919 sour = 1
7920 @},
7921 meat = 0x54 "Pork"
7922 @}
7923 @end group
7924 @end smallexample
7925
7926 @item set print pretty off
7927 Cause @value{GDBN} to print structures in a compact format, like this:
7928
7929 @smallexample
7930 @group
7931 $1 = @{next = 0x0, flags = @{sweet = 1, sour = 1@}, \
7932 meat = 0x54 "Pork"@}
7933 @end group
7934 @end smallexample
7935
7936 @noindent
7937 This is the default format.
7938
7939 @item show print pretty
7940 Show which format @value{GDBN} is using to print structures.
7941
7942 @item set print sevenbit-strings on
7943 @cindex eight-bit characters in strings
7944 @cindex octal escapes in strings
7945 Print using only seven-bit characters; if this option is set,
7946 @value{GDBN} displays any eight-bit characters (in strings or
7947 character values) using the notation @code{\}@var{nnn}. This setting is
7948 best if you are working in English (@sc{ascii}) and you use the
7949 high-order bit of characters as a marker or ``meta'' bit.
7950
7951 @item set print sevenbit-strings off
7952 Print full eight-bit characters. This allows the use of more
7953 international character sets, and is the default.
7954
7955 @item show print sevenbit-strings
7956 Show whether or not @value{GDBN} is printing only seven-bit characters.
7957
7958 @item set print union on
7959 @cindex unions in structures, printing
7960 Tell @value{GDBN} to print unions which are contained in structures
7961 and other unions. This is the default setting.
7962
7963 @item set print union off
7964 Tell @value{GDBN} not to print unions which are contained in
7965 structures and other unions. @value{GDBN} will print @code{"@{...@}"}
7966 instead.
7967
7968 @item show print union
7969 Ask @value{GDBN} whether or not it will print unions which are contained in
7970 structures and other unions.
7971
7972 For example, given the declarations
7973
7974 @smallexample
7975 typedef enum @{Tree, Bug@} Species;
7976 typedef enum @{Big_tree, Acorn, Seedling@} Tree_forms;
7977 typedef enum @{Caterpillar, Cocoon, Butterfly@}
7978 Bug_forms;
7979
7980 struct thing @{
7981 Species it;
7982 union @{
7983 Tree_forms tree;
7984 Bug_forms bug;
7985 @} form;
7986 @};
7987
7988 struct thing foo = @{Tree, @{Acorn@}@};
7989 @end smallexample
7990
7991 @noindent
7992 with @code{set print union on} in effect @samp{p foo} would print
7993
7994 @smallexample
7995 $1 = @{it = Tree, form = @{tree = Acorn, bug = Cocoon@}@}
7996 @end smallexample
7997
7998 @noindent
7999 and with @code{set print union off} in effect it would print
8000
8001 @smallexample
8002 $1 = @{it = Tree, form = @{...@}@}
8003 @end smallexample
8004
8005 @noindent
8006 @code{set print union} affects programs written in C-like languages
8007 and in Pascal.
8008 @end table
8009
8010 @need 1000
8011 @noindent
8012 These settings are of interest when debugging C@t{++} programs:
8013
8014 @table @code
8015 @cindex demangling C@t{++} names
8016 @item set print demangle
8017 @itemx set print demangle on
8018 Print C@t{++} names in their source form rather than in the encoded
8019 (``mangled'') form passed to the assembler and linker for type-safe
8020 linkage. The default is on.
8021
8022 @item show print demangle
8023 Show whether C@t{++} names are printed in mangled or demangled form.
8024
8025 @item set print asm-demangle
8026 @itemx set print asm-demangle on
8027 Print C@t{++} names in their source form rather than their mangled form, even
8028 in assembler code printouts such as instruction disassemblies.
8029 The default is off.
8030
8031 @item show print asm-demangle
8032 Show whether C@t{++} names in assembly listings are printed in mangled
8033 or demangled form.
8034
8035 @cindex C@t{++} symbol decoding style
8036 @cindex symbol decoding style, C@t{++}
8037 @kindex set demangle-style
8038 @item set demangle-style @var{style}
8039 Choose among several encoding schemes used by different compilers to
8040 represent C@t{++} names. The choices for @var{style} are currently:
8041
8042 @table @code
8043 @item auto
8044 Allow @value{GDBN} to choose a decoding style by inspecting your program.
8045
8046 @item gnu
8047 Decode based on the @sc{gnu} C@t{++} compiler (@code{g++}) encoding algorithm.
8048 This is the default.
8049
8050 @item hp
8051 Decode based on the HP ANSI C@t{++} (@code{aCC}) encoding algorithm.
8052
8053 @item lucid
8054 Decode based on the Lucid C@t{++} compiler (@code{lcc}) encoding algorithm.
8055
8056 @item arm
8057 Decode using the algorithm in the @cite{C@t{++} Annotated Reference Manual}.
8058 @strong{Warning:} this setting alone is not sufficient to allow
8059 debugging @code{cfront}-generated executables. @value{GDBN} would
8060 require further enhancement to permit that.
8061
8062 @end table
8063 If you omit @var{style}, you will see a list of possible formats.
8064
8065 @item show demangle-style
8066 Display the encoding style currently in use for decoding C@t{++} symbols.
8067
8068 @item set print object
8069 @itemx set print object on
8070 @cindex derived type of an object, printing
8071 @cindex display derived types
8072 When displaying a pointer to an object, identify the @emph{actual}
8073 (derived) type of the object rather than the @emph{declared} type, using
8074 the virtual function table.
8075
8076 @item set print object off
8077 Display only the declared type of objects, without reference to the
8078 virtual function table. This is the default setting.
8079
8080 @item show print object
8081 Show whether actual, or declared, object types are displayed.
8082
8083 @item set print static-members
8084 @itemx set print static-members on
8085 @cindex static members of C@t{++} objects
8086 Print static members when displaying a C@t{++} object. The default is on.
8087
8088 @item set print static-members off
8089 Do not print static members when displaying a C@t{++} object.
8090
8091 @item show print static-members
8092 Show whether C@t{++} static members are printed or not.
8093
8094 @item set print pascal_static-members
8095 @itemx set print pascal_static-members on
8096 @cindex static members of Pascal objects
8097 @cindex Pascal objects, static members display
8098 Print static members when displaying a Pascal object. The default is on.
8099
8100 @item set print pascal_static-members off
8101 Do not print static members when displaying a Pascal object.
8102
8103 @item show print pascal_static-members
8104 Show whether Pascal static members are printed or not.
8105
8106 @c These don't work with HP ANSI C++ yet.
8107 @item set print vtbl
8108 @itemx set print vtbl on
8109 @cindex pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables
8110 @cindex virtual functions (C@t{++}) display
8111 @cindex VTBL display
8112 Pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables. The default is off.
8113 (The @code{vtbl} commands do not work on programs compiled with the HP
8114 ANSI C@t{++} compiler (@code{aCC}).)
8115
8116 @item set print vtbl off
8117 Do not pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables.
8118
8119 @item show print vtbl
8120 Show whether C@t{++} virtual function tables are pretty printed, or not.
8121 @end table
8122
8123 @node Pretty Printing
8124 @section Pretty Printing
8125
8126 @value{GDBN} provides a mechanism to allow pretty-printing of values using
8127 Python code. It greatly simplifies the display of complex objects. This
8128 mechanism works for both MI and the CLI.
8129
8130 @menu
8131 * Pretty-Printer Introduction:: Introduction to pretty-printers
8132 * Pretty-Printer Example:: An example pretty-printer
8133 * Pretty-Printer Commands:: Pretty-printer commands
8134 @end menu
8135
8136 @node Pretty-Printer Introduction
8137 @subsection Pretty-Printer Introduction
8138
8139 When @value{GDBN} prints a value, it first sees if there is a pretty-printer
8140 registered for the value. If there is then @value{GDBN} invokes the
8141 pretty-printer to print the value. Otherwise the value is printed normally.
8142
8143 Pretty-printers are normally named. This makes them easy to manage.
8144 The @samp{info pretty-printer} command will list all the installed
8145 pretty-printers with their names.
8146 If a pretty-printer can handle multiple data types, then its
8147 @dfn{subprinters} are the printers for the individual data types.
8148 Each such subprinter has its own name.
8149 The format of the name is @var{printer-name};@var{subprinter-name}.
8150
8151 Pretty-printers are installed by @dfn{registering} them with @value{GDBN}.
8152 Typically they are automatically loaded and registered when the corresponding
8153 debug information is loaded, thus making them available without having to
8154 do anything special.
8155
8156 There are three places where a pretty-printer can be registered.
8157
8158 @itemize @bullet
8159 @item
8160 Pretty-printers registered globally are available when debugging
8161 all inferiors.
8162
8163 @item
8164 Pretty-printers registered with a program space are available only
8165 when debugging that program.
8166 @xref{Progspaces In Python}, for more details on program spaces in Python.
8167
8168 @item
8169 Pretty-printers registered with an objfile are loaded and unloaded
8170 with the corresponding objfile (e.g., shared library).
8171 @xref{Objfiles In Python}, for more details on objfiles in Python.
8172 @end itemize
8173
8174 @xref{Selecting Pretty-Printers}, for further information on how
8175 pretty-printers are selected,
8176
8177 @xref{Writing a Pretty-Printer}, for implementing pretty printers
8178 for new types.
8179
8180 @node Pretty-Printer Example
8181 @subsection Pretty-Printer Example
8182
8183 Here is how a C@t{++} @code{std::string} looks without a pretty-printer:
8184
8185 @smallexample
8186 (@value{GDBP}) print s
8187 $1 = @{
8188 static npos = 4294967295,
8189 _M_dataplus = @{
8190 <std::allocator<char>> = @{
8191 <__gnu_cxx::new_allocator<char>> = @{
8192 <No data fields>@}, <No data fields>
8193 @},
8194 members of std::basic_string<char, std::char_traits<char>,
8195 std::allocator<char> >::_Alloc_hider:
8196 _M_p = 0x804a014 "abcd"
8197 @}
8198 @}
8199 @end smallexample
8200
8201 With a pretty-printer for @code{std::string} only the contents are printed:
8202
8203 @smallexample
8204 (@value{GDBP}) print s
8205 $2 = "abcd"
8206 @end smallexample
8207
8208 @node Pretty-Printer Commands
8209 @subsection Pretty-Printer Commands
8210 @cindex pretty-printer commands
8211
8212 @table @code
8213 @kindex info pretty-printer
8214 @item info pretty-printer [@var{object-regexp} [@var{name-regexp}]]
8215 Print the list of installed pretty-printers.
8216 This includes disabled pretty-printers, which are marked as such.
8217
8218 @var{object-regexp} is a regular expression matching the objects
8219 whose pretty-printers to list.
8220 Objects can be @code{global}, the program space's file
8221 (@pxref{Progspaces In Python}),
8222 and the object files within that program space (@pxref{Objfiles In Python}).
8223 @xref{Selecting Pretty-Printers}, for details on how @value{GDBN}
8224 looks up a printer from these three objects.
8225
8226 @var{name-regexp} is a regular expression matching the name of the printers
8227 to list.
8228
8229 @kindex disable pretty-printer
8230 @item disable pretty-printer [@var{object-regexp} [@var{name-regexp}]]
8231 Disable pretty-printers matching @var{object-regexp} and @var{name-regexp}.
8232 A disabled pretty-printer is not forgotten, it may be enabled again later.
8233
8234 @kindex enable pretty-printer
8235 @item enable pretty-printer [@var{object-regexp} [@var{name-regexp}]]
8236 Enable pretty-printers matching @var{object-regexp} and @var{name-regexp}.
8237 @end table
8238
8239 Example:
8240
8241 Suppose we have three pretty-printers installed: one from library1.so
8242 named @code{foo} that prints objects of type @code{foo}, and
8243 another from library2.so named @code{bar} that prints two types of objects,
8244 @code{bar1} and @code{bar2}.
8245
8246 @smallexample
8247 (gdb) info pretty-printer
8248 library1.so:
8249 foo
8250 library2.so:
8251 bar
8252 bar1
8253 bar2
8254 (gdb) info pretty-printer library2
8255 library2.so:
8256 bar
8257 bar1
8258 bar2
8259 (gdb) disable pretty-printer library1
8260 1 printer disabled
8261 2 of 3 printers enabled
8262 (gdb) info pretty-printer
8263 library1.so:
8264 foo [disabled]
8265 library2.so:
8266 bar
8267 bar1
8268 bar2
8269 (gdb) disable pretty-printer library2 bar:bar1
8270 1 printer disabled
8271 1 of 3 printers enabled
8272 (gdb) info pretty-printer library2
8273 library1.so:
8274 foo [disabled]
8275 library2.so:
8276 bar
8277 bar1 [disabled]
8278 bar2
8279 (gdb) disable pretty-printer library2 bar
8280 1 printer disabled
8281 0 of 3 printers enabled
8282 (gdb) info pretty-printer library2
8283 library1.so:
8284 foo [disabled]
8285 library2.so:
8286 bar [disabled]
8287 bar1 [disabled]
8288 bar2
8289 @end smallexample
8290
8291 Note that for @code{bar} the entire printer can be disabled,
8292 as can each individual subprinter.
8293
8294 @node Value History
8295 @section Value History
8296
8297 @cindex value history
8298 @cindex history of values printed by @value{GDBN}
8299 Values printed by the @code{print} command are saved in the @value{GDBN}
8300 @dfn{value history}. This allows you to refer to them in other expressions.
8301 Values are kept until the symbol table is re-read or discarded
8302 (for example with the @code{file} or @code{symbol-file} commands).
8303 When the symbol table changes, the value history is discarded,
8304 since the values may contain pointers back to the types defined in the
8305 symbol table.
8306
8307 @cindex @code{$}
8308 @cindex @code{$$}
8309 @cindex history number
8310 The values printed are given @dfn{history numbers} by which you can
8311 refer to them. These are successive integers starting with one.
8312 @code{print} shows you the history number assigned to a value by
8313 printing @samp{$@var{num} = } before the value; here @var{num} is the
8314 history number.
8315
8316 To refer to any previous value, use @samp{$} followed by the value's
8317 history number. The way @code{print} labels its output is designed to
8318 remind you of this. Just @code{$} refers to the most recent value in
8319 the history, and @code{$$} refers to the value before that.
8320 @code{$$@var{n}} refers to the @var{n}th value from the end; @code{$$2}
8321 is the value just prior to @code{$$}, @code{$$1} is equivalent to
8322 @code{$$}, and @code{$$0} is equivalent to @code{$}.
8323
8324 For example, suppose you have just printed a pointer to a structure and
8325 want to see the contents of the structure. It suffices to type
8326
8327 @smallexample
8328 p *$
8329 @end smallexample
8330
8331 If you have a chain of structures where the component @code{next} points
8332 to the next one, you can print the contents of the next one with this:
8333
8334 @smallexample
8335 p *$.next
8336 @end smallexample
8337
8338 @noindent
8339 You can print successive links in the chain by repeating this
8340 command---which you can do by just typing @key{RET}.
8341
8342 Note that the history records values, not expressions. If the value of
8343 @code{x} is 4 and you type these commands:
8344
8345 @smallexample
8346 print x
8347 set x=5
8348 @end smallexample
8349
8350 @noindent
8351 then the value recorded in the value history by the @code{print} command
8352 remains 4 even though the value of @code{x} has changed.
8353
8354 @table @code
8355 @kindex show values
8356 @item show values
8357 Print the last ten values in the value history, with their item numbers.
8358 This is like @samp{p@ $$9} repeated ten times, except that @code{show
8359 values} does not change the history.
8360
8361 @item show values @var{n}
8362 Print ten history values centered on history item number @var{n}.
8363
8364 @item show values +
8365 Print ten history values just after the values last printed. If no more
8366 values are available, @code{show values +} produces no display.
8367 @end table
8368
8369 Pressing @key{RET} to repeat @code{show values @var{n}} has exactly the
8370 same effect as @samp{show values +}.
8371
8372 @node Convenience Vars
8373 @section Convenience Variables
8374
8375 @cindex convenience variables
8376 @cindex user-defined variables
8377 @value{GDBN} provides @dfn{convenience variables} that you can use within
8378 @value{GDBN} to hold on to a value and refer to it later. These variables
8379 exist entirely within @value{GDBN}; they are not part of your program, and
8380 setting a convenience variable has no direct effect on further execution
8381 of your program. That is why you can use them freely.
8382
8383 Convenience variables are prefixed with @samp{$}. Any name preceded by
8384 @samp{$} can be used for a convenience variable, unless it is one of
8385 the predefined machine-specific register names (@pxref{Registers, ,Registers}).
8386 (Value history references, in contrast, are @emph{numbers} preceded
8387 by @samp{$}. @xref{Value History, ,Value History}.)
8388
8389 You can save a value in a convenience variable with an assignment
8390 expression, just as you would set a variable in your program.
8391 For example:
8392
8393 @smallexample
8394 set $foo = *object_ptr
8395 @end smallexample
8396
8397 @noindent
8398 would save in @code{$foo} the value contained in the object pointed to by
8399 @code{object_ptr}.
8400
8401 Using a convenience variable for the first time creates it, but its
8402 value is @code{void} until you assign a new value. You can alter the
8403 value with another assignment at any time.
8404
8405 Convenience variables have no fixed types. You can assign a convenience
8406 variable any type of value, including structures and arrays, even if
8407 that variable already has a value of a different type. The convenience
8408 variable, when used as an expression, has the type of its current value.
8409
8410 @table @code
8411 @kindex show convenience
8412 @cindex show all user variables
8413 @item show convenience
8414 Print a list of convenience variables used so far, and their values.
8415 Abbreviated @code{show conv}.
8416
8417 @kindex init-if-undefined
8418 @cindex convenience variables, initializing
8419 @item init-if-undefined $@var{variable} = @var{expression}
8420 Set a convenience variable if it has not already been set. This is useful
8421 for user-defined commands that keep some state. It is similar, in concept,
8422 to using local static variables with initializers in C (except that
8423 convenience variables are global). It can also be used to allow users to
8424 override default values used in a command script.
8425
8426 If the variable is already defined then the expression is not evaluated so
8427 any side-effects do not occur.
8428 @end table
8429
8430 One of the ways to use a convenience variable is as a counter to be
8431 incremented or a pointer to be advanced. For example, to print
8432 a field from successive elements of an array of structures:
8433
8434 @smallexample
8435 set $i = 0
8436 print bar[$i++]->contents
8437 @end smallexample
8438
8439 @noindent
8440 Repeat that command by typing @key{RET}.
8441
8442 Some convenience variables are created automatically by @value{GDBN} and given
8443 values likely to be useful.
8444
8445 @table @code
8446 @vindex $_@r{, convenience variable}
8447 @item $_
8448 The variable @code{$_} is automatically set by the @code{x} command to
8449 the last address examined (@pxref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}). Other
8450 commands which provide a default address for @code{x} to examine also
8451 set @code{$_} to that address; these commands include @code{info line}
8452 and @code{info breakpoint}. The type of @code{$_} is @code{void *}
8453 except when set by the @code{x} command, in which case it is a pointer
8454 to the type of @code{$__}.
8455
8456 @vindex $__@r{, convenience variable}
8457 @item $__
8458 The variable @code{$__} is automatically set by the @code{x} command
8459 to the value found in the last address examined. Its type is chosen
8460 to match the format in which the data was printed.
8461
8462 @item $_exitcode
8463 @vindex $_exitcode@r{, convenience variable}
8464 The variable @code{$_exitcode} is automatically set to the exit code when
8465 the program being debugged terminates.
8466
8467 @item $_sdata
8468 @vindex $_sdata@r{, inspect, convenience variable}
8469 The variable @code{$_sdata} contains extra collected static tracepoint
8470 data. @xref{Tracepoint Actions,,Tracepoint Action Lists}. Note that
8471 @code{$_sdata} could be empty, if not inspecting a trace buffer, or
8472 if extra static tracepoint data has not been collected.
8473
8474 @item $_siginfo
8475 @vindex $_siginfo@r{, convenience variable}
8476 The variable @code{$_siginfo} contains extra signal information
8477 (@pxref{extra signal information}). Note that @code{$_siginfo}
8478 could be empty, if the application has not yet received any signals.
8479 For example, it will be empty before you execute the @code{run} command.
8480
8481 @item $_tlb
8482 @vindex $_tlb@r{, convenience variable}
8483 The variable @code{$_tlb} is automatically set when debugging
8484 applications running on MS-Windows in native mode or connected to
8485 gdbserver that supports the @code{qGetTIBAddr} request.
8486 @xref{General Query Packets}.
8487 This variable contains the address of the thread information block.
8488
8489 @end table
8490
8491 On HP-UX systems, if you refer to a function or variable name that
8492 begins with a dollar sign, @value{GDBN} searches for a user or system
8493 name first, before it searches for a convenience variable.
8494
8495 @cindex convenience functions
8496 @value{GDBN} also supplies some @dfn{convenience functions}. These
8497 have a syntax similar to convenience variables. A convenience
8498 function can be used in an expression just like an ordinary function;
8499 however, a convenience function is implemented internally to
8500 @value{GDBN}.
8501
8502 @table @code
8503 @item help function
8504 @kindex help function
8505 @cindex show all convenience functions
8506 Print a list of all convenience functions.
8507 @end table
8508
8509 @node Registers
8510 @section Registers
8511
8512 @cindex registers
8513 You can refer to machine register contents, in expressions, as variables
8514 with names starting with @samp{$}. The names of registers are different
8515 for each machine; use @code{info registers} to see the names used on
8516 your machine.
8517
8518 @table @code
8519 @kindex info registers
8520 @item info registers
8521 Print the names and values of all registers except floating-point
8522 and vector registers (in the selected stack frame).
8523
8524 @kindex info all-registers
8525 @cindex floating point registers
8526 @item info all-registers
8527 Print the names and values of all registers, including floating-point
8528 and vector registers (in the selected stack frame).
8529
8530 @item info registers @var{regname} @dots{}
8531 Print the @dfn{relativized} value of each specified register @var{regname}.
8532 As discussed in detail below, register values are normally relative to
8533 the selected stack frame. @var{regname} may be any register name valid on
8534 the machine you are using, with or without the initial @samp{$}.
8535 @end table
8536
8537 @cindex stack pointer register
8538 @cindex program counter register
8539 @cindex process status register
8540 @cindex frame pointer register
8541 @cindex standard registers
8542 @value{GDBN} has four ``standard'' register names that are available (in
8543 expressions) on most machines---whenever they do not conflict with an
8544 architecture's canonical mnemonics for registers. The register names
8545 @code{$pc} and @code{$sp} are used for the program counter register and
8546 the stack pointer. @code{$fp} is used for a register that contains a
8547 pointer to the current stack frame, and @code{$ps} is used for a
8548 register that contains the processor status. For example,
8549 you could print the program counter in hex with
8550
8551 @smallexample
8552 p/x $pc
8553 @end smallexample
8554
8555 @noindent
8556 or print the instruction to be executed next with
8557
8558 @smallexample
8559 x/i $pc
8560 @end smallexample
8561
8562 @noindent
8563 or add four to the stack pointer@footnote{This is a way of removing
8564 one word from the stack, on machines where stacks grow downward in
8565 memory (most machines, nowadays). This assumes that the innermost
8566 stack frame is selected; setting @code{$sp} is not allowed when other
8567 stack frames are selected. To pop entire frames off the stack,
8568 regardless of machine architecture, use @code{return};
8569 see @ref{Returning, ,Returning from a Function}.} with
8570
8571 @smallexample
8572 set $sp += 4
8573 @end smallexample
8574
8575 Whenever possible, these four standard register names are available on
8576 your machine even though the machine has different canonical mnemonics,
8577 so long as there is no conflict. The @code{info registers} command
8578 shows the canonical names. For example, on the SPARC, @code{info
8579 registers} displays the processor status register as @code{$psr} but you
8580 can also refer to it as @code{$ps}; and on x86-based machines @code{$ps}
8581 is an alias for the @sc{eflags} register.
8582
8583 @value{GDBN} always considers the contents of an ordinary register as an
8584 integer when the register is examined in this way. Some machines have
8585 special registers which can hold nothing but floating point; these
8586 registers are considered to have floating point values. There is no way
8587 to refer to the contents of an ordinary register as floating point value
8588 (although you can @emph{print} it as a floating point value with
8589 @samp{print/f $@var{regname}}).
8590
8591 Some registers have distinct ``raw'' and ``virtual'' data formats. This
8592 means that the data format in which the register contents are saved by
8593 the operating system is not the same one that your program normally
8594 sees. For example, the registers of the 68881 floating point
8595 coprocessor are always saved in ``extended'' (raw) format, but all C
8596 programs expect to work with ``double'' (virtual) format. In such
8597 cases, @value{GDBN} normally works with the virtual format only (the format
8598 that makes sense for your program), but the @code{info registers} command
8599 prints the data in both formats.
8600
8601 @cindex SSE registers (x86)
8602 @cindex MMX registers (x86)
8603 Some machines have special registers whose contents can be interpreted
8604 in several different ways. For example, modern x86-based machines
8605 have SSE and MMX registers that can hold several values packed
8606 together in several different formats. @value{GDBN} refers to such
8607 registers in @code{struct} notation:
8608
8609 @smallexample
8610 (@value{GDBP}) print $xmm1
8611 $1 = @{
8612 v4_float = @{0, 3.43859137e-038, 1.54142831e-044, 1.821688e-044@},
8613 v2_double = @{9.92129282474342e-303, 2.7585945287983262e-313@},
8614 v16_int8 = "\000\000\000\000\3706;\001\v\000\000\000\r\000\000",
8615 v8_int16 = @{0, 0, 14072, 315, 11, 0, 13, 0@},
8616 v4_int32 = @{0, 20657912, 11, 13@},
8617 v2_int64 = @{88725056443645952, 55834574859@},
8618 uint128 = 0x0000000d0000000b013b36f800000000
8619 @}
8620 @end smallexample
8621
8622 @noindent
8623 To set values of such registers, you need to tell @value{GDBN} which
8624 view of the register you wish to change, as if you were assigning
8625 value to a @code{struct} member:
8626
8627 @smallexample
8628 (@value{GDBP}) set $xmm1.uint128 = 0x000000000000000000000000FFFFFFFF
8629 @end smallexample
8630
8631 Normally, register values are relative to the selected stack frame
8632 (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}). This means that you get the
8633 value that the register would contain if all stack frames farther in
8634 were exited and their saved registers restored. In order to see the
8635 true contents of hardware registers, you must select the innermost
8636 frame (with @samp{frame 0}).
8637
8638 However, @value{GDBN} must deduce where registers are saved, from the machine
8639 code generated by your compiler. If some registers are not saved, or if
8640 @value{GDBN} is unable to locate the saved registers, the selected stack
8641 frame makes no difference.
8642
8643 @node Floating Point Hardware
8644 @section Floating Point Hardware
8645 @cindex floating point
8646
8647 Depending on the configuration, @value{GDBN} may be able to give
8648 you more information about the status of the floating point hardware.
8649
8650 @table @code
8651 @kindex info float
8652 @item info float
8653 Display hardware-dependent information about the floating
8654 point unit. The exact contents and layout vary depending on the
8655 floating point chip. Currently, @samp{info float} is supported on
8656 the ARM and x86 machines.
8657 @end table
8658
8659 @node Vector Unit
8660 @section Vector Unit
8661 @cindex vector unit
8662
8663 Depending on the configuration, @value{GDBN} may be able to give you
8664 more information about the status of the vector unit.
8665
8666 @table @code
8667 @kindex info vector
8668 @item info vector
8669 Display information about the vector unit. The exact contents and
8670 layout vary depending on the hardware.
8671 @end table
8672
8673 @node OS Information
8674 @section Operating System Auxiliary Information
8675 @cindex OS information
8676
8677 @value{GDBN} provides interfaces to useful OS facilities that can help
8678 you debug your program.
8679
8680 @cindex @code{ptrace} system call
8681 @cindex @code{struct user} contents
8682 When @value{GDBN} runs on a @dfn{Posix system} (such as GNU or Unix
8683 machines), it interfaces with the inferior via the @code{ptrace}
8684 system call. The operating system creates a special sata structure,
8685 called @code{struct user}, for this interface. You can use the
8686 command @code{info udot} to display the contents of this data
8687 structure.
8688
8689 @table @code
8690 @item info udot
8691 @kindex info udot
8692 Display the contents of the @code{struct user} maintained by the OS
8693 kernel for the program being debugged. @value{GDBN} displays the
8694 contents of @code{struct user} as a list of hex numbers, similar to
8695 the @code{examine} command.
8696 @end table
8697
8698 @cindex auxiliary vector
8699 @cindex vector, auxiliary
8700 Some operating systems supply an @dfn{auxiliary vector} to programs at
8701 startup. This is akin to the arguments and environment that you
8702 specify for a program, but contains a system-dependent variety of
8703 binary values that tell system libraries important details about the
8704 hardware, operating system, and process. Each value's purpose is
8705 identified by an integer tag; the meanings are well-known but system-specific.
8706 Depending on the configuration and operating system facilities,
8707 @value{GDBN} may be able to show you this information. For remote
8708 targets, this functionality may further depend on the remote stub's
8709 support of the @samp{qXfer:auxv:read} packet, see
8710 @ref{qXfer auxiliary vector read}.
8711
8712 @table @code
8713 @kindex info auxv
8714 @item info auxv
8715 Display the auxiliary vector of the inferior, which can be either a
8716 live process or a core dump file. @value{GDBN} prints each tag value
8717 numerically, and also shows names and text descriptions for recognized
8718 tags. Some values in the vector are numbers, some bit masks, and some
8719 pointers to strings or other data. @value{GDBN} displays each value in the
8720 most appropriate form for a recognized tag, and in hexadecimal for
8721 an unrecognized tag.
8722 @end table
8723
8724 On some targets, @value{GDBN} can access operating-system-specific information
8725 and display it to user, without interpretation. For remote targets,
8726 this functionality depends on the remote stub's support of the
8727 @samp{qXfer:osdata:read} packet, see @ref{qXfer osdata read}.
8728
8729 @table @code
8730 @kindex info os
8731 @item info os
8732 List the types of OS information available for the target. If the
8733 target does not return a list of possible types, this command will
8734 report an error.
8735
8736 @kindex info os processes
8737 @item info os processes
8738 Display the list of processes on the target. For each process,
8739 @value{GDBN} prints the process identifier, the name of the user, and
8740 the command corresponding to the process.
8741 @end table
8742
8743 @node Memory Region Attributes
8744 @section Memory Region Attributes
8745 @cindex memory region attributes
8746
8747 @dfn{Memory region attributes} allow you to describe special handling
8748 required by regions of your target's memory. @value{GDBN} uses
8749 attributes to determine whether to allow certain types of memory
8750 accesses; whether to use specific width accesses; and whether to cache
8751 target memory. By default the description of memory regions is
8752 fetched from the target (if the current target supports this), but the
8753 user can override the fetched regions.
8754
8755 Defined memory regions can be individually enabled and disabled. When a
8756 memory region is disabled, @value{GDBN} uses the default attributes when
8757 accessing memory in that region. Similarly, if no memory regions have
8758 been defined, @value{GDBN} uses the default attributes when accessing
8759 all memory.
8760
8761 When a memory region is defined, it is given a number to identify it;
8762 to enable, disable, or remove a memory region, you specify that number.
8763
8764 @table @code
8765 @kindex mem
8766 @item mem @var{lower} @var{upper} @var{attributes}@dots{}
8767 Define a memory region bounded by @var{lower} and @var{upper} with
8768 attributes @var{attributes}@dots{}, and add it to the list of regions
8769 monitored by @value{GDBN}. Note that @var{upper} == 0 is a special
8770 case: it is treated as the target's maximum memory address.
8771 (0xffff on 16 bit targets, 0xffffffff on 32 bit targets, etc.)
8772
8773 @item mem auto
8774 Discard any user changes to the memory regions and use target-supplied
8775 regions, if available, or no regions if the target does not support.
8776
8777 @kindex delete mem
8778 @item delete mem @var{nums}@dots{}
8779 Remove memory regions @var{nums}@dots{} from the list of regions
8780 monitored by @value{GDBN}.
8781
8782 @kindex disable mem
8783 @item disable mem @var{nums}@dots{}
8784 Disable monitoring of memory regions @var{nums}@dots{}.
8785 A disabled memory region is not forgotten.
8786 It may be enabled again later.
8787
8788 @kindex enable mem
8789 @item enable mem @var{nums}@dots{}
8790 Enable monitoring of memory regions @var{nums}@dots{}.
8791
8792 @kindex info mem
8793 @item info mem
8794 Print a table of all defined memory regions, with the following columns
8795 for each region:
8796
8797 @table @emph
8798 @item Memory Region Number
8799 @item Enabled or Disabled.
8800 Enabled memory regions are marked with @samp{y}.
8801 Disabled memory regions are marked with @samp{n}.
8802
8803 @item Lo Address
8804 The address defining the inclusive lower bound of the memory region.
8805
8806 @item Hi Address
8807 The address defining the exclusive upper bound of the memory region.
8808
8809 @item Attributes
8810 The list of attributes set for this memory region.
8811 @end table
8812 @end table
8813
8814
8815 @subsection Attributes
8816
8817 @subsubsection Memory Access Mode
8818 The access mode attributes set whether @value{GDBN} may make read or
8819 write accesses to a memory region.
8820
8821 While these attributes prevent @value{GDBN} from performing invalid
8822 memory accesses, they do nothing to prevent the target system, I/O DMA,
8823 etc.@: from accessing memory.
8824
8825 @table @code
8826 @item ro
8827 Memory is read only.
8828 @item wo
8829 Memory is write only.
8830 @item rw
8831 Memory is read/write. This is the default.
8832 @end table
8833
8834 @subsubsection Memory Access Size
8835 The access size attribute tells @value{GDBN} to use specific sized
8836 accesses in the memory region. Often memory mapped device registers
8837 require specific sized accesses. If no access size attribute is
8838 specified, @value{GDBN} may use accesses of any size.
8839
8840 @table @code
8841 @item 8
8842 Use 8 bit memory accesses.
8843 @item 16
8844 Use 16 bit memory accesses.
8845 @item 32
8846 Use 32 bit memory accesses.
8847 @item 64
8848 Use 64 bit memory accesses.
8849 @end table
8850
8851 @c @subsubsection Hardware/Software Breakpoints
8852 @c The hardware/software breakpoint attributes set whether @value{GDBN}
8853 @c will use hardware or software breakpoints for the internal breakpoints
8854 @c used by the step, next, finish, until, etc. commands.
8855 @c
8856 @c @table @code
8857 @c @item hwbreak
8858 @c Always use hardware breakpoints
8859 @c @item swbreak (default)
8860 @c @end table
8861
8862 @subsubsection Data Cache
8863 The data cache attributes set whether @value{GDBN} will cache target
8864 memory. While this generally improves performance by reducing debug
8865 protocol overhead, it can lead to incorrect results because @value{GDBN}
8866 does not know about volatile variables or memory mapped device
8867 registers.
8868
8869 @table @code
8870 @item cache
8871 Enable @value{GDBN} to cache target memory.
8872 @item nocache
8873 Disable @value{GDBN} from caching target memory. This is the default.
8874 @end table
8875
8876 @subsection Memory Access Checking
8877 @value{GDBN} can be instructed to refuse accesses to memory that is
8878 not explicitly described. This can be useful if accessing such
8879 regions has undesired effects for a specific target, or to provide
8880 better error checking. The following commands control this behaviour.
8881
8882 @table @code
8883 @kindex set mem inaccessible-by-default
8884 @item set mem inaccessible-by-default [on|off]
8885 If @code{on} is specified, make @value{GDBN} treat memory not
8886 explicitly described by the memory ranges as non-existent and refuse accesses
8887 to such memory. The checks are only performed if there's at least one
8888 memory range defined. If @code{off} is specified, make @value{GDBN}
8889 treat the memory not explicitly described by the memory ranges as RAM.
8890 The default value is @code{on}.
8891 @kindex show mem inaccessible-by-default
8892 @item show mem inaccessible-by-default
8893 Show the current handling of accesses to unknown memory.
8894 @end table
8895
8896
8897 @c @subsubsection Memory Write Verification
8898 @c The memory write verification attributes set whether @value{GDBN}
8899 @c will re-reads data after each write to verify the write was successful.
8900 @c
8901 @c @table @code
8902 @c @item verify
8903 @c @item noverify (default)
8904 @c @end table
8905
8906 @node Dump/Restore Files
8907 @section Copy Between Memory and a File
8908 @cindex dump/restore files
8909 @cindex append data to a file
8910 @cindex dump data to a file
8911 @cindex restore data from a file
8912
8913 You can use the commands @code{dump}, @code{append}, and
8914 @code{restore} to copy data between target memory and a file. The
8915 @code{dump} and @code{append} commands write data to a file, and the
8916 @code{restore} command reads data from a file back into the inferior's
8917 memory. Files may be in binary, Motorola S-record, Intel hex, or
8918 Tektronix Hex format; however, @value{GDBN} can only append to binary
8919 files.
8920
8921 @table @code
8922
8923 @kindex dump
8924 @item dump @r{[}@var{format}@r{]} memory @var{filename} @var{start_addr} @var{end_addr}
8925 @itemx dump @r{[}@var{format}@r{]} value @var{filename} @var{expr}
8926 Dump the contents of memory from @var{start_addr} to @var{end_addr},
8927 or the value of @var{expr}, to @var{filename} in the given format.
8928
8929 The @var{format} parameter may be any one of:
8930 @table @code
8931 @item binary
8932 Raw binary form.
8933 @item ihex
8934 Intel hex format.
8935 @item srec
8936 Motorola S-record format.
8937 @item tekhex
8938 Tektronix Hex format.
8939 @end table
8940
8941 @value{GDBN} uses the same definitions of these formats as the
8942 @sc{gnu} binary utilities, like @samp{objdump} and @samp{objcopy}. If
8943 @var{format} is omitted, @value{GDBN} dumps the data in raw binary
8944 form.
8945
8946 @kindex append
8947 @item append @r{[}binary@r{]} memory @var{filename} @var{start_addr} @var{end_addr}
8948 @itemx append @r{[}binary@r{]} value @var{filename} @var{expr}
8949 Append the contents of memory from @var{start_addr} to @var{end_addr},
8950 or the value of @var{expr}, to the file @var{filename}, in raw binary form.
8951 (@value{GDBN} can only append data to files in raw binary form.)
8952
8953 @kindex restore
8954 @item restore @var{filename} @r{[}binary@r{]} @var{bias} @var{start} @var{end}
8955 Restore the contents of file @var{filename} into memory. The
8956 @code{restore} command can automatically recognize any known @sc{bfd}
8957 file format, except for raw binary. To restore a raw binary file you
8958 must specify the optional keyword @code{binary} after the filename.
8959
8960 If @var{bias} is non-zero, its value will be added to the addresses
8961 contained in the file. Binary files always start at address zero, so
8962 they will be restored at address @var{bias}. Other bfd files have
8963 a built-in location; they will be restored at offset @var{bias}
8964 from that location.
8965
8966 If @var{start} and/or @var{end} are non-zero, then only data between
8967 file offset @var{start} and file offset @var{end} will be restored.
8968 These offsets are relative to the addresses in the file, before
8969 the @var{bias} argument is applied.
8970
8971 @end table
8972
8973 @node Core File Generation
8974 @section How to Produce a Core File from Your Program
8975 @cindex dump core from inferior
8976
8977 A @dfn{core file} or @dfn{core dump} is a file that records the memory
8978 image of a running process and its process status (register values
8979 etc.). Its primary use is post-mortem debugging of a program that
8980 crashed while it ran outside a debugger. A program that crashes
8981 automatically produces a core file, unless this feature is disabled by
8982 the user. @xref{Files}, for information on invoking @value{GDBN} in
8983 the post-mortem debugging mode.
8984
8985 Occasionally, you may wish to produce a core file of the program you
8986 are debugging in order to preserve a snapshot of its state.
8987 @value{GDBN} has a special command for that.
8988
8989 @table @code
8990 @kindex gcore
8991 @kindex generate-core-file
8992 @item generate-core-file [@var{file}]
8993 @itemx gcore [@var{file}]
8994 Produce a core dump of the inferior process. The optional argument
8995 @var{file} specifies the file name where to put the core dump. If not
8996 specified, the file name defaults to @file{core.@var{pid}}, where
8997 @var{pid} is the inferior process ID.
8998
8999 Note that this command is implemented only for some systems (as of
9000 this writing, @sc{gnu}/Linux, FreeBSD, Solaris, Unixware, and S390).
9001 @end table
9002
9003 @node Character Sets
9004 @section Character Sets
9005 @cindex character sets
9006 @cindex charset
9007 @cindex translating between character sets
9008 @cindex host character set
9009 @cindex target character set
9010
9011 If the program you are debugging uses a different character set to
9012 represent characters and strings than the one @value{GDBN} uses itself,
9013 @value{GDBN} can automatically translate between the character sets for
9014 you. The character set @value{GDBN} uses we call the @dfn{host
9015 character set}; the one the inferior program uses we call the
9016 @dfn{target character set}.
9017
9018 For example, if you are running @value{GDBN} on a @sc{gnu}/Linux system, which
9019 uses the ISO Latin 1 character set, but you are using @value{GDBN}'s
9020 remote protocol (@pxref{Remote Debugging}) to debug a program
9021 running on an IBM mainframe, which uses the @sc{ebcdic} character set,
9022 then the host character set is Latin-1, and the target character set is
9023 @sc{ebcdic}. If you give @value{GDBN} the command @code{set
9024 target-charset EBCDIC-US}, then @value{GDBN} translates between
9025 @sc{ebcdic} and Latin 1 as you print character or string values, or use
9026 character and string literals in expressions.
9027
9028 @value{GDBN} has no way to automatically recognize which character set
9029 the inferior program uses; you must tell it, using the @code{set
9030 target-charset} command, described below.
9031
9032 Here are the commands for controlling @value{GDBN}'s character set
9033 support:
9034
9035 @table @code
9036 @item set target-charset @var{charset}
9037 @kindex set target-charset
9038 Set the current target character set to @var{charset}. To display the
9039 list of supported target character sets, type
9040 @kbd{@w{set target-charset @key{TAB}@key{TAB}}}.
9041
9042 @item set host-charset @var{charset}
9043 @kindex set host-charset
9044 Set the current host character set to @var{charset}.
9045
9046 By default, @value{GDBN} uses a host character set appropriate to the
9047 system it is running on; you can override that default using the
9048 @code{set host-charset} command. On some systems, @value{GDBN} cannot
9049 automatically determine the appropriate host character set. In this
9050 case, @value{GDBN} uses @samp{UTF-8}.
9051
9052 @value{GDBN} can only use certain character sets as its host character
9053 set. If you type @kbd{@w{set host-charset @key{TAB}@key{TAB}}},
9054 @value{GDBN} will list the host character sets it supports.
9055
9056 @item set charset @var{charset}
9057 @kindex set charset
9058 Set the current host and target character sets to @var{charset}. As
9059 above, if you type @kbd{@w{set charset @key{TAB}@key{TAB}}},
9060 @value{GDBN} will list the names of the character sets that can be used
9061 for both host and target.
9062
9063 @item show charset
9064 @kindex show charset
9065 Show the names of the current host and target character sets.
9066
9067 @item show host-charset
9068 @kindex show host-charset
9069 Show the name of the current host character set.
9070
9071 @item show target-charset
9072 @kindex show target-charset
9073 Show the name of the current target character set.
9074
9075 @item set target-wide-charset @var{charset}
9076 @kindex set target-wide-charset
9077 Set the current target's wide character set to @var{charset}. This is
9078 the character set used by the target's @code{wchar_t} type. To
9079 display the list of supported wide character sets, type
9080 @kbd{@w{set target-wide-charset @key{TAB}@key{TAB}}}.
9081
9082 @item show target-wide-charset
9083 @kindex show target-wide-charset
9084 Show the name of the current target's wide character set.
9085 @end table
9086
9087 Here is an example of @value{GDBN}'s character set support in action.
9088 Assume that the following source code has been placed in the file
9089 @file{charset-test.c}:
9090
9091 @smallexample
9092 #include <stdio.h>
9093
9094 char ascii_hello[]
9095 = @{72, 101, 108, 108, 111, 44, 32, 119,
9096 111, 114, 108, 100, 33, 10, 0@};
9097 char ibm1047_hello[]
9098 = @{200, 133, 147, 147, 150, 107, 64, 166,
9099 150, 153, 147, 132, 90, 37, 0@};
9100
9101 main ()
9102 @{
9103 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
9104 @}
9105 @end smallexample
9106
9107 In this program, @code{ascii_hello} and @code{ibm1047_hello} are arrays
9108 containing the string @samp{Hello, world!} followed by a newline,
9109 encoded in the @sc{ascii} and @sc{ibm1047} character sets.
9110
9111 We compile the program, and invoke the debugger on it:
9112
9113 @smallexample
9114 $ gcc -g charset-test.c -o charset-test
9115 $ gdb -nw charset-test
9116 GNU gdb 2001-12-19-cvs
9117 Copyright 2001 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
9118 @dots{}
9119 (@value{GDBP})
9120 @end smallexample
9121
9122 We can use the @code{show charset} command to see what character sets
9123 @value{GDBN} is currently using to interpret and display characters and
9124 strings:
9125
9126 @smallexample
9127 (@value{GDBP}) show charset
9128 The current host and target character set is `ISO-8859-1'.
9129 (@value{GDBP})
9130 @end smallexample
9131
9132 For the sake of printing this manual, let's use @sc{ascii} as our
9133 initial character set:
9134 @smallexample
9135 (@value{GDBP}) set charset ASCII
9136 (@value{GDBP}) show charset
9137 The current host and target character set is `ASCII'.
9138 (@value{GDBP})
9139 @end smallexample
9140
9141 Let's assume that @sc{ascii} is indeed the correct character set for our
9142 host system --- in other words, let's assume that if @value{GDBN} prints
9143 characters using the @sc{ascii} character set, our terminal will display
9144 them properly. Since our current target character set is also
9145 @sc{ascii}, the contents of @code{ascii_hello} print legibly:
9146
9147 @smallexample
9148 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello
9149 $1 = 0x401698 "Hello, world!\n"
9150 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello[0]
9151 $2 = 72 'H'
9152 (@value{GDBP})
9153 @end smallexample
9154
9155 @value{GDBN} uses the target character set for character and string
9156 literals you use in expressions:
9157
9158 @smallexample
9159 (@value{GDBP}) print '+'
9160 $3 = 43 '+'
9161 (@value{GDBP})
9162 @end smallexample
9163
9164 The @sc{ascii} character set uses the number 43 to encode the @samp{+}
9165 character.
9166
9167 @value{GDBN} relies on the user to tell it which character set the
9168 target program uses. If we print @code{ibm1047_hello} while our target
9169 character set is still @sc{ascii}, we get jibberish:
9170
9171 @smallexample
9172 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello
9173 $4 = 0x4016a8 "\310\205\223\223\226k@@\246\226\231\223\204Z%"
9174 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello[0]
9175 $5 = 200 '\310'
9176 (@value{GDBP})
9177 @end smallexample
9178
9179 If we invoke the @code{set target-charset} followed by @key{TAB}@key{TAB},
9180 @value{GDBN} tells us the character sets it supports:
9181
9182 @smallexample
9183 (@value{GDBP}) set target-charset
9184 ASCII EBCDIC-US IBM1047 ISO-8859-1
9185 (@value{GDBP}) set target-charset
9186 @end smallexample
9187
9188 We can select @sc{ibm1047} as our target character set, and examine the
9189 program's strings again. Now the @sc{ascii} string is wrong, but
9190 @value{GDBN} translates the contents of @code{ibm1047_hello} from the
9191 target character set, @sc{ibm1047}, to the host character set,
9192 @sc{ascii}, and they display correctly:
9193
9194 @smallexample
9195 (@value{GDBP}) set target-charset IBM1047
9196 (@value{GDBP}) show charset
9197 The current host character set is `ASCII'.
9198 The current target character set is `IBM1047'.
9199 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello
9200 $6 = 0x401698 "\110\145%%?\054\040\167?\162%\144\041\012"
9201 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello[0]
9202 $7 = 72 '\110'
9203 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello
9204 $8 = 0x4016a8 "Hello, world!\n"
9205 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello[0]
9206 $9 = 200 'H'
9207 (@value{GDBP})
9208 @end smallexample
9209
9210 As above, @value{GDBN} uses the target character set for character and
9211 string literals you use in expressions:
9212
9213 @smallexample
9214 (@value{GDBP}) print '+'
9215 $10 = 78 '+'
9216 (@value{GDBP})
9217 @end smallexample
9218
9219 The @sc{ibm1047} character set uses the number 78 to encode the @samp{+}
9220 character.
9221
9222 @node Caching Remote Data
9223 @section Caching Data of Remote Targets
9224 @cindex caching data of remote targets
9225
9226 @value{GDBN} caches data exchanged between the debugger and a
9227 remote target (@pxref{Remote Debugging}). Such caching generally improves
9228 performance, because it reduces the overhead of the remote protocol by
9229 bundling memory reads and writes into large chunks. Unfortunately, simply
9230 caching everything would lead to incorrect results, since @value{GDBN}
9231 does not necessarily know anything about volatile values, memory-mapped I/O
9232 addresses, etc. Furthermore, in non-stop mode (@pxref{Non-Stop Mode})
9233 memory can be changed @emph{while} a gdb command is executing.
9234 Therefore, by default, @value{GDBN} only caches data
9235 known to be on the stack@footnote{In non-stop mode, it is moderately
9236 rare for a running thread to modify the stack of a stopped thread
9237 in a way that would interfere with a backtrace, and caching of
9238 stack reads provides a significant speed up of remote backtraces.}.
9239 Other regions of memory can be explicitly marked as
9240 cacheable; see @pxref{Memory Region Attributes}.
9241
9242 @table @code
9243 @kindex set remotecache
9244 @item set remotecache on
9245 @itemx set remotecache off
9246 This option no longer does anything; it exists for compatibility
9247 with old scripts.
9248
9249 @kindex show remotecache
9250 @item show remotecache
9251 Show the current state of the obsolete remotecache flag.
9252
9253 @kindex set stack-cache
9254 @item set stack-cache on
9255 @itemx set stack-cache off
9256 Enable or disable caching of stack accesses. When @code{ON}, use
9257 caching. By default, this option is @code{ON}.
9258
9259 @kindex show stack-cache
9260 @item show stack-cache
9261 Show the current state of data caching for memory accesses.
9262
9263 @kindex info dcache
9264 @item info dcache @r{[}line@r{]}
9265 Print the information about the data cache performance. The
9266 information displayed includes the dcache width and depth, and for
9267 each cache line, its number, address, and how many times it was
9268 referenced. This command is useful for debugging the data cache
9269 operation.
9270
9271 If a line number is specified, the contents of that line will be
9272 printed in hex.
9273 @end table
9274
9275 @node Searching Memory
9276 @section Search Memory
9277 @cindex searching memory
9278
9279 Memory can be searched for a particular sequence of bytes with the
9280 @code{find} command.
9281
9282 @table @code
9283 @kindex find
9284 @item find @r{[}/@var{sn}@r{]} @var{start_addr}, +@var{len}, @var{val1} @r{[}, @var{val2}, @dots{}@r{]}
9285 @itemx find @r{[}/@var{sn}@r{]} @var{start_addr}, @var{end_addr}, @var{val1} @r{[}, @var{val2}, @dots{}@r{]}
9286 Search memory for the sequence of bytes specified by @var{val1}, @var{val2},
9287 etc. The search begins at address @var{start_addr} and continues for either
9288 @var{len} bytes or through to @var{end_addr} inclusive.
9289 @end table
9290
9291 @var{s} and @var{n} are optional parameters.
9292 They may be specified in either order, apart or together.
9293
9294 @table @r
9295 @item @var{s}, search query size
9296 The size of each search query value.
9297
9298 @table @code
9299 @item b
9300 bytes
9301 @item h
9302 halfwords (two bytes)
9303 @item w
9304 words (four bytes)
9305 @item g
9306 giant words (eight bytes)
9307 @end table
9308
9309 All values are interpreted in the current language.
9310 This means, for example, that if the current source language is C/C@t{++}
9311 then searching for the string ``hello'' includes the trailing '\0'.
9312
9313 If the value size is not specified, it is taken from the
9314 value's type in the current language.
9315 This is useful when one wants to specify the search
9316 pattern as a mixture of types.
9317 Note that this means, for example, that in the case of C-like languages
9318 a search for an untyped 0x42 will search for @samp{(int) 0x42}
9319 which is typically four bytes.
9320
9321 @item @var{n}, maximum number of finds
9322 The maximum number of matches to print. The default is to print all finds.
9323 @end table
9324
9325 You can use strings as search values. Quote them with double-quotes
9326 (@code{"}).
9327 The string value is copied into the search pattern byte by byte,
9328 regardless of the endianness of the target and the size specification.
9329
9330 The address of each match found is printed as well as a count of the
9331 number of matches found.
9332
9333 The address of the last value found is stored in convenience variable
9334 @samp{$_}.
9335 A count of the number of matches is stored in @samp{$numfound}.
9336
9337 For example, if stopped at the @code{printf} in this function:
9338
9339 @smallexample
9340 void
9341 hello ()
9342 @{
9343 static char hello[] = "hello-hello";
9344 static struct @{ char c; short s; int i; @}
9345 __attribute__ ((packed)) mixed
9346 = @{ 'c', 0x1234, 0x87654321 @};
9347 printf ("%s\n", hello);
9348 @}
9349 @end smallexample
9350
9351 @noindent
9352 you get during debugging:
9353
9354 @smallexample
9355 (gdb) find &hello[0], +sizeof(hello), "hello"
9356 0x804956d <hello.1620+6>
9357 1 pattern found
9358 (gdb) find &hello[0], +sizeof(hello), 'h', 'e', 'l', 'l', 'o'
9359 0x8049567 <hello.1620>
9360 0x804956d <hello.1620+6>
9361 2 patterns found
9362 (gdb) find /b1 &hello[0], +sizeof(hello), 'h', 0x65, 'l'
9363 0x8049567 <hello.1620>
9364 1 pattern found
9365 (gdb) find &mixed, +sizeof(mixed), (char) 'c', (short) 0x1234, (int) 0x87654321
9366 0x8049560 <mixed.1625>
9367 1 pattern found
9368 (gdb) print $numfound
9369 $1 = 1
9370 (gdb) print $_
9371 $2 = (void *) 0x8049560
9372 @end smallexample
9373
9374 @node Optimized Code
9375 @chapter Debugging Optimized Code
9376 @cindex optimized code, debugging
9377 @cindex debugging optimized code
9378
9379 Almost all compilers support optimization. With optimization
9380 disabled, the compiler generates assembly code that corresponds
9381 directly to your source code, in a simplistic way. As the compiler
9382 applies more powerful optimizations, the generated assembly code
9383 diverges from your original source code. With help from debugging
9384 information generated by the compiler, @value{GDBN} can map from
9385 the running program back to constructs from your original source.
9386
9387 @value{GDBN} is more accurate with optimization disabled. If you
9388 can recompile without optimization, it is easier to follow the
9389 progress of your program during debugging. But, there are many cases
9390 where you may need to debug an optimized version.
9391
9392 When you debug a program compiled with @samp{-g -O}, remember that the
9393 optimizer has rearranged your code; the debugger shows you what is
9394 really there. Do not be too surprised when the execution path does not
9395 exactly match your source file! An extreme example: if you define a
9396 variable, but never use it, @value{GDBN} never sees that
9397 variable---because the compiler optimizes it out of existence.
9398
9399 Some things do not work as well with @samp{-g -O} as with just
9400 @samp{-g}, particularly on machines with instruction scheduling. If in
9401 doubt, recompile with @samp{-g} alone, and if this fixes the problem,
9402 please report it to us as a bug (including a test case!).
9403 @xref{Variables}, for more information about debugging optimized code.
9404
9405 @menu
9406 * Inline Functions:: How @value{GDBN} presents inlining
9407 @end menu
9408
9409 @node Inline Functions
9410 @section Inline Functions
9411 @cindex inline functions, debugging
9412
9413 @dfn{Inlining} is an optimization that inserts a copy of the function
9414 body directly at each call site, instead of jumping to a shared
9415 routine. @value{GDBN} displays inlined functions just like
9416 non-inlined functions. They appear in backtraces. You can view their
9417 arguments and local variables, step into them with @code{step}, skip
9418 them with @code{next}, and escape from them with @code{finish}.
9419 You can check whether a function was inlined by using the
9420 @code{info frame} command.
9421
9422 For @value{GDBN} to support inlined functions, the compiler must
9423 record information about inlining in the debug information ---
9424 @value{NGCC} using the @sc{dwarf 2} format does this, and several
9425 other compilers do also. @value{GDBN} only supports inlined functions
9426 when using @sc{dwarf 2}. Versions of @value{NGCC} before 4.1
9427 do not emit two required attributes (@samp{DW_AT_call_file} and
9428 @samp{DW_AT_call_line}); @value{GDBN} does not display inlined
9429 function calls with earlier versions of @value{NGCC}. It instead
9430 displays the arguments and local variables of inlined functions as
9431 local variables in the caller.
9432
9433 The body of an inlined function is directly included at its call site;
9434 unlike a non-inlined function, there are no instructions devoted to
9435 the call. @value{GDBN} still pretends that the call site and the
9436 start of the inlined function are different instructions. Stepping to
9437 the call site shows the call site, and then stepping again shows
9438 the first line of the inlined function, even though no additional
9439 instructions are executed.
9440
9441 This makes source-level debugging much clearer; you can see both the
9442 context of the call and then the effect of the call. Only stepping by
9443 a single instruction using @code{stepi} or @code{nexti} does not do
9444 this; single instruction steps always show the inlined body.
9445
9446 There are some ways that @value{GDBN} does not pretend that inlined
9447 function calls are the same as normal calls:
9448
9449 @itemize @bullet
9450 @item
9451 You cannot set breakpoints on inlined functions. @value{GDBN}
9452 either reports that there is no symbol with that name, or else sets the
9453 breakpoint only on non-inlined copies of the function. This limitation
9454 will be removed in a future version of @value{GDBN}; until then,
9455 set a breakpoint by line number on the first line of the inlined
9456 function instead.
9457
9458 @item
9459 Setting breakpoints at the call site of an inlined function may not
9460 work, because the call site does not contain any code. @value{GDBN}
9461 may incorrectly move the breakpoint to the next line of the enclosing
9462 function, after the call. This limitation will be removed in a future
9463 version of @value{GDBN}; until then, set a breakpoint on an earlier line
9464 or inside the inlined function instead.
9465
9466 @item
9467 @value{GDBN} cannot locate the return value of inlined calls after
9468 using the @code{finish} command. This is a limitation of compiler-generated
9469 debugging information; after @code{finish}, you can step to the next line
9470 and print a variable where your program stored the return value.
9471
9472 @end itemize
9473
9474
9475 @node Macros
9476 @chapter C Preprocessor Macros
9477
9478 Some languages, such as C and C@t{++}, provide a way to define and invoke
9479 ``preprocessor macros'' which expand into strings of tokens.
9480 @value{GDBN} can evaluate expressions containing macro invocations, show
9481 the result of macro expansion, and show a macro's definition, including
9482 where it was defined.
9483
9484 You may need to compile your program specially to provide @value{GDBN}
9485 with information about preprocessor macros. Most compilers do not
9486 include macros in their debugging information, even when you compile
9487 with the @option{-g} flag. @xref{Compilation}.
9488
9489 A program may define a macro at one point, remove that definition later,
9490 and then provide a different definition after that. Thus, at different
9491 points in the program, a macro may have different definitions, or have
9492 no definition at all. If there is a current stack frame, @value{GDBN}
9493 uses the macros in scope at that frame's source code line. Otherwise,
9494 @value{GDBN} uses the macros in scope at the current listing location;
9495 see @ref{List}.
9496
9497 Whenever @value{GDBN} evaluates an expression, it always expands any
9498 macro invocations present in the expression. @value{GDBN} also provides
9499 the following commands for working with macros explicitly.
9500
9501 @table @code
9502
9503 @kindex macro expand
9504 @cindex macro expansion, showing the results of preprocessor
9505 @cindex preprocessor macro expansion, showing the results of
9506 @cindex expanding preprocessor macros
9507 @item macro expand @var{expression}
9508 @itemx macro exp @var{expression}
9509 Show the results of expanding all preprocessor macro invocations in
9510 @var{expression}. Since @value{GDBN} simply expands macros, but does
9511 not parse the result, @var{expression} need not be a valid expression;
9512 it can be any string of tokens.
9513
9514 @kindex macro exp1
9515 @item macro expand-once @var{expression}
9516 @itemx macro exp1 @var{expression}
9517 @cindex expand macro once
9518 @i{(This command is not yet implemented.)} Show the results of
9519 expanding those preprocessor macro invocations that appear explicitly in
9520 @var{expression}. Macro invocations appearing in that expansion are
9521 left unchanged. This command allows you to see the effect of a
9522 particular macro more clearly, without being confused by further
9523 expansions. Since @value{GDBN} simply expands macros, but does not
9524 parse the result, @var{expression} need not be a valid expression; it
9525 can be any string of tokens.
9526
9527 @kindex info macro
9528 @cindex macro definition, showing
9529 @cindex definition, showing a macro's
9530 @item info macro @var{macro}
9531 Show the definition of the macro named @var{macro}, and describe the
9532 source location or compiler command-line where that definition was established.
9533
9534 @kindex macro define
9535 @cindex user-defined macros
9536 @cindex defining macros interactively
9537 @cindex macros, user-defined
9538 @item macro define @var{macro} @var{replacement-list}
9539 @itemx macro define @var{macro}(@var{arglist}) @var{replacement-list}
9540 Introduce a definition for a preprocessor macro named @var{macro},
9541 invocations of which are replaced by the tokens given in
9542 @var{replacement-list}. The first form of this command defines an
9543 ``object-like'' macro, which takes no arguments; the second form
9544 defines a ``function-like'' macro, which takes the arguments given in
9545 @var{arglist}.
9546
9547 A definition introduced by this command is in scope in every
9548 expression evaluated in @value{GDBN}, until it is removed with the
9549 @code{macro undef} command, described below. The definition overrides
9550 all definitions for @var{macro} present in the program being debugged,
9551 as well as any previous user-supplied definition.
9552
9553 @kindex macro undef
9554 @item macro undef @var{macro}
9555 Remove any user-supplied definition for the macro named @var{macro}.
9556 This command only affects definitions provided with the @code{macro
9557 define} command, described above; it cannot remove definitions present
9558 in the program being debugged.
9559
9560 @kindex macro list
9561 @item macro list
9562 List all the macros defined using the @code{macro define} command.
9563 @end table
9564
9565 @cindex macros, example of debugging with
9566 Here is a transcript showing the above commands in action. First, we
9567 show our source files:
9568
9569 @smallexample
9570 $ cat sample.c
9571 #include <stdio.h>
9572 #include "sample.h"
9573
9574 #define M 42
9575 #define ADD(x) (M + x)
9576
9577 main ()
9578 @{
9579 #define N 28
9580 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
9581 #undef N
9582 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
9583 #define N 1729
9584 printf ("Goodbye, world!\n");
9585 @}
9586 $ cat sample.h
9587 #define Q <
9588 $
9589 @end smallexample
9590
9591 Now, we compile the program using the @sc{gnu} C compiler, @value{NGCC}.
9592 We pass the @option{-gdwarf-2} and @option{-g3} flags to ensure the
9593 compiler includes information about preprocessor macros in the debugging
9594 information.
9595
9596 @smallexample
9597 $ gcc -gdwarf-2 -g3 sample.c -o sample
9598 $
9599 @end smallexample
9600
9601 Now, we start @value{GDBN} on our sample program:
9602
9603 @smallexample
9604 $ gdb -nw sample
9605 GNU gdb 2002-05-06-cvs
9606 Copyright 2002 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
9607 GDB is free software, @dots{}
9608 (@value{GDBP})
9609 @end smallexample
9610
9611 We can expand macros and examine their definitions, even when the
9612 program is not running. @value{GDBN} uses the current listing position
9613 to decide which macro definitions are in scope:
9614
9615 @smallexample
9616 (@value{GDBP}) list main
9617 3
9618 4 #define M 42
9619 5 #define ADD(x) (M + x)
9620 6
9621 7 main ()
9622 8 @{
9623 9 #define N 28
9624 10 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
9625 11 #undef N
9626 12 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
9627 (@value{GDBP}) info macro ADD
9628 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:5
9629 #define ADD(x) (M + x)
9630 (@value{GDBP}) info macro Q
9631 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.h:1
9632 included at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:2
9633 #define Q <
9634 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand ADD(1)
9635 expands to: (42 + 1)
9636 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand-once ADD(1)
9637 expands to: once (M + 1)
9638 (@value{GDBP})
9639 @end smallexample
9640
9641 In the example above, note that @code{macro expand-once} expands only
9642 the macro invocation explicit in the original text --- the invocation of
9643 @code{ADD} --- but does not expand the invocation of the macro @code{M},
9644 which was introduced by @code{ADD}.
9645
9646 Once the program is running, @value{GDBN} uses the macro definitions in
9647 force at the source line of the current stack frame:
9648
9649 @smallexample
9650 (@value{GDBP}) break main
9651 Breakpoint 1 at 0x8048370: file sample.c, line 10.
9652 (@value{GDBP}) run
9653 Starting program: /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample
9654
9655 Breakpoint 1, main () at sample.c:10
9656 10 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
9657 (@value{GDBP})
9658 @end smallexample
9659
9660 At line 10, the definition of the macro @code{N} at line 9 is in force:
9661
9662 @smallexample
9663 (@value{GDBP}) info macro N
9664 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:9
9665 #define N 28
9666 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand N Q M
9667 expands to: 28 < 42
9668 (@value{GDBP}) print N Q M
9669 $1 = 1
9670 (@value{GDBP})
9671 @end smallexample
9672
9673 As we step over directives that remove @code{N}'s definition, and then
9674 give it a new definition, @value{GDBN} finds the definition (or lack
9675 thereof) in force at each point:
9676
9677 @smallexample
9678 (@value{GDBP}) next
9679 Hello, world!
9680 12 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
9681 (@value{GDBP}) info macro N
9682 The symbol `N' has no definition as a C/C++ preprocessor macro
9683 at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:12
9684 (@value{GDBP}) next
9685 We're so creative.
9686 14 printf ("Goodbye, world!\n");
9687 (@value{GDBP}) info macro N
9688 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:13
9689 #define N 1729
9690 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand N Q M
9691 expands to: 1729 < 42
9692 (@value{GDBP}) print N Q M
9693 $2 = 0
9694 (@value{GDBP})
9695 @end smallexample
9696
9697 In addition to source files, macros can be defined on the compilation command
9698 line using the @option{-D@var{name}=@var{value}} syntax. For macros defined in
9699 such a way, @value{GDBN} displays the location of their definition as line zero
9700 of the source file submitted to the compiler.
9701
9702 @smallexample
9703 (@value{GDBP}) info macro __STDC__
9704 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:0
9705 -D__STDC__=1
9706 (@value{GDBP})
9707 @end smallexample
9708
9709
9710 @node Tracepoints
9711 @chapter Tracepoints
9712 @c This chapter is based on the documentation written by Michael
9713 @c Snyder, David Taylor, Jim Blandy, and Elena Zannoni.
9714
9715 @cindex tracepoints
9716 In some applications, it is not feasible for the debugger to interrupt
9717 the program's execution long enough for the developer to learn
9718 anything helpful about its behavior. If the program's correctness
9719 depends on its real-time behavior, delays introduced by a debugger
9720 might cause the program to change its behavior drastically, or perhaps
9721 fail, even when the code itself is correct. It is useful to be able
9722 to observe the program's behavior without interrupting it.
9723
9724 Using @value{GDBN}'s @code{trace} and @code{collect} commands, you can
9725 specify locations in the program, called @dfn{tracepoints}, and
9726 arbitrary expressions to evaluate when those tracepoints are reached.
9727 Later, using the @code{tfind} command, you can examine the values
9728 those expressions had when the program hit the tracepoints. The
9729 expressions may also denote objects in memory---structures or arrays,
9730 for example---whose values @value{GDBN} should record; while visiting
9731 a particular tracepoint, you may inspect those objects as if they were
9732 in memory at that moment. However, because @value{GDBN} records these
9733 values without interacting with you, it can do so quickly and
9734 unobtrusively, hopefully not disturbing the program's behavior.
9735
9736 The tracepoint facility is currently available only for remote
9737 targets. @xref{Targets}. In addition, your remote target must know
9738 how to collect trace data. This functionality is implemented in the
9739 remote stub; however, none of the stubs distributed with @value{GDBN}
9740 support tracepoints as of this writing. The format of the remote
9741 packets used to implement tracepoints are described in @ref{Tracepoint
9742 Packets}.
9743
9744 It is also possible to get trace data from a file, in a manner reminiscent
9745 of corefiles; you specify the filename, and use @code{tfind} to search
9746 through the file. @xref{Trace Files}, for more details.
9747
9748 This chapter describes the tracepoint commands and features.
9749
9750 @menu
9751 * Set Tracepoints::
9752 * Analyze Collected Data::
9753 * Tracepoint Variables::
9754 * Trace Files::
9755 @end menu
9756
9757 @node Set Tracepoints
9758 @section Commands to Set Tracepoints
9759
9760 Before running such a @dfn{trace experiment}, an arbitrary number of
9761 tracepoints can be set. A tracepoint is actually a special type of
9762 breakpoint (@pxref{Set Breaks}), so you can manipulate it using
9763 standard breakpoint commands. For instance, as with breakpoints,
9764 tracepoint numbers are successive integers starting from one, and many
9765 of the commands associated with tracepoints take the tracepoint number
9766 as their argument, to identify which tracepoint to work on.
9767
9768 For each tracepoint, you can specify, in advance, some arbitrary set
9769 of data that you want the target to collect in the trace buffer when
9770 it hits that tracepoint. The collected data can include registers,
9771 local variables, or global data. Later, you can use @value{GDBN}
9772 commands to examine the values these data had at the time the
9773 tracepoint was hit.
9774
9775 Tracepoints do not support every breakpoint feature. Ignore counts on
9776 tracepoints have no effect, and tracepoints cannot run @value{GDBN}
9777 commands when they are hit. Tracepoints may not be thread-specific
9778 either.
9779
9780 @cindex fast tracepoints
9781 Some targets may support @dfn{fast tracepoints}, which are inserted in
9782 a different way (such as with a jump instead of a trap), that is
9783 faster but possibly restricted in where they may be installed.
9784
9785 @cindex static tracepoints
9786 @cindex markers, static tracepoints
9787 @cindex probing markers, static tracepoints
9788 Regular and fast tracepoints are dynamic tracing facilities, meaning
9789 that they can be used to insert tracepoints at (almost) any location
9790 in the target. Some targets may also support controlling @dfn{static
9791 tracepoints} from @value{GDBN}. With static tracing, a set of
9792 instrumentation points, also known as @dfn{markers}, are embedded in
9793 the target program, and can be activated or deactivated by name or
9794 address. These are usually placed at locations which facilitate
9795 investigating what the target is actually doing. @value{GDBN}'s
9796 support for static tracing includes being able to list instrumentation
9797 points, and attach them with @value{GDBN} defined high level
9798 tracepoints that expose the whole range of convenience of
9799 @value{GDBN}'s tracepoints support. Namelly, support for collecting
9800 registers values and values of global or local (to the instrumentation
9801 point) variables; tracepoint conditions and trace state variables.
9802 The act of installing a @value{GDBN} static tracepoint on an
9803 instrumentation point, or marker, is referred to as @dfn{probing} a
9804 static tracepoint marker.
9805
9806 @code{gdbserver} supports tracepoints on some target systems.
9807 @xref{Server,,Tracepoints support in @code{gdbserver}}.
9808
9809 This section describes commands to set tracepoints and associated
9810 conditions and actions.
9811
9812 @menu
9813 * Create and Delete Tracepoints::
9814 * Enable and Disable Tracepoints::
9815 * Tracepoint Passcounts::
9816 * Tracepoint Conditions::
9817 * Trace State Variables::
9818 * Tracepoint Actions::
9819 * Listing Tracepoints::
9820 * Listing Static Tracepoint Markers::
9821 * Starting and Stopping Trace Experiments::
9822 * Tracepoint Restrictions::
9823 @end menu
9824
9825 @node Create and Delete Tracepoints
9826 @subsection Create and Delete Tracepoints
9827
9828 @table @code
9829 @cindex set tracepoint
9830 @kindex trace
9831 @item trace @var{location}
9832 The @code{trace} command is very similar to the @code{break} command.
9833 Its argument @var{location} can be a source line, a function name, or
9834 an address in the target program. @xref{Specify Location}. The
9835 @code{trace} command defines a tracepoint, which is a point in the
9836 target program where the debugger will briefly stop, collect some
9837 data, and then allow the program to continue. Setting a tracepoint or
9838 changing its actions doesn't take effect until the next @code{tstart}
9839 command, and once a trace experiment is running, further changes will
9840 not have any effect until the next trace experiment starts.
9841
9842 Here are some examples of using the @code{trace} command:
9843
9844 @smallexample
9845 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo.c:121} // a source file and line number
9846
9847 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace +2} // 2 lines forward
9848
9849 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace my_function} // first source line of function
9850
9851 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace *my_function} // EXACT start address of function
9852
9853 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace *0x2117c4} // an address
9854 @end smallexample
9855
9856 @noindent
9857 You can abbreviate @code{trace} as @code{tr}.
9858
9859 @item trace @var{location} if @var{cond}
9860 Set a tracepoint with condition @var{cond}; evaluate the expression
9861 @var{cond} each time the tracepoint is reached, and collect data only
9862 if the value is nonzero---that is, if @var{cond} evaluates as true.
9863 @xref{Tracepoint Conditions, ,Tracepoint Conditions}, for more
9864 information on tracepoint conditions.
9865
9866 @item ftrace @var{location} [ if @var{cond} ]
9867 @cindex set fast tracepoint
9868 @cindex fast tracepoints, setting
9869 @kindex ftrace
9870 The @code{ftrace} command sets a fast tracepoint. For targets that
9871 support them, fast tracepoints will use a more efficient but possibly
9872 less general technique to trigger data collection, such as a jump
9873 instruction instead of a trap, or some sort of hardware support. It
9874 may not be possible to create a fast tracepoint at the desired
9875 location, in which case the command will exit with an explanatory
9876 message.
9877
9878 @value{GDBN} handles arguments to @code{ftrace} exactly as for
9879 @code{trace}.
9880
9881 @item strace @var{location} [ if @var{cond} ]
9882 @cindex set static tracepoint
9883 @cindex static tracepoints, setting
9884 @cindex probe static tracepoint marker
9885 @kindex strace
9886 The @code{strace} command sets a static tracepoint. For targets that
9887 support it, setting a static tracepoint probes a static
9888 instrumentation point, or marker, found at @var{location}. It may not
9889 be possible to set a static tracepoint at the desired location, in
9890 which case the command will exit with an explanatory message.
9891
9892 @value{GDBN} handles arguments to @code{strace} exactly as for
9893 @code{trace}, with the addition that the user can also specify
9894 @code{-m @var{marker}} as @var{location}. This probes the marker
9895 identified by the @var{marker} string identifier. This identifier
9896 depends on the static tracepoint backend library your program is
9897 using. You can find all the marker identifiers in the @samp{ID} field
9898 of the @code{info static-tracepoint-markers} command output.
9899 @xref{Listing Static Tracepoint Markers,,Listing Static Tracepoint
9900 Markers}. For example, in the following small program using the UST
9901 tracing engine:
9902
9903 @smallexample
9904 main ()
9905 @{
9906 trace_mark(ust, bar33, "str %s", "FOOBAZ");
9907 @}
9908 @end smallexample
9909
9910 @noindent
9911 the marker id is composed of joining the first two arguments to the
9912 @code{trace_mark} call with a slash, which translates to:
9913
9914 @smallexample
9915 (@value{GDBP}) info static-tracepoint-markers
9916 Cnt Enb ID Address What
9917 1 n ust/bar33 0x0000000000400ddc in main at stexample.c:22
9918 Data: "str %s"
9919 [etc...]
9920 @end smallexample
9921
9922 @noindent
9923 so you may probe the marker above with:
9924
9925 @smallexample
9926 (@value{GDBP}) strace -m ust/bar33
9927 @end smallexample
9928
9929 Static tracepoints accept an extra collect action --- @code{collect
9930 $_sdata}. This collects arbitrary user data passed in the probe point
9931 call to the tracing library. In the UST example above, you'll see
9932 that the third argument to @code{trace_mark} is a printf-like format
9933 string. The user data is then the result of running that formating
9934 string against the following arguments. Note that @code{info
9935 static-tracepoint-markers} command output lists that format string in
9936 the @samp{Data:} field.
9937
9938 You can inspect this data when analyzing the trace buffer, by printing
9939 the $_sdata variable like any other variable available to
9940 @value{GDBN}. @xref{Tracepoint Actions,,Tracepoint Action Lists}.
9941
9942 @vindex $tpnum
9943 @cindex last tracepoint number
9944 @cindex recent tracepoint number
9945 @cindex tracepoint number
9946 The convenience variable @code{$tpnum} records the tracepoint number
9947 of the most recently set tracepoint.
9948
9949 @kindex delete tracepoint
9950 @cindex tracepoint deletion
9951 @item delete tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
9952 Permanently delete one or more tracepoints. With no argument, the
9953 default is to delete all tracepoints. Note that the regular
9954 @code{delete} command can remove tracepoints also.
9955
9956 Examples:
9957
9958 @smallexample
9959 (@value{GDBP}) @b{delete trace 1 2 3} // remove three tracepoints
9960
9961 (@value{GDBP}) @b{delete trace} // remove all tracepoints
9962 @end smallexample
9963
9964 @noindent
9965 You can abbreviate this command as @code{del tr}.
9966 @end table
9967
9968 @node Enable and Disable Tracepoints
9969 @subsection Enable and Disable Tracepoints
9970
9971 These commands are deprecated; they are equivalent to plain @code{disable} and @code{enable}.
9972
9973 @table @code
9974 @kindex disable tracepoint
9975 @item disable tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
9976 Disable tracepoint @var{num}, or all tracepoints if no argument
9977 @var{num} is given. A disabled tracepoint will have no effect during
9978 the next trace experiment, but it is not forgotten. You can re-enable
9979 a disabled tracepoint using the @code{enable tracepoint} command.
9980
9981 @kindex enable tracepoint
9982 @item enable tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
9983 Enable tracepoint @var{num}, or all tracepoints. The enabled
9984 tracepoints will become effective the next time a trace experiment is
9985 run.
9986 @end table
9987
9988 @node Tracepoint Passcounts
9989 @subsection Tracepoint Passcounts
9990
9991 @table @code
9992 @kindex passcount
9993 @cindex tracepoint pass count
9994 @item passcount @r{[}@var{n} @r{[}@var{num}@r{]]}
9995 Set the @dfn{passcount} of a tracepoint. The passcount is a way to
9996 automatically stop a trace experiment. If a tracepoint's passcount is
9997 @var{n}, then the trace experiment will be automatically stopped on
9998 the @var{n}'th time that tracepoint is hit. If the tracepoint number
9999 @var{num} is not specified, the @code{passcount} command sets the
10000 passcount of the most recently defined tracepoint. If no passcount is
10001 given, the trace experiment will run until stopped explicitly by the
10002 user.
10003
10004 Examples:
10005
10006 @smallexample
10007 (@value{GDBP}) @b{passcount 5 2} // Stop on the 5th execution of
10008 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// tracepoint 2}
10009
10010 (@value{GDBP}) @b{passcount 12} // Stop on the 12th execution of the
10011 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// most recently defined tracepoint.}
10012 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo}
10013 (@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 3}
10014 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace bar}
10015 (@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 2}
10016 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace baz}
10017 (@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 1} // Stop tracing when foo has been
10018 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// executed 3 times OR when bar has}
10019 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// been executed 2 times}
10020 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// OR when baz has been executed 1 time.}
10021 @end smallexample
10022 @end table
10023
10024 @node Tracepoint Conditions
10025 @subsection Tracepoint Conditions
10026 @cindex conditional tracepoints
10027 @cindex tracepoint conditions
10028
10029 The simplest sort of tracepoint collects data every time your program
10030 reaches a specified place. You can also specify a @dfn{condition} for
10031 a tracepoint. A condition is just a Boolean expression in your
10032 programming language (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). A
10033 tracepoint with a condition evaluates the expression each time your
10034 program reaches it, and data collection happens only if the condition
10035 is true.
10036
10037 Tracepoint conditions can be specified when a tracepoint is set, by
10038 using @samp{if} in the arguments to the @code{trace} command.
10039 @xref{Create and Delete Tracepoints, ,Setting Tracepoints}. They can
10040 also be set or changed at any time with the @code{condition} command,
10041 just as with breakpoints.
10042
10043 Unlike breakpoint conditions, @value{GDBN} does not actually evaluate
10044 the conditional expression itself. Instead, @value{GDBN} encodes the
10045 expression into an agent expression (@pxref{Agent Expressions}
10046 suitable for execution on the target, independently of @value{GDBN}.
10047 Global variables become raw memory locations, locals become stack
10048 accesses, and so forth.
10049
10050 For instance, suppose you have a function that is usually called
10051 frequently, but should not be called after an error has occurred. You
10052 could use the following tracepoint command to collect data about calls
10053 of that function that happen while the error code is propagating
10054 through the program; an unconditional tracepoint could end up
10055 collecting thousands of useless trace frames that you would have to
10056 search through.
10057
10058 @smallexample
10059 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{trace normal_operation if errcode > 0}
10060 @end smallexample
10061
10062 @node Trace State Variables
10063 @subsection Trace State Variables
10064 @cindex trace state variables
10065
10066 A @dfn{trace state variable} is a special type of variable that is
10067 created and managed by target-side code. The syntax is the same as
10068 that for GDB's convenience variables (a string prefixed with ``$''),
10069 but they are stored on the target. They must be created explicitly,
10070 using a @code{tvariable} command. They are always 64-bit signed
10071 integers.
10072
10073 Trace state variables are remembered by @value{GDBN}, and downloaded
10074 to the target along with tracepoint information when the trace
10075 experiment starts. There are no intrinsic limits on the number of
10076 trace state variables, beyond memory limitations of the target.
10077
10078 @cindex convenience variables, and trace state variables
10079 Although trace state variables are managed by the target, you can use
10080 them in print commands and expressions as if they were convenience
10081 variables; @value{GDBN} will get the current value from the target
10082 while the trace experiment is running. Trace state variables share
10083 the same namespace as other ``$'' variables, which means that you
10084 cannot have trace state variables with names like @code{$23} or
10085 @code{$pc}, nor can you have a trace state variable and a convenience
10086 variable with the same name.
10087
10088 @table @code
10089
10090 @item tvariable $@var{name} [ = @var{expression} ]
10091 @kindex tvariable
10092 The @code{tvariable} command creates a new trace state variable named
10093 @code{$@var{name}}, and optionally gives it an initial value of
10094 @var{expression}. @var{expression} is evaluated when this command is
10095 entered; the result will be converted to an integer if possible,
10096 otherwise @value{GDBN} will report an error. A subsequent
10097 @code{tvariable} command specifying the same name does not create a
10098 variable, but instead assigns the supplied initial value to the
10099 existing variable of that name, overwriting any previous initial
10100 value. The default initial value is 0.
10101
10102 @item info tvariables
10103 @kindex info tvariables
10104 List all the trace state variables along with their initial values.
10105 Their current values may also be displayed, if the trace experiment is
10106 currently running.
10107
10108 @item delete tvariable @r{[} $@var{name} @dots{} @r{]}
10109 @kindex delete tvariable
10110 Delete the given trace state variables, or all of them if no arguments
10111 are specified.
10112
10113 @end table
10114
10115 @node Tracepoint Actions
10116 @subsection Tracepoint Action Lists
10117
10118 @table @code
10119 @kindex actions
10120 @cindex tracepoint actions
10121 @item actions @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
10122 This command will prompt for a list of actions to be taken when the
10123 tracepoint is hit. If the tracepoint number @var{num} is not
10124 specified, this command sets the actions for the one that was most
10125 recently defined (so that you can define a tracepoint and then say
10126 @code{actions} without bothering about its number). You specify the
10127 actions themselves on the following lines, one action at a time, and
10128 terminate the actions list with a line containing just @code{end}. So
10129 far, the only defined actions are @code{collect}, @code{teval}, and
10130 @code{while-stepping}.
10131
10132 @code{actions} is actually equivalent to @code{commands} (@pxref{Break
10133 Commands, ,Breakpoint Command Lists}), except that only the defined
10134 actions are allowed; any other @value{GDBN} command is rejected.
10135
10136 @cindex remove actions from a tracepoint
10137 To remove all actions from a tracepoint, type @samp{actions @var{num}}
10138 and follow it immediately with @samp{end}.
10139
10140 @smallexample
10141 (@value{GDBP}) @b{collect @var{data}} // collect some data
10142
10143 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while-stepping 5} // single-step 5 times, collect data
10144
10145 (@value{GDBP}) @b{end} // signals the end of actions.
10146 @end smallexample
10147
10148 In the following example, the action list begins with @code{collect}
10149 commands indicating the things to be collected when the tracepoint is
10150 hit. Then, in order to single-step and collect additional data
10151 following the tracepoint, a @code{while-stepping} command is used,
10152 followed by the list of things to be collected after each step in a
10153 sequence of single steps. The @code{while-stepping} command is
10154 terminated by its own separate @code{end} command. Lastly, the action
10155 list is terminated by an @code{end} command.
10156
10157 @smallexample
10158 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo}
10159 (@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
10160 Enter actions for tracepoint 1, one per line:
10161 > collect bar,baz
10162 > collect $regs
10163 > while-stepping 12
10164 > collect $pc, arr[i]
10165 > end
10166 end
10167 @end smallexample
10168
10169 @kindex collect @r{(tracepoints)}
10170 @item collect @var{expr1}, @var{expr2}, @dots{}
10171 Collect values of the given expressions when the tracepoint is hit.
10172 This command accepts a comma-separated list of any valid expressions.
10173 In addition to global, static, or local variables, the following
10174 special arguments are supported:
10175
10176 @table @code
10177 @item $regs
10178 Collect all registers.
10179
10180 @item $args
10181 Collect all function arguments.
10182
10183 @item $locals
10184 Collect all local variables.
10185
10186 @item $_sdata
10187 @vindex $_sdata@r{, collect}
10188 Collect static tracepoint marker specific data. Only available for
10189 static tracepoints. @xref{Tracepoint Actions,,Tracepoint Action
10190 Lists}. On the UST static tracepoints library backend, an
10191 instrumentation point resembles a @code{printf} function call. The
10192 tracing library is able to collect user specified data formatted to a
10193 character string using the format provided by the programmer that
10194 instrumented the program. Other backends have similar mechanisms.
10195 Here's an example of a UST marker call:
10196
10197 @smallexample
10198 const char master_name[] = "$your_name";
10199 trace_mark(channel1, marker1, "hello %s", master_name)
10200 @end smallexample
10201
10202 In this case, collecting @code{$_sdata} collects the string
10203 @samp{hello $yourname}. When analyzing the trace buffer, you can
10204 inspect @samp{$_sdata} like any other variable available to
10205 @value{GDBN}.
10206 @end table
10207
10208 You can give several consecutive @code{collect} commands, each one
10209 with a single argument, or one @code{collect} command with several
10210 arguments separated by commas; the effect is the same.
10211
10212 The command @code{info scope} (@pxref{Symbols, info scope}) is
10213 particularly useful for figuring out what data to collect.
10214
10215 @kindex teval @r{(tracepoints)}
10216 @item teval @var{expr1}, @var{expr2}, @dots{}
10217 Evaluate the given expressions when the tracepoint is hit. This
10218 command accepts a comma-separated list of expressions. The results
10219 are discarded, so this is mainly useful for assigning values to trace
10220 state variables (@pxref{Trace State Variables}) without adding those
10221 values to the trace buffer, as would be the case if the @code{collect}
10222 action were used.
10223
10224 @kindex while-stepping @r{(tracepoints)}
10225 @item while-stepping @var{n}
10226 Perform @var{n} single-step instruction traces after the tracepoint,
10227 collecting new data after each step. The @code{while-stepping}
10228 command is followed by the list of what to collect while stepping
10229 (followed by its own @code{end} command):
10230
10231 @smallexample
10232 > while-stepping 12
10233 > collect $regs, myglobal
10234 > end
10235 >
10236 @end smallexample
10237
10238 @noindent
10239 Note that @code{$pc} is not automatically collected by
10240 @code{while-stepping}; you need to explicitly collect that register if
10241 you need it. You may abbreviate @code{while-stepping} as @code{ws} or
10242 @code{stepping}.
10243
10244 @item set default-collect @var{expr1}, @var{expr2}, @dots{}
10245 @kindex set default-collect
10246 @cindex default collection action
10247 This variable is a list of expressions to collect at each tracepoint
10248 hit. It is effectively an additional @code{collect} action prepended
10249 to every tracepoint action list. The expressions are parsed
10250 individually for each tracepoint, so for instance a variable named
10251 @code{xyz} may be interpreted as a global for one tracepoint, and a
10252 local for another, as appropriate to the tracepoint's location.
10253
10254 @item show default-collect
10255 @kindex show default-collect
10256 Show the list of expressions that are collected by default at each
10257 tracepoint hit.
10258
10259 @end table
10260
10261 @node Listing Tracepoints
10262 @subsection Listing Tracepoints
10263
10264 @table @code
10265 @kindex info tracepoints
10266 @kindex info tp
10267 @cindex information about tracepoints
10268 @item info tracepoints @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
10269 Display information about the tracepoint @var{num}. If you don't
10270 specify a tracepoint number, displays information about all the
10271 tracepoints defined so far. The format is similar to that used for
10272 @code{info breakpoints}; in fact, @code{info tracepoints} is the same
10273 command, simply restricting itself to tracepoints.
10274
10275 A tracepoint's listing may include additional information specific to
10276 tracing:
10277
10278 @itemize @bullet
10279 @item
10280 its passcount as given by the @code{passcount @var{n}} command
10281 @end itemize
10282
10283 @smallexample
10284 (@value{GDBP}) @b{info trace}
10285 Num Type Disp Enb Address What
10286 1 tracepoint keep y 0x0804ab57 in foo() at main.cxx:7
10287 while-stepping 20
10288 collect globfoo, $regs
10289 end
10290 collect globfoo2
10291 end
10292 pass count 1200
10293 (@value{GDBP})
10294 @end smallexample
10295
10296 @noindent
10297 This command can be abbreviated @code{info tp}.
10298 @end table
10299
10300 @node Listing Static Tracepoint Markers
10301 @subsection Listing Static Tracepoint Markers
10302
10303 @table @code
10304 @kindex info static-tracepoint-markers
10305 @cindex information about static tracepoint markers
10306 @item info static-tracepoint-markers
10307 Display information about all static tracepoint markers defined in the
10308 program.
10309
10310 For each marker, the following columns are printed:
10311
10312 @table @emph
10313 @item Count
10314 An incrementing counter, output to help readability. This is not a
10315 stable identifier.
10316 @item ID
10317 The marker ID, as reported by the target.
10318 @item Enabled or Disabled
10319 Probed markers are tagged with @samp{y}. @samp{n} identifies marks
10320 that are not enabled.
10321 @item Address
10322 Where the marker is in your program, as a memory address.
10323 @item What
10324 Where the marker is in the source for your program, as a file and line
10325 number. If the debug information included in the program does not
10326 allow @value{GDBN} to locate the source of the marker, this column
10327 will be left blank.
10328 @end table
10329
10330 @noindent
10331 In addition, the following information may be printed for each marker:
10332
10333 @table @emph
10334 @item Data
10335 User data passed to the tracing library by the marker call. In the
10336 UST backend, this is the format string passed as argument to the
10337 marker call.
10338 @item Static tracepoints probing the marker
10339 The list of static tracepoints attached to the marker.
10340 @end table
10341
10342 @smallexample
10343 (@value{GDBP}) info static-tracepoint-markers
10344 Cnt ID Enb Address What
10345 1 ust/bar2 y 0x0000000000400e1a in main at stexample.c:25
10346 Data: number1 %d number2 %d
10347 Probed by static tracepoints: #2
10348 2 ust/bar33 n 0x0000000000400c87 in main at stexample.c:24
10349 Data: str %s
10350 (@value{GDBP})
10351 @end smallexample
10352 @end table
10353
10354 @node Starting and Stopping Trace Experiments
10355 @subsection Starting and Stopping Trace Experiments
10356
10357 @table @code
10358 @kindex tstart
10359 @cindex start a new trace experiment
10360 @cindex collected data discarded
10361 @item tstart
10362 This command takes no arguments. It starts the trace experiment, and
10363 begins collecting data. This has the side effect of discarding all
10364 the data collected in the trace buffer during the previous trace
10365 experiment.
10366
10367 @kindex tstop
10368 @cindex stop a running trace experiment
10369 @item tstop
10370 This command takes no arguments. It ends the trace experiment, and
10371 stops collecting data.
10372
10373 @strong{Note}: a trace experiment and data collection may stop
10374 automatically if any tracepoint's passcount is reached
10375 (@pxref{Tracepoint Passcounts}), or if the trace buffer becomes full.
10376
10377 @kindex tstatus
10378 @cindex status of trace data collection
10379 @cindex trace experiment, status of
10380 @item tstatus
10381 This command displays the status of the current trace data
10382 collection.
10383 @end table
10384
10385 Here is an example of the commands we described so far:
10386
10387 @smallexample
10388 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace gdb_c_test}
10389 (@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
10390 Enter actions for tracepoint #1, one per line.
10391 > collect $regs,$locals,$args
10392 > while-stepping 11
10393 > collect $regs
10394 > end
10395 > end
10396 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tstart}
10397 [time passes @dots{}]
10398 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tstop}
10399 @end smallexample
10400
10401 @cindex disconnected tracing
10402 You can choose to continue running the trace experiment even if
10403 @value{GDBN} disconnects from the target, voluntarily or
10404 involuntarily. For commands such as @code{detach}, the debugger will
10405 ask what you want to do with the trace. But for unexpected
10406 terminations (@value{GDBN} crash, network outage), it would be
10407 unfortunate to lose hard-won trace data, so the variable
10408 @code{disconnected-tracing} lets you decide whether the trace should
10409 continue running without @value{GDBN}.
10410
10411 @table @code
10412 @item set disconnected-tracing on
10413 @itemx set disconnected-tracing off
10414 @kindex set disconnected-tracing
10415 Choose whether a tracing run should continue to run if @value{GDBN}
10416 has disconnected from the target. Note that @code{detach} or
10417 @code{quit} will ask you directly what to do about a running trace no
10418 matter what this variable's setting, so the variable is mainly useful
10419 for handling unexpected situations, such as loss of the network.
10420
10421 @item show disconnected-tracing
10422 @kindex show disconnected-tracing
10423 Show the current choice for disconnected tracing.
10424
10425 @end table
10426
10427 When you reconnect to the target, the trace experiment may or may not
10428 still be running; it might have filled the trace buffer in the
10429 meantime, or stopped for one of the other reasons. If it is running,
10430 it will continue after reconnection.
10431
10432 Upon reconnection, the target will upload information about the
10433 tracepoints in effect. @value{GDBN} will then compare that
10434 information to the set of tracepoints currently defined, and attempt
10435 to match them up, allowing for the possibility that the numbers may
10436 have changed due to creation and deletion in the meantime. If one of
10437 the target's tracepoints does not match any in @value{GDBN}, the
10438 debugger will create a new tracepoint, so that you have a number with
10439 which to specify that tracepoint. This matching-up process is
10440 necessarily heuristic, and it may result in useless tracepoints being
10441 created; you may simply delete them if they are of no use.
10442
10443 @cindex circular trace buffer
10444 If your target agent supports a @dfn{circular trace buffer}, then you
10445 can run a trace experiment indefinitely without filling the trace
10446 buffer; when space runs out, the agent deletes already-collected trace
10447 frames, oldest first, until there is enough room to continue
10448 collecting. This is especially useful if your tracepoints are being
10449 hit too often, and your trace gets terminated prematurely because the
10450 buffer is full. To ask for a circular trace buffer, simply set
10451 @samp{circular_trace_buffer} to on. You can set this at any time,
10452 including during tracing; if the agent can do it, it will change
10453 buffer handling on the fly, otherwise it will not take effect until
10454 the next run.
10455
10456 @table @code
10457 @item set circular-trace-buffer on
10458 @itemx set circular-trace-buffer off
10459 @kindex set circular-trace-buffer
10460 Choose whether a tracing run should use a linear or circular buffer
10461 for trace data. A linear buffer will not lose any trace data, but may
10462 fill up prematurely, while a circular buffer will discard old trace
10463 data, but it will have always room for the latest tracepoint hits.
10464
10465 @item show circular-trace-buffer
10466 @kindex show circular-trace-buffer
10467 Show the current choice for the trace buffer. Note that this may not
10468 match the agent's current buffer handling, nor is it guaranteed to
10469 match the setting that might have been in effect during a past run,
10470 for instance if you are looking at frames from a trace file.
10471
10472 @end table
10473
10474 @node Tracepoint Restrictions
10475 @subsection Tracepoint Restrictions
10476
10477 @cindex tracepoint restrictions
10478 There are a number of restrictions on the use of tracepoints. As
10479 described above, tracepoint data gathering occurs on the target
10480 without interaction from @value{GDBN}. Thus the full capabilities of
10481 the debugger are not available during data gathering, and then at data
10482 examination time, you will be limited by only having what was
10483 collected. The following items describe some common problems, but it
10484 is not exhaustive, and you may run into additional difficulties not
10485 mentioned here.
10486
10487 @itemize @bullet
10488
10489 @item
10490 Tracepoint expressions are intended to gather objects (lvalues). Thus
10491 the full flexibility of GDB's expression evaluator is not available.
10492 You cannot call functions, cast objects to aggregate types, access
10493 convenience variables or modify values (except by assignment to trace
10494 state variables). Some language features may implicitly call
10495 functions (for instance Objective-C fields with accessors), and therefore
10496 cannot be collected either.
10497
10498 @item
10499 Collection of local variables, either individually or in bulk with
10500 @code{$locals} or @code{$args}, during @code{while-stepping} may
10501 behave erratically. The stepping action may enter a new scope (for
10502 instance by stepping into a function), or the location of the variable
10503 may change (for instance it is loaded into a register). The
10504 tracepoint data recorded uses the location information for the
10505 variables that is correct for the tracepoint location. When the
10506 tracepoint is created, it is not possible, in general, to determine
10507 where the steps of a @code{while-stepping} sequence will advance the
10508 program---particularly if a conditional branch is stepped.
10509
10510 @item
10511 Collection of an incompletely-initialized or partially-destroyed object
10512 may result in something that @value{GDBN} cannot display, or displays
10513 in a misleading way.
10514
10515 @item
10516 When @value{GDBN} displays a pointer to character it automatically
10517 dereferences the pointer to also display characters of the string
10518 being pointed to. However, collecting the pointer during tracing does
10519 not automatically collect the string. You need to explicitly
10520 dereference the pointer and provide size information if you want to
10521 collect not only the pointer, but the memory pointed to. For example,
10522 @code{*ptr@@50} can be used to collect the 50 element array pointed to
10523 by @code{ptr}.
10524
10525 @item
10526 It is not possible to collect a complete stack backtrace at a
10527 tracepoint. Instead, you may collect the registers and a few hundred
10528 bytes from the stack pointer with something like @code{*$esp@@300}
10529 (adjust to use the name of the actual stack pointer register on your
10530 target architecture, and the amount of stack you wish to capture).
10531 Then the @code{backtrace} command will show a partial backtrace when
10532 using a trace frame. The number of stack frames that can be examined
10533 depends on the sizes of the frames in the collected stack. Note that
10534 if you ask for a block so large that it goes past the bottom of the
10535 stack, the target agent may report an error trying to read from an
10536 invalid address.
10537
10538 @item
10539 If you do not collect registers at a tracepoint, @value{GDBN} can
10540 infer that the value of @code{$pc} must be the same as the address of
10541 the tracepoint and use that when you are looking at a trace frame
10542 for that tracepoint. However, this cannot work if the tracepoint has
10543 multiple locations (for instance if it was set in a function that was
10544 inlined), or if it has a @code{while-stepping} loop. In those cases
10545 @value{GDBN} will warn you that it can't infer @code{$pc}, and default
10546 it to zero.
10547
10548 @end itemize
10549
10550 @node Analyze Collected Data
10551 @section Using the Collected Data
10552
10553 After the tracepoint experiment ends, you use @value{GDBN} commands
10554 for examining the trace data. The basic idea is that each tracepoint
10555 collects a trace @dfn{snapshot} every time it is hit and another
10556 snapshot every time it single-steps. All these snapshots are
10557 consecutively numbered from zero and go into a buffer, and you can
10558 examine them later. The way you examine them is to @dfn{focus} on a
10559 specific trace snapshot. When the remote stub is focused on a trace
10560 snapshot, it will respond to all @value{GDBN} requests for memory and
10561 registers by reading from the buffer which belongs to that snapshot,
10562 rather than from @emph{real} memory or registers of the program being
10563 debugged. This means that @strong{all} @value{GDBN} commands
10564 (@code{print}, @code{info registers}, @code{backtrace}, etc.) will
10565 behave as if we were currently debugging the program state as it was
10566 when the tracepoint occurred. Any requests for data that are not in
10567 the buffer will fail.
10568
10569 @menu
10570 * tfind:: How to select a trace snapshot
10571 * tdump:: How to display all data for a snapshot
10572 * save tracepoints:: How to save tracepoints for a future run
10573 @end menu
10574
10575 @node tfind
10576 @subsection @code{tfind @var{n}}
10577
10578 @kindex tfind
10579 @cindex select trace snapshot
10580 @cindex find trace snapshot
10581 The basic command for selecting a trace snapshot from the buffer is
10582 @code{tfind @var{n}}, which finds trace snapshot number @var{n},
10583 counting from zero. If no argument @var{n} is given, the next
10584 snapshot is selected.
10585
10586 Here are the various forms of using the @code{tfind} command.
10587
10588 @table @code
10589 @item tfind start
10590 Find the first snapshot in the buffer. This is a synonym for
10591 @code{tfind 0} (since 0 is the number of the first snapshot).
10592
10593 @item tfind none
10594 Stop debugging trace snapshots, resume @emph{live} debugging.
10595
10596 @item tfind end
10597 Same as @samp{tfind none}.
10598
10599 @item tfind
10600 No argument means find the next trace snapshot.
10601
10602 @item tfind -
10603 Find the previous trace snapshot before the current one. This permits
10604 retracing earlier steps.
10605
10606 @item tfind tracepoint @var{num}
10607 Find the next snapshot associated with tracepoint @var{num}. Search
10608 proceeds forward from the last examined trace snapshot. If no
10609 argument @var{num} is given, it means find the next snapshot collected
10610 for the same tracepoint as the current snapshot.
10611
10612 @item tfind pc @var{addr}
10613 Find the next snapshot associated with the value @var{addr} of the
10614 program counter. Search proceeds forward from the last examined trace
10615 snapshot. If no argument @var{addr} is given, it means find the next
10616 snapshot with the same value of PC as the current snapshot.
10617
10618 @item tfind outside @var{addr1}, @var{addr2}
10619 Find the next snapshot whose PC is outside the given range of
10620 addresses (exclusive).
10621
10622 @item tfind range @var{addr1}, @var{addr2}
10623 Find the next snapshot whose PC is between @var{addr1} and
10624 @var{addr2} (inclusive).
10625
10626 @item tfind line @r{[}@var{file}:@r{]}@var{n}
10627 Find the next snapshot associated with the source line @var{n}. If
10628 the optional argument @var{file} is given, refer to line @var{n} in
10629 that source file. Search proceeds forward from the last examined
10630 trace snapshot. If no argument @var{n} is given, it means find the
10631 next line other than the one currently being examined; thus saying
10632 @code{tfind line} repeatedly can appear to have the same effect as
10633 stepping from line to line in a @emph{live} debugging session.
10634 @end table
10635
10636 The default arguments for the @code{tfind} commands are specifically
10637 designed to make it easy to scan through the trace buffer. For
10638 instance, @code{tfind} with no argument selects the next trace
10639 snapshot, and @code{tfind -} with no argument selects the previous
10640 trace snapshot. So, by giving one @code{tfind} command, and then
10641 simply hitting @key{RET} repeatedly you can examine all the trace
10642 snapshots in order. Or, by saying @code{tfind -} and then hitting
10643 @key{RET} repeatedly you can examine the snapshots in reverse order.
10644 The @code{tfind line} command with no argument selects the snapshot
10645 for the next source line executed. The @code{tfind pc} command with
10646 no argument selects the next snapshot with the same program counter
10647 (PC) as the current frame. The @code{tfind tracepoint} command with
10648 no argument selects the next trace snapshot collected by the same
10649 tracepoint as the current one.
10650
10651 In addition to letting you scan through the trace buffer manually,
10652 these commands make it easy to construct @value{GDBN} scripts that
10653 scan through the trace buffer and print out whatever collected data
10654 you are interested in. Thus, if we want to examine the PC, FP, and SP
10655 registers from each trace frame in the buffer, we can say this:
10656
10657 @smallexample
10658 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
10659 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while ($trace_frame != -1)}
10660 > printf "Frame %d, PC = %08X, SP = %08X, FP = %08X\n", \
10661 $trace_frame, $pc, $sp, $fp
10662 > tfind
10663 > end
10664
10665 Frame 0, PC = 0020DC64, SP = 0030BF3C, FP = 0030BF44
10666 Frame 1, PC = 0020DC6C, SP = 0030BF38, FP = 0030BF44
10667 Frame 2, PC = 0020DC70, SP = 0030BF34, FP = 0030BF44
10668 Frame 3, PC = 0020DC74, SP = 0030BF30, FP = 0030BF44
10669 Frame 4, PC = 0020DC78, SP = 0030BF2C, FP = 0030BF44
10670 Frame 5, PC = 0020DC7C, SP = 0030BF28, FP = 0030BF44
10671 Frame 6, PC = 0020DC80, SP = 0030BF24, FP = 0030BF44
10672 Frame 7, PC = 0020DC84, SP = 0030BF20, FP = 0030BF44
10673 Frame 8, PC = 0020DC88, SP = 0030BF1C, FP = 0030BF44
10674 Frame 9, PC = 0020DC8E, SP = 0030BF18, FP = 0030BF44
10675 Frame 10, PC = 00203F6C, SP = 0030BE3C, FP = 0030BF14
10676 @end smallexample
10677
10678 Or, if we want to examine the variable @code{X} at each source line in
10679 the buffer:
10680
10681 @smallexample
10682 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
10683 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while ($trace_frame != -1)}
10684 > printf "Frame %d, X == %d\n", $trace_frame, X
10685 > tfind line
10686 > end
10687
10688 Frame 0, X = 1
10689 Frame 7, X = 2
10690 Frame 13, X = 255
10691 @end smallexample
10692
10693 @node tdump
10694 @subsection @code{tdump}
10695 @kindex tdump
10696 @cindex dump all data collected at tracepoint
10697 @cindex tracepoint data, display
10698
10699 This command takes no arguments. It prints all the data collected at
10700 the current trace snapshot.
10701
10702 @smallexample
10703 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace 444}
10704 (@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
10705 Enter actions for tracepoint #2, one per line:
10706 > collect $regs, $locals, $args, gdb_long_test
10707 > end
10708
10709 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tstart}
10710
10711 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind line 444}
10712 #0 gdb_test (p1=0x11, p2=0x22, p3=0x33, p4=0x44, p5=0x55, p6=0x66)
10713 at gdb_test.c:444
10714 444 printp( "%s: arguments = 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X\n", )
10715
10716 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tdump}
10717 Data collected at tracepoint 2, trace frame 1:
10718 d0 0xc4aa0085 -995491707
10719 d1 0x18 24
10720 d2 0x80 128
10721 d3 0x33 51
10722 d4 0x71aea3d 119204413
10723 d5 0x22 34
10724 d6 0xe0 224
10725 d7 0x380035 3670069
10726 a0 0x19e24a 1696330
10727 a1 0x3000668 50333288
10728 a2 0x100 256
10729 a3 0x322000 3284992
10730 a4 0x3000698 50333336
10731 a5 0x1ad3cc 1758156
10732 fp 0x30bf3c 0x30bf3c
10733 sp 0x30bf34 0x30bf34
10734 ps 0x0 0
10735 pc 0x20b2c8 0x20b2c8
10736 fpcontrol 0x0 0
10737 fpstatus 0x0 0
10738 fpiaddr 0x0 0
10739 p = 0x20e5b4 "gdb-test"
10740 p1 = (void *) 0x11
10741 p2 = (void *) 0x22
10742 p3 = (void *) 0x33
10743 p4 = (void *) 0x44
10744 p5 = (void *) 0x55
10745 p6 = (void *) 0x66
10746 gdb_long_test = 17 '\021'
10747
10748 (@value{GDBP})
10749 @end smallexample
10750
10751 @code{tdump} works by scanning the tracepoint's current collection
10752 actions and printing the value of each expression listed. So
10753 @code{tdump} can fail, if after a run, you change the tracepoint's
10754 actions to mention variables that were not collected during the run.
10755
10756 Also, for tracepoints with @code{while-stepping} loops, @code{tdump}
10757 uses the collected value of @code{$pc} to distinguish between trace
10758 frames that were collected at the tracepoint hit, and frames that were
10759 collected while stepping. This allows it to correctly choose whether
10760 to display the basic list of collections, or the collections from the
10761 body of the while-stepping loop. However, if @code{$pc} was not collected,
10762 then @code{tdump} will always attempt to dump using the basic collection
10763 list, and may fail if a while-stepping frame does not include all the
10764 same data that is collected at the tracepoint hit.
10765 @c This is getting pretty arcane, example would be good.
10766
10767 @node save tracepoints
10768 @subsection @code{save tracepoints @var{filename}}
10769 @kindex save tracepoints
10770 @kindex save-tracepoints
10771 @cindex save tracepoints for future sessions
10772
10773 This command saves all current tracepoint definitions together with
10774 their actions and passcounts, into a file @file{@var{filename}}
10775 suitable for use in a later debugging session. To read the saved
10776 tracepoint definitions, use the @code{source} command (@pxref{Command
10777 Files}). The @w{@code{save-tracepoints}} command is a deprecated
10778 alias for @w{@code{save tracepoints}}
10779
10780 @node Tracepoint Variables
10781 @section Convenience Variables for Tracepoints
10782 @cindex tracepoint variables
10783 @cindex convenience variables for tracepoints
10784
10785 @table @code
10786 @vindex $trace_frame
10787 @item (int) $trace_frame
10788 The current trace snapshot (a.k.a.@: @dfn{frame}) number, or -1 if no
10789 snapshot is selected.
10790
10791 @vindex $tracepoint
10792 @item (int) $tracepoint
10793 The tracepoint for the current trace snapshot.
10794
10795 @vindex $trace_line
10796 @item (int) $trace_line
10797 The line number for the current trace snapshot.
10798
10799 @vindex $trace_file
10800 @item (char []) $trace_file
10801 The source file for the current trace snapshot.
10802
10803 @vindex $trace_func
10804 @item (char []) $trace_func
10805 The name of the function containing @code{$tracepoint}.
10806 @end table
10807
10808 Note: @code{$trace_file} is not suitable for use in @code{printf},
10809 use @code{output} instead.
10810
10811 Here's a simple example of using these convenience variables for
10812 stepping through all the trace snapshots and printing some of their
10813 data. Note that these are not the same as trace state variables,
10814 which are managed by the target.
10815
10816 @smallexample
10817 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
10818
10819 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while $trace_frame != -1}
10820 > output $trace_file
10821 > printf ", line %d (tracepoint #%d)\n", $trace_line, $tracepoint
10822 > tfind
10823 > end
10824 @end smallexample
10825
10826 @node Trace Files
10827 @section Using Trace Files
10828 @cindex trace files
10829
10830 In some situations, the target running a trace experiment may no
10831 longer be available; perhaps it crashed, or the hardware was needed
10832 for a different activity. To handle these cases, you can arrange to
10833 dump the trace data into a file, and later use that file as a source
10834 of trace data, via the @code{target tfile} command.
10835
10836 @table @code
10837
10838 @kindex tsave
10839 @item tsave [ -r ] @var{filename}
10840 Save the trace data to @var{filename}. By default, this command
10841 assumes that @var{filename} refers to the host filesystem, so if
10842 necessary @value{GDBN} will copy raw trace data up from the target and
10843 then save it. If the target supports it, you can also supply the
10844 optional argument @code{-r} (``remote'') to direct the target to save
10845 the data directly into @var{filename} in its own filesystem, which may be
10846 more efficient if the trace buffer is very large. (Note, however, that
10847 @code{target tfile} can only read from files accessible to the host.)
10848
10849 @kindex target tfile
10850 @kindex tfile
10851 @item target tfile @var{filename}
10852 Use the file named @var{filename} as a source of trace data. Commands
10853 that examine data work as they do with a live target, but it is not
10854 possible to run any new trace experiments. @code{tstatus} will report
10855 the state of the trace run at the moment the data was saved, as well
10856 as the current trace frame you are examining. @var{filename} must be
10857 on a filesystem accessible to the host.
10858
10859 @end table
10860
10861 @node Overlays
10862 @chapter Debugging Programs That Use Overlays
10863 @cindex overlays
10864
10865 If your program is too large to fit completely in your target system's
10866 memory, you can sometimes use @dfn{overlays} to work around this
10867 problem. @value{GDBN} provides some support for debugging programs that
10868 use overlays.
10869
10870 @menu
10871 * How Overlays Work:: A general explanation of overlays.
10872 * Overlay Commands:: Managing overlays in @value{GDBN}.
10873 * Automatic Overlay Debugging:: @value{GDBN} can find out which overlays are
10874 mapped by asking the inferior.
10875 * Overlay Sample Program:: A sample program using overlays.
10876 @end menu
10877
10878 @node How Overlays Work
10879 @section How Overlays Work
10880 @cindex mapped overlays
10881 @cindex unmapped overlays
10882 @cindex load address, overlay's
10883 @cindex mapped address
10884 @cindex overlay area
10885
10886 Suppose you have a computer whose instruction address space is only 64
10887 kilobytes long, but which has much more memory which can be accessed by
10888 other means: special instructions, segment registers, or memory
10889 management hardware, for example. Suppose further that you want to
10890 adapt a program which is larger than 64 kilobytes to run on this system.
10891
10892 One solution is to identify modules of your program which are relatively
10893 independent, and need not call each other directly; call these modules
10894 @dfn{overlays}. Separate the overlays from the main program, and place
10895 their machine code in the larger memory. Place your main program in
10896 instruction memory, but leave at least enough space there to hold the
10897 largest overlay as well.
10898
10899 Now, to call a function located in an overlay, you must first copy that
10900 overlay's machine code from the large memory into the space set aside
10901 for it in the instruction memory, and then jump to its entry point
10902 there.
10903
10904 @c NB: In the below the mapped area's size is greater or equal to the
10905 @c size of all overlays. This is intentional to remind the developer
10906 @c that overlays don't necessarily need to be the same size.
10907
10908 @smallexample
10909 @group
10910 Data Instruction Larger
10911 Address Space Address Space Address Space
10912 +-----------+ +-----------+ +-----------+
10913 | | | | | |
10914 +-----------+ +-----------+ +-----------+<-- overlay 1
10915 | program | | main | .----| overlay 1 | load address
10916 | variables | | program | | +-----------+
10917 | and heap | | | | | |
10918 +-----------+ | | | +-----------+<-- overlay 2
10919 | | +-----------+ | | | load address
10920 +-----------+ | | | .-| overlay 2 |
10921 | | | | | |
10922 mapped --->+-----------+ | | +-----------+
10923 address | | | | | |
10924 | overlay | <-' | | |
10925 | area | <---' +-----------+<-- overlay 3
10926 | | <---. | | load address
10927 +-----------+ `--| overlay 3 |
10928 | | | |
10929 +-----------+ | |
10930 +-----------+
10931 | |
10932 +-----------+
10933
10934 @anchor{A code overlay}A code overlay
10935 @end group
10936 @end smallexample
10937
10938 The diagram (@pxref{A code overlay}) shows a system with separate data
10939 and instruction address spaces. To map an overlay, the program copies
10940 its code from the larger address space to the instruction address space.
10941 Since the overlays shown here all use the same mapped address, only one
10942 may be mapped at a time. For a system with a single address space for
10943 data and instructions, the diagram would be similar, except that the
10944 program variables and heap would share an address space with the main
10945 program and the overlay area.
10946
10947 An overlay loaded into instruction memory and ready for use is called a
10948 @dfn{mapped} overlay; its @dfn{mapped address} is its address in the
10949 instruction memory. An overlay not present (or only partially present)
10950 in instruction memory is called @dfn{unmapped}; its @dfn{load address}
10951 is its address in the larger memory. The mapped address is also called
10952 the @dfn{virtual memory address}, or @dfn{VMA}; the load address is also
10953 called the @dfn{load memory address}, or @dfn{LMA}.
10954
10955 Unfortunately, overlays are not a completely transparent way to adapt a
10956 program to limited instruction memory. They introduce a new set of
10957 global constraints you must keep in mind as you design your program:
10958
10959 @itemize @bullet
10960
10961 @item
10962 Before calling or returning to a function in an overlay, your program
10963 must make sure that overlay is actually mapped. Otherwise, the call or
10964 return will transfer control to the right address, but in the wrong
10965 overlay, and your program will probably crash.
10966
10967 @item
10968 If the process of mapping an overlay is expensive on your system, you
10969 will need to choose your overlays carefully to minimize their effect on
10970 your program's performance.
10971
10972 @item
10973 The executable file you load onto your system must contain each
10974 overlay's instructions, appearing at the overlay's load address, not its
10975 mapped address. However, each overlay's instructions must be relocated
10976 and its symbols defined as if the overlay were at its mapped address.
10977 You can use GNU linker scripts to specify different load and relocation
10978 addresses for pieces of your program; see @ref{Overlay Description,,,
10979 ld.info, Using ld: the GNU linker}.
10980
10981 @item
10982 The procedure for loading executable files onto your system must be able
10983 to load their contents into the larger address space as well as the
10984 instruction and data spaces.
10985
10986 @end itemize
10987
10988 The overlay system described above is rather simple, and could be
10989 improved in many ways:
10990
10991 @itemize @bullet
10992
10993 @item
10994 If your system has suitable bank switch registers or memory management
10995 hardware, you could use those facilities to make an overlay's load area
10996 contents simply appear at their mapped address in instruction space.
10997 This would probably be faster than copying the overlay to its mapped
10998 area in the usual way.
10999
11000 @item
11001 If your overlays are small enough, you could set aside more than one
11002 overlay area, and have more than one overlay mapped at a time.
11003
11004 @item
11005 You can use overlays to manage data, as well as instructions. In
11006 general, data overlays are even less transparent to your design than
11007 code overlays: whereas code overlays only require care when you call or
11008 return to functions, data overlays require care every time you access
11009 the data. Also, if you change the contents of a data overlay, you
11010 must copy its contents back out to its load address before you can copy a
11011 different data overlay into the same mapped area.
11012
11013 @end itemize
11014
11015
11016 @node Overlay Commands
11017 @section Overlay Commands
11018
11019 To use @value{GDBN}'s overlay support, each overlay in your program must
11020 correspond to a separate section of the executable file. The section's
11021 virtual memory address and load memory address must be the overlay's
11022 mapped and load addresses. Identifying overlays with sections allows
11023 @value{GDBN} to determine the appropriate address of a function or
11024 variable, depending on whether the overlay is mapped or not.
11025
11026 @value{GDBN}'s overlay commands all start with the word @code{overlay};
11027 you can abbreviate this as @code{ov} or @code{ovly}. The commands are:
11028
11029 @table @code
11030 @item overlay off
11031 @kindex overlay
11032 Disable @value{GDBN}'s overlay support. When overlay support is
11033 disabled, @value{GDBN} assumes that all functions and variables are
11034 always present at their mapped addresses. By default, @value{GDBN}'s
11035 overlay support is disabled.
11036
11037 @item overlay manual
11038 @cindex manual overlay debugging
11039 Enable @dfn{manual} overlay debugging. In this mode, @value{GDBN}
11040 relies on you to tell it which overlays are mapped, and which are not,
11041 using the @code{overlay map-overlay} and @code{overlay unmap-overlay}
11042 commands described below.
11043
11044 @item overlay map-overlay @var{overlay}
11045 @itemx overlay map @var{overlay}
11046 @cindex map an overlay
11047 Tell @value{GDBN} that @var{overlay} is now mapped; @var{overlay} must
11048 be the name of the object file section containing the overlay. When an
11049 overlay is mapped, @value{GDBN} assumes it can find the overlay's
11050 functions and variables at their mapped addresses. @value{GDBN} assumes
11051 that any other overlays whose mapped ranges overlap that of
11052 @var{overlay} are now unmapped.
11053
11054 @item overlay unmap-overlay @var{overlay}
11055 @itemx overlay unmap @var{overlay}
11056 @cindex unmap an overlay
11057 Tell @value{GDBN} that @var{overlay} is no longer mapped; @var{overlay}
11058 must be the name of the object file section containing the overlay.
11059 When an overlay is unmapped, @value{GDBN} assumes it can find the
11060 overlay's functions and variables at their load addresses.
11061
11062 @item overlay auto
11063 Enable @dfn{automatic} overlay debugging. In this mode, @value{GDBN}
11064 consults a data structure the overlay manager maintains in the inferior
11065 to see which overlays are mapped. For details, see @ref{Automatic
11066 Overlay Debugging}.
11067
11068 @item overlay load-target
11069 @itemx overlay load
11070 @cindex reloading the overlay table
11071 Re-read the overlay table from the inferior. Normally, @value{GDBN}
11072 re-reads the table @value{GDBN} automatically each time the inferior
11073 stops, so this command should only be necessary if you have changed the
11074 overlay mapping yourself using @value{GDBN}. This command is only
11075 useful when using automatic overlay debugging.
11076
11077 @item overlay list-overlays
11078 @itemx overlay list
11079 @cindex listing mapped overlays
11080 Display a list of the overlays currently mapped, along with their mapped
11081 addresses, load addresses, and sizes.
11082
11083 @end table
11084
11085 Normally, when @value{GDBN} prints a code address, it includes the name
11086 of the function the address falls in:
11087
11088 @smallexample
11089 (@value{GDBP}) print main
11090 $3 = @{int ()@} 0x11a0 <main>
11091 @end smallexample
11092 @noindent
11093 When overlay debugging is enabled, @value{GDBN} recognizes code in
11094 unmapped overlays, and prints the names of unmapped functions with
11095 asterisks around them. For example, if @code{foo} is a function in an
11096 unmapped overlay, @value{GDBN} prints it this way:
11097
11098 @smallexample
11099 (@value{GDBP}) overlay list
11100 No sections are mapped.
11101 (@value{GDBP}) print foo
11102 $5 = @{int (int)@} 0x100000 <*foo*>
11103 @end smallexample
11104 @noindent
11105 When @code{foo}'s overlay is mapped, @value{GDBN} prints the function's
11106 name normally:
11107
11108 @smallexample
11109 (@value{GDBP}) overlay list
11110 Section .ov.foo.text, loaded at 0x100000 - 0x100034,
11111 mapped at 0x1016 - 0x104a
11112 (@value{GDBP}) print foo
11113 $6 = @{int (int)@} 0x1016 <foo>
11114 @end smallexample
11115
11116 When overlay debugging is enabled, @value{GDBN} can find the correct
11117 address for functions and variables in an overlay, whether or not the
11118 overlay is mapped. This allows most @value{GDBN} commands, like
11119 @code{break} and @code{disassemble}, to work normally, even on unmapped
11120 code. However, @value{GDBN}'s breakpoint support has some limitations:
11121
11122 @itemize @bullet
11123 @item
11124 @cindex breakpoints in overlays
11125 @cindex overlays, setting breakpoints in
11126 You can set breakpoints in functions in unmapped overlays, as long as
11127 @value{GDBN} can write to the overlay at its load address.
11128 @item
11129 @value{GDBN} can not set hardware or simulator-based breakpoints in
11130 unmapped overlays. However, if you set a breakpoint at the end of your
11131 overlay manager (and tell @value{GDBN} which overlays are now mapped, if
11132 you are using manual overlay management), @value{GDBN} will re-set its
11133 breakpoints properly.
11134 @end itemize
11135
11136
11137 @node Automatic Overlay Debugging
11138 @section Automatic Overlay Debugging
11139 @cindex automatic overlay debugging
11140
11141 @value{GDBN} can automatically track which overlays are mapped and which
11142 are not, given some simple co-operation from the overlay manager in the
11143 inferior. If you enable automatic overlay debugging with the
11144 @code{overlay auto} command (@pxref{Overlay Commands}), @value{GDBN}
11145 looks in the inferior's memory for certain variables describing the
11146 current state of the overlays.
11147
11148 Here are the variables your overlay manager must define to support
11149 @value{GDBN}'s automatic overlay debugging:
11150
11151 @table @asis
11152
11153 @item @code{_ovly_table}:
11154 This variable must be an array of the following structures:
11155
11156 @smallexample
11157 struct
11158 @{
11159 /* The overlay's mapped address. */
11160 unsigned long vma;
11161
11162 /* The size of the overlay, in bytes. */
11163 unsigned long size;
11164
11165 /* The overlay's load address. */
11166 unsigned long lma;
11167
11168 /* Non-zero if the overlay is currently mapped;
11169 zero otherwise. */
11170 unsigned long mapped;
11171 @}
11172 @end smallexample
11173
11174 @item @code{_novlys}:
11175 This variable must be a four-byte signed integer, holding the total
11176 number of elements in @code{_ovly_table}.
11177
11178 @end table
11179
11180 To decide whether a particular overlay is mapped or not, @value{GDBN}
11181 looks for an entry in @w{@code{_ovly_table}} whose @code{vma} and
11182 @code{lma} members equal the VMA and LMA of the overlay's section in the
11183 executable file. When @value{GDBN} finds a matching entry, it consults
11184 the entry's @code{mapped} member to determine whether the overlay is
11185 currently mapped.
11186
11187 In addition, your overlay manager may define a function called
11188 @code{_ovly_debug_event}. If this function is defined, @value{GDBN}
11189 will silently set a breakpoint there. If the overlay manager then
11190 calls this function whenever it has changed the overlay table, this
11191 will enable @value{GDBN} to accurately keep track of which overlays
11192 are in program memory, and update any breakpoints that may be set
11193 in overlays. This will allow breakpoints to work even if the
11194 overlays are kept in ROM or other non-writable memory while they
11195 are not being executed.
11196
11197 @node Overlay Sample Program
11198 @section Overlay Sample Program
11199 @cindex overlay example program
11200
11201 When linking a program which uses overlays, you must place the overlays
11202 at their load addresses, while relocating them to run at their mapped
11203 addresses. To do this, you must write a linker script (@pxref{Overlay
11204 Description,,, ld.info, Using ld: the GNU linker}). Unfortunately,
11205 since linker scripts are specific to a particular host system, target
11206 architecture, and target memory layout, this manual cannot provide
11207 portable sample code demonstrating @value{GDBN}'s overlay support.
11208
11209 However, the @value{GDBN} source distribution does contain an overlaid
11210 program, with linker scripts for a few systems, as part of its test
11211 suite. The program consists of the following files from
11212 @file{gdb/testsuite/gdb.base}:
11213
11214 @table @file
11215 @item overlays.c
11216 The main program file.
11217 @item ovlymgr.c
11218 A simple overlay manager, used by @file{overlays.c}.
11219 @item foo.c
11220 @itemx bar.c
11221 @itemx baz.c
11222 @itemx grbx.c
11223 Overlay modules, loaded and used by @file{overlays.c}.
11224 @item d10v.ld
11225 @itemx m32r.ld
11226 Linker scripts for linking the test program on the @code{d10v-elf}
11227 and @code{m32r-elf} targets.
11228 @end table
11229
11230 You can build the test program using the @code{d10v-elf} GCC
11231 cross-compiler like this:
11232
11233 @smallexample
11234 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c overlays.c
11235 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c ovlymgr.c
11236 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c foo.c
11237 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c bar.c
11238 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c baz.c
11239 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c grbx.c
11240 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g overlays.o ovlymgr.o foo.o bar.o \
11241 baz.o grbx.o -Wl,-Td10v.ld -o overlays
11242 @end smallexample
11243
11244 The build process is identical for any other architecture, except that
11245 you must substitute the appropriate compiler and linker script for the
11246 target system for @code{d10v-elf-gcc} and @code{d10v.ld}.
11247
11248
11249 @node Languages
11250 @chapter Using @value{GDBN} with Different Languages
11251 @cindex languages
11252
11253 Although programming languages generally have common aspects, they are
11254 rarely expressed in the same manner. For instance, in ANSI C,
11255 dereferencing a pointer @code{p} is accomplished by @code{*p}, but in
11256 Modula-2, it is accomplished by @code{p^}. Values can also be
11257 represented (and displayed) differently. Hex numbers in C appear as
11258 @samp{0x1ae}, while in Modula-2 they appear as @samp{1AEH}.
11259
11260 @cindex working language
11261 Language-specific information is built into @value{GDBN} for some languages,
11262 allowing you to express operations like the above in your program's
11263 native language, and allowing @value{GDBN} to output values in a manner
11264 consistent with the syntax of your program's native language. The
11265 language you use to build expressions is called the @dfn{working
11266 language}.
11267
11268 @menu
11269 * Setting:: Switching between source languages
11270 * Show:: Displaying the language
11271 * Checks:: Type and range checks
11272 * Supported Languages:: Supported languages
11273 * Unsupported Languages:: Unsupported languages
11274 @end menu
11275
11276 @node Setting
11277 @section Switching Between Source Languages
11278
11279 There are two ways to control the working language---either have @value{GDBN}
11280 set it automatically, or select it manually yourself. You can use the
11281 @code{set language} command for either purpose. On startup, @value{GDBN}
11282 defaults to setting the language automatically. The working language is
11283 used to determine how expressions you type are interpreted, how values
11284 are printed, etc.
11285
11286 In addition to the working language, every source file that
11287 @value{GDBN} knows about has its own working language. For some object
11288 file formats, the compiler might indicate which language a particular
11289 source file is in. However, most of the time @value{GDBN} infers the
11290 language from the name of the file. The language of a source file
11291 controls whether C@t{++} names are demangled---this way @code{backtrace} can
11292 show each frame appropriately for its own language. There is no way to
11293 set the language of a source file from within @value{GDBN}, but you can
11294 set the language associated with a filename extension. @xref{Show, ,
11295 Displaying the Language}.
11296
11297 This is most commonly a problem when you use a program, such
11298 as @code{cfront} or @code{f2c}, that generates C but is written in
11299 another language. In that case, make the
11300 program use @code{#line} directives in its C output; that way
11301 @value{GDBN} will know the correct language of the source code of the original
11302 program, and will display that source code, not the generated C code.
11303
11304 @menu
11305 * Filenames:: Filename extensions and languages.
11306 * Manually:: Setting the working language manually
11307 * Automatically:: Having @value{GDBN} infer the source language
11308 @end menu
11309
11310 @node Filenames
11311 @subsection List of Filename Extensions and Languages
11312
11313 If a source file name ends in one of the following extensions, then
11314 @value{GDBN} infers that its language is the one indicated.
11315
11316 @table @file
11317 @item .ada
11318 @itemx .ads
11319 @itemx .adb
11320 @itemx .a
11321 Ada source file.
11322
11323 @item .c
11324 C source file
11325
11326 @item .C
11327 @itemx .cc
11328 @itemx .cp
11329 @itemx .cpp
11330 @itemx .cxx
11331 @itemx .c++
11332 C@t{++} source file
11333
11334 @item .d
11335 D source file
11336
11337 @item .m
11338 Objective-C source file
11339
11340 @item .f
11341 @itemx .F
11342 Fortran source file
11343
11344 @item .mod
11345 Modula-2 source file
11346
11347 @item .s
11348 @itemx .S
11349 Assembler source file. This actually behaves almost like C, but
11350 @value{GDBN} does not skip over function prologues when stepping.
11351 @end table
11352
11353 In addition, you may set the language associated with a filename
11354 extension. @xref{Show, , Displaying the Language}.
11355
11356 @node Manually
11357 @subsection Setting the Working Language
11358
11359 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically,
11360 expressions are interpreted the same way in your debugging session and
11361 your program.
11362
11363 @kindex set language
11364 If you wish, you may set the language manually. To do this, issue the
11365 command @samp{set language @var{lang}}, where @var{lang} is the name of
11366 a language, such as
11367 @code{c} or @code{modula-2}.
11368 For a list of the supported languages, type @samp{set language}.
11369
11370 Setting the language manually prevents @value{GDBN} from updating the working
11371 language automatically. This can lead to confusion if you try
11372 to debug a program when the working language is not the same as the
11373 source language, when an expression is acceptable to both
11374 languages---but means different things. For instance, if the current
11375 source file were written in C, and @value{GDBN} was parsing Modula-2, a
11376 command such as:
11377
11378 @smallexample
11379 print a = b + c
11380 @end smallexample
11381
11382 @noindent
11383 might not have the effect you intended. In C, this means to add
11384 @code{b} and @code{c} and place the result in @code{a}. The result
11385 printed would be the value of @code{a}. In Modula-2, this means to compare
11386 @code{a} to the result of @code{b+c}, yielding a @code{BOOLEAN} value.
11387
11388 @node Automatically
11389 @subsection Having @value{GDBN} Infer the Source Language
11390
11391 To have @value{GDBN} set the working language automatically, use
11392 @samp{set language local} or @samp{set language auto}. @value{GDBN}
11393 then infers the working language. That is, when your program stops in a
11394 frame (usually by encountering a breakpoint), @value{GDBN} sets the
11395 working language to the language recorded for the function in that
11396 frame. If the language for a frame is unknown (that is, if the function
11397 or block corresponding to the frame was defined in a source file that
11398 does not have a recognized extension), the current working language is
11399 not changed, and @value{GDBN} issues a warning.
11400
11401 This may not seem necessary for most programs, which are written
11402 entirely in one source language. However, program modules and libraries
11403 written in one source language can be used by a main program written in
11404 a different source language. Using @samp{set language auto} in this
11405 case frees you from having to set the working language manually.
11406
11407 @node Show
11408 @section Displaying the Language
11409
11410 The following commands help you find out which language is the
11411 working language, and also what language source files were written in.
11412
11413 @table @code
11414 @item show language
11415 @kindex show language
11416 Display the current working language. This is the
11417 language you can use with commands such as @code{print} to
11418 build and compute expressions that may involve variables in your program.
11419
11420 @item info frame
11421 @kindex info frame@r{, show the source language}
11422 Display the source language for this frame. This language becomes the
11423 working language if you use an identifier from this frame.
11424 @xref{Frame Info, ,Information about a Frame}, to identify the other
11425 information listed here.
11426
11427 @item info source
11428 @kindex info source@r{, show the source language}
11429 Display the source language of this source file.
11430 @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol Table}, to identify the other
11431 information listed here.
11432 @end table
11433
11434 In unusual circumstances, you may have source files with extensions
11435 not in the standard list. You can then set the extension associated
11436 with a language explicitly:
11437
11438 @table @code
11439 @item set extension-language @var{ext} @var{language}
11440 @kindex set extension-language
11441 Tell @value{GDBN} that source files with extension @var{ext} are to be
11442 assumed as written in the source language @var{language}.
11443
11444 @item info extensions
11445 @kindex info extensions
11446 List all the filename extensions and the associated languages.
11447 @end table
11448
11449 @node Checks
11450 @section Type and Range Checking
11451
11452 @quotation
11453 @emph{Warning:} In this release, the @value{GDBN} commands for type and range
11454 checking are included, but they do not yet have any effect. This
11455 section documents the intended facilities.
11456 @end quotation
11457 @c FIXME remove warning when type/range code added
11458
11459 Some languages are designed to guard you against making seemingly common
11460 errors through a series of compile- and run-time checks. These include
11461 checking the type of arguments to functions and operators, and making
11462 sure mathematical overflows are caught at run time. Checks such as
11463 these help to ensure a program's correctness once it has been compiled
11464 by eliminating type mismatches, and providing active checks for range
11465 errors when your program is running.
11466
11467 @value{GDBN} can check for conditions like the above if you wish.
11468 Although @value{GDBN} does not check the statements in your program,
11469 it can check expressions entered directly into @value{GDBN} for
11470 evaluation via the @code{print} command, for example. As with the
11471 working language, @value{GDBN} can also decide whether or not to check
11472 automatically based on your program's source language.
11473 @xref{Supported Languages, ,Supported Languages}, for the default
11474 settings of supported languages.
11475
11476 @menu
11477 * Type Checking:: An overview of type checking
11478 * Range Checking:: An overview of range checking
11479 @end menu
11480
11481 @cindex type checking
11482 @cindex checks, type
11483 @node Type Checking
11484 @subsection An Overview of Type Checking
11485
11486 Some languages, such as Modula-2, are strongly typed, meaning that the
11487 arguments to operators and functions have to be of the correct type,
11488 otherwise an error occurs. These checks prevent type mismatch
11489 errors from ever causing any run-time problems. For example,
11490
11491 @smallexample
11492 1 + 2 @result{} 3
11493 @exdent but
11494 @error{} 1 + 2.3
11495 @end smallexample
11496
11497 The second example fails because the @code{CARDINAL} 1 is not
11498 type-compatible with the @code{REAL} 2.3.
11499
11500 For the expressions you use in @value{GDBN} commands, you can tell the
11501 @value{GDBN} type checker to skip checking;
11502 to treat any mismatches as errors and abandon the expression;
11503 or to only issue warnings when type mismatches occur,
11504 but evaluate the expression anyway. When you choose the last of
11505 these, @value{GDBN} evaluates expressions like the second example above, but
11506 also issues a warning.
11507
11508 Even if you turn type checking off, there may be other reasons
11509 related to type that prevent @value{GDBN} from evaluating an expression.
11510 For instance, @value{GDBN} does not know how to add an @code{int} and
11511 a @code{struct foo}. These particular type errors have nothing to do
11512 with the language in use, and usually arise from expressions, such as
11513 the one described above, which make little sense to evaluate anyway.
11514
11515 Each language defines to what degree it is strict about type. For
11516 instance, both Modula-2 and C require the arguments to arithmetical
11517 operators to be numbers. In C, enumerated types and pointers can be
11518 represented as numbers, so that they are valid arguments to mathematical
11519 operators. @xref{Supported Languages, ,Supported Languages}, for further
11520 details on specific languages.
11521
11522 @value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling the type checker:
11523
11524 @kindex set check type
11525 @kindex show check type
11526 @table @code
11527 @item set check type auto
11528 Set type checking on or off based on the current working language.
11529 @xref{Supported Languages, ,Supported Languages}, for the default settings for
11530 each language.
11531
11532 @item set check type on
11533 @itemx set check type off
11534 Set type checking on or off, overriding the default setting for the
11535 current working language. Issue a warning if the setting does not
11536 match the language default. If any type mismatches occur in
11537 evaluating an expression while type checking is on, @value{GDBN} prints a
11538 message and aborts evaluation of the expression.
11539
11540 @item set check type warn
11541 Cause the type checker to issue warnings, but to always attempt to
11542 evaluate the expression. Evaluating the expression may still
11543 be impossible for other reasons. For example, @value{GDBN} cannot add
11544 numbers and structures.
11545
11546 @item show type
11547 Show the current setting of the type checker, and whether or not @value{GDBN}
11548 is setting it automatically.
11549 @end table
11550
11551 @cindex range checking
11552 @cindex checks, range
11553 @node Range Checking
11554 @subsection An Overview of Range Checking
11555
11556 In some languages (such as Modula-2), it is an error to exceed the
11557 bounds of a type; this is enforced with run-time checks. Such range
11558 checking is meant to ensure program correctness by making sure
11559 computations do not overflow, or indices on an array element access do
11560 not exceed the bounds of the array.
11561
11562 For expressions you use in @value{GDBN} commands, you can tell
11563 @value{GDBN} to treat range errors in one of three ways: ignore them,
11564 always treat them as errors and abandon the expression, or issue
11565 warnings but evaluate the expression anyway.
11566
11567 A range error can result from numerical overflow, from exceeding an
11568 array index bound, or when you type a constant that is not a member
11569 of any type. Some languages, however, do not treat overflows as an
11570 error. In many implementations of C, mathematical overflow causes the
11571 result to ``wrap around'' to lower values---for example, if @var{m} is
11572 the largest integer value, and @var{s} is the smallest, then
11573
11574 @smallexample
11575 @var{m} + 1 @result{} @var{s}
11576 @end smallexample
11577
11578 This, too, is specific to individual languages, and in some cases
11579 specific to individual compilers or machines. @xref{Supported Languages, ,
11580 Supported Languages}, for further details on specific languages.
11581
11582 @value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling the range checker:
11583
11584 @kindex set check range
11585 @kindex show check range
11586 @table @code
11587 @item set check range auto
11588 Set range checking on or off based on the current working language.
11589 @xref{Supported Languages, ,Supported Languages}, for the default settings for
11590 each language.
11591
11592 @item set check range on
11593 @itemx set check range off
11594 Set range checking on or off, overriding the default setting for the
11595 current working language. A warning is issued if the setting does not
11596 match the language default. If a range error occurs and range checking is on,
11597 then a message is printed and evaluation of the expression is aborted.
11598
11599 @item set check range warn
11600 Output messages when the @value{GDBN} range checker detects a range error,
11601 but attempt to evaluate the expression anyway. Evaluating the
11602 expression may still be impossible for other reasons, such as accessing
11603 memory that the process does not own (a typical example from many Unix
11604 systems).
11605
11606 @item show range
11607 Show the current setting of the range checker, and whether or not it is
11608 being set automatically by @value{GDBN}.
11609 @end table
11610
11611 @node Supported Languages
11612 @section Supported Languages
11613
11614 @value{GDBN} supports C, C@t{++}, D, Objective-C, Fortran, Java, OpenCL C, Pascal,
11615 assembly, Modula-2, and Ada.
11616 @c This is false ...
11617 Some @value{GDBN} features may be used in expressions regardless of the
11618 language you use: the @value{GDBN} @code{@@} and @code{::} operators,
11619 and the @samp{@{type@}addr} construct (@pxref{Expressions,
11620 ,Expressions}) can be used with the constructs of any supported
11621 language.
11622
11623 The following sections detail to what degree each source language is
11624 supported by @value{GDBN}. These sections are not meant to be language
11625 tutorials or references, but serve only as a reference guide to what the
11626 @value{GDBN} expression parser accepts, and what input and output
11627 formats should look like for different languages. There are many good
11628 books written on each of these languages; please look to these for a
11629 language reference or tutorial.
11630
11631 @menu
11632 * C:: C and C@t{++}
11633 * D:: D
11634 * Objective-C:: Objective-C
11635 * OpenCL C:: OpenCL C
11636 * Fortran:: Fortran
11637 * Pascal:: Pascal
11638 * Modula-2:: Modula-2
11639 * Ada:: Ada
11640 @end menu
11641
11642 @node C
11643 @subsection C and C@t{++}
11644
11645 @cindex C and C@t{++}
11646 @cindex expressions in C or C@t{++}
11647
11648 Since C and C@t{++} are so closely related, many features of @value{GDBN} apply
11649 to both languages. Whenever this is the case, we discuss those languages
11650 together.
11651
11652 @cindex C@t{++}
11653 @cindex @code{g++}, @sc{gnu} C@t{++} compiler
11654 @cindex @sc{gnu} C@t{++}
11655 The C@t{++} debugging facilities are jointly implemented by the C@t{++}
11656 compiler and @value{GDBN}. Therefore, to debug your C@t{++} code
11657 effectively, you must compile your C@t{++} programs with a supported
11658 C@t{++} compiler, such as @sc{gnu} @code{g++}, or the HP ANSI C@t{++}
11659 compiler (@code{aCC}).
11660
11661 For best results when using @sc{gnu} C@t{++}, use the DWARF 2 debugging
11662 format; if it doesn't work on your system, try the stabs+ debugging
11663 format. You can select those formats explicitly with the @code{g++}
11664 command-line options @option{-gdwarf-2} and @option{-gstabs+}.
11665 @xref{Debugging Options,,Options for Debugging Your Program or GCC,
11666 gcc.info, Using the @sc{gnu} Compiler Collection (GCC)}.
11667
11668 @menu
11669 * C Operators:: C and C@t{++} operators
11670 * C Constants:: C and C@t{++} constants
11671 * C Plus Plus Expressions:: C@t{++} expressions
11672 * C Defaults:: Default settings for C and C@t{++}
11673 * C Checks:: C and C@t{++} type and range checks
11674 * Debugging C:: @value{GDBN} and C
11675 * Debugging C Plus Plus:: @value{GDBN} features for C@t{++}
11676 * Decimal Floating Point:: Numbers in Decimal Floating Point format
11677 @end menu
11678
11679 @node C Operators
11680 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} Operators
11681
11682 @cindex C and C@t{++} operators
11683
11684 Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
11685 @code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on structures. Operators are
11686 often defined on groups of types.
11687
11688 For the purposes of C and C@t{++}, the following definitions hold:
11689
11690 @itemize @bullet
11691
11692 @item
11693 @emph{Integral types} include @code{int} with any of its storage-class
11694 specifiers; @code{char}; @code{enum}; and, for C@t{++}, @code{bool}.
11695
11696 @item
11697 @emph{Floating-point types} include @code{float}, @code{double}, and
11698 @code{long double} (if supported by the target platform).
11699
11700 @item
11701 @emph{Pointer types} include all types defined as @code{(@var{type} *)}.
11702
11703 @item
11704 @emph{Scalar types} include all of the above.
11705
11706 @end itemize
11707
11708 @noindent
11709 The following operators are supported. They are listed here
11710 in order of increasing precedence:
11711
11712 @table @code
11713 @item ,
11714 The comma or sequencing operator. Expressions in a comma-separated list
11715 are evaluated from left to right, with the result of the entire
11716 expression being the last expression evaluated.
11717
11718 @item =
11719 Assignment. The value of an assignment expression is the value
11720 assigned. Defined on scalar types.
11721
11722 @item @var{op}=
11723 Used in an expression of the form @w{@code{@var{a} @var{op}= @var{b}}},
11724 and translated to @w{@code{@var{a} = @var{a op b}}}.
11725 @w{@code{@var{op}=}} and @code{=} have the same precedence.
11726 @var{op} is any one of the operators @code{|}, @code{^}, @code{&},
11727 @code{<<}, @code{>>}, @code{+}, @code{-}, @code{*}, @code{/}, @code{%}.
11728
11729 @item ?:
11730 The ternary operator. @code{@var{a} ? @var{b} : @var{c}} can be thought
11731 of as: if @var{a} then @var{b} else @var{c}. @var{a} should be of an
11732 integral type.
11733
11734 @item ||
11735 Logical @sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
11736
11737 @item &&
11738 Logical @sc{and}. Defined on integral types.
11739
11740 @item |
11741 Bitwise @sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
11742
11743 @item ^
11744 Bitwise exclusive-@sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
11745
11746 @item &
11747 Bitwise @sc{and}. Defined on integral types.
11748
11749 @item ==@r{, }!=
11750 Equality and inequality. Defined on scalar types. The value of these
11751 expressions is 0 for false and non-zero for true.
11752
11753 @item <@r{, }>@r{, }<=@r{, }>=
11754 Less than, greater than, less than or equal, greater than or equal.
11755 Defined on scalar types. The value of these expressions is 0 for false
11756 and non-zero for true.
11757
11758 @item <<@r{, }>>
11759 left shift, and right shift. Defined on integral types.
11760
11761 @item @@
11762 The @value{GDBN} ``artificial array'' operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}).
11763
11764 @item +@r{, }-
11765 Addition and subtraction. Defined on integral types, floating-point types and
11766 pointer types.
11767
11768 @item *@r{, }/@r{, }%
11769 Multiplication, division, and modulus. Multiplication and division are
11770 defined on integral and floating-point types. Modulus is defined on
11771 integral types.
11772
11773 @item ++@r{, }--
11774 Increment and decrement. When appearing before a variable, the
11775 operation is performed before the variable is used in an expression;
11776 when appearing after it, the variable's value is used before the
11777 operation takes place.
11778
11779 @item *
11780 Pointer dereferencing. Defined on pointer types. Same precedence as
11781 @code{++}.
11782
11783 @item &
11784 Address operator. Defined on variables. Same precedence as @code{++}.
11785
11786 For debugging C@t{++}, @value{GDBN} implements a use of @samp{&} beyond what is
11787 allowed in the C@t{++} language itself: you can use @samp{&(&@var{ref})}
11788 to examine the address
11789 where a C@t{++} reference variable (declared with @samp{&@var{ref}}) is
11790 stored.
11791
11792 @item -
11793 Negative. Defined on integral and floating-point types. Same
11794 precedence as @code{++}.
11795
11796 @item !
11797 Logical negation. Defined on integral types. Same precedence as
11798 @code{++}.
11799
11800 @item ~
11801 Bitwise complement operator. Defined on integral types. Same precedence as
11802 @code{++}.
11803
11804
11805 @item .@r{, }->
11806 Structure member, and pointer-to-structure member. For convenience,
11807 @value{GDBN} regards the two as equivalent, choosing whether to dereference a
11808 pointer based on the stored type information.
11809 Defined on @code{struct} and @code{union} data.
11810
11811 @item .*@r{, }->*
11812 Dereferences of pointers to members.
11813
11814 @item []
11815 Array indexing. @code{@var{a}[@var{i}]} is defined as
11816 @code{*(@var{a}+@var{i})}. Same precedence as @code{->}.
11817
11818 @item ()
11819 Function parameter list. Same precedence as @code{->}.
11820
11821 @item ::
11822 C@t{++} scope resolution operator. Defined on @code{struct}, @code{union},
11823 and @code{class} types.
11824
11825 @item ::
11826 Doubled colons also represent the @value{GDBN} scope operator
11827 (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). Same precedence as @code{::},
11828 above.
11829 @end table
11830
11831 If an operator is redefined in the user code, @value{GDBN} usually
11832 attempts to invoke the redefined version instead of using the operator's
11833 predefined meaning.
11834
11835 @node C Constants
11836 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} Constants
11837
11838 @cindex C and C@t{++} constants
11839
11840 @value{GDBN} allows you to express the constants of C and C@t{++} in the
11841 following ways:
11842
11843 @itemize @bullet
11844 @item
11845 Integer constants are a sequence of digits. Octal constants are
11846 specified by a leading @samp{0} (i.e.@: zero), and hexadecimal constants
11847 by a leading @samp{0x} or @samp{0X}. Constants may also end with a letter
11848 @samp{l}, specifying that the constant should be treated as a
11849 @code{long} value.
11850
11851 @item
11852 Floating point constants are a sequence of digits, followed by a decimal
11853 point, followed by a sequence of digits, and optionally followed by an
11854 exponent. An exponent is of the form:
11855 @samp{@w{e@r{[[}+@r{]|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}}}, where @var{nnn} is another
11856 sequence of digits. The @samp{+} is optional for positive exponents.
11857 A floating-point constant may also end with a letter @samp{f} or
11858 @samp{F}, specifying that the constant should be treated as being of
11859 the @code{float} (as opposed to the default @code{double}) type; or with
11860 a letter @samp{l} or @samp{L}, which specifies a @code{long double}
11861 constant.
11862
11863 @item
11864 Enumerated constants consist of enumerated identifiers, or their
11865 integral equivalents.
11866
11867 @item
11868 Character constants are a single character surrounded by single quotes
11869 (@code{'}), or a number---the ordinal value of the corresponding character
11870 (usually its @sc{ascii} value). Within quotes, the single character may
11871 be represented by a letter or by @dfn{escape sequences}, which are of
11872 the form @samp{\@var{nnn}}, where @var{nnn} is the octal representation
11873 of the character's ordinal value; or of the form @samp{\@var{x}}, where
11874 @samp{@var{x}} is a predefined special character---for example,
11875 @samp{\n} for newline.
11876
11877 @item
11878 String constants are a sequence of character constants surrounded by
11879 double quotes (@code{"}). Any valid character constant (as described
11880 above) may appear. Double quotes within the string must be preceded by
11881 a backslash, so for instance @samp{"a\"b'c"} is a string of five
11882 characters.
11883
11884 @item
11885 Pointer constants are an integral value. You can also write pointers
11886 to constants using the C operator @samp{&}.
11887
11888 @item
11889 Array constants are comma-separated lists surrounded by braces @samp{@{}
11890 and @samp{@}}; for example, @samp{@{1,2,3@}} is a three-element array of
11891 integers, @samp{@{@{1,2@}, @{3,4@}, @{5,6@}@}} is a three-by-two array,
11892 and @samp{@{&"hi", &"there", &"fred"@}} is a three-element array of pointers.
11893 @end itemize
11894
11895 @node C Plus Plus Expressions
11896 @subsubsection C@t{++} Expressions
11897
11898 @cindex expressions in C@t{++}
11899 @value{GDBN} expression handling can interpret most C@t{++} expressions.
11900
11901 @cindex debugging C@t{++} programs
11902 @cindex C@t{++} compilers
11903 @cindex debug formats and C@t{++}
11904 @cindex @value{NGCC} and C@t{++}
11905 @quotation
11906 @emph{Warning:} @value{GDBN} can only debug C@t{++} code if you use the
11907 proper compiler and the proper debug format. Currently, @value{GDBN}
11908 works best when debugging C@t{++} code that is compiled with
11909 @value{NGCC} 2.95.3 or with @value{NGCC} 3.1 or newer, using the options
11910 @option{-gdwarf-2} or @option{-gstabs+}. DWARF 2 is preferred over
11911 stabs+. Most configurations of @value{NGCC} emit either DWARF 2 or
11912 stabs+ as their default debug format, so you usually don't need to
11913 specify a debug format explicitly. Other compilers and/or debug formats
11914 are likely to work badly or not at all when using @value{GDBN} to debug
11915 C@t{++} code.
11916 @end quotation
11917
11918 @enumerate
11919
11920 @cindex member functions
11921 @item
11922 Member function calls are allowed; you can use expressions like
11923
11924 @smallexample
11925 count = aml->GetOriginal(x, y)
11926 @end smallexample
11927
11928 @vindex this@r{, inside C@t{++} member functions}
11929 @cindex namespace in C@t{++}
11930 @item
11931 While a member function is active (in the selected stack frame), your
11932 expressions have the same namespace available as the member function;
11933 that is, @value{GDBN} allows implicit references to the class instance
11934 pointer @code{this} following the same rules as C@t{++}.
11935
11936 @cindex call overloaded functions
11937 @cindex overloaded functions, calling
11938 @cindex type conversions in C@t{++}
11939 @item
11940 You can call overloaded functions; @value{GDBN} resolves the function
11941 call to the right definition, with some restrictions. @value{GDBN} does not
11942 perform overload resolution involving user-defined type conversions,
11943 calls to constructors, or instantiations of templates that do not exist
11944 in the program. It also cannot handle ellipsis argument lists or
11945 default arguments.
11946
11947 It does perform integral conversions and promotions, floating-point
11948 promotions, arithmetic conversions, pointer conversions, conversions of
11949 class objects to base classes, and standard conversions such as those of
11950 functions or arrays to pointers; it requires an exact match on the
11951 number of function arguments.
11952
11953 Overload resolution is always performed, unless you have specified
11954 @code{set overload-resolution off}. @xref{Debugging C Plus Plus,
11955 ,@value{GDBN} Features for C@t{++}}.
11956
11957 You must specify @code{set overload-resolution off} in order to use an
11958 explicit function signature to call an overloaded function, as in
11959 @smallexample
11960 p 'foo(char,int)'('x', 13)
11961 @end smallexample
11962
11963 The @value{GDBN} command-completion facility can simplify this;
11964 see @ref{Completion, ,Command Completion}.
11965
11966 @cindex reference declarations
11967 @item
11968 @value{GDBN} understands variables declared as C@t{++} references; you can use
11969 them in expressions just as you do in C@t{++} source---they are automatically
11970 dereferenced.
11971
11972 In the parameter list shown when @value{GDBN} displays a frame, the values of
11973 reference variables are not displayed (unlike other variables); this
11974 avoids clutter, since references are often used for large structures.
11975 The @emph{address} of a reference variable is always shown, unless
11976 you have specified @samp{set print address off}.
11977
11978 @item
11979 @value{GDBN} supports the C@t{++} name resolution operator @code{::}---your
11980 expressions can use it just as expressions in your program do. Since
11981 one scope may be defined in another, you can use @code{::} repeatedly if
11982 necessary, for example in an expression like
11983 @samp{@var{scope1}::@var{scope2}::@var{name}}. @value{GDBN} also allows
11984 resolving name scope by reference to source files, in both C and C@t{++}
11985 debugging (@pxref{Variables, ,Program Variables}).
11986 @end enumerate
11987
11988 In addition, when used with HP's C@t{++} compiler, @value{GDBN} supports
11989 calling virtual functions correctly, printing out virtual bases of
11990 objects, calling functions in a base subobject, casting objects, and
11991 invoking user-defined operators.
11992
11993 @node C Defaults
11994 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} Defaults
11995
11996 @cindex C and C@t{++} defaults
11997
11998 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set type and range checking automatically, they
11999 both default to @code{off} whenever the working language changes to
12000 C or C@t{++}. This happens regardless of whether you or @value{GDBN}
12001 selects the working language.
12002
12003 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically, it
12004 recognizes source files whose names end with @file{.c}, @file{.C}, or
12005 @file{.cc}, etc, and when @value{GDBN} enters code compiled from one of
12006 these files, it sets the working language to C or C@t{++}.
12007 @xref{Automatically, ,Having @value{GDBN} Infer the Source Language},
12008 for further details.
12009
12010 @c Type checking is (a) primarily motivated by Modula-2, and (b)
12011 @c unimplemented. If (b) changes, it might make sense to let this node
12012 @c appear even if Mod-2 does not, but meanwhile ignore it. roland 16jul93.
12013
12014 @node C Checks
12015 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} Type and Range Checks
12016
12017 @cindex C and C@t{++} checks
12018
12019 By default, when @value{GDBN} parses C or C@t{++} expressions, type checking
12020 is not used. However, if you turn type checking on, @value{GDBN}
12021 considers two variables type equivalent if:
12022
12023 @itemize @bullet
12024 @item
12025 The two variables are structured and have the same structure, union, or
12026 enumerated tag.
12027
12028 @item
12029 The two variables have the same type name, or types that have been
12030 declared equivalent through @code{typedef}.
12031
12032 @ignore
12033 @c leaving this out because neither J Gilmore nor R Pesch understand it.
12034 @c FIXME--beers?
12035 @item
12036 The two @code{struct}, @code{union}, or @code{enum} variables are
12037 declared in the same declaration. (Note: this may not be true for all C
12038 compilers.)
12039 @end ignore
12040 @end itemize
12041
12042 Range checking, if turned on, is done on mathematical operations. Array
12043 indices are not checked, since they are often used to index a pointer
12044 that is not itself an array.
12045
12046 @node Debugging C
12047 @subsubsection @value{GDBN} and C
12048
12049 The @code{set print union} and @code{show print union} commands apply to
12050 the @code{union} type. When set to @samp{on}, any @code{union} that is
12051 inside a @code{struct} or @code{class} is also printed. Otherwise, it
12052 appears as @samp{@{...@}}.
12053
12054 The @code{@@} operator aids in the debugging of dynamic arrays, formed
12055 with pointers and a memory allocation function. @xref{Expressions,
12056 ,Expressions}.
12057
12058 @node Debugging C Plus Plus
12059 @subsubsection @value{GDBN} Features for C@t{++}
12060
12061 @cindex commands for C@t{++}
12062
12063 Some @value{GDBN} commands are particularly useful with C@t{++}, and some are
12064 designed specifically for use with C@t{++}. Here is a summary:
12065
12066 @table @code
12067 @cindex break in overloaded functions
12068 @item @r{breakpoint menus}
12069 When you want a breakpoint in a function whose name is overloaded,
12070 @value{GDBN} has the capability to display a menu of possible breakpoint
12071 locations to help you specify which function definition you want.
12072 @xref{Ambiguous Expressions,,Ambiguous Expressions}.
12073
12074 @cindex overloading in C@t{++}
12075 @item rbreak @var{regex}
12076 Setting breakpoints using regular expressions is helpful for setting
12077 breakpoints on overloaded functions that are not members of any special
12078 classes.
12079 @xref{Set Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}.
12080
12081 @cindex C@t{++} exception handling
12082 @item catch throw
12083 @itemx catch catch
12084 Debug C@t{++} exception handling using these commands. @xref{Set
12085 Catchpoints, , Setting Catchpoints}.
12086
12087 @cindex inheritance
12088 @item ptype @var{typename}
12089 Print inheritance relationships as well as other information for type
12090 @var{typename}.
12091 @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol Table}.
12092
12093 @cindex C@t{++} symbol display
12094 @item set print demangle
12095 @itemx show print demangle
12096 @itemx set print asm-demangle
12097 @itemx show print asm-demangle
12098 Control whether C@t{++} symbols display in their source form, both when
12099 displaying code as C@t{++} source and when displaying disassemblies.
12100 @xref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}.
12101
12102 @item set print object
12103 @itemx show print object
12104 Choose whether to print derived (actual) or declared types of objects.
12105 @xref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}.
12106
12107 @item set print vtbl
12108 @itemx show print vtbl
12109 Control the format for printing virtual function tables.
12110 @xref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}.
12111 (The @code{vtbl} commands do not work on programs compiled with the HP
12112 ANSI C@t{++} compiler (@code{aCC}).)
12113
12114 @kindex set overload-resolution
12115 @cindex overloaded functions, overload resolution
12116 @item set overload-resolution on
12117 Enable overload resolution for C@t{++} expression evaluation. The default
12118 is on. For overloaded functions, @value{GDBN} evaluates the arguments
12119 and searches for a function whose signature matches the argument types,
12120 using the standard C@t{++} conversion rules (see @ref{C Plus Plus
12121 Expressions, ,C@t{++} Expressions}, for details).
12122 If it cannot find a match, it emits a message.
12123
12124 @item set overload-resolution off
12125 Disable overload resolution for C@t{++} expression evaluation. For
12126 overloaded functions that are not class member functions, @value{GDBN}
12127 chooses the first function of the specified name that it finds in the
12128 symbol table, whether or not its arguments are of the correct type. For
12129 overloaded functions that are class member functions, @value{GDBN}
12130 searches for a function whose signature @emph{exactly} matches the
12131 argument types.
12132
12133 @kindex show overload-resolution
12134 @item show overload-resolution
12135 Show the current setting of overload resolution.
12136
12137 @item @r{Overloaded symbol names}
12138 You can specify a particular definition of an overloaded symbol, using
12139 the same notation that is used to declare such symbols in C@t{++}: type
12140 @code{@var{symbol}(@var{types})} rather than just @var{symbol}. You can
12141 also use the @value{GDBN} command-line word completion facilities to list the
12142 available choices, or to finish the type list for you.
12143 @xref{Completion,, Command Completion}, for details on how to do this.
12144 @end table
12145
12146 @node Decimal Floating Point
12147 @subsubsection Decimal Floating Point format
12148 @cindex decimal floating point format
12149
12150 @value{GDBN} can examine, set and perform computations with numbers in
12151 decimal floating point format, which in the C language correspond to the
12152 @code{_Decimal32}, @code{_Decimal64} and @code{_Decimal128} types as
12153 specified by the extension to support decimal floating-point arithmetic.
12154
12155 There are two encodings in use, depending on the architecture: BID (Binary
12156 Integer Decimal) for x86 and x86-64, and DPD (Densely Packed Decimal) for
12157 PowerPC. @value{GDBN} will use the appropriate encoding for the configured
12158 target.
12159
12160 Because of a limitation in @file{libdecnumber}, the library used by @value{GDBN}
12161 to manipulate decimal floating point numbers, it is not possible to convert
12162 (using a cast, for example) integers wider than 32-bit to decimal float.
12163
12164 In addition, in order to imitate @value{GDBN}'s behaviour with binary floating
12165 point computations, error checking in decimal float operations ignores
12166 underflow, overflow and divide by zero exceptions.
12167
12168 In the PowerPC architecture, @value{GDBN} provides a set of pseudo-registers
12169 to inspect @code{_Decimal128} values stored in floating point registers.
12170 See @ref{PowerPC,,PowerPC} for more details.
12171
12172 @node D
12173 @subsection D
12174
12175 @cindex D
12176 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in D and compiled with
12177 GDC, LDC or DMD compilers. Currently @value{GDBN} supports only one D
12178 specific feature --- dynamic arrays.
12179
12180 @node Objective-C
12181 @subsection Objective-C
12182
12183 @cindex Objective-C
12184 This section provides information about some commands and command
12185 options that are useful for debugging Objective-C code. See also
12186 @ref{Symbols, info classes}, and @ref{Symbols, info selectors}, for a
12187 few more commands specific to Objective-C support.
12188
12189 @menu
12190 * Method Names in Commands::
12191 * The Print Command with Objective-C::
12192 @end menu
12193
12194 @node Method Names in Commands
12195 @subsubsection Method Names in Commands
12196
12197 The following commands have been extended to accept Objective-C method
12198 names as line specifications:
12199
12200 @kindex clear@r{, and Objective-C}
12201 @kindex break@r{, and Objective-C}
12202 @kindex info line@r{, and Objective-C}
12203 @kindex jump@r{, and Objective-C}
12204 @kindex list@r{, and Objective-C}
12205 @itemize
12206 @item @code{clear}
12207 @item @code{break}
12208 @item @code{info line}
12209 @item @code{jump}
12210 @item @code{list}
12211 @end itemize
12212
12213 A fully qualified Objective-C method name is specified as
12214
12215 @smallexample
12216 -[@var{Class} @var{methodName}]
12217 @end smallexample
12218
12219 where the minus sign is used to indicate an instance method and a
12220 plus sign (not shown) is used to indicate a class method. The class
12221 name @var{Class} and method name @var{methodName} are enclosed in
12222 brackets, similar to the way messages are specified in Objective-C
12223 source code. For example, to set a breakpoint at the @code{create}
12224 instance method of class @code{Fruit} in the program currently being
12225 debugged, enter:
12226
12227 @smallexample
12228 break -[Fruit create]
12229 @end smallexample
12230
12231 To list ten program lines around the @code{initialize} class method,
12232 enter:
12233
12234 @smallexample
12235 list +[NSText initialize]
12236 @end smallexample
12237
12238 In the current version of @value{GDBN}, the plus or minus sign is
12239 required. In future versions of @value{GDBN}, the plus or minus
12240 sign will be optional, but you can use it to narrow the search. It
12241 is also possible to specify just a method name:
12242
12243 @smallexample
12244 break create
12245 @end smallexample
12246
12247 You must specify the complete method name, including any colons. If
12248 your program's source files contain more than one @code{create} method,
12249 you'll be presented with a numbered list of classes that implement that
12250 method. Indicate your choice by number, or type @samp{0} to exit if
12251 none apply.
12252
12253 As another example, to clear a breakpoint established at the
12254 @code{makeKeyAndOrderFront:} method of the @code{NSWindow} class, enter:
12255
12256 @smallexample
12257 clear -[NSWindow makeKeyAndOrderFront:]
12258 @end smallexample
12259
12260 @node The Print Command with Objective-C
12261 @subsubsection The Print Command With Objective-C
12262 @cindex Objective-C, print objects
12263 @kindex print-object
12264 @kindex po @r{(@code{print-object})}
12265
12266 The print command has also been extended to accept methods. For example:
12267
12268 @smallexample
12269 print -[@var{object} hash]
12270 @end smallexample
12271
12272 @cindex print an Objective-C object description
12273 @cindex @code{_NSPrintForDebugger}, and printing Objective-C objects
12274 @noindent
12275 will tell @value{GDBN} to send the @code{hash} message to @var{object}
12276 and print the result. Also, an additional command has been added,
12277 @code{print-object} or @code{po} for short, which is meant to print
12278 the description of an object. However, this command may only work
12279 with certain Objective-C libraries that have a particular hook
12280 function, @code{_NSPrintForDebugger}, defined.
12281
12282 @node OpenCL C
12283 @subsection OpenCL C
12284
12285 @cindex OpenCL C
12286 This section provides information about @value{GDBN}s OpenCL C support.
12287
12288 @menu
12289 * OpenCL C Datatypes::
12290 * OpenCL C Expressions::
12291 * OpenCL C Operators::
12292 @end menu
12293
12294 @node OpenCL C Datatypes
12295 @subsubsection OpenCL C Datatypes
12296
12297 @cindex OpenCL C Datatypes
12298 @value{GDBN} supports the builtin scalar and vector datatypes specified
12299 by OpenCL 1.1. In addition the half- and double-precision floating point
12300 data types of the @code{cl_khr_fp16} and @code{cl_khr_fp64} OpenCL
12301 extensions are also known to @value{GDBN}.
12302
12303 @node OpenCL C Expressions
12304 @subsubsection OpenCL C Expressions
12305
12306 @cindex OpenCL C Expressions
12307 @value{GDBN} supports accesses to vector components including the access as
12308 lvalue where possible. Since OpenCL C is based on C99 most C expressions
12309 supported by @value{GDBN} can be used as well.
12310
12311 @node OpenCL C Operators
12312 @subsubsection OpenCL C Operators
12313
12314 @cindex OpenCL C Operators
12315 @value{GDBN} supports the operators specified by OpenCL 1.1 for scalar and
12316 vector data types.
12317
12318 @node Fortran
12319 @subsection Fortran
12320 @cindex Fortran-specific support in @value{GDBN}
12321
12322 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Fortran, but it
12323 currently supports only the features of Fortran 77 language.
12324
12325 @cindex trailing underscore, in Fortran symbols
12326 Some Fortran compilers (@sc{gnu} Fortran 77 and Fortran 95 compilers
12327 among them) append an underscore to the names of variables and
12328 functions. When you debug programs compiled by those compilers, you
12329 will need to refer to variables and functions with a trailing
12330 underscore.
12331
12332 @menu
12333 * Fortran Operators:: Fortran operators and expressions
12334 * Fortran Defaults:: Default settings for Fortran
12335 * Special Fortran Commands:: Special @value{GDBN} commands for Fortran
12336 @end menu
12337
12338 @node Fortran Operators
12339 @subsubsection Fortran Operators and Expressions
12340
12341 @cindex Fortran operators and expressions
12342
12343 Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
12344 @code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on characters or other non-
12345 arithmetic types. Operators are often defined on groups of types.
12346
12347 @table @code
12348 @item **
12349 The exponentiation operator. It raises the first operand to the power
12350 of the second one.
12351
12352 @item :
12353 The range operator. Normally used in the form of array(low:high) to
12354 represent a section of array.
12355
12356 @item %
12357 The access component operator. Normally used to access elements in derived
12358 types. Also suitable for unions. As unions aren't part of regular Fortran,
12359 this can only happen when accessing a register that uses a gdbarch-defined
12360 union type.
12361 @end table
12362
12363 @node Fortran Defaults
12364 @subsubsection Fortran Defaults
12365
12366 @cindex Fortran Defaults
12367
12368 Fortran symbols are usually case-insensitive, so @value{GDBN} by
12369 default uses case-insensitive matches for Fortran symbols. You can
12370 change that with the @samp{set case-insensitive} command, see
12371 @ref{Symbols}, for the details.
12372
12373 @node Special Fortran Commands
12374 @subsubsection Special Fortran Commands
12375
12376 @cindex Special Fortran commands
12377
12378 @value{GDBN} has some commands to support Fortran-specific features,
12379 such as displaying common blocks.
12380
12381 @table @code
12382 @cindex @code{COMMON} blocks, Fortran
12383 @kindex info common
12384 @item info common @r{[}@var{common-name}@r{]}
12385 This command prints the values contained in the Fortran @code{COMMON}
12386 block whose name is @var{common-name}. With no argument, the names of
12387 all @code{COMMON} blocks visible at the current program location are
12388 printed.
12389 @end table
12390
12391 @node Pascal
12392 @subsection Pascal
12393
12394 @cindex Pascal support in @value{GDBN}, limitations
12395 Debugging Pascal programs which use sets, subranges, file variables, or
12396 nested functions does not currently work. @value{GDBN} does not support
12397 entering expressions, printing values, or similar features using Pascal
12398 syntax.
12399
12400 The Pascal-specific command @code{set print pascal_static-members}
12401 controls whether static members of Pascal objects are displayed.
12402 @xref{Print Settings, pascal_static-members}.
12403
12404 @node Modula-2
12405 @subsection Modula-2
12406
12407 @cindex Modula-2, @value{GDBN} support
12408
12409 The extensions made to @value{GDBN} to support Modula-2 only support
12410 output from the @sc{gnu} Modula-2 compiler (which is currently being
12411 developed). Other Modula-2 compilers are not currently supported, and
12412 attempting to debug executables produced by them is most likely
12413 to give an error as @value{GDBN} reads in the executable's symbol
12414 table.
12415
12416 @cindex expressions in Modula-2
12417 @menu
12418 * M2 Operators:: Built-in operators
12419 * Built-In Func/Proc:: Built-in functions and procedures
12420 * M2 Constants:: Modula-2 constants
12421 * M2 Types:: Modula-2 types
12422 * M2 Defaults:: Default settings for Modula-2
12423 * Deviations:: Deviations from standard Modula-2
12424 * M2 Checks:: Modula-2 type and range checks
12425 * M2 Scope:: The scope operators @code{::} and @code{.}
12426 * GDB/M2:: @value{GDBN} and Modula-2
12427 @end menu
12428
12429 @node M2 Operators
12430 @subsubsection Operators
12431 @cindex Modula-2 operators
12432
12433 Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
12434 @code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on structures. Operators are
12435 often defined on groups of types. For the purposes of Modula-2, the
12436 following definitions hold:
12437
12438 @itemize @bullet
12439
12440 @item
12441 @emph{Integral types} consist of @code{INTEGER}, @code{CARDINAL}, and
12442 their subranges.
12443
12444 @item
12445 @emph{Character types} consist of @code{CHAR} and its subranges.
12446
12447 @item
12448 @emph{Floating-point types} consist of @code{REAL}.
12449
12450 @item
12451 @emph{Pointer types} consist of anything declared as @code{POINTER TO
12452 @var{type}}.
12453
12454 @item
12455 @emph{Scalar types} consist of all of the above.
12456
12457 @item
12458 @emph{Set types} consist of @code{SET} and @code{BITSET} types.
12459
12460 @item
12461 @emph{Boolean types} consist of @code{BOOLEAN}.
12462 @end itemize
12463
12464 @noindent
12465 The following operators are supported, and appear in order of
12466 increasing precedence:
12467
12468 @table @code
12469 @item ,
12470 Function argument or array index separator.
12471
12472 @item :=
12473 Assignment. The value of @var{var} @code{:=} @var{value} is
12474 @var{value}.
12475
12476 @item <@r{, }>
12477 Less than, greater than on integral, floating-point, or enumerated
12478 types.
12479
12480 @item <=@r{, }>=
12481 Less than or equal to, greater than or equal to
12482 on integral, floating-point and enumerated types, or set inclusion on
12483 set types. Same precedence as @code{<}.
12484
12485 @item =@r{, }<>@r{, }#
12486 Equality and two ways of expressing inequality, valid on scalar types.
12487 Same precedence as @code{<}. In @value{GDBN} scripts, only @code{<>} is
12488 available for inequality, since @code{#} conflicts with the script
12489 comment character.
12490
12491 @item IN
12492 Set membership. Defined on set types and the types of their members.
12493 Same precedence as @code{<}.
12494
12495 @item OR
12496 Boolean disjunction. Defined on boolean types.
12497
12498 @item AND@r{, }&
12499 Boolean conjunction. Defined on boolean types.
12500
12501 @item @@
12502 The @value{GDBN} ``artificial array'' operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}).
12503
12504 @item +@r{, }-
12505 Addition and subtraction on integral and floating-point types, or union
12506 and difference on set types.
12507
12508 @item *
12509 Multiplication on integral and floating-point types, or set intersection
12510 on set types.
12511
12512 @item /
12513 Division on floating-point types, or symmetric set difference on set
12514 types. Same precedence as @code{*}.
12515
12516 @item DIV@r{, }MOD
12517 Integer division and remainder. Defined on integral types. Same
12518 precedence as @code{*}.
12519
12520 @item -
12521 Negative. Defined on @code{INTEGER} and @code{REAL} data.
12522
12523 @item ^
12524 Pointer dereferencing. Defined on pointer types.
12525
12526 @item NOT
12527 Boolean negation. Defined on boolean types. Same precedence as
12528 @code{^}.
12529
12530 @item .
12531 @code{RECORD} field selector. Defined on @code{RECORD} data. Same
12532 precedence as @code{^}.
12533
12534 @item []
12535 Array indexing. Defined on @code{ARRAY} data. Same precedence as @code{^}.
12536
12537 @item ()
12538 Procedure argument list. Defined on @code{PROCEDURE} objects. Same precedence
12539 as @code{^}.
12540
12541 @item ::@r{, }.
12542 @value{GDBN} and Modula-2 scope operators.
12543 @end table
12544
12545 @quotation
12546 @emph{Warning:} Set expressions and their operations are not yet supported, so @value{GDBN}
12547 treats the use of the operator @code{IN}, or the use of operators
12548 @code{+}, @code{-}, @code{*}, @code{/}, @code{=}, , @code{<>}, @code{#},
12549 @code{<=}, and @code{>=} on sets as an error.
12550 @end quotation
12551
12552
12553 @node Built-In Func/Proc
12554 @subsubsection Built-in Functions and Procedures
12555 @cindex Modula-2 built-ins
12556
12557 Modula-2 also makes available several built-in procedures and functions.
12558 In describing these, the following metavariables are used:
12559
12560 @table @var
12561
12562 @item a
12563 represents an @code{ARRAY} variable.
12564
12565 @item c
12566 represents a @code{CHAR} constant or variable.
12567
12568 @item i
12569 represents a variable or constant of integral type.
12570
12571 @item m
12572 represents an identifier that belongs to a set. Generally used in the
12573 same function with the metavariable @var{s}. The type of @var{s} should
12574 be @code{SET OF @var{mtype}} (where @var{mtype} is the type of @var{m}).
12575
12576 @item n
12577 represents a variable or constant of integral or floating-point type.
12578
12579 @item r
12580 represents a variable or constant of floating-point type.
12581
12582 @item t
12583 represents a type.
12584
12585 @item v
12586 represents a variable.
12587
12588 @item x
12589 represents a variable or constant of one of many types. See the
12590 explanation of the function for details.
12591 @end table
12592
12593 All Modula-2 built-in procedures also return a result, described below.
12594
12595 @table @code
12596 @item ABS(@var{n})
12597 Returns the absolute value of @var{n}.
12598
12599 @item CAP(@var{c})
12600 If @var{c} is a lower case letter, it returns its upper case
12601 equivalent, otherwise it returns its argument.
12602
12603 @item CHR(@var{i})
12604 Returns the character whose ordinal value is @var{i}.
12605
12606 @item DEC(@var{v})
12607 Decrements the value in the variable @var{v} by one. Returns the new value.
12608
12609 @item DEC(@var{v},@var{i})
12610 Decrements the value in the variable @var{v} by @var{i}. Returns the
12611 new value.
12612
12613 @item EXCL(@var{m},@var{s})
12614 Removes the element @var{m} from the set @var{s}. Returns the new
12615 set.
12616
12617 @item FLOAT(@var{i})
12618 Returns the floating point equivalent of the integer @var{i}.
12619
12620 @item HIGH(@var{a})
12621 Returns the index of the last member of @var{a}.
12622
12623 @item INC(@var{v})
12624 Increments the value in the variable @var{v} by one. Returns the new value.
12625
12626 @item INC(@var{v},@var{i})
12627 Increments the value in the variable @var{v} by @var{i}. Returns the
12628 new value.
12629
12630 @item INCL(@var{m},@var{s})
12631 Adds the element @var{m} to the set @var{s} if it is not already
12632 there. Returns the new set.
12633
12634 @item MAX(@var{t})
12635 Returns the maximum value of the type @var{t}.
12636
12637 @item MIN(@var{t})
12638 Returns the minimum value of the type @var{t}.
12639
12640 @item ODD(@var{i})
12641 Returns boolean TRUE if @var{i} is an odd number.
12642
12643 @item ORD(@var{x})
12644 Returns the ordinal value of its argument. For example, the ordinal
12645 value of a character is its @sc{ascii} value (on machines supporting the
12646 @sc{ascii} character set). @var{x} must be of an ordered type, which include
12647 integral, character and enumerated types.
12648
12649 @item SIZE(@var{x})
12650 Returns the size of its argument. @var{x} can be a variable or a type.
12651
12652 @item TRUNC(@var{r})
12653 Returns the integral part of @var{r}.
12654
12655 @item TSIZE(@var{x})
12656 Returns the size of its argument. @var{x} can be a variable or a type.
12657
12658 @item VAL(@var{t},@var{i})
12659 Returns the member of the type @var{t} whose ordinal value is @var{i}.
12660 @end table
12661
12662 @quotation
12663 @emph{Warning:} Sets and their operations are not yet supported, so
12664 @value{GDBN} treats the use of procedures @code{INCL} and @code{EXCL} as
12665 an error.
12666 @end quotation
12667
12668 @cindex Modula-2 constants
12669 @node M2 Constants
12670 @subsubsection Constants
12671
12672 @value{GDBN} allows you to express the constants of Modula-2 in the following
12673 ways:
12674
12675 @itemize @bullet
12676
12677 @item
12678 Integer constants are simply a sequence of digits. When used in an
12679 expression, a constant is interpreted to be type-compatible with the
12680 rest of the expression. Hexadecimal integers are specified by a
12681 trailing @samp{H}, and octal integers by a trailing @samp{B}.
12682
12683 @item
12684 Floating point constants appear as a sequence of digits, followed by a
12685 decimal point and another sequence of digits. An optional exponent can
12686 then be specified, in the form @samp{E@r{[}+@r{|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}}, where
12687 @samp{@r{[}+@r{|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}} is the desired exponent. All of the
12688 digits of the floating point constant must be valid decimal (base 10)
12689 digits.
12690
12691 @item
12692 Character constants consist of a single character enclosed by a pair of
12693 like quotes, either single (@code{'}) or double (@code{"}). They may
12694 also be expressed by their ordinal value (their @sc{ascii} value, usually)
12695 followed by a @samp{C}.
12696
12697 @item
12698 String constants consist of a sequence of characters enclosed by a
12699 pair of like quotes, either single (@code{'}) or double (@code{"}).
12700 Escape sequences in the style of C are also allowed. @xref{C
12701 Constants, ,C and C@t{++} Constants}, for a brief explanation of escape
12702 sequences.
12703
12704 @item
12705 Enumerated constants consist of an enumerated identifier.
12706
12707 @item
12708 Boolean constants consist of the identifiers @code{TRUE} and
12709 @code{FALSE}.
12710
12711 @item
12712 Pointer constants consist of integral values only.
12713
12714 @item
12715 Set constants are not yet supported.
12716 @end itemize
12717
12718 @node M2 Types
12719 @subsubsection Modula-2 Types
12720 @cindex Modula-2 types
12721
12722 Currently @value{GDBN} can print the following data types in Modula-2
12723 syntax: array types, record types, set types, pointer types, procedure
12724 types, enumerated types, subrange types and base types. You can also
12725 print the contents of variables declared using these type.
12726 This section gives a number of simple source code examples together with
12727 sample @value{GDBN} sessions.
12728
12729 The first example contains the following section of code:
12730
12731 @smallexample
12732 VAR
12733 s: SET OF CHAR ;
12734 r: [20..40] ;
12735 @end smallexample
12736
12737 @noindent
12738 and you can request @value{GDBN} to interrogate the type and value of
12739 @code{r} and @code{s}.
12740
12741 @smallexample
12742 (@value{GDBP}) print s
12743 @{'A'..'C', 'Z'@}
12744 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
12745 SET OF CHAR
12746 (@value{GDBP}) print r
12747 21
12748 (@value{GDBP}) ptype r
12749 [20..40]
12750 @end smallexample
12751
12752 @noindent
12753 Likewise if your source code declares @code{s} as:
12754
12755 @smallexample
12756 VAR
12757 s: SET ['A'..'Z'] ;
12758 @end smallexample
12759
12760 @noindent
12761 then you may query the type of @code{s} by:
12762
12763 @smallexample
12764 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
12765 type = SET ['A'..'Z']
12766 @end smallexample
12767
12768 @noindent
12769 Note that at present you cannot interactively manipulate set
12770 expressions using the debugger.
12771
12772 The following example shows how you might declare an array in Modula-2
12773 and how you can interact with @value{GDBN} to print its type and contents:
12774
12775 @smallexample
12776 VAR
12777 s: ARRAY [-10..10] OF CHAR ;
12778 @end smallexample
12779
12780 @smallexample
12781 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
12782 ARRAY [-10..10] OF CHAR
12783 @end smallexample
12784
12785 Note that the array handling is not yet complete and although the type
12786 is printed correctly, expression handling still assumes that all
12787 arrays have a lower bound of zero and not @code{-10} as in the example
12788 above.
12789
12790 Here are some more type related Modula-2 examples:
12791
12792 @smallexample
12793 TYPE
12794 colour = (blue, red, yellow, green) ;
12795 t = [blue..yellow] ;
12796 VAR
12797 s: t ;
12798 BEGIN
12799 s := blue ;
12800 @end smallexample
12801
12802 @noindent
12803 The @value{GDBN} interaction shows how you can query the data type
12804 and value of a variable.
12805
12806 @smallexample
12807 (@value{GDBP}) print s
12808 $1 = blue
12809 (@value{GDBP}) ptype t
12810 type = [blue..yellow]
12811 @end smallexample
12812
12813 @noindent
12814 In this example a Modula-2 array is declared and its contents
12815 displayed. Observe that the contents are written in the same way as
12816 their @code{C} counterparts.
12817
12818 @smallexample
12819 VAR
12820 s: ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL ;
12821 BEGIN
12822 s[1] := 1 ;
12823 @end smallexample
12824
12825 @smallexample
12826 (@value{GDBP}) print s
12827 $1 = @{1, 0, 0, 0, 0@}
12828 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
12829 type = ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL
12830 @end smallexample
12831
12832 The Modula-2 language interface to @value{GDBN} also understands
12833 pointer types as shown in this example:
12834
12835 @smallexample
12836 VAR
12837 s: POINTER TO ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL ;
12838 BEGIN
12839 NEW(s) ;
12840 s^[1] := 1 ;
12841 @end smallexample
12842
12843 @noindent
12844 and you can request that @value{GDBN} describes the type of @code{s}.
12845
12846 @smallexample
12847 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
12848 type = POINTER TO ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL
12849 @end smallexample
12850
12851 @value{GDBN} handles compound types as we can see in this example.
12852 Here we combine array types, record types, pointer types and subrange
12853 types:
12854
12855 @smallexample
12856 TYPE
12857 foo = RECORD
12858 f1: CARDINAL ;
12859 f2: CHAR ;
12860 f3: myarray ;
12861 END ;
12862
12863 myarray = ARRAY myrange OF CARDINAL ;
12864 myrange = [-2..2] ;
12865 VAR
12866 s: POINTER TO ARRAY myrange OF foo ;
12867 @end smallexample
12868
12869 @noindent
12870 and you can ask @value{GDBN} to describe the type of @code{s} as shown
12871 below.
12872
12873 @smallexample
12874 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
12875 type = POINTER TO ARRAY [-2..2] OF foo = RECORD
12876 f1 : CARDINAL;
12877 f2 : CHAR;
12878 f3 : ARRAY [-2..2] OF CARDINAL;
12879 END
12880 @end smallexample
12881
12882 @node M2 Defaults
12883 @subsubsection Modula-2 Defaults
12884 @cindex Modula-2 defaults
12885
12886 If type and range checking are set automatically by @value{GDBN}, they
12887 both default to @code{on} whenever the working language changes to
12888 Modula-2. This happens regardless of whether you or @value{GDBN}
12889 selected the working language.
12890
12891 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically, then entering
12892 code compiled from a file whose name ends with @file{.mod} sets the
12893 working language to Modula-2. @xref{Automatically, ,Having @value{GDBN}
12894 Infer the Source Language}, for further details.
12895
12896 @node Deviations
12897 @subsubsection Deviations from Standard Modula-2
12898 @cindex Modula-2, deviations from
12899
12900 A few changes have been made to make Modula-2 programs easier to debug.
12901 This is done primarily via loosening its type strictness:
12902
12903 @itemize @bullet
12904 @item
12905 Unlike in standard Modula-2, pointer constants can be formed by
12906 integers. This allows you to modify pointer variables during
12907 debugging. (In standard Modula-2, the actual address contained in a
12908 pointer variable is hidden from you; it can only be modified
12909 through direct assignment to another pointer variable or expression that
12910 returned a pointer.)
12911
12912 @item
12913 C escape sequences can be used in strings and characters to represent
12914 non-printable characters. @value{GDBN} prints out strings with these
12915 escape sequences embedded. Single non-printable characters are
12916 printed using the @samp{CHR(@var{nnn})} format.
12917
12918 @item
12919 The assignment operator (@code{:=}) returns the value of its right-hand
12920 argument.
12921
12922 @item
12923 All built-in procedures both modify @emph{and} return their argument.
12924 @end itemize
12925
12926 @node M2 Checks
12927 @subsubsection Modula-2 Type and Range Checks
12928 @cindex Modula-2 checks
12929
12930 @quotation
12931 @emph{Warning:} in this release, @value{GDBN} does not yet perform type or
12932 range checking.
12933 @end quotation
12934 @c FIXME remove warning when type/range checks added
12935
12936 @value{GDBN} considers two Modula-2 variables type equivalent if:
12937
12938 @itemize @bullet
12939 @item
12940 They are of types that have been declared equivalent via a @code{TYPE
12941 @var{t1} = @var{t2}} statement
12942
12943 @item
12944 They have been declared on the same line. (Note: This is true of the
12945 @sc{gnu} Modula-2 compiler, but it may not be true of other compilers.)
12946 @end itemize
12947
12948 As long as type checking is enabled, any attempt to combine variables
12949 whose types are not equivalent is an error.
12950
12951 Range checking is done on all mathematical operations, assignment, array
12952 index bounds, and all built-in functions and procedures.
12953
12954 @node M2 Scope
12955 @subsubsection The Scope Operators @code{::} and @code{.}
12956 @cindex scope
12957 @cindex @code{.}, Modula-2 scope operator
12958 @cindex colon, doubled as scope operator
12959 @ifinfo
12960 @vindex colon-colon@r{, in Modula-2}
12961 @c Info cannot handle :: but TeX can.
12962 @end ifinfo
12963 @ifnotinfo
12964 @vindex ::@r{, in Modula-2}
12965 @end ifnotinfo
12966
12967 There are a few subtle differences between the Modula-2 scope operator
12968 (@code{.}) and the @value{GDBN} scope operator (@code{::}). The two have
12969 similar syntax:
12970
12971 @smallexample
12972
12973 @var{module} . @var{id}
12974 @var{scope} :: @var{id}
12975 @end smallexample
12976
12977 @noindent
12978 where @var{scope} is the name of a module or a procedure,
12979 @var{module} the name of a module, and @var{id} is any declared
12980 identifier within your program, except another module.
12981
12982 Using the @code{::} operator makes @value{GDBN} search the scope
12983 specified by @var{scope} for the identifier @var{id}. If it is not
12984 found in the specified scope, then @value{GDBN} searches all scopes
12985 enclosing the one specified by @var{scope}.
12986
12987 Using the @code{.} operator makes @value{GDBN} search the current scope for
12988 the identifier specified by @var{id} that was imported from the
12989 definition module specified by @var{module}. With this operator, it is
12990 an error if the identifier @var{id} was not imported from definition
12991 module @var{module}, or if @var{id} is not an identifier in
12992 @var{module}.
12993
12994 @node GDB/M2
12995 @subsubsection @value{GDBN} and Modula-2
12996
12997 Some @value{GDBN} commands have little use when debugging Modula-2 programs.
12998 Five subcommands of @code{set print} and @code{show print} apply
12999 specifically to C and C@t{++}: @samp{vtbl}, @samp{demangle},
13000 @samp{asm-demangle}, @samp{object}, and @samp{union}. The first four
13001 apply to C@t{++}, and the last to the C @code{union} type, which has no direct
13002 analogue in Modula-2.
13003
13004 The @code{@@} operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}), while available
13005 with any language, is not useful with Modula-2. Its
13006 intent is to aid the debugging of @dfn{dynamic arrays}, which cannot be
13007 created in Modula-2 as they can in C or C@t{++}. However, because an
13008 address can be specified by an integral constant, the construct
13009 @samp{@{@var{type}@}@var{adrexp}} is still useful.
13010
13011 @cindex @code{#} in Modula-2
13012 In @value{GDBN} scripts, the Modula-2 inequality operator @code{#} is
13013 interpreted as the beginning of a comment. Use @code{<>} instead.
13014
13015 @node Ada
13016 @subsection Ada
13017 @cindex Ada
13018
13019 The extensions made to @value{GDBN} for Ada only support
13020 output from the @sc{gnu} Ada (GNAT) compiler.
13021 Other Ada compilers are not currently supported, and
13022 attempting to debug executables produced by them is most likely
13023 to be difficult.
13024
13025
13026 @cindex expressions in Ada
13027 @menu
13028 * Ada Mode Intro:: General remarks on the Ada syntax
13029 and semantics supported by Ada mode
13030 in @value{GDBN}.
13031 * Omissions from Ada:: Restrictions on the Ada expression syntax.
13032 * Additions to Ada:: Extensions of the Ada expression syntax.
13033 * Stopping Before Main Program:: Debugging the program during elaboration.
13034 * Ada Tasks:: Listing and setting breakpoints in tasks.
13035 * Ada Tasks and Core Files:: Tasking Support when Debugging Core Files
13036 * Ravenscar Profile:: Tasking Support when using the Ravenscar
13037 Profile
13038 * Ada Glitches:: Known peculiarities of Ada mode.
13039 @end menu
13040
13041 @node Ada Mode Intro
13042 @subsubsection Introduction
13043 @cindex Ada mode, general
13044
13045 The Ada mode of @value{GDBN} supports a fairly large subset of Ada expression
13046 syntax, with some extensions.
13047 The philosophy behind the design of this subset is
13048
13049 @itemize @bullet
13050 @item
13051 That @value{GDBN} should provide basic literals and access to operations for
13052 arithmetic, dereferencing, field selection, indexing, and subprogram calls,
13053 leaving more sophisticated computations to subprograms written into the
13054 program (which therefore may be called from @value{GDBN}).
13055
13056 @item
13057 That type safety and strict adherence to Ada language restrictions
13058 are not particularly important to the @value{GDBN} user.
13059
13060 @item
13061 That brevity is important to the @value{GDBN} user.
13062 @end itemize
13063
13064 Thus, for brevity, the debugger acts as if all names declared in
13065 user-written packages are directly visible, even if they are not visible
13066 according to Ada rules, thus making it unnecessary to fully qualify most
13067 names with their packages, regardless of context. Where this causes
13068 ambiguity, @value{GDBN} asks the user's intent.
13069
13070 The debugger will start in Ada mode if it detects an Ada main program.
13071 As for other languages, it will enter Ada mode when stopped in a program that
13072 was translated from an Ada source file.
13073
13074 While in Ada mode, you may use `@t{--}' for comments. This is useful
13075 mostly for documenting command files. The standard @value{GDBN} comment
13076 (@samp{#}) still works at the beginning of a line in Ada mode, but not in the
13077 middle (to allow based literals).
13078
13079 The debugger supports limited overloading. Given a subprogram call in which
13080 the function symbol has multiple definitions, it will use the number of
13081 actual parameters and some information about their types to attempt to narrow
13082 the set of definitions. It also makes very limited use of context, preferring
13083 procedures to functions in the context of the @code{call} command, and
13084 functions to procedures elsewhere.
13085
13086 @node Omissions from Ada
13087 @subsubsection Omissions from Ada
13088 @cindex Ada, omissions from
13089
13090 Here are the notable omissions from the subset:
13091
13092 @itemize @bullet
13093 @item
13094 Only a subset of the attributes are supported:
13095
13096 @itemize @minus
13097 @item
13098 @t{'First}, @t{'Last}, and @t{'Length}
13099 on array objects (not on types and subtypes).
13100
13101 @item
13102 @t{'Min} and @t{'Max}.
13103
13104 @item
13105 @t{'Pos} and @t{'Val}.
13106
13107 @item
13108 @t{'Tag}.
13109
13110 @item
13111 @t{'Range} on array objects (not subtypes), but only as the right
13112 operand of the membership (@code{in}) operator.
13113
13114 @item
13115 @t{'Access}, @t{'Unchecked_Access}, and
13116 @t{'Unrestricted_Access} (a GNAT extension).
13117
13118 @item
13119 @t{'Address}.
13120 @end itemize
13121
13122 @item
13123 The names in
13124 @code{Characters.Latin_1} are not available and
13125 concatenation is not implemented. Thus, escape characters in strings are
13126 not currently available.
13127
13128 @item
13129 Equality tests (@samp{=} and @samp{/=}) on arrays test for bitwise
13130 equality of representations. They will generally work correctly
13131 for strings and arrays whose elements have integer or enumeration types.
13132 They may not work correctly for arrays whose element
13133 types have user-defined equality, for arrays of real values
13134 (in particular, IEEE-conformant floating point, because of negative
13135 zeroes and NaNs), and for arrays whose elements contain unused bits with
13136 indeterminate values.
13137
13138 @item
13139 The other component-by-component array operations (@code{and}, @code{or},
13140 @code{xor}, @code{not}, and relational tests other than equality)
13141 are not implemented.
13142
13143 @item
13144 @cindex array aggregates (Ada)
13145 @cindex record aggregates (Ada)
13146 @cindex aggregates (Ada)
13147 There is limited support for array and record aggregates. They are
13148 permitted only on the right sides of assignments, as in these examples:
13149
13150 @smallexample
13151 (@value{GDBP}) set An_Array := (1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6)
13152 (@value{GDBP}) set An_Array := (1, others => 0)
13153 (@value{GDBP}) set An_Array := (0|4 => 1, 1..3 => 2, 5 => 6)
13154 (@value{GDBP}) set A_2D_Array := ((1, 2, 3), (4, 5, 6), (7, 8, 9))
13155 (@value{GDBP}) set A_Record := (1, "Peter", True);
13156 (@value{GDBP}) set A_Record := (Name => "Peter", Id => 1, Alive => True)
13157 @end smallexample
13158
13159 Changing a
13160 discriminant's value by assigning an aggregate has an
13161 undefined effect if that discriminant is used within the record.
13162 However, you can first modify discriminants by directly assigning to
13163 them (which normally would not be allowed in Ada), and then performing an
13164 aggregate assignment. For example, given a variable @code{A_Rec}
13165 declared to have a type such as:
13166
13167 @smallexample
13168 type Rec (Len : Small_Integer := 0) is record
13169 Id : Integer;
13170 Vals : IntArray (1 .. Len);
13171 end record;
13172 @end smallexample
13173
13174 you can assign a value with a different size of @code{Vals} with two
13175 assignments:
13176
13177 @smallexample
13178 (@value{GDBP}) set A_Rec.Len := 4
13179 (@value{GDBP}) set A_Rec := (Id => 42, Vals => (1, 2, 3, 4))
13180 @end smallexample
13181
13182 As this example also illustrates, @value{GDBN} is very loose about the usual
13183 rules concerning aggregates. You may leave out some of the
13184 components of an array or record aggregate (such as the @code{Len}
13185 component in the assignment to @code{A_Rec} above); they will retain their
13186 original values upon assignment. You may freely use dynamic values as
13187 indices in component associations. You may even use overlapping or
13188 redundant component associations, although which component values are
13189 assigned in such cases is not defined.
13190
13191 @item
13192 Calls to dispatching subprograms are not implemented.
13193
13194 @item
13195 The overloading algorithm is much more limited (i.e., less selective)
13196 than that of real Ada. It makes only limited use of the context in
13197 which a subexpression appears to resolve its meaning, and it is much
13198 looser in its rules for allowing type matches. As a result, some
13199 function calls will be ambiguous, and the user will be asked to choose
13200 the proper resolution.
13201
13202 @item
13203 The @code{new} operator is not implemented.
13204
13205 @item
13206 Entry calls are not implemented.
13207
13208 @item
13209 Aside from printing, arithmetic operations on the native VAX floating-point
13210 formats are not supported.
13211
13212 @item
13213 It is not possible to slice a packed array.
13214
13215 @item
13216 The names @code{True} and @code{False}, when not part of a qualified name,
13217 are interpreted as if implicitly prefixed by @code{Standard}, regardless of
13218 context.
13219 Should your program
13220 redefine these names in a package or procedure (at best a dubious practice),
13221 you will have to use fully qualified names to access their new definitions.
13222 @end itemize
13223
13224 @node Additions to Ada
13225 @subsubsection Additions to Ada
13226 @cindex Ada, deviations from
13227
13228 As it does for other languages, @value{GDBN} makes certain generic
13229 extensions to Ada (@pxref{Expressions}):
13230
13231 @itemize @bullet
13232 @item
13233 If the expression @var{E} is a variable residing in memory (typically
13234 a local variable or array element) and @var{N} is a positive integer,
13235 then @code{@var{E}@@@var{N}} displays the values of @var{E} and the
13236 @var{N}-1 adjacent variables following it in memory as an array. In
13237 Ada, this operator is generally not necessary, since its prime use is
13238 in displaying parts of an array, and slicing will usually do this in
13239 Ada. However, there are occasional uses when debugging programs in
13240 which certain debugging information has been optimized away.
13241
13242 @item
13243 @code{@var{B}::@var{var}} means ``the variable named @var{var} that
13244 appears in function or file @var{B}.'' When @var{B} is a file name,
13245 you must typically surround it in single quotes.
13246
13247 @item
13248 The expression @code{@{@var{type}@} @var{addr}} means ``the variable of type
13249 @var{type} that appears at address @var{addr}.''
13250
13251 @item
13252 A name starting with @samp{$} is a convenience variable
13253 (@pxref{Convenience Vars}) or a machine register (@pxref{Registers}).
13254 @end itemize
13255
13256 In addition, @value{GDBN} provides a few other shortcuts and outright
13257 additions specific to Ada:
13258
13259 @itemize @bullet
13260 @item
13261 The assignment statement is allowed as an expression, returning
13262 its right-hand operand as its value. Thus, you may enter
13263
13264 @smallexample
13265 (@value{GDBP}) set x := y + 3
13266 (@value{GDBP}) print A(tmp := y + 1)
13267 @end smallexample
13268
13269 @item
13270 The semicolon is allowed as an ``operator,'' returning as its value
13271 the value of its right-hand operand.
13272 This allows, for example,
13273 complex conditional breaks:
13274
13275 @smallexample
13276 (@value{GDBP}) break f
13277 (@value{GDBP}) condition 1 (report(i); k += 1; A(k) > 100)
13278 @end smallexample
13279
13280 @item
13281 Rather than use catenation and symbolic character names to introduce special
13282 characters into strings, one may instead use a special bracket notation,
13283 which is also used to print strings. A sequence of characters of the form
13284 @samp{["@var{XX}"]} within a string or character literal denotes the
13285 (single) character whose numeric encoding is @var{XX} in hexadecimal. The
13286 sequence of characters @samp{["""]} also denotes a single quotation mark
13287 in strings. For example,
13288 @smallexample
13289 "One line.["0a"]Next line.["0a"]"
13290 @end smallexample
13291 @noindent
13292 contains an ASCII newline character (@code{Ada.Characters.Latin_1.LF})
13293 after each period.
13294
13295 @item
13296 The subtype used as a prefix for the attributes @t{'Pos}, @t{'Min}, and
13297 @t{'Max} is optional (and is ignored in any case). For example, it is valid
13298 to write
13299
13300 @smallexample
13301 (@value{GDBP}) print 'max(x, y)
13302 @end smallexample
13303
13304 @item
13305 When printing arrays, @value{GDBN} uses positional notation when the
13306 array has a lower bound of 1, and uses a modified named notation otherwise.
13307 For example, a one-dimensional array of three integers with a lower bound
13308 of 3 might print as
13309
13310 @smallexample
13311 (3 => 10, 17, 1)
13312 @end smallexample
13313
13314 @noindent
13315 That is, in contrast to valid Ada, only the first component has a @code{=>}
13316 clause.
13317
13318 @item
13319 You may abbreviate attributes in expressions with any unique,
13320 multi-character subsequence of
13321 their names (an exact match gets preference).
13322 For example, you may use @t{a'len}, @t{a'gth}, or @t{a'lh}
13323 in place of @t{a'length}.
13324
13325 @item
13326 @cindex quoting Ada internal identifiers
13327 Since Ada is case-insensitive, the debugger normally maps identifiers you type
13328 to lower case. The GNAT compiler uses upper-case characters for
13329 some of its internal identifiers, which are normally of no interest to users.
13330 For the rare occasions when you actually have to look at them,
13331 enclose them in angle brackets to avoid the lower-case mapping.
13332 For example,
13333 @smallexample
13334 (@value{GDBP}) print <JMPBUF_SAVE>[0]
13335 @end smallexample
13336
13337 @item
13338 Printing an object of class-wide type or dereferencing an
13339 access-to-class-wide value will display all the components of the object's
13340 specific type (as indicated by its run-time tag). Likewise, component
13341 selection on such a value will operate on the specific type of the
13342 object.
13343
13344 @end itemize
13345
13346 @node Stopping Before Main Program
13347 @subsubsection Stopping at the Very Beginning
13348
13349 @cindex breakpointing Ada elaboration code
13350 It is sometimes necessary to debug the program during elaboration, and
13351 before reaching the main procedure.
13352 As defined in the Ada Reference
13353 Manual, the elaboration code is invoked from a procedure called
13354 @code{adainit}. To run your program up to the beginning of
13355 elaboration, simply use the following two commands:
13356 @code{tbreak adainit} and @code{run}.
13357
13358 @node Ada Tasks
13359 @subsubsection Extensions for Ada Tasks
13360 @cindex Ada, tasking
13361
13362 Support for Ada tasks is analogous to that for threads (@pxref{Threads}).
13363 @value{GDBN} provides the following task-related commands:
13364
13365 @table @code
13366 @kindex info tasks
13367 @item info tasks
13368 This command shows a list of current Ada tasks, as in the following example:
13369
13370
13371 @smallexample
13372 @iftex
13373 @leftskip=0.5cm
13374 @end iftex
13375 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
13376 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
13377 1 8088000 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
13378 2 80a4000 1 15 Accept Statement b
13379 3 809a800 1 15 Child Activation Wait a
13380 * 4 80ae800 3 15 Runnable c
13381
13382 @end smallexample
13383
13384 @noindent
13385 In this listing, the asterisk before the last task indicates it to be the
13386 task currently being inspected.
13387
13388 @table @asis
13389 @item ID
13390 Represents @value{GDBN}'s internal task number.
13391
13392 @item TID
13393 The Ada task ID.
13394
13395 @item P-ID
13396 The parent's task ID (@value{GDBN}'s internal task number).
13397
13398 @item Pri
13399 The base priority of the task.
13400
13401 @item State
13402 Current state of the task.
13403
13404 @table @code
13405 @item Unactivated
13406 The task has been created but has not been activated. It cannot be
13407 executing.
13408
13409 @item Runnable
13410 The task is not blocked for any reason known to Ada. (It may be waiting
13411 for a mutex, though.) It is conceptually "executing" in normal mode.
13412
13413 @item Terminated
13414 The task is terminated, in the sense of ARM 9.3 (5). Any dependents
13415 that were waiting on terminate alternatives have been awakened and have
13416 terminated themselves.
13417
13418 @item Child Activation Wait
13419 The task is waiting for created tasks to complete activation.
13420
13421 @item Accept Statement
13422 The task is waiting on an accept or selective wait statement.
13423
13424 @item Waiting on entry call
13425 The task is waiting on an entry call.
13426
13427 @item Async Select Wait
13428 The task is waiting to start the abortable part of an asynchronous
13429 select statement.
13430
13431 @item Delay Sleep
13432 The task is waiting on a select statement with only a delay
13433 alternative open.
13434
13435 @item Child Termination Wait
13436 The task is sleeping having completed a master within itself, and is
13437 waiting for the tasks dependent on that master to become terminated or
13438 waiting on a terminate Phase.
13439
13440 @item Wait Child in Term Alt
13441 The task is sleeping waiting for tasks on terminate alternatives to
13442 finish terminating.
13443
13444 @item Accepting RV with @var{taskno}
13445 The task is accepting a rendez-vous with the task @var{taskno}.
13446 @end table
13447
13448 @item Name
13449 Name of the task in the program.
13450
13451 @end table
13452
13453 @kindex info task @var{taskno}
13454 @item info task @var{taskno}
13455 This command shows detailled informations on the specified task, as in
13456 the following example:
13457 @smallexample
13458 @iftex
13459 @leftskip=0.5cm
13460 @end iftex
13461 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
13462 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
13463 1 8077880 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
13464 * 2 807c468 1 15 Runnable task_1
13465 (@value{GDBP}) info task 2
13466 Ada Task: 0x807c468
13467 Name: task_1
13468 Thread: 0x807f378
13469 Parent: 1 (main_task)
13470 Base Priority: 15
13471 State: Runnable
13472 @end smallexample
13473
13474 @item task
13475 @kindex task@r{ (Ada)}
13476 @cindex current Ada task ID
13477 This command prints the ID of the current task.
13478
13479 @smallexample
13480 @iftex
13481 @leftskip=0.5cm
13482 @end iftex
13483 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
13484 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
13485 1 8077870 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
13486 * 2 807c458 1 15 Runnable t
13487 (@value{GDBP}) task
13488 [Current task is 2]
13489 @end smallexample
13490
13491 @item task @var{taskno}
13492 @cindex Ada task switching
13493 This command is like the @code{thread @var{threadno}}
13494 command (@pxref{Threads}). It switches the context of debugging
13495 from the current task to the given task.
13496
13497 @smallexample
13498 @iftex
13499 @leftskip=0.5cm
13500 @end iftex
13501 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
13502 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
13503 1 8077870 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
13504 * 2 807c458 1 15 Runnable t
13505 (@value{GDBP}) task 1
13506 [Switching to task 1]
13507 #0 0x8067726 in pthread_cond_wait ()
13508 (@value{GDBP}) bt
13509 #0 0x8067726 in pthread_cond_wait ()
13510 #1 0x8056714 in system.os_interface.pthread_cond_wait ()
13511 #2 0x805cb63 in system.task_primitives.operations.sleep ()
13512 #3 0x806153e in system.tasking.stages.activate_tasks ()
13513 #4 0x804aacc in un () at un.adb:5
13514 @end smallexample
13515
13516 @item break @var{linespec} task @var{taskno}
13517 @itemx break @var{linespec} task @var{taskno} if @dots{}
13518 @cindex breakpoints and tasks, in Ada
13519 @cindex task breakpoints, in Ada
13520 @kindex break @dots{} task @var{taskno}@r{ (Ada)}
13521 These commands are like the @code{break @dots{} thread @dots{}}
13522 command (@pxref{Thread Stops}).
13523 @var{linespec} specifies source lines, as described
13524 in @ref{Specify Location}.
13525
13526 Use the qualifier @samp{task @var{taskno}} with a breakpoint command
13527 to specify that you only want @value{GDBN} to stop the program when a
13528 particular Ada task reaches this breakpoint. @var{taskno} is one of the
13529 numeric task identifiers assigned by @value{GDBN}, shown in the first
13530 column of the @samp{info tasks} display.
13531
13532 If you do not specify @samp{task @var{taskno}} when you set a
13533 breakpoint, the breakpoint applies to @emph{all} tasks of your
13534 program.
13535
13536 You can use the @code{task} qualifier on conditional breakpoints as
13537 well; in this case, place @samp{task @var{taskno}} before the
13538 breakpoint condition (before the @code{if}).
13539
13540 For example,
13541
13542 @smallexample
13543 @iftex
13544 @leftskip=0.5cm
13545 @end iftex
13546 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
13547 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
13548 1 140022020 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
13549 2 140045060 1 15 Accept/Select Wait t2
13550 3 140044840 1 15 Runnable t1
13551 * 4 140056040 1 15 Runnable t3
13552 (@value{GDBP}) b 15 task 2
13553 Breakpoint 5 at 0x120044cb0: file test_task_debug.adb, line 15.
13554 (@value{GDBP}) cont
13555 Continuing.
13556 task # 1 running
13557 task # 2 running
13558
13559 Breakpoint 5, test_task_debug () at test_task_debug.adb:15
13560 15 flush;
13561 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
13562 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
13563 1 140022020 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
13564 * 2 140045060 1 15 Runnable t2
13565 3 140044840 1 15 Runnable t1
13566 4 140056040 1 15 Delay Sleep t3
13567 @end smallexample
13568 @end table
13569
13570 @node Ada Tasks and Core Files
13571 @subsubsection Tasking Support when Debugging Core Files
13572 @cindex Ada tasking and core file debugging
13573
13574 When inspecting a core file, as opposed to debugging a live program,
13575 tasking support may be limited or even unavailable, depending on
13576 the platform being used.
13577 For instance, on x86-linux, the list of tasks is available, but task
13578 switching is not supported. On Tru64, however, task switching will work
13579 as usual.
13580
13581 On certain platforms, including Tru64, the debugger needs to perform some
13582 memory writes in order to provide Ada tasking support. When inspecting
13583 a core file, this means that the core file must be opened with read-write
13584 privileges, using the command @samp{"set write on"} (@pxref{Patching}).
13585 Under these circumstances, you should make a backup copy of the core
13586 file before inspecting it with @value{GDBN}.
13587
13588 @node Ravenscar Profile
13589 @subsubsection Tasking Support when using the Ravenscar Profile
13590 @cindex Ravenscar Profile
13591
13592 The @dfn{Ravenscar Profile} is a subset of the Ada tasking features,
13593 specifically designed for systems with safety-critical real-time
13594 requirements.
13595
13596 @table @code
13597 @kindex set ravenscar task-switching on
13598 @cindex task switching with program using Ravenscar Profile
13599 @item set ravenscar task-switching on
13600 Allows task switching when debugging a program that uses the Ravenscar
13601 Profile. This is the default.
13602
13603 @kindex set ravenscar task-switching off
13604 @item set ravenscar task-switching off
13605 Turn off task switching when debugging a program that uses the Ravenscar
13606 Profile. This is mostly intended to disable the code that adds support
13607 for the Ravenscar Profile, in case a bug in either @value{GDBN} or in
13608 the Ravenscar runtime is preventing @value{GDBN} from working properly.
13609 To be effective, this command should be run before the program is started.
13610
13611 @kindex show ravenscar task-switching
13612 @item show ravenscar task-switching
13613 Show whether it is possible to switch from task to task in a program
13614 using the Ravenscar Profile.
13615
13616 @end table
13617
13618 @node Ada Glitches
13619 @subsubsection Known Peculiarities of Ada Mode
13620 @cindex Ada, problems
13621
13622 Besides the omissions listed previously (@pxref{Omissions from Ada}),
13623 we know of several problems with and limitations of Ada mode in
13624 @value{GDBN},
13625 some of which will be fixed with planned future releases of the debugger
13626 and the GNU Ada compiler.
13627
13628 @itemize @bullet
13629 @item
13630 Static constants that the compiler chooses not to materialize as objects in
13631 storage are invisible to the debugger.
13632
13633 @item
13634 Named parameter associations in function argument lists are ignored (the
13635 argument lists are treated as positional).
13636
13637 @item
13638 Many useful library packages are currently invisible to the debugger.
13639
13640 @item
13641 Fixed-point arithmetic, conversions, input, and output is carried out using
13642 floating-point arithmetic, and may give results that only approximate those on
13643 the host machine.
13644
13645 @item
13646 The GNAT compiler never generates the prefix @code{Standard} for any of
13647 the standard symbols defined by the Ada language. @value{GDBN} knows about
13648 this: it will strip the prefix from names when you use it, and will never
13649 look for a name you have so qualified among local symbols, nor match against
13650 symbols in other packages or subprograms. If you have
13651 defined entities anywhere in your program other than parameters and
13652 local variables whose simple names match names in @code{Standard},
13653 GNAT's lack of qualification here can cause confusion. When this happens,
13654 you can usually resolve the confusion
13655 by qualifying the problematic names with package
13656 @code{Standard} explicitly.
13657 @end itemize
13658
13659 Older versions of the compiler sometimes generate erroneous debugging
13660 information, resulting in the debugger incorrectly printing the value
13661 of affected entities. In some cases, the debugger is able to work
13662 around an issue automatically. In other cases, the debugger is able
13663 to work around the issue, but the work-around has to be specifically
13664 enabled.
13665
13666 @kindex set ada trust-PAD-over-XVS
13667 @kindex show ada trust-PAD-over-XVS
13668 @table @code
13669
13670 @item set ada trust-PAD-over-XVS on
13671 Configure GDB to strictly follow the GNAT encoding when computing the
13672 value of Ada entities, particularly when @code{PAD} and @code{PAD___XVS}
13673 types are involved (see @code{ada/exp_dbug.ads} in the GCC sources for
13674 a complete description of the encoding used by the GNAT compiler).
13675 This is the default.
13676
13677 @item set ada trust-PAD-over-XVS off
13678 This is related to the encoding using by the GNAT compiler. If @value{GDBN}
13679 sometimes prints the wrong value for certain entities, changing @code{ada
13680 trust-PAD-over-XVS} to @code{off} activates a work-around which may fix
13681 the issue. It is always safe to set @code{ada trust-PAD-over-XVS} to
13682 @code{off}, but this incurs a slight performance penalty, so it is
13683 recommended to leave this setting to @code{on} unless necessary.
13684
13685 @end table
13686
13687 @node Unsupported Languages
13688 @section Unsupported Languages
13689
13690 @cindex unsupported languages
13691 @cindex minimal language
13692 In addition to the other fully-supported programming languages,
13693 @value{GDBN} also provides a pseudo-language, called @code{minimal}.
13694 It does not represent a real programming language, but provides a set
13695 of capabilities close to what the C or assembly languages provide.
13696 This should allow most simple operations to be performed while debugging
13697 an application that uses a language currently not supported by @value{GDBN}.
13698
13699 If the language is set to @code{auto}, @value{GDBN} will automatically
13700 select this language if the current frame corresponds to an unsupported
13701 language.
13702
13703 @node Symbols
13704 @chapter Examining the Symbol Table
13705
13706 The commands described in this chapter allow you to inquire about the
13707 symbols (names of variables, functions and types) defined in your
13708 program. This information is inherent in the text of your program and
13709 does not change as your program executes. @value{GDBN} finds it in your
13710 program's symbol table, in the file indicated when you started @value{GDBN}
13711 (@pxref{File Options, ,Choosing Files}), or by one of the
13712 file-management commands (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}).
13713
13714 @cindex symbol names
13715 @cindex names of symbols
13716 @cindex quoting names
13717 Occasionally, you may need to refer to symbols that contain unusual
13718 characters, which @value{GDBN} ordinarily treats as word delimiters. The
13719 most frequent case is in referring to static variables in other
13720 source files (@pxref{Variables,,Program Variables}). File names
13721 are recorded in object files as debugging symbols, but @value{GDBN} would
13722 ordinarily parse a typical file name, like @file{foo.c}, as the three words
13723 @samp{foo} @samp{.} @samp{c}. To allow @value{GDBN} to recognize
13724 @samp{foo.c} as a single symbol, enclose it in single quotes; for example,
13725
13726 @smallexample
13727 p 'foo.c'::x
13728 @end smallexample
13729
13730 @noindent
13731 looks up the value of @code{x} in the scope of the file @file{foo.c}.
13732
13733 @table @code
13734 @cindex case-insensitive symbol names
13735 @cindex case sensitivity in symbol names
13736 @kindex set case-sensitive
13737 @item set case-sensitive on
13738 @itemx set case-sensitive off
13739 @itemx set case-sensitive auto
13740 Normally, when @value{GDBN} looks up symbols, it matches their names
13741 with case sensitivity determined by the current source language.
13742 Occasionally, you may wish to control that. The command @code{set
13743 case-sensitive} lets you do that by specifying @code{on} for
13744 case-sensitive matches or @code{off} for case-insensitive ones. If
13745 you specify @code{auto}, case sensitivity is reset to the default
13746 suitable for the source language. The default is case-sensitive
13747 matches for all languages except for Fortran, for which the default is
13748 case-insensitive matches.
13749
13750 @kindex show case-sensitive
13751 @item show case-sensitive
13752 This command shows the current setting of case sensitivity for symbols
13753 lookups.
13754
13755 @kindex info address
13756 @cindex address of a symbol
13757 @item info address @var{symbol}
13758 Describe where the data for @var{symbol} is stored. For a register
13759 variable, this says which register it is kept in. For a non-register
13760 local variable, this prints the stack-frame offset at which the variable
13761 is always stored.
13762
13763 Note the contrast with @samp{print &@var{symbol}}, which does not work
13764 at all for a register variable, and for a stack local variable prints
13765 the exact address of the current instantiation of the variable.
13766
13767 @kindex info symbol
13768 @cindex symbol from address
13769 @cindex closest symbol and offset for an address
13770 @item info symbol @var{addr}
13771 Print the name of a symbol which is stored at the address @var{addr}.
13772 If no symbol is stored exactly at @var{addr}, @value{GDBN} prints the
13773 nearest symbol and an offset from it:
13774
13775 @smallexample
13776 (@value{GDBP}) info symbol 0x54320
13777 _initialize_vx + 396 in section .text
13778 @end smallexample
13779
13780 @noindent
13781 This is the opposite of the @code{info address} command. You can use
13782 it to find out the name of a variable or a function given its address.
13783
13784 For dynamically linked executables, the name of executable or shared
13785 library containing the symbol is also printed:
13786
13787 @smallexample
13788 (@value{GDBP}) info symbol 0x400225
13789 _start + 5 in section .text of /tmp/a.out
13790 (@value{GDBP}) info symbol 0x2aaaac2811cf
13791 __read_nocancel + 6 in section .text of /usr/lib64/libc.so.6
13792 @end smallexample
13793
13794 @kindex whatis
13795 @item whatis [@var{arg}]
13796 Print the data type of @var{arg}, which can be either an expression or
13797 a data type. With no argument, print the data type of @code{$}, the
13798 last value in the value history. If @var{arg} is an expression, it is
13799 not actually evaluated, and any side-effecting operations (such as
13800 assignments or function calls) inside it do not take place. If
13801 @var{arg} is a type name, it may be the name of a type or typedef, or
13802 for C code it may have the form @samp{class @var{class-name}},
13803 @samp{struct @var{struct-tag}}, @samp{union @var{union-tag}} or
13804 @samp{enum @var{enum-tag}}.
13805 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
13806
13807 @kindex ptype
13808 @item ptype [@var{arg}]
13809 @code{ptype} accepts the same arguments as @code{whatis}, but prints a
13810 detailed description of the type, instead of just the name of the type.
13811 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
13812
13813 For example, for this variable declaration:
13814
13815 @smallexample
13816 struct complex @{double real; double imag;@} v;
13817 @end smallexample
13818
13819 @noindent
13820 the two commands give this output:
13821
13822 @smallexample
13823 @group
13824 (@value{GDBP}) whatis v
13825 type = struct complex
13826 (@value{GDBP}) ptype v
13827 type = struct complex @{
13828 double real;
13829 double imag;
13830 @}
13831 @end group
13832 @end smallexample
13833
13834 @noindent
13835 As with @code{whatis}, using @code{ptype} without an argument refers to
13836 the type of @code{$}, the last value in the value history.
13837
13838 @cindex incomplete type
13839 Sometimes, programs use opaque data types or incomplete specifications
13840 of complex data structure. If the debug information included in the
13841 program does not allow @value{GDBN} to display a full declaration of
13842 the data type, it will say @samp{<incomplete type>}. For example,
13843 given these declarations:
13844
13845 @smallexample
13846 struct foo;
13847 struct foo *fooptr;
13848 @end smallexample
13849
13850 @noindent
13851 but no definition for @code{struct foo} itself, @value{GDBN} will say:
13852
13853 @smallexample
13854 (@value{GDBP}) ptype foo
13855 $1 = <incomplete type>
13856 @end smallexample
13857
13858 @noindent
13859 ``Incomplete type'' is C terminology for data types that are not
13860 completely specified.
13861
13862 @kindex info types
13863 @item info types @var{regexp}
13864 @itemx info types
13865 Print a brief description of all types whose names match the regular
13866 expression @var{regexp} (or all types in your program, if you supply
13867 no argument). Each complete typename is matched as though it were a
13868 complete line; thus, @samp{i type value} gives information on all
13869 types in your program whose names include the string @code{value}, but
13870 @samp{i type ^value$} gives information only on types whose complete
13871 name is @code{value}.
13872
13873 This command differs from @code{ptype} in two ways: first, like
13874 @code{whatis}, it does not print a detailed description; second, it
13875 lists all source files where a type is defined.
13876
13877 @kindex info scope
13878 @cindex local variables
13879 @item info scope @var{location}
13880 List all the variables local to a particular scope. This command
13881 accepts a @var{location} argument---a function name, a source line, or
13882 an address preceded by a @samp{*}, and prints all the variables local
13883 to the scope defined by that location. (@xref{Specify Location}, for
13884 details about supported forms of @var{location}.) For example:
13885
13886 @smallexample
13887 (@value{GDBP}) @b{info scope command_line_handler}
13888 Scope for command_line_handler:
13889 Symbol rl is an argument at stack/frame offset 8, length 4.
13890 Symbol linebuffer is in static storage at address 0x150a18, length 4.
13891 Symbol linelength is in static storage at address 0x150a1c, length 4.
13892 Symbol p is a local variable in register $esi, length 4.
13893 Symbol p1 is a local variable in register $ebx, length 4.
13894 Symbol nline is a local variable in register $edx, length 4.
13895 Symbol repeat is a local variable at frame offset -8, length 4.
13896 @end smallexample
13897
13898 @noindent
13899 This command is especially useful for determining what data to collect
13900 during a @dfn{trace experiment}, see @ref{Tracepoint Actions,
13901 collect}.
13902
13903 @kindex info source
13904 @item info source
13905 Show information about the current source file---that is, the source file for
13906 the function containing the current point of execution:
13907 @itemize @bullet
13908 @item
13909 the name of the source file, and the directory containing it,
13910 @item
13911 the directory it was compiled in,
13912 @item
13913 its length, in lines,
13914 @item
13915 which programming language it is written in,
13916 @item
13917 whether the executable includes debugging information for that file, and
13918 if so, what format the information is in (e.g., STABS, Dwarf 2, etc.), and
13919 @item
13920 whether the debugging information includes information about
13921 preprocessor macros.
13922 @end itemize
13923
13924
13925 @kindex info sources
13926 @item info sources
13927 Print the names of all source files in your program for which there is
13928 debugging information, organized into two lists: files whose symbols
13929 have already been read, and files whose symbols will be read when needed.
13930
13931 @kindex info functions
13932 @item info functions
13933 Print the names and data types of all defined functions.
13934
13935 @item info functions @var{regexp}
13936 Print the names and data types of all defined functions
13937 whose names contain a match for regular expression @var{regexp}.
13938 Thus, @samp{info fun step} finds all functions whose names
13939 include @code{step}; @samp{info fun ^step} finds those whose names
13940 start with @code{step}. If a function name contains characters
13941 that conflict with the regular expression language (e.g.@:
13942 @samp{operator*()}), they may be quoted with a backslash.
13943
13944 @kindex info variables
13945 @item info variables
13946 Print the names and data types of all variables that are defined
13947 outside of functions (i.e.@: excluding local variables).
13948
13949 @item info variables @var{regexp}
13950 Print the names and data types of all variables (except for local
13951 variables) whose names contain a match for regular expression
13952 @var{regexp}.
13953
13954 @kindex info classes
13955 @cindex Objective-C, classes and selectors
13956 @item info classes
13957 @itemx info classes @var{regexp}
13958 Display all Objective-C classes in your program, or
13959 (with the @var{regexp} argument) all those matching a particular regular
13960 expression.
13961
13962 @kindex info selectors
13963 @item info selectors
13964 @itemx info selectors @var{regexp}
13965 Display all Objective-C selectors in your program, or
13966 (with the @var{regexp} argument) all those matching a particular regular
13967 expression.
13968
13969 @ignore
13970 This was never implemented.
13971 @kindex info methods
13972 @item info methods
13973 @itemx info methods @var{regexp}
13974 The @code{info methods} command permits the user to examine all defined
13975 methods within C@t{++} program, or (with the @var{regexp} argument) a
13976 specific set of methods found in the various C@t{++} classes. Many
13977 C@t{++} classes provide a large number of methods. Thus, the output
13978 from the @code{ptype} command can be overwhelming and hard to use. The
13979 @code{info-methods} command filters the methods, printing only those
13980 which match the regular-expression @var{regexp}.
13981 @end ignore
13982
13983 @cindex reloading symbols
13984 Some systems allow individual object files that make up your program to
13985 be replaced without stopping and restarting your program. For example,
13986 in VxWorks you can simply recompile a defective object file and keep on
13987 running. If you are running on one of these systems, you can allow
13988 @value{GDBN} to reload the symbols for automatically relinked modules:
13989
13990 @table @code
13991 @kindex set symbol-reloading
13992 @item set symbol-reloading on
13993 Replace symbol definitions for the corresponding source file when an
13994 object file with a particular name is seen again.
13995
13996 @item set symbol-reloading off
13997 Do not replace symbol definitions when encountering object files of the
13998 same name more than once. This is the default state; if you are not
13999 running on a system that permits automatic relinking of modules, you
14000 should leave @code{symbol-reloading} off, since otherwise @value{GDBN}
14001 may discard symbols when linking large programs, that may contain
14002 several modules (from different directories or libraries) with the same
14003 name.
14004
14005 @kindex show symbol-reloading
14006 @item show symbol-reloading
14007 Show the current @code{on} or @code{off} setting.
14008 @end table
14009
14010 @cindex opaque data types
14011 @kindex set opaque-type-resolution
14012 @item set opaque-type-resolution on
14013 Tell @value{GDBN} to resolve opaque types. An opaque type is a type
14014 declared as a pointer to a @code{struct}, @code{class}, or
14015 @code{union}---for example, @code{struct MyType *}---that is used in one
14016 source file although the full declaration of @code{struct MyType} is in
14017 another source file. The default is on.
14018
14019 A change in the setting of this subcommand will not take effect until
14020 the next time symbols for a file are loaded.
14021
14022 @item set opaque-type-resolution off
14023 Tell @value{GDBN} not to resolve opaque types. In this case, the type
14024 is printed as follows:
14025 @smallexample
14026 @{<no data fields>@}
14027 @end smallexample
14028
14029 @kindex show opaque-type-resolution
14030 @item show opaque-type-resolution
14031 Show whether opaque types are resolved or not.
14032
14033 @kindex maint print symbols
14034 @cindex symbol dump
14035 @kindex maint print psymbols
14036 @cindex partial symbol dump
14037 @item maint print symbols @var{filename}
14038 @itemx maint print psymbols @var{filename}
14039 @itemx maint print msymbols @var{filename}
14040 Write a dump of debugging symbol data into the file @var{filename}.
14041 These commands are used to debug the @value{GDBN} symbol-reading code. Only
14042 symbols with debugging data are included. If you use @samp{maint print
14043 symbols}, @value{GDBN} includes all the symbols for which it has already
14044 collected full details: that is, @var{filename} reflects symbols for
14045 only those files whose symbols @value{GDBN} has read. You can use the
14046 command @code{info sources} to find out which files these are. If you
14047 use @samp{maint print psymbols} instead, the dump shows information about
14048 symbols that @value{GDBN} only knows partially---that is, symbols defined in
14049 files that @value{GDBN} has skimmed, but not yet read completely. Finally,
14050 @samp{maint print msymbols} dumps just the minimal symbol information
14051 required for each object file from which @value{GDBN} has read some symbols.
14052 @xref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}, for a discussion of how
14053 @value{GDBN} reads symbols (in the description of @code{symbol-file}).
14054
14055 @kindex maint info symtabs
14056 @kindex maint info psymtabs
14057 @cindex listing @value{GDBN}'s internal symbol tables
14058 @cindex symbol tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
14059 @cindex full symbol tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
14060 @cindex partial symbol tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
14061 @item maint info symtabs @r{[} @var{regexp} @r{]}
14062 @itemx maint info psymtabs @r{[} @var{regexp} @r{]}
14063
14064 List the @code{struct symtab} or @code{struct partial_symtab}
14065 structures whose names match @var{regexp}. If @var{regexp} is not
14066 given, list them all. The output includes expressions which you can
14067 copy into a @value{GDBN} debugging this one to examine a particular
14068 structure in more detail. For example:
14069
14070 @smallexample
14071 (@value{GDBP}) maint info psymtabs dwarf2read
14072 @{ objfile /home/gnu/build/gdb/gdb
14073 ((struct objfile *) 0x82e69d0)
14074 @{ psymtab /home/gnu/src/gdb/dwarf2read.c
14075 ((struct partial_symtab *) 0x8474b10)
14076 readin no
14077 fullname (null)
14078 text addresses 0x814d3c8 -- 0x8158074
14079 globals (* (struct partial_symbol **) 0x8507a08 @@ 9)
14080 statics (* (struct partial_symbol **) 0x40e95b78 @@ 2882)
14081 dependencies (none)
14082 @}
14083 @}
14084 (@value{GDBP}) maint info symtabs
14085 (@value{GDBP})
14086 @end smallexample
14087 @noindent
14088 We see that there is one partial symbol table whose filename contains
14089 the string @samp{dwarf2read}, belonging to the @samp{gdb} executable;
14090 and we see that @value{GDBN} has not read in any symtabs yet at all.
14091 If we set a breakpoint on a function, that will cause @value{GDBN} to
14092 read the symtab for the compilation unit containing that function:
14093
14094 @smallexample
14095 (@value{GDBP}) break dwarf2_psymtab_to_symtab
14096 Breakpoint 1 at 0x814e5da: file /home/gnu/src/gdb/dwarf2read.c,
14097 line 1574.
14098 (@value{GDBP}) maint info symtabs
14099 @{ objfile /home/gnu/build/gdb/gdb
14100 ((struct objfile *) 0x82e69d0)
14101 @{ symtab /home/gnu/src/gdb/dwarf2read.c
14102 ((struct symtab *) 0x86c1f38)
14103 dirname (null)
14104 fullname (null)
14105 blockvector ((struct blockvector *) 0x86c1bd0) (primary)
14106 linetable ((struct linetable *) 0x8370fa0)
14107 debugformat DWARF 2
14108 @}
14109 @}
14110 (@value{GDBP})
14111 @end smallexample
14112 @end table
14113
14114
14115 @node Altering
14116 @chapter Altering Execution
14117
14118 Once you think you have found an error in your program, you might want to
14119 find out for certain whether correcting the apparent error would lead to
14120 correct results in the rest of the run. You can find the answer by
14121 experiment, using the @value{GDBN} features for altering execution of the
14122 program.
14123
14124 For example, you can store new values into variables or memory
14125 locations, give your program a signal, restart it at a different
14126 address, or even return prematurely from a function.
14127
14128 @menu
14129 * Assignment:: Assignment to variables
14130 * Jumping:: Continuing at a different address
14131 * Signaling:: Giving your program a signal
14132 * Returning:: Returning from a function
14133 * Calling:: Calling your program's functions
14134 * Patching:: Patching your program
14135 @end menu
14136
14137 @node Assignment
14138 @section Assignment to Variables
14139
14140 @cindex assignment
14141 @cindex setting variables
14142 To alter the value of a variable, evaluate an assignment expression.
14143 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}. For example,
14144
14145 @smallexample
14146 print x=4
14147 @end smallexample
14148
14149 @noindent
14150 stores the value 4 into the variable @code{x}, and then prints the
14151 value of the assignment expression (which is 4).
14152 @xref{Languages, ,Using @value{GDBN} with Different Languages}, for more
14153 information on operators in supported languages.
14154
14155 @kindex set variable
14156 @cindex variables, setting
14157 If you are not interested in seeing the value of the assignment, use the
14158 @code{set} command instead of the @code{print} command. @code{set} is
14159 really the same as @code{print} except that the expression's value is
14160 not printed and is not put in the value history (@pxref{Value History,
14161 ,Value History}). The expression is evaluated only for its effects.
14162
14163 If the beginning of the argument string of the @code{set} command
14164 appears identical to a @code{set} subcommand, use the @code{set
14165 variable} command instead of just @code{set}. This command is identical
14166 to @code{set} except for its lack of subcommands. For example, if your
14167 program has a variable @code{width}, you get an error if you try to set
14168 a new value with just @samp{set width=13}, because @value{GDBN} has the
14169 command @code{set width}:
14170
14171 @smallexample
14172 (@value{GDBP}) whatis width
14173 type = double
14174 (@value{GDBP}) p width
14175 $4 = 13
14176 (@value{GDBP}) set width=47
14177 Invalid syntax in expression.
14178 @end smallexample
14179
14180 @noindent
14181 The invalid expression, of course, is @samp{=47}. In
14182 order to actually set the program's variable @code{width}, use
14183
14184 @smallexample
14185 (@value{GDBP}) set var width=47
14186 @end smallexample
14187
14188 Because the @code{set} command has many subcommands that can conflict
14189 with the names of program variables, it is a good idea to use the
14190 @code{set variable} command instead of just @code{set}. For example, if
14191 your program has a variable @code{g}, you run into problems if you try
14192 to set a new value with just @samp{set g=4}, because @value{GDBN} has
14193 the command @code{set gnutarget}, abbreviated @code{set g}:
14194
14195 @smallexample
14196 @group
14197 (@value{GDBP}) whatis g
14198 type = double
14199 (@value{GDBP}) p g
14200 $1 = 1
14201 (@value{GDBP}) set g=4
14202 (@value{GDBP}) p g
14203 $2 = 1
14204 (@value{GDBP}) r
14205 The program being debugged has been started already.
14206 Start it from the beginning? (y or n) y
14207 Starting program: /home/smith/cc_progs/a.out
14208 "/home/smith/cc_progs/a.out": can't open to read symbols:
14209 Invalid bfd target.
14210 (@value{GDBP}) show g
14211 The current BFD target is "=4".
14212 @end group
14213 @end smallexample
14214
14215 @noindent
14216 The program variable @code{g} did not change, and you silently set the
14217 @code{gnutarget} to an invalid value. In order to set the variable
14218 @code{g}, use
14219
14220 @smallexample
14221 (@value{GDBP}) set var g=4
14222 @end smallexample
14223
14224 @value{GDBN} allows more implicit conversions in assignments than C; you can
14225 freely store an integer value into a pointer variable or vice versa,
14226 and you can convert any structure to any other structure that is the
14227 same length or shorter.
14228 @comment FIXME: how do structs align/pad in these conversions?
14229 @comment /doc@cygnus.com 18dec1990
14230
14231 To store values into arbitrary places in memory, use the @samp{@{@dots{}@}}
14232 construct to generate a value of specified type at a specified address
14233 (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). For example, @code{@{int@}0x83040} refers
14234 to memory location @code{0x83040} as an integer (which implies a certain size
14235 and representation in memory), and
14236
14237 @smallexample
14238 set @{int@}0x83040 = 4
14239 @end smallexample
14240
14241 @noindent
14242 stores the value 4 into that memory location.
14243
14244 @node Jumping
14245 @section Continuing at a Different Address
14246
14247 Ordinarily, when you continue your program, you do so at the place where
14248 it stopped, with the @code{continue} command. You can instead continue at
14249 an address of your own choosing, with the following commands:
14250
14251 @table @code
14252 @kindex jump
14253 @item jump @var{linespec}
14254 @itemx jump @var{location}
14255 Resume execution at line @var{linespec} or at address given by
14256 @var{location}. Execution stops again immediately if there is a
14257 breakpoint there. @xref{Specify Location}, for a description of the
14258 different forms of @var{linespec} and @var{location}. It is common
14259 practice to use the @code{tbreak} command in conjunction with
14260 @code{jump}. @xref{Set Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}.
14261
14262 The @code{jump} command does not change the current stack frame, or
14263 the stack pointer, or the contents of any memory location or any
14264 register other than the program counter. If line @var{linespec} is in
14265 a different function from the one currently executing, the results may
14266 be bizarre if the two functions expect different patterns of arguments or
14267 of local variables. For this reason, the @code{jump} command requests
14268 confirmation if the specified line is not in the function currently
14269 executing. However, even bizarre results are predictable if you are
14270 well acquainted with the machine-language code of your program.
14271 @end table
14272
14273 @c Doesn't work on HP-UX; have to set $pcoqh and $pcoqt.
14274 On many systems, you can get much the same effect as the @code{jump}
14275 command by storing a new value into the register @code{$pc}. The
14276 difference is that this does not start your program running; it only
14277 changes the address of where it @emph{will} run when you continue. For
14278 example,
14279
14280 @smallexample
14281 set $pc = 0x485
14282 @end smallexample
14283
14284 @noindent
14285 makes the next @code{continue} command or stepping command execute at
14286 address @code{0x485}, rather than at the address where your program stopped.
14287 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, ,Continuing and Stepping}.
14288
14289 The most common occasion to use the @code{jump} command is to back
14290 up---perhaps with more breakpoints set---over a portion of a program
14291 that has already executed, in order to examine its execution in more
14292 detail.
14293
14294 @c @group
14295 @node Signaling
14296 @section Giving your Program a Signal
14297 @cindex deliver a signal to a program
14298
14299 @table @code
14300 @kindex signal
14301 @item signal @var{signal}
14302 Resume execution where your program stopped, but immediately give it the
14303 signal @var{signal}. @var{signal} can be the name or the number of a
14304 signal. For example, on many systems @code{signal 2} and @code{signal
14305 SIGINT} are both ways of sending an interrupt signal.
14306
14307 Alternatively, if @var{signal} is zero, continue execution without
14308 giving a signal. This is useful when your program stopped on account of
14309 a signal and would ordinary see the signal when resumed with the
14310 @code{continue} command; @samp{signal 0} causes it to resume without a
14311 signal.
14312
14313 @code{signal} does not repeat when you press @key{RET} a second time
14314 after executing the command.
14315 @end table
14316 @c @end group
14317
14318 Invoking the @code{signal} command is not the same as invoking the
14319 @code{kill} utility from the shell. Sending a signal with @code{kill}
14320 causes @value{GDBN} to decide what to do with the signal depending on
14321 the signal handling tables (@pxref{Signals}). The @code{signal} command
14322 passes the signal directly to your program.
14323
14324
14325 @node Returning
14326 @section Returning from a Function
14327
14328 @table @code
14329 @cindex returning from a function
14330 @kindex return
14331 @item return
14332 @itemx return @var{expression}
14333 You can cancel execution of a function call with the @code{return}
14334 command. If you give an
14335 @var{expression} argument, its value is used as the function's return
14336 value.
14337 @end table
14338
14339 When you use @code{return}, @value{GDBN} discards the selected stack frame
14340 (and all frames within it). You can think of this as making the
14341 discarded frame return prematurely. If you wish to specify a value to
14342 be returned, give that value as the argument to @code{return}.
14343
14344 This pops the selected stack frame (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a
14345 Frame}), and any other frames inside of it, leaving its caller as the
14346 innermost remaining frame. That frame becomes selected. The
14347 specified value is stored in the registers used for returning values
14348 of functions.
14349
14350 The @code{return} command does not resume execution; it leaves the
14351 program stopped in the state that would exist if the function had just
14352 returned. In contrast, the @code{finish} command (@pxref{Continuing
14353 and Stepping, ,Continuing and Stepping}) resumes execution until the
14354 selected stack frame returns naturally.
14355
14356 @value{GDBN} needs to know how the @var{expression} argument should be set for
14357 the inferior. The concrete registers assignment depends on the OS ABI and the
14358 type being returned by the selected stack frame. For example it is common for
14359 OS ABI to return floating point values in FPU registers while integer values in
14360 CPU registers. Still some ABIs return even floating point values in CPU
14361 registers. Larger integer widths (such as @code{long long int}) also have
14362 specific placement rules. @value{GDBN} already knows the OS ABI from its
14363 current target so it needs to find out also the type being returned to make the
14364 assignment into the right register(s).
14365
14366 Normally, the selected stack frame has debug info. @value{GDBN} will always
14367 use the debug info instead of the implicit type of @var{expression} when the
14368 debug info is available. For example, if you type @kbd{return -1}, and the
14369 function in the current stack frame is declared to return a @code{long long
14370 int}, @value{GDBN} transparently converts the implicit @code{int} value of -1
14371 into a @code{long long int}:
14372
14373 @smallexample
14374 Breakpoint 1, func () at gdb.base/return-nodebug.c:29
14375 29 return 31;
14376 (@value{GDBP}) return -1
14377 Make func return now? (y or n) y
14378 #0 0x004004f6 in main () at gdb.base/return-nodebug.c:43
14379 43 printf ("result=%lld\n", func ());
14380 (@value{GDBP})
14381 @end smallexample
14382
14383 However, if the selected stack frame does not have a debug info, e.g., if the
14384 function was compiled without debug info, @value{GDBN} has to find out the type
14385 to return from user. Specifying a different type by mistake may set the value
14386 in different inferior registers than the caller code expects. For example,
14387 typing @kbd{return -1} with its implicit type @code{int} would set only a part
14388 of a @code{long long int} result for a debug info less function (on 32-bit
14389 architectures). Therefore the user is required to specify the return type by
14390 an appropriate cast explicitly:
14391
14392 @smallexample
14393 Breakpoint 2, 0x0040050b in func ()
14394 (@value{GDBP}) return -1
14395 Return value type not available for selected stack frame.
14396 Please use an explicit cast of the value to return.
14397 (@value{GDBP}) return (long long int) -1
14398 Make selected stack frame return now? (y or n) y
14399 #0 0x00400526 in main ()
14400 (@value{GDBP})
14401 @end smallexample
14402
14403 @node Calling
14404 @section Calling Program Functions
14405
14406 @table @code
14407 @cindex calling functions
14408 @cindex inferior functions, calling
14409 @item print @var{expr}
14410 Evaluate the expression @var{expr} and display the resulting value.
14411 @var{expr} may include calls to functions in the program being
14412 debugged.
14413
14414 @kindex call
14415 @item call @var{expr}
14416 Evaluate the expression @var{expr} without displaying @code{void}
14417 returned values.
14418
14419 You can use this variant of the @code{print} command if you want to
14420 execute a function from your program that does not return anything
14421 (a.k.a.@: @dfn{a void function}), but without cluttering the output
14422 with @code{void} returned values that @value{GDBN} will otherwise
14423 print. If the result is not void, it is printed and saved in the
14424 value history.
14425 @end table
14426
14427 It is possible for the function you call via the @code{print} or
14428 @code{call} command to generate a signal (e.g., if there's a bug in
14429 the function, or if you passed it incorrect arguments). What happens
14430 in that case is controlled by the @code{set unwindonsignal} command.
14431
14432 Similarly, with a C@t{++} program it is possible for the function you
14433 call via the @code{print} or @code{call} command to generate an
14434 exception that is not handled due to the constraints of the dummy
14435 frame. In this case, any exception that is raised in the frame, but has
14436 an out-of-frame exception handler will not be found. GDB builds a
14437 dummy-frame for the inferior function call, and the unwinder cannot
14438 seek for exception handlers outside of this dummy-frame. What happens
14439 in that case is controlled by the
14440 @code{set unwind-on-terminating-exception} command.
14441
14442 @table @code
14443 @item set unwindonsignal
14444 @kindex set unwindonsignal
14445 @cindex unwind stack in called functions
14446 @cindex call dummy stack unwinding
14447 Set unwinding of the stack if a signal is received while in a function
14448 that @value{GDBN} called in the program being debugged. If set to on,
14449 @value{GDBN} unwinds the stack it created for the call and restores
14450 the context to what it was before the call. If set to off (the
14451 default), @value{GDBN} stops in the frame where the signal was
14452 received.
14453
14454 @item show unwindonsignal
14455 @kindex show unwindonsignal
14456 Show the current setting of stack unwinding in the functions called by
14457 @value{GDBN}.
14458
14459 @item set unwind-on-terminating-exception
14460 @kindex set unwind-on-terminating-exception
14461 @cindex unwind stack in called functions with unhandled exceptions
14462 @cindex call dummy stack unwinding on unhandled exception.
14463 Set unwinding of the stack if a C@t{++} exception is raised, but left
14464 unhandled while in a function that @value{GDBN} called in the program being
14465 debugged. If set to on (the default), @value{GDBN} unwinds the stack
14466 it created for the call and restores the context to what it was before
14467 the call. If set to off, @value{GDBN} the exception is delivered to
14468 the default C@t{++} exception handler and the inferior terminated.
14469
14470 @item show unwind-on-terminating-exception
14471 @kindex show unwind-on-terminating-exception
14472 Show the current setting of stack unwinding in the functions called by
14473 @value{GDBN}.
14474
14475 @end table
14476
14477 @cindex weak alias functions
14478 Sometimes, a function you wish to call is actually a @dfn{weak alias}
14479 for another function. In such case, @value{GDBN} might not pick up
14480 the type information, including the types of the function arguments,
14481 which causes @value{GDBN} to call the inferior function incorrectly.
14482 As a result, the called function will function erroneously and may
14483 even crash. A solution to that is to use the name of the aliased
14484 function instead.
14485
14486 @node Patching
14487 @section Patching Programs
14488
14489 @cindex patching binaries
14490 @cindex writing into executables
14491 @cindex writing into corefiles
14492
14493 By default, @value{GDBN} opens the file containing your program's
14494 executable code (or the corefile) read-only. This prevents accidental
14495 alterations to machine code; but it also prevents you from intentionally
14496 patching your program's binary.
14497
14498 If you'd like to be able to patch the binary, you can specify that
14499 explicitly with the @code{set write} command. For example, you might
14500 want to turn on internal debugging flags, or even to make emergency
14501 repairs.
14502
14503 @table @code
14504 @kindex set write
14505 @item set write on
14506 @itemx set write off
14507 If you specify @samp{set write on}, @value{GDBN} opens executable and
14508 core files for both reading and writing; if you specify @kbd{set write
14509 off} (the default), @value{GDBN} opens them read-only.
14510
14511 If you have already loaded a file, you must load it again (using the
14512 @code{exec-file} or @code{core-file} command) after changing @code{set
14513 write}, for your new setting to take effect.
14514
14515 @item show write
14516 @kindex show write
14517 Display whether executable files and core files are opened for writing
14518 as well as reading.
14519 @end table
14520
14521 @node GDB Files
14522 @chapter @value{GDBN} Files
14523
14524 @value{GDBN} needs to know the file name of the program to be debugged,
14525 both in order to read its symbol table and in order to start your
14526 program. To debug a core dump of a previous run, you must also tell
14527 @value{GDBN} the name of the core dump file.
14528
14529 @menu
14530 * Files:: Commands to specify files
14531 * Separate Debug Files:: Debugging information in separate files
14532 * Index Files:: Index files speed up GDB
14533 * Symbol Errors:: Errors reading symbol files
14534 * Data Files:: GDB data files
14535 @end menu
14536
14537 @node Files
14538 @section Commands to Specify Files
14539
14540 @cindex symbol table
14541 @cindex core dump file
14542
14543 You may want to specify executable and core dump file names. The usual
14544 way to do this is at start-up time, using the arguments to
14545 @value{GDBN}'s start-up commands (@pxref{Invocation, , Getting In and
14546 Out of @value{GDBN}}).
14547
14548 Occasionally it is necessary to change to a different file during a
14549 @value{GDBN} session. Or you may run @value{GDBN} and forget to
14550 specify a file you want to use. Or you are debugging a remote target
14551 via @code{gdbserver} (@pxref{Server, file, Using the @code{gdbserver}
14552 Program}). In these situations the @value{GDBN} commands to specify
14553 new files are useful.
14554
14555 @table @code
14556 @cindex executable file
14557 @kindex file
14558 @item file @var{filename}
14559 Use @var{filename} as the program to be debugged. It is read for its
14560 symbols and for the contents of pure memory. It is also the program
14561 executed when you use the @code{run} command. If you do not specify a
14562 directory and the file is not found in the @value{GDBN} working directory,
14563 @value{GDBN} uses the environment variable @code{PATH} as a list of
14564 directories to search, just as the shell does when looking for a program
14565 to run. You can change the value of this variable, for both @value{GDBN}
14566 and your program, using the @code{path} command.
14567
14568 @cindex unlinked object files
14569 @cindex patching object files
14570 You can load unlinked object @file{.o} files into @value{GDBN} using
14571 the @code{file} command. You will not be able to ``run'' an object
14572 file, but you can disassemble functions and inspect variables. Also,
14573 if the underlying BFD functionality supports it, you could use
14574 @kbd{gdb -write} to patch object files using this technique. Note
14575 that @value{GDBN} can neither interpret nor modify relocations in this
14576 case, so branches and some initialized variables will appear to go to
14577 the wrong place. But this feature is still handy from time to time.
14578
14579 @item file
14580 @code{file} with no argument makes @value{GDBN} discard any information it
14581 has on both executable file and the symbol table.
14582
14583 @kindex exec-file
14584 @item exec-file @r{[} @var{filename} @r{]}
14585 Specify that the program to be run (but not the symbol table) is found
14586 in @var{filename}. @value{GDBN} searches the environment variable @code{PATH}
14587 if necessary to locate your program. Omitting @var{filename} means to
14588 discard information on the executable file.
14589
14590 @kindex symbol-file
14591 @item symbol-file @r{[} @var{filename} @r{]}
14592 Read symbol table information from file @var{filename}. @code{PATH} is
14593 searched when necessary. Use the @code{file} command to get both symbol
14594 table and program to run from the same file.
14595
14596 @code{symbol-file} with no argument clears out @value{GDBN} information on your
14597 program's symbol table.
14598
14599 The @code{symbol-file} command causes @value{GDBN} to forget the contents of
14600 some breakpoints and auto-display expressions. This is because they may
14601 contain pointers to the internal data recording symbols and data types,
14602 which are part of the old symbol table data being discarded inside
14603 @value{GDBN}.
14604
14605 @code{symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after
14606 executing it once.
14607
14608 When @value{GDBN} is configured for a particular environment, it
14609 understands debugging information in whatever format is the standard
14610 generated for that environment; you may use either a @sc{gnu} compiler, or
14611 other compilers that adhere to the local conventions.
14612 Best results are usually obtained from @sc{gnu} compilers; for example,
14613 using @code{@value{NGCC}} you can generate debugging information for
14614 optimized code.
14615
14616 For most kinds of object files, with the exception of old SVR3 systems
14617 using COFF, the @code{symbol-file} command does not normally read the
14618 symbol table in full right away. Instead, it scans the symbol table
14619 quickly to find which source files and which symbols are present. The
14620 details are read later, one source file at a time, as they are needed.
14621
14622 The purpose of this two-stage reading strategy is to make @value{GDBN}
14623 start up faster. For the most part, it is invisible except for
14624 occasional pauses while the symbol table details for a particular source
14625 file are being read. (The @code{set verbose} command can turn these
14626 pauses into messages if desired. @xref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional
14627 Warnings and Messages}.)
14628
14629 We have not implemented the two-stage strategy for COFF yet. When the
14630 symbol table is stored in COFF format, @code{symbol-file} reads the
14631 symbol table data in full right away. Note that ``stabs-in-COFF''
14632 still does the two-stage strategy, since the debug info is actually
14633 in stabs format.
14634
14635 @kindex readnow
14636 @cindex reading symbols immediately
14637 @cindex symbols, reading immediately
14638 @item symbol-file @r{[} -readnow @r{]} @var{filename}
14639 @itemx file @r{[} -readnow @r{]} @var{filename}
14640 You can override the @value{GDBN} two-stage strategy for reading symbol
14641 tables by using the @samp{-readnow} option with any of the commands that
14642 load symbol table information, if you want to be sure @value{GDBN} has the
14643 entire symbol table available.
14644
14645 @c FIXME: for now no mention of directories, since this seems to be in
14646 @c flux. 13mar1992 status is that in theory GDB would look either in
14647 @c current dir or in same dir as myprog; but issues like competing
14648 @c GDB's, or clutter in system dirs, mean that in practice right now
14649 @c only current dir is used. FFish says maybe a special GDB hierarchy
14650 @c (eg rooted in val of env var GDBSYMS) could exist for mappable symbol
14651 @c files.
14652
14653 @kindex core-file
14654 @item core-file @r{[}@var{filename}@r{]}
14655 @itemx core
14656 Specify the whereabouts of a core dump file to be used as the ``contents
14657 of memory''. Traditionally, core files contain only some parts of the
14658 address space of the process that generated them; @value{GDBN} can access the
14659 executable file itself for other parts.
14660
14661 @code{core-file} with no argument specifies that no core file is
14662 to be used.
14663
14664 Note that the core file is ignored when your program is actually running
14665 under @value{GDBN}. So, if you have been running your program and you
14666 wish to debug a core file instead, you must kill the subprocess in which
14667 the program is running. To do this, use the @code{kill} command
14668 (@pxref{Kill Process, ,Killing the Child Process}).
14669
14670 @kindex add-symbol-file
14671 @cindex dynamic linking
14672 @item add-symbol-file @var{filename} @var{address}
14673 @itemx add-symbol-file @var{filename} @var{address} @r{[} -readnow @r{]}
14674 @itemx add-symbol-file @var{filename} @r{-s}@var{section} @var{address} @dots{}
14675 The @code{add-symbol-file} command reads additional symbol table
14676 information from the file @var{filename}. You would use this command
14677 when @var{filename} has been dynamically loaded (by some other means)
14678 into the program that is running. @var{address} should be the memory
14679 address at which the file has been loaded; @value{GDBN} cannot figure
14680 this out for itself. You can additionally specify an arbitrary number
14681 of @samp{@r{-s}@var{section} @var{address}} pairs, to give an explicit
14682 section name and base address for that section. You can specify any
14683 @var{address} as an expression.
14684
14685 The symbol table of the file @var{filename} is added to the symbol table
14686 originally read with the @code{symbol-file} command. You can use the
14687 @code{add-symbol-file} command any number of times; the new symbol data
14688 thus read keeps adding to the old. To discard all old symbol data
14689 instead, use the @code{symbol-file} command without any arguments.
14690
14691 @cindex relocatable object files, reading symbols from
14692 @cindex object files, relocatable, reading symbols from
14693 @cindex reading symbols from relocatable object files
14694 @cindex symbols, reading from relocatable object files
14695 @cindex @file{.o} files, reading symbols from
14696 Although @var{filename} is typically a shared library file, an
14697 executable file, or some other object file which has been fully
14698 relocated for loading into a process, you can also load symbolic
14699 information from relocatable @file{.o} files, as long as:
14700
14701 @itemize @bullet
14702 @item
14703 the file's symbolic information refers only to linker symbols defined in
14704 that file, not to symbols defined by other object files,
14705 @item
14706 every section the file's symbolic information refers to has actually
14707 been loaded into the inferior, as it appears in the file, and
14708 @item
14709 you can determine the address at which every section was loaded, and
14710 provide these to the @code{add-symbol-file} command.
14711 @end itemize
14712
14713 @noindent
14714 Some embedded operating systems, like Sun Chorus and VxWorks, can load
14715 relocatable files into an already running program; such systems
14716 typically make the requirements above easy to meet. However, it's
14717 important to recognize that many native systems use complex link
14718 procedures (@code{.linkonce} section factoring and C@t{++} constructor table
14719 assembly, for example) that make the requirements difficult to meet. In
14720 general, one cannot assume that using @code{add-symbol-file} to read a
14721 relocatable object file's symbolic information will have the same effect
14722 as linking the relocatable object file into the program in the normal
14723 way.
14724
14725 @code{add-symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
14726
14727 @kindex add-symbol-file-from-memory
14728 @cindex @code{syscall DSO}
14729 @cindex load symbols from memory
14730 @item add-symbol-file-from-memory @var{address}
14731 Load symbols from the given @var{address} in a dynamically loaded
14732 object file whose image is mapped directly into the inferior's memory.
14733 For example, the Linux kernel maps a @code{syscall DSO} into each
14734 process's address space; this DSO provides kernel-specific code for
14735 some system calls. The argument can be any expression whose
14736 evaluation yields the address of the file's shared object file header.
14737 For this command to work, you must have used @code{symbol-file} or
14738 @code{exec-file} commands in advance.
14739
14740 @kindex add-shared-symbol-files
14741 @kindex assf
14742 @item add-shared-symbol-files @var{library-file}
14743 @itemx assf @var{library-file}
14744 The @code{add-shared-symbol-files} command can currently be used only
14745 in the Cygwin build of @value{GDBN} on MS-Windows OS, where it is an
14746 alias for the @code{dll-symbols} command (@pxref{Cygwin Native}).
14747 @value{GDBN} automatically looks for shared libraries, however if
14748 @value{GDBN} does not find yours, you can invoke
14749 @code{add-shared-symbol-files}. It takes one argument: the shared
14750 library's file name. @code{assf} is a shorthand alias for
14751 @code{add-shared-symbol-files}.
14752
14753 @kindex section
14754 @item section @var{section} @var{addr}
14755 The @code{section} command changes the base address of the named
14756 @var{section} of the exec file to @var{addr}. This can be used if the
14757 exec file does not contain section addresses, (such as in the
14758 @code{a.out} format), or when the addresses specified in the file
14759 itself are wrong. Each section must be changed separately. The
14760 @code{info files} command, described below, lists all the sections and
14761 their addresses.
14762
14763 @kindex info files
14764 @kindex info target
14765 @item info files
14766 @itemx info target
14767 @code{info files} and @code{info target} are synonymous; both print the
14768 current target (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}),
14769 including the names of the executable and core dump files currently in
14770 use by @value{GDBN}, and the files from which symbols were loaded. The
14771 command @code{help target} lists all possible targets rather than
14772 current ones.
14773
14774 @kindex maint info sections
14775 @item maint info sections
14776 Another command that can give you extra information about program sections
14777 is @code{maint info sections}. In addition to the section information
14778 displayed by @code{info files}, this command displays the flags and file
14779 offset of each section in the executable and core dump files. In addition,
14780 @code{maint info sections} provides the following command options (which
14781 may be arbitrarily combined):
14782
14783 @table @code
14784 @item ALLOBJ
14785 Display sections for all loaded object files, including shared libraries.
14786 @item @var{sections}
14787 Display info only for named @var{sections}.
14788 @item @var{section-flags}
14789 Display info only for sections for which @var{section-flags} are true.
14790 The section flags that @value{GDBN} currently knows about are:
14791 @table @code
14792 @item ALLOC
14793 Section will have space allocated in the process when loaded.
14794 Set for all sections except those containing debug information.
14795 @item LOAD
14796 Section will be loaded from the file into the child process memory.
14797 Set for pre-initialized code and data, clear for @code{.bss} sections.
14798 @item RELOC
14799 Section needs to be relocated before loading.
14800 @item READONLY
14801 Section cannot be modified by the child process.
14802 @item CODE
14803 Section contains executable code only.
14804 @item DATA
14805 Section contains data only (no executable code).
14806 @item ROM
14807 Section will reside in ROM.
14808 @item CONSTRUCTOR
14809 Section contains data for constructor/destructor lists.
14810 @item HAS_CONTENTS
14811 Section is not empty.
14812 @item NEVER_LOAD
14813 An instruction to the linker to not output the section.
14814 @item COFF_SHARED_LIBRARY
14815 A notification to the linker that the section contains
14816 COFF shared library information.
14817 @item IS_COMMON
14818 Section contains common symbols.
14819 @end table
14820 @end table
14821 @kindex set trust-readonly-sections
14822 @cindex read-only sections
14823 @item set trust-readonly-sections on
14824 Tell @value{GDBN} that readonly sections in your object file
14825 really are read-only (i.e.@: that their contents will not change).
14826 In that case, @value{GDBN} can fetch values from these sections
14827 out of the object file, rather than from the target program.
14828 For some targets (notably embedded ones), this can be a significant
14829 enhancement to debugging performance.
14830
14831 The default is off.
14832
14833 @item set trust-readonly-sections off
14834 Tell @value{GDBN} not to trust readonly sections. This means that
14835 the contents of the section might change while the program is running,
14836 and must therefore be fetched from the target when needed.
14837
14838 @item show trust-readonly-sections
14839 Show the current setting of trusting readonly sections.
14840 @end table
14841
14842 All file-specifying commands allow both absolute and relative file names
14843 as arguments. @value{GDBN} always converts the file name to an absolute file
14844 name and remembers it that way.
14845
14846 @cindex shared libraries
14847 @anchor{Shared Libraries}
14848 @value{GDBN} supports @sc{gnu}/Linux, MS-Windows, HP-UX, SunOS, SVr4, Irix,
14849 and IBM RS/6000 AIX shared libraries.
14850
14851 On MS-Windows @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support
14852 shared libraries. @xref{Expat}.
14853
14854 @value{GDBN} automatically loads symbol definitions from shared libraries
14855 when you use the @code{run} command, or when you examine a core file.
14856 (Before you issue the @code{run} command, @value{GDBN} does not understand
14857 references to a function in a shared library, however---unless you are
14858 debugging a core file).
14859
14860 On HP-UX, if the program loads a library explicitly, @value{GDBN}
14861 automatically loads the symbols at the time of the @code{shl_load} call.
14862
14863 @c FIXME: some @value{GDBN} release may permit some refs to undef
14864 @c FIXME...symbols---eg in a break cmd---assuming they are from a shared
14865 @c FIXME...lib; check this from time to time when updating manual
14866
14867 There are times, however, when you may wish to not automatically load
14868 symbol definitions from shared libraries, such as when they are
14869 particularly large or there are many of them.
14870
14871 To control the automatic loading of shared library symbols, use the
14872 commands:
14873
14874 @table @code
14875 @kindex set auto-solib-add
14876 @item set auto-solib-add @var{mode}
14877 If @var{mode} is @code{on}, symbols from all shared object libraries
14878 will be loaded automatically when the inferior begins execution, you
14879 attach to an independently started inferior, or when the dynamic linker
14880 informs @value{GDBN} that a new library has been loaded. If @var{mode}
14881 is @code{off}, symbols must be loaded manually, using the
14882 @code{sharedlibrary} command. The default value is @code{on}.
14883
14884 @cindex memory used for symbol tables
14885 If your program uses lots of shared libraries with debug info that
14886 takes large amounts of memory, you can decrease the @value{GDBN}
14887 memory footprint by preventing it from automatically loading the
14888 symbols from shared libraries. To that end, type @kbd{set
14889 auto-solib-add off} before running the inferior, then load each
14890 library whose debug symbols you do need with @kbd{sharedlibrary
14891 @var{regexp}}, where @var{regexp} is a regular expression that matches
14892 the libraries whose symbols you want to be loaded.
14893
14894 @kindex show auto-solib-add
14895 @item show auto-solib-add
14896 Display the current autoloading mode.
14897 @end table
14898
14899 @cindex load shared library
14900 To explicitly load shared library symbols, use the @code{sharedlibrary}
14901 command:
14902
14903 @table @code
14904 @kindex info sharedlibrary
14905 @kindex info share
14906 @item info share @var{regex}
14907 @itemx info sharedlibrary @var{regex}
14908 Print the names of the shared libraries which are currently loaded
14909 that match @var{regex}. If @var{regex} is omitted then print
14910 all shared libraries that are loaded.
14911
14912 @kindex sharedlibrary
14913 @kindex share
14914 @item sharedlibrary @var{regex}
14915 @itemx share @var{regex}
14916 Load shared object library symbols for files matching a
14917 Unix regular expression.
14918 As with files loaded automatically, it only loads shared libraries
14919 required by your program for a core file or after typing @code{run}. If
14920 @var{regex} is omitted all shared libraries required by your program are
14921 loaded.
14922
14923 @item nosharedlibrary
14924 @kindex nosharedlibrary
14925 @cindex unload symbols from shared libraries
14926 Unload all shared object library symbols. This discards all symbols
14927 that have been loaded from all shared libraries. Symbols from shared
14928 libraries that were loaded by explicit user requests are not
14929 discarded.
14930 @end table
14931
14932 Sometimes you may wish that @value{GDBN} stops and gives you control
14933 when any of shared library events happen. Use the @code{set
14934 stop-on-solib-events} command for this:
14935
14936 @table @code
14937 @item set stop-on-solib-events
14938 @kindex set stop-on-solib-events
14939 This command controls whether @value{GDBN} should give you control
14940 when the dynamic linker notifies it about some shared library event.
14941 The most common event of interest is loading or unloading of a new
14942 shared library.
14943
14944 @item show stop-on-solib-events
14945 @kindex show stop-on-solib-events
14946 Show whether @value{GDBN} stops and gives you control when shared
14947 library events happen.
14948 @end table
14949
14950 Shared libraries are also supported in many cross or remote debugging
14951 configurations. @value{GDBN} needs to have access to the target's libraries;
14952 this can be accomplished either by providing copies of the libraries
14953 on the host system, or by asking @value{GDBN} to automatically retrieve the
14954 libraries from the target. If copies of the target libraries are
14955 provided, they need to be the same as the target libraries, although the
14956 copies on the target can be stripped as long as the copies on the host are
14957 not.
14958
14959 @cindex where to look for shared libraries
14960 For remote debugging, you need to tell @value{GDBN} where the target
14961 libraries are, so that it can load the correct copies---otherwise, it
14962 may try to load the host's libraries. @value{GDBN} has two variables
14963 to specify the search directories for target libraries.
14964
14965 @table @code
14966 @cindex prefix for shared library file names
14967 @cindex system root, alternate
14968 @kindex set solib-absolute-prefix
14969 @kindex set sysroot
14970 @item set sysroot @var{path}
14971 Use @var{path} as the system root for the program being debugged. Any
14972 absolute shared library paths will be prefixed with @var{path}; many
14973 runtime loaders store the absolute paths to the shared library in the
14974 target program's memory. If you use @code{set sysroot} to find shared
14975 libraries, they need to be laid out in the same way that they are on
14976 the target, with e.g.@: a @file{/lib} and @file{/usr/lib} hierarchy
14977 under @var{path}.
14978
14979 If @var{path} starts with the sequence @file{remote:}, @value{GDBN} will
14980 retrieve the target libraries from the remote system. This is only
14981 supported when using a remote target that supports the @code{remote get}
14982 command (@pxref{File Transfer,,Sending files to a remote system}).
14983 The part of @var{path} following the initial @file{remote:}
14984 (if present) is used as system root prefix on the remote file system.
14985 @footnote{If you want to specify a local system root using a directory
14986 that happens to be named @file{remote:}, you need to use some equivalent
14987 variant of the name like @file{./remote:}.}
14988
14989 For targets with an MS-DOS based filesystem, such as MS-Windows and
14990 SymbianOS, @value{GDBN} tries prefixing a few variants of the target
14991 absolute file name with @var{path}. But first, on Unix hosts,
14992 @value{GDBN} converts all backslash directory separators into forward
14993 slashes, because the backslash is not a directory separator on Unix:
14994
14995 @smallexample
14996 c:\foo\bar.dll @result{} c:/foo/bar.dll
14997 @end smallexample
14998
14999 Then, @value{GDBN} attempts prefixing the target file name with
15000 @var{path}, and looks for the resulting file name in the host file
15001 system:
15002
15003 @smallexample
15004 c:/foo/bar.dll @result{} /path/to/sysroot/c:/foo/bar.dll
15005 @end smallexample
15006
15007 If that does not find the shared library, @value{GDBN} tries removing
15008 the @samp{:} character from the drive spec, both for convenience, and,
15009 for the case of the host file system not supporting file names with
15010 colons:
15011
15012 @smallexample
15013 c:/foo/bar.dll @result{} /path/to/sysroot/c/foo/bar.dll
15014 @end smallexample
15015
15016 This makes it possible to have a system root that mirrors a target
15017 with more than one drive. E.g., you may want to setup your local
15018 copies of the target system shared libraries like so (note @samp{c} vs
15019 @samp{z}):
15020
15021 @smallexample
15022 @file{/path/to/sysroot/c/sys/bin/foo.dll}
15023 @file{/path/to/sysroot/c/sys/bin/bar.dll}
15024 @file{/path/to/sysroot/z/sys/bin/bar.dll}
15025 @end smallexample
15026
15027 @noindent
15028 and point the system root at @file{/path/to/sysroot}, so that
15029 @value{GDBN} can find the correct copies of both
15030 @file{c:\sys\bin\foo.dll}, and @file{z:\sys\bin\bar.dll}.
15031
15032 If that still does not find the shared library, @value{GDBN} tries
15033 removing the whole drive spec from the target file name:
15034
15035 @smallexample
15036 c:/foo/bar.dll @result{} /path/to/sysroot/foo/bar.dll
15037 @end smallexample
15038
15039 This last lookup makes it possible to not care about the drive name,
15040 if you don't want or need to.
15041
15042 The @code{set solib-absolute-prefix} command is an alias for @code{set
15043 sysroot}.
15044
15045 @cindex default system root
15046 @cindex @samp{--with-sysroot}
15047 You can set the default system root by using the configure-time
15048 @samp{--with-sysroot} option. If the system root is inside
15049 @value{GDBN}'s configured binary prefix (set with @samp{--prefix} or
15050 @samp{--exec-prefix}), then the default system root will be updated
15051 automatically if the installed @value{GDBN} is moved to a new
15052 location.
15053
15054 @kindex show sysroot
15055 @item show sysroot
15056 Display the current shared library prefix.
15057
15058 @kindex set solib-search-path
15059 @item set solib-search-path @var{path}
15060 If this variable is set, @var{path} is a colon-separated list of
15061 directories to search for shared libraries. @samp{solib-search-path}
15062 is used after @samp{sysroot} fails to locate the library, or if the
15063 path to the library is relative instead of absolute. If you want to
15064 use @samp{solib-search-path} instead of @samp{sysroot}, be sure to set
15065 @samp{sysroot} to a nonexistent directory to prevent @value{GDBN} from
15066 finding your host's libraries. @samp{sysroot} is preferred; setting
15067 it to a nonexistent directory may interfere with automatic loading
15068 of shared library symbols.
15069
15070 @kindex show solib-search-path
15071 @item show solib-search-path
15072 Display the current shared library search path.
15073
15074 @cindex DOS file-name semantics of file names.
15075 @kindex set target-file-system-kind (unix|dos-based|auto)
15076 @kindex show target-file-system-kind
15077 @item set target-file-system-kind @var{kind}
15078 Set assumed file system kind for target reported file names.
15079
15080 Shared library file names as reported by the target system may not
15081 make sense as is on the system @value{GDBN} is running on. For
15082 example, when remote debugging a target that has MS-DOS based file
15083 system semantics, from a Unix host, the target may be reporting to
15084 @value{GDBN} a list of loaded shared libraries with file names such as
15085 @file{c:\Windows\kernel32.dll}. On Unix hosts, there's no concept of
15086 drive letters, so the @samp{c:\} prefix is not normally understood as
15087 indicating an absolute file name, and neither is the backslash
15088 normally considered a directory separator character. In that case,
15089 the native file system would interpret this whole absolute file name
15090 as a relative file name with no directory components. This would make
15091 it impossible to point @value{GDBN} at a copy of the remote target's
15092 shared libraries on the host using @code{set sysroot}, and impractical
15093 with @code{set solib-search-path}. Setting
15094 @code{target-file-system-kind} to @code{dos-based} tells @value{GDBN}
15095 to interpret such file names similarly to how the target would, and to
15096 map them to file names valid on @value{GDBN}'s native file system
15097 semantics. The value of @var{kind} can be @code{"auto"}, in addition
15098 to one of the supported file system kinds. In that case, @value{GDBN}
15099 tries to determine the appropriate file system variant based on the
15100 current target's operating system (@pxref{ABI, ,Configuring the
15101 Current ABI}). The supported file system settings are:
15102
15103 @table @code
15104 @item unix
15105 Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target file system is of Unix
15106 kind. Only file names starting the forward slash (@samp{/}) character
15107 are considered absolute, and the directory separator character is also
15108 the forward slash.
15109
15110 @item dos-based
15111 Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target file system is DOS based.
15112 File names starting with either a forward slash, or a drive letter
15113 followed by a colon (e.g., @samp{c:}), are considered absolute, and
15114 both the slash (@samp{/}) and the backslash (@samp{\\}) characters are
15115 considered directory separators.
15116
15117 @item auto
15118 Instruct @value{GDBN} to use the file system kind associated with the
15119 target operating system (@pxref{ABI, ,Configuring the Current ABI}).
15120 This is the default.
15121 @end table
15122 @end table
15123
15124
15125 @node Separate Debug Files
15126 @section Debugging Information in Separate Files
15127 @cindex separate debugging information files
15128 @cindex debugging information in separate files
15129 @cindex @file{.debug} subdirectories
15130 @cindex debugging information directory, global
15131 @cindex global debugging information directory
15132 @cindex build ID, and separate debugging files
15133 @cindex @file{.build-id} directory
15134
15135 @value{GDBN} allows you to put a program's debugging information in a
15136 file separate from the executable itself, in a way that allows
15137 @value{GDBN} to find and load the debugging information automatically.
15138 Since debugging information can be very large---sometimes larger
15139 than the executable code itself---some systems distribute debugging
15140 information for their executables in separate files, which users can
15141 install only when they need to debug a problem.
15142
15143 @value{GDBN} supports two ways of specifying the separate debug info
15144 file:
15145
15146 @itemize @bullet
15147 @item
15148 The executable contains a @dfn{debug link} that specifies the name of
15149 the separate debug info file. The separate debug file's name is
15150 usually @file{@var{executable}.debug}, where @var{executable} is the
15151 name of the corresponding executable file without leading directories
15152 (e.g., @file{ls.debug} for @file{/usr/bin/ls}). In addition, the
15153 debug link specifies a 32-bit @dfn{Cyclic Redundancy Check} (CRC)
15154 checksum for the debug file, which @value{GDBN} uses to validate that
15155 the executable and the debug file came from the same build.
15156
15157 @item
15158 The executable contains a @dfn{build ID}, a unique bit string that is
15159 also present in the corresponding debug info file. (This is supported
15160 only on some operating systems, notably those which use the ELF format
15161 for binary files and the @sc{gnu} Binutils.) For more details about
15162 this feature, see the description of the @option{--build-id}
15163 command-line option in @ref{Options, , Command Line Options, ld.info,
15164 The GNU Linker}. The debug info file's name is not specified
15165 explicitly by the build ID, but can be computed from the build ID, see
15166 below.
15167 @end itemize
15168
15169 Depending on the way the debug info file is specified, @value{GDBN}
15170 uses two different methods of looking for the debug file:
15171
15172 @itemize @bullet
15173 @item
15174 For the ``debug link'' method, @value{GDBN} looks up the named file in
15175 the directory of the executable file, then in a subdirectory of that
15176 directory named @file{.debug}, and finally under the global debug
15177 directory, in a subdirectory whose name is identical to the leading
15178 directories of the executable's absolute file name.
15179
15180 @item
15181 For the ``build ID'' method, @value{GDBN} looks in the
15182 @file{.build-id} subdirectory of the global debug directory for a file
15183 named @file{@var{nn}/@var{nnnnnnnn}.debug}, where @var{nn} are the
15184 first 2 hex characters of the build ID bit string, and @var{nnnnnnnn}
15185 are the rest of the bit string. (Real build ID strings are 32 or more
15186 hex characters, not 10.)
15187 @end itemize
15188
15189 So, for example, suppose you ask @value{GDBN} to debug
15190 @file{/usr/bin/ls}, which has a debug link that specifies the
15191 file @file{ls.debug}, and a build ID whose value in hex is
15192 @code{abcdef1234}. If the global debug directory is
15193 @file{/usr/lib/debug}, then @value{GDBN} will look for the following
15194 debug information files, in the indicated order:
15195
15196 @itemize @minus
15197 @item
15198 @file{/usr/lib/debug/.build-id/ab/cdef1234.debug}
15199 @item
15200 @file{/usr/bin/ls.debug}
15201 @item
15202 @file{/usr/bin/.debug/ls.debug}
15203 @item
15204 @file{/usr/lib/debug/usr/bin/ls.debug}.
15205 @end itemize
15206
15207 You can set the global debugging info directory's name, and view the
15208 name @value{GDBN} is currently using.
15209
15210 @table @code
15211
15212 @kindex set debug-file-directory
15213 @item set debug-file-directory @var{directories}
15214 Set the directories which @value{GDBN} searches for separate debugging
15215 information files to @var{directory}. Multiple directory components can be set
15216 concatenating them by a directory separator.
15217
15218 @kindex show debug-file-directory
15219 @item show debug-file-directory
15220 Show the directories @value{GDBN} searches for separate debugging
15221 information files.
15222
15223 @end table
15224
15225 @cindex @code{.gnu_debuglink} sections
15226 @cindex debug link sections
15227 A debug link is a special section of the executable file named
15228 @code{.gnu_debuglink}. The section must contain:
15229
15230 @itemize
15231 @item
15232 A filename, with any leading directory components removed, followed by
15233 a zero byte,
15234 @item
15235 zero to three bytes of padding, as needed to reach the next four-byte
15236 boundary within the section, and
15237 @item
15238 a four-byte CRC checksum, stored in the same endianness used for the
15239 executable file itself. The checksum is computed on the debugging
15240 information file's full contents by the function given below, passing
15241 zero as the @var{crc} argument.
15242 @end itemize
15243
15244 Any executable file format can carry a debug link, as long as it can
15245 contain a section named @code{.gnu_debuglink} with the contents
15246 described above.
15247
15248 @cindex @code{.note.gnu.build-id} sections
15249 @cindex build ID sections
15250 The build ID is a special section in the executable file (and in other
15251 ELF binary files that @value{GDBN} may consider). This section is
15252 often named @code{.note.gnu.build-id}, but that name is not mandatory.
15253 It contains unique identification for the built files---the ID remains
15254 the same across multiple builds of the same build tree. The default
15255 algorithm SHA1 produces 160 bits (40 hexadecimal characters) of the
15256 content for the build ID string. The same section with an identical
15257 value is present in the original built binary with symbols, in its
15258 stripped variant, and in the separate debugging information file.
15259
15260 The debugging information file itself should be an ordinary
15261 executable, containing a full set of linker symbols, sections, and
15262 debugging information. The sections of the debugging information file
15263 should have the same names, addresses, and sizes as the original file,
15264 but they need not contain any data---much like a @code{.bss} section
15265 in an ordinary executable.
15266
15267 The @sc{gnu} binary utilities (Binutils) package includes the
15268 @samp{objcopy} utility that can produce
15269 the separated executable / debugging information file pairs using the
15270 following commands:
15271
15272 @smallexample
15273 @kbd{objcopy --only-keep-debug foo foo.debug}
15274 @kbd{strip -g foo}
15275 @end smallexample
15276
15277 @noindent
15278 These commands remove the debugging
15279 information from the executable file @file{foo} and place it in the file
15280 @file{foo.debug}. You can use the first, second or both methods to link the
15281 two files:
15282
15283 @itemize @bullet
15284 @item
15285 The debug link method needs the following additional command to also leave
15286 behind a debug link in @file{foo}:
15287
15288 @smallexample
15289 @kbd{objcopy --add-gnu-debuglink=foo.debug foo}
15290 @end smallexample
15291
15292 Ulrich Drepper's @file{elfutils} package, starting with version 0.53, contains
15293 a version of the @code{strip} command such that the command @kbd{strip foo -f
15294 foo.debug} has the same functionality as the two @code{objcopy} commands and
15295 the @code{ln -s} command above, together.
15296
15297 @item
15298 Build ID gets embedded into the main executable using @code{ld --build-id} or
15299 the @value{NGCC} counterpart @code{gcc -Wl,--build-id}. Build ID support plus
15300 compatibility fixes for debug files separation are present in @sc{gnu} binary
15301 utilities (Binutils) package since version 2.18.
15302 @end itemize
15303
15304 @noindent
15305
15306 @cindex CRC algorithm definition
15307 The CRC used in @code{.gnu_debuglink} is the CRC-32 defined in
15308 IEEE 802.3 using the polynomial:
15309
15310 @c TexInfo requires naked braces for multi-digit exponents for Tex
15311 @c output, but this causes HTML output to barf. HTML has to be set using
15312 @c raw commands. So we end up having to specify this equation in 2
15313 @c different ways!
15314 @ifhtml
15315 @display
15316 @html
15317 <em>x</em><sup>32</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>26</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>23</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>22</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>16</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>12</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>11</sup>
15318 + <em>x</em><sup>10</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>8</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>7</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>5</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>4</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>2</sup> + <em>x</em> + 1
15319 @end html
15320 @end display
15321 @end ifhtml
15322 @ifnothtml
15323 @display
15324 @math{x^{32} + x^{26} + x^{23} + x^{22} + x^{16} + x^{12} + x^{11}}
15325 @math{+ x^{10} + x^8 + x^7 + x^5 + x^4 + x^2 + x + 1}
15326 @end display
15327 @end ifnothtml
15328
15329 The function is computed byte at a time, taking the least
15330 significant bit of each byte first. The initial pattern
15331 @code{0xffffffff} is used, to ensure leading zeros affect the CRC and
15332 the final result is inverted to ensure trailing zeros also affect the
15333 CRC.
15334
15335 @emph{Note:} This is the same CRC polynomial as used in handling the
15336 @dfn{Remote Serial Protocol} @code{qCRC} packet (@pxref{Remote Protocol,
15337 , @value{GDBN} Remote Serial Protocol}). However in the
15338 case of the Remote Serial Protocol, the CRC is computed @emph{most}
15339 significant bit first, and the result is not inverted, so trailing
15340 zeros have no effect on the CRC value.
15341
15342 To complete the description, we show below the code of the function
15343 which produces the CRC used in @code{.gnu_debuglink}. Inverting the
15344 initially supplied @code{crc} argument means that an initial call to
15345 this function passing in zero will start computing the CRC using
15346 @code{0xffffffff}.
15347
15348 @kindex gnu_debuglink_crc32
15349 @smallexample
15350 unsigned long
15351 gnu_debuglink_crc32 (unsigned long crc,
15352 unsigned char *buf, size_t len)
15353 @{
15354 static const unsigned long crc32_table[256] =
15355 @{
15356 0x00000000, 0x77073096, 0xee0e612c, 0x990951ba, 0x076dc419,
15357 0x706af48f, 0xe963a535, 0x9e6495a3, 0x0edb8832, 0x79dcb8a4,
15358 0xe0d5e91e, 0x97d2d988, 0x09b64c2b, 0x7eb17cbd, 0xe7b82d07,
15359 0x90bf1d91, 0x1db71064, 0x6ab020f2, 0xf3b97148, 0x84be41de,
15360 0x1adad47d, 0x6ddde4eb, 0xf4d4b551, 0x83d385c7, 0x136c9856,
15361 0x646ba8c0, 0xfd62f97a, 0x8a65c9ec, 0x14015c4f, 0x63066cd9,
15362 0xfa0f3d63, 0x8d080df5, 0x3b6e20c8, 0x4c69105e, 0xd56041e4,
15363 0xa2677172, 0x3c03e4d1, 0x4b04d447, 0xd20d85fd, 0xa50ab56b,
15364 0x35b5a8fa, 0x42b2986c, 0xdbbbc9d6, 0xacbcf940, 0x32d86ce3,
15365 0x45df5c75, 0xdcd60dcf, 0xabd13d59, 0x26d930ac, 0x51de003a,
15366 0xc8d75180, 0xbfd06116, 0x21b4f4b5, 0x56b3c423, 0xcfba9599,
15367 0xb8bda50f, 0x2802b89e, 0x5f058808, 0xc60cd9b2, 0xb10be924,
15368 0x2f6f7c87, 0x58684c11, 0xc1611dab, 0xb6662d3d, 0x76dc4190,
15369 0x01db7106, 0x98d220bc, 0xefd5102a, 0x71b18589, 0x06b6b51f,
15370 0x9fbfe4a5, 0xe8b8d433, 0x7807c9a2, 0x0f00f934, 0x9609a88e,
15371 0xe10e9818, 0x7f6a0dbb, 0x086d3d2d, 0x91646c97, 0xe6635c01,
15372 0x6b6b51f4, 0x1c6c6162, 0x856530d8, 0xf262004e, 0x6c0695ed,
15373 0x1b01a57b, 0x8208f4c1, 0xf50fc457, 0x65b0d9c6, 0x12b7e950,
15374 0x8bbeb8ea, 0xfcb9887c, 0x62dd1ddf, 0x15da2d49, 0x8cd37cf3,
15375 0xfbd44c65, 0x4db26158, 0x3ab551ce, 0xa3bc0074, 0xd4bb30e2,
15376 0x4adfa541, 0x3dd895d7, 0xa4d1c46d, 0xd3d6f4fb, 0x4369e96a,
15377 0x346ed9fc, 0xad678846, 0xda60b8d0, 0x44042d73, 0x33031de5,
15378 0xaa0a4c5f, 0xdd0d7cc9, 0x5005713c, 0x270241aa, 0xbe0b1010,
15379 0xc90c2086, 0x5768b525, 0x206f85b3, 0xb966d409, 0xce61e49f,
15380 0x5edef90e, 0x29d9c998, 0xb0d09822, 0xc7d7a8b4, 0x59b33d17,
15381 0x2eb40d81, 0xb7bd5c3b, 0xc0ba6cad, 0xedb88320, 0x9abfb3b6,
15382 0x03b6e20c, 0x74b1d29a, 0xead54739, 0x9dd277af, 0x04db2615,
15383 0x73dc1683, 0xe3630b12, 0x94643b84, 0x0d6d6a3e, 0x7a6a5aa8,
15384 0xe40ecf0b, 0x9309ff9d, 0x0a00ae27, 0x7d079eb1, 0xf00f9344,
15385 0x8708a3d2, 0x1e01f268, 0x6906c2fe, 0xf762575d, 0x806567cb,
15386 0x196c3671, 0x6e6b06e7, 0xfed41b76, 0x89d32be0, 0x10da7a5a,
15387 0x67dd4acc, 0xf9b9df6f, 0x8ebeeff9, 0x17b7be43, 0x60b08ed5,
15388 0xd6d6a3e8, 0xa1d1937e, 0x38d8c2c4, 0x4fdff252, 0xd1bb67f1,
15389 0xa6bc5767, 0x3fb506dd, 0x48b2364b, 0xd80d2bda, 0xaf0a1b4c,
15390 0x36034af6, 0x41047a60, 0xdf60efc3, 0xa867df55, 0x316e8eef,
15391 0x4669be79, 0xcb61b38c, 0xbc66831a, 0x256fd2a0, 0x5268e236,
15392 0xcc0c7795, 0xbb0b4703, 0x220216b9, 0x5505262f, 0xc5ba3bbe,
15393 0xb2bd0b28, 0x2bb45a92, 0x5cb36a04, 0xc2d7ffa7, 0xb5d0cf31,
15394 0x2cd99e8b, 0x5bdeae1d, 0x9b64c2b0, 0xec63f226, 0x756aa39c,
15395 0x026d930a, 0x9c0906a9, 0xeb0e363f, 0x72076785, 0x05005713,
15396 0x95bf4a82, 0xe2b87a14, 0x7bb12bae, 0x0cb61b38, 0x92d28e9b,
15397 0xe5d5be0d, 0x7cdcefb7, 0x0bdbdf21, 0x86d3d2d4, 0xf1d4e242,
15398 0x68ddb3f8, 0x1fda836e, 0x81be16cd, 0xf6b9265b, 0x6fb077e1,
15399 0x18b74777, 0x88085ae6, 0xff0f6a70, 0x66063bca, 0x11010b5c,
15400 0x8f659eff, 0xf862ae69, 0x616bffd3, 0x166ccf45, 0xa00ae278,
15401 0xd70dd2ee, 0x4e048354, 0x3903b3c2, 0xa7672661, 0xd06016f7,
15402 0x4969474d, 0x3e6e77db, 0xaed16a4a, 0xd9d65adc, 0x40df0b66,
15403 0x37d83bf0, 0xa9bcae53, 0xdebb9ec5, 0x47b2cf7f, 0x30b5ffe9,
15404 0xbdbdf21c, 0xcabac28a, 0x53b39330, 0x24b4a3a6, 0xbad03605,
15405 0xcdd70693, 0x54de5729, 0x23d967bf, 0xb3667a2e, 0xc4614ab8,
15406 0x5d681b02, 0x2a6f2b94, 0xb40bbe37, 0xc30c8ea1, 0x5a05df1b,
15407 0x2d02ef8d
15408 @};
15409 unsigned char *end;
15410
15411 crc = ~crc & 0xffffffff;
15412 for (end = buf + len; buf < end; ++buf)
15413 crc = crc32_table[(crc ^ *buf) & 0xff] ^ (crc >> 8);
15414 return ~crc & 0xffffffff;
15415 @}
15416 @end smallexample
15417
15418 @noindent
15419 This computation does not apply to the ``build ID'' method.
15420
15421
15422 @node Index Files
15423 @section Index Files Speed Up @value{GDBN}
15424 @cindex index files
15425 @cindex @samp{.gdb_index} section
15426
15427 When @value{GDBN} finds a symbol file, it scans the symbols in the
15428 file in order to construct an internal symbol table. This lets most
15429 @value{GDBN} operations work quickly---at the cost of a delay early
15430 on. For large programs, this delay can be quite lengthy, so
15431 @value{GDBN} provides a way to build an index, which speeds up
15432 startup.
15433
15434 The index is stored as a section in the symbol file. @value{GDBN} can
15435 write the index to a file, then you can put it into the symbol file
15436 using @command{objcopy}.
15437
15438 To create an index file, use the @code{save gdb-index} command:
15439
15440 @table @code
15441 @item save gdb-index @var{directory}
15442 @kindex save gdb-index
15443 Create an index file for each symbol file currently known by
15444 @value{GDBN}. Each file is named after its corresponding symbol file,
15445 with @samp{.gdb-index} appended, and is written into the given
15446 @var{directory}.
15447 @end table
15448
15449 Once you have created an index file you can merge it into your symbol
15450 file, here named @file{symfile}, using @command{objcopy}:
15451
15452 @smallexample
15453 $ objcopy --add-section .gdb_index=symfile.gdb-index \
15454 --set-section-flags .gdb_index=readonly symfile symfile
15455 @end smallexample
15456
15457 There are currently some limitation on indices. They only work when
15458 for DWARF debugging information, not stabs. And, they do not
15459 currently work for programs using Ada.
15460
15461 @node Symbol Errors
15462 @section Errors Reading Symbol Files
15463
15464 While reading a symbol file, @value{GDBN} occasionally encounters problems,
15465 such as symbol types it does not recognize, or known bugs in compiler
15466 output. By default, @value{GDBN} does not notify you of such problems, since
15467 they are relatively common and primarily of interest to people
15468 debugging compilers. If you are interested in seeing information
15469 about ill-constructed symbol tables, you can either ask @value{GDBN} to print
15470 only one message about each such type of problem, no matter how many
15471 times the problem occurs; or you can ask @value{GDBN} to print more messages,
15472 to see how many times the problems occur, with the @code{set
15473 complaints} command (@pxref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional Warnings and
15474 Messages}).
15475
15476 The messages currently printed, and their meanings, include:
15477
15478 @table @code
15479 @item inner block not inside outer block in @var{symbol}
15480
15481 The symbol information shows where symbol scopes begin and end
15482 (such as at the start of a function or a block of statements). This
15483 error indicates that an inner scope block is not fully contained
15484 in its outer scope blocks.
15485
15486 @value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by treating the inner block as if it had
15487 the same scope as the outer block. In the error message, @var{symbol}
15488 may be shown as ``@code{(don't know)}'' if the outer block is not a
15489 function.
15490
15491 @item block at @var{address} out of order
15492
15493 The symbol information for symbol scope blocks should occur in
15494 order of increasing addresses. This error indicates that it does not
15495 do so.
15496
15497 @value{GDBN} does not circumvent this problem, and has trouble
15498 locating symbols in the source file whose symbols it is reading. (You
15499 can often determine what source file is affected by specifying
15500 @code{set verbose on}. @xref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional Warnings and
15501 Messages}.)
15502
15503 @item bad block start address patched
15504
15505 The symbol information for a symbol scope block has a start address
15506 smaller than the address of the preceding source line. This is known
15507 to occur in the SunOS 4.1.1 (and earlier) C compiler.
15508
15509 @value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by treating the symbol scope block as
15510 starting on the previous source line.
15511
15512 @item bad string table offset in symbol @var{n}
15513
15514 @cindex foo
15515 Symbol number @var{n} contains a pointer into the string table which is
15516 larger than the size of the string table.
15517
15518 @value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by considering the symbol to have the
15519 name @code{foo}, which may cause other problems if many symbols end up
15520 with this name.
15521
15522 @item unknown symbol type @code{0x@var{nn}}
15523
15524 The symbol information contains new data types that @value{GDBN} does
15525 not yet know how to read. @code{0x@var{nn}} is the symbol type of the
15526 uncomprehended information, in hexadecimal.
15527
15528 @value{GDBN} circumvents the error by ignoring this symbol information.
15529 This usually allows you to debug your program, though certain symbols
15530 are not accessible. If you encounter such a problem and feel like
15531 debugging it, you can debug @code{@value{GDBP}} with itself, breakpoint
15532 on @code{complain}, then go up to the function @code{read_dbx_symtab}
15533 and examine @code{*bufp} to see the symbol.
15534
15535 @item stub type has NULL name
15536
15537 @value{GDBN} could not find the full definition for a struct or class.
15538
15539 @item const/volatile indicator missing (ok if using g++ v1.x), got@dots{}
15540 The symbol information for a C@t{++} member function is missing some
15541 information that recent versions of the compiler should have output for
15542 it.
15543
15544 @item info mismatch between compiler and debugger
15545
15546 @value{GDBN} could not parse a type specification output by the compiler.
15547
15548 @end table
15549
15550 @node Data Files
15551 @section GDB Data Files
15552
15553 @cindex prefix for data files
15554 @value{GDBN} will sometimes read an auxiliary data file. These files
15555 are kept in a directory known as the @dfn{data directory}.
15556
15557 You can set the data directory's name, and view the name @value{GDBN}
15558 is currently using.
15559
15560 @table @code
15561 @kindex set data-directory
15562 @item set data-directory @var{directory}
15563 Set the directory which @value{GDBN} searches for auxiliary data files
15564 to @var{directory}.
15565
15566 @kindex show data-directory
15567 @item show data-directory
15568 Show the directory @value{GDBN} searches for auxiliary data files.
15569 @end table
15570
15571 @cindex default data directory
15572 @cindex @samp{--with-gdb-datadir}
15573 You can set the default data directory by using the configure-time
15574 @samp{--with-gdb-datadir} option. If the data directory is inside
15575 @value{GDBN}'s configured binary prefix (set with @samp{--prefix} or
15576 @samp{--exec-prefix}), then the default data directory will be updated
15577 automatically if the installed @value{GDBN} is moved to a new
15578 location.
15579
15580 The data directory may also be specified with the
15581 @code{--data-directory} command line option.
15582 @xref{Mode Options}.
15583
15584 @node Targets
15585 @chapter Specifying a Debugging Target
15586
15587 @cindex debugging target
15588 A @dfn{target} is the execution environment occupied by your program.
15589
15590 Often, @value{GDBN} runs in the same host environment as your program;
15591 in that case, the debugging target is specified as a side effect when
15592 you use the @code{file} or @code{core} commands. When you need more
15593 flexibility---for example, running @value{GDBN} on a physically separate
15594 host, or controlling a standalone system over a serial port or a
15595 realtime system over a TCP/IP connection---you can use the @code{target}
15596 command to specify one of the target types configured for @value{GDBN}
15597 (@pxref{Target Commands, ,Commands for Managing Targets}).
15598
15599 @cindex target architecture
15600 It is possible to build @value{GDBN} for several different @dfn{target
15601 architectures}. When @value{GDBN} is built like that, you can choose
15602 one of the available architectures with the @kbd{set architecture}
15603 command.
15604
15605 @table @code
15606 @kindex set architecture
15607 @kindex show architecture
15608 @item set architecture @var{arch}
15609 This command sets the current target architecture to @var{arch}. The
15610 value of @var{arch} can be @code{"auto"}, in addition to one of the
15611 supported architectures.
15612
15613 @item show architecture
15614 Show the current target architecture.
15615
15616 @item set processor
15617 @itemx processor
15618 @kindex set processor
15619 @kindex show processor
15620 These are alias commands for, respectively, @code{set architecture}
15621 and @code{show architecture}.
15622 @end table
15623
15624 @menu
15625 * Active Targets:: Active targets
15626 * Target Commands:: Commands for managing targets
15627 * Byte Order:: Choosing target byte order
15628 @end menu
15629
15630 @node Active Targets
15631 @section Active Targets
15632
15633 @cindex stacking targets
15634 @cindex active targets
15635 @cindex multiple targets
15636
15637 There are multiple classes of targets such as: processes, executable files or
15638 recording sessions. Core files belong to the process class, making core file
15639 and process mutually exclusive. Otherwise, @value{GDBN} can work concurrently
15640 on multiple active targets, one in each class. This allows you to (for
15641 example) start a process and inspect its activity, while still having access to
15642 the executable file after the process finishes. Or if you start process
15643 recording (@pxref{Reverse Execution}) and @code{reverse-step} there, you are
15644 presented a virtual layer of the recording target, while the process target
15645 remains stopped at the chronologically last point of the process execution.
15646
15647 Use the @code{core-file} and @code{exec-file} commands to select a new core
15648 file or executable target (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}). To
15649 specify as a target a process that is already running, use the @code{attach}
15650 command (@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an Already-running Process}).
15651
15652 @node Target Commands
15653 @section Commands for Managing Targets
15654
15655 @table @code
15656 @item target @var{type} @var{parameters}
15657 Connects the @value{GDBN} host environment to a target machine or
15658 process. A target is typically a protocol for talking to debugging
15659 facilities. You use the argument @var{type} to specify the type or
15660 protocol of the target machine.
15661
15662 Further @var{parameters} are interpreted by the target protocol, but
15663 typically include things like device names or host names to connect
15664 with, process numbers, and baud rates.
15665
15666 The @code{target} command does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again
15667 after executing the command.
15668
15669 @kindex help target
15670 @item help target
15671 Displays the names of all targets available. To display targets
15672 currently selected, use either @code{info target} or @code{info files}
15673 (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}).
15674
15675 @item help target @var{name}
15676 Describe a particular target, including any parameters necessary to
15677 select it.
15678
15679 @kindex set gnutarget
15680 @item set gnutarget @var{args}
15681 @value{GDBN} uses its own library BFD to read your files. @value{GDBN}
15682 knows whether it is reading an @dfn{executable},
15683 a @dfn{core}, or a @dfn{.o} file; however, you can specify the file format
15684 with the @code{set gnutarget} command. Unlike most @code{target} commands,
15685 with @code{gnutarget} the @code{target} refers to a program, not a machine.
15686
15687 @quotation
15688 @emph{Warning:} To specify a file format with @code{set gnutarget},
15689 you must know the actual BFD name.
15690 @end quotation
15691
15692 @noindent
15693 @xref{Files, , Commands to Specify Files}.
15694
15695 @kindex show gnutarget
15696 @item show gnutarget
15697 Use the @code{show gnutarget} command to display what file format
15698 @code{gnutarget} is set to read. If you have not set @code{gnutarget},
15699 @value{GDBN} will determine the file format for each file automatically,
15700 and @code{show gnutarget} displays @samp{The current BDF target is "auto"}.
15701 @end table
15702
15703 @cindex common targets
15704 Here are some common targets (available, or not, depending on the GDB
15705 configuration):
15706
15707 @table @code
15708 @kindex target
15709 @item target exec @var{program}
15710 @cindex executable file target
15711 An executable file. @samp{target exec @var{program}} is the same as
15712 @samp{exec-file @var{program}}.
15713
15714 @item target core @var{filename}
15715 @cindex core dump file target
15716 A core dump file. @samp{target core @var{filename}} is the same as
15717 @samp{core-file @var{filename}}.
15718
15719 @item target remote @var{medium}
15720 @cindex remote target
15721 A remote system connected to @value{GDBN} via a serial line or network
15722 connection. This command tells @value{GDBN} to use its own remote
15723 protocol over @var{medium} for debugging. @xref{Remote Debugging}.
15724
15725 For example, if you have a board connected to @file{/dev/ttya} on the
15726 machine running @value{GDBN}, you could say:
15727
15728 @smallexample
15729 target remote /dev/ttya
15730 @end smallexample
15731
15732 @code{target remote} supports the @code{load} command. This is only
15733 useful if you have some other way of getting the stub to the target
15734 system, and you can put it somewhere in memory where it won't get
15735 clobbered by the download.
15736
15737 @item target sim @r{[}@var{simargs}@r{]} @dots{}
15738 @cindex built-in simulator target
15739 Builtin CPU simulator. @value{GDBN} includes simulators for most architectures.
15740 In general,
15741 @smallexample
15742 target sim
15743 load
15744 run
15745 @end smallexample
15746 @noindent
15747 works; however, you cannot assume that a specific memory map, device
15748 drivers, or even basic I/O is available, although some simulators do
15749 provide these. For info about any processor-specific simulator details,
15750 see the appropriate section in @ref{Embedded Processors, ,Embedded
15751 Processors}.
15752
15753 @end table
15754
15755 Some configurations may include these targets as well:
15756
15757 @table @code
15758
15759 @item target nrom @var{dev}
15760 @cindex NetROM ROM emulator target
15761 NetROM ROM emulator. This target only supports downloading.
15762
15763 @end table
15764
15765 Different targets are available on different configurations of @value{GDBN};
15766 your configuration may have more or fewer targets.
15767
15768 Many remote targets require you to download the executable's code once
15769 you've successfully established a connection. You may wish to control
15770 various aspects of this process.
15771
15772 @table @code
15773
15774 @item set hash
15775 @kindex set hash@r{, for remote monitors}
15776 @cindex hash mark while downloading
15777 This command controls whether a hash mark @samp{#} is displayed while
15778 downloading a file to the remote monitor. If on, a hash mark is
15779 displayed after each S-record is successfully downloaded to the
15780 monitor.
15781
15782 @item show hash
15783 @kindex show hash@r{, for remote monitors}
15784 Show the current status of displaying the hash mark.
15785
15786 @item set debug monitor
15787 @kindex set debug monitor
15788 @cindex display remote monitor communications
15789 Enable or disable display of communications messages between
15790 @value{GDBN} and the remote monitor.
15791
15792 @item show debug monitor
15793 @kindex show debug monitor
15794 Show the current status of displaying communications between
15795 @value{GDBN} and the remote monitor.
15796 @end table
15797
15798 @table @code
15799
15800 @kindex load @var{filename}
15801 @item load @var{filename}
15802 @anchor{load}
15803 Depending on what remote debugging facilities are configured into
15804 @value{GDBN}, the @code{load} command may be available. Where it exists, it
15805 is meant to make @var{filename} (an executable) available for debugging
15806 on the remote system---by downloading, or dynamic linking, for example.
15807 @code{load} also records the @var{filename} symbol table in @value{GDBN}, like
15808 the @code{add-symbol-file} command.
15809
15810 If your @value{GDBN} does not have a @code{load} command, attempting to
15811 execute it gets the error message ``@code{You can't do that when your
15812 target is @dots{}}''
15813
15814 The file is loaded at whatever address is specified in the executable.
15815 For some object file formats, you can specify the load address when you
15816 link the program; for other formats, like a.out, the object file format
15817 specifies a fixed address.
15818 @c FIXME! This would be a good place for an xref to the GNU linker doc.
15819
15820 Depending on the remote side capabilities, @value{GDBN} may be able to
15821 load programs into flash memory.
15822
15823 @code{load} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after using it.
15824 @end table
15825
15826 @node Byte Order
15827 @section Choosing Target Byte Order
15828
15829 @cindex choosing target byte order
15830 @cindex target byte order
15831
15832 Some types of processors, such as the MIPS, PowerPC, and Renesas SH,
15833 offer the ability to run either big-endian or little-endian byte
15834 orders. Usually the executable or symbol will include a bit to
15835 designate the endian-ness, and you will not need to worry about
15836 which to use. However, you may still find it useful to adjust
15837 @value{GDBN}'s idea of processor endian-ness manually.
15838
15839 @table @code
15840 @kindex set endian
15841 @item set endian big
15842 Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target is big-endian.
15843
15844 @item set endian little
15845 Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target is little-endian.
15846
15847 @item set endian auto
15848 Instruct @value{GDBN} to use the byte order associated with the
15849 executable.
15850
15851 @item show endian
15852 Display @value{GDBN}'s current idea of the target byte order.
15853
15854 @end table
15855
15856 Note that these commands merely adjust interpretation of symbolic
15857 data on the host, and that they have absolutely no effect on the
15858 target system.
15859
15860
15861 @node Remote Debugging
15862 @chapter Debugging Remote Programs
15863 @cindex remote debugging
15864
15865 If you are trying to debug a program running on a machine that cannot run
15866 @value{GDBN} in the usual way, it is often useful to use remote debugging.
15867 For example, you might use remote debugging on an operating system kernel,
15868 or on a small system which does not have a general purpose operating system
15869 powerful enough to run a full-featured debugger.
15870
15871 Some configurations of @value{GDBN} have special serial or TCP/IP interfaces
15872 to make this work with particular debugging targets. In addition,
15873 @value{GDBN} comes with a generic serial protocol (specific to @value{GDBN},
15874 but not specific to any particular target system) which you can use if you
15875 write the remote stubs---the code that runs on the remote system to
15876 communicate with @value{GDBN}.
15877
15878 Other remote targets may be available in your
15879 configuration of @value{GDBN}; use @code{help target} to list them.
15880
15881 @menu
15882 * Connecting:: Connecting to a remote target
15883 * File Transfer:: Sending files to a remote system
15884 * Server:: Using the gdbserver program
15885 * Remote Configuration:: Remote configuration
15886 * Remote Stub:: Implementing a remote stub
15887 @end menu
15888
15889 @node Connecting
15890 @section Connecting to a Remote Target
15891
15892 On the @value{GDBN} host machine, you will need an unstripped copy of
15893 your program, since @value{GDBN} needs symbol and debugging information.
15894 Start up @value{GDBN} as usual, using the name of the local copy of your
15895 program as the first argument.
15896
15897 @cindex @code{target remote}
15898 @value{GDBN} can communicate with the target over a serial line, or
15899 over an @acronym{IP} network using @acronym{TCP} or @acronym{UDP}. In
15900 each case, @value{GDBN} uses the same protocol for debugging your
15901 program; only the medium carrying the debugging packets varies. The
15902 @code{target remote} command establishes a connection to the target.
15903 Its arguments indicate which medium to use:
15904
15905 @table @code
15906
15907 @item target remote @var{serial-device}
15908 @cindex serial line, @code{target remote}
15909 Use @var{serial-device} to communicate with the target. For example,
15910 to use a serial line connected to the device named @file{/dev/ttyb}:
15911
15912 @smallexample
15913 target remote /dev/ttyb
15914 @end smallexample
15915
15916 If you're using a serial line, you may want to give @value{GDBN} the
15917 @w{@samp{--baud}} option, or use the @code{set remotebaud} command
15918 (@pxref{Remote Configuration, set remotebaud}) before the
15919 @code{target} command.
15920
15921 @item target remote @code{@var{host}:@var{port}}
15922 @itemx target remote @code{tcp:@var{host}:@var{port}}
15923 @cindex @acronym{TCP} port, @code{target remote}
15924 Debug using a @acronym{TCP} connection to @var{port} on @var{host}.
15925 The @var{host} may be either a host name or a numeric @acronym{IP}
15926 address; @var{port} must be a decimal number. The @var{host} could be
15927 the target machine itself, if it is directly connected to the net, or
15928 it might be a terminal server which in turn has a serial line to the
15929 target.
15930
15931 For example, to connect to port 2828 on a terminal server named
15932 @code{manyfarms}:
15933
15934 @smallexample
15935 target remote manyfarms:2828
15936 @end smallexample
15937
15938 If your remote target is actually running on the same machine as your
15939 debugger session (e.g.@: a simulator for your target running on the
15940 same host), you can omit the hostname. For example, to connect to
15941 port 1234 on your local machine:
15942
15943 @smallexample
15944 target remote :1234
15945 @end smallexample
15946 @noindent
15947
15948 Note that the colon is still required here.
15949
15950 @item target remote @code{udp:@var{host}:@var{port}}
15951 @cindex @acronym{UDP} port, @code{target remote}
15952 Debug using @acronym{UDP} packets to @var{port} on @var{host}. For example, to
15953 connect to @acronym{UDP} port 2828 on a terminal server named @code{manyfarms}:
15954
15955 @smallexample
15956 target remote udp:manyfarms:2828
15957 @end smallexample
15958
15959 When using a @acronym{UDP} connection for remote debugging, you should
15960 keep in mind that the `U' stands for ``Unreliable''. @acronym{UDP}
15961 can silently drop packets on busy or unreliable networks, which will
15962 cause havoc with your debugging session.
15963
15964 @item target remote | @var{command}
15965 @cindex pipe, @code{target remote} to
15966 Run @var{command} in the background and communicate with it using a
15967 pipe. The @var{command} is a shell command, to be parsed and expanded
15968 by the system's command shell, @code{/bin/sh}; it should expect remote
15969 protocol packets on its standard input, and send replies on its
15970 standard output. You could use this to run a stand-alone simulator
15971 that speaks the remote debugging protocol, to make net connections
15972 using programs like @code{ssh}, or for other similar tricks.
15973
15974 If @var{command} closes its standard output (perhaps by exiting),
15975 @value{GDBN} will try to send it a @code{SIGTERM} signal. (If the
15976 program has already exited, this will have no effect.)
15977
15978 @end table
15979
15980 Once the connection has been established, you can use all the usual
15981 commands to examine and change data. The remote program is already
15982 running; you can use @kbd{step} and @kbd{continue}, and you do not
15983 need to use @kbd{run}.
15984
15985 @cindex interrupting remote programs
15986 @cindex remote programs, interrupting
15987 Whenever @value{GDBN} is waiting for the remote program, if you type the
15988 interrupt character (often @kbd{Ctrl-c}), @value{GDBN} attempts to stop the
15989 program. This may or may not succeed, depending in part on the hardware
15990 and the serial drivers the remote system uses. If you type the
15991 interrupt character once again, @value{GDBN} displays this prompt:
15992
15993 @smallexample
15994 Interrupted while waiting for the program.
15995 Give up (and stop debugging it)? (y or n)
15996 @end smallexample
15997
15998 If you type @kbd{y}, @value{GDBN} abandons the remote debugging session.
15999 (If you decide you want to try again later, you can use @samp{target
16000 remote} again to connect once more.) If you type @kbd{n}, @value{GDBN}
16001 goes back to waiting.
16002
16003 @table @code
16004 @kindex detach (remote)
16005 @item detach
16006 When you have finished debugging the remote program, you can use the
16007 @code{detach} command to release it from @value{GDBN} control.
16008 Detaching from the target normally resumes its execution, but the results
16009 will depend on your particular remote stub. After the @code{detach}
16010 command, @value{GDBN} is free to connect to another target.
16011
16012 @kindex disconnect
16013 @item disconnect
16014 The @code{disconnect} command behaves like @code{detach}, except that
16015 the target is generally not resumed. It will wait for @value{GDBN}
16016 (this instance or another one) to connect and continue debugging. After
16017 the @code{disconnect} command, @value{GDBN} is again free to connect to
16018 another target.
16019
16020 @cindex send command to remote monitor
16021 @cindex extend @value{GDBN} for remote targets
16022 @cindex add new commands for external monitor
16023 @kindex monitor
16024 @item monitor @var{cmd}
16025 This command allows you to send arbitrary commands directly to the
16026 remote monitor. Since @value{GDBN} doesn't care about the commands it
16027 sends like this, this command is the way to extend @value{GDBN}---you
16028 can add new commands that only the external monitor will understand
16029 and implement.
16030 @end table
16031
16032 @node File Transfer
16033 @section Sending files to a remote system
16034 @cindex remote target, file transfer
16035 @cindex file transfer
16036 @cindex sending files to remote systems
16037
16038 Some remote targets offer the ability to transfer files over the same
16039 connection used to communicate with @value{GDBN}. This is convenient
16040 for targets accessible through other means, e.g.@: @sc{gnu}/Linux systems
16041 running @code{gdbserver} over a network interface. For other targets,
16042 e.g.@: embedded devices with only a single serial port, this may be
16043 the only way to upload or download files.
16044
16045 Not all remote targets support these commands.
16046
16047 @table @code
16048 @kindex remote put
16049 @item remote put @var{hostfile} @var{targetfile}
16050 Copy file @var{hostfile} from the host system (the machine running
16051 @value{GDBN}) to @var{targetfile} on the target system.
16052
16053 @kindex remote get
16054 @item remote get @var{targetfile} @var{hostfile}
16055 Copy file @var{targetfile} from the target system to @var{hostfile}
16056 on the host system.
16057
16058 @kindex remote delete
16059 @item remote delete @var{targetfile}
16060 Delete @var{targetfile} from the target system.
16061
16062 @end table
16063
16064 @node Server
16065 @section Using the @code{gdbserver} Program
16066
16067 @kindex gdbserver
16068 @cindex remote connection without stubs
16069 @code{gdbserver} is a control program for Unix-like systems, which
16070 allows you to connect your program with a remote @value{GDBN} via
16071 @code{target remote}---but without linking in the usual debugging stub.
16072
16073 @code{gdbserver} is not a complete replacement for the debugging stubs,
16074 because it requires essentially the same operating-system facilities
16075 that @value{GDBN} itself does. In fact, a system that can run
16076 @code{gdbserver} to connect to a remote @value{GDBN} could also run
16077 @value{GDBN} locally! @code{gdbserver} is sometimes useful nevertheless,
16078 because it is a much smaller program than @value{GDBN} itself. It is
16079 also easier to port than all of @value{GDBN}, so you may be able to get
16080 started more quickly on a new system by using @code{gdbserver}.
16081 Finally, if you develop code for real-time systems, you may find that
16082 the tradeoffs involved in real-time operation make it more convenient to
16083 do as much development work as possible on another system, for example
16084 by cross-compiling. You can use @code{gdbserver} to make a similar
16085 choice for debugging.
16086
16087 @value{GDBN} and @code{gdbserver} communicate via either a serial line
16088 or a TCP connection, using the standard @value{GDBN} remote serial
16089 protocol.
16090
16091 @quotation
16092 @emph{Warning:} @code{gdbserver} does not have any built-in security.
16093 Do not run @code{gdbserver} connected to any public network; a
16094 @value{GDBN} connection to @code{gdbserver} provides access to the
16095 target system with the same privileges as the user running
16096 @code{gdbserver}.
16097 @end quotation
16098
16099 @subsection Running @code{gdbserver}
16100 @cindex arguments, to @code{gdbserver}
16101
16102 Run @code{gdbserver} on the target system. You need a copy of the
16103 program you want to debug, including any libraries it requires.
16104 @code{gdbserver} does not need your program's symbol table, so you can
16105 strip the program if necessary to save space. @value{GDBN} on the host
16106 system does all the symbol handling.
16107
16108 To use the server, you must tell it how to communicate with @value{GDBN};
16109 the name of your program; and the arguments for your program. The usual
16110 syntax is:
16111
16112 @smallexample
16113 target> gdbserver @var{comm} @var{program} [ @var{args} @dots{} ]
16114 @end smallexample
16115
16116 @var{comm} is either a device name (to use a serial line) or a TCP
16117 hostname and portnumber. For example, to debug Emacs with the argument
16118 @samp{foo.txt} and communicate with @value{GDBN} over the serial port
16119 @file{/dev/com1}:
16120
16121 @smallexample
16122 target> gdbserver /dev/com1 emacs foo.txt
16123 @end smallexample
16124
16125 @code{gdbserver} waits passively for the host @value{GDBN} to communicate
16126 with it.
16127
16128 To use a TCP connection instead of a serial line:
16129
16130 @smallexample
16131 target> gdbserver host:2345 emacs foo.txt
16132 @end smallexample
16133
16134 The only difference from the previous example is the first argument,
16135 specifying that you are communicating with the host @value{GDBN} via
16136 TCP. The @samp{host:2345} argument means that @code{gdbserver} is to
16137 expect a TCP connection from machine @samp{host} to local TCP port 2345.
16138 (Currently, the @samp{host} part is ignored.) You can choose any number
16139 you want for the port number as long as it does not conflict with any
16140 TCP ports already in use on the target system (for example, @code{23} is
16141 reserved for @code{telnet}).@footnote{If you choose a port number that
16142 conflicts with another service, @code{gdbserver} prints an error message
16143 and exits.} You must use the same port number with the host @value{GDBN}
16144 @code{target remote} command.
16145
16146 @subsubsection Attaching to a Running Program
16147
16148 On some targets, @code{gdbserver} can also attach to running programs.
16149 This is accomplished via the @code{--attach} argument. The syntax is:
16150
16151 @smallexample
16152 target> gdbserver --attach @var{comm} @var{pid}
16153 @end smallexample
16154
16155 @var{pid} is the process ID of a currently running process. It isn't necessary
16156 to point @code{gdbserver} at a binary for the running process.
16157
16158 @pindex pidof
16159 @cindex attach to a program by name
16160 You can debug processes by name instead of process ID if your target has the
16161 @code{pidof} utility:
16162
16163 @smallexample
16164 target> gdbserver --attach @var{comm} `pidof @var{program}`
16165 @end smallexample
16166
16167 In case more than one copy of @var{program} is running, or @var{program}
16168 has multiple threads, most versions of @code{pidof} support the
16169 @code{-s} option to only return the first process ID.
16170
16171 @subsubsection Multi-Process Mode for @code{gdbserver}
16172 @cindex gdbserver, multiple processes
16173 @cindex multiple processes with gdbserver
16174
16175 When you connect to @code{gdbserver} using @code{target remote},
16176 @code{gdbserver} debugs the specified program only once. When the
16177 program exits, or you detach from it, @value{GDBN} closes the connection
16178 and @code{gdbserver} exits.
16179
16180 If you connect using @kbd{target extended-remote}, @code{gdbserver}
16181 enters multi-process mode. When the debugged program exits, or you
16182 detach from it, @value{GDBN} stays connected to @code{gdbserver} even
16183 though no program is running. The @code{run} and @code{attach}
16184 commands instruct @code{gdbserver} to run or attach to a new program.
16185 The @code{run} command uses @code{set remote exec-file} (@pxref{set
16186 remote exec-file}) to select the program to run. Command line
16187 arguments are supported, except for wildcard expansion and I/O
16188 redirection (@pxref{Arguments}).
16189
16190 To start @code{gdbserver} without supplying an initial command to run
16191 or process ID to attach, use the @option{--multi} command line option.
16192 Then you can connect using @kbd{target extended-remote} and start
16193 the program you want to debug.
16194
16195 @code{gdbserver} does not automatically exit in multi-process mode.
16196 You can terminate it by using @code{monitor exit}
16197 (@pxref{Monitor Commands for gdbserver}).
16198
16199 @subsubsection Other Command-Line Arguments for @code{gdbserver}
16200
16201 The @option{--debug} option tells @code{gdbserver} to display extra
16202 status information about the debugging process. The
16203 @option{--remote-debug} option tells @code{gdbserver} to display
16204 remote protocol debug output. These options are intended for
16205 @code{gdbserver} development and for bug reports to the developers.
16206
16207 The @option{--wrapper} option specifies a wrapper to launch programs
16208 for debugging. The option should be followed by the name of the
16209 wrapper, then any command-line arguments to pass to the wrapper, then
16210 @kbd{--} indicating the end of the wrapper arguments.
16211
16212 @code{gdbserver} runs the specified wrapper program with a combined
16213 command line including the wrapper arguments, then the name of the
16214 program to debug, then any arguments to the program. The wrapper
16215 runs until it executes your program, and then @value{GDBN} gains control.
16216
16217 You can use any program that eventually calls @code{execve} with
16218 its arguments as a wrapper. Several standard Unix utilities do
16219 this, e.g.@: @code{env} and @code{nohup}. Any Unix shell script ending
16220 with @code{exec "$@@"} will also work.
16221
16222 For example, you can use @code{env} to pass an environment variable to
16223 the debugged program, without setting the variable in @code{gdbserver}'s
16224 environment:
16225
16226 @smallexample
16227 $ gdbserver --wrapper env LD_PRELOAD=libtest.so -- :2222 ./testprog
16228 @end smallexample
16229
16230 @subsection Connecting to @code{gdbserver}
16231
16232 Run @value{GDBN} on the host system.
16233
16234 First make sure you have the necessary symbol files. Load symbols for
16235 your application using the @code{file} command before you connect. Use
16236 @code{set sysroot} to locate target libraries (unless your @value{GDBN}
16237 was compiled with the correct sysroot using @code{--with-sysroot}).
16238
16239 The symbol file and target libraries must exactly match the executable
16240 and libraries on the target, with one exception: the files on the host
16241 system should not be stripped, even if the files on the target system
16242 are. Mismatched or missing files will lead to confusing results
16243 during debugging. On @sc{gnu}/Linux targets, mismatched or missing
16244 files may also prevent @code{gdbserver} from debugging multi-threaded
16245 programs.
16246
16247 Connect to your target (@pxref{Connecting,,Connecting to a Remote Target}).
16248 For TCP connections, you must start up @code{gdbserver} prior to using
16249 the @code{target remote} command. Otherwise you may get an error whose
16250 text depends on the host system, but which usually looks something like
16251 @samp{Connection refused}. Don't use the @code{load}
16252 command in @value{GDBN} when using @code{gdbserver}, since the program is
16253 already on the target.
16254
16255 @subsection Monitor Commands for @code{gdbserver}
16256 @cindex monitor commands, for @code{gdbserver}
16257 @anchor{Monitor Commands for gdbserver}
16258
16259 During a @value{GDBN} session using @code{gdbserver}, you can use the
16260 @code{monitor} command to send special requests to @code{gdbserver}.
16261 Here are the available commands.
16262
16263 @table @code
16264 @item monitor help
16265 List the available monitor commands.
16266
16267 @item monitor set debug 0
16268 @itemx monitor set debug 1
16269 Disable or enable general debugging messages.
16270
16271 @item monitor set remote-debug 0
16272 @itemx monitor set remote-debug 1
16273 Disable or enable specific debugging messages associated with the remote
16274 protocol (@pxref{Remote Protocol}).
16275
16276 @item monitor set libthread-db-search-path [PATH]
16277 @cindex gdbserver, search path for @code{libthread_db}
16278 When this command is issued, @var{path} is a colon-separated list of
16279 directories to search for @code{libthread_db} (@pxref{Threads,,set
16280 libthread-db-search-path}). If you omit @var{path},
16281 @samp{libthread-db-search-path} will be reset to an empty list.
16282
16283 @item monitor exit
16284 Tell gdbserver to exit immediately. This command should be followed by
16285 @code{disconnect} to close the debugging session. @code{gdbserver} will
16286 detach from any attached processes and kill any processes it created.
16287 Use @code{monitor exit} to terminate @code{gdbserver} at the end
16288 of a multi-process mode debug session.
16289
16290 @end table
16291
16292 @subsection Tracepoints support in @code{gdbserver}
16293 @cindex tracepoints support in @code{gdbserver}
16294
16295 On some targets, @code{gdbserver} supports tracepoints, fast
16296 tracepoints and static tracepoints.
16297
16298 For fast or static tracepoints to work, a special library called the
16299 @dfn{in-process agent} (IPA), must be loaded in the inferior process.
16300 This library is built and distributed as an integral part of
16301 @code{gdbserver}. In addition, support for static tracepoints
16302 requires building the in-process agent library with static tracepoints
16303 support. At present, the UST (LTTng Userspace Tracer,
16304 @url{http://lttng.org/ust}) tracing engine is supported. This support
16305 is automatically available if UST development headers are found in the
16306 standard include path when @code{gdbserver} is built, or if
16307 @code{gdbserver} was explicitly configured using @option{--with-ust}
16308 to point at such headers. You can explicitly disable the support
16309 using @option{--with-ust=no}.
16310
16311 There are several ways to load the in-process agent in your program:
16312
16313 @table @code
16314 @item Specifying it as dependency at link time
16315
16316 You can link your program dynamically with the in-process agent
16317 library. On most systems, this is accomplished by adding
16318 @code{-linproctrace} to the link command.
16319
16320 @item Using the system's preloading mechanisms
16321
16322 You can force loading the in-process agent at startup time by using
16323 your system's support for preloading shared libraries. Many Unixes
16324 support the concept of preloading user defined libraries. In most
16325 cases, you do that by specifying @code{LD_PRELOAD=libinproctrace.so}
16326 in the environment. See also the description of @code{gdbserver}'s
16327 @option{--wrapper} command line option.
16328
16329 @item Using @value{GDBN} to force loading the agent at run time
16330
16331 On some systems, you can force the inferior to load a shared library,
16332 by calling a dynamic loader function in the inferior that takes care
16333 of dynamically looking up and loading a shared library. On most Unix
16334 systems, the function is @code{dlopen}. You'll use the @code{call}
16335 command for that. For example:
16336
16337 @smallexample
16338 (@value{GDBP}) call dlopen ("libinproctrace.so", ...)
16339 @end smallexample
16340
16341 Note that on most Unix systems, for the @code{dlopen} function to be
16342 available, the program needs to be linked with @code{-ldl}.
16343 @end table
16344
16345 On systems that have a userspace dynamic loader, like most Unix
16346 systems, when you connect to @code{gdbserver} using @code{target
16347 remote}, you'll find that the program is stopped at the dynamic
16348 loader's entry point, and no shared library has been loaded in the
16349 program's address space yet, including the in-process agent. In that
16350 case, before being able to use any of the fast or static tracepoints
16351 features, you need to let the loader run and load the shared
16352 libraries. The simplest way to do that is to run the program to the
16353 main procedure. E.g., if debugging a C or C@t{++} program, start
16354 @code{gdbserver} like so:
16355
16356 @smallexample
16357 $ gdbserver :9999 myprogram
16358 @end smallexample
16359
16360 Start GDB and connect to @code{gdbserver} like so, and run to main:
16361
16362 @smallexample
16363 $ gdb myprogram
16364 (@value{GDBP}) target remote myhost:9999
16365 0x00007f215893ba60 in ?? () from /lib64/ld-linux-x86-64.so.2
16366 (@value{GDBP}) b main
16367 (@value{GDBP}) continue
16368 @end smallexample
16369
16370 The in-process tracing agent library should now be loaded into the
16371 process; you can confirm it with the @code{info sharedlibrary}
16372 command, which will list @file{libinproctrace.so} as loaded in the
16373 process. You are now ready to install fast tracepoints, list static
16374 tracepoint markers, probe static tracepoints markers, and start
16375 tracing.
16376
16377 @node Remote Configuration
16378 @section Remote Configuration
16379
16380 @kindex set remote
16381 @kindex show remote
16382 This section documents the configuration options available when
16383 debugging remote programs. For the options related to the File I/O
16384 extensions of the remote protocol, see @ref{system,
16385 system-call-allowed}.
16386
16387 @table @code
16388 @item set remoteaddresssize @var{bits}
16389 @cindex address size for remote targets
16390 @cindex bits in remote address
16391 Set the maximum size of address in a memory packet to the specified
16392 number of bits. @value{GDBN} will mask off the address bits above
16393 that number, when it passes addresses to the remote target. The
16394 default value is the number of bits in the target's address.
16395
16396 @item show remoteaddresssize
16397 Show the current value of remote address size in bits.
16398
16399 @item set remotebaud @var{n}
16400 @cindex baud rate for remote targets
16401 Set the baud rate for the remote serial I/O to @var{n} baud. The
16402 value is used to set the speed of the serial port used for debugging
16403 remote targets.
16404
16405 @item show remotebaud
16406 Show the current speed of the remote connection.
16407
16408 @item set remotebreak
16409 @cindex interrupt remote programs
16410 @cindex BREAK signal instead of Ctrl-C
16411 @anchor{set remotebreak}
16412 If set to on, @value{GDBN} sends a @code{BREAK} signal to the remote
16413 when you type @kbd{Ctrl-c} to interrupt the program running
16414 on the remote. If set to off, @value{GDBN} sends the @samp{Ctrl-C}
16415 character instead. The default is off, since most remote systems
16416 expect to see @samp{Ctrl-C} as the interrupt signal.
16417
16418 @item show remotebreak
16419 Show whether @value{GDBN} sends @code{BREAK} or @samp{Ctrl-C} to
16420 interrupt the remote program.
16421
16422 @item set remoteflow on
16423 @itemx set remoteflow off
16424 @kindex set remoteflow
16425 Enable or disable hardware flow control (@code{RTS}/@code{CTS})
16426 on the serial port used to communicate to the remote target.
16427
16428 @item show remoteflow
16429 @kindex show remoteflow
16430 Show the current setting of hardware flow control.
16431
16432 @item set remotelogbase @var{base}
16433 Set the base (a.k.a.@: radix) of logging serial protocol
16434 communications to @var{base}. Supported values of @var{base} are:
16435 @code{ascii}, @code{octal}, and @code{hex}. The default is
16436 @code{ascii}.
16437
16438 @item show remotelogbase
16439 Show the current setting of the radix for logging remote serial
16440 protocol.
16441
16442 @item set remotelogfile @var{file}
16443 @cindex record serial communications on file
16444 Record remote serial communications on the named @var{file}. The
16445 default is not to record at all.
16446
16447 @item show remotelogfile.
16448 Show the current setting of the file name on which to record the
16449 serial communications.
16450
16451 @item set remotetimeout @var{num}
16452 @cindex timeout for serial communications
16453 @cindex remote timeout
16454 Set the timeout limit to wait for the remote target to respond to
16455 @var{num} seconds. The default is 2 seconds.
16456
16457 @item show remotetimeout
16458 Show the current number of seconds to wait for the remote target
16459 responses.
16460
16461 @cindex limit hardware breakpoints and watchpoints
16462 @cindex remote target, limit break- and watchpoints
16463 @anchor{set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit}
16464 @anchor{set remote hardware-breakpoint-limit}
16465 @item set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit @var{limit}
16466 @itemx set remote hardware-breakpoint-limit @var{limit}
16467 Restrict @value{GDBN} to using @var{limit} remote hardware breakpoint or
16468 watchpoints. A limit of -1, the default, is treated as unlimited.
16469
16470 @item set remote exec-file @var{filename}
16471 @itemx show remote exec-file
16472 @anchor{set remote exec-file}
16473 @cindex executable file, for remote target
16474 Select the file used for @code{run} with @code{target
16475 extended-remote}. This should be set to a filename valid on the
16476 target system. If it is not set, the target will use a default
16477 filename (e.g.@: the last program run).
16478
16479 @item set remote interrupt-sequence
16480 @cindex interrupt remote programs
16481 @cindex select Ctrl-C, BREAK or BREAK-g
16482 Allow the user to select one of @samp{Ctrl-C}, a @code{BREAK} or
16483 @samp{BREAK-g} as the
16484 sequence to the remote target in order to interrupt the execution.
16485 @samp{Ctrl-C} is a default. Some system prefers @code{BREAK} which
16486 is high level of serial line for some certain time.
16487 Linux kernel prefers @samp{BREAK-g}, a.k.a Magic SysRq g.
16488 It is @code{BREAK} signal followed by character @code{g}.
16489
16490 @item show interrupt-sequence
16491 Show which of @samp{Ctrl-C}, @code{BREAK} or @code{BREAK-g}
16492 is sent by @value{GDBN} to interrupt the remote program.
16493 @code{BREAK-g} is BREAK signal followed by @code{g} and
16494 also known as Magic SysRq g.
16495
16496 @item set remote interrupt-on-connect
16497 @cindex send interrupt-sequence on start
16498 Specify whether interrupt-sequence is sent to remote target when
16499 @value{GDBN} connects to it. This is mostly needed when you debug
16500 Linux kernel. Linux kernel expects @code{BREAK} followed by @code{g}
16501 which is known as Magic SysRq g in order to connect @value{GDBN}.
16502
16503 @item show interrupt-on-connect
16504 Show whether interrupt-sequence is sent
16505 to remote target when @value{GDBN} connects to it.
16506
16507 @kindex set tcp
16508 @kindex show tcp
16509 @item set tcp auto-retry on
16510 @cindex auto-retry, for remote TCP target
16511 Enable auto-retry for remote TCP connections. This is useful if the remote
16512 debugging agent is launched in parallel with @value{GDBN}; there is a race
16513 condition because the agent may not become ready to accept the connection
16514 before @value{GDBN} attempts to connect. When auto-retry is
16515 enabled, if the initial attempt to connect fails, @value{GDBN} reattempts
16516 to establish the connection using the timeout specified by
16517 @code{set tcp connect-timeout}.
16518
16519 @item set tcp auto-retry off
16520 Do not auto-retry failed TCP connections.
16521
16522 @item show tcp auto-retry
16523 Show the current auto-retry setting.
16524
16525 @item set tcp connect-timeout @var{seconds}
16526 @cindex connection timeout, for remote TCP target
16527 @cindex timeout, for remote target connection
16528 Set the timeout for establishing a TCP connection to the remote target to
16529 @var{seconds}. The timeout affects both polling to retry failed connections
16530 (enabled by @code{set tcp auto-retry on}) and waiting for connections
16531 that are merely slow to complete, and represents an approximate cumulative
16532 value.
16533
16534 @item show tcp connect-timeout
16535 Show the current connection timeout setting.
16536 @end table
16537
16538 @cindex remote packets, enabling and disabling
16539 The @value{GDBN} remote protocol autodetects the packets supported by
16540 your debugging stub. If you need to override the autodetection, you
16541 can use these commands to enable or disable individual packets. Each
16542 packet can be set to @samp{on} (the remote target supports this
16543 packet), @samp{off} (the remote target does not support this packet),
16544 or @samp{auto} (detect remote target support for this packet). They
16545 all default to @samp{auto}. For more information about each packet,
16546 see @ref{Remote Protocol}.
16547
16548 During normal use, you should not have to use any of these commands.
16549 If you do, that may be a bug in your remote debugging stub, or a bug
16550 in @value{GDBN}. You may want to report the problem to the
16551 @value{GDBN} developers.
16552
16553 For each packet @var{name}, the command to enable or disable the
16554 packet is @code{set remote @var{name}-packet}. The available settings
16555 are:
16556
16557 @multitable @columnfractions 0.28 0.32 0.25
16558 @item Command Name
16559 @tab Remote Packet
16560 @tab Related Features
16561
16562 @item @code{fetch-register}
16563 @tab @code{p}
16564 @tab @code{info registers}
16565
16566 @item @code{set-register}
16567 @tab @code{P}
16568 @tab @code{set}
16569
16570 @item @code{binary-download}
16571 @tab @code{X}
16572 @tab @code{load}, @code{set}
16573
16574 @item @code{read-aux-vector}
16575 @tab @code{qXfer:auxv:read}
16576 @tab @code{info auxv}
16577
16578 @item @code{symbol-lookup}
16579 @tab @code{qSymbol}
16580 @tab Detecting multiple threads
16581
16582 @item @code{attach}
16583 @tab @code{vAttach}
16584 @tab @code{attach}
16585
16586 @item @code{verbose-resume}
16587 @tab @code{vCont}
16588 @tab Stepping or resuming multiple threads
16589
16590 @item @code{run}
16591 @tab @code{vRun}
16592 @tab @code{run}
16593
16594 @item @code{software-breakpoint}
16595 @tab @code{Z0}
16596 @tab @code{break}
16597
16598 @item @code{hardware-breakpoint}
16599 @tab @code{Z1}
16600 @tab @code{hbreak}
16601
16602 @item @code{write-watchpoint}
16603 @tab @code{Z2}
16604 @tab @code{watch}
16605
16606 @item @code{read-watchpoint}
16607 @tab @code{Z3}
16608 @tab @code{rwatch}
16609
16610 @item @code{access-watchpoint}
16611 @tab @code{Z4}
16612 @tab @code{awatch}
16613
16614 @item @code{target-features}
16615 @tab @code{qXfer:features:read}
16616 @tab @code{set architecture}
16617
16618 @item @code{library-info}
16619 @tab @code{qXfer:libraries:read}
16620 @tab @code{info sharedlibrary}
16621
16622 @item @code{memory-map}
16623 @tab @code{qXfer:memory-map:read}
16624 @tab @code{info mem}
16625
16626 @item @code{read-sdata-object}
16627 @tab @code{qXfer:sdata:read}
16628 @tab @code{print $_sdata}
16629
16630 @item @code{read-spu-object}
16631 @tab @code{qXfer:spu:read}
16632 @tab @code{info spu}
16633
16634 @item @code{write-spu-object}
16635 @tab @code{qXfer:spu:write}
16636 @tab @code{info spu}
16637
16638 @item @code{read-siginfo-object}
16639 @tab @code{qXfer:siginfo:read}
16640 @tab @code{print $_siginfo}
16641
16642 @item @code{write-siginfo-object}
16643 @tab @code{qXfer:siginfo:write}
16644 @tab @code{set $_siginfo}
16645
16646 @item @code{threads}
16647 @tab @code{qXfer:threads:read}
16648 @tab @code{info threads}
16649
16650 @item @code{get-thread-local-@*storage-address}
16651 @tab @code{qGetTLSAddr}
16652 @tab Displaying @code{__thread} variables
16653
16654 @item @code{get-thread-information-block-address}
16655 @tab @code{qGetTIBAddr}
16656 @tab Display MS-Windows Thread Information Block.
16657
16658 @item @code{search-memory}
16659 @tab @code{qSearch:memory}
16660 @tab @code{find}
16661
16662 @item @code{supported-packets}
16663 @tab @code{qSupported}
16664 @tab Remote communications parameters
16665
16666 @item @code{pass-signals}
16667 @tab @code{QPassSignals}
16668 @tab @code{handle @var{signal}}
16669
16670 @item @code{hostio-close-packet}
16671 @tab @code{vFile:close}
16672 @tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
16673
16674 @item @code{hostio-open-packet}
16675 @tab @code{vFile:open}
16676 @tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
16677
16678 @item @code{hostio-pread-packet}
16679 @tab @code{vFile:pread}
16680 @tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
16681
16682 @item @code{hostio-pwrite-packet}
16683 @tab @code{vFile:pwrite}
16684 @tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
16685
16686 @item @code{hostio-unlink-packet}
16687 @tab @code{vFile:unlink}
16688 @tab @code{remote delete}
16689
16690 @item @code{noack-packet}
16691 @tab @code{QStartNoAckMode}
16692 @tab Packet acknowledgment
16693
16694 @item @code{osdata}
16695 @tab @code{qXfer:osdata:read}
16696 @tab @code{info os}
16697
16698 @item @code{query-attached}
16699 @tab @code{qAttached}
16700 @tab Querying remote process attach state.
16701 @end multitable
16702
16703 @node Remote Stub
16704 @section Implementing a Remote Stub
16705
16706 @cindex debugging stub, example
16707 @cindex remote stub, example
16708 @cindex stub example, remote debugging
16709 The stub files provided with @value{GDBN} implement the target side of the
16710 communication protocol, and the @value{GDBN} side is implemented in the
16711 @value{GDBN} source file @file{remote.c}. Normally, you can simply allow
16712 these subroutines to communicate, and ignore the details. (If you're
16713 implementing your own stub file, you can still ignore the details: start
16714 with one of the existing stub files. @file{sparc-stub.c} is the best
16715 organized, and therefore the easiest to read.)
16716
16717 @cindex remote serial debugging, overview
16718 To debug a program running on another machine (the debugging
16719 @dfn{target} machine), you must first arrange for all the usual
16720 prerequisites for the program to run by itself. For example, for a C
16721 program, you need:
16722
16723 @enumerate
16724 @item
16725 A startup routine to set up the C runtime environment; these usually
16726 have a name like @file{crt0}. The startup routine may be supplied by
16727 your hardware supplier, or you may have to write your own.
16728
16729 @item
16730 A C subroutine library to support your program's
16731 subroutine calls, notably managing input and output.
16732
16733 @item
16734 A way of getting your program to the other machine---for example, a
16735 download program. These are often supplied by the hardware
16736 manufacturer, but you may have to write your own from hardware
16737 documentation.
16738 @end enumerate
16739
16740 The next step is to arrange for your program to use a serial port to
16741 communicate with the machine where @value{GDBN} is running (the @dfn{host}
16742 machine). In general terms, the scheme looks like this:
16743
16744 @table @emph
16745 @item On the host,
16746 @value{GDBN} already understands how to use this protocol; when everything
16747 else is set up, you can simply use the @samp{target remote} command
16748 (@pxref{Targets,,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
16749
16750 @item On the target,
16751 you must link with your program a few special-purpose subroutines that
16752 implement the @value{GDBN} remote serial protocol. The file containing these
16753 subroutines is called a @dfn{debugging stub}.
16754
16755 On certain remote targets, you can use an auxiliary program
16756 @code{gdbserver} instead of linking a stub into your program.
16757 @xref{Server,,Using the @code{gdbserver} Program}, for details.
16758 @end table
16759
16760 The debugging stub is specific to the architecture of the remote
16761 machine; for example, use @file{sparc-stub.c} to debug programs on
16762 @sc{sparc} boards.
16763
16764 @cindex remote serial stub list
16765 These working remote stubs are distributed with @value{GDBN}:
16766
16767 @table @code
16768
16769 @item i386-stub.c
16770 @cindex @file{i386-stub.c}
16771 @cindex Intel
16772 @cindex i386
16773 For Intel 386 and compatible architectures.
16774
16775 @item m68k-stub.c
16776 @cindex @file{m68k-stub.c}
16777 @cindex Motorola 680x0
16778 @cindex m680x0
16779 For Motorola 680x0 architectures.
16780
16781 @item sh-stub.c
16782 @cindex @file{sh-stub.c}
16783 @cindex Renesas
16784 @cindex SH
16785 For Renesas SH architectures.
16786
16787 @item sparc-stub.c
16788 @cindex @file{sparc-stub.c}
16789 @cindex Sparc
16790 For @sc{sparc} architectures.
16791
16792 @item sparcl-stub.c
16793 @cindex @file{sparcl-stub.c}
16794 @cindex Fujitsu
16795 @cindex SparcLite
16796 For Fujitsu @sc{sparclite} architectures.
16797
16798 @end table
16799
16800 The @file{README} file in the @value{GDBN} distribution may list other
16801 recently added stubs.
16802
16803 @menu
16804 * Stub Contents:: What the stub can do for you
16805 * Bootstrapping:: What you must do for the stub
16806 * Debug Session:: Putting it all together
16807 @end menu
16808
16809 @node Stub Contents
16810 @subsection What the Stub Can Do for You
16811
16812 @cindex remote serial stub
16813 The debugging stub for your architecture supplies these three
16814 subroutines:
16815
16816 @table @code
16817 @item set_debug_traps
16818 @findex set_debug_traps
16819 @cindex remote serial stub, initialization
16820 This routine arranges for @code{handle_exception} to run when your
16821 program stops. You must call this subroutine explicitly near the
16822 beginning of your program.
16823
16824 @item handle_exception
16825 @findex handle_exception
16826 @cindex remote serial stub, main routine
16827 This is the central workhorse, but your program never calls it
16828 explicitly---the setup code arranges for @code{handle_exception} to
16829 run when a trap is triggered.
16830
16831 @code{handle_exception} takes control when your program stops during
16832 execution (for example, on a breakpoint), and mediates communications
16833 with @value{GDBN} on the host machine. This is where the communications
16834 protocol is implemented; @code{handle_exception} acts as the @value{GDBN}
16835 representative on the target machine. It begins by sending summary
16836 information on the state of your program, then continues to execute,
16837 retrieving and transmitting any information @value{GDBN} needs, until you
16838 execute a @value{GDBN} command that makes your program resume; at that point,
16839 @code{handle_exception} returns control to your own code on the target
16840 machine.
16841
16842 @item breakpoint
16843 @cindex @code{breakpoint} subroutine, remote
16844 Use this auxiliary subroutine to make your program contain a
16845 breakpoint. Depending on the particular situation, this may be the only
16846 way for @value{GDBN} to get control. For instance, if your target
16847 machine has some sort of interrupt button, you won't need to call this;
16848 pressing the interrupt button transfers control to
16849 @code{handle_exception}---in effect, to @value{GDBN}. On some machines,
16850 simply receiving characters on the serial port may also trigger a trap;
16851 again, in that situation, you don't need to call @code{breakpoint} from
16852 your own program---simply running @samp{target remote} from the host
16853 @value{GDBN} session gets control.
16854
16855 Call @code{breakpoint} if none of these is true, or if you simply want
16856 to make certain your program stops at a predetermined point for the
16857 start of your debugging session.
16858 @end table
16859
16860 @node Bootstrapping
16861 @subsection What You Must Do for the Stub
16862
16863 @cindex remote stub, support routines
16864 The debugging stubs that come with @value{GDBN} are set up for a particular
16865 chip architecture, but they have no information about the rest of your
16866 debugging target machine.
16867
16868 First of all you need to tell the stub how to communicate with the
16869 serial port.
16870
16871 @table @code
16872 @item int getDebugChar()
16873 @findex getDebugChar
16874 Write this subroutine to read a single character from the serial port.
16875 It may be identical to @code{getchar} for your target system; a
16876 different name is used to allow you to distinguish the two if you wish.
16877
16878 @item void putDebugChar(int)
16879 @findex putDebugChar
16880 Write this subroutine to write a single character to the serial port.
16881 It may be identical to @code{putchar} for your target system; a
16882 different name is used to allow you to distinguish the two if you wish.
16883 @end table
16884
16885 @cindex control C, and remote debugging
16886 @cindex interrupting remote targets
16887 If you want @value{GDBN} to be able to stop your program while it is
16888 running, you need to use an interrupt-driven serial driver, and arrange
16889 for it to stop when it receives a @code{^C} (@samp{\003}, the control-C
16890 character). That is the character which @value{GDBN} uses to tell the
16891 remote system to stop.
16892
16893 Getting the debugging target to return the proper status to @value{GDBN}
16894 probably requires changes to the standard stub; one quick and dirty way
16895 is to just execute a breakpoint instruction (the ``dirty'' part is that
16896 @value{GDBN} reports a @code{SIGTRAP} instead of a @code{SIGINT}).
16897
16898 Other routines you need to supply are:
16899
16900 @table @code
16901 @item void exceptionHandler (int @var{exception_number}, void *@var{exception_address})
16902 @findex exceptionHandler
16903 Write this function to install @var{exception_address} in the exception
16904 handling tables. You need to do this because the stub does not have any
16905 way of knowing what the exception handling tables on your target system
16906 are like (for example, the processor's table might be in @sc{rom},
16907 containing entries which point to a table in @sc{ram}).
16908 @var{exception_number} is the exception number which should be changed;
16909 its meaning is architecture-dependent (for example, different numbers
16910 might represent divide by zero, misaligned access, etc). When this
16911 exception occurs, control should be transferred directly to
16912 @var{exception_address}, and the processor state (stack, registers,
16913 and so on) should be just as it is when a processor exception occurs. So if
16914 you want to use a jump instruction to reach @var{exception_address}, it
16915 should be a simple jump, not a jump to subroutine.
16916
16917 For the 386, @var{exception_address} should be installed as an interrupt
16918 gate so that interrupts are masked while the handler runs. The gate
16919 should be at privilege level 0 (the most privileged level). The
16920 @sc{sparc} and 68k stubs are able to mask interrupts themselves without
16921 help from @code{exceptionHandler}.
16922
16923 @item void flush_i_cache()
16924 @findex flush_i_cache
16925 On @sc{sparc} and @sc{sparclite} only, write this subroutine to flush the
16926 instruction cache, if any, on your target machine. If there is no
16927 instruction cache, this subroutine may be a no-op.
16928
16929 On target machines that have instruction caches, @value{GDBN} requires this
16930 function to make certain that the state of your program is stable.
16931 @end table
16932
16933 @noindent
16934 You must also make sure this library routine is available:
16935
16936 @table @code
16937 @item void *memset(void *, int, int)
16938 @findex memset
16939 This is the standard library function @code{memset} that sets an area of
16940 memory to a known value. If you have one of the free versions of
16941 @code{libc.a}, @code{memset} can be found there; otherwise, you must
16942 either obtain it from your hardware manufacturer, or write your own.
16943 @end table
16944
16945 If you do not use the GNU C compiler, you may need other standard
16946 library subroutines as well; this varies from one stub to another,
16947 but in general the stubs are likely to use any of the common library
16948 subroutines which @code{@value{NGCC}} generates as inline code.
16949
16950
16951 @node Debug Session
16952 @subsection Putting it All Together
16953
16954 @cindex remote serial debugging summary
16955 In summary, when your program is ready to debug, you must follow these
16956 steps.
16957
16958 @enumerate
16959 @item
16960 Make sure you have defined the supporting low-level routines
16961 (@pxref{Bootstrapping,,What You Must Do for the Stub}):
16962 @display
16963 @code{getDebugChar}, @code{putDebugChar},
16964 @code{flush_i_cache}, @code{memset}, @code{exceptionHandler}.
16965 @end display
16966
16967 @item
16968 Insert these lines near the top of your program:
16969
16970 @smallexample
16971 set_debug_traps();
16972 breakpoint();
16973 @end smallexample
16974
16975 @item
16976 For the 680x0 stub only, you need to provide a variable called
16977 @code{exceptionHook}. Normally you just use:
16978
16979 @smallexample
16980 void (*exceptionHook)() = 0;
16981 @end smallexample
16982
16983 @noindent
16984 but if before calling @code{set_debug_traps}, you set it to point to a
16985 function in your program, that function is called when
16986 @code{@value{GDBN}} continues after stopping on a trap (for example, bus
16987 error). The function indicated by @code{exceptionHook} is called with
16988 one parameter: an @code{int} which is the exception number.
16989
16990 @item
16991 Compile and link together: your program, the @value{GDBN} debugging stub for
16992 your target architecture, and the supporting subroutines.
16993
16994 @item
16995 Make sure you have a serial connection between your target machine and
16996 the @value{GDBN} host, and identify the serial port on the host.
16997
16998 @item
16999 @c The "remote" target now provides a `load' command, so we should
17000 @c document that. FIXME.
17001 Download your program to your target machine (or get it there by
17002 whatever means the manufacturer provides), and start it.
17003
17004 @item
17005 Start @value{GDBN} on the host, and connect to the target
17006 (@pxref{Connecting,,Connecting to a Remote Target}).
17007
17008 @end enumerate
17009
17010 @node Configurations
17011 @chapter Configuration-Specific Information
17012
17013 While nearly all @value{GDBN} commands are available for all native and
17014 cross versions of the debugger, there are some exceptions. This chapter
17015 describes things that are only available in certain configurations.
17016
17017 There are three major categories of configurations: native
17018 configurations, where the host and target are the same, embedded
17019 operating system configurations, which are usually the same for several
17020 different processor architectures, and bare embedded processors, which
17021 are quite different from each other.
17022
17023 @menu
17024 * Native::
17025 * Embedded OS::
17026 * Embedded Processors::
17027 * Architectures::
17028 @end menu
17029
17030 @node Native
17031 @section Native
17032
17033 This section describes details specific to particular native
17034 configurations.
17035
17036 @menu
17037 * HP-UX:: HP-UX
17038 * BSD libkvm Interface:: Debugging BSD kernel memory images
17039 * SVR4 Process Information:: SVR4 process information
17040 * DJGPP Native:: Features specific to the DJGPP port
17041 * Cygwin Native:: Features specific to the Cygwin port
17042 * Hurd Native:: Features specific to @sc{gnu} Hurd
17043 * Neutrino:: Features specific to QNX Neutrino
17044 * Darwin:: Features specific to Darwin
17045 @end menu
17046
17047 @node HP-UX
17048 @subsection HP-UX
17049
17050 On HP-UX systems, if you refer to a function or variable name that
17051 begins with a dollar sign, @value{GDBN} searches for a user or system
17052 name first, before it searches for a convenience variable.
17053
17054
17055 @node BSD libkvm Interface
17056 @subsection BSD libkvm Interface
17057
17058 @cindex libkvm
17059 @cindex kernel memory image
17060 @cindex kernel crash dump
17061
17062 BSD-derived systems (FreeBSD/NetBSD/OpenBSD) have a kernel memory
17063 interface that provides a uniform interface for accessing kernel virtual
17064 memory images, including live systems and crash dumps. @value{GDBN}
17065 uses this interface to allow you to debug live kernels and kernel crash
17066 dumps on many native BSD configurations. This is implemented as a
17067 special @code{kvm} debugging target. For debugging a live system, load
17068 the currently running kernel into @value{GDBN} and connect to the
17069 @code{kvm} target:
17070
17071 @smallexample
17072 (@value{GDBP}) @b{target kvm}
17073 @end smallexample
17074
17075 For debugging crash dumps, provide the file name of the crash dump as an
17076 argument:
17077
17078 @smallexample
17079 (@value{GDBP}) @b{target kvm /var/crash/bsd.0}
17080 @end smallexample
17081
17082 Once connected to the @code{kvm} target, the following commands are
17083 available:
17084
17085 @table @code
17086 @kindex kvm
17087 @item kvm pcb
17088 Set current context from the @dfn{Process Control Block} (PCB) address.
17089
17090 @item kvm proc
17091 Set current context from proc address. This command isn't available on
17092 modern FreeBSD systems.
17093 @end table
17094
17095 @node SVR4 Process Information
17096 @subsection SVR4 Process Information
17097 @cindex /proc
17098 @cindex examine process image
17099 @cindex process info via @file{/proc}
17100
17101 Many versions of SVR4 and compatible systems provide a facility called
17102 @samp{/proc} that can be used to examine the image of a running
17103 process using file-system subroutines. If @value{GDBN} is configured
17104 for an operating system with this facility, the command @code{info
17105 proc} is available to report information about the process running
17106 your program, or about any process running on your system. @code{info
17107 proc} works only on SVR4 systems that include the @code{procfs} code.
17108 This includes, as of this writing, @sc{gnu}/Linux, OSF/1 (Digital
17109 Unix), Solaris, Irix, and Unixware, but not HP-UX, for example.
17110
17111 @table @code
17112 @kindex info proc
17113 @cindex process ID
17114 @item info proc
17115 @itemx info proc @var{process-id}
17116 Summarize available information about any running process. If a
17117 process ID is specified by @var{process-id}, display information about
17118 that process; otherwise display information about the program being
17119 debugged. The summary includes the debugged process ID, the command
17120 line used to invoke it, its current working directory, and its
17121 executable file's absolute file name.
17122
17123 On some systems, @var{process-id} can be of the form
17124 @samp{[@var{pid}]/@var{tid}} which specifies a certain thread ID
17125 within a process. If the optional @var{pid} part is missing, it means
17126 a thread from the process being debugged (the leading @samp{/} still
17127 needs to be present, or else @value{GDBN} will interpret the number as
17128 a process ID rather than a thread ID).
17129
17130 @item info proc mappings
17131 @cindex memory address space mappings
17132 Report the memory address space ranges accessible in the program, with
17133 information on whether the process has read, write, or execute access
17134 rights to each range. On @sc{gnu}/Linux systems, each memory range
17135 includes the object file which is mapped to that range, instead of the
17136 memory access rights to that range.
17137
17138 @item info proc stat
17139 @itemx info proc status
17140 @cindex process detailed status information
17141 These subcommands are specific to @sc{gnu}/Linux systems. They show
17142 the process-related information, including the user ID and group ID;
17143 how many threads are there in the process; its virtual memory usage;
17144 the signals that are pending, blocked, and ignored; its TTY; its
17145 consumption of system and user time; its stack size; its @samp{nice}
17146 value; etc. For more information, see the @samp{proc} man page
17147 (type @kbd{man 5 proc} from your shell prompt).
17148
17149 @item info proc all
17150 Show all the information about the process described under all of the
17151 above @code{info proc} subcommands.
17152
17153 @ignore
17154 @comment These sub-options of 'info proc' were not included when
17155 @comment procfs.c was re-written. Keep their descriptions around
17156 @comment against the day when someone finds the time to put them back in.
17157 @kindex info proc times
17158 @item info proc times
17159 Starting time, user CPU time, and system CPU time for your program and
17160 its children.
17161
17162 @kindex info proc id
17163 @item info proc id
17164 Report on the process IDs related to your program: its own process ID,
17165 the ID of its parent, the process group ID, and the session ID.
17166 @end ignore
17167
17168 @item set procfs-trace
17169 @kindex set procfs-trace
17170 @cindex @code{procfs} API calls
17171 This command enables and disables tracing of @code{procfs} API calls.
17172
17173 @item show procfs-trace
17174 @kindex show procfs-trace
17175 Show the current state of @code{procfs} API call tracing.
17176
17177 @item set procfs-file @var{file}
17178 @kindex set procfs-file
17179 Tell @value{GDBN} to write @code{procfs} API trace to the named
17180 @var{file}. @value{GDBN} appends the trace info to the previous
17181 contents of the file. The default is to display the trace on the
17182 standard output.
17183
17184 @item show procfs-file
17185 @kindex show procfs-file
17186 Show the file to which @code{procfs} API trace is written.
17187
17188 @item proc-trace-entry
17189 @itemx proc-trace-exit
17190 @itemx proc-untrace-entry
17191 @itemx proc-untrace-exit
17192 @kindex proc-trace-entry
17193 @kindex proc-trace-exit
17194 @kindex proc-untrace-entry
17195 @kindex proc-untrace-exit
17196 These commands enable and disable tracing of entries into and exits
17197 from the @code{syscall} interface.
17198
17199 @item info pidlist
17200 @kindex info pidlist
17201 @cindex process list, QNX Neutrino
17202 For QNX Neutrino only, this command displays the list of all the
17203 processes and all the threads within each process.
17204
17205 @item info meminfo
17206 @kindex info meminfo
17207 @cindex mapinfo list, QNX Neutrino
17208 For QNX Neutrino only, this command displays the list of all mapinfos.
17209 @end table
17210
17211 @node DJGPP Native
17212 @subsection Features for Debugging @sc{djgpp} Programs
17213 @cindex @sc{djgpp} debugging
17214 @cindex native @sc{djgpp} debugging
17215 @cindex MS-DOS-specific commands
17216
17217 @cindex DPMI
17218 @sc{djgpp} is a port of the @sc{gnu} development tools to MS-DOS and
17219 MS-Windows. @sc{djgpp} programs are 32-bit protected-mode programs
17220 that use the @dfn{DPMI} (DOS Protected-Mode Interface) API to run on
17221 top of real-mode DOS systems and their emulations.
17222
17223 @value{GDBN} supports native debugging of @sc{djgpp} programs, and
17224 defines a few commands specific to the @sc{djgpp} port. This
17225 subsection describes those commands.
17226
17227 @table @code
17228 @kindex info dos
17229 @item info dos
17230 This is a prefix of @sc{djgpp}-specific commands which print
17231 information about the target system and important OS structures.
17232
17233 @kindex sysinfo
17234 @cindex MS-DOS system info
17235 @cindex free memory information (MS-DOS)
17236 @item info dos sysinfo
17237 This command displays assorted information about the underlying
17238 platform: the CPU type and features, the OS version and flavor, the
17239 DPMI version, and the available conventional and DPMI memory.
17240
17241 @cindex GDT
17242 @cindex LDT
17243 @cindex IDT
17244 @cindex segment descriptor tables
17245 @cindex descriptor tables display
17246 @item info dos gdt
17247 @itemx info dos ldt
17248 @itemx info dos idt
17249 These 3 commands display entries from, respectively, Global, Local,
17250 and Interrupt Descriptor Tables (GDT, LDT, and IDT). The descriptor
17251 tables are data structures which store a descriptor for each segment
17252 that is currently in use. The segment's selector is an index into a
17253 descriptor table; the table entry for that index holds the
17254 descriptor's base address and limit, and its attributes and access
17255 rights.
17256
17257 A typical @sc{djgpp} program uses 3 segments: a code segment, a data
17258 segment (used for both data and the stack), and a DOS segment (which
17259 allows access to DOS/BIOS data structures and absolute addresses in
17260 conventional memory). However, the DPMI host will usually define
17261 additional segments in order to support the DPMI environment.
17262
17263 @cindex garbled pointers
17264 These commands allow to display entries from the descriptor tables.
17265 Without an argument, all entries from the specified table are
17266 displayed. An argument, which should be an integer expression, means
17267 display a single entry whose index is given by the argument. For
17268 example, here's a convenient way to display information about the
17269 debugged program's data segment:
17270
17271 @smallexample
17272 @exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos ldt $ds}
17273 @exdent @code{0x13f: base=0x11970000 limit=0x0009ffff 32-Bit Data (Read/Write, Exp-up)}
17274 @end smallexample
17275
17276 @noindent
17277 This comes in handy when you want to see whether a pointer is outside
17278 the data segment's limit (i.e.@: @dfn{garbled}).
17279
17280 @cindex page tables display (MS-DOS)
17281 @item info dos pde
17282 @itemx info dos pte
17283 These two commands display entries from, respectively, the Page
17284 Directory and the Page Tables. Page Directories and Page Tables are
17285 data structures which control how virtual memory addresses are mapped
17286 into physical addresses. A Page Table includes an entry for every
17287 page of memory that is mapped into the program's address space; there
17288 may be several Page Tables, each one holding up to 4096 entries. A
17289 Page Directory has up to 4096 entries, one each for every Page Table
17290 that is currently in use.
17291
17292 Without an argument, @kbd{info dos pde} displays the entire Page
17293 Directory, and @kbd{info dos pte} displays all the entries in all of
17294 the Page Tables. An argument, an integer expression, given to the
17295 @kbd{info dos pde} command means display only that entry from the Page
17296 Directory table. An argument given to the @kbd{info dos pte} command
17297 means display entries from a single Page Table, the one pointed to by
17298 the specified entry in the Page Directory.
17299
17300 @cindex direct memory access (DMA) on MS-DOS
17301 These commands are useful when your program uses @dfn{DMA} (Direct
17302 Memory Access), which needs physical addresses to program the DMA
17303 controller.
17304
17305 These commands are supported only with some DPMI servers.
17306
17307 @cindex physical address from linear address
17308 @item info dos address-pte @var{addr}
17309 This command displays the Page Table entry for a specified linear
17310 address. The argument @var{addr} is a linear address which should
17311 already have the appropriate segment's base address added to it,
17312 because this command accepts addresses which may belong to @emph{any}
17313 segment. For example, here's how to display the Page Table entry for
17314 the page where a variable @code{i} is stored:
17315
17316 @smallexample
17317 @exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos address-pte __djgpp_base_address + (char *)&i}
17318 @exdent @code{Page Table entry for address 0x11a00d30:}
17319 @exdent @code{Base=0x02698000 Dirty Acc. Not-Cached Write-Back Usr Read-Write +0xd30}
17320 @end smallexample
17321
17322 @noindent
17323 This says that @code{i} is stored at offset @code{0xd30} from the page
17324 whose physical base address is @code{0x02698000}, and shows all the
17325 attributes of that page.
17326
17327 Note that you must cast the addresses of variables to a @code{char *},
17328 since otherwise the value of @code{__djgpp_base_address}, the base
17329 address of all variables and functions in a @sc{djgpp} program, will
17330 be added using the rules of C pointer arithmetics: if @code{i} is
17331 declared an @code{int}, @value{GDBN} will add 4 times the value of
17332 @code{__djgpp_base_address} to the address of @code{i}.
17333
17334 Here's another example, it displays the Page Table entry for the
17335 transfer buffer:
17336
17337 @smallexample
17338 @exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos address-pte *((unsigned *)&_go32_info_block + 3)}
17339 @exdent @code{Page Table entry for address 0x29110:}
17340 @exdent @code{Base=0x00029000 Dirty Acc. Not-Cached Write-Back Usr Read-Write +0x110}
17341 @end smallexample
17342
17343 @noindent
17344 (The @code{+ 3} offset is because the transfer buffer's address is the
17345 3rd member of the @code{_go32_info_block} structure.) The output
17346 clearly shows that this DPMI server maps the addresses in conventional
17347 memory 1:1, i.e.@: the physical (@code{0x00029000} + @code{0x110}) and
17348 linear (@code{0x29110}) addresses are identical.
17349
17350 This command is supported only with some DPMI servers.
17351 @end table
17352
17353 @cindex DOS serial data link, remote debugging
17354 In addition to native debugging, the DJGPP port supports remote
17355 debugging via a serial data link. The following commands are specific
17356 to remote serial debugging in the DJGPP port of @value{GDBN}.
17357
17358 @table @code
17359 @kindex set com1base
17360 @kindex set com1irq
17361 @kindex set com2base
17362 @kindex set com2irq
17363 @kindex set com3base
17364 @kindex set com3irq
17365 @kindex set com4base
17366 @kindex set com4irq
17367 @item set com1base @var{addr}
17368 This command sets the base I/O port address of the @file{COM1} serial
17369 port.
17370
17371 @item set com1irq @var{irq}
17372 This command sets the @dfn{Interrupt Request} (@code{IRQ}) line to use
17373 for the @file{COM1} serial port.
17374
17375 There are similar commands @samp{set com2base}, @samp{set com3irq},
17376 etc.@: for setting the port address and the @code{IRQ} lines for the
17377 other 3 COM ports.
17378
17379 @kindex show com1base
17380 @kindex show com1irq
17381 @kindex show com2base
17382 @kindex show com2irq
17383 @kindex show com3base
17384 @kindex show com3irq
17385 @kindex show com4base
17386 @kindex show com4irq
17387 The related commands @samp{show com1base}, @samp{show com1irq} etc.@:
17388 display the current settings of the base address and the @code{IRQ}
17389 lines used by the COM ports.
17390
17391 @item info serial
17392 @kindex info serial
17393 @cindex DOS serial port status
17394 This command prints the status of the 4 DOS serial ports. For each
17395 port, it prints whether it's active or not, its I/O base address and
17396 IRQ number, whether it uses a 16550-style FIFO, its baudrate, and the
17397 counts of various errors encountered so far.
17398 @end table
17399
17400
17401 @node Cygwin Native
17402 @subsection Features for Debugging MS Windows PE Executables
17403 @cindex MS Windows debugging
17404 @cindex native Cygwin debugging
17405 @cindex Cygwin-specific commands
17406
17407 @value{GDBN} supports native debugging of MS Windows programs, including
17408 DLLs with and without symbolic debugging information.
17409
17410 @cindex Ctrl-BREAK, MS-Windows
17411 @cindex interrupt debuggee on MS-Windows
17412 MS-Windows programs that call @code{SetConsoleMode} to switch off the
17413 special meaning of the @samp{Ctrl-C} keystroke cannot be interrupted
17414 by typing @kbd{C-c}. For this reason, @value{GDBN} on MS-Windows
17415 supports @kbd{C-@key{BREAK}} as an alternative interrupt key
17416 sequence, which can be used to interrupt the debuggee even if it
17417 ignores @kbd{C-c}.
17418
17419 There are various additional Cygwin-specific commands, described in
17420 this section. Working with DLLs that have no debugging symbols is
17421 described in @ref{Non-debug DLL Symbols}.
17422
17423 @table @code
17424 @kindex info w32
17425 @item info w32
17426 This is a prefix of MS Windows-specific commands which print
17427 information about the target system and important OS structures.
17428
17429 @item info w32 selector
17430 This command displays information returned by
17431 the Win32 API @code{GetThreadSelectorEntry} function.
17432 It takes an optional argument that is evaluated to
17433 a long value to give the information about this given selector.
17434 Without argument, this command displays information
17435 about the six segment registers.
17436
17437 @item info w32 thread-information-block
17438 This command displays thread specific information stored in the
17439 Thread Information Block (readable on the X86 CPU family using @code{$fs}
17440 selector for 32-bit programs and @code{$gs} for 64-bit programs).
17441
17442 @kindex info dll
17443 @item info dll
17444 This is a Cygwin-specific alias of @code{info shared}.
17445
17446 @kindex dll-symbols
17447 @item dll-symbols
17448 This command loads symbols from a dll similarly to
17449 add-sym command but without the need to specify a base address.
17450
17451 @kindex set cygwin-exceptions
17452 @cindex debugging the Cygwin DLL
17453 @cindex Cygwin DLL, debugging
17454 @item set cygwin-exceptions @var{mode}
17455 If @var{mode} is @code{on}, @value{GDBN} will break on exceptions that
17456 happen inside the Cygwin DLL. If @var{mode} is @code{off},
17457 @value{GDBN} will delay recognition of exceptions, and may ignore some
17458 exceptions which seem to be caused by internal Cygwin DLL
17459 ``bookkeeping''. This option is meant primarily for debugging the
17460 Cygwin DLL itself; the default value is @code{off} to avoid annoying
17461 @value{GDBN} users with false @code{SIGSEGV} signals.
17462
17463 @kindex show cygwin-exceptions
17464 @item show cygwin-exceptions
17465 Displays whether @value{GDBN} will break on exceptions that happen
17466 inside the Cygwin DLL itself.
17467
17468 @kindex set new-console
17469 @item set new-console @var{mode}
17470 If @var{mode} is @code{on} the debuggee will
17471 be started in a new console on next start.
17472 If @var{mode} is @code{off}, the debuggee will
17473 be started in the same console as the debugger.
17474
17475 @kindex show new-console
17476 @item show new-console
17477 Displays whether a new console is used
17478 when the debuggee is started.
17479
17480 @kindex set new-group
17481 @item set new-group @var{mode}
17482 This boolean value controls whether the debuggee should
17483 start a new group or stay in the same group as the debugger.
17484 This affects the way the Windows OS handles
17485 @samp{Ctrl-C}.
17486
17487 @kindex show new-group
17488 @item show new-group
17489 Displays current value of new-group boolean.
17490
17491 @kindex set debugevents
17492 @item set debugevents
17493 This boolean value adds debug output concerning kernel events related
17494 to the debuggee seen by the debugger. This includes events that
17495 signal thread and process creation and exit, DLL loading and
17496 unloading, console interrupts, and debugging messages produced by the
17497 Windows @code{OutputDebugString} API call.
17498
17499 @kindex set debugexec
17500 @item set debugexec
17501 This boolean value adds debug output concerning execute events
17502 (such as resume thread) seen by the debugger.
17503
17504 @kindex set debugexceptions
17505 @item set debugexceptions
17506 This boolean value adds debug output concerning exceptions in the
17507 debuggee seen by the debugger.
17508
17509 @kindex set debugmemory
17510 @item set debugmemory
17511 This boolean value adds debug output concerning debuggee memory reads
17512 and writes by the debugger.
17513
17514 @kindex set shell
17515 @item set shell
17516 This boolean values specifies whether the debuggee is called
17517 via a shell or directly (default value is on).
17518
17519 @kindex show shell
17520 @item show shell
17521 Displays if the debuggee will be started with a shell.
17522
17523 @end table
17524
17525 @menu
17526 * Non-debug DLL Symbols:: Support for DLLs without debugging symbols
17527 @end menu
17528
17529 @node Non-debug DLL Symbols
17530 @subsubsection Support for DLLs without Debugging Symbols
17531 @cindex DLLs with no debugging symbols
17532 @cindex Minimal symbols and DLLs
17533
17534 Very often on windows, some of the DLLs that your program relies on do
17535 not include symbolic debugging information (for example,
17536 @file{kernel32.dll}). When @value{GDBN} doesn't recognize any debugging
17537 symbols in a DLL, it relies on the minimal amount of symbolic
17538 information contained in the DLL's export table. This section
17539 describes working with such symbols, known internally to @value{GDBN} as
17540 ``minimal symbols''.
17541
17542 Note that before the debugged program has started execution, no DLLs
17543 will have been loaded. The easiest way around this problem is simply to
17544 start the program --- either by setting a breakpoint or letting the
17545 program run once to completion. It is also possible to force
17546 @value{GDBN} to load a particular DLL before starting the executable ---
17547 see the shared library information in @ref{Files}, or the
17548 @code{dll-symbols} command in @ref{Cygwin Native}. Currently,
17549 explicitly loading symbols from a DLL with no debugging information will
17550 cause the symbol names to be duplicated in @value{GDBN}'s lookup table,
17551 which may adversely affect symbol lookup performance.
17552
17553 @subsubsection DLL Name Prefixes
17554
17555 In keeping with the naming conventions used by the Microsoft debugging
17556 tools, DLL export symbols are made available with a prefix based on the
17557 DLL name, for instance @code{KERNEL32!CreateFileA}. The plain name is
17558 also entered into the symbol table, so @code{CreateFileA} is often
17559 sufficient. In some cases there will be name clashes within a program
17560 (particularly if the executable itself includes full debugging symbols)
17561 necessitating the use of the fully qualified name when referring to the
17562 contents of the DLL. Use single-quotes around the name to avoid the
17563 exclamation mark (``!'') being interpreted as a language operator.
17564
17565 Note that the internal name of the DLL may be all upper-case, even
17566 though the file name of the DLL is lower-case, or vice-versa. Since
17567 symbols within @value{GDBN} are @emph{case-sensitive} this may cause
17568 some confusion. If in doubt, try the @code{info functions} and
17569 @code{info variables} commands or even @code{maint print msymbols}
17570 (@pxref{Symbols}). Here's an example:
17571
17572 @smallexample
17573 (@value{GDBP}) info function CreateFileA
17574 All functions matching regular expression "CreateFileA":
17575
17576 Non-debugging symbols:
17577 0x77e885f4 CreateFileA
17578 0x77e885f4 KERNEL32!CreateFileA
17579 @end smallexample
17580
17581 @smallexample
17582 (@value{GDBP}) info function !
17583 All functions matching regular expression "!":
17584
17585 Non-debugging symbols:
17586 0x6100114c cygwin1!__assert
17587 0x61004034 cygwin1!_dll_crt0@@0
17588 0x61004240 cygwin1!dll_crt0(per_process *)
17589 [etc...]
17590 @end smallexample
17591
17592 @subsubsection Working with Minimal Symbols
17593
17594 Symbols extracted from a DLL's export table do not contain very much
17595 type information. All that @value{GDBN} can do is guess whether a symbol
17596 refers to a function or variable depending on the linker section that
17597 contains the symbol. Also note that the actual contents of the memory
17598 contained in a DLL are not available unless the program is running. This
17599 means that you cannot examine the contents of a variable or disassemble
17600 a function within a DLL without a running program.
17601
17602 Variables are generally treated as pointers and dereferenced
17603 automatically. For this reason, it is often necessary to prefix a
17604 variable name with the address-of operator (``&'') and provide explicit
17605 type information in the command. Here's an example of the type of
17606 problem:
17607
17608 @smallexample
17609 (@value{GDBP}) print 'cygwin1!__argv'
17610 $1 = 268572168
17611 @end smallexample
17612
17613 @smallexample
17614 (@value{GDBP}) x 'cygwin1!__argv'
17615 0x10021610: "\230y\""
17616 @end smallexample
17617
17618 And two possible solutions:
17619
17620 @smallexample
17621 (@value{GDBP}) print ((char **)'cygwin1!__argv')[0]
17622 $2 = 0x22fd98 "/cygdrive/c/mydirectory/myprogram"
17623 @end smallexample
17624
17625 @smallexample
17626 (@value{GDBP}) x/2x &'cygwin1!__argv'
17627 0x610c0aa8 <cygwin1!__argv>: 0x10021608 0x00000000
17628 (@value{GDBP}) x/x 0x10021608
17629 0x10021608: 0x0022fd98
17630 (@value{GDBP}) x/s 0x0022fd98
17631 0x22fd98: "/cygdrive/c/mydirectory/myprogram"
17632 @end smallexample
17633
17634 Setting a break point within a DLL is possible even before the program
17635 starts execution. However, under these circumstances, @value{GDBN} can't
17636 examine the initial instructions of the function in order to skip the
17637 function's frame set-up code. You can work around this by using ``*&''
17638 to set the breakpoint at a raw memory address:
17639
17640 @smallexample
17641 (@value{GDBP}) break *&'python22!PyOS_Readline'
17642 Breakpoint 1 at 0x1e04eff0
17643 @end smallexample
17644
17645 The author of these extensions is not entirely convinced that setting a
17646 break point within a shared DLL like @file{kernel32.dll} is completely
17647 safe.
17648
17649 @node Hurd Native
17650 @subsection Commands Specific to @sc{gnu} Hurd Systems
17651 @cindex @sc{gnu} Hurd debugging
17652
17653 This subsection describes @value{GDBN} commands specific to the
17654 @sc{gnu} Hurd native debugging.
17655
17656 @table @code
17657 @item set signals
17658 @itemx set sigs
17659 @kindex set signals@r{, Hurd command}
17660 @kindex set sigs@r{, Hurd command}
17661 This command toggles the state of inferior signal interception by
17662 @value{GDBN}. Mach exceptions, such as breakpoint traps, are not
17663 affected by this command. @code{sigs} is a shorthand alias for
17664 @code{signals}.
17665
17666 @item show signals
17667 @itemx show sigs
17668 @kindex show signals@r{, Hurd command}
17669 @kindex show sigs@r{, Hurd command}
17670 Show the current state of intercepting inferior's signals.
17671
17672 @item set signal-thread
17673 @itemx set sigthread
17674 @kindex set signal-thread
17675 @kindex set sigthread
17676 This command tells @value{GDBN} which thread is the @code{libc} signal
17677 thread. That thread is run when a signal is delivered to a running
17678 process. @code{set sigthread} is the shorthand alias of @code{set
17679 signal-thread}.
17680
17681 @item show signal-thread
17682 @itemx show sigthread
17683 @kindex show signal-thread
17684 @kindex show sigthread
17685 These two commands show which thread will run when the inferior is
17686 delivered a signal.
17687
17688 @item set stopped
17689 @kindex set stopped@r{, Hurd command}
17690 This commands tells @value{GDBN} that the inferior process is stopped,
17691 as with the @code{SIGSTOP} signal. The stopped process can be
17692 continued by delivering a signal to it.
17693
17694 @item show stopped
17695 @kindex show stopped@r{, Hurd command}
17696 This command shows whether @value{GDBN} thinks the debuggee is
17697 stopped.
17698
17699 @item set exceptions
17700 @kindex set exceptions@r{, Hurd command}
17701 Use this command to turn off trapping of exceptions in the inferior.
17702 When exception trapping is off, neither breakpoints nor
17703 single-stepping will work. To restore the default, set exception
17704 trapping on.
17705
17706 @item show exceptions
17707 @kindex show exceptions@r{, Hurd command}
17708 Show the current state of trapping exceptions in the inferior.
17709
17710 @item set task pause
17711 @kindex set task@r{, Hurd commands}
17712 @cindex task attributes (@sc{gnu} Hurd)
17713 @cindex pause current task (@sc{gnu} Hurd)
17714 This command toggles task suspension when @value{GDBN} has control.
17715 Setting it to on takes effect immediately, and the task is suspended
17716 whenever @value{GDBN} gets control. Setting it to off will take
17717 effect the next time the inferior is continued. If this option is set
17718 to off, you can use @code{set thread default pause on} or @code{set
17719 thread pause on} (see below) to pause individual threads.
17720
17721 @item show task pause
17722 @kindex show task@r{, Hurd commands}
17723 Show the current state of task suspension.
17724
17725 @item set task detach-suspend-count
17726 @cindex task suspend count
17727 @cindex detach from task, @sc{gnu} Hurd
17728 This command sets the suspend count the task will be left with when
17729 @value{GDBN} detaches from it.
17730
17731 @item show task detach-suspend-count
17732 Show the suspend count the task will be left with when detaching.
17733
17734 @item set task exception-port
17735 @itemx set task excp
17736 @cindex task exception port, @sc{gnu} Hurd
17737 This command sets the task exception port to which @value{GDBN} will
17738 forward exceptions. The argument should be the value of the @dfn{send
17739 rights} of the task. @code{set task excp} is a shorthand alias.
17740
17741 @item set noninvasive
17742 @cindex noninvasive task options
17743 This command switches @value{GDBN} to a mode that is the least
17744 invasive as far as interfering with the inferior is concerned. This
17745 is the same as using @code{set task pause}, @code{set exceptions}, and
17746 @code{set signals} to values opposite to the defaults.
17747
17748 @item info send-rights
17749 @itemx info receive-rights
17750 @itemx info port-rights
17751 @itemx info port-sets
17752 @itemx info dead-names
17753 @itemx info ports
17754 @itemx info psets
17755 @cindex send rights, @sc{gnu} Hurd
17756 @cindex receive rights, @sc{gnu} Hurd
17757 @cindex port rights, @sc{gnu} Hurd
17758 @cindex port sets, @sc{gnu} Hurd
17759 @cindex dead names, @sc{gnu} Hurd
17760 These commands display information about, respectively, send rights,
17761 receive rights, port rights, port sets, and dead names of a task.
17762 There are also shorthand aliases: @code{info ports} for @code{info
17763 port-rights} and @code{info psets} for @code{info port-sets}.
17764
17765 @item set thread pause
17766 @kindex set thread@r{, Hurd command}
17767 @cindex thread properties, @sc{gnu} Hurd
17768 @cindex pause current thread (@sc{gnu} Hurd)
17769 This command toggles current thread suspension when @value{GDBN} has
17770 control. Setting it to on takes effect immediately, and the current
17771 thread is suspended whenever @value{GDBN} gets control. Setting it to
17772 off will take effect the next time the inferior is continued.
17773 Normally, this command has no effect, since when @value{GDBN} has
17774 control, the whole task is suspended. However, if you used @code{set
17775 task pause off} (see above), this command comes in handy to suspend
17776 only the current thread.
17777
17778 @item show thread pause
17779 @kindex show thread@r{, Hurd command}
17780 This command shows the state of current thread suspension.
17781
17782 @item set thread run
17783 This command sets whether the current thread is allowed to run.
17784
17785 @item show thread run
17786 Show whether the current thread is allowed to run.
17787
17788 @item set thread detach-suspend-count
17789 @cindex thread suspend count, @sc{gnu} Hurd
17790 @cindex detach from thread, @sc{gnu} Hurd
17791 This command sets the suspend count @value{GDBN} will leave on a
17792 thread when detaching. This number is relative to the suspend count
17793 found by @value{GDBN} when it notices the thread; use @code{set thread
17794 takeover-suspend-count} to force it to an absolute value.
17795
17796 @item show thread detach-suspend-count
17797 Show the suspend count @value{GDBN} will leave on the thread when
17798 detaching.
17799
17800 @item set thread exception-port
17801 @itemx set thread excp
17802 Set the thread exception port to which to forward exceptions. This
17803 overrides the port set by @code{set task exception-port} (see above).
17804 @code{set thread excp} is the shorthand alias.
17805
17806 @item set thread takeover-suspend-count
17807 Normally, @value{GDBN}'s thread suspend counts are relative to the
17808 value @value{GDBN} finds when it notices each thread. This command
17809 changes the suspend counts to be absolute instead.
17810
17811 @item set thread default
17812 @itemx show thread default
17813 @cindex thread default settings, @sc{gnu} Hurd
17814 Each of the above @code{set thread} commands has a @code{set thread
17815 default} counterpart (e.g., @code{set thread default pause}, @code{set
17816 thread default exception-port}, etc.). The @code{thread default}
17817 variety of commands sets the default thread properties for all
17818 threads; you can then change the properties of individual threads with
17819 the non-default commands.
17820 @end table
17821
17822
17823 @node Neutrino
17824 @subsection QNX Neutrino
17825 @cindex QNX Neutrino
17826
17827 @value{GDBN} provides the following commands specific to the QNX
17828 Neutrino target:
17829
17830 @table @code
17831 @item set debug nto-debug
17832 @kindex set debug nto-debug
17833 When set to on, enables debugging messages specific to the QNX
17834 Neutrino support.
17835
17836 @item show debug nto-debug
17837 @kindex show debug nto-debug
17838 Show the current state of QNX Neutrino messages.
17839 @end table
17840
17841 @node Darwin
17842 @subsection Darwin
17843 @cindex Darwin
17844
17845 @value{GDBN} provides the following commands specific to the Darwin target:
17846
17847 @table @code
17848 @item set debug darwin @var{num}
17849 @kindex set debug darwin
17850 When set to a non zero value, enables debugging messages specific to
17851 the Darwin support. Higher values produce more verbose output.
17852
17853 @item show debug darwin
17854 @kindex show debug darwin
17855 Show the current state of Darwin messages.
17856
17857 @item set debug mach-o @var{num}
17858 @kindex set debug mach-o
17859 When set to a non zero value, enables debugging messages while
17860 @value{GDBN} is reading Darwin object files. (@dfn{Mach-O} is the
17861 file format used on Darwin for object and executable files.) Higher
17862 values produce more verbose output. This is a command to diagnose
17863 problems internal to @value{GDBN} and should not be needed in normal
17864 usage.
17865
17866 @item show debug mach-o
17867 @kindex show debug mach-o
17868 Show the current state of Mach-O file messages.
17869
17870 @item set mach-exceptions on
17871 @itemx set mach-exceptions off
17872 @kindex set mach-exceptions
17873 On Darwin, faults are first reported as a Mach exception and are then
17874 mapped to a Posix signal. Use this command to turn on trapping of
17875 Mach exceptions in the inferior. This might be sometimes useful to
17876 better understand the cause of a fault. The default is off.
17877
17878 @item show mach-exceptions
17879 @kindex show mach-exceptions
17880 Show the current state of exceptions trapping.
17881 @end table
17882
17883
17884 @node Embedded OS
17885 @section Embedded Operating Systems
17886
17887 This section describes configurations involving the debugging of
17888 embedded operating systems that are available for several different
17889 architectures.
17890
17891 @menu
17892 * VxWorks:: Using @value{GDBN} with VxWorks
17893 @end menu
17894
17895 @value{GDBN} includes the ability to debug programs running on
17896 various real-time operating systems.
17897
17898 @node VxWorks
17899 @subsection Using @value{GDBN} with VxWorks
17900
17901 @cindex VxWorks
17902
17903 @table @code
17904
17905 @kindex target vxworks
17906 @item target vxworks @var{machinename}
17907 A VxWorks system, attached via TCP/IP. The argument @var{machinename}
17908 is the target system's machine name or IP address.
17909
17910 @end table
17911
17912 On VxWorks, @code{load} links @var{filename} dynamically on the
17913 current target system as well as adding its symbols in @value{GDBN}.
17914
17915 @value{GDBN} enables developers to spawn and debug tasks running on networked
17916 VxWorks targets from a Unix host. Already-running tasks spawned from
17917 the VxWorks shell can also be debugged. @value{GDBN} uses code that runs on
17918 both the Unix host and on the VxWorks target. The program
17919 @code{@value{GDBP}} is installed and executed on the Unix host. (It may be
17920 installed with the name @code{vxgdb}, to distinguish it from a
17921 @value{GDBN} for debugging programs on the host itself.)
17922
17923 @table @code
17924 @item VxWorks-timeout @var{args}
17925 @kindex vxworks-timeout
17926 All VxWorks-based targets now support the option @code{vxworks-timeout}.
17927 This option is set by the user, and @var{args} represents the number of
17928 seconds @value{GDBN} waits for responses to rpc's. You might use this if
17929 your VxWorks target is a slow software simulator or is on the far side
17930 of a thin network line.
17931 @end table
17932
17933 The following information on connecting to VxWorks was current when
17934 this manual was produced; newer releases of VxWorks may use revised
17935 procedures.
17936
17937 @findex INCLUDE_RDB
17938 To use @value{GDBN} with VxWorks, you must rebuild your VxWorks kernel
17939 to include the remote debugging interface routines in the VxWorks
17940 library @file{rdb.a}. To do this, define @code{INCLUDE_RDB} in the
17941 VxWorks configuration file @file{configAll.h} and rebuild your VxWorks
17942 kernel. The resulting kernel contains @file{rdb.a}, and spawns the
17943 source debugging task @code{tRdbTask} when VxWorks is booted. For more
17944 information on configuring and remaking VxWorks, see the manufacturer's
17945 manual.
17946 @c VxWorks, see the @cite{VxWorks Programmer's Guide}.
17947
17948 Once you have included @file{rdb.a} in your VxWorks system image and set
17949 your Unix execution search path to find @value{GDBN}, you are ready to
17950 run @value{GDBN}. From your Unix host, run @code{@value{GDBP}} (or
17951 @code{vxgdb}, depending on your installation).
17952
17953 @value{GDBN} comes up showing the prompt:
17954
17955 @smallexample
17956 (vxgdb)
17957 @end smallexample
17958
17959 @menu
17960 * VxWorks Connection:: Connecting to VxWorks
17961 * VxWorks Download:: VxWorks download
17962 * VxWorks Attach:: Running tasks
17963 @end menu
17964
17965 @node VxWorks Connection
17966 @subsubsection Connecting to VxWorks
17967
17968 The @value{GDBN} command @code{target} lets you connect to a VxWorks target on the
17969 network. To connect to a target whose host name is ``@code{tt}'', type:
17970
17971 @smallexample
17972 (vxgdb) target vxworks tt
17973 @end smallexample
17974
17975 @need 750
17976 @value{GDBN} displays messages like these:
17977
17978 @smallexample
17979 Attaching remote machine across net...
17980 Connected to tt.
17981 @end smallexample
17982
17983 @need 1000
17984 @value{GDBN} then attempts to read the symbol tables of any object modules
17985 loaded into the VxWorks target since it was last booted. @value{GDBN} locates
17986 these files by searching the directories listed in the command search
17987 path (@pxref{Environment, ,Your Program's Environment}); if it fails
17988 to find an object file, it displays a message such as:
17989
17990 @smallexample
17991 prog.o: No such file or directory.
17992 @end smallexample
17993
17994 When this happens, add the appropriate directory to the search path with
17995 the @value{GDBN} command @code{path}, and execute the @code{target}
17996 command again.
17997
17998 @node VxWorks Download
17999 @subsubsection VxWorks Download
18000
18001 @cindex download to VxWorks
18002 If you have connected to the VxWorks target and you want to debug an
18003 object that has not yet been loaded, you can use the @value{GDBN}
18004 @code{load} command to download a file from Unix to VxWorks
18005 incrementally. The object file given as an argument to the @code{load}
18006 command is actually opened twice: first by the VxWorks target in order
18007 to download the code, then by @value{GDBN} in order to read the symbol
18008 table. This can lead to problems if the current working directories on
18009 the two systems differ. If both systems have NFS mounted the same
18010 filesystems, you can avoid these problems by using absolute paths.
18011 Otherwise, it is simplest to set the working directory on both systems
18012 to the directory in which the object file resides, and then to reference
18013 the file by its name, without any path. For instance, a program
18014 @file{prog.o} may reside in @file{@var{vxpath}/vw/demo/rdb} in VxWorks
18015 and in @file{@var{hostpath}/vw/demo/rdb} on the host. To load this
18016 program, type this on VxWorks:
18017
18018 @smallexample
18019 -> cd "@var{vxpath}/vw/demo/rdb"
18020 @end smallexample
18021
18022 @noindent
18023 Then, in @value{GDBN}, type:
18024
18025 @smallexample
18026 (vxgdb) cd @var{hostpath}/vw/demo/rdb
18027 (vxgdb) load prog.o
18028 @end smallexample
18029
18030 @value{GDBN} displays a response similar to this:
18031
18032 @smallexample
18033 Reading symbol data from wherever/vw/demo/rdb/prog.o... done.
18034 @end smallexample
18035
18036 You can also use the @code{load} command to reload an object module
18037 after editing and recompiling the corresponding source file. Note that
18038 this makes @value{GDBN} delete all currently-defined breakpoints,
18039 auto-displays, and convenience variables, and to clear the value
18040 history. (This is necessary in order to preserve the integrity of
18041 debugger's data structures that reference the target system's symbol
18042 table.)
18043
18044 @node VxWorks Attach
18045 @subsubsection Running Tasks
18046
18047 @cindex running VxWorks tasks
18048 You can also attach to an existing task using the @code{attach} command as
18049 follows:
18050
18051 @smallexample
18052 (vxgdb) attach @var{task}
18053 @end smallexample
18054
18055 @noindent
18056 where @var{task} is the VxWorks hexadecimal task ID. The task can be running
18057 or suspended when you attach to it. Running tasks are suspended at
18058 the time of attachment.
18059
18060 @node Embedded Processors
18061 @section Embedded Processors
18062
18063 This section goes into details specific to particular embedded
18064 configurations.
18065
18066 @cindex send command to simulator
18067 Whenever a specific embedded processor has a simulator, @value{GDBN}
18068 allows to send an arbitrary command to the simulator.
18069
18070 @table @code
18071 @item sim @var{command}
18072 @kindex sim@r{, a command}
18073 Send an arbitrary @var{command} string to the simulator. Consult the
18074 documentation for the specific simulator in use for information about
18075 acceptable commands.
18076 @end table
18077
18078
18079 @menu
18080 * ARM:: ARM RDI
18081 * M32R/D:: Renesas M32R/D
18082 * M68K:: Motorola M68K
18083 * MicroBlaze:: Xilinx MicroBlaze
18084 * MIPS Embedded:: MIPS Embedded
18085 * OpenRISC 1000:: OpenRisc 1000
18086 * PA:: HP PA Embedded
18087 * PowerPC Embedded:: PowerPC Embedded
18088 * Sparclet:: Tsqware Sparclet
18089 * Sparclite:: Fujitsu Sparclite
18090 * Z8000:: Zilog Z8000
18091 * AVR:: Atmel AVR
18092 * CRIS:: CRIS
18093 * Super-H:: Renesas Super-H
18094 @end menu
18095
18096 @node ARM
18097 @subsection ARM
18098 @cindex ARM RDI
18099
18100 @table @code
18101 @kindex target rdi
18102 @item target rdi @var{dev}
18103 ARM Angel monitor, via RDI library interface to ADP protocol. You may
18104 use this target to communicate with both boards running the Angel
18105 monitor, or with the EmbeddedICE JTAG debug device.
18106
18107 @kindex target rdp
18108 @item target rdp @var{dev}
18109 ARM Demon monitor.
18110
18111 @end table
18112
18113 @value{GDBN} provides the following ARM-specific commands:
18114
18115 @table @code
18116 @item set arm disassembler
18117 @kindex set arm
18118 This commands selects from a list of disassembly styles. The
18119 @code{"std"} style is the standard style.
18120
18121 @item show arm disassembler
18122 @kindex show arm
18123 Show the current disassembly style.
18124
18125 @item set arm apcs32
18126 @cindex ARM 32-bit mode
18127 This command toggles ARM operation mode between 32-bit and 26-bit.
18128
18129 @item show arm apcs32
18130 Display the current usage of the ARM 32-bit mode.
18131
18132 @item set arm fpu @var{fputype}
18133 This command sets the ARM floating-point unit (FPU) type. The
18134 argument @var{fputype} can be one of these:
18135
18136 @table @code
18137 @item auto
18138 Determine the FPU type by querying the OS ABI.
18139 @item softfpa
18140 Software FPU, with mixed-endian doubles on little-endian ARM
18141 processors.
18142 @item fpa
18143 GCC-compiled FPA co-processor.
18144 @item softvfp
18145 Software FPU with pure-endian doubles.
18146 @item vfp
18147 VFP co-processor.
18148 @end table
18149
18150 @item show arm fpu
18151 Show the current type of the FPU.
18152
18153 @item set arm abi
18154 This command forces @value{GDBN} to use the specified ABI.
18155
18156 @item show arm abi
18157 Show the currently used ABI.
18158
18159 @item set arm fallback-mode (arm|thumb|auto)
18160 @value{GDBN} uses the symbol table, when available, to determine
18161 whether instructions are ARM or Thumb. This command controls
18162 @value{GDBN}'s default behavior when the symbol table is not
18163 available. The default is @samp{auto}, which causes @value{GDBN} to
18164 use the current execution mode (from the @code{T} bit in the @code{CPSR}
18165 register).
18166
18167 @item show arm fallback-mode
18168 Show the current fallback instruction mode.
18169
18170 @item set arm force-mode (arm|thumb|auto)
18171 This command overrides use of the symbol table to determine whether
18172 instructions are ARM or Thumb. The default is @samp{auto}, which
18173 causes @value{GDBN} to use the symbol table and then the setting
18174 of @samp{set arm fallback-mode}.
18175
18176 @item show arm force-mode
18177 Show the current forced instruction mode.
18178
18179 @item set debug arm
18180 Toggle whether to display ARM-specific debugging messages from the ARM
18181 target support subsystem.
18182
18183 @item show debug arm
18184 Show whether ARM-specific debugging messages are enabled.
18185 @end table
18186
18187 The following commands are available when an ARM target is debugged
18188 using the RDI interface:
18189
18190 @table @code
18191 @item rdilogfile @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
18192 @kindex rdilogfile
18193 @cindex ADP (Angel Debugger Protocol) logging
18194 Set the filename for the ADP (Angel Debugger Protocol) packet log.
18195 With an argument, sets the log file to the specified @var{file}. With
18196 no argument, show the current log file name. The default log file is
18197 @file{rdi.log}.
18198
18199 @item rdilogenable @r{[}@var{arg}@r{]}
18200 @kindex rdilogenable
18201 Control logging of ADP packets. With an argument of 1 or @code{"yes"}
18202 enables logging, with an argument 0 or @code{"no"} disables it. With
18203 no arguments displays the current setting. When logging is enabled,
18204 ADP packets exchanged between @value{GDBN} and the RDI target device
18205 are logged to a file.
18206
18207 @item set rdiromatzero
18208 @kindex set rdiromatzero
18209 @cindex ROM at zero address, RDI
18210 Tell @value{GDBN} whether the target has ROM at address 0. If on,
18211 vector catching is disabled, so that zero address can be used. If off
18212 (the default), vector catching is enabled. For this command to take
18213 effect, it needs to be invoked prior to the @code{target rdi} command.
18214
18215 @item show rdiromatzero
18216 @kindex show rdiromatzero
18217 Show the current setting of ROM at zero address.
18218
18219 @item set rdiheartbeat
18220 @kindex set rdiheartbeat
18221 @cindex RDI heartbeat
18222 Enable or disable RDI heartbeat packets. It is not recommended to
18223 turn on this option, since it confuses ARM and EPI JTAG interface, as
18224 well as the Angel monitor.
18225
18226 @item show rdiheartbeat
18227 @kindex show rdiheartbeat
18228 Show the setting of RDI heartbeat packets.
18229 @end table
18230
18231 @table @code
18232 @item target sim @r{[}@var{simargs}@r{]} @dots{}
18233 The @value{GDBN} ARM simulator accepts the following optional arguments.
18234
18235 @table @code
18236 @item --swi-support=@var{type}
18237 Tell the simulator which SWI interfaces to support.
18238 @var{type} may be a comma separated list of the following values.
18239 The default value is @code{all}.
18240
18241 @table @code
18242 @item none
18243 @item demon
18244 @item angel
18245 @item redboot
18246 @item all
18247 @end table
18248 @end table
18249 @end table
18250
18251 @node M32R/D
18252 @subsection Renesas M32R/D and M32R/SDI
18253
18254 @table @code
18255 @kindex target m32r
18256 @item target m32r @var{dev}
18257 Renesas M32R/D ROM monitor.
18258
18259 @kindex target m32rsdi
18260 @item target m32rsdi @var{dev}
18261 Renesas M32R SDI server, connected via parallel port to the board.
18262 @end table
18263
18264 The following @value{GDBN} commands are specific to the M32R monitor:
18265
18266 @table @code
18267 @item set download-path @var{path}
18268 @kindex set download-path
18269 @cindex find downloadable @sc{srec} files (M32R)
18270 Set the default path for finding downloadable @sc{srec} files.
18271
18272 @item show download-path
18273 @kindex show download-path
18274 Show the default path for downloadable @sc{srec} files.
18275
18276 @item set board-address @var{addr}
18277 @kindex set board-address
18278 @cindex M32-EVA target board address
18279 Set the IP address for the M32R-EVA target board.
18280
18281 @item show board-address
18282 @kindex show board-address
18283 Show the current IP address of the target board.
18284
18285 @item set server-address @var{addr}
18286 @kindex set server-address
18287 @cindex download server address (M32R)
18288 Set the IP address for the download server, which is the @value{GDBN}'s
18289 host machine.
18290
18291 @item show server-address
18292 @kindex show server-address
18293 Display the IP address of the download server.
18294
18295 @item upload @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
18296 @kindex upload@r{, M32R}
18297 Upload the specified @sc{srec} @var{file} via the monitor's Ethernet
18298 upload capability. If no @var{file} argument is given, the current
18299 executable file is uploaded.
18300
18301 @item tload @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
18302 @kindex tload@r{, M32R}
18303 Test the @code{upload} command.
18304 @end table
18305
18306 The following commands are available for M32R/SDI:
18307
18308 @table @code
18309 @item sdireset
18310 @kindex sdireset
18311 @cindex reset SDI connection, M32R
18312 This command resets the SDI connection.
18313
18314 @item sdistatus
18315 @kindex sdistatus
18316 This command shows the SDI connection status.
18317
18318 @item debug_chaos
18319 @kindex debug_chaos
18320 @cindex M32R/Chaos debugging
18321 Instructs the remote that M32R/Chaos debugging is to be used.
18322
18323 @item use_debug_dma
18324 @kindex use_debug_dma
18325 Instructs the remote to use the DEBUG_DMA method of accessing memory.
18326
18327 @item use_mon_code
18328 @kindex use_mon_code
18329 Instructs the remote to use the MON_CODE method of accessing memory.
18330
18331 @item use_ib_break
18332 @kindex use_ib_break
18333 Instructs the remote to set breakpoints by IB break.
18334
18335 @item use_dbt_break
18336 @kindex use_dbt_break
18337 Instructs the remote to set breakpoints by DBT.
18338 @end table
18339
18340 @node M68K
18341 @subsection M68k
18342
18343 The Motorola m68k configuration includes ColdFire support, and a
18344 target command for the following ROM monitor.
18345
18346 @table @code
18347
18348 @kindex target dbug
18349 @item target dbug @var{dev}
18350 dBUG ROM monitor for Motorola ColdFire.
18351
18352 @end table
18353
18354 @node MicroBlaze
18355 @subsection MicroBlaze
18356 @cindex Xilinx MicroBlaze
18357 @cindex XMD, Xilinx Microprocessor Debugger
18358
18359 The MicroBlaze is a soft-core processor supported on various Xilinx
18360 FPGAs, such as Spartan or Virtex series. Boards with these processors
18361 usually have JTAG ports which connect to a host system running the Xilinx
18362 Embedded Development Kit (EDK) or Software Development Kit (SDK).
18363 This host system is used to download the configuration bitstream to
18364 the target FPGA. The Xilinx Microprocessor Debugger (XMD) program
18365 communicates with the target board using the JTAG interface and
18366 presents a @code{gdbserver} interface to the board. By default
18367 @code{xmd} uses port @code{1234}. (While it is possible to change
18368 this default port, it requires the use of undocumented @code{xmd}
18369 commands. Contact Xilinx support if you need to do this.)
18370
18371 Use these GDB commands to connect to the MicroBlaze target processor.
18372
18373 @table @code
18374 @item target remote :1234
18375 Use this command to connect to the target if you are running @value{GDBN}
18376 on the same system as @code{xmd}.
18377
18378 @item target remote @var{xmd-host}:1234
18379 Use this command to connect to the target if it is connected to @code{xmd}
18380 running on a different system named @var{xmd-host}.
18381
18382 @item load
18383 Use this command to download a program to the MicroBlaze target.
18384
18385 @item set debug microblaze @var{n}
18386 Enable MicroBlaze-specific debugging messages if non-zero.
18387
18388 @item show debug microblaze @var{n}
18389 Show MicroBlaze-specific debugging level.
18390 @end table
18391
18392 @node MIPS Embedded
18393 @subsection MIPS Embedded
18394
18395 @cindex MIPS boards
18396 @value{GDBN} can use the MIPS remote debugging protocol to talk to a
18397 MIPS board attached to a serial line. This is available when
18398 you configure @value{GDBN} with @samp{--target=mips-idt-ecoff}.
18399
18400 @need 1000
18401 Use these @value{GDBN} commands to specify the connection to your target board:
18402
18403 @table @code
18404 @item target mips @var{port}
18405 @kindex target mips @var{port}
18406 To run a program on the board, start up @code{@value{GDBP}} with the
18407 name of your program as the argument. To connect to the board, use the
18408 command @samp{target mips @var{port}}, where @var{port} is the name of
18409 the serial port connected to the board. If the program has not already
18410 been downloaded to the board, you may use the @code{load} command to
18411 download it. You can then use all the usual @value{GDBN} commands.
18412
18413 For example, this sequence connects to the target board through a serial
18414 port, and loads and runs a program called @var{prog} through the
18415 debugger:
18416
18417 @smallexample
18418 host$ @value{GDBP} @var{prog}
18419 @value{GDBN} is free software and @dots{}
18420 (@value{GDBP}) target mips /dev/ttyb
18421 (@value{GDBP}) load @var{prog}
18422 (@value{GDBP}) run
18423 @end smallexample
18424
18425 @item target mips @var{hostname}:@var{portnumber}
18426 On some @value{GDBN} host configurations, you can specify a TCP
18427 connection (for instance, to a serial line managed by a terminal
18428 concentrator) instead of a serial port, using the syntax
18429 @samp{@var{hostname}:@var{portnumber}}.
18430
18431 @item target pmon @var{port}
18432 @kindex target pmon @var{port}
18433 PMON ROM monitor.
18434
18435 @item target ddb @var{port}
18436 @kindex target ddb @var{port}
18437 NEC's DDB variant of PMON for Vr4300.
18438
18439 @item target lsi @var{port}
18440 @kindex target lsi @var{port}
18441 LSI variant of PMON.
18442
18443 @kindex target r3900
18444 @item target r3900 @var{dev}
18445 Densan DVE-R3900 ROM monitor for Toshiba R3900 Mips.
18446
18447 @kindex target array
18448 @item target array @var{dev}
18449 Array Tech LSI33K RAID controller board.
18450
18451 @end table
18452
18453
18454 @noindent
18455 @value{GDBN} also supports these special commands for MIPS targets:
18456
18457 @table @code
18458 @item set mipsfpu double
18459 @itemx set mipsfpu single
18460 @itemx set mipsfpu none
18461 @itemx set mipsfpu auto
18462 @itemx show mipsfpu
18463 @kindex set mipsfpu
18464 @kindex show mipsfpu
18465 @cindex MIPS remote floating point
18466 @cindex floating point, MIPS remote
18467 If your target board does not support the MIPS floating point
18468 coprocessor, you should use the command @samp{set mipsfpu none} (if you
18469 need this, you may wish to put the command in your @value{GDBN} init
18470 file). This tells @value{GDBN} how to find the return value of
18471 functions which return floating point values. It also allows
18472 @value{GDBN} to avoid saving the floating point registers when calling
18473 functions on the board. If you are using a floating point coprocessor
18474 with only single precision floating point support, as on the @sc{r4650}
18475 processor, use the command @samp{set mipsfpu single}. The default
18476 double precision floating point coprocessor may be selected using
18477 @samp{set mipsfpu double}.
18478
18479 In previous versions the only choices were double precision or no
18480 floating point, so @samp{set mipsfpu on} will select double precision
18481 and @samp{set mipsfpu off} will select no floating point.
18482
18483 As usual, you can inquire about the @code{mipsfpu} variable with
18484 @samp{show mipsfpu}.
18485
18486 @item set timeout @var{seconds}
18487 @itemx set retransmit-timeout @var{seconds}
18488 @itemx show timeout
18489 @itemx show retransmit-timeout
18490 @cindex @code{timeout}, MIPS protocol
18491 @cindex @code{retransmit-timeout}, MIPS protocol
18492 @kindex set timeout
18493 @kindex show timeout
18494 @kindex set retransmit-timeout
18495 @kindex show retransmit-timeout
18496 You can control the timeout used while waiting for a packet, in the MIPS
18497 remote protocol, with the @code{set timeout @var{seconds}} command. The
18498 default is 5 seconds. Similarly, you can control the timeout used while
18499 waiting for an acknowledgment of a packet with the @code{set
18500 retransmit-timeout @var{seconds}} command. The default is 3 seconds.
18501 You can inspect both values with @code{show timeout} and @code{show
18502 retransmit-timeout}. (These commands are @emph{only} available when
18503 @value{GDBN} is configured for @samp{--target=mips-idt-ecoff}.)
18504
18505 The timeout set by @code{set timeout} does not apply when @value{GDBN}
18506 is waiting for your program to stop. In that case, @value{GDBN} waits
18507 forever because it has no way of knowing how long the program is going
18508 to run before stopping.
18509
18510 @item set syn-garbage-limit @var{num}
18511 @kindex set syn-garbage-limit@r{, MIPS remote}
18512 @cindex synchronize with remote MIPS target
18513 Limit the maximum number of characters @value{GDBN} should ignore when
18514 it tries to synchronize with the remote target. The default is 10
18515 characters. Setting the limit to -1 means there's no limit.
18516
18517 @item show syn-garbage-limit
18518 @kindex show syn-garbage-limit@r{, MIPS remote}
18519 Show the current limit on the number of characters to ignore when
18520 trying to synchronize with the remote system.
18521
18522 @item set monitor-prompt @var{prompt}
18523 @kindex set monitor-prompt@r{, MIPS remote}
18524 @cindex remote monitor prompt
18525 Tell @value{GDBN} to expect the specified @var{prompt} string from the
18526 remote monitor. The default depends on the target:
18527 @table @asis
18528 @item pmon target
18529 @samp{PMON}
18530 @item ddb target
18531 @samp{NEC010}
18532 @item lsi target
18533 @samp{PMON>}
18534 @end table
18535
18536 @item show monitor-prompt
18537 @kindex show monitor-prompt@r{, MIPS remote}
18538 Show the current strings @value{GDBN} expects as the prompt from the
18539 remote monitor.
18540
18541 @item set monitor-warnings
18542 @kindex set monitor-warnings@r{, MIPS remote}
18543 Enable or disable monitor warnings about hardware breakpoints. This
18544 has effect only for the @code{lsi} target. When on, @value{GDBN} will
18545 display warning messages whose codes are returned by the @code{lsi}
18546 PMON monitor for breakpoint commands.
18547
18548 @item show monitor-warnings
18549 @kindex show monitor-warnings@r{, MIPS remote}
18550 Show the current setting of printing monitor warnings.
18551
18552 @item pmon @var{command}
18553 @kindex pmon@r{, MIPS remote}
18554 @cindex send PMON command
18555 This command allows sending an arbitrary @var{command} string to the
18556 monitor. The monitor must be in debug mode for this to work.
18557 @end table
18558
18559 @node OpenRISC 1000
18560 @subsection OpenRISC 1000
18561 @cindex OpenRISC 1000
18562
18563 @cindex or1k boards
18564 See OR1k Architecture document (@uref{www.opencores.org}) for more information
18565 about platform and commands.
18566
18567 @table @code
18568
18569 @kindex target jtag
18570 @item target jtag jtag://@var{host}:@var{port}
18571
18572 Connects to remote JTAG server.
18573 JTAG remote server can be either an or1ksim or JTAG server,
18574 connected via parallel port to the board.
18575
18576 Example: @code{target jtag jtag://localhost:9999}
18577
18578 @kindex or1ksim
18579 @item or1ksim @var{command}
18580 If connected to @code{or1ksim} OpenRISC 1000 Architectural
18581 Simulator, proprietary commands can be executed.
18582
18583 @kindex info or1k spr
18584 @item info or1k spr
18585 Displays spr groups.
18586
18587 @item info or1k spr @var{group}
18588 @itemx info or1k spr @var{groupno}
18589 Displays register names in selected group.
18590
18591 @item info or1k spr @var{group} @var{register}
18592 @itemx info or1k spr @var{register}
18593 @itemx info or1k spr @var{groupno} @var{registerno}
18594 @itemx info or1k spr @var{registerno}
18595 Shows information about specified spr register.
18596
18597 @kindex spr
18598 @item spr @var{group} @var{register} @var{value}
18599 @itemx spr @var{register @var{value}}
18600 @itemx spr @var{groupno} @var{registerno @var{value}}
18601 @itemx spr @var{registerno @var{value}}
18602 Writes @var{value} to specified spr register.
18603 @end table
18604
18605 Some implementations of OpenRISC 1000 Architecture also have hardware trace.
18606 It is very similar to @value{GDBN} trace, except it does not interfere with normal
18607 program execution and is thus much faster. Hardware breakpoints/watchpoint
18608 triggers can be set using:
18609 @table @code
18610 @item $LEA/$LDATA
18611 Load effective address/data
18612 @item $SEA/$SDATA
18613 Store effective address/data
18614 @item $AEA/$ADATA
18615 Access effective address ($SEA or $LEA) or data ($SDATA/$LDATA)
18616 @item $FETCH
18617 Fetch data
18618 @end table
18619
18620 When triggered, it can capture low level data, like: @code{PC}, @code{LSEA},
18621 @code{LDATA}, @code{SDATA}, @code{READSPR}, @code{WRITESPR}, @code{INSTR}.
18622
18623 @code{htrace} commands:
18624 @cindex OpenRISC 1000 htrace
18625 @table @code
18626 @kindex hwatch
18627 @item hwatch @var{conditional}
18628 Set hardware watchpoint on combination of Load/Store Effective Address(es)
18629 or Data. For example:
18630
18631 @code{hwatch ($LEA == my_var) && ($LDATA < 50) || ($SEA == my_var) && ($SDATA >= 50)}
18632
18633 @code{hwatch ($LEA == my_var) && ($LDATA < 50) || ($SEA == my_var) && ($SDATA >= 50)}
18634
18635 @kindex htrace
18636 @item htrace info
18637 Display information about current HW trace configuration.
18638
18639 @item htrace trigger @var{conditional}
18640 Set starting criteria for HW trace.
18641
18642 @item htrace qualifier @var{conditional}
18643 Set acquisition qualifier for HW trace.
18644
18645 @item htrace stop @var{conditional}
18646 Set HW trace stopping criteria.
18647
18648 @item htrace record [@var{data}]*
18649 Selects the data to be recorded, when qualifier is met and HW trace was
18650 triggered.
18651
18652 @item htrace enable
18653 @itemx htrace disable
18654 Enables/disables the HW trace.
18655
18656 @item htrace rewind [@var{filename}]
18657 Clears currently recorded trace data.
18658
18659 If filename is specified, new trace file is made and any newly collected data
18660 will be written there.
18661
18662 @item htrace print [@var{start} [@var{len}]]
18663 Prints trace buffer, using current record configuration.
18664
18665 @item htrace mode continuous
18666 Set continuous trace mode.
18667
18668 @item htrace mode suspend
18669 Set suspend trace mode.
18670
18671 @end table
18672
18673 @node PowerPC Embedded
18674 @subsection PowerPC Embedded
18675
18676 @cindex DVC register
18677 @value{GDBN} supports using the DVC (Data Value Compare) register to
18678 implement in hardware simple hardware watchpoint conditions of the form:
18679
18680 @smallexample
18681 (@value{GDBP}) watch @var{ADDRESS|VARIABLE} \
18682 if @var{ADDRESS|VARIABLE} == @var{CONSTANT EXPRESSION}
18683 @end smallexample
18684
18685 The DVC register will be automatically used when @value{GDBN} detects
18686 such pattern in a condition expression, and the created watchpoint uses one
18687 debug register (either the @code{exact-watchpoints} option is on and the
18688 variable is scalar, or the variable has a length of one byte). This feature
18689 is available in native @value{GDBN} running on a Linux kernel version 2.6.34
18690 or newer.
18691
18692 When running on PowerPC embedded processors, @value{GDBN} automatically uses
18693 ranged hardware watchpoints, unless the @code{exact-watchpoints} option is on,
18694 in which case watchpoints using only one debug register are created when
18695 watching variables of scalar types.
18696
18697 You can create an artificial array to watch an arbitrary memory
18698 region using one of the following commands (@pxref{Expressions}):
18699
18700 @smallexample
18701 (@value{GDBP}) watch *((char *) @var{address})@@@var{length}
18702 (@value{GDBP}) watch @{char[@var{length}]@} @var{address}
18703 @end smallexample
18704
18705 @value{GDBN} provides the following PowerPC-specific commands:
18706
18707 @table @code
18708 @kindex set powerpc
18709 @item set powerpc soft-float
18710 @itemx show powerpc soft-float
18711 Force @value{GDBN} to use (or not use) a software floating point calling
18712 convention. By default, @value{GDBN} selects the calling convention based
18713 on the selected architecture and the provided executable file.
18714
18715 @item set powerpc vector-abi
18716 @itemx show powerpc vector-abi
18717 Force @value{GDBN} to use the specified calling convention for vector
18718 arguments and return values. The valid options are @samp{auto};
18719 @samp{generic}, to avoid vector registers even if they are present;
18720 @samp{altivec}, to use AltiVec registers; and @samp{spe} to use SPE
18721 registers. By default, @value{GDBN} selects the calling convention
18722 based on the selected architecture and the provided executable file.
18723
18724 @item set powerpc exact-watchpoints
18725 @itemx show powerpc exact-watchpoints
18726 Allow @value{GDBN} to use only one debug register when watching a variable
18727 of scalar type, thus assuming that the variable is accessed through the
18728 address of its first byte.
18729
18730 @kindex target dink32
18731 @item target dink32 @var{dev}
18732 DINK32 ROM monitor.
18733
18734 @kindex target ppcbug
18735 @item target ppcbug @var{dev}
18736 @kindex target ppcbug1
18737 @item target ppcbug1 @var{dev}
18738 PPCBUG ROM monitor for PowerPC.
18739
18740 @kindex target sds
18741 @item target sds @var{dev}
18742 SDS monitor, running on a PowerPC board (such as Motorola's ADS).
18743 @end table
18744
18745 @cindex SDS protocol
18746 The following commands specific to the SDS protocol are supported
18747 by @value{GDBN}:
18748
18749 @table @code
18750 @item set sdstimeout @var{nsec}
18751 @kindex set sdstimeout
18752 Set the timeout for SDS protocol reads to be @var{nsec} seconds. The
18753 default is 2 seconds.
18754
18755 @item show sdstimeout
18756 @kindex show sdstimeout
18757 Show the current value of the SDS timeout.
18758
18759 @item sds @var{command}
18760 @kindex sds@r{, a command}
18761 Send the specified @var{command} string to the SDS monitor.
18762 @end table
18763
18764
18765 @node PA
18766 @subsection HP PA Embedded
18767
18768 @table @code
18769
18770 @kindex target op50n
18771 @item target op50n @var{dev}
18772 OP50N monitor, running on an OKI HPPA board.
18773
18774 @kindex target w89k
18775 @item target w89k @var{dev}
18776 W89K monitor, running on a Winbond HPPA board.
18777
18778 @end table
18779
18780 @node Sparclet
18781 @subsection Tsqware Sparclet
18782
18783 @cindex Sparclet
18784
18785 @value{GDBN} enables developers to debug tasks running on
18786 Sparclet targets from a Unix host.
18787 @value{GDBN} uses code that runs on
18788 both the Unix host and on the Sparclet target. The program
18789 @code{@value{GDBP}} is installed and executed on the Unix host.
18790
18791 @table @code
18792 @item remotetimeout @var{args}
18793 @kindex remotetimeout
18794 @value{GDBN} supports the option @code{remotetimeout}.
18795 This option is set by the user, and @var{args} represents the number of
18796 seconds @value{GDBN} waits for responses.
18797 @end table
18798
18799 @cindex compiling, on Sparclet
18800 When compiling for debugging, include the options @samp{-g} to get debug
18801 information and @samp{-Ttext} to relocate the program to where you wish to
18802 load it on the target. You may also want to add the options @samp{-n} or
18803 @samp{-N} in order to reduce the size of the sections. Example:
18804
18805 @smallexample
18806 sparclet-aout-gcc prog.c -Ttext 0x12010000 -g -o prog -N
18807 @end smallexample
18808
18809 You can use @code{objdump} to verify that the addresses are what you intended:
18810
18811 @smallexample
18812 sparclet-aout-objdump --headers --syms prog
18813 @end smallexample
18814
18815 @cindex running, on Sparclet
18816 Once you have set
18817 your Unix execution search path to find @value{GDBN}, you are ready to
18818 run @value{GDBN}. From your Unix host, run @code{@value{GDBP}}
18819 (or @code{sparclet-aout-gdb}, depending on your installation).
18820
18821 @value{GDBN} comes up showing the prompt:
18822
18823 @smallexample
18824 (gdbslet)
18825 @end smallexample
18826
18827 @menu
18828 * Sparclet File:: Setting the file to debug
18829 * Sparclet Connection:: Connecting to Sparclet
18830 * Sparclet Download:: Sparclet download
18831 * Sparclet Execution:: Running and debugging
18832 @end menu
18833
18834 @node Sparclet File
18835 @subsubsection Setting File to Debug
18836
18837 The @value{GDBN} command @code{file} lets you choose with program to debug.
18838
18839 @smallexample
18840 (gdbslet) file prog
18841 @end smallexample
18842
18843 @need 1000
18844 @value{GDBN} then attempts to read the symbol table of @file{prog}.
18845 @value{GDBN} locates
18846 the file by searching the directories listed in the command search
18847 path.
18848 If the file was compiled with debug information (option @samp{-g}), source
18849 files will be searched as well.
18850 @value{GDBN} locates
18851 the source files by searching the directories listed in the directory search
18852 path (@pxref{Environment, ,Your Program's Environment}).
18853 If it fails
18854 to find a file, it displays a message such as:
18855
18856 @smallexample
18857 prog: No such file or directory.
18858 @end smallexample
18859
18860 When this happens, add the appropriate directories to the search paths with
18861 the @value{GDBN} commands @code{path} and @code{dir}, and execute the
18862 @code{target} command again.
18863
18864 @node Sparclet Connection
18865 @subsubsection Connecting to Sparclet
18866
18867 The @value{GDBN} command @code{target} lets you connect to a Sparclet target.
18868 To connect to a target on serial port ``@code{ttya}'', type:
18869
18870 @smallexample
18871 (gdbslet) target sparclet /dev/ttya
18872 Remote target sparclet connected to /dev/ttya
18873 main () at ../prog.c:3
18874 @end smallexample
18875
18876 @need 750
18877 @value{GDBN} displays messages like these:
18878
18879 @smallexample
18880 Connected to ttya.
18881 @end smallexample
18882
18883 @node Sparclet Download
18884 @subsubsection Sparclet Download
18885
18886 @cindex download to Sparclet
18887 Once connected to the Sparclet target,
18888 you can use the @value{GDBN}
18889 @code{load} command to download the file from the host to the target.
18890 The file name and load offset should be given as arguments to the @code{load}
18891 command.
18892 Since the file format is aout, the program must be loaded to the starting
18893 address. You can use @code{objdump} to find out what this value is. The load
18894 offset is an offset which is added to the VMA (virtual memory address)
18895 of each of the file's sections.
18896 For instance, if the program
18897 @file{prog} was linked to text address 0x1201000, with data at 0x12010160
18898 and bss at 0x12010170, in @value{GDBN}, type:
18899
18900 @smallexample
18901 (gdbslet) load prog 0x12010000
18902 Loading section .text, size 0xdb0 vma 0x12010000
18903 @end smallexample
18904
18905 If the code is loaded at a different address then what the program was linked
18906 to, you may need to use the @code{section} and @code{add-symbol-file} commands
18907 to tell @value{GDBN} where to map the symbol table.
18908
18909 @node Sparclet Execution
18910 @subsubsection Running and Debugging
18911
18912 @cindex running and debugging Sparclet programs
18913 You can now begin debugging the task using @value{GDBN}'s execution control
18914 commands, @code{b}, @code{step}, @code{run}, etc. See the @value{GDBN}
18915 manual for the list of commands.
18916
18917 @smallexample
18918 (gdbslet) b main
18919 Breakpoint 1 at 0x12010000: file prog.c, line 3.
18920 (gdbslet) run
18921 Starting program: prog
18922 Breakpoint 1, main (argc=1, argv=0xeffff21c) at prog.c:3
18923 3 char *symarg = 0;
18924 (gdbslet) step
18925 4 char *execarg = "hello!";
18926 (gdbslet)
18927 @end smallexample
18928
18929 @node Sparclite
18930 @subsection Fujitsu Sparclite
18931
18932 @table @code
18933
18934 @kindex target sparclite
18935 @item target sparclite @var{dev}
18936 Fujitsu sparclite boards, used only for the purpose of loading.
18937 You must use an additional command to debug the program.
18938 For example: target remote @var{dev} using @value{GDBN} standard
18939 remote protocol.
18940
18941 @end table
18942
18943 @node Z8000
18944 @subsection Zilog Z8000
18945
18946 @cindex Z8000
18947 @cindex simulator, Z8000
18948 @cindex Zilog Z8000 simulator
18949
18950 When configured for debugging Zilog Z8000 targets, @value{GDBN} includes
18951 a Z8000 simulator.
18952
18953 For the Z8000 family, @samp{target sim} simulates either the Z8002 (the
18954 unsegmented variant of the Z8000 architecture) or the Z8001 (the
18955 segmented variant). The simulator recognizes which architecture is
18956 appropriate by inspecting the object code.
18957
18958 @table @code
18959 @item target sim @var{args}
18960 @kindex sim
18961 @kindex target sim@r{, with Z8000}
18962 Debug programs on a simulated CPU. If the simulator supports setup
18963 options, specify them via @var{args}.
18964 @end table
18965
18966 @noindent
18967 After specifying this target, you can debug programs for the simulated
18968 CPU in the same style as programs for your host computer; use the
18969 @code{file} command to load a new program image, the @code{run} command
18970 to run your program, and so on.
18971
18972 As well as making available all the usual machine registers
18973 (@pxref{Registers, ,Registers}), the Z8000 simulator provides three
18974 additional items of information as specially named registers:
18975
18976 @table @code
18977
18978 @item cycles
18979 Counts clock-ticks in the simulator.
18980
18981 @item insts
18982 Counts instructions run in the simulator.
18983
18984 @item time
18985 Execution time in 60ths of a second.
18986
18987 @end table
18988
18989 You can refer to these values in @value{GDBN} expressions with the usual
18990 conventions; for example, @w{@samp{b fputc if $cycles>5000}} sets a
18991 conditional breakpoint that suspends only after at least 5000
18992 simulated clock ticks.
18993
18994 @node AVR
18995 @subsection Atmel AVR
18996 @cindex AVR
18997
18998 When configured for debugging the Atmel AVR, @value{GDBN} supports the
18999 following AVR-specific commands:
19000
19001 @table @code
19002 @item info io_registers
19003 @kindex info io_registers@r{, AVR}
19004 @cindex I/O registers (Atmel AVR)
19005 This command displays information about the AVR I/O registers. For
19006 each register, @value{GDBN} prints its number and value.
19007 @end table
19008
19009 @node CRIS
19010 @subsection CRIS
19011 @cindex CRIS
19012
19013 When configured for debugging CRIS, @value{GDBN} provides the
19014 following CRIS-specific commands:
19015
19016 @table @code
19017 @item set cris-version @var{ver}
19018 @cindex CRIS version
19019 Set the current CRIS version to @var{ver}, either @samp{10} or @samp{32}.
19020 The CRIS version affects register names and sizes. This command is useful in
19021 case autodetection of the CRIS version fails.
19022
19023 @item show cris-version
19024 Show the current CRIS version.
19025
19026 @item set cris-dwarf2-cfi
19027 @cindex DWARF-2 CFI and CRIS
19028 Set the usage of DWARF-2 CFI for CRIS debugging. The default is @samp{on}.
19029 Change to @samp{off} when using @code{gcc-cris} whose version is below
19030 @code{R59}.
19031
19032 @item show cris-dwarf2-cfi
19033 Show the current state of using DWARF-2 CFI.
19034
19035 @item set cris-mode @var{mode}
19036 @cindex CRIS mode
19037 Set the current CRIS mode to @var{mode}. It should only be changed when
19038 debugging in guru mode, in which case it should be set to
19039 @samp{guru} (the default is @samp{normal}).
19040
19041 @item show cris-mode
19042 Show the current CRIS mode.
19043 @end table
19044
19045 @node Super-H
19046 @subsection Renesas Super-H
19047 @cindex Super-H
19048
19049 For the Renesas Super-H processor, @value{GDBN} provides these
19050 commands:
19051
19052 @table @code
19053 @item regs
19054 @kindex regs@r{, Super-H}
19055 Show the values of all Super-H registers.
19056
19057 @item set sh calling-convention @var{convention}
19058 @kindex set sh calling-convention
19059 Set the calling-convention used when calling functions from @value{GDBN}.
19060 Allowed values are @samp{gcc}, which is the default setting, and @samp{renesas}.
19061 With the @samp{gcc} setting, functions are called using the @value{NGCC} calling
19062 convention. If the DWARF-2 information of the called function specifies
19063 that the function follows the Renesas calling convention, the function
19064 is called using the Renesas calling convention. If the calling convention
19065 is set to @samp{renesas}, the Renesas calling convention is always used,
19066 regardless of the DWARF-2 information. This can be used to override the
19067 default of @samp{gcc} if debug information is missing, or the compiler
19068 does not emit the DWARF-2 calling convention entry for a function.
19069
19070 @item show sh calling-convention
19071 @kindex show sh calling-convention
19072 Show the current calling convention setting.
19073
19074 @end table
19075
19076
19077 @node Architectures
19078 @section Architectures
19079
19080 This section describes characteristics of architectures that affect
19081 all uses of @value{GDBN} with the architecture, both native and cross.
19082
19083 @menu
19084 * i386::
19085 * A29K::
19086 * Alpha::
19087 * MIPS::
19088 * HPPA:: HP PA architecture
19089 * SPU:: Cell Broadband Engine SPU architecture
19090 * PowerPC::
19091 @end menu
19092
19093 @node i386
19094 @subsection x86 Architecture-specific Issues
19095
19096 @table @code
19097 @item set struct-convention @var{mode}
19098 @kindex set struct-convention
19099 @cindex struct return convention
19100 @cindex struct/union returned in registers
19101 Set the convention used by the inferior to return @code{struct}s and
19102 @code{union}s from functions to @var{mode}. Possible values of
19103 @var{mode} are @code{"pcc"}, @code{"reg"}, and @code{"default"} (the
19104 default). @code{"default"} or @code{"pcc"} means that @code{struct}s
19105 are returned on the stack, while @code{"reg"} means that a
19106 @code{struct} or a @code{union} whose size is 1, 2, 4, or 8 bytes will
19107 be returned in a register.
19108
19109 @item show struct-convention
19110 @kindex show struct-convention
19111 Show the current setting of the convention to return @code{struct}s
19112 from functions.
19113 @end table
19114
19115 @node A29K
19116 @subsection A29K
19117
19118 @table @code
19119
19120 @kindex set rstack_high_address
19121 @cindex AMD 29K register stack
19122 @cindex register stack, AMD29K
19123 @item set rstack_high_address @var{address}
19124 On AMD 29000 family processors, registers are saved in a separate
19125 @dfn{register stack}. There is no way for @value{GDBN} to determine the
19126 extent of this stack. Normally, @value{GDBN} just assumes that the
19127 stack is ``large enough''. This may result in @value{GDBN} referencing
19128 memory locations that do not exist. If necessary, you can get around
19129 this problem by specifying the ending address of the register stack with
19130 the @code{set rstack_high_address} command. The argument should be an
19131 address, which you probably want to precede with @samp{0x} to specify in
19132 hexadecimal.
19133
19134 @kindex show rstack_high_address
19135 @item show rstack_high_address
19136 Display the current limit of the register stack, on AMD 29000 family
19137 processors.
19138
19139 @end table
19140
19141 @node Alpha
19142 @subsection Alpha
19143
19144 See the following section.
19145
19146 @node MIPS
19147 @subsection MIPS
19148
19149 @cindex stack on Alpha
19150 @cindex stack on MIPS
19151 @cindex Alpha stack
19152 @cindex MIPS stack
19153 Alpha- and MIPS-based computers use an unusual stack frame, which
19154 sometimes requires @value{GDBN} to search backward in the object code to
19155 find the beginning of a function.
19156
19157 @cindex response time, MIPS debugging
19158 To improve response time (especially for embedded applications, where
19159 @value{GDBN} may be restricted to a slow serial line for this search)
19160 you may want to limit the size of this search, using one of these
19161 commands:
19162
19163 @table @code
19164 @cindex @code{heuristic-fence-post} (Alpha, MIPS)
19165 @item set heuristic-fence-post @var{limit}
19166 Restrict @value{GDBN} to examining at most @var{limit} bytes in its
19167 search for the beginning of a function. A value of @var{0} (the
19168 default) means there is no limit. However, except for @var{0}, the
19169 larger the limit the more bytes @code{heuristic-fence-post} must search
19170 and therefore the longer it takes to run. You should only need to use
19171 this command when debugging a stripped executable.
19172
19173 @item show heuristic-fence-post
19174 Display the current limit.
19175 @end table
19176
19177 @noindent
19178 These commands are available @emph{only} when @value{GDBN} is configured
19179 for debugging programs on Alpha or MIPS processors.
19180
19181 Several MIPS-specific commands are available when debugging MIPS
19182 programs:
19183
19184 @table @code
19185 @item set mips abi @var{arg}
19186 @kindex set mips abi
19187 @cindex set ABI for MIPS
19188 Tell @value{GDBN} which MIPS ABI is used by the inferior. Possible
19189 values of @var{arg} are:
19190
19191 @table @samp
19192 @item auto
19193 The default ABI associated with the current binary (this is the
19194 default).
19195 @item o32
19196 @item o64
19197 @item n32
19198 @item n64
19199 @item eabi32
19200 @item eabi64
19201 @item auto
19202 @end table
19203
19204 @item show mips abi
19205 @kindex show mips abi
19206 Show the MIPS ABI used by @value{GDBN} to debug the inferior.
19207
19208 @item set mipsfpu
19209 @itemx show mipsfpu
19210 @xref{MIPS Embedded, set mipsfpu}.
19211
19212 @item set mips mask-address @var{arg}
19213 @kindex set mips mask-address
19214 @cindex MIPS addresses, masking
19215 This command determines whether the most-significant 32 bits of 64-bit
19216 MIPS addresses are masked off. The argument @var{arg} can be
19217 @samp{on}, @samp{off}, or @samp{auto}. The latter is the default
19218 setting, which lets @value{GDBN} determine the correct value.
19219
19220 @item show mips mask-address
19221 @kindex show mips mask-address
19222 Show whether the upper 32 bits of MIPS addresses are masked off or
19223 not.
19224
19225 @item set remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
19226 @kindex set remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
19227 This command controls compatibility with 64-bit MIPS targets that
19228 transfer data in 32-bit quantities. If you have an old MIPS 64 target
19229 that transfers 32 bits for some registers, like @sc{sr} and @sc{fsr},
19230 and 64 bits for other registers, set this option to @samp{on}.
19231
19232 @item show remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
19233 @kindex show remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
19234 Show the current setting of compatibility with older MIPS 64 targets.
19235
19236 @item set debug mips
19237 @kindex set debug mips
19238 This command turns on and off debugging messages for the MIPS-specific
19239 target code in @value{GDBN}.
19240
19241 @item show debug mips
19242 @kindex show debug mips
19243 Show the current setting of MIPS debugging messages.
19244 @end table
19245
19246
19247 @node HPPA
19248 @subsection HPPA
19249 @cindex HPPA support
19250
19251 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the HP PA architecture, it provides the
19252 following special commands:
19253
19254 @table @code
19255 @item set debug hppa
19256 @kindex set debug hppa
19257 This command determines whether HPPA architecture-specific debugging
19258 messages are to be displayed.
19259
19260 @item show debug hppa
19261 Show whether HPPA debugging messages are displayed.
19262
19263 @item maint print unwind @var{address}
19264 @kindex maint print unwind@r{, HPPA}
19265 This command displays the contents of the unwind table entry at the
19266 given @var{address}.
19267
19268 @end table
19269
19270
19271 @node SPU
19272 @subsection Cell Broadband Engine SPU architecture
19273 @cindex Cell Broadband Engine
19274 @cindex SPU
19275
19276 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the Cell Broadband Engine SPU architecture,
19277 it provides the following special commands:
19278
19279 @table @code
19280 @item info spu event
19281 @kindex info spu
19282 Display SPU event facility status. Shows current event mask
19283 and pending event status.
19284
19285 @item info spu signal
19286 Display SPU signal notification facility status. Shows pending
19287 signal-control word and signal notification mode of both signal
19288 notification channels.
19289
19290 @item info spu mailbox
19291 Display SPU mailbox facility status. Shows all pending entries,
19292 in order of processing, in each of the SPU Write Outbound,
19293 SPU Write Outbound Interrupt, and SPU Read Inbound mailboxes.
19294
19295 @item info spu dma
19296 Display MFC DMA status. Shows all pending commands in the MFC
19297 DMA queue. For each entry, opcode, tag, class IDs, effective
19298 and local store addresses and transfer size are shown.
19299
19300 @item info spu proxydma
19301 Display MFC Proxy-DMA status. Shows all pending commands in the MFC
19302 Proxy-DMA queue. For each entry, opcode, tag, class IDs, effective
19303 and local store addresses and transfer size are shown.
19304
19305 @end table
19306
19307 When @value{GDBN} is debugging a combined PowerPC/SPU application
19308 on the Cell Broadband Engine, it provides in addition the following
19309 special commands:
19310
19311 @table @code
19312 @item set spu stop-on-load @var{arg}
19313 @kindex set spu
19314 Set whether to stop for new SPE threads. When set to @code{on}, @value{GDBN}
19315 will give control to the user when a new SPE thread enters its @code{main}
19316 function. The default is @code{off}.
19317
19318 @item show spu stop-on-load
19319 @kindex show spu
19320 Show whether to stop for new SPE threads.
19321
19322 @item set spu auto-flush-cache @var{arg}
19323 Set whether to automatically flush the software-managed cache. When set to
19324 @code{on}, @value{GDBN} will automatically cause the SPE software-managed
19325 cache to be flushed whenever SPE execution stops. This provides a consistent
19326 view of PowerPC memory that is accessed via the cache. If an application
19327 does not use the software-managed cache, this option has no effect.
19328
19329 @item show spu auto-flush-cache
19330 Show whether to automatically flush the software-managed cache.
19331
19332 @end table
19333
19334 @node PowerPC
19335 @subsection PowerPC
19336 @cindex PowerPC architecture
19337
19338 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the PowerPC architecture, it provides a set of
19339 pseudo-registers to enable inspection of 128-bit wide Decimal Floating Point
19340 numbers stored in the floating point registers. These values must be stored
19341 in two consecutive registers, always starting at an even register like
19342 @code{f0} or @code{f2}.
19343
19344 The pseudo-registers go from @code{$dl0} through @code{$dl15}, and are formed
19345 by joining the even/odd register pairs @code{f0} and @code{f1} for @code{$dl0},
19346 @code{f2} and @code{f3} for @code{$dl1} and so on.
19347
19348 For POWER7 processors, @value{GDBN} provides a set of pseudo-registers, the 64-bit
19349 wide Extended Floating Point Registers (@samp{f32} through @samp{f63}).
19350
19351
19352 @node Controlling GDB
19353 @chapter Controlling @value{GDBN}
19354
19355 You can alter the way @value{GDBN} interacts with you by using the
19356 @code{set} command. For commands controlling how @value{GDBN} displays
19357 data, see @ref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}. Other settings are
19358 described here.
19359
19360 @menu
19361 * Prompt:: Prompt
19362 * Editing:: Command editing
19363 * Command History:: Command history
19364 * Screen Size:: Screen size
19365 * Numbers:: Numbers
19366 * ABI:: Configuring the current ABI
19367 * Messages/Warnings:: Optional warnings and messages
19368 * Debugging Output:: Optional messages about internal happenings
19369 * Other Misc Settings:: Other Miscellaneous Settings
19370 @end menu
19371
19372 @node Prompt
19373 @section Prompt
19374
19375 @cindex prompt
19376
19377 @value{GDBN} indicates its readiness to read a command by printing a string
19378 called the @dfn{prompt}. This string is normally @samp{(@value{GDBP})}. You
19379 can change the prompt string with the @code{set prompt} command. For
19380 instance, when debugging @value{GDBN} with @value{GDBN}, it is useful to change
19381 the prompt in one of the @value{GDBN} sessions so that you can always tell
19382 which one you are talking to.
19383
19384 @emph{Note:} @code{set prompt} does not add a space for you after the
19385 prompt you set. This allows you to set a prompt which ends in a space
19386 or a prompt that does not.
19387
19388 @table @code
19389 @kindex set prompt
19390 @item set prompt @var{newprompt}
19391 Directs @value{GDBN} to use @var{newprompt} as its prompt string henceforth.
19392
19393 @kindex show prompt
19394 @item show prompt
19395 Prints a line of the form: @samp{Gdb's prompt is: @var{your-prompt}}
19396 @end table
19397
19398 @node Editing
19399 @section Command Editing
19400 @cindex readline
19401 @cindex command line editing
19402
19403 @value{GDBN} reads its input commands via the @dfn{Readline} interface. This
19404 @sc{gnu} library provides consistent behavior for programs which provide a
19405 command line interface to the user. Advantages are @sc{gnu} Emacs-style
19406 or @dfn{vi}-style inline editing of commands, @code{csh}-like history
19407 substitution, and a storage and recall of command history across
19408 debugging sessions.
19409
19410 You may control the behavior of command line editing in @value{GDBN} with the
19411 command @code{set}.
19412
19413 @table @code
19414 @kindex set editing
19415 @cindex editing
19416 @item set editing
19417 @itemx set editing on
19418 Enable command line editing (enabled by default).
19419
19420 @item set editing off
19421 Disable command line editing.
19422
19423 @kindex show editing
19424 @item show editing
19425 Show whether command line editing is enabled.
19426 @end table
19427
19428 @ifset SYSTEM_READLINE
19429 @xref{Command Line Editing, , , rluserman, GNU Readline Library},
19430 @end ifset
19431 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
19432 @xref{Command Line Editing},
19433 @end ifclear
19434 for more details about the Readline
19435 interface. Users unfamiliar with @sc{gnu} Emacs or @code{vi} are
19436 encouraged to read that chapter.
19437
19438 @node Command History
19439 @section Command History
19440 @cindex command history
19441
19442 @value{GDBN} can keep track of the commands you type during your
19443 debugging sessions, so that you can be certain of precisely what
19444 happened. Use these commands to manage the @value{GDBN} command
19445 history facility.
19446
19447 @value{GDBN} uses the @sc{gnu} History library, a part of the Readline
19448 package, to provide the history facility.
19449 @ifset SYSTEM_READLINE
19450 @xref{Using History Interactively, , , history, GNU History Library},
19451 @end ifset
19452 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
19453 @xref{Using History Interactively},
19454 @end ifclear
19455 for the detailed description of the History library.
19456
19457 To issue a command to @value{GDBN} without affecting certain aspects of
19458 the state which is seen by users, prefix it with @samp{server }
19459 (@pxref{Server Prefix}). This
19460 means that this command will not affect the command history, nor will it
19461 affect @value{GDBN}'s notion of which command to repeat if @key{RET} is
19462 pressed on a line by itself.
19463
19464 @cindex @code{server}, command prefix
19465 The server prefix does not affect the recording of values into the value
19466 history; to print a value without recording it into the value history,
19467 use the @code{output} command instead of the @code{print} command.
19468
19469 Here is the description of @value{GDBN} commands related to command
19470 history.
19471
19472 @table @code
19473 @cindex history substitution
19474 @cindex history file
19475 @kindex set history filename
19476 @cindex @env{GDBHISTFILE}, environment variable
19477 @item set history filename @var{fname}
19478 Set the name of the @value{GDBN} command history file to @var{fname}.
19479 This is the file where @value{GDBN} reads an initial command history
19480 list, and where it writes the command history from this session when it
19481 exits. You can access this list through history expansion or through
19482 the history command editing characters listed below. This file defaults
19483 to the value of the environment variable @code{GDBHISTFILE}, or to
19484 @file{./.gdb_history} (@file{./_gdb_history} on MS-DOS) if this variable
19485 is not set.
19486
19487 @cindex save command history
19488 @kindex set history save
19489 @item set history save
19490 @itemx set history save on
19491 Record command history in a file, whose name may be specified with the
19492 @code{set history filename} command. By default, this option is disabled.
19493
19494 @item set history save off
19495 Stop recording command history in a file.
19496
19497 @cindex history size
19498 @kindex set history size
19499 @cindex @env{HISTSIZE}, environment variable
19500 @item set history size @var{size}
19501 Set the number of commands which @value{GDBN} keeps in its history list.
19502 This defaults to the value of the environment variable
19503 @code{HISTSIZE}, or to 256 if this variable is not set.
19504 @end table
19505
19506 History expansion assigns special meaning to the character @kbd{!}.
19507 @ifset SYSTEM_READLINE
19508 @xref{Event Designators, , , history, GNU History Library},
19509 @end ifset
19510 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
19511 @xref{Event Designators},
19512 @end ifclear
19513 for more details.
19514
19515 @cindex history expansion, turn on/off
19516 Since @kbd{!} is also the logical not operator in C, history expansion
19517 is off by default. If you decide to enable history expansion with the
19518 @code{set history expansion on} command, you may sometimes need to
19519 follow @kbd{!} (when it is used as logical not, in an expression) with
19520 a space or a tab to prevent it from being expanded. The readline
19521 history facilities do not attempt substitution on the strings
19522 @kbd{!=} and @kbd{!(}, even when history expansion is enabled.
19523
19524 The commands to control history expansion are:
19525
19526 @table @code
19527 @item set history expansion on
19528 @itemx set history expansion
19529 @kindex set history expansion
19530 Enable history expansion. History expansion is off by default.
19531
19532 @item set history expansion off
19533 Disable history expansion.
19534
19535 @c @group
19536 @kindex show history
19537 @item show history
19538 @itemx show history filename
19539 @itemx show history save
19540 @itemx show history size
19541 @itemx show history expansion
19542 These commands display the state of the @value{GDBN} history parameters.
19543 @code{show history} by itself displays all four states.
19544 @c @end group
19545 @end table
19546
19547 @table @code
19548 @kindex show commands
19549 @cindex show last commands
19550 @cindex display command history
19551 @item show commands
19552 Display the last ten commands in the command history.
19553
19554 @item show commands @var{n}
19555 Print ten commands centered on command number @var{n}.
19556
19557 @item show commands +
19558 Print ten commands just after the commands last printed.
19559 @end table
19560
19561 @node Screen Size
19562 @section Screen Size
19563 @cindex size of screen
19564 @cindex pauses in output
19565
19566 Certain commands to @value{GDBN} may produce large amounts of
19567 information output to the screen. To help you read all of it,
19568 @value{GDBN} pauses and asks you for input at the end of each page of
19569 output. Type @key{RET} when you want to continue the output, or @kbd{q}
19570 to discard the remaining output. Also, the screen width setting
19571 determines when to wrap lines of output. Depending on what is being
19572 printed, @value{GDBN} tries to break the line at a readable place,
19573 rather than simply letting it overflow onto the following line.
19574
19575 Normally @value{GDBN} knows the size of the screen from the terminal
19576 driver software. For example, on Unix @value{GDBN} uses the termcap data base
19577 together with the value of the @code{TERM} environment variable and the
19578 @code{stty rows} and @code{stty cols} settings. If this is not correct,
19579 you can override it with the @code{set height} and @code{set
19580 width} commands:
19581
19582 @table @code
19583 @kindex set height
19584 @kindex set width
19585 @kindex show width
19586 @kindex show height
19587 @item set height @var{lpp}
19588 @itemx show height
19589 @itemx set width @var{cpl}
19590 @itemx show width
19591 These @code{set} commands specify a screen height of @var{lpp} lines and
19592 a screen width of @var{cpl} characters. The associated @code{show}
19593 commands display the current settings.
19594
19595 If you specify a height of zero lines, @value{GDBN} does not pause during
19596 output no matter how long the output is. This is useful if output is to a
19597 file or to an editor buffer.
19598
19599 Likewise, you can specify @samp{set width 0} to prevent @value{GDBN}
19600 from wrapping its output.
19601
19602 @item set pagination on
19603 @itemx set pagination off
19604 @kindex set pagination
19605 Turn the output pagination on or off; the default is on. Turning
19606 pagination off is the alternative to @code{set height 0}. Note that
19607 running @value{GDBN} with the @option{--batch} option (@pxref{Mode
19608 Options, -batch}) also automatically disables pagination.
19609
19610 @item show pagination
19611 @kindex show pagination
19612 Show the current pagination mode.
19613 @end table
19614
19615 @node Numbers
19616 @section Numbers
19617 @cindex number representation
19618 @cindex entering numbers
19619
19620 You can always enter numbers in octal, decimal, or hexadecimal in
19621 @value{GDBN} by the usual conventions: octal numbers begin with
19622 @samp{0}, decimal numbers end with @samp{.}, and hexadecimal numbers
19623 begin with @samp{0x}. Numbers that neither begin with @samp{0} or
19624 @samp{0x}, nor end with a @samp{.} are, by default, entered in base
19625 10; likewise, the default display for numbers---when no particular
19626 format is specified---is base 10. You can change the default base for
19627 both input and output with the commands described below.
19628
19629 @table @code
19630 @kindex set input-radix
19631 @item set input-radix @var{base}
19632 Set the default base for numeric input. Supported choices
19633 for @var{base} are decimal 8, 10, or 16. @var{base} must itself be
19634 specified either unambiguously or using the current input radix; for
19635 example, any of
19636
19637 @smallexample
19638 set input-radix 012
19639 set input-radix 10.
19640 set input-radix 0xa
19641 @end smallexample
19642
19643 @noindent
19644 sets the input base to decimal. On the other hand, @samp{set input-radix 10}
19645 leaves the input radix unchanged, no matter what it was, since
19646 @samp{10}, being without any leading or trailing signs of its base, is
19647 interpreted in the current radix. Thus, if the current radix is 16,
19648 @samp{10} is interpreted in hex, i.e.@: as 16 decimal, which doesn't
19649 change the radix.
19650
19651 @kindex set output-radix
19652 @item set output-radix @var{base}
19653 Set the default base for numeric display. Supported choices
19654 for @var{base} are decimal 8, 10, or 16. @var{base} must itself be
19655 specified either unambiguously or using the current input radix.
19656
19657 @kindex show input-radix
19658 @item show input-radix
19659 Display the current default base for numeric input.
19660
19661 @kindex show output-radix
19662 @item show output-radix
19663 Display the current default base for numeric display.
19664
19665 @item set radix @r{[}@var{base}@r{]}
19666 @itemx show radix
19667 @kindex set radix
19668 @kindex show radix
19669 These commands set and show the default base for both input and output
19670 of numbers. @code{set radix} sets the radix of input and output to
19671 the same base; without an argument, it resets the radix back to its
19672 default value of 10.
19673
19674 @end table
19675
19676 @node ABI
19677 @section Configuring the Current ABI
19678
19679 @value{GDBN} can determine the @dfn{ABI} (Application Binary Interface) of your
19680 application automatically. However, sometimes you need to override its
19681 conclusions. Use these commands to manage @value{GDBN}'s view of the
19682 current ABI.
19683
19684 @cindex OS ABI
19685 @kindex set osabi
19686 @kindex show osabi
19687
19688 One @value{GDBN} configuration can debug binaries for multiple operating
19689 system targets, either via remote debugging or native emulation.
19690 @value{GDBN} will autodetect the @dfn{OS ABI} (Operating System ABI) in use,
19691 but you can override its conclusion using the @code{set osabi} command.
19692 One example where this is useful is in debugging of binaries which use
19693 an alternate C library (e.g.@: @sc{uClibc} for @sc{gnu}/Linux) which does
19694 not have the same identifying marks that the standard C library for your
19695 platform provides.
19696
19697 @table @code
19698 @item show osabi
19699 Show the OS ABI currently in use.
19700
19701 @item set osabi
19702 With no argument, show the list of registered available OS ABI's.
19703
19704 @item set osabi @var{abi}
19705 Set the current OS ABI to @var{abi}.
19706 @end table
19707
19708 @cindex float promotion
19709
19710 Generally, the way that an argument of type @code{float} is passed to a
19711 function depends on whether the function is prototyped. For a prototyped
19712 (i.e.@: ANSI/ISO style) function, @code{float} arguments are passed unchanged,
19713 according to the architecture's convention for @code{float}. For unprototyped
19714 (i.e.@: K&R style) functions, @code{float} arguments are first promoted to type
19715 @code{double} and then passed.
19716
19717 Unfortunately, some forms of debug information do not reliably indicate whether
19718 a function is prototyped. If @value{GDBN} calls a function that is not marked
19719 as prototyped, it consults @kbd{set coerce-float-to-double}.
19720
19721 @table @code
19722 @kindex set coerce-float-to-double
19723 @item set coerce-float-to-double
19724 @itemx set coerce-float-to-double on
19725 Arguments of type @code{float} will be promoted to @code{double} when passed
19726 to an unprototyped function. This is the default setting.
19727
19728 @item set coerce-float-to-double off
19729 Arguments of type @code{float} will be passed directly to unprototyped
19730 functions.
19731
19732 @kindex show coerce-float-to-double
19733 @item show coerce-float-to-double
19734 Show the current setting of promoting @code{float} to @code{double}.
19735 @end table
19736
19737 @kindex set cp-abi
19738 @kindex show cp-abi
19739 @value{GDBN} needs to know the ABI used for your program's C@t{++}
19740 objects. The correct C@t{++} ABI depends on which C@t{++} compiler was
19741 used to build your application. @value{GDBN} only fully supports
19742 programs with a single C@t{++} ABI; if your program contains code using
19743 multiple C@t{++} ABI's or if @value{GDBN} can not identify your
19744 program's ABI correctly, you can tell @value{GDBN} which ABI to use.
19745 Currently supported ABI's include ``gnu-v2'', for @code{g++} versions
19746 before 3.0, ``gnu-v3'', for @code{g++} versions 3.0 and later, and
19747 ``hpaCC'' for the HP ANSI C@t{++} compiler. Other C@t{++} compilers may
19748 use the ``gnu-v2'' or ``gnu-v3'' ABI's as well. The default setting is
19749 ``auto''.
19750
19751 @table @code
19752 @item show cp-abi
19753 Show the C@t{++} ABI currently in use.
19754
19755 @item set cp-abi
19756 With no argument, show the list of supported C@t{++} ABI's.
19757
19758 @item set cp-abi @var{abi}
19759 @itemx set cp-abi auto
19760 Set the current C@t{++} ABI to @var{abi}, or return to automatic detection.
19761 @end table
19762
19763 @node Messages/Warnings
19764 @section Optional Warnings and Messages
19765
19766 @cindex verbose operation
19767 @cindex optional warnings
19768 By default, @value{GDBN} is silent about its inner workings. If you are
19769 running on a slow machine, you may want to use the @code{set verbose}
19770 command. This makes @value{GDBN} tell you when it does a lengthy
19771 internal operation, so you will not think it has crashed.
19772
19773 Currently, the messages controlled by @code{set verbose} are those
19774 which announce that the symbol table for a source file is being read;
19775 see @code{symbol-file} in @ref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}.
19776
19777 @table @code
19778 @kindex set verbose
19779 @item set verbose on
19780 Enables @value{GDBN} output of certain informational messages.
19781
19782 @item set verbose off
19783 Disables @value{GDBN} output of certain informational messages.
19784
19785 @kindex show verbose
19786 @item show verbose
19787 Displays whether @code{set verbose} is on or off.
19788 @end table
19789
19790 By default, if @value{GDBN} encounters bugs in the symbol table of an
19791 object file, it is silent; but if you are debugging a compiler, you may
19792 find this information useful (@pxref{Symbol Errors, ,Errors Reading
19793 Symbol Files}).
19794
19795 @table @code
19796
19797 @kindex set complaints
19798 @item set complaints @var{limit}
19799 Permits @value{GDBN} to output @var{limit} complaints about each type of
19800 unusual symbols before becoming silent about the problem. Set
19801 @var{limit} to zero to suppress all complaints; set it to a large number
19802 to prevent complaints from being suppressed.
19803
19804 @kindex show complaints
19805 @item show complaints
19806 Displays how many symbol complaints @value{GDBN} is permitted to produce.
19807
19808 @end table
19809
19810 @anchor{confirmation requests}
19811 By default, @value{GDBN} is cautious, and asks what sometimes seems to be a
19812 lot of stupid questions to confirm certain commands. For example, if
19813 you try to run a program which is already running:
19814
19815 @smallexample
19816 (@value{GDBP}) run
19817 The program being debugged has been started already.
19818 Start it from the beginning? (y or n)
19819 @end smallexample
19820
19821 If you are willing to unflinchingly face the consequences of your own
19822 commands, you can disable this ``feature'':
19823
19824 @table @code
19825
19826 @kindex set confirm
19827 @cindex flinching
19828 @cindex confirmation
19829 @cindex stupid questions
19830 @item set confirm off
19831 Disables confirmation requests. Note that running @value{GDBN} with
19832 the @option{--batch} option (@pxref{Mode Options, -batch}) also
19833 automatically disables confirmation requests.
19834
19835 @item set confirm on
19836 Enables confirmation requests (the default).
19837
19838 @kindex show confirm
19839 @item show confirm
19840 Displays state of confirmation requests.
19841
19842 @end table
19843
19844 @cindex command tracing
19845 If you need to debug user-defined commands or sourced files you may find it
19846 useful to enable @dfn{command tracing}. In this mode each command will be
19847 printed as it is executed, prefixed with one or more @samp{+} symbols, the
19848 quantity denoting the call depth of each command.
19849
19850 @table @code
19851 @kindex set trace-commands
19852 @cindex command scripts, debugging
19853 @item set trace-commands on
19854 Enable command tracing.
19855 @item set trace-commands off
19856 Disable command tracing.
19857 @item show trace-commands
19858 Display the current state of command tracing.
19859 @end table
19860
19861 @node Debugging Output
19862 @section Optional Messages about Internal Happenings
19863 @cindex optional debugging messages
19864
19865 @value{GDBN} has commands that enable optional debugging messages from
19866 various @value{GDBN} subsystems; normally these commands are of
19867 interest to @value{GDBN} maintainers, or when reporting a bug. This
19868 section documents those commands.
19869
19870 @table @code
19871 @kindex set exec-done-display
19872 @item set exec-done-display
19873 Turns on or off the notification of asynchronous commands'
19874 completion. When on, @value{GDBN} will print a message when an
19875 asynchronous command finishes its execution. The default is off.
19876 @kindex show exec-done-display
19877 @item show exec-done-display
19878 Displays the current setting of asynchronous command completion
19879 notification.
19880 @kindex set debug
19881 @cindex gdbarch debugging info
19882 @cindex architecture debugging info
19883 @item set debug arch
19884 Turns on or off display of gdbarch debugging info. The default is off
19885 @kindex show debug
19886 @item show debug arch
19887 Displays the current state of displaying gdbarch debugging info.
19888 @item set debug aix-thread
19889 @cindex AIX threads
19890 Display debugging messages about inner workings of the AIX thread
19891 module.
19892 @item show debug aix-thread
19893 Show the current state of AIX thread debugging info display.
19894 @item set debug dwarf2-die
19895 @cindex DWARF2 DIEs
19896 Dump DWARF2 DIEs after they are read in.
19897 The value is the number of nesting levels to print.
19898 A value of zero turns off the display.
19899 @item show debug dwarf2-die
19900 Show the current state of DWARF2 DIE debugging.
19901 @item set debug displaced
19902 @cindex displaced stepping debugging info
19903 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} debugging info for the
19904 displaced stepping support. The default is off.
19905 @item show debug displaced
19906 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} debugging info
19907 related to displaced stepping.
19908 @item set debug event
19909 @cindex event debugging info
19910 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} event debugging info. The
19911 default is off.
19912 @item show debug event
19913 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} event debugging
19914 info.
19915 @item set debug expression
19916 @cindex expression debugging info
19917 Turns on or off display of debugging info about @value{GDBN}
19918 expression parsing. The default is off.
19919 @item show debug expression
19920 Displays the current state of displaying debugging info about
19921 @value{GDBN} expression parsing.
19922 @item set debug frame
19923 @cindex frame debugging info
19924 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} frame debugging info. The
19925 default is off.
19926 @item show debug frame
19927 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} frame debugging
19928 info.
19929 @item set debug gnu-nat
19930 @cindex @sc{gnu}/Hurd debug messages
19931 Turns on or off debugging messages from the @sc{gnu}/Hurd debug support.
19932 @item show debug gnu-nat
19933 Show the current state of @sc{gnu}/Hurd debugging messages.
19934 @item set debug infrun
19935 @cindex inferior debugging info
19936 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} debugging info for running the inferior.
19937 The default is off. @file{infrun.c} contains GDB's runtime state machine used
19938 for implementing operations such as single-stepping the inferior.
19939 @item show debug infrun
19940 Displays the current state of @value{GDBN} inferior debugging.
19941 @item set debug jit
19942 @cindex just-in-time compilation, debugging messages
19943 Turns on or off debugging messages from JIT debug support.
19944 @item show debug jit
19945 Displays the current state of @value{GDBN} JIT debugging.
19946 @item set debug lin-lwp
19947 @cindex @sc{gnu}/Linux LWP debug messages
19948 @cindex Linux lightweight processes
19949 Turns on or off debugging messages from the Linux LWP debug support.
19950 @item show debug lin-lwp
19951 Show the current state of Linux LWP debugging messages.
19952 @item set debug lin-lwp-async
19953 @cindex @sc{gnu}/Linux LWP async debug messages
19954 @cindex Linux lightweight processes
19955 Turns on or off debugging messages from the Linux LWP async debug support.
19956 @item show debug lin-lwp-async
19957 Show the current state of Linux LWP async debugging messages.
19958 @item set debug observer
19959 @cindex observer debugging info
19960 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} observer debugging. This
19961 includes info such as the notification of observable events.
19962 @item show debug observer
19963 Displays the current state of observer debugging.
19964 @item set debug overload
19965 @cindex C@t{++} overload debugging info
19966 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} C@t{++} overload debugging
19967 info. This includes info such as ranking of functions, etc. The default
19968 is off.
19969 @item show debug overload
19970 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} C@t{++} overload
19971 debugging info.
19972 @cindex expression parser, debugging info
19973 @cindex debug expression parser
19974 @item set debug parser
19975 Turns on or off the display of expression parser debugging output.
19976 Internally, this sets the @code{yydebug} variable in the expression
19977 parser. @xref{Tracing, , Tracing Your Parser, bison, Bison}, for
19978 details. The default is off.
19979 @item show debug parser
19980 Show the current state of expression parser debugging.
19981 @cindex packets, reporting on stdout
19982 @cindex serial connections, debugging
19983 @cindex debug remote protocol
19984 @cindex remote protocol debugging
19985 @cindex display remote packets
19986 @item set debug remote
19987 Turns on or off display of reports on all packets sent back and forth across
19988 the serial line to the remote machine. The info is printed on the
19989 @value{GDBN} standard output stream. The default is off.
19990 @item show debug remote
19991 Displays the state of display of remote packets.
19992 @item set debug serial
19993 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} serial debugging info. The
19994 default is off.
19995 @item show debug serial
19996 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} serial debugging
19997 info.
19998 @item set debug solib-frv
19999 @cindex FR-V shared-library debugging
20000 Turns on or off debugging messages for FR-V shared-library code.
20001 @item show debug solib-frv
20002 Display the current state of FR-V shared-library code debugging
20003 messages.
20004 @item set debug target
20005 @cindex target debugging info
20006 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} target debugging info. This info
20007 includes what is going on at the target level of GDB, as it happens. The
20008 default is 0. Set it to 1 to track events, and to 2 to also track the
20009 value of large memory transfers. Changes to this flag do not take effect
20010 until the next time you connect to a target or use the @code{run} command.
20011 @item show debug target
20012 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} target debugging
20013 info.
20014 @item set debug timestamp
20015 @cindex timestampping debugging info
20016 Turns on or off display of timestamps with @value{GDBN} debugging info.
20017 When enabled, seconds and microseconds are displayed before each debugging
20018 message.
20019 @item show debug timestamp
20020 Displays the current state of displaying timestamps with @value{GDBN}
20021 debugging info.
20022 @item set debugvarobj
20023 @cindex variable object debugging info
20024 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} variable object debugging
20025 info. The default is off.
20026 @item show debugvarobj
20027 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} variable object
20028 debugging info.
20029 @item set debug xml
20030 @cindex XML parser debugging
20031 Turns on or off debugging messages for built-in XML parsers.
20032 @item show debug xml
20033 Displays the current state of XML debugging messages.
20034 @end table
20035
20036 @node Other Misc Settings
20037 @section Other Miscellaneous Settings
20038 @cindex miscellaneous settings
20039
20040 @table @code
20041 @kindex set interactive-mode
20042 @item set interactive-mode
20043 If @code{on}, forces @value{GDBN} to assume that GDB was started
20044 in a terminal. In practice, this means that @value{GDBN} should wait
20045 for the user to answer queries generated by commands entered at
20046 the command prompt. If @code{off}, forces @value{GDBN} to operate
20047 in the opposite mode, and it uses the default answers to all queries.
20048 If @code{auto} (the default), @value{GDBN} tries to determine whether
20049 its standard input is a terminal, and works in interactive-mode if it
20050 is, non-interactively otherwise.
20051
20052 In the vast majority of cases, the debugger should be able to guess
20053 correctly which mode should be used. But this setting can be useful
20054 in certain specific cases, such as running a MinGW @value{GDBN}
20055 inside a cygwin window.
20056
20057 @kindex show interactive-mode
20058 @item show interactive-mode
20059 Displays whether the debugger is operating in interactive mode or not.
20060 @end table
20061
20062 @node Extending GDB
20063 @chapter Extending @value{GDBN}
20064 @cindex extending GDB
20065
20066 @value{GDBN} provides two mechanisms for extension. The first is based
20067 on composition of @value{GDBN} commands, and the second is based on the
20068 Python scripting language.
20069
20070 To facilitate the use of these extensions, @value{GDBN} is capable
20071 of evaluating the contents of a file. When doing so, @value{GDBN}
20072 can recognize which scripting language is being used by looking at
20073 the filename extension. Files with an unrecognized filename extension
20074 are always treated as a @value{GDBN} Command Files.
20075 @xref{Command Files,, Command files}.
20076
20077 You can control how @value{GDBN} evaluates these files with the following
20078 setting:
20079
20080 @table @code
20081 @kindex set script-extension
20082 @kindex show script-extension
20083 @item set script-extension off
20084 All scripts are always evaluated as @value{GDBN} Command Files.
20085
20086 @item set script-extension soft
20087 The debugger determines the scripting language based on filename
20088 extension. If this scripting language is supported, @value{GDBN}
20089 evaluates the script using that language. Otherwise, it evaluates
20090 the file as a @value{GDBN} Command File.
20091
20092 @item set script-extension strict
20093 The debugger determines the scripting language based on filename
20094 extension, and evaluates the script using that language. If the
20095 language is not supported, then the evaluation fails.
20096
20097 @item show script-extension
20098 Display the current value of the @code{script-extension} option.
20099
20100 @end table
20101
20102 @menu
20103 * Sequences:: Canned Sequences of Commands
20104 * Python:: Scripting @value{GDBN} using Python
20105 @end menu
20106
20107 @node Sequences
20108 @section Canned Sequences of Commands
20109
20110 Aside from breakpoint commands (@pxref{Break Commands, ,Breakpoint
20111 Command Lists}), @value{GDBN} provides two ways to store sequences of
20112 commands for execution as a unit: user-defined commands and command
20113 files.
20114
20115 @menu
20116 * Define:: How to define your own commands
20117 * Hooks:: Hooks for user-defined commands
20118 * Command Files:: How to write scripts of commands to be stored in a file
20119 * Output:: Commands for controlled output
20120 @end menu
20121
20122 @node Define
20123 @subsection User-defined Commands
20124
20125 @cindex user-defined command
20126 @cindex arguments, to user-defined commands
20127 A @dfn{user-defined command} is a sequence of @value{GDBN} commands to
20128 which you assign a new name as a command. This is done with the
20129 @code{define} command. User commands may accept up to 10 arguments
20130 separated by whitespace. Arguments are accessed within the user command
20131 via @code{$arg0@dots{}$arg9}. A trivial example:
20132
20133 @smallexample
20134 define adder
20135 print $arg0 + $arg1 + $arg2
20136 end
20137 @end smallexample
20138
20139 @noindent
20140 To execute the command use:
20141
20142 @smallexample
20143 adder 1 2 3
20144 @end smallexample
20145
20146 @noindent
20147 This defines the command @code{adder}, which prints the sum of
20148 its three arguments. Note the arguments are text substitutions, so they may
20149 reference variables, use complex expressions, or even perform inferior
20150 functions calls.
20151
20152 @cindex argument count in user-defined commands
20153 @cindex how many arguments (user-defined commands)
20154 In addition, @code{$argc} may be used to find out how many arguments have
20155 been passed. This expands to a number in the range 0@dots{}10.
20156
20157 @smallexample
20158 define adder
20159 if $argc == 2
20160 print $arg0 + $arg1
20161 end
20162 if $argc == 3
20163 print $arg0 + $arg1 + $arg2
20164 end
20165 end
20166 @end smallexample
20167
20168 @table @code
20169
20170 @kindex define
20171 @item define @var{commandname}
20172 Define a command named @var{commandname}. If there is already a command
20173 by that name, you are asked to confirm that you want to redefine it.
20174 @var{commandname} may be a bare command name consisting of letters,
20175 numbers, dashes, and underscores. It may also start with any predefined
20176 prefix command. For example, @samp{define target my-target} creates
20177 a user-defined @samp{target my-target} command.
20178
20179 The definition of the command is made up of other @value{GDBN} command lines,
20180 which are given following the @code{define} command. The end of these
20181 commands is marked by a line containing @code{end}.
20182
20183 @kindex document
20184 @kindex end@r{ (user-defined commands)}
20185 @item document @var{commandname}
20186 Document the user-defined command @var{commandname}, so that it can be
20187 accessed by @code{help}. The command @var{commandname} must already be
20188 defined. This command reads lines of documentation just as @code{define}
20189 reads the lines of the command definition, ending with @code{end}.
20190 After the @code{document} command is finished, @code{help} on command
20191 @var{commandname} displays the documentation you have written.
20192
20193 You may use the @code{document} command again to change the
20194 documentation of a command. Redefining the command with @code{define}
20195 does not change the documentation.
20196
20197 @kindex dont-repeat
20198 @cindex don't repeat command
20199 @item dont-repeat
20200 Used inside a user-defined command, this tells @value{GDBN} that this
20201 command should not be repeated when the user hits @key{RET}
20202 (@pxref{Command Syntax, repeat last command}).
20203
20204 @kindex help user-defined
20205 @item help user-defined
20206 List all user-defined commands, with the first line of the documentation
20207 (if any) for each.
20208
20209 @kindex show user
20210 @item show user
20211 @itemx show user @var{commandname}
20212 Display the @value{GDBN} commands used to define @var{commandname} (but
20213 not its documentation). If no @var{commandname} is given, display the
20214 definitions for all user-defined commands.
20215
20216 @cindex infinite recursion in user-defined commands
20217 @kindex show max-user-call-depth
20218 @kindex set max-user-call-depth
20219 @item show max-user-call-depth
20220 @itemx set max-user-call-depth
20221 The value of @code{max-user-call-depth} controls how many recursion
20222 levels are allowed in user-defined commands before @value{GDBN} suspects an
20223 infinite recursion and aborts the command.
20224 @end table
20225
20226 In addition to the above commands, user-defined commands frequently
20227 use control flow commands, described in @ref{Command Files}.
20228
20229 When user-defined commands are executed, the
20230 commands of the definition are not printed. An error in any command
20231 stops execution of the user-defined command.
20232
20233 If used interactively, commands that would ask for confirmation proceed
20234 without asking when used inside a user-defined command. Many @value{GDBN}
20235 commands that normally print messages to say what they are doing omit the
20236 messages when used in a user-defined command.
20237
20238 @node Hooks
20239 @subsection User-defined Command Hooks
20240 @cindex command hooks
20241 @cindex hooks, for commands
20242 @cindex hooks, pre-command
20243
20244 @kindex hook
20245 You may define @dfn{hooks}, which are a special kind of user-defined
20246 command. Whenever you run the command @samp{foo}, if the user-defined
20247 command @samp{hook-foo} exists, it is executed (with no arguments)
20248 before that command.
20249
20250 @cindex hooks, post-command
20251 @kindex hookpost
20252 A hook may also be defined which is run after the command you executed.
20253 Whenever you run the command @samp{foo}, if the user-defined command
20254 @samp{hookpost-foo} exists, it is executed (with no arguments) after
20255 that command. Post-execution hooks may exist simultaneously with
20256 pre-execution hooks, for the same command.
20257
20258 It is valid for a hook to call the command which it hooks. If this
20259 occurs, the hook is not re-executed, thereby avoiding infinite recursion.
20260
20261 @c It would be nice if hookpost could be passed a parameter indicating
20262 @c if the command it hooks executed properly or not. FIXME!
20263
20264 @kindex stop@r{, a pseudo-command}
20265 In addition, a pseudo-command, @samp{stop} exists. Defining
20266 (@samp{hook-stop}) makes the associated commands execute every time
20267 execution stops in your program: before breakpoint commands are run,
20268 displays are printed, or the stack frame is printed.
20269
20270 For example, to ignore @code{SIGALRM} signals while
20271 single-stepping, but treat them normally during normal execution,
20272 you could define:
20273
20274 @smallexample
20275 define hook-stop
20276 handle SIGALRM nopass
20277 end
20278
20279 define hook-run
20280 handle SIGALRM pass
20281 end
20282
20283 define hook-continue
20284 handle SIGALRM pass
20285 end
20286 @end smallexample
20287
20288 As a further example, to hook at the beginning and end of the @code{echo}
20289 command, and to add extra text to the beginning and end of the message,
20290 you could define:
20291
20292 @smallexample
20293 define hook-echo
20294 echo <<<---
20295 end
20296
20297 define hookpost-echo
20298 echo --->>>\n
20299 end
20300
20301 (@value{GDBP}) echo Hello World
20302 <<<---Hello World--->>>
20303 (@value{GDBP})
20304
20305 @end smallexample
20306
20307 You can define a hook for any single-word command in @value{GDBN}, but
20308 not for command aliases; you should define a hook for the basic command
20309 name, e.g.@: @code{backtrace} rather than @code{bt}.
20310 @c FIXME! So how does Joe User discover whether a command is an alias
20311 @c or not?
20312 You can hook a multi-word command by adding @code{hook-} or
20313 @code{hookpost-} to the last word of the command, e.g.@:
20314 @samp{define target hook-remote} to add a hook to @samp{target remote}.
20315
20316 If an error occurs during the execution of your hook, execution of
20317 @value{GDBN} commands stops and @value{GDBN} issues a prompt
20318 (before the command that you actually typed had a chance to run).
20319
20320 If you try to define a hook which does not match any known command, you
20321 get a warning from the @code{define} command.
20322
20323 @node Command Files
20324 @subsection Command Files
20325
20326 @cindex command files
20327 @cindex scripting commands
20328 A command file for @value{GDBN} is a text file made of lines that are
20329 @value{GDBN} commands. Comments (lines starting with @kbd{#}) may
20330 also be included. An empty line in a command file does nothing; it
20331 does not mean to repeat the last command, as it would from the
20332 terminal.
20333
20334 You can request the execution of a command file with the @code{source}
20335 command. Note that the @code{source} command is also used to evaluate
20336 scripts that are not Command Files. The exact behavior can be configured
20337 using the @code{script-extension} setting.
20338 @xref{Extending GDB,, Extending GDB}.
20339
20340 @table @code
20341 @kindex source
20342 @cindex execute commands from a file
20343 @item source [-s] [-v] @var{filename}
20344 Execute the command file @var{filename}.
20345 @end table
20346
20347 The lines in a command file are generally executed sequentially,
20348 unless the order of execution is changed by one of the
20349 @emph{flow-control commands} described below. The commands are not
20350 printed as they are executed. An error in any command terminates
20351 execution of the command file and control is returned to the console.
20352
20353 @value{GDBN} first searches for @var{filename} in the current directory.
20354 If the file is not found there, and @var{filename} does not specify a
20355 directory, then @value{GDBN} also looks for the file on the source search path
20356 (specified with the @samp{directory} command);
20357 except that @file{$cdir} is not searched because the compilation directory
20358 is not relevant to scripts.
20359
20360 If @code{-s} is specified, then @value{GDBN} searches for @var{filename}
20361 on the search path even if @var{filename} specifies a directory.
20362 The search is done by appending @var{filename} to each element of the
20363 search path. So, for example, if @var{filename} is @file{mylib/myscript}
20364 and the search path contains @file{/home/user} then @value{GDBN} will
20365 look for the script @file{/home/user/mylib/myscript}.
20366 The search is also done if @var{filename} is an absolute path.
20367 For example, if @var{filename} is @file{/tmp/myscript} and
20368 the search path contains @file{/home/user} then @value{GDBN} will
20369 look for the script @file{/home/user/tmp/myscript}.
20370 For DOS-like systems, if @var{filename} contains a drive specification,
20371 it is stripped before concatenation. For example, if @var{filename} is
20372 @file{d:myscript} and the search path contains @file{c:/tmp} then @value{GDBN}
20373 will look for the script @file{c:/tmp/myscript}.
20374
20375 If @code{-v}, for verbose mode, is given then @value{GDBN} displays
20376 each command as it is executed. The option must be given before
20377 @var{filename}, and is interpreted as part of the filename anywhere else.
20378
20379 Commands that would ask for confirmation if used interactively proceed
20380 without asking when used in a command file. Many @value{GDBN} commands that
20381 normally print messages to say what they are doing omit the messages
20382 when called from command files.
20383
20384 @value{GDBN} also accepts command input from standard input. In this
20385 mode, normal output goes to standard output and error output goes to
20386 standard error. Errors in a command file supplied on standard input do
20387 not terminate execution of the command file---execution continues with
20388 the next command.
20389
20390 @smallexample
20391 gdb < cmds > log 2>&1
20392 @end smallexample
20393
20394 (The syntax above will vary depending on the shell used.) This example
20395 will execute commands from the file @file{cmds}. All output and errors
20396 would be directed to @file{log}.
20397
20398 Since commands stored on command files tend to be more general than
20399 commands typed interactively, they frequently need to deal with
20400 complicated situations, such as different or unexpected values of
20401 variables and symbols, changes in how the program being debugged is
20402 built, etc. @value{GDBN} provides a set of flow-control commands to
20403 deal with these complexities. Using these commands, you can write
20404 complex scripts that loop over data structures, execute commands
20405 conditionally, etc.
20406
20407 @table @code
20408 @kindex if
20409 @kindex else
20410 @item if
20411 @itemx else
20412 This command allows to include in your script conditionally executed
20413 commands. The @code{if} command takes a single argument, which is an
20414 expression to evaluate. It is followed by a series of commands that
20415 are executed only if the expression is true (its value is nonzero).
20416 There can then optionally be an @code{else} line, followed by a series
20417 of commands that are only executed if the expression was false. The
20418 end of the list is marked by a line containing @code{end}.
20419
20420 @kindex while
20421 @item while
20422 This command allows to write loops. Its syntax is similar to
20423 @code{if}: the command takes a single argument, which is an expression
20424 to evaluate, and must be followed by the commands to execute, one per
20425 line, terminated by an @code{end}. These commands are called the
20426 @dfn{body} of the loop. The commands in the body of @code{while} are
20427 executed repeatedly as long as the expression evaluates to true.
20428
20429 @kindex loop_break
20430 @item loop_break
20431 This command exits the @code{while} loop in whose body it is included.
20432 Execution of the script continues after that @code{while}s @code{end}
20433 line.
20434
20435 @kindex loop_continue
20436 @item loop_continue
20437 This command skips the execution of the rest of the body of commands
20438 in the @code{while} loop in whose body it is included. Execution
20439 branches to the beginning of the @code{while} loop, where it evaluates
20440 the controlling expression.
20441
20442 @kindex end@r{ (if/else/while commands)}
20443 @item end
20444 Terminate the block of commands that are the body of @code{if},
20445 @code{else}, or @code{while} flow-control commands.
20446 @end table
20447
20448
20449 @node Output
20450 @subsection Commands for Controlled Output
20451
20452 During the execution of a command file or a user-defined command, normal
20453 @value{GDBN} output is suppressed; the only output that appears is what is
20454 explicitly printed by the commands in the definition. This section
20455 describes three commands useful for generating exactly the output you
20456 want.
20457
20458 @table @code
20459 @kindex echo
20460 @item echo @var{text}
20461 @c I do not consider backslash-space a standard C escape sequence
20462 @c because it is not in ANSI.
20463 Print @var{text}. Nonprinting characters can be included in
20464 @var{text} using C escape sequences, such as @samp{\n} to print a
20465 newline. @strong{No newline is printed unless you specify one.}
20466 In addition to the standard C escape sequences, a backslash followed
20467 by a space stands for a space. This is useful for displaying a
20468 string with spaces at the beginning or the end, since leading and
20469 trailing spaces are otherwise trimmed from all arguments.
20470 To print @samp{@w{ }and foo =@w{ }}, use the command
20471 @samp{echo \@w{ }and foo = \@w{ }}.
20472
20473 A backslash at the end of @var{text} can be used, as in C, to continue
20474 the command onto subsequent lines. For example,
20475
20476 @smallexample
20477 echo This is some text\n\
20478 which is continued\n\
20479 onto several lines.\n
20480 @end smallexample
20481
20482 produces the same output as
20483
20484 @smallexample
20485 echo This is some text\n
20486 echo which is continued\n
20487 echo onto several lines.\n
20488 @end smallexample
20489
20490 @kindex output
20491 @item output @var{expression}
20492 Print the value of @var{expression} and nothing but that value: no
20493 newlines, no @samp{$@var{nn} = }. The value is not entered in the
20494 value history either. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}, for more information
20495 on expressions.
20496
20497 @item output/@var{fmt} @var{expression}
20498 Print the value of @var{expression} in format @var{fmt}. You can use
20499 the same formats as for @code{print}. @xref{Output Formats,,Output
20500 Formats}, for more information.
20501
20502 @kindex printf
20503 @item printf @var{template}, @var{expressions}@dots{}
20504 Print the values of one or more @var{expressions} under the control of
20505 the string @var{template}. To print several values, make
20506 @var{expressions} be a comma-separated list of individual expressions,
20507 which may be either numbers or pointers. Their values are printed as
20508 specified by @var{template}, exactly as a C program would do by
20509 executing the code below:
20510
20511 @smallexample
20512 printf (@var{template}, @var{expressions}@dots{});
20513 @end smallexample
20514
20515 As in @code{C} @code{printf}, ordinary characters in @var{template}
20516 are printed verbatim, while @dfn{conversion specification} introduced
20517 by the @samp{%} character cause subsequent @var{expressions} to be
20518 evaluated, their values converted and formatted according to type and
20519 style information encoded in the conversion specifications, and then
20520 printed.
20521
20522 For example, you can print two values in hex like this:
20523
20524 @smallexample
20525 printf "foo, bar-foo = 0x%x, 0x%x\n", foo, bar-foo
20526 @end smallexample
20527
20528 @code{printf} supports all the standard @code{C} conversion
20529 specifications, including the flags and modifiers between the @samp{%}
20530 character and the conversion letter, with the following exceptions:
20531
20532 @itemize @bullet
20533 @item
20534 The argument-ordering modifiers, such as @samp{2$}, are not supported.
20535
20536 @item
20537 The modifier @samp{*} is not supported for specifying precision or
20538 width.
20539
20540 @item
20541 The @samp{'} flag (for separation of digits into groups according to
20542 @code{LC_NUMERIC'}) is not supported.
20543
20544 @item
20545 The type modifiers @samp{hh}, @samp{j}, @samp{t}, and @samp{z} are not
20546 supported.
20547
20548 @item
20549 The conversion letter @samp{n} (as in @samp{%n}) is not supported.
20550
20551 @item
20552 The conversion letters @samp{a} and @samp{A} are not supported.
20553 @end itemize
20554
20555 @noindent
20556 Note that the @samp{ll} type modifier is supported only if the
20557 underlying @code{C} implementation used to build @value{GDBN} supports
20558 the @code{long long int} type, and the @samp{L} type modifier is
20559 supported only if @code{long double} type is available.
20560
20561 As in @code{C}, @code{printf} supports simple backslash-escape
20562 sequences, such as @code{\n}, @samp{\t}, @samp{\\}, @samp{\"},
20563 @samp{\a}, and @samp{\f}, that consist of backslash followed by a
20564 single character. Octal and hexadecimal escape sequences are not
20565 supported.
20566
20567 Additionally, @code{printf} supports conversion specifications for DFP
20568 (@dfn{Decimal Floating Point}) types using the following length modifiers
20569 together with a floating point specifier.
20570 letters:
20571
20572 @itemize @bullet
20573 @item
20574 @samp{H} for printing @code{Decimal32} types.
20575
20576 @item
20577 @samp{D} for printing @code{Decimal64} types.
20578
20579 @item
20580 @samp{DD} for printing @code{Decimal128} types.
20581 @end itemize
20582
20583 If the underlying @code{C} implementation used to build @value{GDBN} has
20584 support for the three length modifiers for DFP types, other modifiers
20585 such as width and precision will also be available for @value{GDBN} to use.
20586
20587 In case there is no such @code{C} support, no additional modifiers will be
20588 available and the value will be printed in the standard way.
20589
20590 Here's an example of printing DFP types using the above conversion letters:
20591 @smallexample
20592 printf "D32: %Hf - D64: %Df - D128: %DDf\n",1.2345df,1.2E10dd,1.2E1dl
20593 @end smallexample
20594
20595 @kindex eval
20596 @item eval @var{template}, @var{expressions}@dots{}
20597 Convert the values of one or more @var{expressions} under the control of
20598 the string @var{template} to a command line, and call it.
20599
20600 @end table
20601
20602 @node Python
20603 @section Scripting @value{GDBN} using Python
20604 @cindex python scripting
20605 @cindex scripting with python
20606
20607 You can script @value{GDBN} using the @uref{http://www.python.org/,
20608 Python programming language}. This feature is available only if
20609 @value{GDBN} was configured using @option{--with-python}.
20610
20611 @cindex python directory
20612 Python scripts used by @value{GDBN} should be installed in
20613 @file{@var{data-directory}/python}, where @var{data-directory} is
20614 the data directory as determined at @value{GDBN} startup (@pxref{Data Files}).
20615 This directory, known as the @dfn{python directory},
20616 is automatically added to the Python Search Path in order to allow
20617 the Python interpreter to locate all scripts installed at this location.
20618
20619 @menu
20620 * Python Commands:: Accessing Python from @value{GDBN}.
20621 * Python API:: Accessing @value{GDBN} from Python.
20622 * Auto-loading:: Automatically loading Python code.
20623 * Python modules:: Python modules provided by @value{GDBN}.
20624 @end menu
20625
20626 @node Python Commands
20627 @subsection Python Commands
20628 @cindex python commands
20629 @cindex commands to access python
20630
20631 @value{GDBN} provides one command for accessing the Python interpreter,
20632 and one related setting:
20633
20634 @table @code
20635 @kindex python
20636 @item python @r{[}@var{code}@r{]}
20637 The @code{python} command can be used to evaluate Python code.
20638
20639 If given an argument, the @code{python} command will evaluate the
20640 argument as a Python command. For example:
20641
20642 @smallexample
20643 (@value{GDBP}) python print 23
20644 23
20645 @end smallexample
20646
20647 If you do not provide an argument to @code{python}, it will act as a
20648 multi-line command, like @code{define}. In this case, the Python
20649 script is made up of subsequent command lines, given after the
20650 @code{python} command. This command list is terminated using a line
20651 containing @code{end}. For example:
20652
20653 @smallexample
20654 (@value{GDBP}) python
20655 Type python script
20656 End with a line saying just "end".
20657 >print 23
20658 >end
20659 23
20660 @end smallexample
20661
20662 @kindex maint set python print-stack
20663 @item maint set python print-stack
20664 By default, @value{GDBN} will print a stack trace when an error occurs
20665 in a Python script. This can be controlled using @code{maint set
20666 python print-stack}: if @code{on}, the default, then Python stack
20667 printing is enabled; if @code{off}, then Python stack printing is
20668 disabled.
20669 @end table
20670
20671 It is also possible to execute a Python script from the @value{GDBN}
20672 interpreter:
20673
20674 @table @code
20675 @item source @file{script-name}
20676 The script name must end with @samp{.py} and @value{GDBN} must be configured
20677 to recognize the script language based on filename extension using
20678 the @code{script-extension} setting. @xref{Extending GDB, ,Extending GDB}.
20679
20680 @item python execfile ("script-name")
20681 This method is based on the @code{execfile} Python built-in function,
20682 and thus is always available.
20683 @end table
20684
20685 @node Python API
20686 @subsection Python API
20687 @cindex python api
20688 @cindex programming in python
20689
20690 @cindex python stdout
20691 @cindex python pagination
20692 At startup, @value{GDBN} overrides Python's @code{sys.stdout} and
20693 @code{sys.stderr} to print using @value{GDBN}'s output-paging streams.
20694 A Python program which outputs to one of these streams may have its
20695 output interrupted by the user (@pxref{Screen Size}). In this
20696 situation, a Python @code{KeyboardInterrupt} exception is thrown.
20697
20698 @menu
20699 * Basic Python:: Basic Python Functions.
20700 * Exception Handling:: How Python exceptions are translated.
20701 * Values From Inferior:: Python representation of values.
20702 * Types In Python:: Python representation of types.
20703 * Pretty Printing API:: Pretty-printing values.
20704 * Selecting Pretty-Printers:: How GDB chooses a pretty-printer.
20705 * Writing a Pretty-Printer:: Writing a Pretty-Printer.
20706 * Inferiors In Python:: Python representation of inferiors (processes)
20707 * Events In Python:: Listening for events from @value{GDBN}.
20708 * Threads In Python:: Accessing inferior threads from Python.
20709 * Commands In Python:: Implementing new commands in Python.
20710 * Parameters In Python:: Adding new @value{GDBN} parameters.
20711 * Functions In Python:: Writing new convenience functions.
20712 * Progspaces In Python:: Program spaces.
20713 * Objfiles In Python:: Object files.
20714 * Frames In Python:: Accessing inferior stack frames from Python.
20715 * Blocks In Python:: Accessing frame blocks from Python.
20716 * Symbols In Python:: Python representation of symbols.
20717 * Symbol Tables In Python:: Python representation of symbol tables.
20718 * Lazy Strings In Python:: Python representation of lazy strings.
20719 * Breakpoints In Python:: Manipulating breakpoints using Python.
20720 @end menu
20721
20722 @node Basic Python
20723 @subsubsection Basic Python
20724
20725 @cindex python functions
20726 @cindex python module
20727 @cindex gdb module
20728 @value{GDBN} introduces a new Python module, named @code{gdb}. All
20729 methods and classes added by @value{GDBN} are placed in this module.
20730 @value{GDBN} automatically @code{import}s the @code{gdb} module for
20731 use in all scripts evaluated by the @code{python} command.
20732
20733 @findex gdb.PYTHONDIR
20734 @defvar PYTHONDIR
20735 A string containing the python directory (@pxref{Python}).
20736 @end defvar
20737
20738 @findex gdb.execute
20739 @defun execute command [from_tty] [to_string]
20740 Evaluate @var{command}, a string, as a @value{GDBN} CLI command.
20741 If a GDB exception happens while @var{command} runs, it is
20742 translated as described in @ref{Exception Handling,,Exception Handling}.
20743
20744 @var{from_tty} specifies whether @value{GDBN} ought to consider this
20745 command as having originated from the user invoking it interactively.
20746 It must be a boolean value. If omitted, it defaults to @code{False}.
20747
20748 By default, any output produced by @var{command} is sent to
20749 @value{GDBN}'s standard output. If the @var{to_string} parameter is
20750 @code{True}, then output will be collected by @code{gdb.execute} and
20751 returned as a string. The default is @code{False}, in which case the
20752 return value is @code{None}. If @var{to_string} is @code{True}, the
20753 @value{GDBN} virtual terminal will be temporarily set to unlimited width
20754 and height, and its pagination will be disabled; @pxref{Screen Size}.
20755 @end defun
20756
20757 @findex gdb.breakpoints
20758 @defun breakpoints
20759 Return a sequence holding all of @value{GDBN}'s breakpoints.
20760 @xref{Breakpoints In Python}, for more information.
20761 @end defun
20762
20763 @findex gdb.parameter
20764 @defun parameter parameter
20765 Return the value of a @value{GDBN} parameter. @var{parameter} is a
20766 string naming the parameter to look up; @var{parameter} may contain
20767 spaces if the parameter has a multi-part name. For example,
20768 @samp{print object} is a valid parameter name.
20769
20770 If the named parameter does not exist, this function throws a
20771 @code{gdb.error} (@pxref{Exception Handling}). Otherwise, the
20772 parameter's value is converted to a Python value of the appropriate
20773 type, and returned.
20774 @end defun
20775
20776 @findex gdb.history
20777 @defun history number
20778 Return a value from @value{GDBN}'s value history (@pxref{Value
20779 History}). @var{number} indicates which history element to return.
20780 If @var{number} is negative, then @value{GDBN} will take its absolute value
20781 and count backward from the last element (i.e., the most recent element) to
20782 find the value to return. If @var{number} is zero, then @value{GDBN} will
20783 return the most recent element. If the element specified by @var{number}
20784 doesn't exist in the value history, a @code{gdb.error} exception will be
20785 raised.
20786
20787 If no exception is raised, the return value is always an instance of
20788 @code{gdb.Value} (@pxref{Values From Inferior}).
20789 @end defun
20790
20791 @findex gdb.parse_and_eval
20792 @defun parse_and_eval expression
20793 Parse @var{expression} as an expression in the current language,
20794 evaluate it, and return the result as a @code{gdb.Value}.
20795 @var{expression} must be a string.
20796
20797 This function can be useful when implementing a new command
20798 (@pxref{Commands In Python}), as it provides a way to parse the
20799 command's argument as an expression. It is also useful simply to
20800 compute values, for example, it is the only way to get the value of a
20801 convenience variable (@pxref{Convenience Vars}) as a @code{gdb.Value}.
20802 @end defun
20803
20804 @findex gdb.post_event
20805 @defun post_event event
20806 Put @var{event}, a callable object taking no arguments, into
20807 @value{GDBN}'s internal event queue. This callable will be invoked at
20808 some later point, during @value{GDBN}'s event processing. Events
20809 posted using @code{post_event} will be run in the order in which they
20810 were posted; however, there is no way to know when they will be
20811 processed relative to other events inside @value{GDBN}.
20812
20813 @value{GDBN} is not thread-safe. If your Python program uses multiple
20814 threads, you must be careful to only call @value{GDBN}-specific
20815 functions in the main @value{GDBN} thread. @code{post_event} ensures
20816 this. For example:
20817
20818 @smallexample
20819 (@value{GDBP}) python
20820 >import threading
20821 >
20822 >class Writer():
20823 > def __init__(self, message):
20824 > self.message = message;
20825 > def __call__(self):
20826 > gdb.write(self.message)
20827 >
20828 >class MyThread1 (threading.Thread):
20829 > def run (self):
20830 > gdb.post_event(Writer("Hello "))
20831 >
20832 >class MyThread2 (threading.Thread):
20833 > def run (self):
20834 > gdb.post_event(Writer("World\n"))
20835 >
20836 >MyThread1().start()
20837 >MyThread2().start()
20838 >end
20839 (@value{GDBP}) Hello World
20840 @end smallexample
20841 @end defun
20842
20843 @findex gdb.write
20844 @defun write string
20845 Print a string to @value{GDBN}'s paginated standard output stream.
20846 Writing to @code{sys.stdout} or @code{sys.stderr} will automatically
20847 call this function.
20848 @end defun
20849
20850 @findex gdb.flush
20851 @defun flush
20852 Flush @value{GDBN}'s paginated standard output stream. Flushing
20853 @code{sys.stdout} or @code{sys.stderr} will automatically call this
20854 function.
20855 @end defun
20856
20857 @findex gdb.target_charset
20858 @defun target_charset
20859 Return the name of the current target character set (@pxref{Character
20860 Sets}). This differs from @code{gdb.parameter('target-charset')} in
20861 that @samp{auto} is never returned.
20862 @end defun
20863
20864 @findex gdb.target_wide_charset
20865 @defun target_wide_charset
20866 Return the name of the current target wide character set
20867 (@pxref{Character Sets}). This differs from
20868 @code{gdb.parameter('target-wide-charset')} in that @samp{auto} is
20869 never returned.
20870 @end defun
20871
20872 @findex gdb.solib_name
20873 @defun solib_name address
20874 Return the name of the shared library holding the given @var{address}
20875 as a string, or @code{None}.
20876 @end defun
20877
20878 @findex gdb.decode_line
20879 @defun decode_line @r{[}expression@r{]}
20880 Return locations of the line specified by @var{expression}, or of the
20881 current line if no argument was given. This function returns a Python
20882 tuple containing two elements. The first element contains a string
20883 holding any unparsed section of @var{expression} (or @code{None} if
20884 the expression has been fully parsed). The second element contains
20885 either @code{None} or another tuple that contains all the locations
20886 that match the expression represented as @code{gdb.Symtab_and_line}
20887 objects (@pxref{Symbol Tables In Python}). If @var{expression} is
20888 provided, it is decoded the way that @value{GDBN}'s inbuilt
20889 @code{break} or @code{edit} commands do (@pxref{Specify Location}).
20890 @end defun
20891
20892 @node Exception Handling
20893 @subsubsection Exception Handling
20894 @cindex python exceptions
20895 @cindex exceptions, python
20896
20897 When executing the @code{python} command, Python exceptions
20898 uncaught within the Python code are translated to calls to
20899 @value{GDBN} error-reporting mechanism. If the command that called
20900 @code{python} does not handle the error, @value{GDBN} will
20901 terminate it and print an error message containing the Python
20902 exception name, the associated value, and the Python call stack
20903 backtrace at the point where the exception was raised. Example:
20904
20905 @smallexample
20906 (@value{GDBP}) python print foo
20907 Traceback (most recent call last):
20908 File "<string>", line 1, in <module>
20909 NameError: name 'foo' is not defined
20910 @end smallexample
20911
20912 @value{GDBN} errors that happen in @value{GDBN} commands invoked by
20913 Python code are converted to Python exceptions. The type of the
20914 Python exception depends on the error.
20915
20916 @ftable @code
20917 @item gdb.error
20918 This is the base class for most exceptions generated by @value{GDBN}.
20919 It is derived from @code{RuntimeError}, for compatibility with earlier
20920 versions of @value{GDBN}.
20921
20922 If an error occurring in @value{GDBN} does not fit into some more
20923 specific category, then the generated exception will have this type.
20924
20925 @item gdb.MemoryError
20926 This is a subclass of @code{gdb.error} which is thrown when an
20927 operation tried to access invalid memory in the inferior.
20928
20929 @item KeyboardInterrupt
20930 User interrupt (via @kbd{C-c} or by typing @kbd{q} at a pagination
20931 prompt) is translated to a Python @code{KeyboardInterrupt} exception.
20932 @end ftable
20933
20934 In all cases, your exception handler will see the @value{GDBN} error
20935 message as its value and the Python call stack backtrace at the Python
20936 statement closest to where the @value{GDBN} error occured as the
20937 traceback.
20938
20939 @findex gdb.GdbError
20940 When implementing @value{GDBN} commands in Python via @code{gdb.Command},
20941 it is useful to be able to throw an exception that doesn't cause a
20942 traceback to be printed. For example, the user may have invoked the
20943 command incorrectly. Use the @code{gdb.GdbError} exception
20944 to handle this case. Example:
20945
20946 @smallexample
20947 (gdb) python
20948 >class HelloWorld (gdb.Command):
20949 > """Greet the whole world."""
20950 > def __init__ (self):
20951 > super (HelloWorld, self).__init__ ("hello-world", gdb.COMMAND_OBSCURE)
20952 > def invoke (self, args, from_tty):
20953 > argv = gdb.string_to_argv (args)
20954 > if len (argv) != 0:
20955 > raise gdb.GdbError ("hello-world takes no arguments")
20956 > print "Hello, World!"
20957 >HelloWorld ()
20958 >end
20959 (gdb) hello-world 42
20960 hello-world takes no arguments
20961 @end smallexample
20962
20963 @node Values From Inferior
20964 @subsubsection Values From Inferior
20965 @cindex values from inferior, with Python
20966 @cindex python, working with values from inferior
20967
20968 @cindex @code{gdb.Value}
20969 @value{GDBN} provides values it obtains from the inferior program in
20970 an object of type @code{gdb.Value}. @value{GDBN} uses this object
20971 for its internal bookkeeping of the inferior's values, and for
20972 fetching values when necessary.
20973
20974 Inferior values that are simple scalars can be used directly in
20975 Python expressions that are valid for the value's data type. Here's
20976 an example for an integer or floating-point value @code{some_val}:
20977
20978 @smallexample
20979 bar = some_val + 2
20980 @end smallexample
20981
20982 @noindent
20983 As result of this, @code{bar} will also be a @code{gdb.Value} object
20984 whose values are of the same type as those of @code{some_val}.
20985
20986 Inferior values that are structures or instances of some class can
20987 be accessed using the Python @dfn{dictionary syntax}. For example, if
20988 @code{some_val} is a @code{gdb.Value} instance holding a structure, you
20989 can access its @code{foo} element with:
20990
20991 @smallexample
20992 bar = some_val['foo']
20993 @end smallexample
20994
20995 Again, @code{bar} will also be a @code{gdb.Value} object.
20996
20997 A @code{gdb.Value} that represents a function can be executed via
20998 inferior function call. Any arguments provided to the call must match
20999 the function's prototype, and must be provided in the order specified
21000 by that prototype.
21001
21002 For example, @code{some_val} is a @code{gdb.Value} instance
21003 representing a function that takes two integers as arguments. To
21004 execute this function, call it like so:
21005
21006 @smallexample
21007 result = some_val (10,20)
21008 @end smallexample
21009
21010 Any values returned from a function call will be stored as a
21011 @code{gdb.Value}.
21012
21013 The following attributes are provided:
21014
21015 @table @code
21016 @defivar Value address
21017 If this object is addressable, this read-only attribute holds a
21018 @code{gdb.Value} object representing the address. Otherwise,
21019 this attribute holds @code{None}.
21020 @end defivar
21021
21022 @cindex optimized out value in Python
21023 @defivar Value is_optimized_out
21024 This read-only boolean attribute is true if the compiler optimized out
21025 this value, thus it is not available for fetching from the inferior.
21026 @end defivar
21027
21028 @defivar Value type
21029 The type of this @code{gdb.Value}. The value of this attribute is a
21030 @code{gdb.Type} object (@pxref{Types In Python}).
21031 @end defivar
21032
21033 @defivar Value dynamic_type
21034 The dynamic type of this @code{gdb.Value}. This uses C@t{++} run-time
21035 type information (@acronym{RTTI}) to determine the dynamic type of the
21036 value. If this value is of class type, it will return the class in
21037 which the value is embedded, if any. If this value is of pointer or
21038 reference to a class type, it will compute the dynamic type of the
21039 referenced object, and return a pointer or reference to that type,
21040 respectively. In all other cases, it will return the value's static
21041 type.
21042
21043 Note that this feature will only work when debugging a C@t{++} program
21044 that includes @acronym{RTTI} for the object in question. Otherwise,
21045 it will just return the static type of the value as in @kbd{ptype foo}
21046 (@pxref{Symbols, ptype}).
21047 @end defivar
21048 @end table
21049
21050 The following methods are provided:
21051
21052 @table @code
21053 @defmethod Value __init__ @var{val}
21054 Many Python values can be converted directly to a @code{gdb.Value} via
21055 this object initializer. Specifically:
21056
21057 @table @asis
21058 @item Python boolean
21059 A Python boolean is converted to the boolean type from the current
21060 language.
21061
21062 @item Python integer
21063 A Python integer is converted to the C @code{long} type for the
21064 current architecture.
21065
21066 @item Python long
21067 A Python long is converted to the C @code{long long} type for the
21068 current architecture.
21069
21070 @item Python float
21071 A Python float is converted to the C @code{double} type for the
21072 current architecture.
21073
21074 @item Python string
21075 A Python string is converted to a target string, using the current
21076 target encoding.
21077
21078 @item @code{gdb.Value}
21079 If @code{val} is a @code{gdb.Value}, then a copy of the value is made.
21080
21081 @item @code{gdb.LazyString}
21082 If @code{val} is a @code{gdb.LazyString} (@pxref{Lazy Strings In
21083 Python}), then the lazy string's @code{value} method is called, and
21084 its result is used.
21085 @end table
21086 @end defmethod
21087
21088 @defmethod Value cast type
21089 Return a new instance of @code{gdb.Value} that is the result of
21090 casting this instance to the type described by @var{type}, which must
21091 be a @code{gdb.Type} object. If the cast cannot be performed for some
21092 reason, this method throws an exception.
21093 @end defmethod
21094
21095 @defmethod Value dereference
21096 For pointer data types, this method returns a new @code{gdb.Value} object
21097 whose contents is the object pointed to by the pointer. For example, if
21098 @code{foo} is a C pointer to an @code{int}, declared in your C program as
21099
21100 @smallexample
21101 int *foo;
21102 @end smallexample
21103
21104 @noindent
21105 then you can use the corresponding @code{gdb.Value} to access what
21106 @code{foo} points to like this:
21107
21108 @smallexample
21109 bar = foo.dereference ()
21110 @end smallexample
21111
21112 The result @code{bar} will be a @code{gdb.Value} object holding the
21113 value pointed to by @code{foo}.
21114 @end defmethod
21115
21116 @defmethod Value dynamic_cast type
21117 Like @code{Value.cast}, but works as if the C@t{++} @code{dynamic_cast}
21118 operator were used. Consult a C@t{++} reference for details.
21119 @end defmethod
21120
21121 @defmethod Value reinterpret_cast type
21122 Like @code{Value.cast}, but works as if the C@t{++} @code{reinterpret_cast}
21123 operator were used. Consult a C@t{++} reference for details.
21124 @end defmethod
21125
21126 @defmethod Value string @r{[}encoding@r{]} @r{[}errors@r{]} @r{[}length@r{]}
21127 If this @code{gdb.Value} represents a string, then this method
21128 converts the contents to a Python string. Otherwise, this method will
21129 throw an exception.
21130
21131 Strings are recognized in a language-specific way; whether a given
21132 @code{gdb.Value} represents a string is determined by the current
21133 language.
21134
21135 For C-like languages, a value is a string if it is a pointer to or an
21136 array of characters or ints. The string is assumed to be terminated
21137 by a zero of the appropriate width. However if the optional length
21138 argument is given, the string will be converted to that given length,
21139 ignoring any embedded zeros that the string may contain.
21140
21141 If the optional @var{encoding} argument is given, it must be a string
21142 naming the encoding of the string in the @code{gdb.Value}, such as
21143 @code{"ascii"}, @code{"iso-8859-6"} or @code{"utf-8"}. It accepts
21144 the same encodings as the corresponding argument to Python's
21145 @code{string.decode} method, and the Python codec machinery will be used
21146 to convert the string. If @var{encoding} is not given, or if
21147 @var{encoding} is the empty string, then either the @code{target-charset}
21148 (@pxref{Character Sets}) will be used, or a language-specific encoding
21149 will be used, if the current language is able to supply one.
21150
21151 The optional @var{errors} argument is the same as the corresponding
21152 argument to Python's @code{string.decode} method.
21153
21154 If the optional @var{length} argument is given, the string will be
21155 fetched and converted to the given length.
21156 @end defmethod
21157
21158 @defmethod Value lazy_string @r{[}encoding@r{]} @r{[}length@r{]}
21159 If this @code{gdb.Value} represents a string, then this method
21160 converts the contents to a @code{gdb.LazyString} (@pxref{Lazy Strings
21161 In Python}). Otherwise, this method will throw an exception.
21162
21163 If the optional @var{encoding} argument is given, it must be a string
21164 naming the encoding of the @code{gdb.LazyString}. Some examples are:
21165 @samp{ascii}, @samp{iso-8859-6} or @samp{utf-8}. If the
21166 @var{encoding} argument is an encoding that @value{GDBN} does
21167 recognize, @value{GDBN} will raise an error.
21168
21169 When a lazy string is printed, the @value{GDBN} encoding machinery is
21170 used to convert the string during printing. If the optional
21171 @var{encoding} argument is not provided, or is an empty string,
21172 @value{GDBN} will automatically select the encoding most suitable for
21173 the string type. For further information on encoding in @value{GDBN}
21174 please see @ref{Character Sets}.
21175
21176 If the optional @var{length} argument is given, the string will be
21177 fetched and encoded to the length of characters specified. If
21178 the @var{length} argument is not provided, the string will be fetched
21179 and encoded until a null of appropriate width is found.
21180 @end defmethod
21181 @end table
21182
21183 @node Types In Python
21184 @subsubsection Types In Python
21185 @cindex types in Python
21186 @cindex Python, working with types
21187
21188 @tindex gdb.Type
21189 @value{GDBN} represents types from the inferior using the class
21190 @code{gdb.Type}.
21191
21192 The following type-related functions are available in the @code{gdb}
21193 module:
21194
21195 @findex gdb.lookup_type
21196 @defun lookup_type name [block]
21197 This function looks up a type by name. @var{name} is the name of the
21198 type to look up. It must be a string.
21199
21200 If @var{block} is given, then @var{name} is looked up in that scope.
21201 Otherwise, it is searched for globally.
21202
21203 Ordinarily, this function will return an instance of @code{gdb.Type}.
21204 If the named type cannot be found, it will throw an exception.
21205 @end defun
21206
21207 An instance of @code{Type} has the following attributes:
21208
21209 @table @code
21210 @defivar Type code
21211 The type code for this type. The type code will be one of the
21212 @code{TYPE_CODE_} constants defined below.
21213 @end defivar
21214
21215 @defivar Type sizeof
21216 The size of this type, in target @code{char} units. Usually, a
21217 target's @code{char} type will be an 8-bit byte. However, on some
21218 unusual platforms, this type may have a different size.
21219 @end defivar
21220
21221 @defivar Type tag
21222 The tag name for this type. The tag name is the name after
21223 @code{struct}, @code{union}, or @code{enum} in C and C@t{++}; not all
21224 languages have this concept. If this type has no tag name, then
21225 @code{None} is returned.
21226 @end defivar
21227 @end table
21228
21229 The following methods are provided:
21230
21231 @table @code
21232 @defmethod Type fields
21233 For structure and union types, this method returns the fields. Range
21234 types have two fields, the minimum and maximum values. Enum types
21235 have one field per enum constant. Function and method types have one
21236 field per parameter. The base types of C@t{++} classes are also
21237 represented as fields. If the type has no fields, or does not fit
21238 into one of these categories, an empty sequence will be returned.
21239
21240 Each field is an object, with some pre-defined attributes:
21241 @table @code
21242 @item bitpos
21243 This attribute is not available for @code{static} fields (as in
21244 C@t{++} or Java). For non-@code{static} fields, the value is the bit
21245 position of the field.
21246
21247 @item name
21248 The name of the field, or @code{None} for anonymous fields.
21249
21250 @item artificial
21251 This is @code{True} if the field is artificial, usually meaning that
21252 it was provided by the compiler and not the user. This attribute is
21253 always provided, and is @code{False} if the field is not artificial.
21254
21255 @item is_base_class
21256 This is @code{True} if the field represents a base class of a C@t{++}
21257 structure. This attribute is always provided, and is @code{False}
21258 if the field is not a base class of the type that is the argument of
21259 @code{fields}, or if that type was not a C@t{++} class.
21260
21261 @item bitsize
21262 If the field is packed, or is a bitfield, then this will have a
21263 non-zero value, which is the size of the field in bits. Otherwise,
21264 this will be zero; in this case the field's size is given by its type.
21265
21266 @item type
21267 The type of the field. This is usually an instance of @code{Type},
21268 but it can be @code{None} in some situations.
21269 @end table
21270 @end defmethod
21271
21272 @defmethod Type array @var{n1} @r{[}@var{n2}@r{]}
21273 Return a new @code{gdb.Type} object which represents an array of this
21274 type. If one argument is given, it is the inclusive upper bound of
21275 the array; in this case the lower bound is zero. If two arguments are
21276 given, the first argument is the lower bound of the array, and the
21277 second argument is the upper bound of the array. An array's length
21278 must not be negative, but the bounds can be.
21279 @end defmethod
21280
21281 @defmethod Type const
21282 Return a new @code{gdb.Type} object which represents a
21283 @code{const}-qualified variant of this type.
21284 @end defmethod
21285
21286 @defmethod Type volatile
21287 Return a new @code{gdb.Type} object which represents a
21288 @code{volatile}-qualified variant of this type.
21289 @end defmethod
21290
21291 @defmethod Type unqualified
21292 Return a new @code{gdb.Type} object which represents an unqualified
21293 variant of this type. That is, the result is neither @code{const} nor
21294 @code{volatile}.
21295 @end defmethod
21296
21297 @defmethod Type range
21298 Return a Python @code{Tuple} object that contains two elements: the
21299 low bound of the argument type and the high bound of that type. If
21300 the type does not have a range, @value{GDBN} will raise a
21301 @code{gdb.error} exception (@pxref{Exception Handling}).
21302 @end defmethod
21303
21304 @defmethod Type reference
21305 Return a new @code{gdb.Type} object which represents a reference to this
21306 type.
21307 @end defmethod
21308
21309 @defmethod Type pointer
21310 Return a new @code{gdb.Type} object which represents a pointer to this
21311 type.
21312 @end defmethod
21313
21314 @defmethod Type strip_typedefs
21315 Return a new @code{gdb.Type} that represents the real type,
21316 after removing all layers of typedefs.
21317 @end defmethod
21318
21319 @defmethod Type target
21320 Return a new @code{gdb.Type} object which represents the target type
21321 of this type.
21322
21323 For a pointer type, the target type is the type of the pointed-to
21324 object. For an array type (meaning C-like arrays), the target type is
21325 the type of the elements of the array. For a function or method type,
21326 the target type is the type of the return value. For a complex type,
21327 the target type is the type of the elements. For a typedef, the
21328 target type is the aliased type.
21329
21330 If the type does not have a target, this method will throw an
21331 exception.
21332 @end defmethod
21333
21334 @defmethod Type template_argument n [block]
21335 If this @code{gdb.Type} is an instantiation of a template, this will
21336 return a new @code{gdb.Type} which represents the type of the
21337 @var{n}th template argument.
21338
21339 If this @code{gdb.Type} is not a template type, this will throw an
21340 exception. Ordinarily, only C@t{++} code will have template types.
21341
21342 If @var{block} is given, then @var{name} is looked up in that scope.
21343 Otherwise, it is searched for globally.
21344 @end defmethod
21345 @end table
21346
21347
21348 Each type has a code, which indicates what category this type falls
21349 into. The available type categories are represented by constants
21350 defined in the @code{gdb} module:
21351
21352 @table @code
21353 @findex TYPE_CODE_PTR
21354 @findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_PTR
21355 @item TYPE_CODE_PTR
21356 The type is a pointer.
21357
21358 @findex TYPE_CODE_ARRAY
21359 @findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_ARRAY
21360 @item TYPE_CODE_ARRAY
21361 The type is an array.
21362
21363 @findex TYPE_CODE_STRUCT
21364 @findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_STRUCT
21365 @item TYPE_CODE_STRUCT
21366 The type is a structure.
21367
21368 @findex TYPE_CODE_UNION
21369 @findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_UNION
21370 @item TYPE_CODE_UNION
21371 The type is a union.
21372
21373 @findex TYPE_CODE_ENUM
21374 @findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_ENUM
21375 @item TYPE_CODE_ENUM
21376 The type is an enum.
21377
21378 @findex TYPE_CODE_FLAGS
21379 @findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_FLAGS
21380 @item TYPE_CODE_FLAGS
21381 A bit flags type, used for things such as status registers.
21382
21383 @findex TYPE_CODE_FUNC
21384 @findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_FUNC
21385 @item TYPE_CODE_FUNC
21386 The type is a function.
21387
21388 @findex TYPE_CODE_INT
21389 @findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_INT
21390 @item TYPE_CODE_INT
21391 The type is an integer type.
21392
21393 @findex TYPE_CODE_FLT
21394 @findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_FLT
21395 @item TYPE_CODE_FLT
21396 A floating point type.
21397
21398 @findex TYPE_CODE_VOID
21399 @findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_VOID
21400 @item TYPE_CODE_VOID
21401 The special type @code{void}.
21402
21403 @findex TYPE_CODE_SET
21404 @findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_SET
21405 @item TYPE_CODE_SET
21406 A Pascal set type.
21407
21408 @findex TYPE_CODE_RANGE
21409 @findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_RANGE
21410 @item TYPE_CODE_RANGE
21411 A range type, that is, an integer type with bounds.
21412
21413 @findex TYPE_CODE_STRING
21414 @findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_STRING
21415 @item TYPE_CODE_STRING
21416 A string type. Note that this is only used for certain languages with
21417 language-defined string types; C strings are not represented this way.
21418
21419 @findex TYPE_CODE_BITSTRING
21420 @findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_BITSTRING
21421 @item TYPE_CODE_BITSTRING
21422 A string of bits.
21423
21424 @findex TYPE_CODE_ERROR
21425 @findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_ERROR
21426 @item TYPE_CODE_ERROR
21427 An unknown or erroneous type.
21428
21429 @findex TYPE_CODE_METHOD
21430 @findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_METHOD
21431 @item TYPE_CODE_METHOD
21432 A method type, as found in C@t{++} or Java.
21433
21434 @findex TYPE_CODE_METHODPTR
21435 @findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_METHODPTR
21436 @item TYPE_CODE_METHODPTR
21437 A pointer-to-member-function.
21438
21439 @findex TYPE_CODE_MEMBERPTR
21440 @findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_MEMBERPTR
21441 @item TYPE_CODE_MEMBERPTR
21442 A pointer-to-member.
21443
21444 @findex TYPE_CODE_REF
21445 @findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_REF
21446 @item TYPE_CODE_REF
21447 A reference type.
21448
21449 @findex TYPE_CODE_CHAR
21450 @findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_CHAR
21451 @item TYPE_CODE_CHAR
21452 A character type.
21453
21454 @findex TYPE_CODE_BOOL
21455 @findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_BOOL
21456 @item TYPE_CODE_BOOL
21457 A boolean type.
21458
21459 @findex TYPE_CODE_COMPLEX
21460 @findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_COMPLEX
21461 @item TYPE_CODE_COMPLEX
21462 A complex float type.
21463
21464 @findex TYPE_CODE_TYPEDEF
21465 @findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_TYPEDEF
21466 @item TYPE_CODE_TYPEDEF
21467 A typedef to some other type.
21468
21469 @findex TYPE_CODE_NAMESPACE
21470 @findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_NAMESPACE
21471 @item TYPE_CODE_NAMESPACE
21472 A C@t{++} namespace.
21473
21474 @findex TYPE_CODE_DECFLOAT
21475 @findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_DECFLOAT
21476 @item TYPE_CODE_DECFLOAT
21477 A decimal floating point type.
21478
21479 @findex TYPE_CODE_INTERNAL_FUNCTION
21480 @findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_INTERNAL_FUNCTION
21481 @item TYPE_CODE_INTERNAL_FUNCTION
21482 A function internal to @value{GDBN}. This is the type used to represent
21483 convenience functions.
21484 @end table
21485
21486 Further support for types is provided in the @code{gdb.types}
21487 Python module (@pxref{gdb.types}).
21488
21489 @node Pretty Printing API
21490 @subsubsection Pretty Printing API
21491
21492 An example output is provided (@pxref{Pretty Printing}).
21493
21494 A pretty-printer is just an object that holds a value and implements a
21495 specific interface, defined here.
21496
21497 @defop Operation {pretty printer} children (self)
21498 @value{GDBN} will call this method on a pretty-printer to compute the
21499 children of the pretty-printer's value.
21500
21501 This method must return an object conforming to the Python iterator
21502 protocol. Each item returned by the iterator must be a tuple holding
21503 two elements. The first element is the ``name'' of the child; the
21504 second element is the child's value. The value can be any Python
21505 object which is convertible to a @value{GDBN} value.
21506
21507 This method is optional. If it does not exist, @value{GDBN} will act
21508 as though the value has no children.
21509 @end defop
21510
21511 @defop Operation {pretty printer} display_hint (self)
21512 The CLI may call this method and use its result to change the
21513 formatting of a value. The result will also be supplied to an MI
21514 consumer as a @samp{displayhint} attribute of the variable being
21515 printed.
21516
21517 This method is optional. If it does exist, this method must return a
21518 string.
21519
21520 Some display hints are predefined by @value{GDBN}:
21521
21522 @table @samp
21523 @item array
21524 Indicate that the object being printed is ``array-like''. The CLI
21525 uses this to respect parameters such as @code{set print elements} and
21526 @code{set print array}.
21527
21528 @item map
21529 Indicate that the object being printed is ``map-like'', and that the
21530 children of this value can be assumed to alternate between keys and
21531 values.
21532
21533 @item string
21534 Indicate that the object being printed is ``string-like''. If the
21535 printer's @code{to_string} method returns a Python string of some
21536 kind, then @value{GDBN} will call its internal language-specific
21537 string-printing function to format the string. For the CLI this means
21538 adding quotation marks, possibly escaping some characters, respecting
21539 @code{set print elements}, and the like.
21540 @end table
21541 @end defop
21542
21543 @defop Operation {pretty printer} to_string (self)
21544 @value{GDBN} will call this method to display the string
21545 representation of the value passed to the object's constructor.
21546
21547 When printing from the CLI, if the @code{to_string} method exists,
21548 then @value{GDBN} will prepend its result to the values returned by
21549 @code{children}. Exactly how this formatting is done is dependent on
21550 the display hint, and may change as more hints are added. Also,
21551 depending on the print settings (@pxref{Print Settings}), the CLI may
21552 print just the result of @code{to_string} in a stack trace, omitting
21553 the result of @code{children}.
21554
21555 If this method returns a string, it is printed verbatim.
21556
21557 Otherwise, if this method returns an instance of @code{gdb.Value},
21558 then @value{GDBN} prints this value. This may result in a call to
21559 another pretty-printer.
21560
21561 If instead the method returns a Python value which is convertible to a
21562 @code{gdb.Value}, then @value{GDBN} performs the conversion and prints
21563 the resulting value. Again, this may result in a call to another
21564 pretty-printer. Python scalars (integers, floats, and booleans) and
21565 strings are convertible to @code{gdb.Value}; other types are not.
21566
21567 Finally, if this method returns @code{None} then no further operations
21568 are peformed in this method and nothing is printed.
21569
21570 If the result is not one of these types, an exception is raised.
21571 @end defop
21572
21573 @value{GDBN} provides a function which can be used to look up the
21574 default pretty-printer for a @code{gdb.Value}:
21575
21576 @findex gdb.default_visualizer
21577 @defun default_visualizer value
21578 This function takes a @code{gdb.Value} object as an argument. If a
21579 pretty-printer for this value exists, then it is returned. If no such
21580 printer exists, then this returns @code{None}.
21581 @end defun
21582
21583 @node Selecting Pretty-Printers
21584 @subsubsection Selecting Pretty-Printers
21585
21586 The Python list @code{gdb.pretty_printers} contains an array of
21587 functions or callable objects that have been registered via addition
21588 as a pretty-printer. Printers in this list are called @code{global}
21589 printers, they're available when debugging all inferiors.
21590 Each @code{gdb.Progspace} contains a @code{pretty_printers} attribute.
21591 Each @code{gdb.Objfile} also contains a @code{pretty_printers}
21592 attribute.
21593
21594 Each function on these lists is passed a single @code{gdb.Value}
21595 argument and should return a pretty-printer object conforming to the
21596 interface definition above (@pxref{Pretty Printing API}). If a function
21597 cannot create a pretty-printer for the value, it should return
21598 @code{None}.
21599
21600 @value{GDBN} first checks the @code{pretty_printers} attribute of each
21601 @code{gdb.Objfile} in the current program space and iteratively calls
21602 each enabled lookup routine in the list for that @code{gdb.Objfile}
21603 until it receives a pretty-printer object.
21604 If no pretty-printer is found in the objfile lists, @value{GDBN} then
21605 searches the pretty-printer list of the current program space,
21606 calling each enabled function until an object is returned.
21607 After these lists have been exhausted, it tries the global
21608 @code{gdb.pretty_printers} list, again calling each enabled function until an
21609 object is returned.
21610
21611 The order in which the objfiles are searched is not specified. For a
21612 given list, functions are always invoked from the head of the list,
21613 and iterated over sequentially until the end of the list, or a printer
21614 object is returned.
21615
21616 For various reasons a pretty-printer may not work.
21617 For example, the underlying data structure may have changed and
21618 the pretty-printer is out of date.
21619
21620 The consequences of a broken pretty-printer are severe enough that
21621 @value{GDBN} provides support for enabling and disabling individual
21622 printers. For example, if @code{print frame-arguments} is on,
21623 a backtrace can become highly illegible if any argument is printed
21624 with a broken printer.
21625
21626 Pretty-printers are enabled and disabled by attaching an @code{enabled}
21627 attribute to the registered function or callable object. If this attribute
21628 is present and its value is @code{False}, the printer is disabled, otherwise
21629 the printer is enabled.
21630
21631 @node Writing a Pretty-Printer
21632 @subsubsection Writing a Pretty-Printer
21633 @cindex writing a pretty-printer
21634
21635 A pretty-printer consists of two parts: a lookup function to detect
21636 if the type is supported, and the printer itself.
21637
21638 Here is an example showing how a @code{std::string} printer might be
21639 written. @xref{Pretty Printing API}, for details on the API this class
21640 must provide.
21641
21642 @smallexample
21643 class StdStringPrinter(object):
21644 "Print a std::string"
21645
21646 def __init__(self, val):
21647 self.val = val
21648
21649 def to_string(self):
21650 return self.val['_M_dataplus']['_M_p']
21651
21652 def display_hint(self):
21653 return 'string'
21654 @end smallexample
21655
21656 And here is an example showing how a lookup function for the printer
21657 example above might be written.
21658
21659 @smallexample
21660 def str_lookup_function(val):
21661 lookup_tag = val.type.tag
21662 if lookup_tag == None:
21663 return None
21664 regex = re.compile("^std::basic_string<char,.*>$")
21665 if regex.match(lookup_tag):
21666 return StdStringPrinter(val)
21667 return None
21668 @end smallexample
21669
21670 The example lookup function extracts the value's type, and attempts to
21671 match it to a type that it can pretty-print. If it is a type the
21672 printer can pretty-print, it will return a printer object. If not, it
21673 returns @code{None}.
21674
21675 We recommend that you put your core pretty-printers into a Python
21676 package. If your pretty-printers are for use with a library, we
21677 further recommend embedding a version number into the package name.
21678 This practice will enable @value{GDBN} to load multiple versions of
21679 your pretty-printers at the same time, because they will have
21680 different names.
21681
21682 You should write auto-loaded code (@pxref{Auto-loading}) such that it
21683 can be evaluated multiple times without changing its meaning. An
21684 ideal auto-load file will consist solely of @code{import}s of your
21685 printer modules, followed by a call to a register pretty-printers with
21686 the current objfile.
21687
21688 Taken as a whole, this approach will scale nicely to multiple
21689 inferiors, each potentially using a different library version.
21690 Embedding a version number in the Python package name will ensure that
21691 @value{GDBN} is able to load both sets of printers simultaneously.
21692 Then, because the search for pretty-printers is done by objfile, and
21693 because your auto-loaded code took care to register your library's
21694 printers with a specific objfile, @value{GDBN} will find the correct
21695 printers for the specific version of the library used by each
21696 inferior.
21697
21698 To continue the @code{std::string} example (@pxref{Pretty Printing API}),
21699 this code might appear in @code{gdb.libstdcxx.v6}:
21700
21701 @smallexample
21702 def register_printers(objfile):
21703 objfile.pretty_printers.add(str_lookup_function)
21704 @end smallexample
21705
21706 @noindent
21707 And then the corresponding contents of the auto-load file would be:
21708
21709 @smallexample
21710 import gdb.libstdcxx.v6
21711 gdb.libstdcxx.v6.register_printers(gdb.current_objfile())
21712 @end smallexample
21713
21714 The previous example illustrates a basic pretty-printer.
21715 There are a few things that can be improved on.
21716 The printer doesn't have a name, making it hard to identify in a
21717 list of installed printers. The lookup function has a name, but
21718 lookup functions can have arbitrary, even identical, names.
21719
21720 Second, the printer only handles one type, whereas a library typically has
21721 several types. One could install a lookup function for each desired type
21722 in the library, but one could also have a single lookup function recognize
21723 several types. The latter is the conventional way this is handled.
21724 If a pretty-printer can handle multiple data types, then its
21725 @dfn{subprinters} are the printers for the individual data types.
21726
21727 The @code{gdb.printing} module provides a formal way of solving these
21728 problems (@pxref{gdb.printing}).
21729 Here is another example that handles multiple types.
21730
21731 These are the types we are going to pretty-print:
21732
21733 @smallexample
21734 struct foo @{ int a, b; @};
21735 struct bar @{ struct foo x, y; @};
21736 @end smallexample
21737
21738 Here are the printers:
21739
21740 @smallexample
21741 class fooPrinter:
21742 """Print a foo object."""
21743
21744 def __init__(self, val):
21745 self.val = val
21746
21747 def to_string(self):
21748 return ("a=<" + str(self.val["a"]) +
21749 "> b=<" + str(self.val["b"]) + ">")
21750
21751 class barPrinter:
21752 """Print a bar object."""
21753
21754 def __init__(self, val):
21755 self.val = val
21756
21757 def to_string(self):
21758 return ("x=<" + str(self.val["x"]) +
21759 "> y=<" + str(self.val["y"]) + ">")
21760 @end smallexample
21761
21762 This example doesn't need a lookup function, that is handled by the
21763 @code{gdb.printing} module. Instead a function is provided to build up
21764 the object that handles the lookup.
21765
21766 @smallexample
21767 import gdb.printing
21768
21769 def build_pretty_printer():
21770 pp = gdb.printing.RegexpCollectionPrettyPrinter(
21771 "my_library")
21772 pp.add_printer('foo', '^foo$', fooPrinter)
21773 pp.add_printer('bar', '^bar$', barPrinter)
21774 return pp
21775 @end smallexample
21776
21777 And here is the autoload support:
21778
21779 @smallexample
21780 import gdb.printing
21781 import my_library
21782 gdb.printing.register_pretty_printer(
21783 gdb.current_objfile(),
21784 my_library.build_pretty_printer())
21785 @end smallexample
21786
21787 Finally, when this printer is loaded into @value{GDBN}, here is the
21788 corresponding output of @samp{info pretty-printer}:
21789
21790 @smallexample
21791 (gdb) info pretty-printer
21792 my_library.so:
21793 my_library
21794 foo
21795 bar
21796 @end smallexample
21797
21798 @node Inferiors In Python
21799 @subsubsection Inferiors In Python
21800 @cindex inferiors in Python
21801
21802 @findex gdb.Inferior
21803 Programs which are being run under @value{GDBN} are called inferiors
21804 (@pxref{Inferiors and Programs}). Python scripts can access
21805 information about and manipulate inferiors controlled by @value{GDBN}
21806 via objects of the @code{gdb.Inferior} class.
21807
21808 The following inferior-related functions are available in the @code{gdb}
21809 module:
21810
21811 @defun inferiors
21812 Return a tuple containing all inferior objects.
21813 @end defun
21814
21815 A @code{gdb.Inferior} object has the following attributes:
21816
21817 @table @code
21818 @defivar Inferior num
21819 ID of inferior, as assigned by GDB.
21820 @end defivar
21821
21822 @defivar Inferior pid
21823 Process ID of the inferior, as assigned by the underlying operating
21824 system.
21825 @end defivar
21826
21827 @defivar Inferior was_attached
21828 Boolean signaling whether the inferior was created using `attach', or
21829 started by @value{GDBN} itself.
21830 @end defivar
21831 @end table
21832
21833 A @code{gdb.Inferior} object has the following methods:
21834
21835 @table @code
21836 @defmethod Inferior threads
21837 This method returns a tuple holding all the threads which are valid
21838 when it is called. If there are no valid threads, the method will
21839 return an empty tuple.
21840 @end defmethod
21841
21842 @findex gdb.read_memory
21843 @defmethod Inferior read_memory address length
21844 Read @var{length} bytes of memory from the inferior, starting at
21845 @var{address}. Returns a buffer object, which behaves much like an array
21846 or a string. It can be modified and given to the @code{gdb.write_memory}
21847 function.
21848 @end defmethod
21849
21850 @findex gdb.write_memory
21851 @defmethod Inferior write_memory address buffer @r{[}length@r{]}
21852 Write the contents of @var{buffer} to the inferior, starting at
21853 @var{address}. The @var{buffer} parameter must be a Python object
21854 which supports the buffer protocol, i.e., a string, an array or the
21855 object returned from @code{gdb.read_memory}. If given, @var{length}
21856 determines the number of bytes from @var{buffer} to be written.
21857 @end defmethod
21858
21859 @findex gdb.search_memory
21860 @defmethod Inferior search_memory address length pattern
21861 Search a region of the inferior memory starting at @var{address} with
21862 the given @var{length} using the search pattern supplied in
21863 @var{pattern}. The @var{pattern} parameter must be a Python object
21864 which supports the buffer protocol, i.e., a string, an array or the
21865 object returned from @code{gdb.read_memory}. Returns a Python @code{Long}
21866 containing the address where the pattern was found, or @code{None} if
21867 the pattern could not be found.
21868 @end defmethod
21869 @end table
21870
21871 @node Events In Python
21872 @subsubsection Events In Python
21873 @cindex inferior events in Python
21874
21875 @value{GDBN} provides a general event facility so that Python code can be
21876 notified of various state changes, particularly changes that occur in
21877 the inferior.
21878
21879 An @dfn{event} is just an object that describes some state change. The
21880 type of the object and its attributes will vary depending on the details
21881 of the change. All the existing events are described below.
21882
21883 In order to be notified of an event, you must register an event handler
21884 with an @dfn{event registry}. An event registry is an object in the
21885 @code{gdb.events} module which dispatches particular events. A registry
21886 provides methods to register and unregister event handlers:
21887
21888 @table @code
21889 @defmethod EventRegistry connect object
21890 Add the given callable @var{object} to the registry. This object will be
21891 called when an event corresponding to this registry occurs.
21892 @end defmethod
21893
21894 @defmethod EventRegistry disconnect object
21895 Remove the given @var{object} from the registry. Once removed, the object
21896 will no longer receive notifications of events.
21897 @end defmethod
21898 @end table
21899
21900 Here is an example:
21901
21902 @smallexample
21903 def exit_handler (event):
21904 print "event type: exit"
21905 print "exit code: %d" % (event.exit_code)
21906
21907 gdb.events.exited.connect (exit_handler)
21908 @end smallexample
21909
21910 In the above example we connect our handler @code{exit_handler} to the
21911 registry @code{events.exited}. Once connected, @code{exit_handler} gets
21912 called when the inferior exits. The argument @dfn{event} in this example is
21913 of type @code{gdb.ExitedEvent}. As you can see in the example the
21914 @code{ExitedEvent} object has an attribute which indicates the exit code of
21915 the inferior.
21916
21917 The following is a listing of the event registries that are available and
21918 details of the events they emit:
21919
21920 @table @code
21921
21922 @item events.cont
21923 Emits @code{gdb.ThreadEvent}.
21924
21925 Some events can be thread specific when @value{GDBN} is running in non-stop
21926 mode. When represented in Python, these events all extend
21927 @code{gdb.ThreadEvent}. Note, this event is not emitted directly; instead,
21928 events which are emitted by this or other modules might extend this event.
21929 Examples of these events are @code{gdb.BreakpointEvent} and
21930 @code{gdb.ContinueEvent}.
21931
21932 @table @code
21933 @defivar ThreadEvent inferior_thread
21934 In non-stop mode this attribute will be set to the specific thread which was
21935 involved in the emitted event. Otherwise, it will be set to @code{None}.
21936 @end defivar
21937 @end table
21938
21939 Emits @code{gdb.ContinueEvent} which extends @code{gdb.ThreadEvent}.
21940
21941 This event indicates that the inferior has been continued after a stop. For
21942 inherited attribute refer to @code{gdb.ThreadEvent} above.
21943
21944 @item events.exited
21945 Emits @code{events.ExitedEvent} which indicates that the inferior has exited.
21946 @code{events.ExitedEvent} has one attribute:
21947 @table @code
21948 @defivar ExitedEvent exit_code
21949 An integer representing the exit code which the inferior has returned.
21950 @end defivar
21951 @end table
21952
21953 @item events.stop
21954 Emits @code{gdb.StopEvent} which extends @code{gdb.ThreadEvent}.
21955
21956 Indicates that the inferior has stopped. All events emitted by this registry
21957 extend StopEvent. As a child of @code{gdb.ThreadEvent}, @code{gdb.StopEvent}
21958 will indicate the stopped thread when @value{GDBN} is running in non-stop
21959 mode. Refer to @code{gdb.ThreadEvent} above for more details.
21960
21961 Emits @code{gdb.SignalEvent} which extends @code{gdb.StopEvent}.
21962
21963 This event indicates that the inferior or one of its threads has received as
21964 signal. @code{gdb.SignalEvent} has the following attributes:
21965
21966 @table @code
21967 @defivar SignalEvent stop_signal
21968 A string representing the signal received by the inferior. A list of possible
21969 signal values can be obtained by running the command @code{info signals} in
21970 the @value{GDBN} command prompt.
21971 @end defivar
21972 @end table
21973
21974 Also emits @code{gdb.BreakpointEvent} which extends @code{gdb.StopEvent}.
21975
21976 @code{gdb.BreakpointEvent} event indicates that a breakpoint has been hit, and
21977 has the following attributes:
21978
21979 @table @code
21980 @defivar BreakpointEvent breakpoint
21981 A reference to the breakpoint that was hit of type @code{gdb.Breakpoint}.
21982 @xref{Breakpoints In Python}, for details of the @code{gdb.Breakpoint} object.
21983 @end defivar
21984 @end table
21985
21986 @end table
21987
21988 @node Threads In Python
21989 @subsubsection Threads In Python
21990 @cindex threads in python
21991
21992 @findex gdb.InferiorThread
21993 Python scripts can access information about, and manipulate inferior threads
21994 controlled by @value{GDBN}, via objects of the @code{gdb.InferiorThread} class.
21995
21996 The following thread-related functions are available in the @code{gdb}
21997 module:
21998
21999 @findex gdb.selected_thread
22000 @defun selected_thread
22001 This function returns the thread object for the selected thread. If there
22002 is no selected thread, this will return @code{None}.
22003 @end defun
22004
22005 A @code{gdb.InferiorThread} object has the following attributes:
22006
22007 @table @code
22008 @defivar InferiorThread name
22009 The name of the thread. If the user specified a name using
22010 @code{thread name}, then this returns that name. Otherwise, if an
22011 OS-supplied name is available, then it is returned. Otherwise, this
22012 returns @code{None}.
22013
22014 This attribute can be assigned to. The new value must be a string
22015 object, which sets the new name, or @code{None}, which removes any
22016 user-specified thread name.
22017 @end defivar
22018
22019 @defivar InferiorThread num
22020 ID of the thread, as assigned by GDB.
22021 @end defivar
22022
22023 @defivar InferiorThread ptid
22024 ID of the thread, as assigned by the operating system. This attribute is a
22025 tuple containing three integers. The first is the Process ID (PID); the second
22026 is the Lightweight Process ID (LWPID), and the third is the Thread ID (TID).
22027 Either the LWPID or TID may be 0, which indicates that the operating system
22028 does not use that identifier.
22029 @end defivar
22030 @end table
22031
22032 A @code{gdb.InferiorThread} object has the following methods:
22033
22034 @table @code
22035 @defmethod InferiorThread switch
22036 This changes @value{GDBN}'s currently selected thread to the one represented
22037 by this object.
22038 @end defmethod
22039
22040 @defmethod InferiorThread is_stopped
22041 Return a Boolean indicating whether the thread is stopped.
22042 @end defmethod
22043
22044 @defmethod InferiorThread is_running
22045 Return a Boolean indicating whether the thread is running.
22046 @end defmethod
22047
22048 @defmethod InferiorThread is_exited
22049 Return a Boolean indicating whether the thread is exited.
22050 @end defmethod
22051 @end table
22052
22053 @node Commands In Python
22054 @subsubsection Commands In Python
22055
22056 @cindex commands in python
22057 @cindex python commands
22058 You can implement new @value{GDBN} CLI commands in Python. A CLI
22059 command is implemented using an instance of the @code{gdb.Command}
22060 class, most commonly using a subclass.
22061
22062 @defmethod Command __init__ name @var{command_class} @r{[}@var{completer_class}@r{]} @r{[}@var{prefix}@r{]}
22063 The object initializer for @code{Command} registers the new command
22064 with @value{GDBN}. This initializer is normally invoked from the
22065 subclass' own @code{__init__} method.
22066
22067 @var{name} is the name of the command. If @var{name} consists of
22068 multiple words, then the initial words are looked for as prefix
22069 commands. In this case, if one of the prefix commands does not exist,
22070 an exception is raised.
22071
22072 There is no support for multi-line commands.
22073
22074 @var{command_class} should be one of the @samp{COMMAND_} constants
22075 defined below. This argument tells @value{GDBN} how to categorize the
22076 new command in the help system.
22077
22078 @var{completer_class} is an optional argument. If given, it should be
22079 one of the @samp{COMPLETE_} constants defined below. This argument
22080 tells @value{GDBN} how to perform completion for this command. If not
22081 given, @value{GDBN} will attempt to complete using the object's
22082 @code{complete} method (see below); if no such method is found, an
22083 error will occur when completion is attempted.
22084
22085 @var{prefix} is an optional argument. If @code{True}, then the new
22086 command is a prefix command; sub-commands of this command may be
22087 registered.
22088
22089 The help text for the new command is taken from the Python
22090 documentation string for the command's class, if there is one. If no
22091 documentation string is provided, the default value ``This command is
22092 not documented.'' is used.
22093 @end defmethod
22094
22095 @cindex don't repeat Python command
22096 @defmethod Command dont_repeat
22097 By default, a @value{GDBN} command is repeated when the user enters a
22098 blank line at the command prompt. A command can suppress this
22099 behavior by invoking the @code{dont_repeat} method. This is similar
22100 to the user command @code{dont-repeat}, see @ref{Define, dont-repeat}.
22101 @end defmethod
22102
22103 @defmethod Command invoke argument from_tty
22104 This method is called by @value{GDBN} when this command is invoked.
22105
22106 @var{argument} is a string. It is the argument to the command, after
22107 leading and trailing whitespace has been stripped.
22108
22109 @var{from_tty} is a boolean argument. When true, this means that the
22110 command was entered by the user at the terminal; when false it means
22111 that the command came from elsewhere.
22112
22113 If this method throws an exception, it is turned into a @value{GDBN}
22114 @code{error} call. Otherwise, the return value is ignored.
22115
22116 @findex gdb.string_to_argv
22117 To break @var{argument} up into an argv-like string use
22118 @code{gdb.string_to_argv}. This function behaves identically to
22119 @value{GDBN}'s internal argument lexer @code{buildargv}.
22120 It is recommended to use this for consistency.
22121 Arguments are separated by spaces and may be quoted.
22122 Example:
22123
22124 @smallexample
22125 print gdb.string_to_argv ("1 2\ \\\"3 '4 \"5' \"6 '7\"")
22126 ['1', '2 "3', '4 "5', "6 '7"]
22127 @end smallexample
22128
22129 @end defmethod
22130
22131 @cindex completion of Python commands
22132 @defmethod Command complete text word
22133 This method is called by @value{GDBN} when the user attempts
22134 completion on this command. All forms of completion are handled by
22135 this method, that is, the @key{TAB} and @key{M-?} key bindings
22136 (@pxref{Completion}), and the @code{complete} command (@pxref{Help,
22137 complete}).
22138
22139 The arguments @var{text} and @var{word} are both strings. @var{text}
22140 holds the complete command line up to the cursor's location.
22141 @var{word} holds the last word of the command line; this is computed
22142 using a word-breaking heuristic.
22143
22144 The @code{complete} method can return several values:
22145 @itemize @bullet
22146 @item
22147 If the return value is a sequence, the contents of the sequence are
22148 used as the completions. It is up to @code{complete} to ensure that the
22149 contents actually do complete the word. A zero-length sequence is
22150 allowed, it means that there were no completions available. Only
22151 string elements of the sequence are used; other elements in the
22152 sequence are ignored.
22153
22154 @item
22155 If the return value is one of the @samp{COMPLETE_} constants defined
22156 below, then the corresponding @value{GDBN}-internal completion
22157 function is invoked, and its result is used.
22158
22159 @item
22160 All other results are treated as though there were no available
22161 completions.
22162 @end itemize
22163 @end defmethod
22164
22165 When a new command is registered, it must be declared as a member of
22166 some general class of commands. This is used to classify top-level
22167 commands in the on-line help system; note that prefix commands are not
22168 listed under their own category but rather that of their top-level
22169 command. The available classifications are represented by constants
22170 defined in the @code{gdb} module:
22171
22172 @table @code
22173 @findex COMMAND_NONE
22174 @findex gdb.COMMAND_NONE
22175 @item COMMAND_NONE
22176 The command does not belong to any particular class. A command in
22177 this category will not be displayed in any of the help categories.
22178
22179 @findex COMMAND_RUNNING
22180 @findex gdb.COMMAND_RUNNING
22181 @item COMMAND_RUNNING
22182 The command is related to running the inferior. For example,
22183 @code{start}, @code{step}, and @code{continue} are in this category.
22184 Type @kbd{help running} at the @value{GDBN} prompt to see a list of
22185 commands in this category.
22186
22187 @findex COMMAND_DATA
22188 @findex gdb.COMMAND_DATA
22189 @item COMMAND_DATA
22190 The command is related to data or variables. For example,
22191 @code{call}, @code{find}, and @code{print} are in this category. Type
22192 @kbd{help data} at the @value{GDBN} prompt to see a list of commands
22193 in this category.
22194
22195 @findex COMMAND_STACK
22196 @findex gdb.COMMAND_STACK
22197 @item COMMAND_STACK
22198 The command has to do with manipulation of the stack. For example,
22199 @code{backtrace}, @code{frame}, and @code{return} are in this
22200 category. Type @kbd{help stack} at the @value{GDBN} prompt to see a
22201 list of commands in this category.
22202
22203 @findex COMMAND_FILES
22204 @findex gdb.COMMAND_FILES
22205 @item COMMAND_FILES
22206 This class is used for file-related commands. For example,
22207 @code{file}, @code{list} and @code{section} are in this category.
22208 Type @kbd{help files} at the @value{GDBN} prompt to see a list of
22209 commands in this category.
22210
22211 @findex COMMAND_SUPPORT
22212 @findex gdb.COMMAND_SUPPORT
22213 @item COMMAND_SUPPORT
22214 This should be used for ``support facilities'', generally meaning
22215 things that are useful to the user when interacting with @value{GDBN},
22216 but not related to the state of the inferior. For example,
22217 @code{help}, @code{make}, and @code{shell} are in this category. Type
22218 @kbd{help support} at the @value{GDBN} prompt to see a list of
22219 commands in this category.
22220
22221 @findex COMMAND_STATUS
22222 @findex gdb.COMMAND_STATUS
22223 @item COMMAND_STATUS
22224 The command is an @samp{info}-related command, that is, related to the
22225 state of @value{GDBN} itself. For example, @code{info}, @code{macro},
22226 and @code{show} are in this category. Type @kbd{help status} at the
22227 @value{GDBN} prompt to see a list of commands in this category.
22228
22229 @findex COMMAND_BREAKPOINTS
22230 @findex gdb.COMMAND_BREAKPOINTS
22231 @item COMMAND_BREAKPOINTS
22232 The command has to do with breakpoints. For example, @code{break},
22233 @code{clear}, and @code{delete} are in this category. Type @kbd{help
22234 breakpoints} at the @value{GDBN} prompt to see a list of commands in
22235 this category.
22236
22237 @findex COMMAND_TRACEPOINTS
22238 @findex gdb.COMMAND_TRACEPOINTS
22239 @item COMMAND_TRACEPOINTS
22240 The command has to do with tracepoints. For example, @code{trace},
22241 @code{actions}, and @code{tfind} are in this category. Type
22242 @kbd{help tracepoints} at the @value{GDBN} prompt to see a list of
22243 commands in this category.
22244
22245 @findex COMMAND_OBSCURE
22246 @findex gdb.COMMAND_OBSCURE
22247 @item COMMAND_OBSCURE
22248 The command is only used in unusual circumstances, or is not of
22249 general interest to users. For example, @code{checkpoint},
22250 @code{fork}, and @code{stop} are in this category. Type @kbd{help
22251 obscure} at the @value{GDBN} prompt to see a list of commands in this
22252 category.
22253
22254 @findex COMMAND_MAINTENANCE
22255 @findex gdb.COMMAND_MAINTENANCE
22256 @item COMMAND_MAINTENANCE
22257 The command is only useful to @value{GDBN} maintainers. The
22258 @code{maintenance} and @code{flushregs} commands are in this category.
22259 Type @kbd{help internals} at the @value{GDBN} prompt to see a list of
22260 commands in this category.
22261 @end table
22262
22263 A new command can use a predefined completion function, either by
22264 specifying it via an argument at initialization, or by returning it
22265 from the @code{complete} method. These predefined completion
22266 constants are all defined in the @code{gdb} module:
22267
22268 @table @code
22269 @findex COMPLETE_NONE
22270 @findex gdb.COMPLETE_NONE
22271 @item COMPLETE_NONE
22272 This constant means that no completion should be done.
22273
22274 @findex COMPLETE_FILENAME
22275 @findex gdb.COMPLETE_FILENAME
22276 @item COMPLETE_FILENAME
22277 This constant means that filename completion should be performed.
22278
22279 @findex COMPLETE_LOCATION
22280 @findex gdb.COMPLETE_LOCATION
22281 @item COMPLETE_LOCATION
22282 This constant means that location completion should be done.
22283 @xref{Specify Location}.
22284
22285 @findex COMPLETE_COMMAND
22286 @findex gdb.COMPLETE_COMMAND
22287 @item COMPLETE_COMMAND
22288 This constant means that completion should examine @value{GDBN}
22289 command names.
22290
22291 @findex COMPLETE_SYMBOL
22292 @findex gdb.COMPLETE_SYMBOL
22293 @item COMPLETE_SYMBOL
22294 This constant means that completion should be done using symbol names
22295 as the source.
22296 @end table
22297
22298 The following code snippet shows how a trivial CLI command can be
22299 implemented in Python:
22300
22301 @smallexample
22302 class HelloWorld (gdb.Command):
22303 """Greet the whole world."""
22304
22305 def __init__ (self):
22306 super (HelloWorld, self).__init__ ("hello-world", gdb.COMMAND_OBSCURE)
22307
22308 def invoke (self, arg, from_tty):
22309 print "Hello, World!"
22310
22311 HelloWorld ()
22312 @end smallexample
22313
22314 The last line instantiates the class, and is necessary to trigger the
22315 registration of the command with @value{GDBN}. Depending on how the
22316 Python code is read into @value{GDBN}, you may need to import the
22317 @code{gdb} module explicitly.
22318
22319 @node Parameters In Python
22320 @subsubsection Parameters In Python
22321
22322 @cindex parameters in python
22323 @cindex python parameters
22324 @tindex gdb.Parameter
22325 @tindex Parameter
22326 You can implement new @value{GDBN} parameters using Python. A new
22327 parameter is implemented as an instance of the @code{gdb.Parameter}
22328 class.
22329
22330 Parameters are exposed to the user via the @code{set} and
22331 @code{show} commands. @xref{Help}.
22332
22333 There are many parameters that already exist and can be set in
22334 @value{GDBN}. Two examples are: @code{set follow fork} and
22335 @code{set charset}. Setting these parameters influences certain
22336 behavior in @value{GDBN}. Similarly, you can define parameters that
22337 can be used to influence behavior in custom Python scripts and commands.
22338
22339 @defmethod Parameter __init__ name @var{command-class} @var{parameter-class} @r{[}@var{enum-sequence}@r{]}
22340 The object initializer for @code{Parameter} registers the new
22341 parameter with @value{GDBN}. This initializer is normally invoked
22342 from the subclass' own @code{__init__} method.
22343
22344 @var{name} is the name of the new parameter. If @var{name} consists
22345 of multiple words, then the initial words are looked for as prefix
22346 parameters. An example of this can be illustrated with the
22347 @code{set print} set of parameters. If @var{name} is
22348 @code{print foo}, then @code{print} will be searched as the prefix
22349 parameter. In this case the parameter can subsequently be accessed in
22350 @value{GDBN} as @code{set print foo}.
22351
22352 If @var{name} consists of multiple words, and no prefix parameter group
22353 can be found, an exception is raised.
22354
22355 @var{command-class} should be one of the @samp{COMMAND_} constants
22356 (@pxref{Commands In Python}). This argument tells @value{GDBN} how to
22357 categorize the new parameter in the help system.
22358
22359 @var{parameter-class} should be one of the @samp{PARAM_} constants
22360 defined below. This argument tells @value{GDBN} the type of the new
22361 parameter; this information is used for input validation and
22362 completion.
22363
22364 If @var{parameter-class} is @code{PARAM_ENUM}, then
22365 @var{enum-sequence} must be a sequence of strings. These strings
22366 represent the possible values for the parameter.
22367
22368 If @var{parameter-class} is not @code{PARAM_ENUM}, then the presence
22369 of a fourth argument will cause an exception to be thrown.
22370
22371 The help text for the new parameter is taken from the Python
22372 documentation string for the parameter's class, if there is one. If
22373 there is no documentation string, a default value is used.
22374 @end defmethod
22375
22376 @defivar Parameter set_doc
22377 If this attribute exists, and is a string, then its value is used as
22378 the help text for this parameter's @code{set} command. The value is
22379 examined when @code{Parameter.__init__} is invoked; subsequent changes
22380 have no effect.
22381 @end defivar
22382
22383 @defivar Parameter show_doc
22384 If this attribute exists, and is a string, then its value is used as
22385 the help text for this parameter's @code{show} command. The value is
22386 examined when @code{Parameter.__init__} is invoked; subsequent changes
22387 have no effect.
22388 @end defivar
22389
22390 @defivar Parameter value
22391 The @code{value} attribute holds the underlying value of the
22392 parameter. It can be read and assigned to just as any other
22393 attribute. @value{GDBN} does validation when assignments are made.
22394 @end defivar
22395
22396
22397 When a new parameter is defined, its type must be specified. The
22398 available types are represented by constants defined in the @code{gdb}
22399 module:
22400
22401 @table @code
22402 @findex PARAM_BOOLEAN
22403 @findex gdb.PARAM_BOOLEAN
22404 @item PARAM_BOOLEAN
22405 The value is a plain boolean. The Python boolean values, @code{True}
22406 and @code{False} are the only valid values.
22407
22408 @findex PARAM_AUTO_BOOLEAN
22409 @findex gdb.PARAM_AUTO_BOOLEAN
22410 @item PARAM_AUTO_BOOLEAN
22411 The value has three possible states: true, false, and @samp{auto}. In
22412 Python, true and false are represented using boolean constants, and
22413 @samp{auto} is represented using @code{None}.
22414
22415 @findex PARAM_UINTEGER
22416 @findex gdb.PARAM_UINTEGER
22417 @item PARAM_UINTEGER
22418 The value is an unsigned integer. The value of 0 should be
22419 interpreted to mean ``unlimited''.
22420
22421 @findex PARAM_INTEGER
22422 @findex gdb.PARAM_INTEGER
22423 @item PARAM_INTEGER
22424 The value is a signed integer. The value of 0 should be interpreted
22425 to mean ``unlimited''.
22426
22427 @findex PARAM_STRING
22428 @findex gdb.PARAM_STRING
22429 @item PARAM_STRING
22430 The value is a string. When the user modifies the string, any escape
22431 sequences, such as @samp{\t}, @samp{\f}, and octal escapes, are
22432 translated into corresponding characters and encoded into the current
22433 host charset.
22434
22435 @findex PARAM_STRING_NOESCAPE
22436 @findex gdb.PARAM_STRING_NOESCAPE
22437 @item PARAM_STRING_NOESCAPE
22438 The value is a string. When the user modifies the string, escapes are
22439 passed through untranslated.
22440
22441 @findex PARAM_OPTIONAL_FILENAME
22442 @findex gdb.PARAM_OPTIONAL_FILENAME
22443 @item PARAM_OPTIONAL_FILENAME
22444 The value is a either a filename (a string), or @code{None}.
22445
22446 @findex PARAM_FILENAME
22447 @findex gdb.PARAM_FILENAME
22448 @item PARAM_FILENAME
22449 The value is a filename. This is just like
22450 @code{PARAM_STRING_NOESCAPE}, but uses file names for completion.
22451
22452 @findex PARAM_ZINTEGER
22453 @findex gdb.PARAM_ZINTEGER
22454 @item PARAM_ZINTEGER
22455 The value is an integer. This is like @code{PARAM_INTEGER}, except 0
22456 is interpreted as itself.
22457
22458 @findex PARAM_ENUM
22459 @findex gdb.PARAM_ENUM
22460 @item PARAM_ENUM
22461 The value is a string, which must be one of a collection string
22462 constants provided when the parameter is created.
22463 @end table
22464
22465 @node Functions In Python
22466 @subsubsection Writing new convenience functions
22467
22468 @cindex writing convenience functions
22469 @cindex convenience functions in python
22470 @cindex python convenience functions
22471 @tindex gdb.Function
22472 @tindex Function
22473 You can implement new convenience functions (@pxref{Convenience Vars})
22474 in Python. A convenience function is an instance of a subclass of the
22475 class @code{gdb.Function}.
22476
22477 @defmethod Function __init__ name
22478 The initializer for @code{Function} registers the new function with
22479 @value{GDBN}. The argument @var{name} is the name of the function,
22480 a string. The function will be visible to the user as a convenience
22481 variable of type @code{internal function}, whose name is the same as
22482 the given @var{name}.
22483
22484 The documentation for the new function is taken from the documentation
22485 string for the new class.
22486 @end defmethod
22487
22488 @defmethod Function invoke @var{*args}
22489 When a convenience function is evaluated, its arguments are converted
22490 to instances of @code{gdb.Value}, and then the function's
22491 @code{invoke} method is called. Note that @value{GDBN} does not
22492 predetermine the arity of convenience functions. Instead, all
22493 available arguments are passed to @code{invoke}, following the
22494 standard Python calling convention. In particular, a convenience
22495 function can have default values for parameters without ill effect.
22496
22497 The return value of this method is used as its value in the enclosing
22498 expression. If an ordinary Python value is returned, it is converted
22499 to a @code{gdb.Value} following the usual rules.
22500 @end defmethod
22501
22502 The following code snippet shows how a trivial convenience function can
22503 be implemented in Python:
22504
22505 @smallexample
22506 class Greet (gdb.Function):
22507 """Return string to greet someone.
22508 Takes a name as argument."""
22509
22510 def __init__ (self):
22511 super (Greet, self).__init__ ("greet")
22512
22513 def invoke (self, name):
22514 return "Hello, %s!" % name.string ()
22515
22516 Greet ()
22517 @end smallexample
22518
22519 The last line instantiates the class, and is necessary to trigger the
22520 registration of the function with @value{GDBN}. Depending on how the
22521 Python code is read into @value{GDBN}, you may need to import the
22522 @code{gdb} module explicitly.
22523
22524 @node Progspaces In Python
22525 @subsubsection Program Spaces In Python
22526
22527 @cindex progspaces in python
22528 @tindex gdb.Progspace
22529 @tindex Progspace
22530 A program space, or @dfn{progspace}, represents a symbolic view
22531 of an address space.
22532 It consists of all of the objfiles of the program.
22533 @xref{Objfiles In Python}.
22534 @xref{Inferiors and Programs, program spaces}, for more details
22535 about program spaces.
22536
22537 The following progspace-related functions are available in the
22538 @code{gdb} module:
22539
22540 @findex gdb.current_progspace
22541 @defun current_progspace
22542 This function returns the program space of the currently selected inferior.
22543 @xref{Inferiors and Programs}.
22544 @end defun
22545
22546 @findex gdb.progspaces
22547 @defun progspaces
22548 Return a sequence of all the progspaces currently known to @value{GDBN}.
22549 @end defun
22550
22551 Each progspace is represented by an instance of the @code{gdb.Progspace}
22552 class.
22553
22554 @defivar Progspace filename
22555 The file name of the progspace as a string.
22556 @end defivar
22557
22558 @defivar Progspace pretty_printers
22559 The @code{pretty_printers} attribute is a list of functions. It is
22560 used to look up pretty-printers. A @code{Value} is passed to each
22561 function in order; if the function returns @code{None}, then the
22562 search continues. Otherwise, the return value should be an object
22563 which is used to format the value. @xref{Pretty Printing API}, for more
22564 information.
22565 @end defivar
22566
22567 @node Objfiles In Python
22568 @subsubsection Objfiles In Python
22569
22570 @cindex objfiles in python
22571 @tindex gdb.Objfile
22572 @tindex Objfile
22573 @value{GDBN} loads symbols for an inferior from various
22574 symbol-containing files (@pxref{Files}). These include the primary
22575 executable file, any shared libraries used by the inferior, and any
22576 separate debug info files (@pxref{Separate Debug Files}).
22577 @value{GDBN} calls these symbol-containing files @dfn{objfiles}.
22578
22579 The following objfile-related functions are available in the
22580 @code{gdb} module:
22581
22582 @findex gdb.current_objfile
22583 @defun current_objfile
22584 When auto-loading a Python script (@pxref{Auto-loading}), @value{GDBN}
22585 sets the ``current objfile'' to the corresponding objfile. This
22586 function returns the current objfile. If there is no current objfile,
22587 this function returns @code{None}.
22588 @end defun
22589
22590 @findex gdb.objfiles
22591 @defun objfiles
22592 Return a sequence of all the objfiles current known to @value{GDBN}.
22593 @xref{Objfiles In Python}.
22594 @end defun
22595
22596 Each objfile is represented by an instance of the @code{gdb.Objfile}
22597 class.
22598
22599 @defivar Objfile filename
22600 The file name of the objfile as a string.
22601 @end defivar
22602
22603 @defivar Objfile pretty_printers
22604 The @code{pretty_printers} attribute is a list of functions. It is
22605 used to look up pretty-printers. A @code{Value} is passed to each
22606 function in order; if the function returns @code{None}, then the
22607 search continues. Otherwise, the return value should be an object
22608 which is used to format the value. @xref{Pretty Printing API}, for more
22609 information.
22610 @end defivar
22611
22612 @node Frames In Python
22613 @subsubsection Accessing inferior stack frames from Python.
22614
22615 @cindex frames in python
22616 When the debugged program stops, @value{GDBN} is able to analyze its call
22617 stack (@pxref{Frames,,Stack frames}). The @code{gdb.Frame} class
22618 represents a frame in the stack. A @code{gdb.Frame} object is only valid
22619 while its corresponding frame exists in the inferior's stack. If you try
22620 to use an invalid frame object, @value{GDBN} will throw a @code{gdb.error}
22621 exception (@pxref{Exception Handling}).
22622
22623 Two @code{gdb.Frame} objects can be compared for equality with the @code{==}
22624 operator, like:
22625
22626 @smallexample
22627 (@value{GDBP}) python print gdb.newest_frame() == gdb.selected_frame ()
22628 True
22629 @end smallexample
22630
22631 The following frame-related functions are available in the @code{gdb} module:
22632
22633 @findex gdb.selected_frame
22634 @defun selected_frame
22635 Return the selected frame object. (@pxref{Selection,,Selecting a Frame}).
22636 @end defun
22637
22638 @findex gdb.newest_frame
22639 @defun newest_frame
22640 Return the newest frame object for the selected thread.
22641 @end defun
22642
22643 @defun frame_stop_reason_string reason
22644 Return a string explaining the reason why @value{GDBN} stopped unwinding
22645 frames, as expressed by the given @var{reason} code (an integer, see the
22646 @code{unwind_stop_reason} method further down in this section).
22647 @end defun
22648
22649 A @code{gdb.Frame} object has the following methods:
22650
22651 @table @code
22652 @defmethod Frame is_valid
22653 Returns true if the @code{gdb.Frame} object is valid, false if not.
22654 A frame object can become invalid if the frame it refers to doesn't
22655 exist anymore in the inferior. All @code{gdb.Frame} methods will throw
22656 an exception if it is invalid at the time the method is called.
22657 @end defmethod
22658
22659 @defmethod Frame name
22660 Returns the function name of the frame, or @code{None} if it can't be
22661 obtained.
22662 @end defmethod
22663
22664 @defmethod Frame type
22665 Returns the type of the frame. The value can be one of:
22666 @table @code
22667 @item gdb.NORMAL_FRAME
22668 An ordinary stack frame.
22669
22670 @item gdb.DUMMY_FRAME
22671 A fake stack frame that was created by @value{GDBN} when performing an
22672 inferior function call.
22673
22674 @item gdb.INLINE_FRAME
22675 A frame representing an inlined function. The function was inlined
22676 into a @code{gdb.NORMAL_FRAME} that is older than this one.
22677
22678 @item gdb.SIGTRAMP_FRAME
22679 A signal trampoline frame. This is the frame created by the OS when
22680 it calls into a signal handler.
22681
22682 @item gdb.ARCH_FRAME
22683 A fake stack frame representing a cross-architecture call.
22684
22685 @item gdb.SENTINEL_FRAME
22686 This is like @code{gdb.NORMAL_FRAME}, but it is only used for the
22687 newest frame.
22688 @end table
22689 @end defmethod
22690
22691 @defmethod Frame unwind_stop_reason
22692 Return an integer representing the reason why it's not possible to find
22693 more frames toward the outermost frame. Use
22694 @code{gdb.frame_stop_reason_string} to convert the value returned by this
22695 function to a string.
22696 @end defmethod
22697
22698 @defmethod Frame pc
22699 Returns the frame's resume address.
22700 @end defmethod
22701
22702 @defmethod Frame block
22703 Return the frame's code block. @xref{Blocks In Python}.
22704 @end defmethod
22705
22706 @defmethod Frame function
22707 Return the symbol for the function corresponding to this frame.
22708 @xref{Symbols In Python}.
22709 @end defmethod
22710
22711 @defmethod Frame older
22712 Return the frame that called this frame.
22713 @end defmethod
22714
22715 @defmethod Frame newer
22716 Return the frame called by this frame.
22717 @end defmethod
22718
22719 @defmethod Frame find_sal
22720 Return the frame's symtab and line object.
22721 @xref{Symbol Tables In Python}.
22722 @end defmethod
22723
22724 @defmethod Frame read_var variable @r{[}block@r{]}
22725 Return the value of @var{variable} in this frame. If the optional
22726 argument @var{block} is provided, search for the variable from that
22727 block; otherwise start at the frame's current block (which is
22728 determined by the frame's current program counter). @var{variable}
22729 must be a string or a @code{gdb.Symbol} object. @var{block} must be a
22730 @code{gdb.Block} object.
22731 @end defmethod
22732
22733 @defmethod Frame select
22734 Set this frame to be the selected frame. @xref{Stack, ,Examining the
22735 Stack}.
22736 @end defmethod
22737 @end table
22738
22739 @node Blocks In Python
22740 @subsubsection Accessing frame blocks from Python.
22741
22742 @cindex blocks in python
22743 @tindex gdb.Block
22744
22745 Within each frame, @value{GDBN} maintains information on each block
22746 stored in that frame. These blocks are organized hierarchically, and
22747 are represented individually in Python as a @code{gdb.Block}.
22748 Please see @ref{Frames In Python}, for a more in-depth discussion on
22749 frames. Furthermore, see @ref{Stack, ,Examining the Stack}, for more
22750 detailed technical information on @value{GDBN}'s book-keeping of the
22751 stack.
22752
22753 The following block-related functions are available in the @code{gdb}
22754 module:
22755
22756 @findex gdb.block_for_pc
22757 @defun block_for_pc pc
22758 Return the @code{gdb.Block} containing the given @var{pc} value. If the
22759 block cannot be found for the @var{pc} value specified, the function
22760 will return @code{None}.
22761 @end defun
22762
22763 A @code{gdb.Block} object has the following attributes:
22764
22765 @table @code
22766 @defivar Block start
22767 The start address of the block. This attribute is not writable.
22768 @end defivar
22769
22770 @defivar Block end
22771 The end address of the block. This attribute is not writable.
22772 @end defivar
22773
22774 @defivar Block function
22775 The name of the block represented as a @code{gdb.Symbol}. If the
22776 block is not named, then this attribute holds @code{None}. This
22777 attribute is not writable.
22778 @end defivar
22779
22780 @defivar Block superblock
22781 The block containing this block. If this parent block does not exist,
22782 this attribute holds @code{None}. This attribute is not writable.
22783 @end defivar
22784 @end table
22785
22786 @node Symbols In Python
22787 @subsubsection Python representation of Symbols.
22788
22789 @cindex symbols in python
22790 @tindex gdb.Symbol
22791
22792 @value{GDBN} represents every variable, function and type as an
22793 entry in a symbol table. @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol Table}.
22794 Similarly, Python represents these symbols in @value{GDBN} with the
22795 @code{gdb.Symbol} object.
22796
22797 The following symbol-related functions are available in the @code{gdb}
22798 module:
22799
22800 @findex gdb.lookup_symbol
22801 @defun lookup_symbol name [block] [domain]
22802 This function searches for a symbol by name. The search scope can be
22803 restricted to the parameters defined in the optional domain and block
22804 arguments.
22805
22806 @var{name} is the name of the symbol. It must be a string. The
22807 optional @var{block} argument restricts the search to symbols visible
22808 in that @var{block}. The @var{block} argument must be a
22809 @code{gdb.Block} object. The optional @var{domain} argument restricts
22810 the search to the domain type. The @var{domain} argument must be a
22811 domain constant defined in the @code{gdb} module and described later
22812 in this chapter.
22813 @end defun
22814
22815 A @code{gdb.Symbol} object has the following attributes:
22816
22817 @table @code
22818 @defivar Symbol symtab
22819 The symbol table in which the symbol appears. This attribute is
22820 represented as a @code{gdb.Symtab} object. @xref{Symbol Tables In
22821 Python}. This attribute is not writable.
22822 @end defivar
22823
22824 @defivar Symbol name
22825 The name of the symbol as a string. This attribute is not writable.
22826 @end defivar
22827
22828 @defivar Symbol linkage_name
22829 The name of the symbol, as used by the linker (i.e., may be mangled).
22830 This attribute is not writable.
22831 @end defivar
22832
22833 @defivar Symbol print_name
22834 The name of the symbol in a form suitable for output. This is either
22835 @code{name} or @code{linkage_name}, depending on whether the user
22836 asked @value{GDBN} to display demangled or mangled names.
22837 @end defivar
22838
22839 @defivar Symbol addr_class
22840 The address class of the symbol. This classifies how to find the value
22841 of a symbol. Each address class is a constant defined in the
22842 @code{gdb} module and described later in this chapter.
22843 @end defivar
22844
22845 @defivar Symbol is_argument
22846 @code{True} if the symbol is an argument of a function.
22847 @end defivar
22848
22849 @defivar Symbol is_constant
22850 @code{True} if the symbol is a constant.
22851 @end defivar
22852
22853 @defivar Symbol is_function
22854 @code{True} if the symbol is a function or a method.
22855 @end defivar
22856
22857 @defivar Symbol is_variable
22858 @code{True} if the symbol is a variable.
22859 @end defivar
22860 @end table
22861
22862 The available domain categories in @code{gdb.Symbol} are represented
22863 as constants in the @code{gdb} module:
22864
22865 @table @code
22866 @findex SYMBOL_UNDEF_DOMAIN
22867 @findex gdb.SYMBOL_UNDEF_DOMAIN
22868 @item SYMBOL_UNDEF_DOMAIN
22869 This is used when a domain has not been discovered or none of the
22870 following domains apply. This usually indicates an error either
22871 in the symbol information or in @value{GDBN}'s handling of symbols.
22872 @findex SYMBOL_VAR_DOMAIN
22873 @findex gdb.SYMBOL_VAR_DOMAIN
22874 @item SYMBOL_VAR_DOMAIN
22875 This domain contains variables, function names, typedef names and enum
22876 type values.
22877 @findex SYMBOL_STRUCT_DOMAIN
22878 @findex gdb.SYMBOL_STRUCT_DOMAIN
22879 @item SYMBOL_STRUCT_DOMAIN
22880 This domain holds struct, union and enum type names.
22881 @findex SYMBOL_LABEL_DOMAIN
22882 @findex gdb.SYMBOL_LABEL_DOMAIN
22883 @item SYMBOL_LABEL_DOMAIN
22884 This domain contains names of labels (for gotos).
22885 @findex SYMBOL_VARIABLES_DOMAIN
22886 @findex gdb.SYMBOL_VARIABLES_DOMAIN
22887 @item SYMBOL_VARIABLES_DOMAIN
22888 This domain holds a subset of the @code{SYMBOLS_VAR_DOMAIN}; it
22889 contains everything minus functions and types.
22890 @findex SYMBOL_FUNCTIONS_DOMAIN
22891 @findex gdb.SYMBOL_FUNCTIONS_DOMAIN
22892 @item SYMBOL_FUNCTION_DOMAIN
22893 This domain contains all functions.
22894 @findex SYMBOL_TYPES_DOMAIN
22895 @findex gdb.SYMBOL_TYPES_DOMAIN
22896 @item SYMBOL_TYPES_DOMAIN
22897 This domain contains all types.
22898 @end table
22899
22900 The available address class categories in @code{gdb.Symbol} are represented
22901 as constants in the @code{gdb} module:
22902
22903 @table @code
22904 @findex SYMBOL_LOC_UNDEF
22905 @findex gdb.SYMBOL_LOC_UNDEF
22906 @item SYMBOL_LOC_UNDEF
22907 If this is returned by address class, it indicates an error either in
22908 the symbol information or in @value{GDBN}'s handling of symbols.
22909 @findex SYMBOL_LOC_CONST
22910 @findex gdb.SYMBOL_LOC_CONST
22911 @item SYMBOL_LOC_CONST
22912 Value is constant int.
22913 @findex SYMBOL_LOC_STATIC
22914 @findex gdb.SYMBOL_LOC_STATIC
22915 @item SYMBOL_LOC_STATIC
22916 Value is at a fixed address.
22917 @findex SYMBOL_LOC_REGISTER
22918 @findex gdb.SYMBOL_LOC_REGISTER
22919 @item SYMBOL_LOC_REGISTER
22920 Value is in a register.
22921 @findex SYMBOL_LOC_ARG
22922 @findex gdb.SYMBOL_LOC_ARG
22923 @item SYMBOL_LOC_ARG
22924 Value is an argument. This value is at the offset stored within the
22925 symbol inside the frame's argument list.
22926 @findex SYMBOL_LOC_REF_ARG
22927 @findex gdb.SYMBOL_LOC_REF_ARG
22928 @item SYMBOL_LOC_REF_ARG
22929 Value address is stored in the frame's argument list. Just like
22930 @code{LOC_ARG} except that the value's address is stored at the
22931 offset, not the value itself.
22932 @findex SYMBOL_LOC_REGPARM_ADDR
22933 @findex gdb.SYMBOL_LOC_REGPARM_ADDR
22934 @item SYMBOL_LOC_REGPARM_ADDR
22935 Value is a specified register. Just like @code{LOC_REGISTER} except
22936 the register holds the address of the argument instead of the argument
22937 itself.
22938 @findex SYMBOL_LOC_LOCAL
22939 @findex gdb.SYMBOL_LOC_LOCAL
22940 @item SYMBOL_LOC_LOCAL
22941 Value is a local variable.
22942 @findex SYMBOL_LOC_TYPEDEF
22943 @findex gdb.SYMBOL_LOC_TYPEDEF
22944 @item SYMBOL_LOC_TYPEDEF
22945 Value not used. Symbols in the domain @code{SYMBOL_STRUCT_DOMAIN} all
22946 have this class.
22947 @findex SYMBOL_LOC_BLOCK
22948 @findex gdb.SYMBOL_LOC_BLOCK
22949 @item SYMBOL_LOC_BLOCK
22950 Value is a block.
22951 @findex SYMBOL_LOC_CONST_BYTES
22952 @findex gdb.SYMBOL_LOC_CONST_BYTES
22953 @item SYMBOL_LOC_CONST_BYTES
22954 Value is a byte-sequence.
22955 @findex SYMBOL_LOC_UNRESOLVED
22956 @findex gdb.SYMBOL_LOC_UNRESOLVED
22957 @item SYMBOL_LOC_UNRESOLVED
22958 Value is at a fixed address, but the address of the variable has to be
22959 determined from the minimal symbol table whenever the variable is
22960 referenced.
22961 @findex SYMBOL_LOC_OPTIMIZED_OUT
22962 @findex gdb.SYMBOL_LOC_OPTIMIZED_OUT
22963 @item SYMBOL_LOC_OPTIMIZED_OUT
22964 The value does not actually exist in the program.
22965 @findex SYMBOL_LOC_COMPUTED
22966 @findex gdb.SYMBOL_LOC_COMPUTED
22967 @item SYMBOL_LOC_COMPUTED
22968 The value's address is a computed location.
22969 @end table
22970
22971 @node Symbol Tables In Python
22972 @subsubsection Symbol table representation in Python.
22973
22974 @cindex symbol tables in python
22975 @tindex gdb.Symtab
22976 @tindex gdb.Symtab_and_line
22977
22978 Access to symbol table data maintained by @value{GDBN} on the inferior
22979 is exposed to Python via two objects: @code{gdb.Symtab_and_line} and
22980 @code{gdb.Symtab}. Symbol table and line data for a frame is returned
22981 from the @code{find_sal} method in @code{gdb.Frame} object.
22982 @xref{Frames In Python}.
22983
22984 For more information on @value{GDBN}'s symbol table management, see
22985 @ref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol Table}, for more information.
22986
22987 A @code{gdb.Symtab_and_line} object has the following attributes:
22988
22989 @table @code
22990 @defivar Symtab_and_line symtab
22991 The symbol table object (@code{gdb.Symtab}) for this frame.
22992 This attribute is not writable.
22993 @end defivar
22994
22995 @defivar Symtab_and_line pc
22996 Indicates the current program counter address. This attribute is not
22997 writable.
22998 @end defivar
22999
23000 @defivar Symtab_and_line line
23001 Indicates the current line number for this object. This
23002 attribute is not writable.
23003 @end defivar
23004 @end table
23005
23006 A @code{gdb.Symtab} object has the following attributes:
23007
23008 @table @code
23009 @defivar Symtab filename
23010 The symbol table's source filename. This attribute is not writable.
23011 @end defivar
23012
23013 @defivar Symtab objfile
23014 The symbol table's backing object file. @xref{Objfiles In Python}.
23015 This attribute is not writable.
23016 @end defivar
23017 @end table
23018
23019 The following methods are provided:
23020
23021 @table @code
23022 @defmethod Symtab fullname
23023 Return the symbol table's source absolute file name.
23024 @end defmethod
23025 @end table
23026
23027 @node Breakpoints In Python
23028 @subsubsection Manipulating breakpoints using Python
23029
23030 @cindex breakpoints in python
23031 @tindex gdb.Breakpoint
23032
23033 Python code can manipulate breakpoints via the @code{gdb.Breakpoint}
23034 class.
23035
23036 @defmethod Breakpoint __init__ spec @r{[}type@r{]} @r{[}wp_class@r{]} @r{[}internal@r{]}
23037 Create a new breakpoint. @var{spec} is a string naming the
23038 location of the breakpoint, or an expression that defines a
23039 watchpoint. The contents can be any location recognized by the
23040 @code{break} command, or in the case of a watchpoint, by the @code{watch}
23041 command. The optional @var{type} denotes the breakpoint to create
23042 from the types defined later in this chapter. This argument can be
23043 either: @code{BP_BREAKPOINT} or @code{BP_WATCHPOINT}. @var{type}
23044 defaults to @code{BP_BREAKPOINT}. The optional @var{internal} argument
23045 allows the breakpoint to become invisible to the user. The breakpoint
23046 will neither be reported when created, nor will it be listed in the
23047 output from @code{info breakpoints} (but will be listed with the
23048 @code{maint info breakpoints} command). The optional @var{wp_class}
23049 argument defines the class of watchpoint to create, if @var{type} is
23050 @code{BP_WATCHPOINT}. If a watchpoint class is not provided, it is
23051 assumed to be a @var{WP_WRITE} class.
23052 @end defmethod
23053
23054 The available watchpoint types represented by constants are defined in the
23055 @code{gdb} module:
23056
23057 @table @code
23058 @findex WP_READ
23059 @findex gdb.WP_READ
23060 @item WP_READ
23061 Read only watchpoint.
23062
23063 @findex WP_WRITE
23064 @findex gdb.WP_WRITE
23065 @item WP_WRITE
23066 Write only watchpoint.
23067
23068 @findex WP_ACCESS
23069 @findex gdb.WP_ACCESS
23070 @item WP_ACCESS
23071 Read/Write watchpoint.
23072 @end table
23073
23074 @defmethod Breakpoint is_valid
23075 Return @code{True} if this @code{Breakpoint} object is valid,
23076 @code{False} otherwise. A @code{Breakpoint} object can become invalid
23077 if the user deletes the breakpoint. In this case, the object still
23078 exists, but the underlying breakpoint does not. In the cases of
23079 watchpoint scope, the watchpoint remains valid even if execution of the
23080 inferior leaves the scope of that watchpoint.
23081 @end defmethod
23082
23083 @defmethod Breakpoint delete
23084 Permanently deletes the @value{GDBN} breakpoint. This also
23085 invalidates the Python @code{Breakpoint} object. Any further access
23086 to this object's attributes or methods will raise an error.
23087 @end defmethod
23088
23089 @defivar Breakpoint enabled
23090 This attribute is @code{True} if the breakpoint is enabled, and
23091 @code{False} otherwise. This attribute is writable.
23092 @end defivar
23093
23094 @defivar Breakpoint silent
23095 This attribute is @code{True} if the breakpoint is silent, and
23096 @code{False} otherwise. This attribute is writable.
23097
23098 Note that a breakpoint can also be silent if it has commands and the
23099 first command is @code{silent}. This is not reported by the
23100 @code{silent} attribute.
23101 @end defivar
23102
23103 @defivar Breakpoint thread
23104 If the breakpoint is thread-specific, this attribute holds the thread
23105 id. If the breakpoint is not thread-specific, this attribute is
23106 @code{None}. This attribute is writable.
23107 @end defivar
23108
23109 @defivar Breakpoint task
23110 If the breakpoint is Ada task-specific, this attribute holds the Ada task
23111 id. If the breakpoint is not task-specific (or the underlying
23112 language is not Ada), this attribute is @code{None}. This attribute
23113 is writable.
23114 @end defivar
23115
23116 @defivar Breakpoint ignore_count
23117 This attribute holds the ignore count for the breakpoint, an integer.
23118 This attribute is writable.
23119 @end defivar
23120
23121 @defivar Breakpoint number
23122 This attribute holds the breakpoint's number --- the identifier used by
23123 the user to manipulate the breakpoint. This attribute is not writable.
23124 @end defivar
23125
23126 @defivar Breakpoint type
23127 This attribute holds the breakpoint's type --- the identifier used to
23128 determine the actual breakpoint type or use-case. This attribute is not
23129 writable.
23130 @end defivar
23131
23132 @defivar Breakpoint visible
23133 This attribute tells whether the breakpoint is visible to the user
23134 when set, or when the @samp{info breakpoints} command is run. This
23135 attribute is not writable.
23136 @end defivar
23137
23138 The available types are represented by constants defined in the @code{gdb}
23139 module:
23140
23141 @table @code
23142 @findex BP_BREAKPOINT
23143 @findex gdb.BP_BREAKPOINT
23144 @item BP_BREAKPOINT
23145 Normal code breakpoint.
23146
23147 @findex BP_WATCHPOINT
23148 @findex gdb.BP_WATCHPOINT
23149 @item BP_WATCHPOINT
23150 Watchpoint breakpoint.
23151
23152 @findex BP_HARDWARE_WATCHPOINT
23153 @findex gdb.BP_HARDWARE_WATCHPOINT
23154 @item BP_HARDWARE_WATCHPOINT
23155 Hardware assisted watchpoint.
23156
23157 @findex BP_READ_WATCHPOINT
23158 @findex gdb.BP_READ_WATCHPOINT
23159 @item BP_READ_WATCHPOINT
23160 Hardware assisted read watchpoint.
23161
23162 @findex BP_ACCESS_WATCHPOINT
23163 @findex gdb.BP_ACCESS_WATCHPOINT
23164 @item BP_ACCESS_WATCHPOINT
23165 Hardware assisted access watchpoint.
23166 @end table
23167
23168 @defivar Breakpoint hit_count
23169 This attribute holds the hit count for the breakpoint, an integer.
23170 This attribute is writable, but currently it can only be set to zero.
23171 @end defivar
23172
23173 @defivar Breakpoint location
23174 This attribute holds the location of the breakpoint, as specified by
23175 the user. It is a string. If the breakpoint does not have a location
23176 (that is, it is a watchpoint) the attribute's value is @code{None}. This
23177 attribute is not writable.
23178 @end defivar
23179
23180 @defivar Breakpoint expression
23181 This attribute holds a breakpoint expression, as specified by
23182 the user. It is a string. If the breakpoint does not have an
23183 expression (the breakpoint is not a watchpoint) the attribute's value
23184 is @code{None}. This attribute is not writable.
23185 @end defivar
23186
23187 @defivar Breakpoint condition
23188 This attribute holds the condition of the breakpoint, as specified by
23189 the user. It is a string. If there is no condition, this attribute's
23190 value is @code{None}. This attribute is writable.
23191 @end defivar
23192
23193 @defivar Breakpoint commands
23194 This attribute holds the commands attached to the breakpoint. If
23195 there are commands, this attribute's value is a string holding all the
23196 commands, separated by newlines. If there are no commands, this
23197 attribute is @code{None}. This attribute is not writable.
23198 @end defivar
23199
23200 @node Lazy Strings In Python
23201 @subsubsection Python representation of lazy strings.
23202
23203 @cindex lazy strings in python
23204 @tindex gdb.LazyString
23205
23206 A @dfn{lazy string} is a string whose contents is not retrieved or
23207 encoded until it is needed.
23208
23209 A @code{gdb.LazyString} is represented in @value{GDBN} as an
23210 @code{address} that points to a region of memory, an @code{encoding}
23211 that will be used to encode that region of memory, and a @code{length}
23212 to delimit the region of memory that represents the string. The
23213 difference between a @code{gdb.LazyString} and a string wrapped within
23214 a @code{gdb.Value} is that a @code{gdb.LazyString} will be treated
23215 differently by @value{GDBN} when printing. A @code{gdb.LazyString} is
23216 retrieved and encoded during printing, while a @code{gdb.Value}
23217 wrapping a string is immediately retrieved and encoded on creation.
23218
23219 A @code{gdb.LazyString} object has the following functions:
23220
23221 @defmethod LazyString value
23222 Convert the @code{gdb.LazyString} to a @code{gdb.Value}. This value
23223 will point to the string in memory, but will lose all the delayed
23224 retrieval, encoding and handling that @value{GDBN} applies to a
23225 @code{gdb.LazyString}.
23226 @end defmethod
23227
23228 @defivar LazyString address
23229 This attribute holds the address of the string. This attribute is not
23230 writable.
23231 @end defivar
23232
23233 @defivar LazyString length
23234 This attribute holds the length of the string in characters. If the
23235 length is -1, then the string will be fetched and encoded up to the
23236 first null of appropriate width. This attribute is not writable.
23237 @end defivar
23238
23239 @defivar LazyString encoding
23240 This attribute holds the encoding that will be applied to the string
23241 when the string is printed by @value{GDBN}. If the encoding is not
23242 set, or contains an empty string, then @value{GDBN} will select the
23243 most appropriate encoding when the string is printed. This attribute
23244 is not writable.
23245 @end defivar
23246
23247 @defivar LazyString type
23248 This attribute holds the type that is represented by the lazy string's
23249 type. For a lazy string this will always be a pointer type. To
23250 resolve this to the lazy string's character type, use the type's
23251 @code{target} method. @xref{Types In Python}. This attribute is not
23252 writable.
23253 @end defivar
23254
23255 @node Auto-loading
23256 @subsection Auto-loading
23257 @cindex auto-loading, Python
23258
23259 When a new object file is read (for example, due to the @code{file}
23260 command, or because the inferior has loaded a shared library),
23261 @value{GDBN} will look for Python support scripts in several ways:
23262 @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.py} and @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section.
23263
23264 @menu
23265 * objfile-gdb.py file:: The @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.py} file
23266 * .debug_gdb_scripts section:: The @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section
23267 * Which flavor to choose?::
23268 @end menu
23269
23270 The auto-loading feature is useful for supplying application-specific
23271 debugging commands and scripts.
23272
23273 Auto-loading can be enabled or disabled.
23274
23275 @table @code
23276 @kindex set auto-load-scripts
23277 @item set auto-load-scripts [yes|no]
23278 Enable or disable the auto-loading of Python scripts.
23279
23280 @kindex show auto-load-scripts
23281 @item show auto-load-scripts
23282 Show whether auto-loading of Python scripts is enabled or disabled.
23283 @end table
23284
23285 When reading an auto-loaded file, @value{GDBN} sets the
23286 @dfn{current objfile}. This is available via the @code{gdb.current_objfile}
23287 function (@pxref{Objfiles In Python}). This can be useful for
23288 registering objfile-specific pretty-printers.
23289
23290 @node objfile-gdb.py file
23291 @subsubsection The @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.py} file
23292 @cindex @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.py}
23293
23294 When a new object file is read, @value{GDBN} looks for
23295 a file named @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.py},
23296 where @var{objfile} is the object file's real name, formed by ensuring
23297 that the file name is absolute, following all symlinks, and resolving
23298 @code{.} and @code{..} components. If this file exists and is
23299 readable, @value{GDBN} will evaluate it as a Python script.
23300
23301 If this file does not exist, and if the parameter
23302 @code{debug-file-directory} is set (@pxref{Separate Debug Files}),
23303 then @value{GDBN} will look for @var{real-name} in all of the
23304 directories mentioned in the value of @code{debug-file-directory}.
23305
23306 Finally, if this file does not exist, then @value{GDBN} will look for
23307 a file named @file{@var{data-directory}/python/auto-load/@var{real-name}}, where
23308 @var{data-directory} is @value{GDBN}'s data directory (available via
23309 @code{show data-directory}, @pxref{Data Files}), and @var{real-name}
23310 is the object file's real name, as described above.
23311
23312 @value{GDBN} does not track which files it has already auto-loaded this way.
23313 @value{GDBN} will load the associated script every time the corresponding
23314 @var{objfile} is opened.
23315 So your @file{-gdb.py} file should be careful to avoid errors if it
23316 is evaluated more than once.
23317
23318 @node .debug_gdb_scripts section
23319 @subsubsection The @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section
23320 @cindex @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section
23321
23322 For systems using file formats like ELF and COFF,
23323 when @value{GDBN} loads a new object file
23324 it will look for a special section named @samp{.debug_gdb_scripts}.
23325 If this section exists, its contents is a list of names of scripts to load.
23326
23327 @value{GDBN} will look for each specified script file first in the
23328 current directory and then along the source search path
23329 (@pxref{Source Path, ,Specifying Source Directories}),
23330 except that @file{$cdir} is not searched, since the compilation
23331 directory is not relevant to scripts.
23332
23333 Entries can be placed in section @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} with,
23334 for example, this GCC macro:
23335
23336 @example
23337 /* Note: The "MS" section flags are to remove duplicates. */
23338 #define DEFINE_GDB_SCRIPT(script_name) \
23339 asm("\
23340 .pushsection \".debug_gdb_scripts\", \"MS\",@@progbits,1\n\
23341 .byte 1\n\
23342 .asciz \"" script_name "\"\n\
23343 .popsection \n\
23344 ");
23345 @end example
23346
23347 @noindent
23348 Then one can reference the macro in a header or source file like this:
23349
23350 @example
23351 DEFINE_GDB_SCRIPT ("my-app-scripts.py")
23352 @end example
23353
23354 The script name may include directories if desired.
23355
23356 If the macro is put in a header, any application or library
23357 using this header will get a reference to the specified script.
23358
23359 @node Which flavor to choose?
23360 @subsubsection Which flavor to choose?
23361
23362 Given the multiple ways of auto-loading Python scripts, it might not always
23363 be clear which one to choose. This section provides some guidance.
23364
23365 Benefits of the @file{-gdb.py} way:
23366
23367 @itemize @bullet
23368 @item
23369 Can be used with file formats that don't support multiple sections.
23370
23371 @item
23372 Ease of finding scripts for public libraries.
23373
23374 Scripts specified in the @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section are searched for
23375 in the source search path.
23376 For publicly installed libraries, e.g., @file{libstdc++}, there typically
23377 isn't a source directory in which to find the script.
23378
23379 @item
23380 Doesn't require source code additions.
23381 @end itemize
23382
23383 Benefits of the @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} way:
23384
23385 @itemize @bullet
23386 @item
23387 Works with static linking.
23388
23389 Scripts for libraries done the @file{-gdb.py} way require an objfile to
23390 trigger their loading. When an application is statically linked the only
23391 objfile available is the executable, and it is cumbersome to attach all the
23392 scripts from all the input libraries to the executable's @file{-gdb.py} script.
23393
23394 @item
23395 Works with classes that are entirely inlined.
23396
23397 Some classes can be entirely inlined, and thus there may not be an associated
23398 shared library to attach a @file{-gdb.py} script to.
23399
23400 @item
23401 Scripts needn't be copied out of the source tree.
23402
23403 In some circumstances, apps can be built out of large collections of internal
23404 libraries, and the build infrastructure necessary to install the
23405 @file{-gdb.py} scripts in a place where @value{GDBN} can find them is
23406 cumbersome. It may be easier to specify the scripts in the
23407 @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section as relative paths, and add a path to the
23408 top of the source tree to the source search path.
23409 @end itemize
23410
23411 @node Python modules
23412 @subsection Python modules
23413 @cindex python modules
23414
23415 @value{GDBN} comes with a module to assist writing Python code.
23416
23417 @menu
23418 * gdb.printing:: Building and registering pretty-printers.
23419 * gdb.types:: Utilities for working with types.
23420 @end menu
23421
23422 @node gdb.printing
23423 @subsubsection gdb.printing
23424 @cindex gdb.printing
23425
23426 This module provides a collection of utilities for working with
23427 pretty-printers.
23428
23429 @table @code
23430 @item PrettyPrinter (@var{name}, @var{subprinters}=None)
23431 This class specifies the API that makes @samp{info pretty-printer},
23432 @samp{enable pretty-printer} and @samp{disable pretty-printer} work.
23433 Pretty-printers should generally inherit from this class.
23434
23435 @item SubPrettyPrinter (@var{name})
23436 For printers that handle multiple types, this class specifies the
23437 corresponding API for the subprinters.
23438
23439 @item RegexpCollectionPrettyPrinter (@var{name})
23440 Utility class for handling multiple printers, all recognized via
23441 regular expressions.
23442 @xref{Writing a Pretty-Printer}, for an example.
23443
23444 @item register_pretty_printer (@var{obj}, @var{printer})
23445 Register @var{printer} with the pretty-printer list of @var{obj}.
23446 @end table
23447
23448 @node gdb.types
23449 @subsubsection gdb.types
23450 @cindex gdb.types
23451
23452 This module provides a collection of utilities for working with
23453 @code{gdb.Types} objects.
23454
23455 @table @code
23456 @item get_basic_type (@var{type})
23457 Return @var{type} with const and volatile qualifiers stripped,
23458 and with typedefs and C@t{++} references converted to the underlying type.
23459
23460 C@t{++} example:
23461
23462 @smallexample
23463 typedef const int const_int;
23464 const_int foo (3);
23465 const_int& foo_ref (foo);
23466 int main () @{ return 0; @}
23467 @end smallexample
23468
23469 Then in gdb:
23470
23471 @smallexample
23472 (gdb) start
23473 (gdb) python import gdb.types
23474 (gdb) python foo_ref = gdb.parse_and_eval("foo_ref")
23475 (gdb) python print gdb.types.get_basic_type(foo_ref.type)
23476 int
23477 @end smallexample
23478
23479 @item has_field (@var{type}, @var{field})
23480 Return @code{True} if @var{type}, assumed to be a type with fields
23481 (e.g., a structure or union), has field @var{field}.
23482
23483 @item make_enum_dict (@var{enum_type})
23484 Return a Python @code{dictionary} type produced from @var{enum_type}.
23485 @end table
23486
23487 @node Interpreters
23488 @chapter Command Interpreters
23489 @cindex command interpreters
23490
23491 @value{GDBN} supports multiple command interpreters, and some command
23492 infrastructure to allow users or user interface writers to switch
23493 between interpreters or run commands in other interpreters.
23494
23495 @value{GDBN} currently supports two command interpreters, the console
23496 interpreter (sometimes called the command-line interpreter or @sc{cli})
23497 and the machine interface interpreter (or @sc{gdb/mi}). This manual
23498 describes both of these interfaces in great detail.
23499
23500 By default, @value{GDBN} will start with the console interpreter.
23501 However, the user may choose to start @value{GDBN} with another
23502 interpreter by specifying the @option{-i} or @option{--interpreter}
23503 startup options. Defined interpreters include:
23504
23505 @table @code
23506 @item console
23507 @cindex console interpreter
23508 The traditional console or command-line interpreter. This is the most often
23509 used interpreter with @value{GDBN}. With no interpreter specified at runtime,
23510 @value{GDBN} will use this interpreter.
23511
23512 @item mi
23513 @cindex mi interpreter
23514 The newest @sc{gdb/mi} interface (currently @code{mi2}). Used primarily
23515 by programs wishing to use @value{GDBN} as a backend for a debugger GUI
23516 or an IDE. For more information, see @ref{GDB/MI, ,The @sc{gdb/mi}
23517 Interface}.
23518
23519 @item mi2
23520 @cindex mi2 interpreter
23521 The current @sc{gdb/mi} interface.
23522
23523 @item mi1
23524 @cindex mi1 interpreter
23525 The @sc{gdb/mi} interface included in @value{GDBN} 5.1, 5.2, and 5.3.
23526
23527 @end table
23528
23529 @cindex invoke another interpreter
23530 The interpreter being used by @value{GDBN} may not be dynamically
23531 switched at runtime. Although possible, this could lead to a very
23532 precarious situation. Consider an IDE using @sc{gdb/mi}. If a user
23533 enters the command "interpreter-set console" in a console view,
23534 @value{GDBN} would switch to using the console interpreter, rendering
23535 the IDE inoperable!
23536
23537 @kindex interpreter-exec
23538 Although you may only choose a single interpreter at startup, you may execute
23539 commands in any interpreter from the current interpreter using the appropriate
23540 command. If you are running the console interpreter, simply use the
23541 @code{interpreter-exec} command:
23542
23543 @smallexample
23544 interpreter-exec mi "-data-list-register-names"
23545 @end smallexample
23546
23547 @sc{gdb/mi} has a similar command, although it is only available in versions of
23548 @value{GDBN} which support @sc{gdb/mi} version 2 (or greater).
23549
23550 @node TUI
23551 @chapter @value{GDBN} Text User Interface
23552 @cindex TUI
23553 @cindex Text User Interface
23554
23555 @menu
23556 * TUI Overview:: TUI overview
23557 * TUI Keys:: TUI key bindings
23558 * TUI Single Key Mode:: TUI single key mode
23559 * TUI Commands:: TUI-specific commands
23560 * TUI Configuration:: TUI configuration variables
23561 @end menu
23562
23563 The @value{GDBN} Text User Interface (TUI) is a terminal
23564 interface which uses the @code{curses} library to show the source
23565 file, the assembly output, the program registers and @value{GDBN}
23566 commands in separate text windows. The TUI mode is supported only
23567 on platforms where a suitable version of the @code{curses} library
23568 is available.
23569
23570 @pindex @value{GDBTUI}
23571 The TUI mode is enabled by default when you invoke @value{GDBN} as
23572 either @samp{@value{GDBTUI}} or @samp{@value{GDBP} -tui}.
23573 You can also switch in and out of TUI mode while @value{GDBN} runs by
23574 using various TUI commands and key bindings, such as @kbd{C-x C-a}.
23575 @xref{TUI Keys, ,TUI Key Bindings}.
23576
23577 @node TUI Overview
23578 @section TUI Overview
23579
23580 In TUI mode, @value{GDBN} can display several text windows:
23581
23582 @table @emph
23583 @item command
23584 This window is the @value{GDBN} command window with the @value{GDBN}
23585 prompt and the @value{GDBN} output. The @value{GDBN} input is still
23586 managed using readline.
23587
23588 @item source
23589 The source window shows the source file of the program. The current
23590 line and active breakpoints are displayed in this window.
23591
23592 @item assembly
23593 The assembly window shows the disassembly output of the program.
23594
23595 @item register
23596 This window shows the processor registers. Registers are highlighted
23597 when their values change.
23598 @end table
23599
23600 The source and assembly windows show the current program position
23601 by highlighting the current line and marking it with a @samp{>} marker.
23602 Breakpoints are indicated with two markers. The first marker
23603 indicates the breakpoint type:
23604
23605 @table @code
23606 @item B
23607 Breakpoint which was hit at least once.
23608
23609 @item b
23610 Breakpoint which was never hit.
23611
23612 @item H
23613 Hardware breakpoint which was hit at least once.
23614
23615 @item h
23616 Hardware breakpoint which was never hit.
23617 @end table
23618
23619 The second marker indicates whether the breakpoint is enabled or not:
23620
23621 @table @code
23622 @item +
23623 Breakpoint is enabled.
23624
23625 @item -
23626 Breakpoint is disabled.
23627 @end table
23628
23629 The source, assembly and register windows are updated when the current
23630 thread changes, when the frame changes, or when the program counter
23631 changes.
23632
23633 These windows are not all visible at the same time. The command
23634 window is always visible. The others can be arranged in several
23635 layouts:
23636
23637 @itemize @bullet
23638 @item
23639 source only,
23640
23641 @item
23642 assembly only,
23643
23644 @item
23645 source and assembly,
23646
23647 @item
23648 source and registers, or
23649
23650 @item
23651 assembly and registers.
23652 @end itemize
23653
23654 A status line above the command window shows the following information:
23655
23656 @table @emph
23657 @item target
23658 Indicates the current @value{GDBN} target.
23659 (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
23660
23661 @item process
23662 Gives the current process or thread number.
23663 When no process is being debugged, this field is set to @code{No process}.
23664
23665 @item function
23666 Gives the current function name for the selected frame.
23667 The name is demangled if demangling is turned on (@pxref{Print Settings}).
23668 When there is no symbol corresponding to the current program counter,
23669 the string @code{??} is displayed.
23670
23671 @item line
23672 Indicates the current line number for the selected frame.
23673 When the current line number is not known, the string @code{??} is displayed.
23674
23675 @item pc
23676 Indicates the current program counter address.
23677 @end table
23678
23679 @node TUI Keys
23680 @section TUI Key Bindings
23681 @cindex TUI key bindings
23682
23683 The TUI installs several key bindings in the readline keymaps
23684 @ifset SYSTEM_READLINE
23685 (@pxref{Command Line Editing, , , rluserman, GNU Readline Library}).
23686 @end ifset
23687 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
23688 (@pxref{Command Line Editing}).
23689 @end ifclear
23690 The following key bindings are installed for both TUI mode and the
23691 @value{GDBN} standard mode.
23692
23693 @table @kbd
23694 @kindex C-x C-a
23695 @item C-x C-a
23696 @kindex C-x a
23697 @itemx C-x a
23698 @kindex C-x A
23699 @itemx C-x A
23700 Enter or leave the TUI mode. When leaving the TUI mode,
23701 the curses window management stops and @value{GDBN} operates using
23702 its standard mode, writing on the terminal directly. When reentering
23703 the TUI mode, control is given back to the curses windows.
23704 The screen is then refreshed.
23705
23706 @kindex C-x 1
23707 @item C-x 1
23708 Use a TUI layout with only one window. The layout will
23709 either be @samp{source} or @samp{assembly}. When the TUI mode
23710 is not active, it will switch to the TUI mode.
23711
23712 Think of this key binding as the Emacs @kbd{C-x 1} binding.
23713
23714 @kindex C-x 2
23715 @item C-x 2
23716 Use a TUI layout with at least two windows. When the current
23717 layout already has two windows, the next layout with two windows is used.
23718 When a new layout is chosen, one window will always be common to the
23719 previous layout and the new one.
23720
23721 Think of it as the Emacs @kbd{C-x 2} binding.
23722
23723 @kindex C-x o
23724 @item C-x o
23725 Change the active window. The TUI associates several key bindings
23726 (like scrolling and arrow keys) with the active window. This command
23727 gives the focus to the next TUI window.
23728
23729 Think of it as the Emacs @kbd{C-x o} binding.
23730
23731 @kindex C-x s
23732 @item C-x s
23733 Switch in and out of the TUI SingleKey mode that binds single
23734 keys to @value{GDBN} commands (@pxref{TUI Single Key Mode}).
23735 @end table
23736
23737 The following key bindings only work in the TUI mode:
23738
23739 @table @asis
23740 @kindex PgUp
23741 @item @key{PgUp}
23742 Scroll the active window one page up.
23743
23744 @kindex PgDn
23745 @item @key{PgDn}
23746 Scroll the active window one page down.
23747
23748 @kindex Up
23749 @item @key{Up}
23750 Scroll the active window one line up.
23751
23752 @kindex Down
23753 @item @key{Down}
23754 Scroll the active window one line down.
23755
23756 @kindex Left
23757 @item @key{Left}
23758 Scroll the active window one column left.
23759
23760 @kindex Right
23761 @item @key{Right}
23762 Scroll the active window one column right.
23763
23764 @kindex C-L
23765 @item @kbd{C-L}
23766 Refresh the screen.
23767 @end table
23768
23769 Because the arrow keys scroll the active window in the TUI mode, they
23770 are not available for their normal use by readline unless the command
23771 window has the focus. When another window is active, you must use
23772 other readline key bindings such as @kbd{C-p}, @kbd{C-n}, @kbd{C-b}
23773 and @kbd{C-f} to control the command window.
23774
23775 @node TUI Single Key Mode
23776 @section TUI Single Key Mode
23777 @cindex TUI single key mode
23778
23779 The TUI also provides a @dfn{SingleKey} mode, which binds several
23780 frequently used @value{GDBN} commands to single keys. Type @kbd{C-x s} to
23781 switch into this mode, where the following key bindings are used:
23782
23783 @table @kbd
23784 @kindex c @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
23785 @item c
23786 continue
23787
23788 @kindex d @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
23789 @item d
23790 down
23791
23792 @kindex f @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
23793 @item f
23794 finish
23795
23796 @kindex n @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
23797 @item n
23798 next
23799
23800 @kindex q @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
23801 @item q
23802 exit the SingleKey mode.
23803
23804 @kindex r @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
23805 @item r
23806 run
23807
23808 @kindex s @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
23809 @item s
23810 step
23811
23812 @kindex u @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
23813 @item u
23814 up
23815
23816 @kindex v @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
23817 @item v
23818 info locals
23819
23820 @kindex w @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
23821 @item w
23822 where
23823 @end table
23824
23825 Other keys temporarily switch to the @value{GDBN} command prompt.
23826 The key that was pressed is inserted in the editing buffer so that
23827 it is possible to type most @value{GDBN} commands without interaction
23828 with the TUI SingleKey mode. Once the command is entered the TUI
23829 SingleKey mode is restored. The only way to permanently leave
23830 this mode is by typing @kbd{q} or @kbd{C-x s}.
23831
23832
23833 @node TUI Commands
23834 @section TUI-specific Commands
23835 @cindex TUI commands
23836
23837 The TUI has specific commands to control the text windows.
23838 These commands are always available, even when @value{GDBN} is not in
23839 the TUI mode. When @value{GDBN} is in the standard mode, most
23840 of these commands will automatically switch to the TUI mode.
23841
23842 Note that if @value{GDBN}'s @code{stdout} is not connected to a
23843 terminal, or @value{GDBN} has been started with the machine interface
23844 interpreter (@pxref{GDB/MI, ,The @sc{gdb/mi} Interface}), most of
23845 these commands will fail with an error, because it would not be
23846 possible or desirable to enable curses window management.
23847
23848 @table @code
23849 @item info win
23850 @kindex info win
23851 List and give the size of all displayed windows.
23852
23853 @item layout next
23854 @kindex layout
23855 Display the next layout.
23856
23857 @item layout prev
23858 Display the previous layout.
23859
23860 @item layout src
23861 Display the source window only.
23862
23863 @item layout asm
23864 Display the assembly window only.
23865
23866 @item layout split
23867 Display the source and assembly window.
23868
23869 @item layout regs
23870 Display the register window together with the source or assembly window.
23871
23872 @item focus next
23873 @kindex focus
23874 Make the next window active for scrolling.
23875
23876 @item focus prev
23877 Make the previous window active for scrolling.
23878
23879 @item focus src
23880 Make the source window active for scrolling.
23881
23882 @item focus asm
23883 Make the assembly window active for scrolling.
23884
23885 @item focus regs
23886 Make the register window active for scrolling.
23887
23888 @item focus cmd
23889 Make the command window active for scrolling.
23890
23891 @item refresh
23892 @kindex refresh
23893 Refresh the screen. This is similar to typing @kbd{C-L}.
23894
23895 @item tui reg float
23896 @kindex tui reg
23897 Show the floating point registers in the register window.
23898
23899 @item tui reg general
23900 Show the general registers in the register window.
23901
23902 @item tui reg next
23903 Show the next register group. The list of register groups as well as
23904 their order is target specific. The predefined register groups are the
23905 following: @code{general}, @code{float}, @code{system}, @code{vector},
23906 @code{all}, @code{save}, @code{restore}.
23907
23908 @item tui reg system
23909 Show the system registers in the register window.
23910
23911 @item update
23912 @kindex update
23913 Update the source window and the current execution point.
23914
23915 @item winheight @var{name} +@var{count}
23916 @itemx winheight @var{name} -@var{count}
23917 @kindex winheight
23918 Change the height of the window @var{name} by @var{count}
23919 lines. Positive counts increase the height, while negative counts
23920 decrease it.
23921
23922 @item tabset @var{nchars}
23923 @kindex tabset
23924 Set the width of tab stops to be @var{nchars} characters.
23925 @end table
23926
23927 @node TUI Configuration
23928 @section TUI Configuration Variables
23929 @cindex TUI configuration variables
23930
23931 Several configuration variables control the appearance of TUI windows.
23932
23933 @table @code
23934 @item set tui border-kind @var{kind}
23935 @kindex set tui border-kind
23936 Select the border appearance for the source, assembly and register windows.
23937 The possible values are the following:
23938 @table @code
23939 @item space
23940 Use a space character to draw the border.
23941
23942 @item ascii
23943 Use @sc{ascii} characters @samp{+}, @samp{-} and @samp{|} to draw the border.
23944
23945 @item acs
23946 Use the Alternate Character Set to draw the border. The border is
23947 drawn using character line graphics if the terminal supports them.
23948 @end table
23949
23950 @item set tui border-mode @var{mode}
23951 @kindex set tui border-mode
23952 @itemx set tui active-border-mode @var{mode}
23953 @kindex set tui active-border-mode
23954 Select the display attributes for the borders of the inactive windows
23955 or the active window. The @var{mode} can be one of the following:
23956 @table @code
23957 @item normal
23958 Use normal attributes to display the border.
23959
23960 @item standout
23961 Use standout mode.
23962
23963 @item reverse
23964 Use reverse video mode.
23965
23966 @item half
23967 Use half bright mode.
23968
23969 @item half-standout
23970 Use half bright and standout mode.
23971
23972 @item bold
23973 Use extra bright or bold mode.
23974
23975 @item bold-standout
23976 Use extra bright or bold and standout mode.
23977 @end table
23978 @end table
23979
23980 @node Emacs
23981 @chapter Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs
23982
23983 @cindex Emacs
23984 @cindex @sc{gnu} Emacs
23985 A special interface allows you to use @sc{gnu} Emacs to view (and
23986 edit) the source files for the program you are debugging with
23987 @value{GDBN}.
23988
23989 To use this interface, use the command @kbd{M-x gdb} in Emacs. Give the
23990 executable file you want to debug as an argument. This command starts
23991 @value{GDBN} as a subprocess of Emacs, with input and output through a newly
23992 created Emacs buffer.
23993 @c (Do not use the @code{-tui} option to run @value{GDBN} from Emacs.)
23994
23995 Running @value{GDBN} under Emacs can be just like running @value{GDBN} normally except for two
23996 things:
23997
23998 @itemize @bullet
23999 @item
24000 All ``terminal'' input and output goes through an Emacs buffer, called
24001 the GUD buffer.
24002
24003 This applies both to @value{GDBN} commands and their output, and to the input
24004 and output done by the program you are debugging.
24005
24006 This is useful because it means that you can copy the text of previous
24007 commands and input them again; you can even use parts of the output
24008 in this way.
24009
24010 All the facilities of Emacs' Shell mode are available for interacting
24011 with your program. In particular, you can send signals the usual
24012 way---for example, @kbd{C-c C-c} for an interrupt, @kbd{C-c C-z} for a
24013 stop.
24014
24015 @item
24016 @value{GDBN} displays source code through Emacs.
24017
24018 Each time @value{GDBN} displays a stack frame, Emacs automatically finds the
24019 source file for that frame and puts an arrow (@samp{=>}) at the
24020 left margin of the current line. Emacs uses a separate buffer for
24021 source display, and splits the screen to show both your @value{GDBN} session
24022 and the source.
24023
24024 Explicit @value{GDBN} @code{list} or search commands still produce output as
24025 usual, but you probably have no reason to use them from Emacs.
24026 @end itemize
24027
24028 We call this @dfn{text command mode}. Emacs 22.1, and later, also uses
24029 a graphical mode, enabled by default, which provides further buffers
24030 that can control the execution and describe the state of your program.
24031 @xref{GDB Graphical Interface,,, Emacs, The @sc{gnu} Emacs Manual}.
24032
24033 If you specify an absolute file name when prompted for the @kbd{M-x
24034 gdb} argument, then Emacs sets your current working directory to where
24035 your program resides. If you only specify the file name, then Emacs
24036 sets your current working directory to to the directory associated
24037 with the previous buffer. In this case, @value{GDBN} may find your
24038 program by searching your environment's @code{PATH} variable, but on
24039 some operating systems it might not find the source. So, although the
24040 @value{GDBN} input and output session proceeds normally, the auxiliary
24041 buffer does not display the current source and line of execution.
24042
24043 The initial working directory of @value{GDBN} is printed on the top
24044 line of the GUD buffer and this serves as a default for the commands
24045 that specify files for @value{GDBN} to operate on. @xref{Files,
24046 ,Commands to Specify Files}.
24047
24048 By default, @kbd{M-x gdb} calls the program called @file{gdb}. If you
24049 need to call @value{GDBN} by a different name (for example, if you
24050 keep several configurations around, with different names) you can
24051 customize the Emacs variable @code{gud-gdb-command-name} to run the
24052 one you want.
24053
24054 In the GUD buffer, you can use these special Emacs commands in
24055 addition to the standard Shell mode commands:
24056
24057 @table @kbd
24058 @item C-h m
24059 Describe the features of Emacs' GUD Mode.
24060
24061 @item C-c C-s
24062 Execute to another source line, like the @value{GDBN} @code{step} command; also
24063 update the display window to show the current file and location.
24064
24065 @item C-c C-n
24066 Execute to next source line in this function, skipping all function
24067 calls, like the @value{GDBN} @code{next} command. Then update the display window
24068 to show the current file and location.
24069
24070 @item C-c C-i
24071 Execute one instruction, like the @value{GDBN} @code{stepi} command; update
24072 display window accordingly.
24073
24074 @item C-c C-f
24075 Execute until exit from the selected stack frame, like the @value{GDBN}
24076 @code{finish} command.
24077
24078 @item C-c C-r
24079 Continue execution of your program, like the @value{GDBN} @code{continue}
24080 command.
24081
24082 @item C-c <
24083 Go up the number of frames indicated by the numeric argument
24084 (@pxref{Arguments, , Numeric Arguments, Emacs, The @sc{gnu} Emacs Manual}),
24085 like the @value{GDBN} @code{up} command.
24086
24087 @item C-c >
24088 Go down the number of frames indicated by the numeric argument, like the
24089 @value{GDBN} @code{down} command.
24090 @end table
24091
24092 In any source file, the Emacs command @kbd{C-x @key{SPC}} (@code{gud-break})
24093 tells @value{GDBN} to set a breakpoint on the source line point is on.
24094
24095 In text command mode, if you type @kbd{M-x speedbar}, Emacs displays a
24096 separate frame which shows a backtrace when the GUD buffer is current.
24097 Move point to any frame in the stack and type @key{RET} to make it
24098 become the current frame and display the associated source in the
24099 source buffer. Alternatively, click @kbd{Mouse-2} to make the
24100 selected frame become the current one. In graphical mode, the
24101 speedbar displays watch expressions.
24102
24103 If you accidentally delete the source-display buffer, an easy way to get
24104 it back is to type the command @code{f} in the @value{GDBN} buffer, to
24105 request a frame display; when you run under Emacs, this recreates
24106 the source buffer if necessary to show you the context of the current
24107 frame.
24108
24109 The source files displayed in Emacs are in ordinary Emacs buffers
24110 which are visiting the source files in the usual way. You can edit
24111 the files with these buffers if you wish; but keep in mind that @value{GDBN}
24112 communicates with Emacs in terms of line numbers. If you add or
24113 delete lines from the text, the line numbers that @value{GDBN} knows cease
24114 to correspond properly with the code.
24115
24116 A more detailed description of Emacs' interaction with @value{GDBN} is
24117 given in the Emacs manual (@pxref{Debuggers,,, Emacs, The @sc{gnu}
24118 Emacs Manual}).
24119
24120 @c The following dropped because Epoch is nonstandard. Reactivate
24121 @c if/when v19 does something similar. ---doc@cygnus.com 19dec1990
24122 @ignore
24123 @kindex Emacs Epoch environment
24124 @kindex Epoch
24125 @kindex inspect
24126
24127 Version 18 of @sc{gnu} Emacs has a built-in window system
24128 called the @code{epoch}
24129 environment. Users of this environment can use a new command,
24130 @code{inspect} which performs identically to @code{print} except that
24131 each value is printed in its own window.
24132 @end ignore
24133
24134
24135 @node GDB/MI
24136 @chapter The @sc{gdb/mi} Interface
24137
24138 @unnumberedsec Function and Purpose
24139
24140 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, its purpose
24141 @sc{gdb/mi} is a line based machine oriented text interface to
24142 @value{GDBN} and is activated by specifying using the
24143 @option{--interpreter} command line option (@pxref{Mode Options}). It
24144 is specifically intended to support the development of systems which
24145 use the debugger as just one small component of a larger system.
24146
24147 This chapter is a specification of the @sc{gdb/mi} interface. It is written
24148 in the form of a reference manual.
24149
24150 Note that @sc{gdb/mi} is still under construction, so some of the
24151 features described below are incomplete and subject to change
24152 (@pxref{GDB/MI Development and Front Ends, , @sc{gdb/mi} Development and Front Ends}).
24153
24154 @unnumberedsec Notation and Terminology
24155
24156 @cindex notational conventions, for @sc{gdb/mi}
24157 This chapter uses the following notation:
24158
24159 @itemize @bullet
24160 @item
24161 @code{|} separates two alternatives.
24162
24163 @item
24164 @code{[ @var{something} ]} indicates that @var{something} is optional:
24165 it may or may not be given.
24166
24167 @item
24168 @code{( @var{group} )*} means that @var{group} inside the parentheses
24169 may repeat zero or more times.
24170
24171 @item
24172 @code{( @var{group} )+} means that @var{group} inside the parentheses
24173 may repeat one or more times.
24174
24175 @item
24176 @code{"@var{string}"} means a literal @var{string}.
24177 @end itemize
24178
24179 @ignore
24180 @heading Dependencies
24181 @end ignore
24182
24183 @menu
24184 * GDB/MI General Design::
24185 * GDB/MI Command Syntax::
24186 * GDB/MI Compatibility with CLI::
24187 * GDB/MI Development and Front Ends::
24188 * GDB/MI Output Records::
24189 * GDB/MI Simple Examples::
24190 * GDB/MI Command Description Format::
24191 * GDB/MI Breakpoint Commands::
24192 * GDB/MI Program Context::
24193 * GDB/MI Thread Commands::
24194 * GDB/MI Program Execution::
24195 * GDB/MI Stack Manipulation::
24196 * GDB/MI Variable Objects::
24197 * GDB/MI Data Manipulation::
24198 * GDB/MI Tracepoint Commands::
24199 * GDB/MI Symbol Query::
24200 * GDB/MI File Commands::
24201 @ignore
24202 * GDB/MI Kod Commands::
24203 * GDB/MI Memory Overlay Commands::
24204 * GDB/MI Signal Handling Commands::
24205 @end ignore
24206 * GDB/MI Target Manipulation::
24207 * GDB/MI File Transfer Commands::
24208 * GDB/MI Miscellaneous Commands::
24209 @end menu
24210
24211 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
24212 @node GDB/MI General Design
24213 @section @sc{gdb/mi} General Design
24214 @cindex GDB/MI General Design
24215
24216 Interaction of a @sc{GDB/MI} frontend with @value{GDBN} involves three
24217 parts---commands sent to @value{GDBN}, responses to those commands
24218 and notifications. Each command results in exactly one response,
24219 indicating either successful completion of the command, or an error.
24220 For the commands that do not resume the target, the response contains the
24221 requested information. For the commands that resume the target, the
24222 response only indicates whether the target was successfully resumed.
24223 Notifications is the mechanism for reporting changes in the state of the
24224 target, or in @value{GDBN} state, that cannot conveniently be associated with
24225 a command and reported as part of that command response.
24226
24227 The important examples of notifications are:
24228 @itemize @bullet
24229
24230 @item
24231 Exec notifications. These are used to report changes in
24232 target state---when a target is resumed, or stopped. It would not
24233 be feasible to include this information in response of resuming
24234 commands, because one resume commands can result in multiple events in
24235 different threads. Also, quite some time may pass before any event
24236 happens in the target, while a frontend needs to know whether the resuming
24237 command itself was successfully executed.
24238
24239 @item
24240 Console output, and status notifications. Console output
24241 notifications are used to report output of CLI commands, as well as
24242 diagnostics for other commands. Status notifications are used to
24243 report the progress of a long-running operation. Naturally, including
24244 this information in command response would mean no output is produced
24245 until the command is finished, which is undesirable.
24246
24247 @item
24248 General notifications. Commands may have various side effects on
24249 the @value{GDBN} or target state beyond their official purpose. For example,
24250 a command may change the selected thread. Although such changes can
24251 be included in command response, using notification allows for more
24252 orthogonal frontend design.
24253
24254 @end itemize
24255
24256 There's no guarantee that whenever an MI command reports an error,
24257 @value{GDBN} or the target are in any specific state, and especially,
24258 the state is not reverted to the state before the MI command was
24259 processed. Therefore, whenever an MI command results in an error,
24260 we recommend that the frontend refreshes all the information shown in
24261 the user interface.
24262
24263
24264 @menu
24265 * Context management::
24266 * Asynchronous and non-stop modes::
24267 * Thread groups::
24268 @end menu
24269
24270 @node Context management
24271 @subsection Context management
24272
24273 In most cases when @value{GDBN} accesses the target, this access is
24274 done in context of a specific thread and frame (@pxref{Frames}).
24275 Often, even when accessing global data, the target requires that a thread
24276 be specified. The CLI interface maintains the selected thread and frame,
24277 and supplies them to target on each command. This is convenient,
24278 because a command line user would not want to specify that information
24279 explicitly on each command, and because user interacts with
24280 @value{GDBN} via a single terminal, so no confusion is possible as
24281 to what thread and frame are the current ones.
24282
24283 In the case of MI, the concept of selected thread and frame is less
24284 useful. First, a frontend can easily remember this information
24285 itself. Second, a graphical frontend can have more than one window,
24286 each one used for debugging a different thread, and the frontend might
24287 want to access additional threads for internal purposes. This
24288 increases the risk that by relying on implicitly selected thread, the
24289 frontend may be operating on a wrong one. Therefore, each MI command
24290 should explicitly specify which thread and frame to operate on. To
24291 make it possible, each MI command accepts the @samp{--thread} and
24292 @samp{--frame} options, the value to each is @value{GDBN} identifier
24293 for thread and frame to operate on.
24294
24295 Usually, each top-level window in a frontend allows the user to select
24296 a thread and a frame, and remembers the user selection for further
24297 operations. However, in some cases @value{GDBN} may suggest that the
24298 current thread be changed. For example, when stopping on a breakpoint
24299 it is reasonable to switch to the thread where breakpoint is hit. For
24300 another example, if the user issues the CLI @samp{thread} command via
24301 the frontend, it is desirable to change the frontend's selected thread to the
24302 one specified by user. @value{GDBN} communicates the suggestion to
24303 change current thread using the @samp{=thread-selected} notification.
24304 No such notification is available for the selected frame at the moment.
24305
24306 Note that historically, MI shares the selected thread with CLI, so
24307 frontends used the @code{-thread-select} to execute commands in the
24308 right context. However, getting this to work right is cumbersome. The
24309 simplest way is for frontend to emit @code{-thread-select} command
24310 before every command. This doubles the number of commands that need
24311 to be sent. The alternative approach is to suppress @code{-thread-select}
24312 if the selected thread in @value{GDBN} is supposed to be identical to the
24313 thread the frontend wants to operate on. However, getting this
24314 optimization right can be tricky. In particular, if the frontend
24315 sends several commands to @value{GDBN}, and one of the commands changes the
24316 selected thread, then the behaviour of subsequent commands will
24317 change. So, a frontend should either wait for response from such
24318 problematic commands, or explicitly add @code{-thread-select} for
24319 all subsequent commands. No frontend is known to do this exactly
24320 right, so it is suggested to just always pass the @samp{--thread} and
24321 @samp{--frame} options.
24322
24323 @node Asynchronous and non-stop modes
24324 @subsection Asynchronous command execution and non-stop mode
24325
24326 On some targets, @value{GDBN} is capable of processing MI commands
24327 even while the target is running. This is called @dfn{asynchronous
24328 command execution} (@pxref{Background Execution}). The frontend may
24329 specify a preferrence for asynchronous execution using the
24330 @code{-gdb-set target-async 1} command, which should be emitted before
24331 either running the executable or attaching to the target. After the
24332 frontend has started the executable or attached to the target, it can
24333 find if asynchronous execution is enabled using the
24334 @code{-list-target-features} command.
24335
24336 Even if @value{GDBN} can accept a command while target is running,
24337 many commands that access the target do not work when the target is
24338 running. Therefore, asynchronous command execution is most useful
24339 when combined with non-stop mode (@pxref{Non-Stop Mode}). Then,
24340 it is possible to examine the state of one thread, while other threads
24341 are running.
24342
24343 When a given thread is running, MI commands that try to access the
24344 target in the context of that thread may not work, or may work only on
24345 some targets. In particular, commands that try to operate on thread's
24346 stack will not work, on any target. Commands that read memory, or
24347 modify breakpoints, may work or not work, depending on the target. Note
24348 that even commands that operate on global state, such as @code{print},
24349 @code{set}, and breakpoint commands, still access the target in the
24350 context of a specific thread, so frontend should try to find a
24351 stopped thread and perform the operation on that thread (using the
24352 @samp{--thread} option).
24353
24354 Which commands will work in the context of a running thread is
24355 highly target dependent. However, the two commands
24356 @code{-exec-interrupt}, to stop a thread, and @code{-thread-info},
24357 to find the state of a thread, will always work.
24358
24359 @node Thread groups
24360 @subsection Thread groups
24361 @value{GDBN} may be used to debug several processes at the same time.
24362 On some platfroms, @value{GDBN} may support debugging of several
24363 hardware systems, each one having several cores with several different
24364 processes running on each core. This section describes the MI
24365 mechanism to support such debugging scenarios.
24366
24367 The key observation is that regardless of the structure of the
24368 target, MI can have a global list of threads, because most commands that
24369 accept the @samp{--thread} option do not need to know what process that
24370 thread belongs to. Therefore, it is not necessary to introduce
24371 neither additional @samp{--process} option, nor an notion of the
24372 current process in the MI interface. The only strictly new feature
24373 that is required is the ability to find how the threads are grouped
24374 into processes.
24375
24376 To allow the user to discover such grouping, and to support arbitrary
24377 hierarchy of machines/cores/processes, MI introduces the concept of a
24378 @dfn{thread group}. Thread group is a collection of threads and other
24379 thread groups. A thread group always has a string identifier, a type,
24380 and may have additional attributes specific to the type. A new
24381 command, @code{-list-thread-groups}, returns the list of top-level
24382 thread groups, which correspond to processes that @value{GDBN} is
24383 debugging at the moment. By passing an identifier of a thread group
24384 to the @code{-list-thread-groups} command, it is possible to obtain
24385 the members of specific thread group.
24386
24387 To allow the user to easily discover processes, and other objects, he
24388 wishes to debug, a concept of @dfn{available thread group} is
24389 introduced. Available thread group is an thread group that
24390 @value{GDBN} is not debugging, but that can be attached to, using the
24391 @code{-target-attach} command. The list of available top-level thread
24392 groups can be obtained using @samp{-list-thread-groups --available}.
24393 In general, the content of a thread group may be only retrieved only
24394 after attaching to that thread group.
24395
24396 Thread groups are related to inferiors (@pxref{Inferiors and
24397 Programs}). Each inferior corresponds to a thread group of a special
24398 type @samp{process}, and some additional operations are permitted on
24399 such thread groups.
24400
24401 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
24402 @node GDB/MI Command Syntax
24403 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Command Syntax
24404
24405 @menu
24406 * GDB/MI Input Syntax::
24407 * GDB/MI Output Syntax::
24408 @end menu
24409
24410 @node GDB/MI Input Syntax
24411 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Input Syntax
24412
24413 @cindex input syntax for @sc{gdb/mi}
24414 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, input syntax
24415 @table @code
24416 @item @var{command} @expansion{}
24417 @code{@var{cli-command} | @var{mi-command}}
24418
24419 @item @var{cli-command} @expansion{}
24420 @code{[ @var{token} ] @var{cli-command} @var{nl}}, where
24421 @var{cli-command} is any existing @value{GDBN} CLI command.
24422
24423 @item @var{mi-command} @expansion{}
24424 @code{[ @var{token} ] "-" @var{operation} ( " " @var{option} )*
24425 @code{[} " --" @code{]} ( " " @var{parameter} )* @var{nl}}
24426
24427 @item @var{token} @expansion{}
24428 "any sequence of digits"
24429
24430 @item @var{option} @expansion{}
24431 @code{"-" @var{parameter} [ " " @var{parameter} ]}
24432
24433 @item @var{parameter} @expansion{}
24434 @code{@var{non-blank-sequence} | @var{c-string}}
24435
24436 @item @var{operation} @expansion{}
24437 @emph{any of the operations described in this chapter}
24438
24439 @item @var{non-blank-sequence} @expansion{}
24440 @emph{anything, provided it doesn't contain special characters such as
24441 "-", @var{nl}, """ and of course " "}
24442
24443 @item @var{c-string} @expansion{}
24444 @code{""" @var{seven-bit-iso-c-string-content} """}
24445
24446 @item @var{nl} @expansion{}
24447 @code{CR | CR-LF}
24448 @end table
24449
24450 @noindent
24451 Notes:
24452
24453 @itemize @bullet
24454 @item
24455 The CLI commands are still handled by the @sc{mi} interpreter; their
24456 output is described below.
24457
24458 @item
24459 The @code{@var{token}}, when present, is passed back when the command
24460 finishes.
24461
24462 @item
24463 Some @sc{mi} commands accept optional arguments as part of the parameter
24464 list. Each option is identified by a leading @samp{-} (dash) and may be
24465 followed by an optional argument parameter. Options occur first in the
24466 parameter list and can be delimited from normal parameters using
24467 @samp{--} (this is useful when some parameters begin with a dash).
24468 @end itemize
24469
24470 Pragmatics:
24471
24472 @itemize @bullet
24473 @item
24474 We want easy access to the existing CLI syntax (for debugging).
24475
24476 @item
24477 We want it to be easy to spot a @sc{mi} operation.
24478 @end itemize
24479
24480 @node GDB/MI Output Syntax
24481 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Output Syntax
24482
24483 @cindex output syntax of @sc{gdb/mi}
24484 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, output syntax
24485 The output from @sc{gdb/mi} consists of zero or more out-of-band records
24486 followed, optionally, by a single result record. This result record
24487 is for the most recent command. The sequence of output records is
24488 terminated by @samp{(gdb)}.
24489
24490 If an input command was prefixed with a @code{@var{token}} then the
24491 corresponding output for that command will also be prefixed by that same
24492 @var{token}.
24493
24494 @table @code
24495 @item @var{output} @expansion{}
24496 @code{( @var{out-of-band-record} )* [ @var{result-record} ] "(gdb)" @var{nl}}
24497
24498 @item @var{result-record} @expansion{}
24499 @code{ [ @var{token} ] "^" @var{result-class} ( "," @var{result} )* @var{nl}}
24500
24501 @item @var{out-of-band-record} @expansion{}
24502 @code{@var{async-record} | @var{stream-record}}
24503
24504 @item @var{async-record} @expansion{}
24505 @code{@var{exec-async-output} | @var{status-async-output} | @var{notify-async-output}}
24506
24507 @item @var{exec-async-output} @expansion{}
24508 @code{[ @var{token} ] "*" @var{async-output}}
24509
24510 @item @var{status-async-output} @expansion{}
24511 @code{[ @var{token} ] "+" @var{async-output}}
24512
24513 @item @var{notify-async-output} @expansion{}
24514 @code{[ @var{token} ] "=" @var{async-output}}
24515
24516 @item @var{async-output} @expansion{}
24517 @code{@var{async-class} ( "," @var{result} )* @var{nl}}
24518
24519 @item @var{result-class} @expansion{}
24520 @code{"done" | "running" | "connected" | "error" | "exit"}
24521
24522 @item @var{async-class} @expansion{}
24523 @code{"stopped" | @var{others}} (where @var{others} will be added
24524 depending on the needs---this is still in development).
24525
24526 @item @var{result} @expansion{}
24527 @code{ @var{variable} "=" @var{value}}
24528
24529 @item @var{variable} @expansion{}
24530 @code{ @var{string} }
24531
24532 @item @var{value} @expansion{}
24533 @code{ @var{const} | @var{tuple} | @var{list} }
24534
24535 @item @var{const} @expansion{}
24536 @code{@var{c-string}}
24537
24538 @item @var{tuple} @expansion{}
24539 @code{ "@{@}" | "@{" @var{result} ( "," @var{result} )* "@}" }
24540
24541 @item @var{list} @expansion{}
24542 @code{ "[]" | "[" @var{value} ( "," @var{value} )* "]" | "["
24543 @var{result} ( "," @var{result} )* "]" }
24544
24545 @item @var{stream-record} @expansion{}
24546 @code{@var{console-stream-output} | @var{target-stream-output} | @var{log-stream-output}}
24547
24548 @item @var{console-stream-output} @expansion{}
24549 @code{"~" @var{c-string}}
24550
24551 @item @var{target-stream-output} @expansion{}
24552 @code{"@@" @var{c-string}}
24553
24554 @item @var{log-stream-output} @expansion{}
24555 @code{"&" @var{c-string}}
24556
24557 @item @var{nl} @expansion{}
24558 @code{CR | CR-LF}
24559
24560 @item @var{token} @expansion{}
24561 @emph{any sequence of digits}.
24562 @end table
24563
24564 @noindent
24565 Notes:
24566
24567 @itemize @bullet
24568 @item
24569 All output sequences end in a single line containing a period.
24570
24571 @item
24572 The @code{@var{token}} is from the corresponding request. Note that
24573 for all async output, while the token is allowed by the grammar and
24574 may be output by future versions of @value{GDBN} for select async
24575 output messages, it is generally omitted. Frontends should treat
24576 all async output as reporting general changes in the state of the
24577 target and there should be no need to associate async output to any
24578 prior command.
24579
24580 @item
24581 @cindex status output in @sc{gdb/mi}
24582 @var{status-async-output} contains on-going status information about the
24583 progress of a slow operation. It can be discarded. All status output is
24584 prefixed by @samp{+}.
24585
24586 @item
24587 @cindex async output in @sc{gdb/mi}
24588 @var{exec-async-output} contains asynchronous state change on the target
24589 (stopped, started, disappeared). All async output is prefixed by
24590 @samp{*}.
24591
24592 @item
24593 @cindex notify output in @sc{gdb/mi}
24594 @var{notify-async-output} contains supplementary information that the
24595 client should handle (e.g., a new breakpoint information). All notify
24596 output is prefixed by @samp{=}.
24597
24598 @item
24599 @cindex console output in @sc{gdb/mi}
24600 @var{console-stream-output} is output that should be displayed as is in the
24601 console. It is the textual response to a CLI command. All the console
24602 output is prefixed by @samp{~}.
24603
24604 @item
24605 @cindex target output in @sc{gdb/mi}
24606 @var{target-stream-output} is the output produced by the target program.
24607 All the target output is prefixed by @samp{@@}.
24608
24609 @item
24610 @cindex log output in @sc{gdb/mi}
24611 @var{log-stream-output} is output text coming from @value{GDBN}'s internals, for
24612 instance messages that should be displayed as part of an error log. All
24613 the log output is prefixed by @samp{&}.
24614
24615 @item
24616 @cindex list output in @sc{gdb/mi}
24617 New @sc{gdb/mi} commands should only output @var{lists} containing
24618 @var{values}.
24619
24620
24621 @end itemize
24622
24623 @xref{GDB/MI Stream Records, , @sc{gdb/mi} Stream Records}, for more
24624 details about the various output records.
24625
24626 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
24627 @node GDB/MI Compatibility with CLI
24628 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Compatibility with CLI
24629
24630 @cindex compatibility, @sc{gdb/mi} and CLI
24631 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, compatibility with CLI
24632
24633 For the developers convenience CLI commands can be entered directly,
24634 but there may be some unexpected behaviour. For example, commands
24635 that query the user will behave as if the user replied yes, breakpoint
24636 command lists are not executed and some CLI commands, such as
24637 @code{if}, @code{when} and @code{define}, prompt for further input with
24638 @samp{>}, which is not valid MI output.
24639
24640 This feature may be removed at some stage in the future and it is
24641 recommended that front ends use the @code{-interpreter-exec} command
24642 (@pxref{-interpreter-exec}).
24643
24644 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
24645 @node GDB/MI Development and Front Ends
24646 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Development and Front Ends
24647 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi} development
24648
24649 The application which takes the MI output and presents the state of the
24650 program being debugged to the user is called a @dfn{front end}.
24651
24652 Although @sc{gdb/mi} is still incomplete, it is currently being used
24653 by a variety of front ends to @value{GDBN}. This makes it difficult
24654 to introduce new functionality without breaking existing usage. This
24655 section tries to minimize the problems by describing how the protocol
24656 might change.
24657
24658 Some changes in MI need not break a carefully designed front end, and
24659 for these the MI version will remain unchanged. The following is a
24660 list of changes that may occur within one level, so front ends should
24661 parse MI output in a way that can handle them:
24662
24663 @itemize @bullet
24664 @item
24665 New MI commands may be added.
24666
24667 @item
24668 New fields may be added to the output of any MI command.
24669
24670 @item
24671 The range of values for fields with specified values, e.g.,
24672 @code{in_scope} (@pxref{-var-update}) may be extended.
24673
24674 @c The format of field's content e.g type prefix, may change so parse it
24675 @c at your own risk. Yes, in general?
24676
24677 @c The order of fields may change? Shouldn't really matter but it might
24678 @c resolve inconsistencies.
24679 @end itemize
24680
24681 If the changes are likely to break front ends, the MI version level
24682 will be increased by one. This will allow the front end to parse the
24683 output according to the MI version. Apart from mi0, new versions of
24684 @value{GDBN} will not support old versions of MI and it will be the
24685 responsibility of the front end to work with the new one.
24686
24687 @c Starting with mi3, add a new command -mi-version that prints the MI
24688 @c version?
24689
24690 The best way to avoid unexpected changes in MI that might break your front
24691 end is to make your project known to @value{GDBN} developers and
24692 follow development on @email{gdb@@sourceware.org} and
24693 @email{gdb-patches@@sourceware.org}.
24694 @cindex mailing lists
24695
24696 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
24697 @node GDB/MI Output Records
24698 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Output Records
24699
24700 @menu
24701 * GDB/MI Result Records::
24702 * GDB/MI Stream Records::
24703 * GDB/MI Async Records::
24704 * GDB/MI Frame Information::
24705 * GDB/MI Thread Information::
24706 @end menu
24707
24708 @node GDB/MI Result Records
24709 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Result Records
24710
24711 @cindex result records in @sc{gdb/mi}
24712 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, result records
24713 In addition to a number of out-of-band notifications, the response to a
24714 @sc{gdb/mi} command includes one of the following result indications:
24715
24716 @table @code
24717 @findex ^done
24718 @item "^done" [ "," @var{results} ]
24719 The synchronous operation was successful, @code{@var{results}} are the return
24720 values.
24721
24722 @item "^running"
24723 @findex ^running
24724 This result record is equivalent to @samp{^done}. Historically, it
24725 was output instead of @samp{^done} if the command has resumed the
24726 target. This behaviour is maintained for backward compatibility, but
24727 all frontends should treat @samp{^done} and @samp{^running}
24728 identically and rely on the @samp{*running} output record to determine
24729 which threads are resumed.
24730
24731 @item "^connected"
24732 @findex ^connected
24733 @value{GDBN} has connected to a remote target.
24734
24735 @item "^error" "," @var{c-string}
24736 @findex ^error
24737 The operation failed. The @code{@var{c-string}} contains the corresponding
24738 error message.
24739
24740 @item "^exit"
24741 @findex ^exit
24742 @value{GDBN} has terminated.
24743
24744 @end table
24745
24746 @node GDB/MI Stream Records
24747 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Stream Records
24748
24749 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, stream records
24750 @cindex stream records in @sc{gdb/mi}
24751 @value{GDBN} internally maintains a number of output streams: the console, the
24752 target, and the log. The output intended for each of these streams is
24753 funneled through the @sc{gdb/mi} interface using @dfn{stream records}.
24754
24755 Each stream record begins with a unique @dfn{prefix character} which
24756 identifies its stream (@pxref{GDB/MI Output Syntax, , @sc{gdb/mi} Output
24757 Syntax}). In addition to the prefix, each stream record contains a
24758 @code{@var{string-output}}. This is either raw text (with an implicit new
24759 line) or a quoted C string (which does not contain an implicit newline).
24760
24761 @table @code
24762 @item "~" @var{string-output}
24763 The console output stream contains text that should be displayed in the
24764 CLI console window. It contains the textual responses to CLI commands.
24765
24766 @item "@@" @var{string-output}
24767 The target output stream contains any textual output from the running
24768 target. This is only present when GDB's event loop is truly
24769 asynchronous, which is currently only the case for remote targets.
24770
24771 @item "&" @var{string-output}
24772 The log stream contains debugging messages being produced by @value{GDBN}'s
24773 internals.
24774 @end table
24775
24776 @node GDB/MI Async Records
24777 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Async Records
24778
24779 @cindex async records in @sc{gdb/mi}
24780 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, async records
24781 @dfn{Async} records are used to notify the @sc{gdb/mi} client of
24782 additional changes that have occurred. Those changes can either be a
24783 consequence of @sc{gdb/mi} commands (e.g., a breakpoint modified) or a result of
24784 target activity (e.g., target stopped).
24785
24786 The following is the list of possible async records:
24787
24788 @table @code
24789
24790 @item *running,thread-id="@var{thread}"
24791 The target is now running. The @var{thread} field tells which
24792 specific thread is now running, and can be @samp{all} if all threads
24793 are running. The frontend should assume that no interaction with a
24794 running thread is possible after this notification is produced.
24795 The frontend should not assume that this notification is output
24796 only once for any command. @value{GDBN} may emit this notification
24797 several times, either for different threads, because it cannot resume
24798 all threads together, or even for a single thread, if the thread must
24799 be stepped though some code before letting it run freely.
24800
24801 @item *stopped,reason="@var{reason}",thread-id="@var{id}",stopped-threads="@var{stopped}",core="@var{core}"
24802 The target has stopped. The @var{reason} field can have one of the
24803 following values:
24804
24805 @table @code
24806 @item breakpoint-hit
24807 A breakpoint was reached.
24808 @item watchpoint-trigger
24809 A watchpoint was triggered.
24810 @item read-watchpoint-trigger
24811 A read watchpoint was triggered.
24812 @item access-watchpoint-trigger
24813 An access watchpoint was triggered.
24814 @item function-finished
24815 An -exec-finish or similar CLI command was accomplished.
24816 @item location-reached
24817 An -exec-until or similar CLI command was accomplished.
24818 @item watchpoint-scope
24819 A watchpoint has gone out of scope.
24820 @item end-stepping-range
24821 An -exec-next, -exec-next-instruction, -exec-step, -exec-step-instruction or
24822 similar CLI command was accomplished.
24823 @item exited-signalled
24824 The inferior exited because of a signal.
24825 @item exited
24826 The inferior exited.
24827 @item exited-normally
24828 The inferior exited normally.
24829 @item signal-received
24830 A signal was received by the inferior.
24831 @end table
24832
24833 The @var{id} field identifies the thread that directly caused the stop
24834 -- for example by hitting a breakpoint. Depending on whether all-stop
24835 mode is in effect (@pxref{All-Stop Mode}), @value{GDBN} may either
24836 stop all threads, or only the thread that directly triggered the stop.
24837 If all threads are stopped, the @var{stopped} field will have the
24838 value of @code{"all"}. Otherwise, the value of the @var{stopped}
24839 field will be a list of thread identifiers. Presently, this list will
24840 always include a single thread, but frontend should be prepared to see
24841 several threads in the list. The @var{core} field reports the
24842 processor core on which the stop event has happened. This field may be absent
24843 if such information is not available.
24844
24845 @item =thread-group-added,id="@var{id}"
24846 @itemx =thread-group-removed,id="@var{id}"
24847 A thread group was either added or removed. The @var{id} field
24848 contains the @value{GDBN} identifier of the thread group. When a thread
24849 group is added, it generally might not be associated with a running
24850 process. When a thread group is removed, its id becomes invalid and
24851 cannot be used in any way.
24852
24853 @item =thread-group-started,id="@var{id}",pid="@var{pid}"
24854 A thread group became associated with a running program,
24855 either because the program was just started or the thread group
24856 was attached to a program. The @var{id} field contains the
24857 @value{GDBN} identifier of the thread group. The @var{pid} field
24858 contains process identifier, specific to the operating system.
24859
24860 @itemx =thread-group-exited,id="@var{id}"
24861 A thread group is no longer associated with a running program,
24862 either because the program has exited, or because it was detached
24863 from. The @var{id} field contains the @value{GDBN} identifier of the
24864 thread group.
24865
24866 @item =thread-created,id="@var{id}",group-id="@var{gid}"
24867 @itemx =thread-exited,id="@var{id}",group-id="@var{gid}"
24868 A thread either was created, or has exited. The @var{id} field
24869 contains the @value{GDBN} identifier of the thread. The @var{gid}
24870 field identifies the thread group this thread belongs to.
24871
24872 @item =thread-selected,id="@var{id}"
24873 Informs that the selected thread was changed as result of the last
24874 command. This notification is not emitted as result of @code{-thread-select}
24875 command but is emitted whenever an MI command that is not documented
24876 to change the selected thread actually changes it. In particular,
24877 invoking, directly or indirectly (via user-defined command), the CLI
24878 @code{thread} command, will generate this notification.
24879
24880 We suggest that in response to this notification, front ends
24881 highlight the selected thread and cause subsequent commands to apply to
24882 that thread.
24883
24884 @item =library-loaded,...
24885 Reports that a new library file was loaded by the program. This
24886 notification has 4 fields---@var{id}, @var{target-name},
24887 @var{host-name}, and @var{symbols-loaded}. The @var{id} field is an
24888 opaque identifier of the library. For remote debugging case,
24889 @var{target-name} and @var{host-name} fields give the name of the
24890 library file on the target, and on the host respectively. For native
24891 debugging, both those fields have the same value. The
24892 @var{symbols-loaded} field is emitted only for backward compatibility
24893 and should not be relied on to convey any useful information. The
24894 @var{thread-group} field, if present, specifies the id of the thread
24895 group in whose context the library was loaded. If the field is
24896 absent, it means the library was loaded in the context of all present
24897 thread groups.
24898
24899 @item =library-unloaded,...
24900 Reports that a library was unloaded by the program. This notification
24901 has 3 fields---@var{id}, @var{target-name} and @var{host-name} with
24902 the same meaning as for the @code{=library-loaded} notification.
24903 The @var{thread-group} field, if present, specifies the id of the
24904 thread group in whose context the library was unloaded. If the field is
24905 absent, it means the library was unloaded in the context of all present
24906 thread groups.
24907
24908 @end table
24909
24910 @node GDB/MI Frame Information
24911 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Frame Information
24912
24913 Response from many MI commands includes an information about stack
24914 frame. This information is a tuple that may have the following
24915 fields:
24916
24917 @table @code
24918 @item level
24919 The level of the stack frame. The innermost frame has the level of
24920 zero. This field is always present.
24921
24922 @item func
24923 The name of the function corresponding to the frame. This field may
24924 be absent if @value{GDBN} is unable to determine the function name.
24925
24926 @item addr
24927 The code address for the frame. This field is always present.
24928
24929 @item file
24930 The name of the source files that correspond to the frame's code
24931 address. This field may be absent.
24932
24933 @item line
24934 The source line corresponding to the frames' code address. This field
24935 may be absent.
24936
24937 @item from
24938 The name of the binary file (either executable or shared library) the
24939 corresponds to the frame's code address. This field may be absent.
24940
24941 @end table
24942
24943 @node GDB/MI Thread Information
24944 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Thread Information
24945
24946 Whenever @value{GDBN} has to report an information about a thread, it
24947 uses a tuple with the following fields:
24948
24949 @table @code
24950 @item id
24951 The numeric id assigned to the thread by @value{GDBN}. This field is
24952 always present.
24953
24954 @item target-id
24955 Target-specific string identifying the thread. This field is always present.
24956
24957 @item details
24958 Additional information about the thread provided by the target.
24959 It is supposed to be human-readable and not interpreted by the
24960 frontend. This field is optional.
24961
24962 @item state
24963 Either @samp{stopped} or @samp{running}, depending on whether the
24964 thread is presently running. This field is always present.
24965
24966 @item core
24967 The value of this field is an integer number of the processor core the
24968 thread was last seen on. This field is optional.
24969 @end table
24970
24971
24972 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
24973 @node GDB/MI Simple Examples
24974 @section Simple Examples of @sc{gdb/mi} Interaction
24975 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, simple examples
24976
24977 This subsection presents several simple examples of interaction using
24978 the @sc{gdb/mi} interface. In these examples, @samp{->} means that the
24979 following line is passed to @sc{gdb/mi} as input, while @samp{<-} means
24980 the output received from @sc{gdb/mi}.
24981
24982 Note the line breaks shown in the examples are here only for
24983 readability, they don't appear in the real output.
24984
24985 @subheading Setting a Breakpoint
24986
24987 Setting a breakpoint generates synchronous output which contains detailed
24988 information of the breakpoint.
24989
24990 @smallexample
24991 -> -break-insert main
24992 <- ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
24993 enabled="y",addr="0x08048564",func="main",file="myprog.c",
24994 fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="68",times="0"@}
24995 <- (gdb)
24996 @end smallexample
24997
24998 @subheading Program Execution
24999
25000 Program execution generates asynchronous records and MI gives the
25001 reason that execution stopped.
25002
25003 @smallexample
25004 -> -exec-run
25005 <- ^running
25006 <- (gdb)
25007 <- *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",thread-id="0",
25008 frame=@{addr="0x08048564",func="main",
25009 args=[@{name="argc",value="1"@},@{name="argv",value="0xbfc4d4d4"@}],
25010 file="myprog.c",fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="68"@}
25011 <- (gdb)
25012 -> -exec-continue
25013 <- ^running
25014 <- (gdb)
25015 <- *stopped,reason="exited-normally"
25016 <- (gdb)
25017 @end smallexample
25018
25019 @subheading Quitting @value{GDBN}
25020
25021 Quitting @value{GDBN} just prints the result class @samp{^exit}.
25022
25023 @smallexample
25024 -> (gdb)
25025 <- -gdb-exit
25026 <- ^exit
25027 @end smallexample
25028
25029 Please note that @samp{^exit} is printed immediately, but it might
25030 take some time for @value{GDBN} to actually exit. During that time, @value{GDBN}
25031 performs necessary cleanups, including killing programs being debugged
25032 or disconnecting from debug hardware, so the frontend should wait till
25033 @value{GDBN} exits and should only forcibly kill @value{GDBN} if it
25034 fails to exit in reasonable time.
25035
25036 @subheading A Bad Command
25037
25038 Here's what happens if you pass a non-existent command:
25039
25040 @smallexample
25041 -> -rubbish
25042 <- ^error,msg="Undefined MI command: rubbish"
25043 <- (gdb)
25044 @end smallexample
25045
25046
25047 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
25048 @node GDB/MI Command Description Format
25049 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Command Description Format
25050
25051 The remaining sections describe blocks of commands. Each block of
25052 commands is laid out in a fashion similar to this section.
25053
25054 @subheading Motivation
25055
25056 The motivation for this collection of commands.
25057
25058 @subheading Introduction
25059
25060 A brief introduction to this collection of commands as a whole.
25061
25062 @subheading Commands
25063
25064 For each command in the block, the following is described:
25065
25066 @subsubheading Synopsis
25067
25068 @smallexample
25069 -command @var{args}@dots{}
25070 @end smallexample
25071
25072 @subsubheading Result
25073
25074 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
25075
25076 The corresponding @value{GDBN} CLI command(s), if any.
25077
25078 @subsubheading Example
25079
25080 Example(s) formatted for readability. Some of the described commands have
25081 not been implemented yet and these are labeled N.A.@: (not available).
25082
25083
25084 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
25085 @node GDB/MI Breakpoint Commands
25086 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Breakpoint Commands
25087
25088 @cindex breakpoint commands for @sc{gdb/mi}
25089 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, breakpoint commands
25090 This section documents @sc{gdb/mi} commands for manipulating
25091 breakpoints.
25092
25093 @subheading The @code{-break-after} Command
25094 @findex -break-after
25095
25096 @subsubheading Synopsis
25097
25098 @smallexample
25099 -break-after @var{number} @var{count}
25100 @end smallexample
25101
25102 The breakpoint number @var{number} is not in effect until it has been
25103 hit @var{count} times. To see how this is reflected in the output of
25104 the @samp{-break-list} command, see the description of the
25105 @samp{-break-list} command below.
25106
25107 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
25108
25109 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{ignore}.
25110
25111 @subsubheading Example
25112
25113 @smallexample
25114 (gdb)
25115 -break-insert main
25116 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
25117 enabled="y",addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",
25118 fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",line="5",times="0"@}
25119 (gdb)
25120 -break-after 1 3
25121 ~
25122 ^done
25123 (gdb)
25124 -break-list
25125 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
25126 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
25127 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
25128 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
25129 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
25130 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
25131 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
25132 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
25133 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
25134 line="5",times="0",ignore="3"@}]@}
25135 (gdb)
25136 @end smallexample
25137
25138 @ignore
25139 @subheading The @code{-break-catch} Command
25140 @findex -break-catch
25141 @end ignore
25142
25143 @subheading The @code{-break-commands} Command
25144 @findex -break-commands
25145
25146 @subsubheading Synopsis
25147
25148 @smallexample
25149 -break-commands @var{number} [ @var{command1} ... @var{commandN} ]
25150 @end smallexample
25151
25152 Specifies the CLI commands that should be executed when breakpoint
25153 @var{number} is hit. The parameters @var{command1} to @var{commandN}
25154 are the commands. If no command is specified, any previously-set
25155 commands are cleared. @xref{Break Commands}. Typical use of this
25156 functionality is tracing a program, that is, printing of values of
25157 some variables whenever breakpoint is hit and then continuing.
25158
25159 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
25160
25161 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{commands}.
25162
25163 @subsubheading Example
25164
25165 @smallexample
25166 (gdb)
25167 -break-insert main
25168 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
25169 enabled="y",addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",
25170 fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",line="5",times="0"@}
25171 (gdb)
25172 -break-commands 1 "print v" "continue"
25173 ^done
25174 (gdb)
25175 @end smallexample
25176
25177 @subheading The @code{-break-condition} Command
25178 @findex -break-condition
25179
25180 @subsubheading Synopsis
25181
25182 @smallexample
25183 -break-condition @var{number} @var{expr}
25184 @end smallexample
25185
25186 Breakpoint @var{number} will stop the program only if the condition in
25187 @var{expr} is true. The condition becomes part of the
25188 @samp{-break-list} output (see the description of the @samp{-break-list}
25189 command below).
25190
25191 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
25192
25193 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{condition}.
25194
25195 @subsubheading Example
25196
25197 @smallexample
25198 (gdb)
25199 -break-condition 1 1
25200 ^done
25201 (gdb)
25202 -break-list
25203 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
25204 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
25205 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
25206 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
25207 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
25208 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
25209 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
25210 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
25211 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
25212 line="5",cond="1",times="0",ignore="3"@}]@}
25213 (gdb)
25214 @end smallexample
25215
25216 @subheading The @code{-break-delete} Command
25217 @findex -break-delete
25218
25219 @subsubheading Synopsis
25220
25221 @smallexample
25222 -break-delete ( @var{breakpoint} )+
25223 @end smallexample
25224
25225 Delete the breakpoint(s) whose number(s) are specified in the argument
25226 list. This is obviously reflected in the breakpoint list.
25227
25228 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
25229
25230 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{delete}.
25231
25232 @subsubheading Example
25233
25234 @smallexample
25235 (gdb)
25236 -break-delete 1
25237 ^done
25238 (gdb)
25239 -break-list
25240 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="0",nr_cols="6",
25241 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
25242 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
25243 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
25244 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
25245 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
25246 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
25247 body=[]@}
25248 (gdb)
25249 @end smallexample
25250
25251 @subheading The @code{-break-disable} Command
25252 @findex -break-disable
25253
25254 @subsubheading Synopsis
25255
25256 @smallexample
25257 -break-disable ( @var{breakpoint} )+
25258 @end smallexample
25259
25260 Disable the named @var{breakpoint}(s). The field @samp{enabled} in the
25261 break list is now set to @samp{n} for the named @var{breakpoint}(s).
25262
25263 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
25264
25265 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{disable}.
25266
25267 @subsubheading Example
25268
25269 @smallexample
25270 (gdb)
25271 -break-disable 2
25272 ^done
25273 (gdb)
25274 -break-list
25275 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
25276 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
25277 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
25278 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
25279 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
25280 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
25281 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
25282 body=[bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="n",
25283 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
25284 line="5",times="0"@}]@}
25285 (gdb)
25286 @end smallexample
25287
25288 @subheading The @code{-break-enable} Command
25289 @findex -break-enable
25290
25291 @subsubheading Synopsis
25292
25293 @smallexample
25294 -break-enable ( @var{breakpoint} )+
25295 @end smallexample
25296
25297 Enable (previously disabled) @var{breakpoint}(s).
25298
25299 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
25300
25301 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{enable}.
25302
25303 @subsubheading Example
25304
25305 @smallexample
25306 (gdb)
25307 -break-enable 2
25308 ^done
25309 (gdb)
25310 -break-list
25311 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
25312 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
25313 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
25314 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
25315 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
25316 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
25317 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
25318 body=[bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
25319 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
25320 line="5",times="0"@}]@}
25321 (gdb)
25322 @end smallexample
25323
25324 @subheading The @code{-break-info} Command
25325 @findex -break-info
25326
25327 @subsubheading Synopsis
25328
25329 @smallexample
25330 -break-info @var{breakpoint}
25331 @end smallexample
25332
25333 @c REDUNDANT???
25334 Get information about a single breakpoint.
25335
25336 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
25337
25338 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info break @var{breakpoint}}.
25339
25340 @subsubheading Example
25341 N.A.
25342
25343 @subheading The @code{-break-insert} Command
25344 @findex -break-insert
25345
25346 @subsubheading Synopsis
25347
25348 @smallexample
25349 -break-insert [ -t ] [ -h ] [ -f ] [ -d ] [ -a ]
25350 [ -c @var{condition} ] [ -i @var{ignore-count} ]
25351 [ -p @var{thread} ] [ @var{location} ]
25352 @end smallexample
25353
25354 @noindent
25355 If specified, @var{location}, can be one of:
25356
25357 @itemize @bullet
25358 @item function
25359 @c @item +offset
25360 @c @item -offset
25361 @c @item linenum
25362 @item filename:linenum
25363 @item filename:function
25364 @item *address
25365 @end itemize
25366
25367 The possible optional parameters of this command are:
25368
25369 @table @samp
25370 @item -t
25371 Insert a temporary breakpoint.
25372 @item -h
25373 Insert a hardware breakpoint.
25374 @item -c @var{condition}
25375 Make the breakpoint conditional on @var{condition}.
25376 @item -i @var{ignore-count}
25377 Initialize the @var{ignore-count}.
25378 @item -f
25379 If @var{location} cannot be parsed (for example if it
25380 refers to unknown files or functions), create a pending
25381 breakpoint. Without this flag, @value{GDBN} will report
25382 an error, and won't create a breakpoint, if @var{location}
25383 cannot be parsed.
25384 @item -d
25385 Create a disabled breakpoint.
25386 @item -a
25387 Create a tracepoint. @xref{Tracepoints}. When this parameter
25388 is used together with @samp{-h}, a fast tracepoint is created.
25389 @end table
25390
25391 @subsubheading Result
25392
25393 The result is in the form:
25394
25395 @smallexample
25396 ^done,bkpt=@{number="@var{number}",type="@var{type}",disp="del"|"keep",
25397 enabled="y"|"n",addr="@var{hex}",func="@var{funcname}",file="@var{filename}",
25398 fullname="@var{full_filename}",line="@var{lineno}",[thread="@var{threadno},]
25399 times="@var{times}"@}
25400 @end smallexample
25401
25402 @noindent
25403 where @var{number} is the @value{GDBN} number for this breakpoint,
25404 @var{funcname} is the name of the function where the breakpoint was
25405 inserted, @var{filename} is the name of the source file which contains
25406 this function, @var{lineno} is the source line number within that file
25407 and @var{times} the number of times that the breakpoint has been hit
25408 (always 0 for -break-insert but may be greater for -break-info or -break-list
25409 which use the same output).
25410
25411 Note: this format is open to change.
25412 @c An out-of-band breakpoint instead of part of the result?
25413
25414 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
25415
25416 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{break}, @samp{tbreak},
25417 @samp{hbreak}, @samp{thbreak}, and @samp{rbreak}.
25418
25419 @subsubheading Example
25420
25421 @smallexample
25422 (gdb)
25423 -break-insert main
25424 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x0001072c",file="recursive2.c",
25425 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c,line="4",times="0"@}
25426 (gdb)
25427 -break-insert -t foo
25428 ^done,bkpt=@{number="2",addr="0x00010774",file="recursive2.c",
25429 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c,line="11",times="0"@}
25430 (gdb)
25431 -break-list
25432 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
25433 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
25434 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
25435 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
25436 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
25437 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
25438 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
25439 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
25440 addr="0x0001072c", func="main",file="recursive2.c",
25441 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c,"line="4",times="0"@},
25442 bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="del",enabled="y",
25443 addr="0x00010774",func="foo",file="recursive2.c",
25444 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c",line="11",times="0"@}]@}
25445 (gdb)
25446 -break-insert -r foo.*
25447 ~int foo(int, int);
25448 ^done,bkpt=@{number="3",addr="0x00010774",file="recursive2.c,
25449 "fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c",line="11",times="0"@}
25450 (gdb)
25451 @end smallexample
25452
25453 @subheading The @code{-break-list} Command
25454 @findex -break-list
25455
25456 @subsubheading Synopsis
25457
25458 @smallexample
25459 -break-list
25460 @end smallexample
25461
25462 Displays the list of inserted breakpoints, showing the following fields:
25463
25464 @table @samp
25465 @item Number
25466 number of the breakpoint
25467 @item Type
25468 type of the breakpoint: @samp{breakpoint} or @samp{watchpoint}
25469 @item Disposition
25470 should the breakpoint be deleted or disabled when it is hit: @samp{keep}
25471 or @samp{nokeep}
25472 @item Enabled
25473 is the breakpoint enabled or no: @samp{y} or @samp{n}
25474 @item Address
25475 memory location at which the breakpoint is set
25476 @item What
25477 logical location of the breakpoint, expressed by function name, file
25478 name, line number
25479 @item Times
25480 number of times the breakpoint has been hit
25481 @end table
25482
25483 If there are no breakpoints or watchpoints, the @code{BreakpointTable}
25484 @code{body} field is an empty list.
25485
25486 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
25487
25488 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info break}.
25489
25490 @subsubheading Example
25491
25492 @smallexample
25493 (gdb)
25494 -break-list
25495 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
25496 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
25497 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
25498 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
25499 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
25500 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
25501 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
25502 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
25503 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",line="5",times="0"@},
25504 bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
25505 addr="0x00010114",func="foo",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
25506 line="13",times="0"@}]@}
25507 (gdb)
25508 @end smallexample
25509
25510 Here's an example of the result when there are no breakpoints:
25511
25512 @smallexample
25513 (gdb)
25514 -break-list
25515 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="0",nr_cols="6",
25516 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
25517 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
25518 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
25519 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
25520 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
25521 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
25522 body=[]@}
25523 (gdb)
25524 @end smallexample
25525
25526 @subheading The @code{-break-passcount} Command
25527 @findex -break-passcount
25528
25529 @subsubheading Synopsis
25530
25531 @smallexample
25532 -break-passcount @var{tracepoint-number} @var{passcount}
25533 @end smallexample
25534
25535 Set the passcount for tracepoint @var{tracepoint-number} to
25536 @var{passcount}. If the breakpoint referred to by @var{tracepoint-number}
25537 is not a tracepoint, error is emitted. This corresponds to CLI
25538 command @samp{passcount}.
25539
25540 @subheading The @code{-break-watch} Command
25541 @findex -break-watch
25542
25543 @subsubheading Synopsis
25544
25545 @smallexample
25546 -break-watch [ -a | -r ]
25547 @end smallexample
25548
25549 Create a watchpoint. With the @samp{-a} option it will create an
25550 @dfn{access} watchpoint, i.e., a watchpoint that triggers either on a
25551 read from or on a write to the memory location. With the @samp{-r}
25552 option, the watchpoint created is a @dfn{read} watchpoint, i.e., it will
25553 trigger only when the memory location is accessed for reading. Without
25554 either of the options, the watchpoint created is a regular watchpoint,
25555 i.e., it will trigger when the memory location is accessed for writing.
25556 @xref{Set Watchpoints, , Setting Watchpoints}.
25557
25558 Note that @samp{-break-list} will report a single list of watchpoints and
25559 breakpoints inserted.
25560
25561 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
25562
25563 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{watch}, @samp{awatch}, and
25564 @samp{rwatch}.
25565
25566 @subsubheading Example
25567
25568 Setting a watchpoint on a variable in the @code{main} function:
25569
25570 @smallexample
25571 (gdb)
25572 -break-watch x
25573 ^done,wpt=@{number="2",exp="x"@}
25574 (gdb)
25575 -exec-continue
25576 ^running
25577 (gdb)
25578 *stopped,reason="watchpoint-trigger",wpt=@{number="2",exp="x"@},
25579 value=@{old="-268439212",new="55"@},
25580 frame=@{func="main",args=[],file="recursive2.c",
25581 fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="5"@}
25582 (gdb)
25583 @end smallexample
25584
25585 Setting a watchpoint on a variable local to a function. @value{GDBN} will stop
25586 the program execution twice: first for the variable changing value, then
25587 for the watchpoint going out of scope.
25588
25589 @smallexample
25590 (gdb)
25591 -break-watch C
25592 ^done,wpt=@{number="5",exp="C"@}
25593 (gdb)
25594 -exec-continue
25595 ^running
25596 (gdb)
25597 *stopped,reason="watchpoint-trigger",
25598 wpt=@{number="5",exp="C"@},value=@{old="-276895068",new="3"@},
25599 frame=@{func="callee4",args=[],
25600 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
25601 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="13"@}
25602 (gdb)
25603 -exec-continue
25604 ^running
25605 (gdb)
25606 *stopped,reason="watchpoint-scope",wpnum="5",
25607 frame=@{func="callee3",args=[@{name="strarg",
25608 value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}],
25609 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
25610 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="18"@}
25611 (gdb)
25612 @end smallexample
25613
25614 Listing breakpoints and watchpoints, at different points in the program
25615 execution. Note that once the watchpoint goes out of scope, it is
25616 deleted.
25617
25618 @smallexample
25619 (gdb)
25620 -break-watch C
25621 ^done,wpt=@{number="2",exp="C"@}
25622 (gdb)
25623 -break-list
25624 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
25625 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
25626 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
25627 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
25628 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
25629 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
25630 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
25631 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
25632 addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
25633 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
25634 fullname="/home/foo/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c"line="8",times="1"@},
25635 bkpt=@{number="2",type="watchpoint",disp="keep",
25636 enabled="y",addr="",what="C",times="0"@}]@}
25637 (gdb)
25638 -exec-continue
25639 ^running
25640 (gdb)
25641 *stopped,reason="watchpoint-trigger",wpt=@{number="2",exp="C"@},
25642 value=@{old="-276895068",new="3"@},
25643 frame=@{func="callee4",args=[],
25644 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
25645 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="13"@}
25646 (gdb)
25647 -break-list
25648 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
25649 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
25650 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
25651 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
25652 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
25653 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
25654 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
25655 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
25656 addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
25657 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
25658 fullname="/home/foo/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8",times="1"@},
25659 bkpt=@{number="2",type="watchpoint",disp="keep",
25660 enabled="y",addr="",what="C",times="-5"@}]@}
25661 (gdb)
25662 -exec-continue
25663 ^running
25664 ^done,reason="watchpoint-scope",wpnum="2",
25665 frame=@{func="callee3",args=[@{name="strarg",
25666 value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}],
25667 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
25668 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="18"@}
25669 (gdb)
25670 -break-list
25671 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
25672 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
25673 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
25674 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
25675 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
25676 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
25677 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
25678 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
25679 addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
25680 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
25681 fullname="/home/foo/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8",
25682 times="1"@}]@}
25683 (gdb)
25684 @end smallexample
25685
25686 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
25687 @node GDB/MI Program Context
25688 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Program Context
25689
25690 @subheading The @code{-exec-arguments} Command
25691 @findex -exec-arguments
25692
25693
25694 @subsubheading Synopsis
25695
25696 @smallexample
25697 -exec-arguments @var{args}
25698 @end smallexample
25699
25700 Set the inferior program arguments, to be used in the next
25701 @samp{-exec-run}.
25702
25703 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
25704
25705 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{set args}.
25706
25707 @subsubheading Example
25708
25709 @smallexample
25710 (gdb)
25711 -exec-arguments -v word
25712 ^done
25713 (gdb)
25714 @end smallexample
25715
25716
25717 @ignore
25718 @subheading The @code{-exec-show-arguments} Command
25719 @findex -exec-show-arguments
25720
25721 @subsubheading Synopsis
25722
25723 @smallexample
25724 -exec-show-arguments
25725 @end smallexample
25726
25727 Print the arguments of the program.
25728
25729 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
25730
25731 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{show args}.
25732
25733 @subsubheading Example
25734 N.A.
25735 @end ignore
25736
25737
25738 @subheading The @code{-environment-cd} Command
25739 @findex -environment-cd
25740
25741 @subsubheading Synopsis
25742
25743 @smallexample
25744 -environment-cd @var{pathdir}
25745 @end smallexample
25746
25747 Set @value{GDBN}'s working directory.
25748
25749 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
25750
25751 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{cd}.
25752
25753 @subsubheading Example
25754
25755 @smallexample
25756 (gdb)
25757 -environment-cd /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb
25758 ^done
25759 (gdb)
25760 @end smallexample
25761
25762
25763 @subheading The @code{-environment-directory} Command
25764 @findex -environment-directory
25765
25766 @subsubheading Synopsis
25767
25768 @smallexample
25769 -environment-directory [ -r ] [ @var{pathdir} ]+
25770 @end smallexample
25771
25772 Add directories @var{pathdir} to beginning of search path for source files.
25773 If the @samp{-r} option is used, the search path is reset to the default
25774 search path. If directories @var{pathdir} are supplied in addition to the
25775 @samp{-r} option, the search path is first reset and then addition
25776 occurs as normal.
25777 Multiple directories may be specified, separated by blanks. Specifying
25778 multiple directories in a single command
25779 results in the directories added to the beginning of the
25780 search path in the same order they were presented in the command.
25781 If blanks are needed as
25782 part of a directory name, double-quotes should be used around
25783 the name. In the command output, the path will show up separated
25784 by the system directory-separator character. The directory-separator
25785 character must not be used
25786 in any directory name.
25787 If no directories are specified, the current search path is displayed.
25788
25789 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
25790
25791 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{dir}.
25792
25793 @subsubheading Example
25794
25795 @smallexample
25796 (gdb)
25797 -environment-directory /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb
25798 ^done,source-path="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb:$cdir:$cwd"
25799 (gdb)
25800 -environment-directory ""
25801 ^done,source-path="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb:$cdir:$cwd"
25802 (gdb)
25803 -environment-directory -r /home/jjohnstn/src/gdb /usr/src
25804 ^done,source-path="/home/jjohnstn/src/gdb:/usr/src:$cdir:$cwd"
25805 (gdb)
25806 -environment-directory -r
25807 ^done,source-path="$cdir:$cwd"
25808 (gdb)
25809 @end smallexample
25810
25811
25812 @subheading The @code{-environment-path} Command
25813 @findex -environment-path
25814
25815 @subsubheading Synopsis
25816
25817 @smallexample
25818 -environment-path [ -r ] [ @var{pathdir} ]+
25819 @end smallexample
25820
25821 Add directories @var{pathdir} to beginning of search path for object files.
25822 If the @samp{-r} option is used, the search path is reset to the original
25823 search path that existed at gdb start-up. If directories @var{pathdir} are
25824 supplied in addition to the
25825 @samp{-r} option, the search path is first reset and then addition
25826 occurs as normal.
25827 Multiple directories may be specified, separated by blanks. Specifying
25828 multiple directories in a single command
25829 results in the directories added to the beginning of the
25830 search path in the same order they were presented in the command.
25831 If blanks are needed as
25832 part of a directory name, double-quotes should be used around
25833 the name. In the command output, the path will show up separated
25834 by the system directory-separator character. The directory-separator
25835 character must not be used
25836 in any directory name.
25837 If no directories are specified, the current path is displayed.
25838
25839
25840 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
25841
25842 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{path}.
25843
25844 @subsubheading Example
25845
25846 @smallexample
25847 (gdb)
25848 -environment-path
25849 ^done,path="/usr/bin"
25850 (gdb)
25851 -environment-path /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/ppc-eabi/gdb /bin
25852 ^done,path="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/ppc-eabi/gdb:/bin:/usr/bin"
25853 (gdb)
25854 -environment-path -r /usr/local/bin
25855 ^done,path="/usr/local/bin:/usr/bin"
25856 (gdb)
25857 @end smallexample
25858
25859
25860 @subheading The @code{-environment-pwd} Command
25861 @findex -environment-pwd
25862
25863 @subsubheading Synopsis
25864
25865 @smallexample
25866 -environment-pwd
25867 @end smallexample
25868
25869 Show the current working directory.
25870
25871 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
25872
25873 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{pwd}.
25874
25875 @subsubheading Example
25876
25877 @smallexample
25878 (gdb)
25879 -environment-pwd
25880 ^done,cwd="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb"
25881 (gdb)
25882 @end smallexample
25883
25884 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
25885 @node GDB/MI Thread Commands
25886 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Thread Commands
25887
25888
25889 @subheading The @code{-thread-info} Command
25890 @findex -thread-info
25891
25892 @subsubheading Synopsis
25893
25894 @smallexample
25895 -thread-info [ @var{thread-id} ]
25896 @end smallexample
25897
25898 Reports information about either a specific thread, if
25899 the @var{thread-id} parameter is present, or about all
25900 threads. When printing information about all threads,
25901 also reports the current thread.
25902
25903 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
25904
25905 The @samp{info thread} command prints the same information
25906 about all threads.
25907
25908 @subsubheading Result
25909
25910 The result is a list of threads. The following attributes are
25911 defined for a given thread:
25912
25913 @table @samp
25914 @item current
25915 This field exists only for the current thread. It has the value @samp{*}.
25916
25917 @item id
25918 The identifier that @value{GDBN} uses to refer to the thread.
25919
25920 @item target-id
25921 The identifier that the target uses to refer to the thread.
25922
25923 @item details
25924 Extra information about the thread, in a target-specific format. This
25925 field is optional.
25926
25927 @item name
25928 The name of the thread. If the user specified a name using the
25929 @code{thread name} command, then this name is given. Otherwise, if
25930 @value{GDBN} can extract the thread name from the target, then that
25931 name is given. If @value{GDBN} cannot find the thread name, then this
25932 field is omitted.
25933
25934 @item frame
25935 The stack frame currently executing in the thread.
25936
25937 @item state
25938 The thread's state. The @samp{state} field may have the following
25939 values:
25940
25941 @table @code
25942 @item stopped
25943 The thread is stopped. Frame information is available for stopped
25944 threads.
25945
25946 @item running
25947 The thread is running. There's no frame information for running
25948 threads.
25949
25950 @end table
25951
25952 @item core
25953 If @value{GDBN} can find the CPU core on which this thread is running,
25954 then this field is the core identifier. This field is optional.
25955
25956 @end table
25957
25958 @subsubheading Example
25959
25960 @smallexample
25961 -thread-info
25962 ^done,threads=[
25963 @{id="2",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90 (LWP 21257)",
25964 frame=@{level="0",addr="0xffffe410",func="__kernel_vsyscall",
25965 args=[]@},state="running"@},
25966 @{id="1",target-id="Thread 0xb7e156b0 (LWP 21254)",
25967 frame=@{level="0",addr="0x0804891f",func="foo",
25968 args=[@{name="i",value="10"@}],
25969 file="/tmp/a.c",fullname="/tmp/a.c",line="158"@},
25970 state="running"@}],
25971 current-thread-id="1"
25972 (gdb)
25973 @end smallexample
25974
25975 @subheading The @code{-thread-list-ids} Command
25976 @findex -thread-list-ids
25977
25978 @subsubheading Synopsis
25979
25980 @smallexample
25981 -thread-list-ids
25982 @end smallexample
25983
25984 Produces a list of the currently known @value{GDBN} thread ids. At the
25985 end of the list it also prints the total number of such threads.
25986
25987 This command is retained for historical reasons, the
25988 @code{-thread-info} command should be used instead.
25989
25990 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
25991
25992 Part of @samp{info threads} supplies the same information.
25993
25994 @subsubheading Example
25995
25996 @smallexample
25997 (gdb)
25998 -thread-list-ids
25999 ^done,thread-ids=@{thread-id="3",thread-id="2",thread-id="1"@},
26000 current-thread-id="1",number-of-threads="3"
26001 (gdb)
26002 @end smallexample
26003
26004
26005 @subheading The @code{-thread-select} Command
26006 @findex -thread-select
26007
26008 @subsubheading Synopsis
26009
26010 @smallexample
26011 -thread-select @var{threadnum}
26012 @end smallexample
26013
26014 Make @var{threadnum} the current thread. It prints the number of the new
26015 current thread, and the topmost frame for that thread.
26016
26017 This command is deprecated in favor of explicitly using the
26018 @samp{--thread} option to each command.
26019
26020 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26021
26022 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{thread}.
26023
26024 @subsubheading Example
26025
26026 @smallexample
26027 (gdb)
26028 -exec-next
26029 ^running
26030 (gdb)
26031 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",thread-id="2",line="187",
26032 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.threads/linux-dp.c"
26033 (gdb)
26034 -thread-list-ids
26035 ^done,
26036 thread-ids=@{thread-id="3",thread-id="2",thread-id="1"@},
26037 number-of-threads="3"
26038 (gdb)
26039 -thread-select 3
26040 ^done,new-thread-id="3",
26041 frame=@{level="0",func="vprintf",
26042 args=[@{name="format",value="0x8048e9c \"%*s%c %d %c\\n\""@},
26043 @{name="arg",value="0x2"@}],file="vprintf.c",line="31"@}
26044 (gdb)
26045 @end smallexample
26046
26047 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
26048 @node GDB/MI Program Execution
26049 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Program Execution
26050
26051 These are the asynchronous commands which generate the out-of-band
26052 record @samp{*stopped}. Currently @value{GDBN} only really executes
26053 asynchronously with remote targets and this interaction is mimicked in
26054 other cases.
26055
26056 @subheading The @code{-exec-continue} Command
26057 @findex -exec-continue
26058
26059 @subsubheading Synopsis
26060
26061 @smallexample
26062 -exec-continue [--reverse] [--all|--thread-group N]
26063 @end smallexample
26064
26065 Resumes the execution of the inferior program, which will continue
26066 to execute until it reaches a debugger stop event. If the
26067 @samp{--reverse} option is specified, execution resumes in reverse until
26068 it reaches a stop event. Stop events may include
26069 @itemize @bullet
26070 @item
26071 breakpoints or watchpoints
26072 @item
26073 signals or exceptions
26074 @item
26075 the end of the process (or its beginning under @samp{--reverse})
26076 @item
26077 the end or beginning of a replay log if one is being used.
26078 @end itemize
26079 In all-stop mode (@pxref{All-Stop
26080 Mode}), may resume only one thread, or all threads, depending on the
26081 value of the @samp{scheduler-locking} variable. If @samp{--all} is
26082 specified, all threads (in all inferiors) will be resumed. The @samp{--all} option is
26083 ignored in all-stop mode. If the @samp{--thread-group} options is
26084 specified, then all threads in that thread group are resumed.
26085
26086 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26087
26088 The corresponding @value{GDBN} corresponding is @samp{continue}.
26089
26090 @subsubheading Example
26091
26092 @smallexample
26093 -exec-continue
26094 ^running
26095 (gdb)
26096 @@Hello world
26097 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="2",frame=@{
26098 func="foo",args=[],file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/hello.c",
26099 line="13"@}
26100 (gdb)
26101 @end smallexample
26102
26103
26104 @subheading The @code{-exec-finish} Command
26105 @findex -exec-finish
26106
26107 @subsubheading Synopsis
26108
26109 @smallexample
26110 -exec-finish [--reverse]
26111 @end smallexample
26112
26113 Resumes the execution of the inferior program until the current
26114 function is exited. Displays the results returned by the function.
26115 If the @samp{--reverse} option is specified, resumes the reverse
26116 execution of the inferior program until the point where current
26117 function was called.
26118
26119 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26120
26121 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{finish}.
26122
26123 @subsubheading Example
26124
26125 Function returning @code{void}.
26126
26127 @smallexample
26128 -exec-finish
26129 ^running
26130 (gdb)
26131 @@hello from foo
26132 *stopped,reason="function-finished",frame=@{func="main",args=[],
26133 file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/hello.c",line="7"@}
26134 (gdb)
26135 @end smallexample
26136
26137 Function returning other than @code{void}. The name of the internal
26138 @value{GDBN} variable storing the result is printed, together with the
26139 value itself.
26140
26141 @smallexample
26142 -exec-finish
26143 ^running
26144 (gdb)
26145 *stopped,reason="function-finished",frame=@{addr="0x000107b0",func="foo",
26146 args=[@{name="a",value="1"],@{name="b",value="9"@}@},
26147 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
26148 gdb-result-var="$1",return-value="0"
26149 (gdb)
26150 @end smallexample
26151
26152
26153 @subheading The @code{-exec-interrupt} Command
26154 @findex -exec-interrupt
26155
26156 @subsubheading Synopsis
26157
26158 @smallexample
26159 -exec-interrupt [--all|--thread-group N]
26160 @end smallexample
26161
26162 Interrupts the background execution of the target. Note how the token
26163 associated with the stop message is the one for the execution command
26164 that has been interrupted. The token for the interrupt itself only
26165 appears in the @samp{^done} output. If the user is trying to
26166 interrupt a non-running program, an error message will be printed.
26167
26168 Note that when asynchronous execution is enabled, this command is
26169 asynchronous just like other execution commands. That is, first the
26170 @samp{^done} response will be printed, and the target stop will be
26171 reported after that using the @samp{*stopped} notification.
26172
26173 In non-stop mode, only the context thread is interrupted by default.
26174 All threads (in all inferiors) will be interrupted if the
26175 @samp{--all} option is specified. If the @samp{--thread-group}
26176 option is specified, all threads in that group will be interrupted.
26177
26178 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26179
26180 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{interrupt}.
26181
26182 @subsubheading Example
26183
26184 @smallexample
26185 (gdb)
26186 111-exec-continue
26187 111^running
26188
26189 (gdb)
26190 222-exec-interrupt
26191 222^done
26192 (gdb)
26193 111*stopped,signal-name="SIGINT",signal-meaning="Interrupt",
26194 frame=@{addr="0x00010140",func="foo",args=[],file="try.c",
26195 fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",line="13"@}
26196 (gdb)
26197
26198 (gdb)
26199 -exec-interrupt
26200 ^error,msg="mi_cmd_exec_interrupt: Inferior not executing."
26201 (gdb)
26202 @end smallexample
26203
26204 @subheading The @code{-exec-jump} Command
26205 @findex -exec-jump
26206
26207 @subsubheading Synopsis
26208
26209 @smallexample
26210 -exec-jump @var{location}
26211 @end smallexample
26212
26213 Resumes execution of the inferior program at the location specified by
26214 parameter. @xref{Specify Location}, for a description of the
26215 different forms of @var{location}.
26216
26217 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26218
26219 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{jump}.
26220
26221 @subsubheading Example
26222
26223 @smallexample
26224 -exec-jump foo.c:10
26225 *running,thread-id="all"
26226 ^running
26227 @end smallexample
26228
26229
26230 @subheading The @code{-exec-next} Command
26231 @findex -exec-next
26232
26233 @subsubheading Synopsis
26234
26235 @smallexample
26236 -exec-next [--reverse]
26237 @end smallexample
26238
26239 Resumes execution of the inferior program, stopping when the beginning
26240 of the next source line is reached.
26241
26242 If the @samp{--reverse} option is specified, resumes reverse execution
26243 of the inferior program, stopping at the beginning of the previous
26244 source line. If you issue this command on the first line of a
26245 function, it will take you back to the caller of that function, to the
26246 source line where the function was called.
26247
26248
26249 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26250
26251 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{next}.
26252
26253 @subsubheading Example
26254
26255 @smallexample
26256 -exec-next
26257 ^running
26258 (gdb)
26259 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",line="8",file="hello.c"
26260 (gdb)
26261 @end smallexample
26262
26263
26264 @subheading The @code{-exec-next-instruction} Command
26265 @findex -exec-next-instruction
26266
26267 @subsubheading Synopsis
26268
26269 @smallexample
26270 -exec-next-instruction [--reverse]
26271 @end smallexample
26272
26273 Executes one machine instruction. If the instruction is a function
26274 call, continues until the function returns. If the program stops at an
26275 instruction in the middle of a source line, the address will be
26276 printed as well.
26277
26278 If the @samp{--reverse} option is specified, resumes reverse execution
26279 of the inferior program, stopping at the previous instruction. If the
26280 previously executed instruction was a return from another function,
26281 it will continue to execute in reverse until the call to that function
26282 (from the current stack frame) is reached.
26283
26284 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26285
26286 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{nexti}.
26287
26288 @subsubheading Example
26289
26290 @smallexample
26291 (gdb)
26292 -exec-next-instruction
26293 ^running
26294
26295 (gdb)
26296 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
26297 addr="0x000100d4",line="5",file="hello.c"
26298 (gdb)
26299 @end smallexample
26300
26301
26302 @subheading The @code{-exec-return} Command
26303 @findex -exec-return
26304
26305 @subsubheading Synopsis
26306
26307 @smallexample
26308 -exec-return
26309 @end smallexample
26310
26311 Makes current function return immediately. Doesn't execute the inferior.
26312 Displays the new current frame.
26313
26314 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26315
26316 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{return}.
26317
26318 @subsubheading Example
26319
26320 @smallexample
26321 (gdb)
26322 200-break-insert callee4
26323 200^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x00010734",
26324 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8"@}
26325 (gdb)
26326 000-exec-run
26327 000^running
26328 (gdb)
26329 000*stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",
26330 frame=@{func="callee4",args=[],
26331 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
26332 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8"@}
26333 (gdb)
26334 205-break-delete
26335 205^done
26336 (gdb)
26337 111-exec-return
26338 111^done,frame=@{level="0",func="callee3",
26339 args=[@{name="strarg",
26340 value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}],
26341 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
26342 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="18"@}
26343 (gdb)
26344 @end smallexample
26345
26346
26347 @subheading The @code{-exec-run} Command
26348 @findex -exec-run
26349
26350 @subsubheading Synopsis
26351
26352 @smallexample
26353 -exec-run [--all | --thread-group N]
26354 @end smallexample
26355
26356 Starts execution of the inferior from the beginning. The inferior
26357 executes until either a breakpoint is encountered or the program
26358 exits. In the latter case the output will include an exit code, if
26359 the program has exited exceptionally.
26360
26361 When no option is specified, the current inferior is started. If the
26362 @samp{--thread-group} option is specified, it should refer to a thread
26363 group of type @samp{process}, and that thread group will be started.
26364 If the @samp{--all} option is specified, then all inferiors will be started.
26365
26366 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26367
26368 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{run}.
26369
26370 @subsubheading Examples
26371
26372 @smallexample
26373 (gdb)
26374 -break-insert main
26375 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x0001072c",file="recursive2.c",line="4"@}
26376 (gdb)
26377 -exec-run
26378 ^running
26379 (gdb)
26380 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",
26381 frame=@{func="main",args=[],file="recursive2.c",
26382 fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="4"@}
26383 (gdb)
26384 @end smallexample
26385
26386 @noindent
26387 Program exited normally:
26388
26389 @smallexample
26390 (gdb)
26391 -exec-run
26392 ^running
26393 (gdb)
26394 x = 55
26395 *stopped,reason="exited-normally"
26396 (gdb)
26397 @end smallexample
26398
26399 @noindent
26400 Program exited exceptionally:
26401
26402 @smallexample
26403 (gdb)
26404 -exec-run
26405 ^running
26406 (gdb)
26407 x = 55
26408 *stopped,reason="exited",exit-code="01"
26409 (gdb)
26410 @end smallexample
26411
26412 Another way the program can terminate is if it receives a signal such as
26413 @code{SIGINT}. In this case, @sc{gdb/mi} displays this:
26414
26415 @smallexample
26416 (gdb)
26417 *stopped,reason="exited-signalled",signal-name="SIGINT",
26418 signal-meaning="Interrupt"
26419 @end smallexample
26420
26421
26422 @c @subheading -exec-signal
26423
26424
26425 @subheading The @code{-exec-step} Command
26426 @findex -exec-step
26427
26428 @subsubheading Synopsis
26429
26430 @smallexample
26431 -exec-step [--reverse]
26432 @end smallexample
26433
26434 Resumes execution of the inferior program, stopping when the beginning
26435 of the next source line is reached, if the next source line is not a
26436 function call. If it is, stop at the first instruction of the called
26437 function. If the @samp{--reverse} option is specified, resumes reverse
26438 execution of the inferior program, stopping at the beginning of the
26439 previously executed source line.
26440
26441 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26442
26443 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{step}.
26444
26445 @subsubheading Example
26446
26447 Stepping into a function:
26448
26449 @smallexample
26450 -exec-step
26451 ^running
26452 (gdb)
26453 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
26454 frame=@{func="foo",args=[@{name="a",value="10"@},
26455 @{name="b",value="0"@}],file="recursive2.c",
26456 fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="11"@}
26457 (gdb)
26458 @end smallexample
26459
26460 Regular stepping:
26461
26462 @smallexample
26463 -exec-step
26464 ^running
26465 (gdb)
26466 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",line="14",file="recursive2.c"
26467 (gdb)
26468 @end smallexample
26469
26470
26471 @subheading The @code{-exec-step-instruction} Command
26472 @findex -exec-step-instruction
26473
26474 @subsubheading Synopsis
26475
26476 @smallexample
26477 -exec-step-instruction [--reverse]
26478 @end smallexample
26479
26480 Resumes the inferior which executes one machine instruction. If the
26481 @samp{--reverse} option is specified, resumes reverse execution of the
26482 inferior program, stopping at the previously executed instruction.
26483 The output, once @value{GDBN} has stopped, will vary depending on
26484 whether we have stopped in the middle of a source line or not. In the
26485 former case, the address at which the program stopped will be printed
26486 as well.
26487
26488 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26489
26490 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{stepi}.
26491
26492 @subsubheading Example
26493
26494 @smallexample
26495 (gdb)
26496 -exec-step-instruction
26497 ^running
26498
26499 (gdb)
26500 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
26501 frame=@{func="foo",args=[],file="try.c",
26502 fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",line="10"@}
26503 (gdb)
26504 -exec-step-instruction
26505 ^running
26506
26507 (gdb)
26508 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
26509 frame=@{addr="0x000100f4",func="foo",args=[],file="try.c",
26510 fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",line="10"@}
26511 (gdb)
26512 @end smallexample
26513
26514
26515 @subheading The @code{-exec-until} Command
26516 @findex -exec-until
26517
26518 @subsubheading Synopsis
26519
26520 @smallexample
26521 -exec-until [ @var{location} ]
26522 @end smallexample
26523
26524 Executes the inferior until the @var{location} specified in the
26525 argument is reached. If there is no argument, the inferior executes
26526 until a source line greater than the current one is reached. The
26527 reason for stopping in this case will be @samp{location-reached}.
26528
26529 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26530
26531 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{until}.
26532
26533 @subsubheading Example
26534
26535 @smallexample
26536 (gdb)
26537 -exec-until recursive2.c:6
26538 ^running
26539 (gdb)
26540 x = 55
26541 *stopped,reason="location-reached",frame=@{func="main",args=[],
26542 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="6"@}
26543 (gdb)
26544 @end smallexample
26545
26546 @ignore
26547 @subheading -file-clear
26548 Is this going away????
26549 @end ignore
26550
26551 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
26552 @node GDB/MI Stack Manipulation
26553 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Stack Manipulation Commands
26554
26555
26556 @subheading The @code{-stack-info-frame} Command
26557 @findex -stack-info-frame
26558
26559 @subsubheading Synopsis
26560
26561 @smallexample
26562 -stack-info-frame
26563 @end smallexample
26564
26565 Get info on the selected frame.
26566
26567 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26568
26569 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info frame} or @samp{frame}
26570 (without arguments).
26571
26572 @subsubheading Example
26573
26574 @smallexample
26575 (gdb)
26576 -stack-info-frame
26577 ^done,frame=@{level="1",addr="0x0001076c",func="callee3",
26578 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
26579 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="17"@}
26580 (gdb)
26581 @end smallexample
26582
26583 @subheading The @code{-stack-info-depth} Command
26584 @findex -stack-info-depth
26585
26586 @subsubheading Synopsis
26587
26588 @smallexample
26589 -stack-info-depth [ @var{max-depth} ]
26590 @end smallexample
26591
26592 Return the depth of the stack. If the integer argument @var{max-depth}
26593 is specified, do not count beyond @var{max-depth} frames.
26594
26595 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26596
26597 There's no equivalent @value{GDBN} command.
26598
26599 @subsubheading Example
26600
26601 For a stack with frame levels 0 through 11:
26602
26603 @smallexample
26604 (gdb)
26605 -stack-info-depth
26606 ^done,depth="12"
26607 (gdb)
26608 -stack-info-depth 4
26609 ^done,depth="4"
26610 (gdb)
26611 -stack-info-depth 12
26612 ^done,depth="12"
26613 (gdb)
26614 -stack-info-depth 11
26615 ^done,depth="11"
26616 (gdb)
26617 -stack-info-depth 13
26618 ^done,depth="12"
26619 (gdb)
26620 @end smallexample
26621
26622 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-arguments} Command
26623 @findex -stack-list-arguments
26624
26625 @subsubheading Synopsis
26626
26627 @smallexample
26628 -stack-list-arguments @var{print-values}
26629 [ @var{low-frame} @var{high-frame} ]
26630 @end smallexample
26631
26632 Display a list of the arguments for the frames between @var{low-frame}
26633 and @var{high-frame} (inclusive). If @var{low-frame} and
26634 @var{high-frame} are not provided, list the arguments for the whole
26635 call stack. If the two arguments are equal, show the single frame
26636 at the corresponding level. It is an error if @var{low-frame} is
26637 larger than the actual number of frames. On the other hand,
26638 @var{high-frame} may be larger than the actual number of frames, in
26639 which case only existing frames will be returned.
26640
26641 If @var{print-values} is 0 or @code{--no-values}, print only the names of
26642 the variables; if it is 1 or @code{--all-values}, print also their
26643 values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values}, print the name,
26644 type and value for simple data types, and the name and type for arrays,
26645 structures and unions.
26646
26647 Use of this command to obtain arguments in a single frame is
26648 deprecated in favor of the @samp{-stack-list-variables} command.
26649
26650 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26651
26652 @value{GDBN} does not have an equivalent command. @code{gdbtk} has a
26653 @samp{gdb_get_args} command which partially overlaps with the
26654 functionality of @samp{-stack-list-arguments}.
26655
26656 @subsubheading Example
26657
26658 @smallexample
26659 (gdb)
26660 -stack-list-frames
26661 ^done,
26662 stack=[
26663 frame=@{level="0",addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
26664 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
26665 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8"@},
26666 frame=@{level="1",addr="0x0001076c",func="callee3",
26667 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
26668 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="17"@},
26669 frame=@{level="2",addr="0x0001078c",func="callee2",
26670 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
26671 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="22"@},
26672 frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107b4",func="callee1",
26673 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
26674 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="27"@},
26675 frame=@{level="4",addr="0x000107e0",func="main",
26676 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
26677 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="32"@}]
26678 (gdb)
26679 -stack-list-arguments 0
26680 ^done,
26681 stack-args=[
26682 frame=@{level="0",args=[]@},
26683 frame=@{level="1",args=[name="strarg"]@},
26684 frame=@{level="2",args=[name="intarg",name="strarg"]@},
26685 frame=@{level="3",args=[name="intarg",name="strarg",name="fltarg"]@},
26686 frame=@{level="4",args=[]@}]
26687 (gdb)
26688 -stack-list-arguments 1
26689 ^done,
26690 stack-args=[
26691 frame=@{level="0",args=[]@},
26692 frame=@{level="1",
26693 args=[@{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}]@},
26694 frame=@{level="2",args=[
26695 @{name="intarg",value="2"@},
26696 @{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}]@},
26697 @{frame=@{level="3",args=[
26698 @{name="intarg",value="2"@},
26699 @{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@},
26700 @{name="fltarg",value="3.5"@}]@},
26701 frame=@{level="4",args=[]@}]
26702 (gdb)
26703 -stack-list-arguments 0 2 2
26704 ^done,stack-args=[frame=@{level="2",args=[name="intarg",name="strarg"]@}]
26705 (gdb)
26706 -stack-list-arguments 1 2 2
26707 ^done,stack-args=[frame=@{level="2",
26708 args=[@{name="intarg",value="2"@},
26709 @{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}]@}]
26710 (gdb)
26711 @end smallexample
26712
26713 @c @subheading -stack-list-exception-handlers
26714
26715
26716 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-frames} Command
26717 @findex -stack-list-frames
26718
26719 @subsubheading Synopsis
26720
26721 @smallexample
26722 -stack-list-frames [ @var{low-frame} @var{high-frame} ]
26723 @end smallexample
26724
26725 List the frames currently on the stack. For each frame it displays the
26726 following info:
26727
26728 @table @samp
26729 @item @var{level}
26730 The frame number, 0 being the topmost frame, i.e., the innermost function.
26731 @item @var{addr}
26732 The @code{$pc} value for that frame.
26733 @item @var{func}
26734 Function name.
26735 @item @var{file}
26736 File name of the source file where the function lives.
26737 @item @var{fullname}
26738 The full file name of the source file where the function lives.
26739 @item @var{line}
26740 Line number corresponding to the @code{$pc}.
26741 @item @var{from}
26742 The shared library where this function is defined. This is only given
26743 if the frame's function is not known.
26744 @end table
26745
26746 If invoked without arguments, this command prints a backtrace for the
26747 whole stack. If given two integer arguments, it shows the frames whose
26748 levels are between the two arguments (inclusive). If the two arguments
26749 are equal, it shows the single frame at the corresponding level. It is
26750 an error if @var{low-frame} is larger than the actual number of
26751 frames. On the other hand, @var{high-frame} may be larger than the
26752 actual number of frames, in which case only existing frames will be returned.
26753
26754 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26755
26756 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{backtrace} and @samp{where}.
26757
26758 @subsubheading Example
26759
26760 Full stack backtrace:
26761
26762 @smallexample
26763 (gdb)
26764 -stack-list-frames
26765 ^done,stack=
26766 [frame=@{level="0",addr="0x0001076c",func="foo",
26767 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="11"@},
26768 frame=@{level="1",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
26769 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
26770 frame=@{level="2",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
26771 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
26772 frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
26773 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
26774 frame=@{level="4",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
26775 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
26776 frame=@{level="5",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
26777 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
26778 frame=@{level="6",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
26779 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
26780 frame=@{level="7",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
26781 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
26782 frame=@{level="8",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
26783 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
26784 frame=@{level="9",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
26785 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
26786 frame=@{level="10",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
26787 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
26788 frame=@{level="11",addr="0x00010738",func="main",
26789 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="4"@}]
26790 (gdb)
26791 @end smallexample
26792
26793 Show frames between @var{low_frame} and @var{high_frame}:
26794
26795 @smallexample
26796 (gdb)
26797 -stack-list-frames 3 5
26798 ^done,stack=
26799 [frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
26800 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
26801 frame=@{level="4",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
26802 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
26803 frame=@{level="5",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
26804 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@}]
26805 (gdb)
26806 @end smallexample
26807
26808 Show a single frame:
26809
26810 @smallexample
26811 (gdb)
26812 -stack-list-frames 3 3
26813 ^done,stack=
26814 [frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
26815 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@}]
26816 (gdb)
26817 @end smallexample
26818
26819
26820 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-locals} Command
26821 @findex -stack-list-locals
26822
26823 @subsubheading Synopsis
26824
26825 @smallexample
26826 -stack-list-locals @var{print-values}
26827 @end smallexample
26828
26829 Display the local variable names for the selected frame. If
26830 @var{print-values} is 0 or @code{--no-values}, print only the names of
26831 the variables; if it is 1 or @code{--all-values}, print also their
26832 values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values}, print the name,
26833 type and value for simple data types, and the name and type for arrays,
26834 structures and unions. In this last case, a frontend can immediately
26835 display the value of simple data types and create variable objects for
26836 other data types when the user wishes to explore their values in
26837 more detail.
26838
26839 This command is deprecated in favor of the
26840 @samp{-stack-list-variables} command.
26841
26842 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26843
26844 @samp{info locals} in @value{GDBN}, @samp{gdb_get_locals} in @code{gdbtk}.
26845
26846 @subsubheading Example
26847
26848 @smallexample
26849 (gdb)
26850 -stack-list-locals 0
26851 ^done,locals=[name="A",name="B",name="C"]
26852 (gdb)
26853 -stack-list-locals --all-values
26854 ^done,locals=[@{name="A",value="1"@},@{name="B",value="2"@},
26855 @{name="C",value="@{1, 2, 3@}"@}]
26856 -stack-list-locals --simple-values
26857 ^done,locals=[@{name="A",type="int",value="1"@},
26858 @{name="B",type="int",value="2"@},@{name="C",type="int [3]"@}]
26859 (gdb)
26860 @end smallexample
26861
26862 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-variables} Command
26863 @findex -stack-list-variables
26864
26865 @subsubheading Synopsis
26866
26867 @smallexample
26868 -stack-list-variables @var{print-values}
26869 @end smallexample
26870
26871 Display the names of local variables and function arguments for the selected frame. If
26872 @var{print-values} is 0 or @code{--no-values}, print only the names of
26873 the variables; if it is 1 or @code{--all-values}, print also their
26874 values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values}, print the name,
26875 type and value for simple data types, and the name and type for arrays,
26876 structures and unions.
26877
26878 @subsubheading Example
26879
26880 @smallexample
26881 (gdb)
26882 -stack-list-variables --thread 1 --frame 0 --all-values
26883 ^done,variables=[@{name="x",value="11"@},@{name="s",value="@{a = 1, b = 2@}"@}]
26884 (gdb)
26885 @end smallexample
26886
26887
26888 @subheading The @code{-stack-select-frame} Command
26889 @findex -stack-select-frame
26890
26891 @subsubheading Synopsis
26892
26893 @smallexample
26894 -stack-select-frame @var{framenum}
26895 @end smallexample
26896
26897 Change the selected frame. Select a different frame @var{framenum} on
26898 the stack.
26899
26900 This command in deprecated in favor of passing the @samp{--frame}
26901 option to every command.
26902
26903 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26904
26905 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{frame}, @samp{up},
26906 @samp{down}, @samp{select-frame}, @samp{up-silent}, and @samp{down-silent}.
26907
26908 @subsubheading Example
26909
26910 @smallexample
26911 (gdb)
26912 -stack-select-frame 2
26913 ^done
26914 (gdb)
26915 @end smallexample
26916
26917 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
26918 @node GDB/MI Variable Objects
26919 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Variable Objects
26920
26921 @ignore
26922
26923 @subheading Motivation for Variable Objects in @sc{gdb/mi}
26924
26925 For the implementation of a variable debugger window (locals, watched
26926 expressions, etc.), we are proposing the adaptation of the existing code
26927 used by @code{Insight}.
26928
26929 The two main reasons for that are:
26930
26931 @enumerate 1
26932 @item
26933 It has been proven in practice (it is already on its second generation).
26934
26935 @item
26936 It will shorten development time (needless to say how important it is
26937 now).
26938 @end enumerate
26939
26940 The original interface was designed to be used by Tcl code, so it was
26941 slightly changed so it could be used through @sc{gdb/mi}. This section
26942 describes the @sc{gdb/mi} operations that will be available and gives some
26943 hints about their use.
26944
26945 @emph{Note}: In addition to the set of operations described here, we
26946 expect the @sc{gui} implementation of a variable window to require, at
26947 least, the following operations:
26948
26949 @itemize @bullet
26950 @item @code{-gdb-show} @code{output-radix}
26951 @item @code{-stack-list-arguments}
26952 @item @code{-stack-list-locals}
26953 @item @code{-stack-select-frame}
26954 @end itemize
26955
26956 @end ignore
26957
26958 @subheading Introduction to Variable Objects
26959
26960 @cindex variable objects in @sc{gdb/mi}
26961
26962 Variable objects are "object-oriented" MI interface for examining and
26963 changing values of expressions. Unlike some other MI interfaces that
26964 work with expressions, variable objects are specifically designed for
26965 simple and efficient presentation in the frontend. A variable object
26966 is identified by string name. When a variable object is created, the
26967 frontend specifies the expression for that variable object. The
26968 expression can be a simple variable, or it can be an arbitrary complex
26969 expression, and can even involve CPU registers. After creating a
26970 variable object, the frontend can invoke other variable object
26971 operations---for example to obtain or change the value of a variable
26972 object, or to change display format.
26973
26974 Variable objects have hierarchical tree structure. Any variable object
26975 that corresponds to a composite type, such as structure in C, has
26976 a number of child variable objects, for example corresponding to each
26977 element of a structure. A child variable object can itself have
26978 children, recursively. Recursion ends when we reach
26979 leaf variable objects, which always have built-in types. Child variable
26980 objects are created only by explicit request, so if a frontend
26981 is not interested in the children of a particular variable object, no
26982 child will be created.
26983
26984 For a leaf variable object it is possible to obtain its value as a
26985 string, or set the value from a string. String value can be also
26986 obtained for a non-leaf variable object, but it's generally a string
26987 that only indicates the type of the object, and does not list its
26988 contents. Assignment to a non-leaf variable object is not allowed.
26989
26990 A frontend does not need to read the values of all variable objects each time
26991 the program stops. Instead, MI provides an update command that lists all
26992 variable objects whose values has changed since the last update
26993 operation. This considerably reduces the amount of data that must
26994 be transferred to the frontend. As noted above, children variable
26995 objects are created on demand, and only leaf variable objects have a
26996 real value. As result, gdb will read target memory only for leaf
26997 variables that frontend has created.
26998
26999 The automatic update is not always desirable. For example, a frontend
27000 might want to keep a value of some expression for future reference,
27001 and never update it. For another example, fetching memory is
27002 relatively slow for embedded targets, so a frontend might want
27003 to disable automatic update for the variables that are either not
27004 visible on the screen, or ``closed''. This is possible using so
27005 called ``frozen variable objects''. Such variable objects are never
27006 implicitly updated.
27007
27008 Variable objects can be either @dfn{fixed} or @dfn{floating}. For the
27009 fixed variable object, the expression is parsed when the variable
27010 object is created, including associating identifiers to specific
27011 variables. The meaning of expression never changes. For a floating
27012 variable object the values of variables whose names appear in the
27013 expressions are re-evaluated every time in the context of the current
27014 frame. Consider this example:
27015
27016 @smallexample
27017 void do_work(...)
27018 @{
27019 struct work_state state;
27020
27021 if (...)
27022 do_work(...);
27023 @}
27024 @end smallexample
27025
27026 If a fixed variable object for the @code{state} variable is created in
27027 this function, and we enter the recursive call, the the variable
27028 object will report the value of @code{state} in the top-level
27029 @code{do_work} invocation. On the other hand, a floating variable
27030 object will report the value of @code{state} in the current frame.
27031
27032 If an expression specified when creating a fixed variable object
27033 refers to a local variable, the variable object becomes bound to the
27034 thread and frame in which the variable object is created. When such
27035 variable object is updated, @value{GDBN} makes sure that the
27036 thread/frame combination the variable object is bound to still exists,
27037 and re-evaluates the variable object in context of that thread/frame.
27038
27039 The following is the complete set of @sc{gdb/mi} operations defined to
27040 access this functionality:
27041
27042 @multitable @columnfractions .4 .6
27043 @item @strong{Operation}
27044 @tab @strong{Description}
27045
27046 @item @code{-enable-pretty-printing}
27047 @tab enable Python-based pretty-printing
27048 @item @code{-var-create}
27049 @tab create a variable object
27050 @item @code{-var-delete}
27051 @tab delete the variable object and/or its children
27052 @item @code{-var-set-format}
27053 @tab set the display format of this variable
27054 @item @code{-var-show-format}
27055 @tab show the display format of this variable
27056 @item @code{-var-info-num-children}
27057 @tab tells how many children this object has
27058 @item @code{-var-list-children}
27059 @tab return a list of the object's children
27060 @item @code{-var-info-type}
27061 @tab show the type of this variable object
27062 @item @code{-var-info-expression}
27063 @tab print parent-relative expression that this variable object represents
27064 @item @code{-var-info-path-expression}
27065 @tab print full expression that this variable object represents
27066 @item @code{-var-show-attributes}
27067 @tab is this variable editable? does it exist here?
27068 @item @code{-var-evaluate-expression}
27069 @tab get the value of this variable
27070 @item @code{-var-assign}
27071 @tab set the value of this variable
27072 @item @code{-var-update}
27073 @tab update the variable and its children
27074 @item @code{-var-set-frozen}
27075 @tab set frozeness attribute
27076 @item @code{-var-set-update-range}
27077 @tab set range of children to display on update
27078 @end multitable
27079
27080 In the next subsection we describe each operation in detail and suggest
27081 how it can be used.
27082
27083 @subheading Description And Use of Operations on Variable Objects
27084
27085 @subheading The @code{-enable-pretty-printing} Command
27086 @findex -enable-pretty-printing
27087
27088 @smallexample
27089 -enable-pretty-printing
27090 @end smallexample
27091
27092 @value{GDBN} allows Python-based visualizers to affect the output of the
27093 MI variable object commands. However, because there was no way to
27094 implement this in a fully backward-compatible way, a front end must
27095 request that this functionality be enabled.
27096
27097 Once enabled, this feature cannot be disabled.
27098
27099 Note that if Python support has not been compiled into @value{GDBN},
27100 this command will still succeed (and do nothing).
27101
27102 This feature is currently (as of @value{GDBN} 7.0) experimental, and
27103 may work differently in future versions of @value{GDBN}.
27104
27105 @subheading The @code{-var-create} Command
27106 @findex -var-create
27107
27108 @subsubheading Synopsis
27109
27110 @smallexample
27111 -var-create @{@var{name} | "-"@}
27112 @{@var{frame-addr} | "*" | "@@"@} @var{expression}
27113 @end smallexample
27114
27115 This operation creates a variable object, which allows the monitoring of
27116 a variable, the result of an expression, a memory cell or a CPU
27117 register.
27118
27119 The @var{name} parameter is the string by which the object can be
27120 referenced. It must be unique. If @samp{-} is specified, the varobj
27121 system will generate a string ``varNNNNNN'' automatically. It will be
27122 unique provided that one does not specify @var{name} of that format.
27123 The command fails if a duplicate name is found.
27124
27125 The frame under which the expression should be evaluated can be
27126 specified by @var{frame-addr}. A @samp{*} indicates that the current
27127 frame should be used. A @samp{@@} indicates that a floating variable
27128 object must be created.
27129
27130 @var{expression} is any expression valid on the current language set (must not
27131 begin with a @samp{*}), or one of the following:
27132
27133 @itemize @bullet
27134 @item
27135 @samp{*@var{addr}}, where @var{addr} is the address of a memory cell
27136
27137 @item
27138 @samp{*@var{addr}-@var{addr}} --- a memory address range (TBD)
27139
27140 @item
27141 @samp{$@var{regname}} --- a CPU register name
27142 @end itemize
27143
27144 @cindex dynamic varobj
27145 A varobj's contents may be provided by a Python-based pretty-printer. In this
27146 case the varobj is known as a @dfn{dynamic varobj}. Dynamic varobjs
27147 have slightly different semantics in some cases. If the
27148 @code{-enable-pretty-printing} command is not sent, then @value{GDBN}
27149 will never create a dynamic varobj. This ensures backward
27150 compatibility for existing clients.
27151
27152 @subsubheading Result
27153
27154 This operation returns attributes of the newly-created varobj. These
27155 are:
27156
27157 @table @samp
27158 @item name
27159 The name of the varobj.
27160
27161 @item numchild
27162 The number of children of the varobj. This number is not necessarily
27163 reliable for a dynamic varobj. Instead, you must examine the
27164 @samp{has_more} attribute.
27165
27166 @item value
27167 The varobj's scalar value. For a varobj whose type is some sort of
27168 aggregate (e.g., a @code{struct}), or for a dynamic varobj, this value
27169 will not be interesting.
27170
27171 @item type
27172 The varobj's type. This is a string representation of the type, as
27173 would be printed by the @value{GDBN} CLI.
27174
27175 @item thread-id
27176 If a variable object is bound to a specific thread, then this is the
27177 thread's identifier.
27178
27179 @item has_more
27180 For a dynamic varobj, this indicates whether there appear to be any
27181 children available. For a non-dynamic varobj, this will be 0.
27182
27183 @item dynamic
27184 This attribute will be present and have the value @samp{1} if the
27185 varobj is a dynamic varobj. If the varobj is not a dynamic varobj,
27186 then this attribute will not be present.
27187
27188 @item displayhint
27189 A dynamic varobj can supply a display hint to the front end. The
27190 value comes directly from the Python pretty-printer object's
27191 @code{display_hint} method. @xref{Pretty Printing API}.
27192 @end table
27193
27194 Typical output will look like this:
27195
27196 @smallexample
27197 name="@var{name}",numchild="@var{N}",type="@var{type}",thread-id="@var{M}",
27198 has_more="@var{has_more}"
27199 @end smallexample
27200
27201
27202 @subheading The @code{-var-delete} Command
27203 @findex -var-delete
27204
27205 @subsubheading Synopsis
27206
27207 @smallexample
27208 -var-delete [ -c ] @var{name}
27209 @end smallexample
27210
27211 Deletes a previously created variable object and all of its children.
27212 With the @samp{-c} option, just deletes the children.
27213
27214 Returns an error if the object @var{name} is not found.
27215
27216
27217 @subheading The @code{-var-set-format} Command
27218 @findex -var-set-format
27219
27220 @subsubheading Synopsis
27221
27222 @smallexample
27223 -var-set-format @var{name} @var{format-spec}
27224 @end smallexample
27225
27226 Sets the output format for the value of the object @var{name} to be
27227 @var{format-spec}.
27228
27229 @anchor{-var-set-format}
27230 The syntax for the @var{format-spec} is as follows:
27231
27232 @smallexample
27233 @var{format-spec} @expansion{}
27234 @{binary | decimal | hexadecimal | octal | natural@}
27235 @end smallexample
27236
27237 The natural format is the default format choosen automatically
27238 based on the variable type (like decimal for an @code{int}, hex
27239 for pointers, etc.).
27240
27241 For a variable with children, the format is set only on the
27242 variable itself, and the children are not affected.
27243
27244 @subheading The @code{-var-show-format} Command
27245 @findex -var-show-format
27246
27247 @subsubheading Synopsis
27248
27249 @smallexample
27250 -var-show-format @var{name}
27251 @end smallexample
27252
27253 Returns the format used to display the value of the object @var{name}.
27254
27255 @smallexample
27256 @var{format} @expansion{}
27257 @var{format-spec}
27258 @end smallexample
27259
27260
27261 @subheading The @code{-var-info-num-children} Command
27262 @findex -var-info-num-children
27263
27264 @subsubheading Synopsis
27265
27266 @smallexample
27267 -var-info-num-children @var{name}
27268 @end smallexample
27269
27270 Returns the number of children of a variable object @var{name}:
27271
27272 @smallexample
27273 numchild=@var{n}
27274 @end smallexample
27275
27276 Note that this number is not completely reliable for a dynamic varobj.
27277 It will return the current number of children, but more children may
27278 be available.
27279
27280
27281 @subheading The @code{-var-list-children} Command
27282 @findex -var-list-children
27283
27284 @subsubheading Synopsis
27285
27286 @smallexample
27287 -var-list-children [@var{print-values}] @var{name} [@var{from} @var{to}]
27288 @end smallexample
27289 @anchor{-var-list-children}
27290
27291 Return a list of the children of the specified variable object and
27292 create variable objects for them, if they do not already exist. With
27293 a single argument or if @var{print-values} has a value of 0 or
27294 @code{--no-values}, print only the names of the variables; if
27295 @var{print-values} is 1 or @code{--all-values}, also print their
27296 values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values} print the name and
27297 value for simple data types and just the name for arrays, structures
27298 and unions.
27299
27300 @var{from} and @var{to}, if specified, indicate the range of children
27301 to report. If @var{from} or @var{to} is less than zero, the range is
27302 reset and all children will be reported. Otherwise, children starting
27303 at @var{from} (zero-based) and up to and excluding @var{to} will be
27304 reported.
27305
27306 If a child range is requested, it will only affect the current call to
27307 @code{-var-list-children}, but not future calls to @code{-var-update}.
27308 For this, you must instead use @code{-var-set-update-range}. The
27309 intent of this approach is to enable a front end to implement any
27310 update approach it likes; for example, scrolling a view may cause the
27311 front end to request more children with @code{-var-list-children}, and
27312 then the front end could call @code{-var-set-update-range} with a
27313 different range to ensure that future updates are restricted to just
27314 the visible items.
27315
27316 For each child the following results are returned:
27317
27318 @table @var
27319
27320 @item name
27321 Name of the variable object created for this child.
27322
27323 @item exp
27324 The expression to be shown to the user by the front end to designate this child.
27325 For example this may be the name of a structure member.
27326
27327 For a dynamic varobj, this value cannot be used to form an
27328 expression. There is no way to do this at all with a dynamic varobj.
27329
27330 For C/C@t{++} structures there are several pseudo children returned to
27331 designate access qualifiers. For these pseudo children @var{exp} is
27332 @samp{public}, @samp{private}, or @samp{protected}. In this case the
27333 type and value are not present.
27334
27335 A dynamic varobj will not report the access qualifying
27336 pseudo-children, regardless of the language. This information is not
27337 available at all with a dynamic varobj.
27338
27339 @item numchild
27340 Number of children this child has. For a dynamic varobj, this will be
27341 0.
27342
27343 @item type
27344 The type of the child.
27345
27346 @item value
27347 If values were requested, this is the value.
27348
27349 @item thread-id
27350 If this variable object is associated with a thread, this is the thread id.
27351 Otherwise this result is not present.
27352
27353 @item frozen
27354 If the variable object is frozen, this variable will be present with a value of 1.
27355 @end table
27356
27357 The result may have its own attributes:
27358
27359 @table @samp
27360 @item displayhint
27361 A dynamic varobj can supply a display hint to the front end. The
27362 value comes directly from the Python pretty-printer object's
27363 @code{display_hint} method. @xref{Pretty Printing API}.
27364
27365 @item has_more
27366 This is an integer attribute which is nonzero if there are children
27367 remaining after the end of the selected range.
27368 @end table
27369
27370 @subsubheading Example
27371
27372 @smallexample
27373 (gdb)
27374 -var-list-children n
27375 ^done,numchild=@var{n},children=[child=@{name=@var{name},exp=@var{exp},
27376 numchild=@var{n},type=@var{type}@},@r{(repeats N times)}]
27377 (gdb)
27378 -var-list-children --all-values n
27379 ^done,numchild=@var{n},children=[child=@{name=@var{name},exp=@var{exp},
27380 numchild=@var{n},value=@var{value},type=@var{type}@},@r{(repeats N times)}]
27381 @end smallexample
27382
27383
27384 @subheading The @code{-var-info-type} Command
27385 @findex -var-info-type
27386
27387 @subsubheading Synopsis
27388
27389 @smallexample
27390 -var-info-type @var{name}
27391 @end smallexample
27392
27393 Returns the type of the specified variable @var{name}. The type is
27394 returned as a string in the same format as it is output by the
27395 @value{GDBN} CLI:
27396
27397 @smallexample
27398 type=@var{typename}
27399 @end smallexample
27400
27401
27402 @subheading The @code{-var-info-expression} Command
27403 @findex -var-info-expression
27404
27405 @subsubheading Synopsis
27406
27407 @smallexample
27408 -var-info-expression @var{name}
27409 @end smallexample
27410
27411 Returns a string that is suitable for presenting this
27412 variable object in user interface. The string is generally
27413 not valid expression in the current language, and cannot be evaluated.
27414
27415 For example, if @code{a} is an array, and variable object
27416 @code{A} was created for @code{a}, then we'll get this output:
27417
27418 @smallexample
27419 (gdb) -var-info-expression A.1
27420 ^done,lang="C",exp="1"
27421 @end smallexample
27422
27423 @noindent
27424 Here, the values of @code{lang} can be @code{@{"C" | "C++" | "Java"@}}.
27425
27426 Note that the output of the @code{-var-list-children} command also
27427 includes those expressions, so the @code{-var-info-expression} command
27428 is of limited use.
27429
27430 @subheading The @code{-var-info-path-expression} Command
27431 @findex -var-info-path-expression
27432
27433 @subsubheading Synopsis
27434
27435 @smallexample
27436 -var-info-path-expression @var{name}
27437 @end smallexample
27438
27439 Returns an expression that can be evaluated in the current
27440 context and will yield the same value that a variable object has.
27441 Compare this with the @code{-var-info-expression} command, which
27442 result can be used only for UI presentation. Typical use of
27443 the @code{-var-info-path-expression} command is creating a
27444 watchpoint from a variable object.
27445
27446 This command is currently not valid for children of a dynamic varobj,
27447 and will give an error when invoked on one.
27448
27449 For example, suppose @code{C} is a C@t{++} class, derived from class
27450 @code{Base}, and that the @code{Base} class has a member called
27451 @code{m_size}. Assume a variable @code{c} is has the type of
27452 @code{C} and a variable object @code{C} was created for variable
27453 @code{c}. Then, we'll get this output:
27454 @smallexample
27455 (gdb) -var-info-path-expression C.Base.public.m_size
27456 ^done,path_expr=((Base)c).m_size)
27457 @end smallexample
27458
27459 @subheading The @code{-var-show-attributes} Command
27460 @findex -var-show-attributes
27461
27462 @subsubheading Synopsis
27463
27464 @smallexample
27465 -var-show-attributes @var{name}
27466 @end smallexample
27467
27468 List attributes of the specified variable object @var{name}:
27469
27470 @smallexample
27471 status=@var{attr} [ ( ,@var{attr} )* ]
27472 @end smallexample
27473
27474 @noindent
27475 where @var{attr} is @code{@{ @{ editable | noneditable @} | TBD @}}.
27476
27477 @subheading The @code{-var-evaluate-expression} Command
27478 @findex -var-evaluate-expression
27479
27480 @subsubheading Synopsis
27481
27482 @smallexample
27483 -var-evaluate-expression [-f @var{format-spec}] @var{name}
27484 @end smallexample
27485
27486 Evaluates the expression that is represented by the specified variable
27487 object and returns its value as a string. The format of the string
27488 can be specified with the @samp{-f} option. The possible values of
27489 this option are the same as for @code{-var-set-format}
27490 (@pxref{-var-set-format}). If the @samp{-f} option is not specified,
27491 the current display format will be used. The current display format
27492 can be changed using the @code{-var-set-format} command.
27493
27494 @smallexample
27495 value=@var{value}
27496 @end smallexample
27497
27498 Note that one must invoke @code{-var-list-children} for a variable
27499 before the value of a child variable can be evaluated.
27500
27501 @subheading The @code{-var-assign} Command
27502 @findex -var-assign
27503
27504 @subsubheading Synopsis
27505
27506 @smallexample
27507 -var-assign @var{name} @var{expression}
27508 @end smallexample
27509
27510 Assigns the value of @var{expression} to the variable object specified
27511 by @var{name}. The object must be @samp{editable}. If the variable's
27512 value is altered by the assign, the variable will show up in any
27513 subsequent @code{-var-update} list.
27514
27515 @subsubheading Example
27516
27517 @smallexample
27518 (gdb)
27519 -var-assign var1 3
27520 ^done,value="3"
27521 (gdb)
27522 -var-update *
27523 ^done,changelist=[@{name="var1",in_scope="true",type_changed="false"@}]
27524 (gdb)
27525 @end smallexample
27526
27527 @subheading The @code{-var-update} Command
27528 @findex -var-update
27529
27530 @subsubheading Synopsis
27531
27532 @smallexample
27533 -var-update [@var{print-values}] @{@var{name} | "*"@}
27534 @end smallexample
27535
27536 Reevaluate the expressions corresponding to the variable object
27537 @var{name} and all its direct and indirect children, and return the
27538 list of variable objects whose values have changed; @var{name} must
27539 be a root variable object. Here, ``changed'' means that the result of
27540 @code{-var-evaluate-expression} before and after the
27541 @code{-var-update} is different. If @samp{*} is used as the variable
27542 object names, all existing variable objects are updated, except
27543 for frozen ones (@pxref{-var-set-frozen}). The option
27544 @var{print-values} determines whether both names and values, or just
27545 names are printed. The possible values of this option are the same
27546 as for @code{-var-list-children} (@pxref{-var-list-children}). It is
27547 recommended to use the @samp{--all-values} option, to reduce the
27548 number of MI commands needed on each program stop.
27549
27550 With the @samp{*} parameter, if a variable object is bound to a
27551 currently running thread, it will not be updated, without any
27552 diagnostic.
27553
27554 If @code{-var-set-update-range} was previously used on a varobj, then
27555 only the selected range of children will be reported.
27556
27557 @code{-var-update} reports all the changed varobjs in a tuple named
27558 @samp{changelist}.
27559
27560 Each item in the change list is itself a tuple holding:
27561
27562 @table @samp
27563 @item name
27564 The name of the varobj.
27565
27566 @item value
27567 If values were requested for this update, then this field will be
27568 present and will hold the value of the varobj.
27569
27570 @item in_scope
27571 @anchor{-var-update}
27572 This field is a string which may take one of three values:
27573
27574 @table @code
27575 @item "true"
27576 The variable object's current value is valid.
27577
27578 @item "false"
27579 The variable object does not currently hold a valid value but it may
27580 hold one in the future if its associated expression comes back into
27581 scope.
27582
27583 @item "invalid"
27584 The variable object no longer holds a valid value.
27585 This can occur when the executable file being debugged has changed,
27586 either through recompilation or by using the @value{GDBN} @code{file}
27587 command. The front end should normally choose to delete these variable
27588 objects.
27589 @end table
27590
27591 In the future new values may be added to this list so the front should
27592 be prepared for this possibility. @xref{GDB/MI Development and Front Ends, ,@sc{GDB/MI} Development and Front Ends}.
27593
27594 @item type_changed
27595 This is only present if the varobj is still valid. If the type
27596 changed, then this will be the string @samp{true}; otherwise it will
27597 be @samp{false}.
27598
27599 @item new_type
27600 If the varobj's type changed, then this field will be present and will
27601 hold the new type.
27602
27603 @item new_num_children
27604 For a dynamic varobj, if the number of children changed, or if the
27605 type changed, this will be the new number of children.
27606
27607 The @samp{numchild} field in other varobj responses is generally not
27608 valid for a dynamic varobj -- it will show the number of children that
27609 @value{GDBN} knows about, but because dynamic varobjs lazily
27610 instantiate their children, this will not reflect the number of
27611 children which may be available.
27612
27613 The @samp{new_num_children} attribute only reports changes to the
27614 number of children known by @value{GDBN}. This is the only way to
27615 detect whether an update has removed children (which necessarily can
27616 only happen at the end of the update range).
27617
27618 @item displayhint
27619 The display hint, if any.
27620
27621 @item has_more
27622 This is an integer value, which will be 1 if there are more children
27623 available outside the varobj's update range.
27624
27625 @item dynamic
27626 This attribute will be present and have the value @samp{1} if the
27627 varobj is a dynamic varobj. If the varobj is not a dynamic varobj,
27628 then this attribute will not be present.
27629
27630 @item new_children
27631 If new children were added to a dynamic varobj within the selected
27632 update range (as set by @code{-var-set-update-range}), then they will
27633 be listed in this attribute.
27634 @end table
27635
27636 @subsubheading Example
27637
27638 @smallexample
27639 (gdb)
27640 -var-assign var1 3
27641 ^done,value="3"
27642 (gdb)
27643 -var-update --all-values var1
27644 ^done,changelist=[@{name="var1",value="3",in_scope="true",
27645 type_changed="false"@}]
27646 (gdb)
27647 @end smallexample
27648
27649 @subheading The @code{-var-set-frozen} Command
27650 @findex -var-set-frozen
27651 @anchor{-var-set-frozen}
27652
27653 @subsubheading Synopsis
27654
27655 @smallexample
27656 -var-set-frozen @var{name} @var{flag}
27657 @end smallexample
27658
27659 Set the frozenness flag on the variable object @var{name}. The
27660 @var{flag} parameter should be either @samp{1} to make the variable
27661 frozen or @samp{0} to make it unfrozen. If a variable object is
27662 frozen, then neither itself, nor any of its children, are
27663 implicitly updated by @code{-var-update} of
27664 a parent variable or by @code{-var-update *}. Only
27665 @code{-var-update} of the variable itself will update its value and
27666 values of its children. After a variable object is unfrozen, it is
27667 implicitly updated by all subsequent @code{-var-update} operations.
27668 Unfreezing a variable does not update it, only subsequent
27669 @code{-var-update} does.
27670
27671 @subsubheading Example
27672
27673 @smallexample
27674 (gdb)
27675 -var-set-frozen V 1
27676 ^done
27677 (gdb)
27678 @end smallexample
27679
27680 @subheading The @code{-var-set-update-range} command
27681 @findex -var-set-update-range
27682 @anchor{-var-set-update-range}
27683
27684 @subsubheading Synopsis
27685
27686 @smallexample
27687 -var-set-update-range @var{name} @var{from} @var{to}
27688 @end smallexample
27689
27690 Set the range of children to be returned by future invocations of
27691 @code{-var-update}.
27692
27693 @var{from} and @var{to} indicate the range of children to report. If
27694 @var{from} or @var{to} is less than zero, the range is reset and all
27695 children will be reported. Otherwise, children starting at @var{from}
27696 (zero-based) and up to and excluding @var{to} will be reported.
27697
27698 @subsubheading Example
27699
27700 @smallexample
27701 (gdb)
27702 -var-set-update-range V 1 2
27703 ^done
27704 @end smallexample
27705
27706 @subheading The @code{-var-set-visualizer} command
27707 @findex -var-set-visualizer
27708 @anchor{-var-set-visualizer}
27709
27710 @subsubheading Synopsis
27711
27712 @smallexample
27713 -var-set-visualizer @var{name} @var{visualizer}
27714 @end smallexample
27715
27716 Set a visualizer for the variable object @var{name}.
27717
27718 @var{visualizer} is the visualizer to use. The special value
27719 @samp{None} means to disable any visualizer in use.
27720
27721 If not @samp{None}, @var{visualizer} must be a Python expression.
27722 This expression must evaluate to a callable object which accepts a
27723 single argument. @value{GDBN} will call this object with the value of
27724 the varobj @var{name} as an argument (this is done so that the same
27725 Python pretty-printing code can be used for both the CLI and MI).
27726 When called, this object must return an object which conforms to the
27727 pretty-printing interface (@pxref{Pretty Printing API}).
27728
27729 The pre-defined function @code{gdb.default_visualizer} may be used to
27730 select a visualizer by following the built-in process
27731 (@pxref{Selecting Pretty-Printers}). This is done automatically when
27732 a varobj is created, and so ordinarily is not needed.
27733
27734 This feature is only available if Python support is enabled. The MI
27735 command @code{-list-features} (@pxref{GDB/MI Miscellaneous Commands})
27736 can be used to check this.
27737
27738 @subsubheading Example
27739
27740 Resetting the visualizer:
27741
27742 @smallexample
27743 (gdb)
27744 -var-set-visualizer V None
27745 ^done
27746 @end smallexample
27747
27748 Reselecting the default (type-based) visualizer:
27749
27750 @smallexample
27751 (gdb)
27752 -var-set-visualizer V gdb.default_visualizer
27753 ^done
27754 @end smallexample
27755
27756 Suppose @code{SomeClass} is a visualizer class. A lambda expression
27757 can be used to instantiate this class for a varobj:
27758
27759 @smallexample
27760 (gdb)
27761 -var-set-visualizer V "lambda val: SomeClass()"
27762 ^done
27763 @end smallexample
27764
27765 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
27766 @node GDB/MI Data Manipulation
27767 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Data Manipulation
27768
27769 @cindex data manipulation, in @sc{gdb/mi}
27770 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, data manipulation
27771 This section describes the @sc{gdb/mi} commands that manipulate data:
27772 examine memory and registers, evaluate expressions, etc.
27773
27774 @c REMOVED FROM THE INTERFACE.
27775 @c @subheading -data-assign
27776 @c Change the value of a program variable. Plenty of side effects.
27777 @c @subsubheading GDB Command
27778 @c set variable
27779 @c @subsubheading Example
27780 @c N.A.
27781
27782 @subheading The @code{-data-disassemble} Command
27783 @findex -data-disassemble
27784
27785 @subsubheading Synopsis
27786
27787 @smallexample
27788 -data-disassemble
27789 [ -s @var{start-addr} -e @var{end-addr} ]
27790 | [ -f @var{filename} -l @var{linenum} [ -n @var{lines} ] ]
27791 -- @var{mode}
27792 @end smallexample
27793
27794 @noindent
27795 Where:
27796
27797 @table @samp
27798 @item @var{start-addr}
27799 is the beginning address (or @code{$pc})
27800 @item @var{end-addr}
27801 is the end address
27802 @item @var{filename}
27803 is the name of the file to disassemble
27804 @item @var{linenum}
27805 is the line number to disassemble around
27806 @item @var{lines}
27807 is the number of disassembly lines to be produced. If it is -1,
27808 the whole function will be disassembled, in case no @var{end-addr} is
27809 specified. If @var{end-addr} is specified as a non-zero value, and
27810 @var{lines} is lower than the number of disassembly lines between
27811 @var{start-addr} and @var{end-addr}, only @var{lines} lines are
27812 displayed; if @var{lines} is higher than the number of lines between
27813 @var{start-addr} and @var{end-addr}, only the lines up to @var{end-addr}
27814 are displayed.
27815 @item @var{mode}
27816 is either 0 (meaning only disassembly), 1 (meaning mixed source and
27817 disassembly), 2 (meaning disassembly with raw opcodes), or 3 (meaning
27818 mixed source and disassembly with raw opcodes).
27819 @end table
27820
27821 @subsubheading Result
27822
27823 The output for each instruction is composed of four fields:
27824
27825 @itemize @bullet
27826 @item Address
27827 @item Func-name
27828 @item Offset
27829 @item Instruction
27830 @end itemize
27831
27832 Note that whatever included in the instruction field, is not manipulated
27833 directly by @sc{gdb/mi}, i.e., it is not possible to adjust its format.
27834
27835 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27836
27837 There's no direct mapping from this command to the CLI.
27838
27839 @subsubheading Example
27840
27841 Disassemble from the current value of @code{$pc} to @code{$pc + 20}:
27842
27843 @smallexample
27844 (gdb)
27845 -data-disassemble -s $pc -e "$pc + 20" -- 0
27846 ^done,
27847 asm_insns=[
27848 @{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
27849 inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
27850 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
27851 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@},
27852 @{address="0x000107c8",func-name="main",offset="12",
27853 inst="or %o2, 0x140, %o1\t! 0x11940 <_lib_version+8>"@},
27854 @{address="0x000107cc",func-name="main",offset="16",
27855 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@},
27856 @{address="0x000107d0",func-name="main",offset="20",
27857 inst="or %o2, 0x168, %o4\t! 0x11968 <_lib_version+48>"@}]
27858 (gdb)
27859 @end smallexample
27860
27861 Disassemble the whole @code{main} function. Line 32 is part of
27862 @code{main}.
27863
27864 @smallexample
27865 -data-disassemble -f basics.c -l 32 -- 0
27866 ^done,asm_insns=[
27867 @{address="0x000107bc",func-name="main",offset="0",
27868 inst="save %sp, -112, %sp"@},
27869 @{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
27870 inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
27871 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
27872 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@},
27873 [@dots{}]
27874 @{address="0x0001081c",func-name="main",offset="96",inst="ret "@},
27875 @{address="0x00010820",func-name="main",offset="100",inst="restore "@}]
27876 (gdb)
27877 @end smallexample
27878
27879 Disassemble 3 instructions from the start of @code{main}:
27880
27881 @smallexample
27882 (gdb)
27883 -data-disassemble -f basics.c -l 32 -n 3 -- 0
27884 ^done,asm_insns=[
27885 @{address="0x000107bc",func-name="main",offset="0",
27886 inst="save %sp, -112, %sp"@},
27887 @{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
27888 inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
27889 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
27890 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@}]
27891 (gdb)
27892 @end smallexample
27893
27894 Disassemble 3 instructions from the start of @code{main} in mixed mode:
27895
27896 @smallexample
27897 (gdb)
27898 -data-disassemble -f basics.c -l 32 -n 3 -- 1
27899 ^done,asm_insns=[
27900 src_and_asm_line=@{line="31",
27901 file="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb/ \
27902 testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line_asm_insn=[
27903 @{address="0x000107bc",func-name="main",offset="0",
27904 inst="save %sp, -112, %sp"@}]@},
27905 src_and_asm_line=@{line="32",
27906 file="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb/ \
27907 testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line_asm_insn=[
27908 @{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
27909 inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
27910 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
27911 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@}]@}]
27912 (gdb)
27913 @end smallexample
27914
27915
27916 @subheading The @code{-data-evaluate-expression} Command
27917 @findex -data-evaluate-expression
27918
27919 @subsubheading Synopsis
27920
27921 @smallexample
27922 -data-evaluate-expression @var{expr}
27923 @end smallexample
27924
27925 Evaluate @var{expr} as an expression. The expression could contain an
27926 inferior function call. The function call will execute synchronously.
27927 If the expression contains spaces, it must be enclosed in double quotes.
27928
27929 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27930
27931 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{print}, @samp{output}, and
27932 @samp{call}. In @code{gdbtk} only, there's a corresponding
27933 @samp{gdb_eval} command.
27934
27935 @subsubheading Example
27936
27937 In the following example, the numbers that precede the commands are the
27938 @dfn{tokens} described in @ref{GDB/MI Command Syntax, ,@sc{gdb/mi}
27939 Command Syntax}. Notice how @sc{gdb/mi} returns the same tokens in its
27940 output.
27941
27942 @smallexample
27943 211-data-evaluate-expression A
27944 211^done,value="1"
27945 (gdb)
27946 311-data-evaluate-expression &A
27947 311^done,value="0xefffeb7c"
27948 (gdb)
27949 411-data-evaluate-expression A+3
27950 411^done,value="4"
27951 (gdb)
27952 511-data-evaluate-expression "A + 3"
27953 511^done,value="4"
27954 (gdb)
27955 @end smallexample
27956
27957
27958 @subheading The @code{-data-list-changed-registers} Command
27959 @findex -data-list-changed-registers
27960
27961 @subsubheading Synopsis
27962
27963 @smallexample
27964 -data-list-changed-registers
27965 @end smallexample
27966
27967 Display a list of the registers that have changed.
27968
27969 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27970
27971 @value{GDBN} doesn't have a direct analog for this command; @code{gdbtk}
27972 has the corresponding command @samp{gdb_changed_register_list}.
27973
27974 @subsubheading Example
27975
27976 On a PPC MBX board:
27977
27978 @smallexample
27979 (gdb)
27980 -exec-continue
27981 ^running
27982
27983 (gdb)
27984 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",frame=@{
27985 func="main",args=[],file="try.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",
27986 line="5"@}
27987 (gdb)
27988 -data-list-changed-registers
27989 ^done,changed-registers=["0","1","2","4","5","6","7","8","9",
27990 "10","11","13","14","15","16","17","18","19","20","21","22","23",
27991 "24","25","26","27","28","30","31","64","65","66","67","69"]
27992 (gdb)
27993 @end smallexample
27994
27995
27996 @subheading The @code{-data-list-register-names} Command
27997 @findex -data-list-register-names
27998
27999 @subsubheading Synopsis
28000
28001 @smallexample
28002 -data-list-register-names [ ( @var{regno} )+ ]
28003 @end smallexample
28004
28005 Show a list of register names for the current target. If no arguments
28006 are given, it shows a list of the names of all the registers. If
28007 integer numbers are given as arguments, it will print a list of the
28008 names of the registers corresponding to the arguments. To ensure
28009 consistency between a register name and its number, the output list may
28010 include empty register names.
28011
28012 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28013
28014 @value{GDBN} does not have a command which corresponds to
28015 @samp{-data-list-register-names}. In @code{gdbtk} there is a
28016 corresponding command @samp{gdb_regnames}.
28017
28018 @subsubheading Example
28019
28020 For the PPC MBX board:
28021 @smallexample
28022 (gdb)
28023 -data-list-register-names
28024 ^done,register-names=["r0","r1","r2","r3","r4","r5","r6","r7",
28025 "r8","r9","r10","r11","r12","r13","r14","r15","r16","r17","r18",
28026 "r19","r20","r21","r22","r23","r24","r25","r26","r27","r28","r29",
28027 "r30","r31","f0","f1","f2","f3","f4","f5","f6","f7","f8","f9",
28028 "f10","f11","f12","f13","f14","f15","f16","f17","f18","f19","f20",
28029 "f21","f22","f23","f24","f25","f26","f27","f28","f29","f30","f31",
28030 "", "pc","ps","cr","lr","ctr","xer"]
28031 (gdb)
28032 -data-list-register-names 1 2 3
28033 ^done,register-names=["r1","r2","r3"]
28034 (gdb)
28035 @end smallexample
28036
28037 @subheading The @code{-data-list-register-values} Command
28038 @findex -data-list-register-values
28039
28040 @subsubheading Synopsis
28041
28042 @smallexample
28043 -data-list-register-values @var{fmt} [ ( @var{regno} )*]
28044 @end smallexample
28045
28046 Display the registers' contents. @var{fmt} is the format according to
28047 which the registers' contents are to be returned, followed by an optional
28048 list of numbers specifying the registers to display. A missing list of
28049 numbers indicates that the contents of all the registers must be returned.
28050
28051 Allowed formats for @var{fmt} are:
28052
28053 @table @code
28054 @item x
28055 Hexadecimal
28056 @item o
28057 Octal
28058 @item t
28059 Binary
28060 @item d
28061 Decimal
28062 @item r
28063 Raw
28064 @item N
28065 Natural
28066 @end table
28067
28068 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28069
28070 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{info reg}, @samp{info
28071 all-reg}, and (in @code{gdbtk}) @samp{gdb_fetch_registers}.
28072
28073 @subsubheading Example
28074
28075 For a PPC MBX board (note: line breaks are for readability only, they
28076 don't appear in the actual output):
28077
28078 @smallexample
28079 (gdb)
28080 -data-list-register-values r 64 65
28081 ^done,register-values=[@{number="64",value="0xfe00a300"@},
28082 @{number="65",value="0x00029002"@}]
28083 (gdb)
28084 -data-list-register-values x
28085 ^done,register-values=[@{number="0",value="0xfe0043c8"@},
28086 @{number="1",value="0x3fff88"@},@{number="2",value="0xfffffffe"@},
28087 @{number="3",value="0x0"@},@{number="4",value="0xa"@},
28088 @{number="5",value="0x3fff68"@},@{number="6",value="0x3fff58"@},
28089 @{number="7",value="0xfe011e98"@},@{number="8",value="0x2"@},
28090 @{number="9",value="0xfa202820"@},@{number="10",value="0xfa202808"@},
28091 @{number="11",value="0x1"@},@{number="12",value="0x0"@},
28092 @{number="13",value="0x4544"@},@{number="14",value="0xffdfffff"@},
28093 @{number="15",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="16",value="0xfffffeff"@},
28094 @{number="17",value="0xefffffed"@},@{number="18",value="0xfffffffe"@},
28095 @{number="19",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="20",value="0xffffffff"@},
28096 @{number="21",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="22",value="0xfffffff7"@},
28097 @{number="23",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="24",value="0xffffffff"@},
28098 @{number="25",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="26",value="0xfffffffb"@},
28099 @{number="27",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="28",value="0xf7bfffff"@},
28100 @{number="29",value="0x0"@},@{number="30",value="0xfe010000"@},
28101 @{number="31",value="0x0"@},@{number="32",value="0x0"@},
28102 @{number="33",value="0x0"@},@{number="34",value="0x0"@},
28103 @{number="35",value="0x0"@},@{number="36",value="0x0"@},
28104 @{number="37",value="0x0"@},@{number="38",value="0x0"@},
28105 @{number="39",value="0x0"@},@{number="40",value="0x0"@},
28106 @{number="41",value="0x0"@},@{number="42",value="0x0"@},
28107 @{number="43",value="0x0"@},@{number="44",value="0x0"@},
28108 @{number="45",value="0x0"@},@{number="46",value="0x0"@},
28109 @{number="47",value="0x0"@},@{number="48",value="0x0"@},
28110 @{number="49",value="0x0"@},@{number="50",value="0x0"@},
28111 @{number="51",value="0x0"@},@{number="52",value="0x0"@},
28112 @{number="53",value="0x0"@},@{number="54",value="0x0"@},
28113 @{number="55",value="0x0"@},@{number="56",value="0x0"@},
28114 @{number="57",value="0x0"@},@{number="58",value="0x0"@},
28115 @{number="59",value="0x0"@},@{number="60",value="0x0"@},
28116 @{number="61",value="0x0"@},@{number="62",value="0x0"@},
28117 @{number="63",value="0x0"@},@{number="64",value="0xfe00a300"@},
28118 @{number="65",value="0x29002"@},@{number="66",value="0x202f04b5"@},
28119 @{number="67",value="0xfe0043b0"@},@{number="68",value="0xfe00b3e4"@},
28120 @{number="69",value="0x20002b03"@}]
28121 (gdb)
28122 @end smallexample
28123
28124
28125 @subheading The @code{-data-read-memory} Command
28126 @findex -data-read-memory
28127
28128 This command is deprecated, use @code{-data-read-memory-bytes} instead.
28129
28130 @subsubheading Synopsis
28131
28132 @smallexample
28133 -data-read-memory [ -o @var{byte-offset} ]
28134 @var{address} @var{word-format} @var{word-size}
28135 @var{nr-rows} @var{nr-cols} [ @var{aschar} ]
28136 @end smallexample
28137
28138 @noindent
28139 where:
28140
28141 @table @samp
28142 @item @var{address}
28143 An expression specifying the address of the first memory word to be
28144 read. Complex expressions containing embedded white space should be
28145 quoted using the C convention.
28146
28147 @item @var{word-format}
28148 The format to be used to print the memory words. The notation is the
28149 same as for @value{GDBN}'s @code{print} command (@pxref{Output Formats,
28150 ,Output Formats}).
28151
28152 @item @var{word-size}
28153 The size of each memory word in bytes.
28154
28155 @item @var{nr-rows}
28156 The number of rows in the output table.
28157
28158 @item @var{nr-cols}
28159 The number of columns in the output table.
28160
28161 @item @var{aschar}
28162 If present, indicates that each row should include an @sc{ascii} dump. The
28163 value of @var{aschar} is used as a padding character when a byte is not a
28164 member of the printable @sc{ascii} character set (printable @sc{ascii}
28165 characters are those whose code is between 32 and 126, inclusively).
28166
28167 @item @var{byte-offset}
28168 An offset to add to the @var{address} before fetching memory.
28169 @end table
28170
28171 This command displays memory contents as a table of @var{nr-rows} by
28172 @var{nr-cols} words, each word being @var{word-size} bytes. In total,
28173 @code{@var{nr-rows} * @var{nr-cols} * @var{word-size}} bytes are read
28174 (returned as @samp{total-bytes}). Should less than the requested number
28175 of bytes be returned by the target, the missing words are identified
28176 using @samp{N/A}. The number of bytes read from the target is returned
28177 in @samp{nr-bytes} and the starting address used to read memory in
28178 @samp{addr}.
28179
28180 The address of the next/previous row or page is available in
28181 @samp{next-row} and @samp{prev-row}, @samp{next-page} and
28182 @samp{prev-page}.
28183
28184 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28185
28186 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{x}. @code{gdbtk} has
28187 @samp{gdb_get_mem} memory read command.
28188
28189 @subsubheading Example
28190
28191 Read six bytes of memory starting at @code{bytes+6} but then offset by
28192 @code{-6} bytes. Format as three rows of two columns. One byte per
28193 word. Display each word in hex.
28194
28195 @smallexample
28196 (gdb)
28197 9-data-read-memory -o -6 -- bytes+6 x 1 3 2
28198 9^done,addr="0x00001390",nr-bytes="6",total-bytes="6",
28199 next-row="0x00001396",prev-row="0x0000138e",next-page="0x00001396",
28200 prev-page="0x0000138a",memory=[
28201 @{addr="0x00001390",data=["0x00","0x01"]@},
28202 @{addr="0x00001392",data=["0x02","0x03"]@},
28203 @{addr="0x00001394",data=["0x04","0x05"]@}]
28204 (gdb)
28205 @end smallexample
28206
28207 Read two bytes of memory starting at address @code{shorts + 64} and
28208 display as a single word formatted in decimal.
28209
28210 @smallexample
28211 (gdb)
28212 5-data-read-memory shorts+64 d 2 1 1
28213 5^done,addr="0x00001510",nr-bytes="2",total-bytes="2",
28214 next-row="0x00001512",prev-row="0x0000150e",
28215 next-page="0x00001512",prev-page="0x0000150e",memory=[
28216 @{addr="0x00001510",data=["128"]@}]
28217 (gdb)
28218 @end smallexample
28219
28220 Read thirty two bytes of memory starting at @code{bytes+16} and format
28221 as eight rows of four columns. Include a string encoding with @samp{x}
28222 used as the non-printable character.
28223
28224 @smallexample
28225 (gdb)
28226 4-data-read-memory bytes+16 x 1 8 4 x
28227 4^done,addr="0x000013a0",nr-bytes="32",total-bytes="32",
28228 next-row="0x000013c0",prev-row="0x0000139c",
28229 next-page="0x000013c0",prev-page="0x00001380",memory=[
28230 @{addr="0x000013a0",data=["0x10","0x11","0x12","0x13"],ascii="xxxx"@},
28231 @{addr="0x000013a4",data=["0x14","0x15","0x16","0x17"],ascii="xxxx"@},
28232 @{addr="0x000013a8",data=["0x18","0x19","0x1a","0x1b"],ascii="xxxx"@},
28233 @{addr="0x000013ac",data=["0x1c","0x1d","0x1e","0x1f"],ascii="xxxx"@},
28234 @{addr="0x000013b0",data=["0x20","0x21","0x22","0x23"],ascii=" !\"#"@},
28235 @{addr="0x000013b4",data=["0x24","0x25","0x26","0x27"],ascii="$%&'"@},
28236 @{addr="0x000013b8",data=["0x28","0x29","0x2a","0x2b"],ascii="()*+"@},
28237 @{addr="0x000013bc",data=["0x2c","0x2d","0x2e","0x2f"],ascii=",-./"@}]
28238 (gdb)
28239 @end smallexample
28240
28241 @subheading The @code{-data-read-memory-bytes} Command
28242 @findex -data-read-memory-bytes
28243
28244 @subsubheading Synopsis
28245
28246 @smallexample
28247 -data-read-memory-bytes [ -o @var{byte-offset} ]
28248 @var{address} @var{count}
28249 @end smallexample
28250
28251 @noindent
28252 where:
28253
28254 @table @samp
28255 @item @var{address}
28256 An expression specifying the address of the first memory word to be
28257 read. Complex expressions containing embedded white space should be
28258 quoted using the C convention.
28259
28260 @item @var{count}
28261 The number of bytes to read. This should be an integer literal.
28262
28263 @item @var{byte-offset}
28264 The offsets in bytes relative to @var{address} at which to start
28265 reading. This should be an integer literal. This option is provided
28266 so that a frontend is not required to first evaluate address and then
28267 perform address arithmetics itself.
28268
28269 @end table
28270
28271 This command attempts to read all accessible memory regions in the
28272 specified range. First, all regions marked as unreadable in the memory
28273 map (if one is defined) will be skipped. @xref{Memory Region
28274 Attributes}. Second, @value{GDBN} will attempt to read the remaining
28275 regions. For each one, if reading full region results in an errors,
28276 @value{GDBN} will try to read a subset of the region.
28277
28278 In general, every single byte in the region may be readable or not,
28279 and the only way to read every readable byte is to try a read at
28280 every address, which is not practical. Therefore, @value{GDBN} will
28281 attempt to read all accessible bytes at either beginning or the end
28282 of the region, using a binary division scheme. This heuristic works
28283 well for reading accross a memory map boundary. Note that if a region
28284 has a readable range that is neither at the beginning or the end,
28285 @value{GDBN} will not read it.
28286
28287 The result record (@pxref{GDB/MI Result Records}) that is output of
28288 the command includes a field named @samp{memory} whose content is a
28289 list of tuples. Each tuple represent a successfully read memory block
28290 and has the following fields:
28291
28292 @table @code
28293 @item begin
28294 The start address of the memory block, as hexadecimal literal.
28295
28296 @item end
28297 The end address of the memory block, as hexadecimal literal.
28298
28299 @item offset
28300 The offset of the memory block, as hexadecimal literal, relative to
28301 the start address passed to @code{-data-read-memory-bytes}.
28302
28303 @item contents
28304 The contents of the memory block, in hex.
28305
28306 @end table
28307
28308
28309
28310 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28311
28312 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{x}.
28313
28314 @subsubheading Example
28315
28316 @smallexample
28317 (gdb)
28318 -data-read-memory-bytes &a 10
28319 ^done,memory=[@{begin="0xbffff154",offset="0x00000000",
28320 end="0xbffff15e",
28321 contents="01000000020000000300"@}]
28322 (gdb)
28323 @end smallexample
28324
28325
28326 @subheading The @code{-data-write-memory-bytes} Command
28327 @findex -data-write-memory-bytes
28328
28329 @subsubheading Synopsis
28330
28331 @smallexample
28332 -data-write-memory-bytes @var{address} @var{contents}
28333 @end smallexample
28334
28335 @noindent
28336 where:
28337
28338 @table @samp
28339 @item @var{address}
28340 An expression specifying the address of the first memory word to be
28341 read. Complex expressions containing embedded white space should be
28342 quoted using the C convention.
28343
28344 @item @var{contents}
28345 The hex-encoded bytes to write.
28346
28347 @end table
28348
28349 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28350
28351 There's no corresponding @value{GDBN} command.
28352
28353 @subsubheading Example
28354
28355 @smallexample
28356 (gdb)
28357 -data-write-memory-bytes &a "aabbccdd"
28358 ^done
28359 (gdb)
28360 @end smallexample
28361
28362
28363 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
28364 @node GDB/MI Tracepoint Commands
28365 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Tracepoint Commands
28366
28367 The commands defined in this section implement MI support for
28368 tracepoints. For detailed introduction, see @ref{Tracepoints}.
28369
28370 @subheading The @code{-trace-find} Command
28371 @findex -trace-find
28372
28373 @subsubheading Synopsis
28374
28375 @smallexample
28376 -trace-find @var{mode} [@var{parameters}@dots{}]
28377 @end smallexample
28378
28379 Find a trace frame using criteria defined by @var{mode} and
28380 @var{parameters}. The following table lists permissible
28381 modes and their parameters. For details of operation, see @ref{tfind}.
28382
28383 @table @samp
28384
28385 @item none
28386 No parameters are required. Stops examining trace frames.
28387
28388 @item frame-number
28389 An integer is required as parameter. Selects tracepoint frame with
28390 that index.
28391
28392 @item tracepoint-number
28393 An integer is required as parameter. Finds next
28394 trace frame that corresponds to tracepoint with the specified number.
28395
28396 @item pc
28397 An address is required as parameter. Finds
28398 next trace frame that corresponds to any tracepoint at the specified
28399 address.
28400
28401 @item pc-inside-range
28402 Two addresses are required as parameters. Finds next trace
28403 frame that corresponds to a tracepoint at an address inside the
28404 specified range. Both bounds are considered to be inside the range.
28405
28406 @item pc-outside-range
28407 Two addresses are required as parameters. Finds
28408 next trace frame that corresponds to a tracepoint at an address outside
28409 the specified range. Both bounds are considered to be inside the range.
28410
28411 @item line
28412 Line specification is required as parameter. @xref{Specify Location}.
28413 Finds next trace frame that corresponds to a tracepoint at
28414 the specified location.
28415
28416 @end table
28417
28418 If @samp{none} was passed as @var{mode}, the response does not
28419 have fields. Otherwise, the response may have the following fields:
28420
28421 @table @samp
28422 @item found
28423 This field has either @samp{0} or @samp{1} as the value, depending
28424 on whether a matching tracepoint was found.
28425
28426 @item traceframe
28427 The index of the found traceframe. This field is present iff
28428 the @samp{found} field has value of @samp{1}.
28429
28430 @item tracepoint
28431 The index of the found tracepoint. This field is present iff
28432 the @samp{found} field has value of @samp{1}.
28433
28434 @item frame
28435 The information about the frame corresponding to the found trace
28436 frame. This field is present only if a trace frame was found.
28437 @xref{GDB/MI Frame Information}, for description of this field.
28438
28439 @end table
28440
28441 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28442
28443 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tfind}.
28444
28445 @subheading -trace-define-variable
28446 @findex -trace-define-variable
28447
28448 @subsubheading Synopsis
28449
28450 @smallexample
28451 -trace-define-variable @var{name} [ @var{value} ]
28452 @end smallexample
28453
28454 Create trace variable @var{name} if it does not exist. If
28455 @var{value} is specified, sets the initial value of the specified
28456 trace variable to that value. Note that the @var{name} should start
28457 with the @samp{$} character.
28458
28459 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28460
28461 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tvariable}.
28462
28463 @subheading -trace-list-variables
28464 @findex -trace-list-variables
28465
28466 @subsubheading Synopsis
28467
28468 @smallexample
28469 -trace-list-variables
28470 @end smallexample
28471
28472 Return a table of all defined trace variables. Each element of the
28473 table has the following fields:
28474
28475 @table @samp
28476 @item name
28477 The name of the trace variable. This field is always present.
28478
28479 @item initial
28480 The initial value. This is a 64-bit signed integer. This
28481 field is always present.
28482
28483 @item current
28484 The value the trace variable has at the moment. This is a 64-bit
28485 signed integer. This field is absent iff current value is
28486 not defined, for example if the trace was never run, or is
28487 presently running.
28488
28489 @end table
28490
28491 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28492
28493 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tvariables}.
28494
28495 @subsubheading Example
28496
28497 @smallexample
28498 (gdb)
28499 -trace-list-variables
28500 ^done,trace-variables=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="3",
28501 hdr=[@{width="15",alignment="-1",col_name="name",colhdr="Name"@},
28502 @{width="11",alignment="-1",col_name="initial",colhdr="Initial"@},
28503 @{width="11",alignment="-1",col_name="current",colhdr="Current"@}],
28504 body=[variable=@{name="$trace_timestamp",initial="0"@}
28505 variable=@{name="$foo",initial="10",current="15"@}]@}
28506 (gdb)
28507 @end smallexample
28508
28509 @subheading -trace-save
28510 @findex -trace-save
28511
28512 @subsubheading Synopsis
28513
28514 @smallexample
28515 -trace-save [-r ] @var{filename}
28516 @end smallexample
28517
28518 Saves the collected trace data to @var{filename}. Without the
28519 @samp{-r} option, the data is downloaded from the target and saved
28520 in a local file. With the @samp{-r} option the target is asked
28521 to perform the save.
28522
28523 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28524
28525 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tsave}.
28526
28527
28528 @subheading -trace-start
28529 @findex -trace-start
28530
28531 @subsubheading Synopsis
28532
28533 @smallexample
28534 -trace-start
28535 @end smallexample
28536
28537 Starts a tracing experiments. The result of this command does not
28538 have any fields.
28539
28540 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28541
28542 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tstart}.
28543
28544 @subheading -trace-status
28545 @findex -trace-status
28546
28547 @subsubheading Synopsis
28548
28549 @smallexample
28550 -trace-status
28551 @end smallexample
28552
28553 Obtains the status of a tracing experiment. The result may include
28554 the following fields:
28555
28556 @table @samp
28557
28558 @item supported
28559 May have a value of either @samp{0}, when no tracing operations are
28560 supported, @samp{1}, when all tracing operations are supported, or
28561 @samp{file} when examining trace file. In the latter case, examining
28562 of trace frame is possible but new tracing experiement cannot be
28563 started. This field is always present.
28564
28565 @item running
28566 May have a value of either @samp{0} or @samp{1} depending on whether
28567 tracing experiement is in progress on target. This field is present
28568 if @samp{supported} field is not @samp{0}.
28569
28570 @item stop-reason
28571 Report the reason why the tracing was stopped last time. This field
28572 may be absent iff tracing was never stopped on target yet. The
28573 value of @samp{request} means the tracing was stopped as result of
28574 the @code{-trace-stop} command. The value of @samp{overflow} means
28575 the tracing buffer is full. The value of @samp{disconnection} means
28576 tracing was automatically stopped when @value{GDBN} has disconnected.
28577 The value of @samp{passcount} means tracing was stopped when a
28578 tracepoint was passed a maximal number of times for that tracepoint.
28579 This field is present if @samp{supported} field is not @samp{0}.
28580
28581 @item stopping-tracepoint
28582 The number of tracepoint whose passcount as exceeded. This field is
28583 present iff the @samp{stop-reason} field has the value of
28584 @samp{passcount}.
28585
28586 @item frames
28587 @itemx frames-created
28588 The @samp{frames} field is a count of the total number of trace frames
28589 in the trace buffer, while @samp{frames-created} is the total created
28590 during the run, including ones that were discarded, such as when a
28591 circular trace buffer filled up. Both fields are optional.
28592
28593 @item buffer-size
28594 @itemx buffer-free
28595 These fields tell the current size of the tracing buffer and the
28596 remaining space. These fields are optional.
28597
28598 @item circular
28599 The value of the circular trace buffer flag. @code{1} means that the
28600 trace buffer is circular and old trace frames will be discarded if
28601 necessary to make room, @code{0} means that the trace buffer is linear
28602 and may fill up.
28603
28604 @item disconnected
28605 The value of the disconnected tracing flag. @code{1} means that
28606 tracing will continue after @value{GDBN} disconnects, @code{0} means
28607 that the trace run will stop.
28608
28609 @end table
28610
28611 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28612
28613 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tstatus}.
28614
28615 @subheading -trace-stop
28616 @findex -trace-stop
28617
28618 @subsubheading Synopsis
28619
28620 @smallexample
28621 -trace-stop
28622 @end smallexample
28623
28624 Stops a tracing experiment. The result of this command has the same
28625 fields as @code{-trace-status}, except that the @samp{supported} and
28626 @samp{running} fields are not output.
28627
28628 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28629
28630 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tstop}.
28631
28632
28633 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
28634 @node GDB/MI Symbol Query
28635 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Symbol Query Commands
28636
28637
28638 @ignore
28639 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-address} Command
28640 @findex -symbol-info-address
28641
28642 @subsubheading Synopsis
28643
28644 @smallexample
28645 -symbol-info-address @var{symbol}
28646 @end smallexample
28647
28648 Describe where @var{symbol} is stored.
28649
28650 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28651
28652 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info address}.
28653
28654 @subsubheading Example
28655 N.A.
28656
28657
28658 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-file} Command
28659 @findex -symbol-info-file
28660
28661 @subsubheading Synopsis
28662
28663 @smallexample
28664 -symbol-info-file
28665 @end smallexample
28666
28667 Show the file for the symbol.
28668
28669 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28670
28671 There's no equivalent @value{GDBN} command. @code{gdbtk} has
28672 @samp{gdb_find_file}.
28673
28674 @subsubheading Example
28675 N.A.
28676
28677
28678 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-function} Command
28679 @findex -symbol-info-function
28680
28681 @subsubheading Synopsis
28682
28683 @smallexample
28684 -symbol-info-function
28685 @end smallexample
28686
28687 Show which function the symbol lives in.
28688
28689 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28690
28691 @samp{gdb_get_function} in @code{gdbtk}.
28692
28693 @subsubheading Example
28694 N.A.
28695
28696
28697 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-line} Command
28698 @findex -symbol-info-line
28699
28700 @subsubheading Synopsis
28701
28702 @smallexample
28703 -symbol-info-line
28704 @end smallexample
28705
28706 Show the core addresses of the code for a source line.
28707
28708 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28709
28710 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info line}.
28711 @code{gdbtk} has the @samp{gdb_get_line} and @samp{gdb_get_file} commands.
28712
28713 @subsubheading Example
28714 N.A.
28715
28716
28717 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-symbol} Command
28718 @findex -symbol-info-symbol
28719
28720 @subsubheading Synopsis
28721
28722 @smallexample
28723 -symbol-info-symbol @var{addr}
28724 @end smallexample
28725
28726 Describe what symbol is at location @var{addr}.
28727
28728 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28729
28730 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info symbol}.
28731
28732 @subsubheading Example
28733 N.A.
28734
28735
28736 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-functions} Command
28737 @findex -symbol-list-functions
28738
28739 @subsubheading Synopsis
28740
28741 @smallexample
28742 -symbol-list-functions
28743 @end smallexample
28744
28745 List the functions in the executable.
28746
28747 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28748
28749 @samp{info functions} in @value{GDBN}, @samp{gdb_listfunc} and
28750 @samp{gdb_search} in @code{gdbtk}.
28751
28752 @subsubheading Example
28753 N.A.
28754 @end ignore
28755
28756
28757 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-lines} Command
28758 @findex -symbol-list-lines
28759
28760 @subsubheading Synopsis
28761
28762 @smallexample
28763 -symbol-list-lines @var{filename}
28764 @end smallexample
28765
28766 Print the list of lines that contain code and their associated program
28767 addresses for the given source filename. The entries are sorted in
28768 ascending PC order.
28769
28770 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28771
28772 There is no corresponding @value{GDBN} command.
28773
28774 @subsubheading Example
28775 @smallexample
28776 (gdb)
28777 -symbol-list-lines basics.c
28778 ^done,lines=[@{pc="0x08048554",line="7"@},@{pc="0x0804855a",line="8"@}]
28779 (gdb)
28780 @end smallexample
28781
28782
28783 @ignore
28784 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-types} Command
28785 @findex -symbol-list-types
28786
28787 @subsubheading Synopsis
28788
28789 @smallexample
28790 -symbol-list-types
28791 @end smallexample
28792
28793 List all the type names.
28794
28795 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28796
28797 The corresponding commands are @samp{info types} in @value{GDBN},
28798 @samp{gdb_search} in @code{gdbtk}.
28799
28800 @subsubheading Example
28801 N.A.
28802
28803
28804 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-variables} Command
28805 @findex -symbol-list-variables
28806
28807 @subsubheading Synopsis
28808
28809 @smallexample
28810 -symbol-list-variables
28811 @end smallexample
28812
28813 List all the global and static variable names.
28814
28815 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28816
28817 @samp{info variables} in @value{GDBN}, @samp{gdb_search} in @code{gdbtk}.
28818
28819 @subsubheading Example
28820 N.A.
28821
28822
28823 @subheading The @code{-symbol-locate} Command
28824 @findex -symbol-locate
28825
28826 @subsubheading Synopsis
28827
28828 @smallexample
28829 -symbol-locate
28830 @end smallexample
28831
28832 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28833
28834 @samp{gdb_loc} in @code{gdbtk}.
28835
28836 @subsubheading Example
28837 N.A.
28838
28839
28840 @subheading The @code{-symbol-type} Command
28841 @findex -symbol-type
28842
28843 @subsubheading Synopsis
28844
28845 @smallexample
28846 -symbol-type @var{variable}
28847 @end smallexample
28848
28849 Show type of @var{variable}.
28850
28851 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28852
28853 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{ptype}, @code{gdbtk} has
28854 @samp{gdb_obj_variable}.
28855
28856 @subsubheading Example
28857 N.A.
28858 @end ignore
28859
28860
28861 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
28862 @node GDB/MI File Commands
28863 @section @sc{gdb/mi} File Commands
28864
28865 This section describes the GDB/MI commands to specify executable file names
28866 and to read in and obtain symbol table information.
28867
28868 @subheading The @code{-file-exec-and-symbols} Command
28869 @findex -file-exec-and-symbols
28870
28871 @subsubheading Synopsis
28872
28873 @smallexample
28874 -file-exec-and-symbols @var{file}
28875 @end smallexample
28876
28877 Specify the executable file to be debugged. This file is the one from
28878 which the symbol table is also read. If no file is specified, the
28879 command clears the executable and symbol information. If breakpoints
28880 are set when using this command with no arguments, @value{GDBN} will produce
28881 error messages. Otherwise, no output is produced, except a completion
28882 notification.
28883
28884 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28885
28886 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{file}.
28887
28888 @subsubheading Example
28889
28890 @smallexample
28891 (gdb)
28892 -file-exec-and-symbols /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/TRUNK/mbx/hello.mbx
28893 ^done
28894 (gdb)
28895 @end smallexample
28896
28897
28898 @subheading The @code{-file-exec-file} Command
28899 @findex -file-exec-file
28900
28901 @subsubheading Synopsis
28902
28903 @smallexample
28904 -file-exec-file @var{file}
28905 @end smallexample
28906
28907 Specify the executable file to be debugged. Unlike
28908 @samp{-file-exec-and-symbols}, the symbol table is @emph{not} read
28909 from this file. If used without argument, @value{GDBN} clears the information
28910 about the executable file. No output is produced, except a completion
28911 notification.
28912
28913 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28914
28915 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{exec-file}.
28916
28917 @subsubheading Example
28918
28919 @smallexample
28920 (gdb)
28921 -file-exec-file /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/TRUNK/mbx/hello.mbx
28922 ^done
28923 (gdb)
28924 @end smallexample
28925
28926
28927 @ignore
28928 @subheading The @code{-file-list-exec-sections} Command
28929 @findex -file-list-exec-sections
28930
28931 @subsubheading Synopsis
28932
28933 @smallexample
28934 -file-list-exec-sections
28935 @end smallexample
28936
28937 List the sections of the current executable file.
28938
28939 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28940
28941 The @value{GDBN} command @samp{info file} shows, among the rest, the same
28942 information as this command. @code{gdbtk} has a corresponding command
28943 @samp{gdb_load_info}.
28944
28945 @subsubheading Example
28946 N.A.
28947 @end ignore
28948
28949
28950 @subheading The @code{-file-list-exec-source-file} Command
28951 @findex -file-list-exec-source-file
28952
28953 @subsubheading Synopsis
28954
28955 @smallexample
28956 -file-list-exec-source-file
28957 @end smallexample
28958
28959 List the line number, the current source file, and the absolute path
28960 to the current source file for the current executable. The macro
28961 information field has a value of @samp{1} or @samp{0} depending on
28962 whether or not the file includes preprocessor macro information.
28963
28964 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28965
28966 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{info source}
28967
28968 @subsubheading Example
28969
28970 @smallexample
28971 (gdb)
28972 123-file-list-exec-source-file
28973 123^done,line="1",file="foo.c",fullname="/home/bar/foo.c,macro-info="1"
28974 (gdb)
28975 @end smallexample
28976
28977
28978 @subheading The @code{-file-list-exec-source-files} Command
28979 @findex -file-list-exec-source-files
28980
28981 @subsubheading Synopsis
28982
28983 @smallexample
28984 -file-list-exec-source-files
28985 @end smallexample
28986
28987 List the source files for the current executable.
28988
28989 It will always output the filename, but only when @value{GDBN} can find
28990 the absolute file name of a source file, will it output the fullname.
28991
28992 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28993
28994 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{info sources}.
28995 @code{gdbtk} has an analogous command @samp{gdb_listfiles}.
28996
28997 @subsubheading Example
28998 @smallexample
28999 (gdb)
29000 -file-list-exec-source-files
29001 ^done,files=[
29002 @{file=foo.c,fullname=/home/foo.c@},
29003 @{file=/home/bar.c,fullname=/home/bar.c@},
29004 @{file=gdb_could_not_find_fullpath.c@}]
29005 (gdb)
29006 @end smallexample
29007
29008 @ignore
29009 @subheading The @code{-file-list-shared-libraries} Command
29010 @findex -file-list-shared-libraries
29011
29012 @subsubheading Synopsis
29013
29014 @smallexample
29015 -file-list-shared-libraries
29016 @end smallexample
29017
29018 List the shared libraries in the program.
29019
29020 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29021
29022 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info shared}.
29023
29024 @subsubheading Example
29025 N.A.
29026
29027
29028 @subheading The @code{-file-list-symbol-files} Command
29029 @findex -file-list-symbol-files
29030
29031 @subsubheading Synopsis
29032
29033 @smallexample
29034 -file-list-symbol-files
29035 @end smallexample
29036
29037 List symbol files.
29038
29039 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29040
29041 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info file} (part of it).
29042
29043 @subsubheading Example
29044 N.A.
29045 @end ignore
29046
29047
29048 @subheading The @code{-file-symbol-file} Command
29049 @findex -file-symbol-file
29050
29051 @subsubheading Synopsis
29052
29053 @smallexample
29054 -file-symbol-file @var{file}
29055 @end smallexample
29056
29057 Read symbol table info from the specified @var{file} argument. When
29058 used without arguments, clears @value{GDBN}'s symbol table info. No output is
29059 produced, except for a completion notification.
29060
29061 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29062
29063 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{symbol-file}.
29064
29065 @subsubheading Example
29066
29067 @smallexample
29068 (gdb)
29069 -file-symbol-file /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/TRUNK/mbx/hello.mbx
29070 ^done
29071 (gdb)
29072 @end smallexample
29073
29074 @ignore
29075 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
29076 @node GDB/MI Memory Overlay Commands
29077 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Memory Overlay Commands
29078
29079 The memory overlay commands are not implemented.
29080
29081 @c @subheading -overlay-auto
29082
29083 @c @subheading -overlay-list-mapping-state
29084
29085 @c @subheading -overlay-list-overlays
29086
29087 @c @subheading -overlay-map
29088
29089 @c @subheading -overlay-off
29090
29091 @c @subheading -overlay-on
29092
29093 @c @subheading -overlay-unmap
29094
29095 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
29096 @node GDB/MI Signal Handling Commands
29097 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Signal Handling Commands
29098
29099 Signal handling commands are not implemented.
29100
29101 @c @subheading -signal-handle
29102
29103 @c @subheading -signal-list-handle-actions
29104
29105 @c @subheading -signal-list-signal-types
29106 @end ignore
29107
29108
29109 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
29110 @node GDB/MI Target Manipulation
29111 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Target Manipulation Commands
29112
29113
29114 @subheading The @code{-target-attach} Command
29115 @findex -target-attach
29116
29117 @subsubheading Synopsis
29118
29119 @smallexample
29120 -target-attach @var{pid} | @var{gid} | @var{file}
29121 @end smallexample
29122
29123 Attach to a process @var{pid} or a file @var{file} outside of
29124 @value{GDBN}, or a thread group @var{gid}. If attaching to a thread
29125 group, the id previously returned by
29126 @samp{-list-thread-groups --available} must be used.
29127
29128 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29129
29130 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{attach}.
29131
29132 @subsubheading Example
29133 @smallexample
29134 (gdb)
29135 -target-attach 34
29136 =thread-created,id="1"
29137 *stopped,thread-id="1",frame=@{addr="0xb7f7e410",func="bar",args=[]@}
29138 ^done
29139 (gdb)
29140 @end smallexample
29141
29142 @ignore
29143 @subheading The @code{-target-compare-sections} Command
29144 @findex -target-compare-sections
29145
29146 @subsubheading Synopsis
29147
29148 @smallexample
29149 -target-compare-sections [ @var{section} ]
29150 @end smallexample
29151
29152 Compare data of section @var{section} on target to the exec file.
29153 Without the argument, all sections are compared.
29154
29155 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29156
29157 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{compare-sections}.
29158
29159 @subsubheading Example
29160 N.A.
29161 @end ignore
29162
29163
29164 @subheading The @code{-target-detach} Command
29165 @findex -target-detach
29166
29167 @subsubheading Synopsis
29168
29169 @smallexample
29170 -target-detach [ @var{pid} | @var{gid} ]
29171 @end smallexample
29172
29173 Detach from the remote target which normally resumes its execution.
29174 If either @var{pid} or @var{gid} is specified, detaches from either
29175 the specified process, or specified thread group. There's no output.
29176
29177 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29178
29179 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{detach}.
29180
29181 @subsubheading Example
29182
29183 @smallexample
29184 (gdb)
29185 -target-detach
29186 ^done
29187 (gdb)
29188 @end smallexample
29189
29190
29191 @subheading The @code{-target-disconnect} Command
29192 @findex -target-disconnect
29193
29194 @subsubheading Synopsis
29195
29196 @smallexample
29197 -target-disconnect
29198 @end smallexample
29199
29200 Disconnect from the remote target. There's no output and the target is
29201 generally not resumed.
29202
29203 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29204
29205 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{disconnect}.
29206
29207 @subsubheading Example
29208
29209 @smallexample
29210 (gdb)
29211 -target-disconnect
29212 ^done
29213 (gdb)
29214 @end smallexample
29215
29216
29217 @subheading The @code{-target-download} Command
29218 @findex -target-download
29219
29220 @subsubheading Synopsis
29221
29222 @smallexample
29223 -target-download
29224 @end smallexample
29225
29226 Loads the executable onto the remote target.
29227 It prints out an update message every half second, which includes the fields:
29228
29229 @table @samp
29230 @item section
29231 The name of the section.
29232 @item section-sent
29233 The size of what has been sent so far for that section.
29234 @item section-size
29235 The size of the section.
29236 @item total-sent
29237 The total size of what was sent so far (the current and the previous sections).
29238 @item total-size
29239 The size of the overall executable to download.
29240 @end table
29241
29242 @noindent
29243 Each message is sent as status record (@pxref{GDB/MI Output Syntax, ,
29244 @sc{gdb/mi} Output Syntax}).
29245
29246 In addition, it prints the name and size of the sections, as they are
29247 downloaded. These messages include the following fields:
29248
29249 @table @samp
29250 @item section
29251 The name of the section.
29252 @item section-size
29253 The size of the section.
29254 @item total-size
29255 The size of the overall executable to download.
29256 @end table
29257
29258 @noindent
29259 At the end, a summary is printed.
29260
29261 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29262
29263 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{load}.
29264
29265 @subsubheading Example
29266
29267 Note: each status message appears on a single line. Here the messages
29268 have been broken down so that they can fit onto a page.
29269
29270 @smallexample
29271 (gdb)
29272 -target-download
29273 +download,@{section=".text",section-size="6668",total-size="9880"@}
29274 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="512",section-size="6668",
29275 total-sent="512",total-size="9880"@}
29276 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="1024",section-size="6668",
29277 total-sent="1024",total-size="9880"@}
29278 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="1536",section-size="6668",
29279 total-sent="1536",total-size="9880"@}
29280 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="2048",section-size="6668",
29281 total-sent="2048",total-size="9880"@}
29282 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="2560",section-size="6668",
29283 total-sent="2560",total-size="9880"@}
29284 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="3072",section-size="6668",
29285 total-sent="3072",total-size="9880"@}
29286 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="3584",section-size="6668",
29287 total-sent="3584",total-size="9880"@}
29288 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="4096",section-size="6668",
29289 total-sent="4096",total-size="9880"@}
29290 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="4608",section-size="6668",
29291 total-sent="4608",total-size="9880"@}
29292 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="5120",section-size="6668",
29293 total-sent="5120",total-size="9880"@}
29294 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="5632",section-size="6668",
29295 total-sent="5632",total-size="9880"@}
29296 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="6144",section-size="6668",
29297 total-sent="6144",total-size="9880"@}
29298 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="6656",section-size="6668",
29299 total-sent="6656",total-size="9880"@}
29300 +download,@{section=".init",section-size="28",total-size="9880"@}
29301 +download,@{section=".fini",section-size="28",total-size="9880"@}
29302 +download,@{section=".data",section-size="3156",total-size="9880"@}
29303 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="512",section-size="3156",
29304 total-sent="7236",total-size="9880"@}
29305 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="1024",section-size="3156",
29306 total-sent="7748",total-size="9880"@}
29307 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="1536",section-size="3156",
29308 total-sent="8260",total-size="9880"@}
29309 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="2048",section-size="3156",
29310 total-sent="8772",total-size="9880"@}
29311 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="2560",section-size="3156",
29312 total-sent="9284",total-size="9880"@}
29313 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="3072",section-size="3156",
29314 total-sent="9796",total-size="9880"@}
29315 ^done,address="0x10004",load-size="9880",transfer-rate="6586",
29316 write-rate="429"
29317 (gdb)
29318 @end smallexample
29319
29320
29321 @ignore
29322 @subheading The @code{-target-exec-status} Command
29323 @findex -target-exec-status
29324
29325 @subsubheading Synopsis
29326
29327 @smallexample
29328 -target-exec-status
29329 @end smallexample
29330
29331 Provide information on the state of the target (whether it is running or
29332 not, for instance).
29333
29334 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29335
29336 There's no equivalent @value{GDBN} command.
29337
29338 @subsubheading Example
29339 N.A.
29340
29341
29342 @subheading The @code{-target-list-available-targets} Command
29343 @findex -target-list-available-targets
29344
29345 @subsubheading Synopsis
29346
29347 @smallexample
29348 -target-list-available-targets
29349 @end smallexample
29350
29351 List the possible targets to connect to.
29352
29353 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29354
29355 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{help target}.
29356
29357 @subsubheading Example
29358 N.A.
29359
29360
29361 @subheading The @code{-target-list-current-targets} Command
29362 @findex -target-list-current-targets
29363
29364 @subsubheading Synopsis
29365
29366 @smallexample
29367 -target-list-current-targets
29368 @end smallexample
29369
29370 Describe the current target.
29371
29372 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29373
29374 The corresponding information is printed by @samp{info file} (among
29375 other things).
29376
29377 @subsubheading Example
29378 N.A.
29379
29380
29381 @subheading The @code{-target-list-parameters} Command
29382 @findex -target-list-parameters
29383
29384 @subsubheading Synopsis
29385
29386 @smallexample
29387 -target-list-parameters
29388 @end smallexample
29389
29390 @c ????
29391 @end ignore
29392
29393 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29394
29395 No equivalent.
29396
29397 @subsubheading Example
29398 N.A.
29399
29400
29401 @subheading The @code{-target-select} Command
29402 @findex -target-select
29403
29404 @subsubheading Synopsis
29405
29406 @smallexample
29407 -target-select @var{type} @var{parameters @dots{}}
29408 @end smallexample
29409
29410 Connect @value{GDBN} to the remote target. This command takes two args:
29411
29412 @table @samp
29413 @item @var{type}
29414 The type of target, for instance @samp{remote}, etc.
29415 @item @var{parameters}
29416 Device names, host names and the like. @xref{Target Commands, ,
29417 Commands for Managing Targets}, for more details.
29418 @end table
29419
29420 The output is a connection notification, followed by the address at
29421 which the target program is, in the following form:
29422
29423 @smallexample
29424 ^connected,addr="@var{address}",func="@var{function name}",
29425 args=[@var{arg list}]
29426 @end smallexample
29427
29428 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29429
29430 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{target}.
29431
29432 @subsubheading Example
29433
29434 @smallexample
29435 (gdb)
29436 -target-select remote /dev/ttya
29437 ^connected,addr="0xfe00a300",func="??",args=[]
29438 (gdb)
29439 @end smallexample
29440
29441 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
29442 @node GDB/MI File Transfer Commands
29443 @section @sc{gdb/mi} File Transfer Commands
29444
29445
29446 @subheading The @code{-target-file-put} Command
29447 @findex -target-file-put
29448
29449 @subsubheading Synopsis
29450
29451 @smallexample
29452 -target-file-put @var{hostfile} @var{targetfile}
29453 @end smallexample
29454
29455 Copy file @var{hostfile} from the host system (the machine running
29456 @value{GDBN}) to @var{targetfile} on the target system.
29457
29458 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29459
29460 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{remote put}.
29461
29462 @subsubheading Example
29463
29464 @smallexample
29465 (gdb)
29466 -target-file-put localfile remotefile
29467 ^done
29468 (gdb)
29469 @end smallexample
29470
29471
29472 @subheading The @code{-target-file-get} Command
29473 @findex -target-file-get
29474
29475 @subsubheading Synopsis
29476
29477 @smallexample
29478 -target-file-get @var{targetfile} @var{hostfile}
29479 @end smallexample
29480
29481 Copy file @var{targetfile} from the target system to @var{hostfile}
29482 on the host system.
29483
29484 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29485
29486 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{remote get}.
29487
29488 @subsubheading Example
29489
29490 @smallexample
29491 (gdb)
29492 -target-file-get remotefile localfile
29493 ^done
29494 (gdb)
29495 @end smallexample
29496
29497
29498 @subheading The @code{-target-file-delete} Command
29499 @findex -target-file-delete
29500
29501 @subsubheading Synopsis
29502
29503 @smallexample
29504 -target-file-delete @var{targetfile}
29505 @end smallexample
29506
29507 Delete @var{targetfile} from the target system.
29508
29509 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29510
29511 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{remote delete}.
29512
29513 @subsubheading Example
29514
29515 @smallexample
29516 (gdb)
29517 -target-file-delete remotefile
29518 ^done
29519 (gdb)
29520 @end smallexample
29521
29522
29523 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
29524 @node GDB/MI Miscellaneous Commands
29525 @section Miscellaneous @sc{gdb/mi} Commands
29526
29527 @c @subheading -gdb-complete
29528
29529 @subheading The @code{-gdb-exit} Command
29530 @findex -gdb-exit
29531
29532 @subsubheading Synopsis
29533
29534 @smallexample
29535 -gdb-exit
29536 @end smallexample
29537
29538 Exit @value{GDBN} immediately.
29539
29540 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29541
29542 Approximately corresponds to @samp{quit}.
29543
29544 @subsubheading Example
29545
29546 @smallexample
29547 (gdb)
29548 -gdb-exit
29549 ^exit
29550 @end smallexample
29551
29552
29553 @ignore
29554 @subheading The @code{-exec-abort} Command
29555 @findex -exec-abort
29556
29557 @subsubheading Synopsis
29558
29559 @smallexample
29560 -exec-abort
29561 @end smallexample
29562
29563 Kill the inferior running program.
29564
29565 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29566
29567 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{kill}.
29568
29569 @subsubheading Example
29570 N.A.
29571 @end ignore
29572
29573
29574 @subheading The @code{-gdb-set} Command
29575 @findex -gdb-set
29576
29577 @subsubheading Synopsis
29578
29579 @smallexample
29580 -gdb-set
29581 @end smallexample
29582
29583 Set an internal @value{GDBN} variable.
29584 @c IS THIS A DOLLAR VARIABLE? OR SOMETHING LIKE ANNOTATE ?????
29585
29586 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29587
29588 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{set}.
29589
29590 @subsubheading Example
29591
29592 @smallexample
29593 (gdb)
29594 -gdb-set $foo=3
29595 ^done
29596 (gdb)
29597 @end smallexample
29598
29599
29600 @subheading The @code{-gdb-show} Command
29601 @findex -gdb-show
29602
29603 @subsubheading Synopsis
29604
29605 @smallexample
29606 -gdb-show
29607 @end smallexample
29608
29609 Show the current value of a @value{GDBN} variable.
29610
29611 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29612
29613 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{show}.
29614
29615 @subsubheading Example
29616
29617 @smallexample
29618 (gdb)
29619 -gdb-show annotate
29620 ^done,value="0"
29621 (gdb)
29622 @end smallexample
29623
29624 @c @subheading -gdb-source
29625
29626
29627 @subheading The @code{-gdb-version} Command
29628 @findex -gdb-version
29629
29630 @subsubheading Synopsis
29631
29632 @smallexample
29633 -gdb-version
29634 @end smallexample
29635
29636 Show version information for @value{GDBN}. Used mostly in testing.
29637
29638 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29639
29640 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{show version}. @value{GDBN} by
29641 default shows this information when you start an interactive session.
29642
29643 @subsubheading Example
29644
29645 @c This example modifies the actual output from GDB to avoid overfull
29646 @c box in TeX.
29647 @smallexample
29648 (gdb)
29649 -gdb-version
29650 ~GNU gdb 5.2.1
29651 ~Copyright 2000 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
29652 ~GDB is free software, covered by the GNU General Public License, and
29653 ~you are welcome to change it and/or distribute copies of it under
29654 ~ certain conditions.
29655 ~Type "show copying" to see the conditions.
29656 ~There is absolutely no warranty for GDB. Type "show warranty" for
29657 ~ details.
29658 ~This GDB was configured as
29659 "--host=sparc-sun-solaris2.5.1 --target=ppc-eabi".
29660 ^done
29661 (gdb)
29662 @end smallexample
29663
29664 @subheading The @code{-list-features} Command
29665 @findex -list-features
29666
29667 Returns a list of particular features of the MI protocol that
29668 this version of gdb implements. A feature can be a command,
29669 or a new field in an output of some command, or even an
29670 important bugfix. While a frontend can sometimes detect presence
29671 of a feature at runtime, it is easier to perform detection at debugger
29672 startup.
29673
29674 The command returns a list of strings, with each string naming an
29675 available feature. Each returned string is just a name, it does not
29676 have any internal structure. The list of possible feature names
29677 is given below.
29678
29679 Example output:
29680
29681 @smallexample
29682 (gdb) -list-features
29683 ^done,result=["feature1","feature2"]
29684 @end smallexample
29685
29686 The current list of features is:
29687
29688 @table @samp
29689 @item frozen-varobjs
29690 Indicates presence of the @code{-var-set-frozen} command, as well
29691 as possible presense of the @code{frozen} field in the output
29692 of @code{-varobj-create}.
29693 @item pending-breakpoints
29694 Indicates presence of the @option{-f} option to the @code{-break-insert} command.
29695 @item python
29696 Indicates presence of Python scripting support, Python-based
29697 pretty-printing commands, and possible presence of the
29698 @samp{display_hint} field in the output of @code{-var-list-children}
29699 @item thread-info
29700 Indicates presence of the @code{-thread-info} command.
29701 @item data-read-memory-bytes
29702 Indicates presense of the @code{-data-read-memory-bytes} and the
29703 @code{-data-write-memory-bytes} commands.
29704
29705 @end table
29706
29707 @subheading The @code{-list-target-features} Command
29708 @findex -list-target-features
29709
29710 Returns a list of particular features that are supported by the
29711 target. Those features affect the permitted MI commands, but
29712 unlike the features reported by the @code{-list-features} command, the
29713 features depend on which target GDB is using at the moment. Whenever
29714 a target can change, due to commands such as @code{-target-select},
29715 @code{-target-attach} or @code{-exec-run}, the list of target features
29716 may change, and the frontend should obtain it again.
29717 Example output:
29718
29719 @smallexample
29720 (gdb) -list-features
29721 ^done,result=["async"]
29722 @end smallexample
29723
29724 The current list of features is:
29725
29726 @table @samp
29727 @item async
29728 Indicates that the target is capable of asynchronous command
29729 execution, which means that @value{GDBN} will accept further commands
29730 while the target is running.
29731
29732 @item reverse
29733 Indicates that the target is capable of reverse execution.
29734 @xref{Reverse Execution}, for more information.
29735
29736 @end table
29737
29738 @subheading The @code{-list-thread-groups} Command
29739 @findex -list-thread-groups
29740
29741 @subheading Synopsis
29742
29743 @smallexample
29744 -list-thread-groups [ --available ] [ --recurse 1 ] [ @var{group} ... ]
29745 @end smallexample
29746
29747 Lists thread groups (@pxref{Thread groups}). When a single thread
29748 group is passed as the argument, lists the children of that group.
29749 When several thread group are passed, lists information about those
29750 thread groups. Without any parameters, lists information about all
29751 top-level thread groups.
29752
29753 Normally, thread groups that are being debugged are reported.
29754 With the @samp{--available} option, @value{GDBN} reports thread groups
29755 available on the target.
29756
29757 The output of this command may have either a @samp{threads} result or
29758 a @samp{groups} result. The @samp{thread} result has a list of tuples
29759 as value, with each tuple describing a thread (@pxref{GDB/MI Thread
29760 Information}). The @samp{groups} result has a list of tuples as value,
29761 each tuple describing a thread group. If top-level groups are
29762 requested (that is, no parameter is passed), or when several groups
29763 are passed, the output always has a @samp{groups} result. The format
29764 of the @samp{group} result is described below.
29765
29766 To reduce the number of roundtrips it's possible to list thread groups
29767 together with their children, by passing the @samp{--recurse} option
29768 and the recursion depth. Presently, only recursion depth of 1 is
29769 permitted. If this option is present, then every reported thread group
29770 will also include its children, either as @samp{group} or
29771 @samp{threads} field.
29772
29773 In general, any combination of option and parameters is permitted, with
29774 the following caveats:
29775
29776 @itemize @bullet
29777 @item
29778 When a single thread group is passed, the output will typically
29779 be the @samp{threads} result. Because threads may not contain
29780 anything, the @samp{recurse} option will be ignored.
29781
29782 @item
29783 When the @samp{--available} option is passed, limited information may
29784 be available. In particular, the list of threads of a process might
29785 be inaccessible. Further, specifying specific thread groups might
29786 not give any performance advantage over listing all thread groups.
29787 The frontend should assume that @samp{-list-thread-groups --available}
29788 is always an expensive operation and cache the results.
29789
29790 @end itemize
29791
29792 The @samp{groups} result is a list of tuples, where each tuple may
29793 have the following fields:
29794
29795 @table @code
29796 @item id
29797 Identifier of the thread group. This field is always present.
29798 The identifier is an opaque string; frontends should not try to
29799 convert it to an integer, even though it might look like one.
29800
29801 @item type
29802 The type of the thread group. At present, only @samp{process} is a
29803 valid type.
29804
29805 @item pid
29806 The target-specific process identifier. This field is only present
29807 for thread groups of type @samp{process} and only if the process exists.
29808
29809 @item num_children
29810 The number of children this thread group has. This field may be
29811 absent for an available thread group.
29812
29813 @item threads
29814 This field has a list of tuples as value, each tuple describing a
29815 thread. It may be present if the @samp{--recurse} option is
29816 specified, and it's actually possible to obtain the threads.
29817
29818 @item cores
29819 This field is a list of integers, each identifying a core that one
29820 thread of the group is running on. This field may be absent if
29821 such information is not available.
29822
29823 @item executable
29824 The name of the executable file that corresponds to this thread group.
29825 The field is only present for thread groups of type @samp{process},
29826 and only if there is a corresponding executable file.
29827
29828 @end table
29829
29830 @subheading Example
29831
29832 @smallexample
29833 @value{GDBP}
29834 -list-thread-groups
29835 ^done,groups=[@{id="17",type="process",pid="yyy",num_children="2"@}]
29836 -list-thread-groups 17
29837 ^done,threads=[@{id="2",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90 (LWP 21257)",
29838 frame=@{level="0",addr="0xffffe410",func="__kernel_vsyscall",args=[]@},state="running"@},
29839 @{id="1",target-id="Thread 0xb7e156b0 (LWP 21254)",
29840 frame=@{level="0",addr="0x0804891f",func="foo",args=[@{name="i",value="10"@}],
29841 file="/tmp/a.c",fullname="/tmp/a.c",line="158"@},state="running"@}]]
29842 -list-thread-groups --available
29843 ^done,groups=[@{id="17",type="process",pid="yyy",num_children="2",cores=[1,2]@}]
29844 -list-thread-groups --available --recurse 1
29845 ^done,groups=[@{id="17", types="process",pid="yyy",num_children="2",cores=[1,2],
29846 threads=[@{id="1",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90",cores=[1]@},
29847 @{id="2",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90",cores=[2]@}]@},..]
29848 -list-thread-groups --available --recurse 1 17 18
29849 ^done,groups=[@{id="17", types="process",pid="yyy",num_children="2",cores=[1,2],
29850 threads=[@{id="1",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90",cores=[1]@},
29851 @{id="2",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90",cores=[2]@}]@},...]
29852 @end smallexample
29853
29854
29855 @subheading The @code{-add-inferior} Command
29856 @findex -add-inferior
29857
29858 @subheading Synopsis
29859
29860 @smallexample
29861 -add-inferior
29862 @end smallexample
29863
29864 Creates a new inferior (@pxref{Inferiors and Programs}). The created
29865 inferior is not associated with any executable. Such association may
29866 be established with the @samp{-file-exec-and-symbols} command
29867 (@pxref{GDB/MI File Commands}). The command response has a single
29868 field, @samp{thread-group}, whose value is the identifier of the
29869 thread group corresponding to the new inferior.
29870
29871 @subheading Example
29872
29873 @smallexample
29874 @value{GDBP}
29875 -add-inferior
29876 ^done,thread-group="i3"
29877 @end smallexample
29878
29879 @subheading The @code{-interpreter-exec} Command
29880 @findex -interpreter-exec
29881
29882 @subheading Synopsis
29883
29884 @smallexample
29885 -interpreter-exec @var{interpreter} @var{command}
29886 @end smallexample
29887 @anchor{-interpreter-exec}
29888
29889 Execute the specified @var{command} in the given @var{interpreter}.
29890
29891 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
29892
29893 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{interpreter-exec}.
29894
29895 @subheading Example
29896
29897 @smallexample
29898 (gdb)
29899 -interpreter-exec console "break main"
29900 &"During symbol reading, couldn't parse type; debugger out of date?.\n"
29901 &"During symbol reading, bad structure-type format.\n"
29902 ~"Breakpoint 1 at 0x8074fc6: file ../../src/gdb/main.c, line 743.\n"
29903 ^done
29904 (gdb)
29905 @end smallexample
29906
29907 @subheading The @code{-inferior-tty-set} Command
29908 @findex -inferior-tty-set
29909
29910 @subheading Synopsis
29911
29912 @smallexample
29913 -inferior-tty-set /dev/pts/1
29914 @end smallexample
29915
29916 Set terminal for future runs of the program being debugged.
29917
29918 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
29919
29920 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{set inferior-tty} /dev/pts/1.
29921
29922 @subheading Example
29923
29924 @smallexample
29925 (gdb)
29926 -inferior-tty-set /dev/pts/1
29927 ^done
29928 (gdb)
29929 @end smallexample
29930
29931 @subheading The @code{-inferior-tty-show} Command
29932 @findex -inferior-tty-show
29933
29934 @subheading Synopsis
29935
29936 @smallexample
29937 -inferior-tty-show
29938 @end smallexample
29939
29940 Show terminal for future runs of program being debugged.
29941
29942 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
29943
29944 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{show inferior-tty}.
29945
29946 @subheading Example
29947
29948 @smallexample
29949 (gdb)
29950 -inferior-tty-set /dev/pts/1
29951 ^done
29952 (gdb)
29953 -inferior-tty-show
29954 ^done,inferior_tty_terminal="/dev/pts/1"
29955 (gdb)
29956 @end smallexample
29957
29958 @subheading The @code{-enable-timings} Command
29959 @findex -enable-timings
29960
29961 @subheading Synopsis
29962
29963 @smallexample
29964 -enable-timings [yes | no]
29965 @end smallexample
29966
29967 Toggle the printing of the wallclock, user and system times for an MI
29968 command as a field in its output. This command is to help frontend
29969 developers optimize the performance of their code. No argument is
29970 equivalent to @samp{yes}.
29971
29972 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
29973
29974 No equivalent.
29975
29976 @subheading Example
29977
29978 @smallexample
29979 (gdb)
29980 -enable-timings
29981 ^done
29982 (gdb)
29983 -break-insert main
29984 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
29985 addr="0x080484ed",func="main",file="myprog.c",
29986 fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="73",times="0"@},
29987 time=@{wallclock="0.05185",user="0.00800",system="0.00000"@}
29988 (gdb)
29989 -enable-timings no
29990 ^done
29991 (gdb)
29992 -exec-run
29993 ^running
29994 (gdb)
29995 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",thread-id="0",
29996 frame=@{addr="0x080484ed",func="main",args=[@{name="argc",value="1"@},
29997 @{name="argv",value="0xbfb60364"@}],file="myprog.c",
29998 fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="73"@}
29999 (gdb)
30000 @end smallexample
30001
30002 @node Annotations
30003 @chapter @value{GDBN} Annotations
30004
30005 This chapter describes annotations in @value{GDBN}. Annotations were
30006 designed to interface @value{GDBN} to graphical user interfaces or other
30007 similar programs which want to interact with @value{GDBN} at a
30008 relatively high level.
30009
30010 The annotation mechanism has largely been superseded by @sc{gdb/mi}
30011 (@pxref{GDB/MI}).
30012
30013 @ignore
30014 This is Edition @value{EDITION}, @value{DATE}.
30015 @end ignore
30016
30017 @menu
30018 * Annotations Overview:: What annotations are; the general syntax.
30019 * Server Prefix:: Issuing a command without affecting user state.
30020 * Prompting:: Annotations marking @value{GDBN}'s need for input.
30021 * Errors:: Annotations for error messages.
30022 * Invalidation:: Some annotations describe things now invalid.
30023 * Annotations for Running::
30024 Whether the program is running, how it stopped, etc.
30025 * Source Annotations:: Annotations describing source code.
30026 @end menu
30027
30028 @node Annotations Overview
30029 @section What is an Annotation?
30030 @cindex annotations
30031
30032 Annotations start with a newline character, two @samp{control-z}
30033 characters, and the name of the annotation. If there is no additional
30034 information associated with this annotation, the name of the annotation
30035 is followed immediately by a newline. If there is additional
30036 information, the name of the annotation is followed by a space, the
30037 additional information, and a newline. The additional information
30038 cannot contain newline characters.
30039
30040 Any output not beginning with a newline and two @samp{control-z}
30041 characters denotes literal output from @value{GDBN}. Currently there is
30042 no need for @value{GDBN} to output a newline followed by two
30043 @samp{control-z} characters, but if there was such a need, the
30044 annotations could be extended with an @samp{escape} annotation which
30045 means those three characters as output.
30046
30047 The annotation @var{level}, which is specified using the
30048 @option{--annotate} command line option (@pxref{Mode Options}), controls
30049 how much information @value{GDBN} prints together with its prompt,
30050 values of expressions, source lines, and other types of output. Level 0
30051 is for no annotations, level 1 is for use when @value{GDBN} is run as a
30052 subprocess of @sc{gnu} Emacs, level 3 is the maximum annotation suitable
30053 for programs that control @value{GDBN}, and level 2 annotations have
30054 been made obsolete (@pxref{Limitations, , Limitations of the Annotation
30055 Interface, annotate, GDB's Obsolete Annotations}).
30056
30057 @table @code
30058 @kindex set annotate
30059 @item set annotate @var{level}
30060 The @value{GDBN} command @code{set annotate} sets the level of
30061 annotations to the specified @var{level}.
30062
30063 @item show annotate
30064 @kindex show annotate
30065 Show the current annotation level.
30066 @end table
30067
30068 This chapter describes level 3 annotations.
30069
30070 A simple example of starting up @value{GDBN} with annotations is:
30071
30072 @smallexample
30073 $ @kbd{gdb --annotate=3}
30074 GNU gdb 6.0
30075 Copyright 2003 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
30076 GDB is free software, covered by the GNU General Public License,
30077 and you are welcome to change it and/or distribute copies of it
30078 under certain conditions.
30079 Type "show copying" to see the conditions.
30080 There is absolutely no warranty for GDB. Type "show warranty"
30081 for details.
30082 This GDB was configured as "i386-pc-linux-gnu"
30083
30084 ^Z^Zpre-prompt
30085 (@value{GDBP})
30086 ^Z^Zprompt
30087 @kbd{quit}
30088
30089 ^Z^Zpost-prompt
30090 $
30091 @end smallexample
30092
30093 Here @samp{quit} is input to @value{GDBN}; the rest is output from
30094 @value{GDBN}. The three lines beginning @samp{^Z^Z} (where @samp{^Z}
30095 denotes a @samp{control-z} character) are annotations; the rest is
30096 output from @value{GDBN}.
30097
30098 @node Server Prefix
30099 @section The Server Prefix
30100 @cindex server prefix
30101
30102 If you prefix a command with @samp{server } then it will not affect
30103 the command history, nor will it affect @value{GDBN}'s notion of which
30104 command to repeat if @key{RET} is pressed on a line by itself. This
30105 means that commands can be run behind a user's back by a front-end in
30106 a transparent manner.
30107
30108 The @code{server } prefix does not affect the recording of values into
30109 the value history; to print a value without recording it into the
30110 value history, use the @code{output} command instead of the
30111 @code{print} command.
30112
30113 Using this prefix also disables confirmation requests
30114 (@pxref{confirmation requests}).
30115
30116 @node Prompting
30117 @section Annotation for @value{GDBN} Input
30118
30119 @cindex annotations for prompts
30120 When @value{GDBN} prompts for input, it annotates this fact so it is possible
30121 to know when to send output, when the output from a given command is
30122 over, etc.
30123
30124 Different kinds of input each have a different @dfn{input type}. Each
30125 input type has three annotations: a @code{pre-} annotation, which
30126 denotes the beginning of any prompt which is being output, a plain
30127 annotation, which denotes the end of the prompt, and then a @code{post-}
30128 annotation which denotes the end of any echo which may (or may not) be
30129 associated with the input. For example, the @code{prompt} input type
30130 features the following annotations:
30131
30132 @smallexample
30133 ^Z^Zpre-prompt
30134 ^Z^Zprompt
30135 ^Z^Zpost-prompt
30136 @end smallexample
30137
30138 The input types are
30139
30140 @table @code
30141 @findex pre-prompt annotation
30142 @findex prompt annotation
30143 @findex post-prompt annotation
30144 @item prompt
30145 When @value{GDBN} is prompting for a command (the main @value{GDBN} prompt).
30146
30147 @findex pre-commands annotation
30148 @findex commands annotation
30149 @findex post-commands annotation
30150 @item commands
30151 When @value{GDBN} prompts for a set of commands, like in the @code{commands}
30152 command. The annotations are repeated for each command which is input.
30153
30154 @findex pre-overload-choice annotation
30155 @findex overload-choice annotation
30156 @findex post-overload-choice annotation
30157 @item overload-choice
30158 When @value{GDBN} wants the user to select between various overloaded functions.
30159
30160 @findex pre-query annotation
30161 @findex query annotation
30162 @findex post-query annotation
30163 @item query
30164 When @value{GDBN} wants the user to confirm a potentially dangerous operation.
30165
30166 @findex pre-prompt-for-continue annotation
30167 @findex prompt-for-continue annotation
30168 @findex post-prompt-for-continue annotation
30169 @item prompt-for-continue
30170 When @value{GDBN} is asking the user to press return to continue. Note: Don't
30171 expect this to work well; instead use @code{set height 0} to disable
30172 prompting. This is because the counting of lines is buggy in the
30173 presence of annotations.
30174 @end table
30175
30176 @node Errors
30177 @section Errors
30178 @cindex annotations for errors, warnings and interrupts
30179
30180 @findex quit annotation
30181 @smallexample
30182 ^Z^Zquit
30183 @end smallexample
30184
30185 This annotation occurs right before @value{GDBN} responds to an interrupt.
30186
30187 @findex error annotation
30188 @smallexample
30189 ^Z^Zerror
30190 @end smallexample
30191
30192 This annotation occurs right before @value{GDBN} responds to an error.
30193
30194 Quit and error annotations indicate that any annotations which @value{GDBN} was
30195 in the middle of may end abruptly. For example, if a
30196 @code{value-history-begin} annotation is followed by a @code{error}, one
30197 cannot expect to receive the matching @code{value-history-end}. One
30198 cannot expect not to receive it either, however; an error annotation
30199 does not necessarily mean that @value{GDBN} is immediately returning all the way
30200 to the top level.
30201
30202 @findex error-begin annotation
30203 A quit or error annotation may be preceded by
30204
30205 @smallexample
30206 ^Z^Zerror-begin
30207 @end smallexample
30208
30209 Any output between that and the quit or error annotation is the error
30210 message.
30211
30212 Warning messages are not yet annotated.
30213 @c If we want to change that, need to fix warning(), type_error(),
30214 @c range_error(), and possibly other places.
30215
30216 @node Invalidation
30217 @section Invalidation Notices
30218
30219 @cindex annotations for invalidation messages
30220 The following annotations say that certain pieces of state may have
30221 changed.
30222
30223 @table @code
30224 @findex frames-invalid annotation
30225 @item ^Z^Zframes-invalid
30226
30227 The frames (for example, output from the @code{backtrace} command) may
30228 have changed.
30229
30230 @findex breakpoints-invalid annotation
30231 @item ^Z^Zbreakpoints-invalid
30232
30233 The breakpoints may have changed. For example, the user just added or
30234 deleted a breakpoint.
30235 @end table
30236
30237 @node Annotations for Running
30238 @section Running the Program
30239 @cindex annotations for running programs
30240
30241 @findex starting annotation
30242 @findex stopping annotation
30243 When the program starts executing due to a @value{GDBN} command such as
30244 @code{step} or @code{continue},
30245
30246 @smallexample
30247 ^Z^Zstarting
30248 @end smallexample
30249
30250 is output. When the program stops,
30251
30252 @smallexample
30253 ^Z^Zstopped
30254 @end smallexample
30255
30256 is output. Before the @code{stopped} annotation, a variety of
30257 annotations describe how the program stopped.
30258
30259 @table @code
30260 @findex exited annotation
30261 @item ^Z^Zexited @var{exit-status}
30262 The program exited, and @var{exit-status} is the exit status (zero for
30263 successful exit, otherwise nonzero).
30264
30265 @findex signalled annotation
30266 @findex signal-name annotation
30267 @findex signal-name-end annotation
30268 @findex signal-string annotation
30269 @findex signal-string-end annotation
30270 @item ^Z^Zsignalled
30271 The program exited with a signal. After the @code{^Z^Zsignalled}, the
30272 annotation continues:
30273
30274 @smallexample
30275 @var{intro-text}
30276 ^Z^Zsignal-name
30277 @var{name}
30278 ^Z^Zsignal-name-end
30279 @var{middle-text}
30280 ^Z^Zsignal-string
30281 @var{string}
30282 ^Z^Zsignal-string-end
30283 @var{end-text}
30284 @end smallexample
30285
30286 @noindent
30287 where @var{name} is the name of the signal, such as @code{SIGILL} or
30288 @code{SIGSEGV}, and @var{string} is the explanation of the signal, such
30289 as @code{Illegal Instruction} or @code{Segmentation fault}.
30290 @var{intro-text}, @var{middle-text}, and @var{end-text} are for the
30291 user's benefit and have no particular format.
30292
30293 @findex signal annotation
30294 @item ^Z^Zsignal
30295 The syntax of this annotation is just like @code{signalled}, but @value{GDBN} is
30296 just saying that the program received the signal, not that it was
30297 terminated with it.
30298
30299 @findex breakpoint annotation
30300 @item ^Z^Zbreakpoint @var{number}
30301 The program hit breakpoint number @var{number}.
30302
30303 @findex watchpoint annotation
30304 @item ^Z^Zwatchpoint @var{number}
30305 The program hit watchpoint number @var{number}.
30306 @end table
30307
30308 @node Source Annotations
30309 @section Displaying Source
30310 @cindex annotations for source display
30311
30312 @findex source annotation
30313 The following annotation is used instead of displaying source code:
30314
30315 @smallexample
30316 ^Z^Zsource @var{filename}:@var{line}:@var{character}:@var{middle}:@var{addr}
30317 @end smallexample
30318
30319 where @var{filename} is an absolute file name indicating which source
30320 file, @var{line} is the line number within that file (where 1 is the
30321 first line in the file), @var{character} is the character position
30322 within the file (where 0 is the first character in the file) (for most
30323 debug formats this will necessarily point to the beginning of a line),
30324 @var{middle} is @samp{middle} if @var{addr} is in the middle of the
30325 line, or @samp{beg} if @var{addr} is at the beginning of the line, and
30326 @var{addr} is the address in the target program associated with the
30327 source which is being displayed. @var{addr} is in the form @samp{0x}
30328 followed by one or more lowercase hex digits (note that this does not
30329 depend on the language).
30330
30331 @node JIT Interface
30332 @chapter JIT Compilation Interface
30333 @cindex just-in-time compilation
30334 @cindex JIT compilation interface
30335
30336 This chapter documents @value{GDBN}'s @dfn{just-in-time} (JIT) compilation
30337 interface. A JIT compiler is a program or library that generates native
30338 executable code at runtime and executes it, usually in order to achieve good
30339 performance while maintaining platform independence.
30340
30341 Programs that use JIT compilation are normally difficult to debug because
30342 portions of their code are generated at runtime, instead of being loaded from
30343 object files, which is where @value{GDBN} normally finds the program's symbols
30344 and debug information. In order to debug programs that use JIT compilation,
30345 @value{GDBN} has an interface that allows the program to register in-memory
30346 symbol files with @value{GDBN} at runtime.
30347
30348 If you are using @value{GDBN} to debug a program that uses this interface, then
30349 it should work transparently so long as you have not stripped the binary. If
30350 you are developing a JIT compiler, then the interface is documented in the rest
30351 of this chapter. At this time, the only known client of this interface is the
30352 LLVM JIT.
30353
30354 Broadly speaking, the JIT interface mirrors the dynamic loader interface. The
30355 JIT compiler communicates with @value{GDBN} by writing data into a global
30356 variable and calling a fuction at a well-known symbol. When @value{GDBN}
30357 attaches, it reads a linked list of symbol files from the global variable to
30358 find existing code, and puts a breakpoint in the function so that it can find
30359 out about additional code.
30360
30361 @menu
30362 * Declarations:: Relevant C struct declarations
30363 * Registering Code:: Steps to register code
30364 * Unregistering Code:: Steps to unregister code
30365 @end menu
30366
30367 @node Declarations
30368 @section JIT Declarations
30369
30370 These are the relevant struct declarations that a C program should include to
30371 implement the interface:
30372
30373 @smallexample
30374 typedef enum
30375 @{
30376 JIT_NOACTION = 0,
30377 JIT_REGISTER_FN,
30378 JIT_UNREGISTER_FN
30379 @} jit_actions_t;
30380
30381 struct jit_code_entry
30382 @{
30383 struct jit_code_entry *next_entry;
30384 struct jit_code_entry *prev_entry;
30385 const char *symfile_addr;
30386 uint64_t symfile_size;
30387 @};
30388
30389 struct jit_descriptor
30390 @{
30391 uint32_t version;
30392 /* This type should be jit_actions_t, but we use uint32_t
30393 to be explicit about the bitwidth. */
30394 uint32_t action_flag;
30395 struct jit_code_entry *relevant_entry;
30396 struct jit_code_entry *first_entry;
30397 @};
30398
30399 /* GDB puts a breakpoint in this function. */
30400 void __attribute__((noinline)) __jit_debug_register_code() @{ @};
30401
30402 /* Make sure to specify the version statically, because the
30403 debugger may check the version before we can set it. */
30404 struct jit_descriptor __jit_debug_descriptor = @{ 1, 0, 0, 0 @};
30405 @end smallexample
30406
30407 If the JIT is multi-threaded, then it is important that the JIT synchronize any
30408 modifications to this global data properly, which can easily be done by putting
30409 a global mutex around modifications to these structures.
30410
30411 @node Registering Code
30412 @section Registering Code
30413
30414 To register code with @value{GDBN}, the JIT should follow this protocol:
30415
30416 @itemize @bullet
30417 @item
30418 Generate an object file in memory with symbols and other desired debug
30419 information. The file must include the virtual addresses of the sections.
30420
30421 @item
30422 Create a code entry for the file, which gives the start and size of the symbol
30423 file.
30424
30425 @item
30426 Add it to the linked list in the JIT descriptor.
30427
30428 @item
30429 Point the relevant_entry field of the descriptor at the entry.
30430
30431 @item
30432 Set @code{action_flag} to @code{JIT_REGISTER} and call
30433 @code{__jit_debug_register_code}.
30434 @end itemize
30435
30436 When @value{GDBN} is attached and the breakpoint fires, @value{GDBN} uses the
30437 @code{relevant_entry} pointer so it doesn't have to walk the list looking for
30438 new code. However, the linked list must still be maintained in order to allow
30439 @value{GDBN} to attach to a running process and still find the symbol files.
30440
30441 @node Unregistering Code
30442 @section Unregistering Code
30443
30444 If code is freed, then the JIT should use the following protocol:
30445
30446 @itemize @bullet
30447 @item
30448 Remove the code entry corresponding to the code from the linked list.
30449
30450 @item
30451 Point the @code{relevant_entry} field of the descriptor at the code entry.
30452
30453 @item
30454 Set @code{action_flag} to @code{JIT_UNREGISTER} and call
30455 @code{__jit_debug_register_code}.
30456 @end itemize
30457
30458 If the JIT frees or recompiles code without unregistering it, then @value{GDBN}
30459 and the JIT will leak the memory used for the associated symbol files.
30460
30461 @node GDB Bugs
30462 @chapter Reporting Bugs in @value{GDBN}
30463 @cindex bugs in @value{GDBN}
30464 @cindex reporting bugs in @value{GDBN}
30465
30466 Your bug reports play an essential role in making @value{GDBN} reliable.
30467
30468 Reporting a bug may help you by bringing a solution to your problem, or it
30469 may not. But in any case the principal function of a bug report is to help
30470 the entire community by making the next version of @value{GDBN} work better. Bug
30471 reports are your contribution to the maintenance of @value{GDBN}.
30472
30473 In order for a bug report to serve its purpose, you must include the
30474 information that enables us to fix the bug.
30475
30476 @menu
30477 * Bug Criteria:: Have you found a bug?
30478 * Bug Reporting:: How to report bugs
30479 @end menu
30480
30481 @node Bug Criteria
30482 @section Have You Found a Bug?
30483 @cindex bug criteria
30484
30485 If you are not sure whether you have found a bug, here are some guidelines:
30486
30487 @itemize @bullet
30488 @cindex fatal signal
30489 @cindex debugger crash
30490 @cindex crash of debugger
30491 @item
30492 If the debugger gets a fatal signal, for any input whatever, that is a
30493 @value{GDBN} bug. Reliable debuggers never crash.
30494
30495 @cindex error on valid input
30496 @item
30497 If @value{GDBN} produces an error message for valid input, that is a
30498 bug. (Note that if you're cross debugging, the problem may also be
30499 somewhere in the connection to the target.)
30500
30501 @cindex invalid input
30502 @item
30503 If @value{GDBN} does not produce an error message for invalid input,
30504 that is a bug. However, you should note that your idea of
30505 ``invalid input'' might be our idea of ``an extension'' or ``support
30506 for traditional practice''.
30507
30508 @item
30509 If you are an experienced user of debugging tools, your suggestions
30510 for improvement of @value{GDBN} are welcome in any case.
30511 @end itemize
30512
30513 @node Bug Reporting
30514 @section How to Report Bugs
30515 @cindex bug reports
30516 @cindex @value{GDBN} bugs, reporting
30517
30518 A number of companies and individuals offer support for @sc{gnu} products.
30519 If you obtained @value{GDBN} from a support organization, we recommend you
30520 contact that organization first.
30521
30522 You can find contact information for many support companies and
30523 individuals in the file @file{etc/SERVICE} in the @sc{gnu} Emacs
30524 distribution.
30525 @c should add a web page ref...
30526
30527 @ifset BUGURL
30528 @ifset BUGURL_DEFAULT
30529 In any event, we also recommend that you submit bug reports for
30530 @value{GDBN}. The preferred method is to submit them directly using
30531 @uref{http://www.gnu.org/software/gdb/bugs/, @value{GDBN}'s Bugs web
30532 page}. Alternatively, the @email{bug-gdb@@gnu.org, e-mail gateway} can
30533 be used.
30534
30535 @strong{Do not send bug reports to @samp{info-gdb}, or to
30536 @samp{help-gdb}, or to any newsgroups.} Most users of @value{GDBN} do
30537 not want to receive bug reports. Those that do have arranged to receive
30538 @samp{bug-gdb}.
30539
30540 The mailing list @samp{bug-gdb} has a newsgroup @samp{gnu.gdb.bug} which
30541 serves as a repeater. The mailing list and the newsgroup carry exactly
30542 the same messages. Often people think of posting bug reports to the
30543 newsgroup instead of mailing them. This appears to work, but it has one
30544 problem which can be crucial: a newsgroup posting often lacks a mail
30545 path back to the sender. Thus, if we need to ask for more information,
30546 we may be unable to reach you. For this reason, it is better to send
30547 bug reports to the mailing list.
30548 @end ifset
30549 @ifclear BUGURL_DEFAULT
30550 In any event, we also recommend that you submit bug reports for
30551 @value{GDBN} to @value{BUGURL}.
30552 @end ifclear
30553 @end ifset
30554
30555 The fundamental principle of reporting bugs usefully is this:
30556 @strong{report all the facts}. If you are not sure whether to state a
30557 fact or leave it out, state it!
30558
30559 Often people omit facts because they think they know what causes the
30560 problem and assume that some details do not matter. Thus, you might
30561 assume that the name of the variable you use in an example does not matter.
30562 Well, probably it does not, but one cannot be sure. Perhaps the bug is a
30563 stray memory reference which happens to fetch from the location where that
30564 name is stored in memory; perhaps, if the name were different, the contents
30565 of that location would fool the debugger into doing the right thing despite
30566 the bug. Play it safe and give a specific, complete example. That is the
30567 easiest thing for you to do, and the most helpful.
30568
30569 Keep in mind that the purpose of a bug report is to enable us to fix the
30570 bug. It may be that the bug has been reported previously, but neither
30571 you nor we can know that unless your bug report is complete and
30572 self-contained.
30573
30574 Sometimes people give a few sketchy facts and ask, ``Does this ring a
30575 bell?'' Those bug reports are useless, and we urge everyone to
30576 @emph{refuse to respond to them} except to chide the sender to report
30577 bugs properly.
30578
30579 To enable us to fix the bug, you should include all these things:
30580
30581 @itemize @bullet
30582 @item
30583 The version of @value{GDBN}. @value{GDBN} announces it if you start
30584 with no arguments; you can also print it at any time using @code{show
30585 version}.
30586
30587 Without this, we will not know whether there is any point in looking for
30588 the bug in the current version of @value{GDBN}.
30589
30590 @item
30591 The type of machine you are using, and the operating system name and
30592 version number.
30593
30594 @item
30595 What compiler (and its version) was used to compile @value{GDBN}---e.g.@:
30596 ``@value{GCC}--2.8.1''.
30597
30598 @item
30599 What compiler (and its version) was used to compile the program you are
30600 debugging---e.g.@: ``@value{GCC}--2.8.1'', or ``HP92453-01 A.10.32.03 HP
30601 C Compiler''. For @value{NGCC}, you can say @kbd{@value{GCC} --version}
30602 to get this information; for other compilers, see the documentation for
30603 those compilers.
30604
30605 @item
30606 The command arguments you gave the compiler to compile your example and
30607 observe the bug. For example, did you use @samp{-O}? To guarantee
30608 you will not omit something important, list them all. A copy of the
30609 Makefile (or the output from make) is sufficient.
30610
30611 If we were to try to guess the arguments, we would probably guess wrong
30612 and then we might not encounter the bug.
30613
30614 @item
30615 A complete input script, and all necessary source files, that will
30616 reproduce the bug.
30617
30618 @item
30619 A description of what behavior you observe that you believe is
30620 incorrect. For example, ``It gets a fatal signal.''
30621
30622 Of course, if the bug is that @value{GDBN} gets a fatal signal, then we
30623 will certainly notice it. But if the bug is incorrect output, we might
30624 not notice unless it is glaringly wrong. You might as well not give us
30625 a chance to make a mistake.
30626
30627 Even if the problem you experience is a fatal signal, you should still
30628 say so explicitly. Suppose something strange is going on, such as, your
30629 copy of @value{GDBN} is out of synch, or you have encountered a bug in
30630 the C library on your system. (This has happened!) Your copy might
30631 crash and ours would not. If you told us to expect a crash, then when
30632 ours fails to crash, we would know that the bug was not happening for
30633 us. If you had not told us to expect a crash, then we would not be able
30634 to draw any conclusion from our observations.
30635
30636 @pindex script
30637 @cindex recording a session script
30638 To collect all this information, you can use a session recording program
30639 such as @command{script}, which is available on many Unix systems.
30640 Just run your @value{GDBN} session inside @command{script} and then
30641 include the @file{typescript} file with your bug report.
30642
30643 Another way to record a @value{GDBN} session is to run @value{GDBN}
30644 inside Emacs and then save the entire buffer to a file.
30645
30646 @item
30647 If you wish to suggest changes to the @value{GDBN} source, send us context
30648 diffs. If you even discuss something in the @value{GDBN} source, refer to
30649 it by context, not by line number.
30650
30651 The line numbers in our development sources will not match those in your
30652 sources. Your line numbers would convey no useful information to us.
30653
30654 @end itemize
30655
30656 Here are some things that are not necessary:
30657
30658 @itemize @bullet
30659 @item
30660 A description of the envelope of the bug.
30661
30662 Often people who encounter a bug spend a lot of time investigating
30663 which changes to the input file will make the bug go away and which
30664 changes will not affect it.
30665
30666 This is often time consuming and not very useful, because the way we
30667 will find the bug is by running a single example under the debugger
30668 with breakpoints, not by pure deduction from a series of examples.
30669 We recommend that you save your time for something else.
30670
30671 Of course, if you can find a simpler example to report @emph{instead}
30672 of the original one, that is a convenience for us. Errors in the
30673 output will be easier to spot, running under the debugger will take
30674 less time, and so on.
30675
30676 However, simplification is not vital; if you do not want to do this,
30677 report the bug anyway and send us the entire test case you used.
30678
30679 @item
30680 A patch for the bug.
30681
30682 A patch for the bug does help us if it is a good one. But do not omit
30683 the necessary information, such as the test case, on the assumption that
30684 a patch is all we need. We might see problems with your patch and decide
30685 to fix the problem another way, or we might not understand it at all.
30686
30687 Sometimes with a program as complicated as @value{GDBN} it is very hard to
30688 construct an example that will make the program follow a certain path
30689 through the code. If you do not send us the example, we will not be able
30690 to construct one, so we will not be able to verify that the bug is fixed.
30691
30692 And if we cannot understand what bug you are trying to fix, or why your
30693 patch should be an improvement, we will not install it. A test case will
30694 help us to understand.
30695
30696 @item
30697 A guess about what the bug is or what it depends on.
30698
30699 Such guesses are usually wrong. Even we cannot guess right about such
30700 things without first using the debugger to find the facts.
30701 @end itemize
30702
30703 @c The readline documentation is distributed with the readline code
30704 @c and consists of the two following files:
30705 @c rluser.texinfo
30706 @c inc-hist.texinfo
30707 @c Use -I with makeinfo to point to the appropriate directory,
30708 @c environment var TEXINPUTS with TeX.
30709 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
30710 @include rluser.texi
30711 @include inc-hist.texinfo
30712 @end ifclear
30713
30714
30715 @node Formatting Documentation
30716 @appendix Formatting Documentation
30717
30718 @cindex @value{GDBN} reference card
30719 @cindex reference card
30720 The @value{GDBN} 4 release includes an already-formatted reference card, ready
30721 for printing with PostScript or Ghostscript, in the @file{gdb}
30722 subdirectory of the main source directory@footnote{In
30723 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/refcard.ps} of the version @value{GDBVN}
30724 release.}. If you can use PostScript or Ghostscript with your printer,
30725 you can print the reference card immediately with @file{refcard.ps}.
30726
30727 The release also includes the source for the reference card. You
30728 can format it, using @TeX{}, by typing:
30729
30730 @smallexample
30731 make refcard.dvi
30732 @end smallexample
30733
30734 The @value{GDBN} reference card is designed to print in @dfn{landscape}
30735 mode on US ``letter'' size paper;
30736 that is, on a sheet 11 inches wide by 8.5 inches
30737 high. You will need to specify this form of printing as an option to
30738 your @sc{dvi} output program.
30739
30740 @cindex documentation
30741
30742 All the documentation for @value{GDBN} comes as part of the machine-readable
30743 distribution. The documentation is written in Texinfo format, which is
30744 a documentation system that uses a single source file to produce both
30745 on-line information and a printed manual. You can use one of the Info
30746 formatting commands to create the on-line version of the documentation
30747 and @TeX{} (or @code{texi2roff}) to typeset the printed version.
30748
30749 @value{GDBN} includes an already formatted copy of the on-line Info
30750 version of this manual in the @file{gdb} subdirectory. The main Info
30751 file is @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/gdb.info}, and it refers to
30752 subordinate files matching @samp{gdb.info*} in the same directory. If
30753 necessary, you can print out these files, or read them with any editor;
30754 but they are easier to read using the @code{info} subsystem in @sc{gnu}
30755 Emacs or the standalone @code{info} program, available as part of the
30756 @sc{gnu} Texinfo distribution.
30757
30758 If you want to format these Info files yourself, you need one of the
30759 Info formatting programs, such as @code{texinfo-format-buffer} or
30760 @code{makeinfo}.
30761
30762 If you have @code{makeinfo} installed, and are in the top level
30763 @value{GDBN} source directory (@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}}, in the case of
30764 version @value{GDBVN}), you can make the Info file by typing:
30765
30766 @smallexample
30767 cd gdb
30768 make gdb.info
30769 @end smallexample
30770
30771 If you want to typeset and print copies of this manual, you need @TeX{},
30772 a program to print its @sc{dvi} output files, and @file{texinfo.tex}, the
30773 Texinfo definitions file.
30774
30775 @TeX{} is a typesetting program; it does not print files directly, but
30776 produces output files called @sc{dvi} files. To print a typeset
30777 document, you need a program to print @sc{dvi} files. If your system
30778 has @TeX{} installed, chances are it has such a program. The precise
30779 command to use depends on your system; @kbd{lpr -d} is common; another
30780 (for PostScript devices) is @kbd{dvips}. The @sc{dvi} print command may
30781 require a file name without any extension or a @samp{.dvi} extension.
30782
30783 @TeX{} also requires a macro definitions file called
30784 @file{texinfo.tex}. This file tells @TeX{} how to typeset a document
30785 written in Texinfo format. On its own, @TeX{} cannot either read or
30786 typeset a Texinfo file. @file{texinfo.tex} is distributed with GDB
30787 and is located in the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}/texinfo}
30788 directory.
30789
30790 If you have @TeX{} and a @sc{dvi} printer program installed, you can
30791 typeset and print this manual. First switch to the @file{gdb}
30792 subdirectory of the main source directory (for example, to
30793 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb}) and type:
30794
30795 @smallexample
30796 make gdb.dvi
30797 @end smallexample
30798
30799 Then give @file{gdb.dvi} to your @sc{dvi} printing program.
30800
30801 @node Installing GDB
30802 @appendix Installing @value{GDBN}
30803 @cindex installation
30804
30805 @menu
30806 * Requirements:: Requirements for building @value{GDBN}
30807 * Running Configure:: Invoking the @value{GDBN} @file{configure} script
30808 * Separate Objdir:: Compiling @value{GDBN} in another directory
30809 * Config Names:: Specifying names for hosts and targets
30810 * Configure Options:: Summary of options for configure
30811 * System-wide configuration:: Having a system-wide init file
30812 @end menu
30813
30814 @node Requirements
30815 @section Requirements for Building @value{GDBN}
30816 @cindex building @value{GDBN}, requirements for
30817
30818 Building @value{GDBN} requires various tools and packages to be available.
30819 Other packages will be used only if they are found.
30820
30821 @heading Tools/Packages Necessary for Building @value{GDBN}
30822 @table @asis
30823 @item ISO C90 compiler
30824 @value{GDBN} is written in ISO C90. It should be buildable with any
30825 working C90 compiler, e.g.@: GCC.
30826
30827 @end table
30828
30829 @heading Tools/Packages Optional for Building @value{GDBN}
30830 @table @asis
30831 @item Expat
30832 @anchor{Expat}
30833 @value{GDBN} can use the Expat XML parsing library. This library may be
30834 included with your operating system distribution; if it is not, you
30835 can get the latest version from @url{http://expat.sourceforge.net}.
30836 The @file{configure} script will search for this library in several
30837 standard locations; if it is installed in an unusual path, you can
30838 use the @option{--with-libexpat-prefix} option to specify its location.
30839
30840 Expat is used for:
30841
30842 @itemize @bullet
30843 @item
30844 Remote protocol memory maps (@pxref{Memory Map Format})
30845 @item
30846 Target descriptions (@pxref{Target Descriptions})
30847 @item
30848 Remote shared library lists (@pxref{Library List Format})
30849 @item
30850 MS-Windows shared libraries (@pxref{Shared Libraries})
30851 @end itemize
30852
30853 @item zlib
30854 @cindex compressed debug sections
30855 @value{GDBN} will use the @samp{zlib} library, if available, to read
30856 compressed debug sections. Some linkers, such as GNU gold, are capable
30857 of producing binaries with compressed debug sections. If @value{GDBN}
30858 is compiled with @samp{zlib}, it will be able to read the debug
30859 information in such binaries.
30860
30861 The @samp{zlib} library is likely included with your operating system
30862 distribution; if it is not, you can get the latest version from
30863 @url{http://zlib.net}.
30864
30865 @item iconv
30866 @value{GDBN}'s features related to character sets (@pxref{Character
30867 Sets}) require a functioning @code{iconv} implementation. If you are
30868 on a GNU system, then this is provided by the GNU C Library. Some
30869 other systems also provide a working @code{iconv}.
30870
30871 On systems with @code{iconv}, you can install GNU Libiconv. If you
30872 have previously installed Libiconv, you can use the
30873 @option{--with-libiconv-prefix} option to configure.
30874
30875 @value{GDBN}'s top-level @file{configure} and @file{Makefile} will
30876 arrange to build Libiconv if a directory named @file{libiconv} appears
30877 in the top-most source directory. If Libiconv is built this way, and
30878 if the operating system does not provide a suitable @code{iconv}
30879 implementation, then the just-built library will automatically be used
30880 by @value{GDBN}. One easy way to set this up is to download GNU
30881 Libiconv, unpack it, and then rename the directory holding the
30882 Libiconv source code to @samp{libiconv}.
30883 @end table
30884
30885 @node Running Configure
30886 @section Invoking the @value{GDBN} @file{configure} Script
30887 @cindex configuring @value{GDBN}
30888 @value{GDBN} comes with a @file{configure} script that automates the process
30889 of preparing @value{GDBN} for installation; you can then use @code{make} to
30890 build the @code{gdb} program.
30891 @iftex
30892 @c irrelevant in info file; it's as current as the code it lives with.
30893 @footnote{If you have a more recent version of @value{GDBN} than @value{GDBVN},
30894 look at the @file{README} file in the sources; we may have improved the
30895 installation procedures since publishing this manual.}
30896 @end iftex
30897
30898 The @value{GDBN} distribution includes all the source code you need for
30899 @value{GDBN} in a single directory, whose name is usually composed by
30900 appending the version number to @samp{gdb}.
30901
30902 For example, the @value{GDBN} version @value{GDBVN} distribution is in the
30903 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} directory. That directory contains:
30904
30905 @table @code
30906 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/configure @r{(and supporting files)}
30907 script for configuring @value{GDBN} and all its supporting libraries
30908
30909 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb
30910 the source specific to @value{GDBN} itself
30911
30912 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/bfd
30913 source for the Binary File Descriptor library
30914
30915 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/include
30916 @sc{gnu} include files
30917
30918 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/libiberty
30919 source for the @samp{-liberty} free software library
30920
30921 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/opcodes
30922 source for the library of opcode tables and disassemblers
30923
30924 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/readline
30925 source for the @sc{gnu} command-line interface
30926
30927 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/glob
30928 source for the @sc{gnu} filename pattern-matching subroutine
30929
30930 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/mmalloc
30931 source for the @sc{gnu} memory-mapped malloc package
30932 @end table
30933
30934 The simplest way to configure and build @value{GDBN} is to run @file{configure}
30935 from the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} source directory, which in
30936 this example is the @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} directory.
30937
30938 First switch to the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} source directory
30939 if you are not already in it; then run @file{configure}. Pass the
30940 identifier for the platform on which @value{GDBN} will run as an
30941 argument.
30942
30943 For example:
30944
30945 @smallexample
30946 cd gdb-@value{GDBVN}
30947 ./configure @var{host}
30948 make
30949 @end smallexample
30950
30951 @noindent
30952 where @var{host} is an identifier such as @samp{sun4} or
30953 @samp{decstation}, that identifies the platform where @value{GDBN} will run.
30954 (You can often leave off @var{host}; @file{configure} tries to guess the
30955 correct value by examining your system.)
30956
30957 Running @samp{configure @var{host}} and then running @code{make} builds the
30958 @file{bfd}, @file{readline}, @file{mmalloc}, and @file{libiberty}
30959 libraries, then @code{gdb} itself. The configured source files, and the
30960 binaries, are left in the corresponding source directories.
30961
30962 @need 750
30963 @file{configure} is a Bourne-shell (@code{/bin/sh}) script; if your
30964 system does not recognize this automatically when you run a different
30965 shell, you may need to run @code{sh} on it explicitly:
30966
30967 @smallexample
30968 sh configure @var{host}
30969 @end smallexample
30970
30971 If you run @file{configure} from a directory that contains source
30972 directories for multiple libraries or programs, such as the
30973 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} source directory for version @value{GDBVN},
30974 @file{configure}
30975 creates configuration files for every directory level underneath (unless
30976 you tell it not to, with the @samp{--norecursion} option).
30977
30978 You should run the @file{configure} script from the top directory in the
30979 source tree, the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} directory. If you run
30980 @file{configure} from one of the subdirectories, you will configure only
30981 that subdirectory. That is usually not what you want. In particular,
30982 if you run the first @file{configure} from the @file{gdb} subdirectory
30983 of the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} directory, you will omit the
30984 configuration of @file{bfd}, @file{readline}, and other sibling
30985 directories of the @file{gdb} subdirectory. This leads to build errors
30986 about missing include files such as @file{bfd/bfd.h}.
30987
30988 You can install @code{@value{GDBP}} anywhere; it has no hardwired paths.
30989 However, you should make sure that the shell on your path (named by
30990 the @samp{SHELL} environment variable) is publicly readable. Remember
30991 that @value{GDBN} uses the shell to start your program---some systems refuse to
30992 let @value{GDBN} debug child processes whose programs are not readable.
30993
30994 @node Separate Objdir
30995 @section Compiling @value{GDBN} in Another Directory
30996
30997 If you want to run @value{GDBN} versions for several host or target machines,
30998 you need a different @code{gdb} compiled for each combination of
30999 host and target. @file{configure} is designed to make this easy by
31000 allowing you to generate each configuration in a separate subdirectory,
31001 rather than in the source directory. If your @code{make} program
31002 handles the @samp{VPATH} feature (@sc{gnu} @code{make} does), running
31003 @code{make} in each of these directories builds the @code{gdb}
31004 program specified there.
31005
31006 To build @code{gdb} in a separate directory, run @file{configure}
31007 with the @samp{--srcdir} option to specify where to find the source.
31008 (You also need to specify a path to find @file{configure}
31009 itself from your working directory. If the path to @file{configure}
31010 would be the same as the argument to @samp{--srcdir}, you can leave out
31011 the @samp{--srcdir} option; it is assumed.)
31012
31013 For example, with version @value{GDBVN}, you can build @value{GDBN} in a
31014 separate directory for a Sun 4 like this:
31015
31016 @smallexample
31017 @group
31018 cd gdb-@value{GDBVN}
31019 mkdir ../gdb-sun4
31020 cd ../gdb-sun4
31021 ../gdb-@value{GDBVN}/configure sun4
31022 make
31023 @end group
31024 @end smallexample
31025
31026 When @file{configure} builds a configuration using a remote source
31027 directory, it creates a tree for the binaries with the same structure
31028 (and using the same names) as the tree under the source directory. In
31029 the example, you'd find the Sun 4 library @file{libiberty.a} in the
31030 directory @file{gdb-sun4/libiberty}, and @value{GDBN} itself in
31031 @file{gdb-sun4/gdb}.
31032
31033 Make sure that your path to the @file{configure} script has just one
31034 instance of @file{gdb} in it. If your path to @file{configure} looks
31035 like @file{../gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/configure}, you are configuring only
31036 one subdirectory of @value{GDBN}, not the whole package. This leads to
31037 build errors about missing include files such as @file{bfd/bfd.h}.
31038
31039 One popular reason to build several @value{GDBN} configurations in separate
31040 directories is to configure @value{GDBN} for cross-compiling (where
31041 @value{GDBN} runs on one machine---the @dfn{host}---while debugging
31042 programs that run on another machine---the @dfn{target}).
31043 You specify a cross-debugging target by
31044 giving the @samp{--target=@var{target}} option to @file{configure}.
31045
31046 When you run @code{make} to build a program or library, you must run
31047 it in a configured directory---whatever directory you were in when you
31048 called @file{configure} (or one of its subdirectories).
31049
31050 The @code{Makefile} that @file{configure} generates in each source
31051 directory also runs recursively. If you type @code{make} in a source
31052 directory such as @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} (or in a separate configured
31053 directory configured with @samp{--srcdir=@var{dirname}/gdb-@value{GDBVN}}), you
31054 will build all the required libraries, and then build GDB.
31055
31056 When you have multiple hosts or targets configured in separate
31057 directories, you can run @code{make} on them in parallel (for example,
31058 if they are NFS-mounted on each of the hosts); they will not interfere
31059 with each other.
31060
31061 @node Config Names
31062 @section Specifying Names for Hosts and Targets
31063
31064 The specifications used for hosts and targets in the @file{configure}
31065 script are based on a three-part naming scheme, but some short predefined
31066 aliases are also supported. The full naming scheme encodes three pieces
31067 of information in the following pattern:
31068
31069 @smallexample
31070 @var{architecture}-@var{vendor}-@var{os}
31071 @end smallexample
31072
31073 For example, you can use the alias @code{sun4} as a @var{host} argument,
31074 or as the value for @var{target} in a @code{--target=@var{target}}
31075 option. The equivalent full name is @samp{sparc-sun-sunos4}.
31076
31077 The @file{configure} script accompanying @value{GDBN} does not provide
31078 any query facility to list all supported host and target names or
31079 aliases. @file{configure} calls the Bourne shell script
31080 @code{config.sub} to map abbreviations to full names; you can read the
31081 script, if you wish, or you can use it to test your guesses on
31082 abbreviations---for example:
31083
31084 @smallexample
31085 % sh config.sub i386-linux
31086 i386-pc-linux-gnu
31087 % sh config.sub alpha-linux
31088 alpha-unknown-linux-gnu
31089 % sh config.sub hp9k700
31090 hppa1.1-hp-hpux
31091 % sh config.sub sun4
31092 sparc-sun-sunos4.1.1
31093 % sh config.sub sun3
31094 m68k-sun-sunos4.1.1
31095 % sh config.sub i986v
31096 Invalid configuration `i986v': machine `i986v' not recognized
31097 @end smallexample
31098
31099 @noindent
31100 @code{config.sub} is also distributed in the @value{GDBN} source
31101 directory (@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}}, for version @value{GDBVN}).
31102
31103 @node Configure Options
31104 @section @file{configure} Options
31105
31106 Here is a summary of the @file{configure} options and arguments that
31107 are most often useful for building @value{GDBN}. @file{configure} also has
31108 several other options not listed here. @inforef{What Configure
31109 Does,,configure.info}, for a full explanation of @file{configure}.
31110
31111 @smallexample
31112 configure @r{[}--help@r{]}
31113 @r{[}--prefix=@var{dir}@r{]}
31114 @r{[}--exec-prefix=@var{dir}@r{]}
31115 @r{[}--srcdir=@var{dirname}@r{]}
31116 @r{[}--norecursion@r{]} @r{[}--rm@r{]}
31117 @r{[}--target=@var{target}@r{]}
31118 @var{host}
31119 @end smallexample
31120
31121 @noindent
31122 You may introduce options with a single @samp{-} rather than
31123 @samp{--} if you prefer; but you may abbreviate option names if you use
31124 @samp{--}.
31125
31126 @table @code
31127 @item --help
31128 Display a quick summary of how to invoke @file{configure}.
31129
31130 @item --prefix=@var{dir}
31131 Configure the source to install programs and files under directory
31132 @file{@var{dir}}.
31133
31134 @item --exec-prefix=@var{dir}
31135 Configure the source to install programs under directory
31136 @file{@var{dir}}.
31137
31138 @c avoid splitting the warning from the explanation:
31139 @need 2000
31140 @item --srcdir=@var{dirname}
31141 @strong{Warning: using this option requires @sc{gnu} @code{make}, or another
31142 @code{make} that implements the @code{VPATH} feature.}@*
31143 Use this option to make configurations in directories separate from the
31144 @value{GDBN} source directories. Among other things, you can use this to
31145 build (or maintain) several configurations simultaneously, in separate
31146 directories. @file{configure} writes configuration-specific files in
31147 the current directory, but arranges for them to use the source in the
31148 directory @var{dirname}. @file{configure} creates directories under
31149 the working directory in parallel to the source directories below
31150 @var{dirname}.
31151
31152 @item --norecursion
31153 Configure only the directory level where @file{configure} is executed; do not
31154 propagate configuration to subdirectories.
31155
31156 @item --target=@var{target}
31157 Configure @value{GDBN} for cross-debugging programs running on the specified
31158 @var{target}. Without this option, @value{GDBN} is configured to debug
31159 programs that run on the same machine (@var{host}) as @value{GDBN} itself.
31160
31161 There is no convenient way to generate a list of all available targets.
31162
31163 @item @var{host} @dots{}
31164 Configure @value{GDBN} to run on the specified @var{host}.
31165
31166 There is no convenient way to generate a list of all available hosts.
31167 @end table
31168
31169 There are many other options available as well, but they are generally
31170 needed for special purposes only.
31171
31172 @node System-wide configuration
31173 @section System-wide configuration and settings
31174 @cindex system-wide init file
31175
31176 @value{GDBN} can be configured to have a system-wide init file;
31177 this file will be read and executed at startup (@pxref{Startup, , What
31178 @value{GDBN} does during startup}).
31179
31180 Here is the corresponding configure option:
31181
31182 @table @code
31183 @item --with-system-gdbinit=@var{file}
31184 Specify that the default location of the system-wide init file is
31185 @var{file}.
31186 @end table
31187
31188 If @value{GDBN} has been configured with the option @option{--prefix=$prefix},
31189 it may be subject to relocation. Two possible cases:
31190
31191 @itemize @bullet
31192 @item
31193 If the default location of this init file contains @file{$prefix},
31194 it will be subject to relocation. Suppose that the configure options
31195 are @option{--prefix=$prefix --with-system-gdbinit=$prefix/etc/gdbinit};
31196 if @value{GDBN} is moved from @file{$prefix} to @file{$install}, the system
31197 init file is looked for as @file{$install/etc/gdbinit} instead of
31198 @file{$prefix/etc/gdbinit}.
31199
31200 @item
31201 By contrast, if the default location does not contain the prefix,
31202 it will not be relocated. E.g.@: if @value{GDBN} has been configured with
31203 @option{--prefix=/usr/local --with-system-gdbinit=/usr/share/gdb/gdbinit},
31204 then @value{GDBN} will always look for @file{/usr/share/gdb/gdbinit},
31205 wherever @value{GDBN} is installed.
31206 @end itemize
31207
31208 @node Maintenance Commands
31209 @appendix Maintenance Commands
31210 @cindex maintenance commands
31211 @cindex internal commands
31212
31213 In addition to commands intended for @value{GDBN} users, @value{GDBN}
31214 includes a number of commands intended for @value{GDBN} developers,
31215 that are not documented elsewhere in this manual. These commands are
31216 provided here for reference. (For commands that turn on debugging
31217 messages, see @ref{Debugging Output}.)
31218
31219 @table @code
31220 @kindex maint agent
31221 @kindex maint agent-eval
31222 @item maint agent @var{expression}
31223 @itemx maint agent-eval @var{expression}
31224 Translate the given @var{expression} into remote agent bytecodes.
31225 This command is useful for debugging the Agent Expression mechanism
31226 (@pxref{Agent Expressions}). The @samp{agent} version produces an
31227 expression useful for data collection, such as by tracepoints, while
31228 @samp{maint agent-eval} produces an expression that evaluates directly
31229 to a result. For instance, a collection expression for @code{globa +
31230 globb} will include bytecodes to record four bytes of memory at each
31231 of the addresses of @code{globa} and @code{globb}, while discarding
31232 the result of the addition, while an evaluation expression will do the
31233 addition and return the sum.
31234
31235 @kindex maint info breakpoints
31236 @item @anchor{maint info breakpoints}maint info breakpoints
31237 Using the same format as @samp{info breakpoints}, display both the
31238 breakpoints you've set explicitly, and those @value{GDBN} is using for
31239 internal purposes. Internal breakpoints are shown with negative
31240 breakpoint numbers. The type column identifies what kind of breakpoint
31241 is shown:
31242
31243 @table @code
31244 @item breakpoint
31245 Normal, explicitly set breakpoint.
31246
31247 @item watchpoint
31248 Normal, explicitly set watchpoint.
31249
31250 @item longjmp
31251 Internal breakpoint, used to handle correctly stepping through
31252 @code{longjmp} calls.
31253
31254 @item longjmp resume
31255 Internal breakpoint at the target of a @code{longjmp}.
31256
31257 @item until
31258 Temporary internal breakpoint used by the @value{GDBN} @code{until} command.
31259
31260 @item finish
31261 Temporary internal breakpoint used by the @value{GDBN} @code{finish} command.
31262
31263 @item shlib events
31264 Shared library events.
31265
31266 @end table
31267
31268 @kindex set displaced-stepping
31269 @kindex show displaced-stepping
31270 @cindex displaced stepping support
31271 @cindex out-of-line single-stepping
31272 @item set displaced-stepping
31273 @itemx show displaced-stepping
31274 Control whether or not @value{GDBN} will do @dfn{displaced stepping}
31275 if the target supports it. Displaced stepping is a way to single-step
31276 over breakpoints without removing them from the inferior, by executing
31277 an out-of-line copy of the instruction that was originally at the
31278 breakpoint location. It is also known as out-of-line single-stepping.
31279
31280 @table @code
31281 @item set displaced-stepping on
31282 If the target architecture supports it, @value{GDBN} will use
31283 displaced stepping to step over breakpoints.
31284
31285 @item set displaced-stepping off
31286 @value{GDBN} will not use displaced stepping to step over breakpoints,
31287 even if such is supported by the target architecture.
31288
31289 @cindex non-stop mode, and @samp{set displaced-stepping}
31290 @item set displaced-stepping auto
31291 This is the default mode. @value{GDBN} will use displaced stepping
31292 only if non-stop mode is active (@pxref{Non-Stop Mode}) and the target
31293 architecture supports displaced stepping.
31294 @end table
31295
31296 @kindex maint check-symtabs
31297 @item maint check-symtabs
31298 Check the consistency of psymtabs and symtabs.
31299
31300 @kindex maint cplus first_component
31301 @item maint cplus first_component @var{name}
31302 Print the first C@t{++} class/namespace component of @var{name}.
31303
31304 @kindex maint cplus namespace
31305 @item maint cplus namespace
31306 Print the list of possible C@t{++} namespaces.
31307
31308 @kindex maint demangle
31309 @item maint demangle @var{name}
31310 Demangle a C@t{++} or Objective-C mangled @var{name}.
31311
31312 @kindex maint deprecate
31313 @kindex maint undeprecate
31314 @cindex deprecated commands
31315 @item maint deprecate @var{command} @r{[}@var{replacement}@r{]}
31316 @itemx maint undeprecate @var{command}
31317 Deprecate or undeprecate the named @var{command}. Deprecated commands
31318 cause @value{GDBN} to issue a warning when you use them. The optional
31319 argument @var{replacement} says which newer command should be used in
31320 favor of the deprecated one; if it is given, @value{GDBN} will mention
31321 the replacement as part of the warning.
31322
31323 @kindex maint dump-me
31324 @item maint dump-me
31325 @cindex @code{SIGQUIT} signal, dump core of @value{GDBN}
31326 Cause a fatal signal in the debugger and force it to dump its core.
31327 This is supported only on systems which support aborting a program
31328 with the @code{SIGQUIT} signal.
31329
31330 @kindex maint internal-error
31331 @kindex maint internal-warning
31332 @item maint internal-error @r{[}@var{message-text}@r{]}
31333 @itemx maint internal-warning @r{[}@var{message-text}@r{]}
31334 Cause @value{GDBN} to call the internal function @code{internal_error}
31335 or @code{internal_warning} and hence behave as though an internal error
31336 or internal warning has been detected. In addition to reporting the
31337 internal problem, these functions give the user the opportunity to
31338 either quit @value{GDBN} or create a core file of the current
31339 @value{GDBN} session.
31340
31341 These commands take an optional parameter @var{message-text} that is
31342 used as the text of the error or warning message.
31343
31344 Here's an example of using @code{internal-error}:
31345
31346 @smallexample
31347 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{maint internal-error testing, 1, 2}
31348 @dots{}/maint.c:121: internal-error: testing, 1, 2
31349 A problem internal to GDB has been detected. Further
31350 debugging may prove unreliable.
31351 Quit this debugging session? (y or n) @kbd{n}
31352 Create a core file? (y or n) @kbd{n}
31353 (@value{GDBP})
31354 @end smallexample
31355
31356 @cindex @value{GDBN} internal error
31357 @cindex internal errors, control of @value{GDBN} behavior
31358
31359 @kindex maint set internal-error
31360 @kindex maint show internal-error
31361 @kindex maint set internal-warning
31362 @kindex maint show internal-warning
31363 @item maint set internal-error @var{action} [ask|yes|no]
31364 @itemx maint show internal-error @var{action}
31365 @itemx maint set internal-warning @var{action} [ask|yes|no]
31366 @itemx maint show internal-warning @var{action}
31367 When @value{GDBN} reports an internal problem (error or warning) it
31368 gives the user the opportunity to both quit @value{GDBN} and create a
31369 core file of the current @value{GDBN} session. These commands let you
31370 override the default behaviour for each particular @var{action},
31371 described in the table below.
31372
31373 @table @samp
31374 @item quit
31375 You can specify that @value{GDBN} should always (yes) or never (no)
31376 quit. The default is to ask the user what to do.
31377
31378 @item corefile
31379 You can specify that @value{GDBN} should always (yes) or never (no)
31380 create a core file. The default is to ask the user what to do.
31381 @end table
31382
31383 @kindex maint packet
31384 @item maint packet @var{text}
31385 If @value{GDBN} is talking to an inferior via the serial protocol,
31386 then this command sends the string @var{text} to the inferior, and
31387 displays the response packet. @value{GDBN} supplies the initial
31388 @samp{$} character, the terminating @samp{#} character, and the
31389 checksum.
31390
31391 @kindex maint print architecture
31392 @item maint print architecture @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
31393 Print the entire architecture configuration. The optional argument
31394 @var{file} names the file where the output goes.
31395
31396 @kindex maint print c-tdesc
31397 @item maint print c-tdesc
31398 Print the current target description (@pxref{Target Descriptions}) as
31399 a C source file. The created source file can be used in @value{GDBN}
31400 when an XML parser is not available to parse the description.
31401
31402 @kindex maint print dummy-frames
31403 @item maint print dummy-frames
31404 Prints the contents of @value{GDBN}'s internal dummy-frame stack.
31405
31406 @smallexample
31407 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{b add}
31408 @dots{}
31409 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{print add(2,3)}
31410 Breakpoint 2, add (a=2, b=3) at @dots{}
31411 58 return (a + b);
31412 The program being debugged stopped while in a function called from GDB.
31413 @dots{}
31414 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{maint print dummy-frames}
31415 0x1a57c80: pc=0x01014068 fp=0x0200bddc sp=0x0200bdd6
31416 top=0x0200bdd4 id=@{stack=0x200bddc,code=0x101405c@}
31417 call_lo=0x01014000 call_hi=0x01014001
31418 (@value{GDBP})
31419 @end smallexample
31420
31421 Takes an optional file parameter.
31422
31423 @kindex maint print registers
31424 @kindex maint print raw-registers
31425 @kindex maint print cooked-registers
31426 @kindex maint print register-groups
31427 @item maint print registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
31428 @itemx maint print raw-registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
31429 @itemx maint print cooked-registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
31430 @itemx maint print register-groups @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
31431 Print @value{GDBN}'s internal register data structures.
31432
31433 The command @code{maint print raw-registers} includes the contents of
31434 the raw register cache; the command @code{maint print cooked-registers}
31435 includes the (cooked) value of all registers, including registers which
31436 aren't available on the target nor visible to user; and the
31437 command @code{maint print register-groups} includes the groups that each
31438 register is a member of. @xref{Registers,, Registers, gdbint,
31439 @value{GDBN} Internals}.
31440
31441 These commands take an optional parameter, a file name to which to
31442 write the information.
31443
31444 @kindex maint print reggroups
31445 @item maint print reggroups @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
31446 Print @value{GDBN}'s internal register group data structures. The
31447 optional argument @var{file} tells to what file to write the
31448 information.
31449
31450 The register groups info looks like this:
31451
31452 @smallexample
31453 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{maint print reggroups}
31454 Group Type
31455 general user
31456 float user
31457 all user
31458 vector user
31459 system user
31460 save internal
31461 restore internal
31462 @end smallexample
31463
31464 @kindex flushregs
31465 @item flushregs
31466 This command forces @value{GDBN} to flush its internal register cache.
31467
31468 @kindex maint print objfiles
31469 @cindex info for known object files
31470 @item maint print objfiles
31471 Print a dump of all known object files. For each object file, this
31472 command prints its name, address in memory, and all of its psymtabs
31473 and symtabs.
31474
31475 @kindex maint print section-scripts
31476 @cindex info for known .debug_gdb_scripts-loaded scripts
31477 @item maint print section-scripts [@var{regexp}]
31478 Print a dump of scripts specified in the @code{.debug_gdb_section} section.
31479 If @var{regexp} is specified, only print scripts loaded by object files
31480 matching @var{regexp}.
31481 For each script, this command prints its name as specified in the objfile,
31482 and the full path if known.
31483 @xref{.debug_gdb_scripts section}.
31484
31485 @kindex maint print statistics
31486 @cindex bcache statistics
31487 @item maint print statistics
31488 This command prints, for each object file in the program, various data
31489 about that object file followed by the byte cache (@dfn{bcache})
31490 statistics for the object file. The objfile data includes the number
31491 of minimal, partial, full, and stabs symbols, the number of types
31492 defined by the objfile, the number of as yet unexpanded psym tables,
31493 the number of line tables and string tables, and the amount of memory
31494 used by the various tables. The bcache statistics include the counts,
31495 sizes, and counts of duplicates of all and unique objects, max,
31496 average, and median entry size, total memory used and its overhead and
31497 savings, and various measures of the hash table size and chain
31498 lengths.
31499
31500 @kindex maint print target-stack
31501 @cindex target stack description
31502 @item maint print target-stack
31503 A @dfn{target} is an interface between the debugger and a particular
31504 kind of file or process. Targets can be stacked in @dfn{strata},
31505 so that more than one target can potentially respond to a request.
31506 In particular, memory accesses will walk down the stack of targets
31507 until they find a target that is interested in handling that particular
31508 address.
31509
31510 This command prints a short description of each layer that was pushed on
31511 the @dfn{target stack}, starting from the top layer down to the bottom one.
31512
31513 @kindex maint print type
31514 @cindex type chain of a data type
31515 @item maint print type @var{expr}
31516 Print the type chain for a type specified by @var{expr}. The argument
31517 can be either a type name or a symbol. If it is a symbol, the type of
31518 that symbol is described. The type chain produced by this command is
31519 a recursive definition of the data type as stored in @value{GDBN}'s
31520 data structures, including its flags and contained types.
31521
31522 @kindex maint set dwarf2 always-disassemble
31523 @kindex maint show dwarf2 always-disassemble
31524 @item maint set dwarf2 always-disassemble
31525 @item maint show dwarf2 always-disassemble
31526 Control the behavior of @code{info address} when using DWARF debugging
31527 information.
31528
31529 The default is @code{off}, which means that @value{GDBN} should try to
31530 describe a variable's location in an easily readable format. When
31531 @code{on}, @value{GDBN} will instead display the DWARF location
31532 expression in an assembly-like format. Note that some locations are
31533 too complex for @value{GDBN} to describe simply; in this case you will
31534 always see the disassembly form.
31535
31536 Here is an example of the resulting disassembly:
31537
31538 @smallexample
31539 (gdb) info addr argc
31540 Symbol "argc" is a complex DWARF expression:
31541 1: DW_OP_fbreg 0
31542 @end smallexample
31543
31544 For more information on these expressions, see
31545 @uref{http://www.dwarfstd.org/, the DWARF standard}.
31546
31547 @kindex maint set dwarf2 max-cache-age
31548 @kindex maint show dwarf2 max-cache-age
31549 @item maint set dwarf2 max-cache-age
31550 @itemx maint show dwarf2 max-cache-age
31551 Control the DWARF 2 compilation unit cache.
31552
31553 @cindex DWARF 2 compilation units cache
31554 In object files with inter-compilation-unit references, such as those
31555 produced by the GCC option @samp{-feliminate-dwarf2-dups}, the DWARF 2
31556 reader needs to frequently refer to previously read compilation units.
31557 This setting controls how long a compilation unit will remain in the
31558 cache if it is not referenced. A higher limit means that cached
31559 compilation units will be stored in memory longer, and more total
31560 memory will be used. Setting it to zero disables caching, which will
31561 slow down @value{GDBN} startup, but reduce memory consumption.
31562
31563 @kindex maint set profile
31564 @kindex maint show profile
31565 @cindex profiling GDB
31566 @item maint set profile
31567 @itemx maint show profile
31568 Control profiling of @value{GDBN}.
31569
31570 Profiling will be disabled until you use the @samp{maint set profile}
31571 command to enable it. When you enable profiling, the system will begin
31572 collecting timing and execution count data; when you disable profiling or
31573 exit @value{GDBN}, the results will be written to a log file. Remember that
31574 if you use profiling, @value{GDBN} will overwrite the profiling log file
31575 (often called @file{gmon.out}). If you have a record of important profiling
31576 data in a @file{gmon.out} file, be sure to move it to a safe location.
31577
31578 Configuring with @samp{--enable-profiling} arranges for @value{GDBN} to be
31579 compiled with the @samp{-pg} compiler option.
31580
31581 @kindex maint set show-debug-regs
31582 @kindex maint show show-debug-regs
31583 @cindex hardware debug registers
31584 @item maint set show-debug-regs
31585 @itemx maint show show-debug-regs
31586 Control whether to show variables that mirror the hardware debug
31587 registers. Use @code{ON} to enable, @code{OFF} to disable. If
31588 enabled, the debug registers values are shown when @value{GDBN} inserts or
31589 removes a hardware breakpoint or watchpoint, and when the inferior
31590 triggers a hardware-assisted breakpoint or watchpoint.
31591
31592 @kindex maint set show-all-tib
31593 @kindex maint show show-all-tib
31594 @item maint set show-all-tib
31595 @itemx maint show show-all-tib
31596 Control whether to show all non zero areas within a 1k block starting
31597 at thread local base, when using the @samp{info w32 thread-information-block}
31598 command.
31599
31600 @kindex maint space
31601 @cindex memory used by commands
31602 @item maint space
31603 Control whether to display memory usage for each command. If set to a
31604 nonzero value, @value{GDBN} will display how much memory each command
31605 took, following the command's own output. This can also be requested
31606 by invoking @value{GDBN} with the @option{--statistics} command-line
31607 switch (@pxref{Mode Options}).
31608
31609 @kindex maint time
31610 @cindex time of command execution
31611 @item maint time
31612 Control whether to display the execution time for each command. If
31613 set to a nonzero value, @value{GDBN} will display how much time it
31614 took to execute each command, following the command's own output.
31615 The time is not printed for the commands that run the target, since
31616 there's no mechanism currently to compute how much time was spend
31617 by @value{GDBN} and how much time was spend by the program been debugged.
31618 it's not possibly currently
31619 This can also be requested by invoking @value{GDBN} with the
31620 @option{--statistics} command-line switch (@pxref{Mode Options}).
31621
31622 @kindex maint translate-address
31623 @item maint translate-address @r{[}@var{section}@r{]} @var{addr}
31624 Find the symbol stored at the location specified by the address
31625 @var{addr} and an optional section name @var{section}. If found,
31626 @value{GDBN} prints the name of the closest symbol and an offset from
31627 the symbol's location to the specified address. This is similar to
31628 the @code{info address} command (@pxref{Symbols}), except that this
31629 command also allows to find symbols in other sections.
31630
31631 If section was not specified, the section in which the symbol was found
31632 is also printed. For dynamically linked executables, the name of
31633 executable or shared library containing the symbol is printed as well.
31634
31635 @end table
31636
31637 The following command is useful for non-interactive invocations of
31638 @value{GDBN}, such as in the test suite.
31639
31640 @table @code
31641 @item set watchdog @var{nsec}
31642 @kindex set watchdog
31643 @cindex watchdog timer
31644 @cindex timeout for commands
31645 Set the maximum number of seconds @value{GDBN} will wait for the
31646 target operation to finish. If this time expires, @value{GDBN}
31647 reports and error and the command is aborted.
31648
31649 @item show watchdog
31650 Show the current setting of the target wait timeout.
31651 @end table
31652
31653 @node Remote Protocol
31654 @appendix @value{GDBN} Remote Serial Protocol
31655
31656 @menu
31657 * Overview::
31658 * Packets::
31659 * Stop Reply Packets::
31660 * General Query Packets::
31661 * Architecture-Specific Protocol Details::
31662 * Tracepoint Packets::
31663 * Host I/O Packets::
31664 * Interrupts::
31665 * Notification Packets::
31666 * Remote Non-Stop::
31667 * Packet Acknowledgment::
31668 * Examples::
31669 * File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension::
31670 * Library List Format::
31671 * Memory Map Format::
31672 * Thread List Format::
31673 @end menu
31674
31675 @node Overview
31676 @section Overview
31677
31678 There may be occasions when you need to know something about the
31679 protocol---for example, if there is only one serial port to your target
31680 machine, you might want your program to do something special if it
31681 recognizes a packet meant for @value{GDBN}.
31682
31683 In the examples below, @samp{->} and @samp{<-} are used to indicate
31684 transmitted and received data, respectively.
31685
31686 @cindex protocol, @value{GDBN} remote serial
31687 @cindex serial protocol, @value{GDBN} remote
31688 @cindex remote serial protocol
31689 All @value{GDBN} commands and responses (other than acknowledgments
31690 and notifications, see @ref{Notification Packets}) are sent as a
31691 @var{packet}. A @var{packet} is introduced with the character
31692 @samp{$}, the actual @var{packet-data}, and the terminating character
31693 @samp{#} followed by a two-digit @var{checksum}:
31694
31695 @smallexample
31696 @code{$}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
31697 @end smallexample
31698 @noindent
31699
31700 @cindex checksum, for @value{GDBN} remote
31701 @noindent
31702 The two-digit @var{checksum} is computed as the modulo 256 sum of all
31703 characters between the leading @samp{$} and the trailing @samp{#} (an
31704 eight bit unsigned checksum).
31705
31706 Implementors should note that prior to @value{GDBN} 5.0 the protocol
31707 specification also included an optional two-digit @var{sequence-id}:
31708
31709 @smallexample
31710 @code{$}@var{sequence-id}@code{:}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
31711 @end smallexample
31712
31713 @cindex sequence-id, for @value{GDBN} remote
31714 @noindent
31715 That @var{sequence-id} was appended to the acknowledgment. @value{GDBN}
31716 has never output @var{sequence-id}s. Stubs that handle packets added
31717 since @value{GDBN} 5.0 must not accept @var{sequence-id}.
31718
31719 When either the host or the target machine receives a packet, the first
31720 response expected is an acknowledgment: either @samp{+} (to indicate
31721 the package was received correctly) or @samp{-} (to request
31722 retransmission):
31723
31724 @smallexample
31725 -> @code{$}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
31726 <- @code{+}
31727 @end smallexample
31728 @noindent
31729
31730 The @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgments can be disabled
31731 once a connection is established.
31732 @xref{Packet Acknowledgment}, for details.
31733
31734 The host (@value{GDBN}) sends @var{command}s, and the target (the
31735 debugging stub incorporated in your program) sends a @var{response}. In
31736 the case of step and continue @var{command}s, the response is only sent
31737 when the operation has completed, and the target has again stopped all
31738 threads in all attached processes. This is the default all-stop mode
31739 behavior, but the remote protocol also supports @value{GDBN}'s non-stop
31740 execution mode; see @ref{Remote Non-Stop}, for details.
31741
31742 @var{packet-data} consists of a sequence of characters with the
31743 exception of @samp{#} and @samp{$} (see @samp{X} packet for additional
31744 exceptions).
31745
31746 @cindex remote protocol, field separator
31747 Fields within the packet should be separated using @samp{,} @samp{;} or
31748 @samp{:}. Except where otherwise noted all numbers are represented in
31749 @sc{hex} with leading zeros suppressed.
31750
31751 Implementors should note that prior to @value{GDBN} 5.0, the character
31752 @samp{:} could not appear as the third character in a packet (as it
31753 would potentially conflict with the @var{sequence-id}).
31754
31755 @cindex remote protocol, binary data
31756 @anchor{Binary Data}
31757 Binary data in most packets is encoded either as two hexadecimal
31758 digits per byte of binary data. This allowed the traditional remote
31759 protocol to work over connections which were only seven-bit clean.
31760 Some packets designed more recently assume an eight-bit clean
31761 connection, and use a more efficient encoding to send and receive
31762 binary data.
31763
31764 The binary data representation uses @code{7d} (@sc{ascii} @samp{@}})
31765 as an escape character. Any escaped byte is transmitted as the escape
31766 character followed by the original character XORed with @code{0x20}.
31767 For example, the byte @code{0x7d} would be transmitted as the two
31768 bytes @code{0x7d 0x5d}. The bytes @code{0x23} (@sc{ascii} @samp{#}),
31769 @code{0x24} (@sc{ascii} @samp{$}), and @code{0x7d} (@sc{ascii}
31770 @samp{@}}) must always be escaped. Responses sent by the stub
31771 must also escape @code{0x2a} (@sc{ascii} @samp{*}), so that it
31772 is not interpreted as the start of a run-length encoded sequence
31773 (described next).
31774
31775 Response @var{data} can be run-length encoded to save space.
31776 Run-length encoding replaces runs of identical characters with one
31777 instance of the repeated character, followed by a @samp{*} and a
31778 repeat count. The repeat count is itself sent encoded, to avoid
31779 binary characters in @var{data}: a value of @var{n} is sent as
31780 @code{@var{n}+29}. For a repeat count greater or equal to 3, this
31781 produces a printable @sc{ascii} character, e.g.@: a space (@sc{ascii}
31782 code 32) for a repeat count of 3. (This is because run-length
31783 encoding starts to win for counts 3 or more.) Thus, for example,
31784 @samp{0* } is a run-length encoding of ``0000'': the space character
31785 after @samp{*} means repeat the leading @code{0} @w{@code{32 - 29 =
31786 3}} more times.
31787
31788 The printable characters @samp{#} and @samp{$} or with a numeric value
31789 greater than 126 must not be used. Runs of six repeats (@samp{#}) or
31790 seven repeats (@samp{$}) can be expanded using a repeat count of only
31791 five (@samp{"}). For example, @samp{00000000} can be encoded as
31792 @samp{0*"00}.
31793
31794 The error response returned for some packets includes a two character
31795 error number. That number is not well defined.
31796
31797 @cindex empty response, for unsupported packets
31798 For any @var{command} not supported by the stub, an empty response
31799 (@samp{$#00}) should be returned. That way it is possible to extend the
31800 protocol. A newer @value{GDBN} can tell if a packet is supported based
31801 on that response.
31802
31803 A stub is required to support the @samp{g}, @samp{G}, @samp{m}, @samp{M},
31804 @samp{c}, and @samp{s} @var{command}s. All other @var{command}s are
31805 optional.
31806
31807 @node Packets
31808 @section Packets
31809
31810 The following table provides a complete list of all currently defined
31811 @var{command}s and their corresponding response @var{data}.
31812 @xref{File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension}, for details about the File
31813 I/O extension of the remote protocol.
31814
31815 Each packet's description has a template showing the packet's overall
31816 syntax, followed by an explanation of the packet's meaning. We
31817 include spaces in some of the templates for clarity; these are not
31818 part of the packet's syntax. No @value{GDBN} packet uses spaces to
31819 separate its components. For example, a template like @samp{foo
31820 @var{bar} @var{baz}} describes a packet beginning with the three ASCII
31821 bytes @samp{foo}, followed by a @var{bar}, followed directly by a
31822 @var{baz}. @value{GDBN} does not transmit a space character between the
31823 @samp{foo} and the @var{bar}, or between the @var{bar} and the
31824 @var{baz}.
31825
31826 @cindex @var{thread-id}, in remote protocol
31827 @anchor{thread-id syntax}
31828 Several packets and replies include a @var{thread-id} field to identify
31829 a thread. Normally these are positive numbers with a target-specific
31830 interpretation, formatted as big-endian hex strings. A @var{thread-id}
31831 can also be a literal @samp{-1} to indicate all threads, or @samp{0} to
31832 pick any thread.
31833
31834 In addition, the remote protocol supports a multiprocess feature in
31835 which the @var{thread-id} syntax is extended to optionally include both
31836 process and thread ID fields, as @samp{p@var{pid}.@var{tid}}.
31837 The @var{pid} (process) and @var{tid} (thread) components each have the
31838 format described above: a positive number with target-specific
31839 interpretation formatted as a big-endian hex string, literal @samp{-1}
31840 to indicate all processes or threads (respectively), or @samp{0} to
31841 indicate an arbitrary process or thread. Specifying just a process, as
31842 @samp{p@var{pid}}, is equivalent to @samp{p@var{pid}.-1}. It is an
31843 error to specify all processes but a specific thread, such as
31844 @samp{p-1.@var{tid}}. Note that the @samp{p} prefix is @emph{not} used
31845 for those packets and replies explicitly documented to include a process
31846 ID, rather than a @var{thread-id}.
31847
31848 The multiprocess @var{thread-id} syntax extensions are only used if both
31849 @value{GDBN} and the stub report support for the @samp{multiprocess}
31850 feature using @samp{qSupported}. @xref{multiprocess extensions}, for
31851 more information.
31852
31853 Note that all packet forms beginning with an upper- or lower-case
31854 letter, other than those described here, are reserved for future use.
31855
31856 Here are the packet descriptions.
31857
31858 @table @samp
31859
31860 @item !
31861 @cindex @samp{!} packet
31862 @anchor{extended mode}
31863 Enable extended mode. In extended mode, the remote server is made
31864 persistent. The @samp{R} packet is used to restart the program being
31865 debugged.
31866
31867 Reply:
31868 @table @samp
31869 @item OK
31870 The remote target both supports and has enabled extended mode.
31871 @end table
31872
31873 @item ?
31874 @cindex @samp{?} packet
31875 Indicate the reason the target halted. The reply is the same as for
31876 step and continue. This packet has a special interpretation when the
31877 target is in non-stop mode; see @ref{Remote Non-Stop}.
31878
31879 Reply:
31880 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
31881
31882 @item A @var{arglen},@var{argnum},@var{arg},@dots{}
31883 @cindex @samp{A} packet
31884 Initialized @code{argv[]} array passed into program. @var{arglen}
31885 specifies the number of bytes in the hex encoded byte stream
31886 @var{arg}. See @code{gdbserver} for more details.
31887
31888 Reply:
31889 @table @samp
31890 @item OK
31891 The arguments were set.
31892 @item E @var{NN}
31893 An error occurred.
31894 @end table
31895
31896 @item b @var{baud}
31897 @cindex @samp{b} packet
31898 (Don't use this packet; its behavior is not well-defined.)
31899 Change the serial line speed to @var{baud}.
31900
31901 JTC: @emph{When does the transport layer state change? When it's
31902 received, or after the ACK is transmitted. In either case, there are
31903 problems if the command or the acknowledgment packet is dropped.}
31904
31905 Stan: @emph{If people really wanted to add something like this, and get
31906 it working for the first time, they ought to modify ser-unix.c to send
31907 some kind of out-of-band message to a specially-setup stub and have the
31908 switch happen "in between" packets, so that from remote protocol's point
31909 of view, nothing actually happened.}
31910
31911 @item B @var{addr},@var{mode}
31912 @cindex @samp{B} packet
31913 Set (@var{mode} is @samp{S}) or clear (@var{mode} is @samp{C}) a
31914 breakpoint at @var{addr}.
31915
31916 Don't use this packet. Use the @samp{Z} and @samp{z} packets instead
31917 (@pxref{insert breakpoint or watchpoint packet}).
31918
31919 @cindex @samp{bc} packet
31920 @anchor{bc}
31921 @item bc
31922 Backward continue. Execute the target system in reverse. No parameter.
31923 @xref{Reverse Execution}, for more information.
31924
31925 Reply:
31926 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
31927
31928 @cindex @samp{bs} packet
31929 @anchor{bs}
31930 @item bs
31931 Backward single step. Execute one instruction in reverse. No parameter.
31932 @xref{Reverse Execution}, for more information.
31933
31934 Reply:
31935 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
31936
31937 @item c @r{[}@var{addr}@r{]}
31938 @cindex @samp{c} packet
31939 Continue. @var{addr} is address to resume. If @var{addr} is omitted,
31940 resume at current address.
31941
31942 Reply:
31943 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
31944
31945 @item C @var{sig}@r{[};@var{addr}@r{]}
31946 @cindex @samp{C} packet
31947 Continue with signal @var{sig} (hex signal number). If
31948 @samp{;@var{addr}} is omitted, resume at same address.
31949
31950 Reply:
31951 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
31952
31953 @item d
31954 @cindex @samp{d} packet
31955 Toggle debug flag.
31956
31957 Don't use this packet; instead, define a general set packet
31958 (@pxref{General Query Packets}).
31959
31960 @item D
31961 @itemx D;@var{pid}
31962 @cindex @samp{D} packet
31963 The first form of the packet is used to detach @value{GDBN} from the
31964 remote system. It is sent to the remote target
31965 before @value{GDBN} disconnects via the @code{detach} command.
31966
31967 The second form, including a process ID, is used when multiprocess
31968 protocol extensions are enabled (@pxref{multiprocess extensions}), to
31969 detach only a specific process. The @var{pid} is specified as a
31970 big-endian hex string.
31971
31972 Reply:
31973 @table @samp
31974 @item OK
31975 for success
31976 @item E @var{NN}
31977 for an error
31978 @end table
31979
31980 @item F @var{RC},@var{EE},@var{CF};@var{XX}
31981 @cindex @samp{F} packet
31982 A reply from @value{GDBN} to an @samp{F} packet sent by the target.
31983 This is part of the File-I/O protocol extension. @xref{File-I/O
31984 Remote Protocol Extension}, for the specification.
31985
31986 @item g
31987 @anchor{read registers packet}
31988 @cindex @samp{g} packet
31989 Read general registers.
31990
31991 Reply:
31992 @table @samp
31993 @item @var{XX@dots{}}
31994 Each byte of register data is described by two hex digits. The bytes
31995 with the register are transmitted in target byte order. The size of
31996 each register and their position within the @samp{g} packet are
31997 determined by the @value{GDBN} internal gdbarch functions
31998 @code{DEPRECATED_REGISTER_RAW_SIZE} and @code{gdbarch_register_name}. The
31999 specification of several standard @samp{g} packets is specified below.
32000
32001 When reading registers from a trace frame (@pxref{Analyze Collected
32002 Data,,Using the Collected Data}), the stub may also return a string of
32003 literal @samp{x}'s in place of the register data digits, to indicate
32004 that the corresponding register has not been collected, thus its value
32005 is unavailable. For example, for an architecture with 4 registers of
32006 4 bytes each, the following reply indicates to @value{GDBN} that
32007 registers 0 and 2 have not been collected, while registers 1 and 3
32008 have been collected, and both have zero value:
32009
32010 @smallexample
32011 -> @code{g}
32012 <- @code{xxxxxxxx00000000xxxxxxxx00000000}
32013 @end smallexample
32014
32015 @item E @var{NN}
32016 for an error.
32017 @end table
32018
32019 @item G @var{XX@dots{}}
32020 @cindex @samp{G} packet
32021 Write general registers. @xref{read registers packet}, for a
32022 description of the @var{XX@dots{}} data.
32023
32024 Reply:
32025 @table @samp
32026 @item OK
32027 for success
32028 @item E @var{NN}
32029 for an error
32030 @end table
32031
32032 @item H @var{c} @var{thread-id}
32033 @cindex @samp{H} packet
32034 Set thread for subsequent operations (@samp{m}, @samp{M}, @samp{g},
32035 @samp{G}, et.al.). @var{c} depends on the operation to be performed: it
32036 should be @samp{c} for step and continue operations, @samp{g} for other
32037 operations. The thread designator @var{thread-id} has the format and
32038 interpretation described in @ref{thread-id syntax}.
32039
32040 Reply:
32041 @table @samp
32042 @item OK
32043 for success
32044 @item E @var{NN}
32045 for an error
32046 @end table
32047
32048 @c FIXME: JTC:
32049 @c 'H': How restrictive (or permissive) is the thread model. If a
32050 @c thread is selected and stopped, are other threads allowed
32051 @c to continue to execute? As I mentioned above, I think the
32052 @c semantics of each command when a thread is selected must be
32053 @c described. For example:
32054 @c
32055 @c 'g': If the stub supports threads and a specific thread is
32056 @c selected, returns the register block from that thread;
32057 @c otherwise returns current registers.
32058 @c
32059 @c 'G' If the stub supports threads and a specific thread is
32060 @c selected, sets the registers of the register block of
32061 @c that thread; otherwise sets current registers.
32062
32063 @item i @r{[}@var{addr}@r{[},@var{nnn}@r{]]}
32064 @anchor{cycle step packet}
32065 @cindex @samp{i} packet
32066 Step the remote target by a single clock cycle. If @samp{,@var{nnn}} is
32067 present, cycle step @var{nnn} cycles. If @var{addr} is present, cycle
32068 step starting at that address.
32069
32070 @item I
32071 @cindex @samp{I} packet
32072 Signal, then cycle step. @xref{step with signal packet}. @xref{cycle
32073 step packet}.
32074
32075 @item k
32076 @cindex @samp{k} packet
32077 Kill request.
32078
32079 FIXME: @emph{There is no description of how to operate when a specific
32080 thread context has been selected (i.e.@: does 'k' kill only that
32081 thread?)}.
32082
32083 @item m @var{addr},@var{length}
32084 @cindex @samp{m} packet
32085 Read @var{length} bytes of memory starting at address @var{addr}.
32086 Note that @var{addr} may not be aligned to any particular boundary.
32087
32088 The stub need not use any particular size or alignment when gathering
32089 data from memory for the response; even if @var{addr} is word-aligned
32090 and @var{length} is a multiple of the word size, the stub is free to
32091 use byte accesses, or not. For this reason, this packet may not be
32092 suitable for accessing memory-mapped I/O devices.
32093 @cindex alignment of remote memory accesses
32094 @cindex size of remote memory accesses
32095 @cindex memory, alignment and size of remote accesses
32096
32097 Reply:
32098 @table @samp
32099 @item @var{XX@dots{}}
32100 Memory contents; each byte is transmitted as a two-digit hexadecimal
32101 number. The reply may contain fewer bytes than requested if the
32102 server was able to read only part of the region of memory.
32103 @item E @var{NN}
32104 @var{NN} is errno
32105 @end table
32106
32107 @item M @var{addr},@var{length}:@var{XX@dots{}}
32108 @cindex @samp{M} packet
32109 Write @var{length} bytes of memory starting at address @var{addr}.
32110 @var{XX@dots{}} is the data; each byte is transmitted as a two-digit
32111 hexadecimal number.
32112
32113 Reply:
32114 @table @samp
32115 @item OK
32116 for success
32117 @item E @var{NN}
32118 for an error (this includes the case where only part of the data was
32119 written).
32120 @end table
32121
32122 @item p @var{n}
32123 @cindex @samp{p} packet
32124 Read the value of register @var{n}; @var{n} is in hex.
32125 @xref{read registers packet}, for a description of how the returned
32126 register value is encoded.
32127
32128 Reply:
32129 @table @samp
32130 @item @var{XX@dots{}}
32131 the register's value
32132 @item E @var{NN}
32133 for an error
32134 @item
32135 Indicating an unrecognized @var{query}.
32136 @end table
32137
32138 @item P @var{n@dots{}}=@var{r@dots{}}
32139 @anchor{write register packet}
32140 @cindex @samp{P} packet
32141 Write register @var{n@dots{}} with value @var{r@dots{}}. The register
32142 number @var{n} is in hexadecimal, and @var{r@dots{}} contains two hex
32143 digits for each byte in the register (target byte order).
32144
32145 Reply:
32146 @table @samp
32147 @item OK
32148 for success
32149 @item E @var{NN}
32150 for an error
32151 @end table
32152
32153 @item q @var{name} @var{params}@dots{}
32154 @itemx Q @var{name} @var{params}@dots{}
32155 @cindex @samp{q} packet
32156 @cindex @samp{Q} packet
32157 General query (@samp{q}) and set (@samp{Q}). These packets are
32158 described fully in @ref{General Query Packets}.
32159
32160 @item r
32161 @cindex @samp{r} packet
32162 Reset the entire system.
32163
32164 Don't use this packet; use the @samp{R} packet instead.
32165
32166 @item R @var{XX}
32167 @cindex @samp{R} packet
32168 Restart the program being debugged. @var{XX}, while needed, is ignored.
32169 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended mode}).
32170
32171 The @samp{R} packet has no reply.
32172
32173 @item s @r{[}@var{addr}@r{]}
32174 @cindex @samp{s} packet
32175 Single step. @var{addr} is the address at which to resume. If
32176 @var{addr} is omitted, resume at same address.
32177
32178 Reply:
32179 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
32180
32181 @item S @var{sig}@r{[};@var{addr}@r{]}
32182 @anchor{step with signal packet}
32183 @cindex @samp{S} packet
32184 Step with signal. This is analogous to the @samp{C} packet, but
32185 requests a single-step, rather than a normal resumption of execution.
32186
32187 Reply:
32188 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
32189
32190 @item t @var{addr}:@var{PP},@var{MM}
32191 @cindex @samp{t} packet
32192 Search backwards starting at address @var{addr} for a match with pattern
32193 @var{PP} and mask @var{MM}. @var{PP} and @var{MM} are 4 bytes.
32194 @var{addr} must be at least 3 digits.
32195
32196 @item T @var{thread-id}
32197 @cindex @samp{T} packet
32198 Find out if the thread @var{thread-id} is alive. @xref{thread-id syntax}.
32199
32200 Reply:
32201 @table @samp
32202 @item OK
32203 thread is still alive
32204 @item E @var{NN}
32205 thread is dead
32206 @end table
32207
32208 @item v
32209 Packets starting with @samp{v} are identified by a multi-letter name,
32210 up to the first @samp{;} or @samp{?} (or the end of the packet).
32211
32212 @item vAttach;@var{pid}
32213 @cindex @samp{vAttach} packet
32214 Attach to a new process with the specified process ID @var{pid}.
32215 The process ID is a
32216 hexadecimal integer identifying the process. In all-stop mode, all
32217 threads in the attached process are stopped; in non-stop mode, it may be
32218 attached without being stopped if that is supported by the target.
32219
32220 @c In non-stop mode, on a successful vAttach, the stub should set the
32221 @c current thread to a thread of the newly-attached process. After
32222 @c attaching, GDB queries for the attached process's thread ID with qC.
32223 @c Also note that, from a user perspective, whether or not the
32224 @c target is stopped on attach in non-stop mode depends on whether you
32225 @c use the foreground or background version of the attach command, not
32226 @c on what vAttach does; GDB does the right thing with respect to either
32227 @c stopping or restarting threads.
32228
32229 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended mode}).
32230
32231 Reply:
32232 @table @samp
32233 @item E @var{nn}
32234 for an error
32235 @item @r{Any stop packet}
32236 for success in all-stop mode (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets})
32237 @item OK
32238 for success in non-stop mode (@pxref{Remote Non-Stop})
32239 @end table
32240
32241 @item vCont@r{[};@var{action}@r{[}:@var{thread-id}@r{]]}@dots{}
32242 @cindex @samp{vCont} packet
32243 Resume the inferior, specifying different actions for each thread.
32244 If an action is specified with no @var{thread-id}, then it is applied to any
32245 threads that don't have a specific action specified; if no default action is
32246 specified then other threads should remain stopped in all-stop mode and
32247 in their current state in non-stop mode.
32248 Specifying multiple
32249 default actions is an error; specifying no actions is also an error.
32250 Thread IDs are specified using the syntax described in @ref{thread-id syntax}.
32251
32252 Currently supported actions are:
32253
32254 @table @samp
32255 @item c
32256 Continue.
32257 @item C @var{sig}
32258 Continue with signal @var{sig}. The signal @var{sig} should be two hex digits.
32259 @item s
32260 Step.
32261 @item S @var{sig}
32262 Step with signal @var{sig}. The signal @var{sig} should be two hex digits.
32263 @item t
32264 Stop.
32265 @end table
32266
32267 The optional argument @var{addr} normally associated with the
32268 @samp{c}, @samp{C}, @samp{s}, and @samp{S} packets is
32269 not supported in @samp{vCont}.
32270
32271 The @samp{t} action is only relevant in non-stop mode
32272 (@pxref{Remote Non-Stop}) and may be ignored by the stub otherwise.
32273 A stop reply should be generated for any affected thread not already stopped.
32274 When a thread is stopped by means of a @samp{t} action,
32275 the corresponding stop reply should indicate that the thread has stopped with
32276 signal @samp{0}, regardless of whether the target uses some other signal
32277 as an implementation detail.
32278
32279 Reply:
32280 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
32281
32282 @item vCont?
32283 @cindex @samp{vCont?} packet
32284 Request a list of actions supported by the @samp{vCont} packet.
32285
32286 Reply:
32287 @table @samp
32288 @item vCont@r{[};@var{action}@dots{}@r{]}
32289 The @samp{vCont} packet is supported. Each @var{action} is a supported
32290 command in the @samp{vCont} packet.
32291 @item
32292 The @samp{vCont} packet is not supported.
32293 @end table
32294
32295 @item vFile:@var{operation}:@var{parameter}@dots{}
32296 @cindex @samp{vFile} packet
32297 Perform a file operation on the target system. For details,
32298 see @ref{Host I/O Packets}.
32299
32300 @item vFlashErase:@var{addr},@var{length}
32301 @cindex @samp{vFlashErase} packet
32302 Direct the stub to erase @var{length} bytes of flash starting at
32303 @var{addr}. The region may enclose any number of flash blocks, but
32304 its start and end must fall on block boundaries, as indicated by the
32305 flash block size appearing in the memory map (@pxref{Memory Map
32306 Format}). @value{GDBN} groups flash memory programming operations
32307 together, and sends a @samp{vFlashDone} request after each group; the
32308 stub is allowed to delay erase operation until the @samp{vFlashDone}
32309 packet is received.
32310
32311 The stub must support @samp{vCont} if it reports support for
32312 multiprocess extensions (@pxref{multiprocess extensions}). Note that in
32313 this case @samp{vCont} actions can be specified to apply to all threads
32314 in a process by using the @samp{p@var{pid}.-1} form of the
32315 @var{thread-id}.
32316
32317 Reply:
32318 @table @samp
32319 @item OK
32320 for success
32321 @item E @var{NN}
32322 for an error
32323 @end table
32324
32325 @item vFlashWrite:@var{addr}:@var{XX@dots{}}
32326 @cindex @samp{vFlashWrite} packet
32327 Direct the stub to write data to flash address @var{addr}. The data
32328 is passed in binary form using the same encoding as for the @samp{X}
32329 packet (@pxref{Binary Data}). The memory ranges specified by
32330 @samp{vFlashWrite} packets preceding a @samp{vFlashDone} packet must
32331 not overlap, and must appear in order of increasing addresses
32332 (although @samp{vFlashErase} packets for higher addresses may already
32333 have been received; the ordering is guaranteed only between
32334 @samp{vFlashWrite} packets). If a packet writes to an address that was
32335 neither erased by a preceding @samp{vFlashErase} packet nor by some other
32336 target-specific method, the results are unpredictable.
32337
32338
32339 Reply:
32340 @table @samp
32341 @item OK
32342 for success
32343 @item E.memtype
32344 for vFlashWrite addressing non-flash memory
32345 @item E @var{NN}
32346 for an error
32347 @end table
32348
32349 @item vFlashDone
32350 @cindex @samp{vFlashDone} packet
32351 Indicate to the stub that flash programming operation is finished.
32352 The stub is permitted to delay or batch the effects of a group of
32353 @samp{vFlashErase} and @samp{vFlashWrite} packets until a
32354 @samp{vFlashDone} packet is received. The contents of the affected
32355 regions of flash memory are unpredictable until the @samp{vFlashDone}
32356 request is completed.
32357
32358 @item vKill;@var{pid}
32359 @cindex @samp{vKill} packet
32360 Kill the process with the specified process ID. @var{pid} is a
32361 hexadecimal integer identifying the process. This packet is used in
32362 preference to @samp{k} when multiprocess protocol extensions are
32363 supported; see @ref{multiprocess extensions}.
32364
32365 Reply:
32366 @table @samp
32367 @item E @var{nn}
32368 for an error
32369 @item OK
32370 for success
32371 @end table
32372
32373 @item vRun;@var{filename}@r{[};@var{argument}@r{]}@dots{}
32374 @cindex @samp{vRun} packet
32375 Run the program @var{filename}, passing it each @var{argument} on its
32376 command line. The file and arguments are hex-encoded strings. If
32377 @var{filename} is an empty string, the stub may use a default program
32378 (e.g.@: the last program run). The program is created in the stopped
32379 state.
32380
32381 @c FIXME: What about non-stop mode?
32382
32383 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended mode}).
32384
32385 Reply:
32386 @table @samp
32387 @item E @var{nn}
32388 for an error
32389 @item @r{Any stop packet}
32390 for success (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets})
32391 @end table
32392
32393 @item vStopped
32394 @anchor{vStopped packet}
32395 @cindex @samp{vStopped} packet
32396
32397 In non-stop mode (@pxref{Remote Non-Stop}), acknowledge a previous stop
32398 reply and prompt for the stub to report another one.
32399
32400 Reply:
32401 @table @samp
32402 @item @r{Any stop packet}
32403 if there is another unreported stop event (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets})
32404 @item OK
32405 if there are no unreported stop events
32406 @end table
32407
32408 @item X @var{addr},@var{length}:@var{XX@dots{}}
32409 @anchor{X packet}
32410 @cindex @samp{X} packet
32411 Write data to memory, where the data is transmitted in binary.
32412 @var{addr} is address, @var{length} is number of bytes,
32413 @samp{@var{XX}@dots{}} is binary data (@pxref{Binary Data}).
32414
32415 Reply:
32416 @table @samp
32417 @item OK
32418 for success
32419 @item E @var{NN}
32420 for an error
32421 @end table
32422
32423 @item z @var{type},@var{addr},@var{kind}
32424 @itemx Z @var{type},@var{addr},@var{kind}
32425 @anchor{insert breakpoint or watchpoint packet}
32426 @cindex @samp{z} packet
32427 @cindex @samp{Z} packets
32428 Insert (@samp{Z}) or remove (@samp{z}) a @var{type} breakpoint or
32429 watchpoint starting at address @var{address} of kind @var{kind}.
32430
32431 Each breakpoint and watchpoint packet @var{type} is documented
32432 separately.
32433
32434 @emph{Implementation notes: A remote target shall return an empty string
32435 for an unrecognized breakpoint or watchpoint packet @var{type}. A
32436 remote target shall support either both or neither of a given
32437 @samp{Z@var{type}@dots{}} and @samp{z@var{type}@dots{}} packet pair. To
32438 avoid potential problems with duplicate packets, the operations should
32439 be implemented in an idempotent way.}
32440
32441 @item z0,@var{addr},@var{kind}
32442 @itemx Z0,@var{addr},@var{kind}
32443 @cindex @samp{z0} packet
32444 @cindex @samp{Z0} packet
32445 Insert (@samp{Z0}) or remove (@samp{z0}) a memory breakpoint at address
32446 @var{addr} of type @var{kind}.
32447
32448 A memory breakpoint is implemented by replacing the instruction at
32449 @var{addr} with a software breakpoint or trap instruction. The
32450 @var{kind} is target-specific and typically indicates the size of
32451 the breakpoint in bytes that should be inserted. E.g., the @sc{arm}
32452 and @sc{mips} can insert either a 2 or 4 byte breakpoint. Some
32453 architectures have additional meanings for @var{kind};
32454 see @ref{Architecture-Specific Protocol Details}.
32455
32456 @emph{Implementation note: It is possible for a target to copy or move
32457 code that contains memory breakpoints (e.g., when implementing
32458 overlays). The behavior of this packet, in the presence of such a
32459 target, is not defined.}
32460
32461 Reply:
32462 @table @samp
32463 @item OK
32464 success
32465 @item
32466 not supported
32467 @item E @var{NN}
32468 for an error
32469 @end table
32470
32471 @item z1,@var{addr},@var{kind}
32472 @itemx Z1,@var{addr},@var{kind}
32473 @cindex @samp{z1} packet
32474 @cindex @samp{Z1} packet
32475 Insert (@samp{Z1}) or remove (@samp{z1}) a hardware breakpoint at
32476 address @var{addr}.
32477
32478 A hardware breakpoint is implemented using a mechanism that is not
32479 dependant on being able to modify the target's memory. @var{kind}
32480 has the same meaning as in @samp{Z0} packets.
32481
32482 @emph{Implementation note: A hardware breakpoint is not affected by code
32483 movement.}
32484
32485 Reply:
32486 @table @samp
32487 @item OK
32488 success
32489 @item
32490 not supported
32491 @item E @var{NN}
32492 for an error
32493 @end table
32494
32495 @item z2,@var{addr},@var{kind}
32496 @itemx Z2,@var{addr},@var{kind}
32497 @cindex @samp{z2} packet
32498 @cindex @samp{Z2} packet
32499 Insert (@samp{Z2}) or remove (@samp{z2}) a write watchpoint at @var{addr}.
32500 @var{kind} is interpreted as the number of bytes to watch.
32501
32502 Reply:
32503 @table @samp
32504 @item OK
32505 success
32506 @item
32507 not supported
32508 @item E @var{NN}
32509 for an error
32510 @end table
32511
32512 @item z3,@var{addr},@var{kind}
32513 @itemx Z3,@var{addr},@var{kind}
32514 @cindex @samp{z3} packet
32515 @cindex @samp{Z3} packet
32516 Insert (@samp{Z3}) or remove (@samp{z3}) a read watchpoint at @var{addr}.
32517 @var{kind} is interpreted as the number of bytes to watch.
32518
32519 Reply:
32520 @table @samp
32521 @item OK
32522 success
32523 @item
32524 not supported
32525 @item E @var{NN}
32526 for an error
32527 @end table
32528
32529 @item z4,@var{addr},@var{kind}
32530 @itemx Z4,@var{addr},@var{kind}
32531 @cindex @samp{z4} packet
32532 @cindex @samp{Z4} packet
32533 Insert (@samp{Z4}) or remove (@samp{z4}) an access watchpoint at @var{addr}.
32534 @var{kind} is interpreted as the number of bytes to watch.
32535
32536 Reply:
32537 @table @samp
32538 @item OK
32539 success
32540 @item
32541 not supported
32542 @item E @var{NN}
32543 for an error
32544 @end table
32545
32546 @end table
32547
32548 @node Stop Reply Packets
32549 @section Stop Reply Packets
32550 @cindex stop reply packets
32551
32552 The @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}, @samp{s}, @samp{vCont},
32553 @samp{vAttach}, @samp{vRun}, @samp{vStopped}, and @samp{?} packets can
32554 receive any of the below as a reply. Except for @samp{?}
32555 and @samp{vStopped}, that reply is only returned
32556 when the target halts. In the below the exact meaning of @dfn{signal
32557 number} is defined by the header @file{include/gdb/signals.h} in the
32558 @value{GDBN} source code.
32559
32560 As in the description of request packets, we include spaces in the
32561 reply templates for clarity; these are not part of the reply packet's
32562 syntax. No @value{GDBN} stop reply packet uses spaces to separate its
32563 components.
32564
32565 @table @samp
32566
32567 @item S @var{AA}
32568 The program received signal number @var{AA} (a two-digit hexadecimal
32569 number). This is equivalent to a @samp{T} response with no
32570 @var{n}:@var{r} pairs.
32571
32572 @item T @var{AA} @var{n1}:@var{r1};@var{n2}:@var{r2};@dots{}
32573 @cindex @samp{T} packet reply
32574 The program received signal number @var{AA} (a two-digit hexadecimal
32575 number). This is equivalent to an @samp{S} response, except that the
32576 @samp{@var{n}:@var{r}} pairs can carry values of important registers
32577 and other information directly in the stop reply packet, reducing
32578 round-trip latency. Single-step and breakpoint traps are reported
32579 this way. Each @samp{@var{n}:@var{r}} pair is interpreted as follows:
32580
32581 @itemize @bullet
32582 @item
32583 If @var{n} is a hexadecimal number, it is a register number, and the
32584 corresponding @var{r} gives that register's value. @var{r} is a
32585 series of bytes in target byte order, with each byte given by a
32586 two-digit hex number.
32587
32588 @item
32589 If @var{n} is @samp{thread}, then @var{r} is the @var{thread-id} of
32590 the stopped thread, as specified in @ref{thread-id syntax}.
32591
32592 @item
32593 If @var{n} is @samp{core}, then @var{r} is the hexadecimal number of
32594 the core on which the stop event was detected.
32595
32596 @item
32597 If @var{n} is a recognized @dfn{stop reason}, it describes a more
32598 specific event that stopped the target. The currently defined stop
32599 reasons are listed below. @var{aa} should be @samp{05}, the trap
32600 signal. At most one stop reason should be present.
32601
32602 @item
32603 Otherwise, @value{GDBN} should ignore this @samp{@var{n}:@var{r}} pair
32604 and go on to the next; this allows us to extend the protocol in the
32605 future.
32606 @end itemize
32607
32608 The currently defined stop reasons are:
32609
32610 @table @samp
32611 @item watch
32612 @itemx rwatch
32613 @itemx awatch
32614 The packet indicates a watchpoint hit, and @var{r} is the data address, in
32615 hex.
32616
32617 @cindex shared library events, remote reply
32618 @item library
32619 The packet indicates that the loaded libraries have changed.
32620 @value{GDBN} should use @samp{qXfer:libraries:read} to fetch a new
32621 list of loaded libraries. @var{r} is ignored.
32622
32623 @cindex replay log events, remote reply
32624 @item replaylog
32625 The packet indicates that the target cannot continue replaying
32626 logged execution events, because it has reached the end (or the
32627 beginning when executing backward) of the log. The value of @var{r}
32628 will be either @samp{begin} or @samp{end}. @xref{Reverse Execution},
32629 for more information.
32630 @end table
32631
32632 @item W @var{AA}
32633 @itemx W @var{AA} ; process:@var{pid}
32634 The process exited, and @var{AA} is the exit status. This is only
32635 applicable to certain targets.
32636
32637 The second form of the response, including the process ID of the exited
32638 process, can be used only when @value{GDBN} has reported support for
32639 multiprocess protocol extensions; see @ref{multiprocess extensions}.
32640 The @var{pid} is formatted as a big-endian hex string.
32641
32642 @item X @var{AA}
32643 @itemx X @var{AA} ; process:@var{pid}
32644 The process terminated with signal @var{AA}.
32645
32646 The second form of the response, including the process ID of the
32647 terminated process, can be used only when @value{GDBN} has reported
32648 support for multiprocess protocol extensions; see @ref{multiprocess
32649 extensions}. The @var{pid} is formatted as a big-endian hex string.
32650
32651 @item O @var{XX}@dots{}
32652 @samp{@var{XX}@dots{}} is hex encoding of @sc{ascii} data, to be
32653 written as the program's console output. This can happen at any time
32654 while the program is running and the debugger should continue to wait
32655 for @samp{W}, @samp{T}, etc. This reply is not permitted in non-stop mode.
32656
32657 @item F @var{call-id},@var{parameter}@dots{}
32658 @var{call-id} is the identifier which says which host system call should
32659 be called. This is just the name of the function. Translation into the
32660 correct system call is only applicable as it's defined in @value{GDBN}.
32661 @xref{File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension}, for a list of implemented
32662 system calls.
32663
32664 @samp{@var{parameter}@dots{}} is a list of parameters as defined for
32665 this very system call.
32666
32667 The target replies with this packet when it expects @value{GDBN} to
32668 call a host system call on behalf of the target. @value{GDBN} replies
32669 with an appropriate @samp{F} packet and keeps up waiting for the next
32670 reply packet from the target. The latest @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}
32671 or @samp{s} action is expected to be continued. @xref{File-I/O Remote
32672 Protocol Extension}, for more details.
32673
32674 @end table
32675
32676 @node General Query Packets
32677 @section General Query Packets
32678 @cindex remote query requests
32679
32680 Packets starting with @samp{q} are @dfn{general query packets};
32681 packets starting with @samp{Q} are @dfn{general set packets}. General
32682 query and set packets are a semi-unified form for retrieving and
32683 sending information to and from the stub.
32684
32685 The initial letter of a query or set packet is followed by a name
32686 indicating what sort of thing the packet applies to. For example,
32687 @value{GDBN} may use a @samp{qSymbol} packet to exchange symbol
32688 definitions with the stub. These packet names follow some
32689 conventions:
32690
32691 @itemize @bullet
32692 @item
32693 The name must not contain commas, colons or semicolons.
32694 @item
32695 Most @value{GDBN} query and set packets have a leading upper case
32696 letter.
32697 @item
32698 The names of custom vendor packets should use a company prefix, in
32699 lower case, followed by a period. For example, packets designed at
32700 the Acme Corporation might begin with @samp{qacme.foo} (for querying
32701 foos) or @samp{Qacme.bar} (for setting bars).
32702 @end itemize
32703
32704 The name of a query or set packet should be separated from any
32705 parameters by a @samp{:}; the parameters themselves should be
32706 separated by @samp{,} or @samp{;}. Stubs must be careful to match the
32707 full packet name, and check for a separator or the end of the packet,
32708 in case two packet names share a common prefix. New packets should not begin
32709 with @samp{qC}, @samp{qP}, or @samp{qL}@footnote{The @samp{qP} and @samp{qL}
32710 packets predate these conventions, and have arguments without any terminator
32711 for the packet name; we suspect they are in widespread use in places that
32712 are difficult to upgrade. The @samp{qC} packet has no arguments, but some
32713 existing stubs (e.g.@: RedBoot) are known to not check for the end of the
32714 packet.}.
32715
32716 Like the descriptions of the other packets, each description here
32717 has a template showing the packet's overall syntax, followed by an
32718 explanation of the packet's meaning. We include spaces in some of the
32719 templates for clarity; these are not part of the packet's syntax. No
32720 @value{GDBN} packet uses spaces to separate its components.
32721
32722 Here are the currently defined query and set packets:
32723
32724 @table @samp
32725
32726 @item QAllow:@var{op}:@var{val}@dots{}
32727 @cindex @samp{QAllow} packet
32728 Specify which operations @value{GDBN} expects to request of the
32729 target, as a semicolon-separated list of operation name and value
32730 pairs. Possible values for @var{op} include @samp{WriteReg},
32731 @samp{WriteMem}, @samp{InsertBreak}, @samp{InsertTrace},
32732 @samp{InsertFastTrace}, and @samp{Stop}. @var{val} is either 0,
32733 indicating that @value{GDBN} will not request the operation, or 1,
32734 indicating that it may. (The target can then use this to set up its
32735 own internals optimally, for instance if the debugger never expects to
32736 insert breakpoints, it may not need to install its own trap handler.)
32737
32738 @item qC
32739 @cindex current thread, remote request
32740 @cindex @samp{qC} packet
32741 Return the current thread ID.
32742
32743 Reply:
32744 @table @samp
32745 @item QC @var{thread-id}
32746 Where @var{thread-id} is a thread ID as documented in
32747 @ref{thread-id syntax}.
32748 @item @r{(anything else)}
32749 Any other reply implies the old thread ID.
32750 @end table
32751
32752 @item qCRC:@var{addr},@var{length}
32753 @cindex CRC of memory block, remote request
32754 @cindex @samp{qCRC} packet
32755 Compute the CRC checksum of a block of memory using CRC-32 defined in
32756 IEEE 802.3. The CRC is computed byte at a time, taking the most
32757 significant bit of each byte first. The initial pattern code
32758 @code{0xffffffff} is used to ensure leading zeros affect the CRC.
32759
32760 @emph{Note:} This is the same CRC used in validating separate debug
32761 files (@pxref{Separate Debug Files, , Debugging Information in Separate
32762 Files}). However the algorithm is slightly different. When validating
32763 separate debug files, the CRC is computed taking the @emph{least}
32764 significant bit of each byte first, and the final result is inverted to
32765 detect trailing zeros.
32766
32767 Reply:
32768 @table @samp
32769 @item E @var{NN}
32770 An error (such as memory fault)
32771 @item C @var{crc32}
32772 The specified memory region's checksum is @var{crc32}.
32773 @end table
32774
32775 @item qfThreadInfo
32776 @itemx qsThreadInfo
32777 @cindex list active threads, remote request
32778 @cindex @samp{qfThreadInfo} packet
32779 @cindex @samp{qsThreadInfo} packet
32780 Obtain a list of all active thread IDs from the target (OS). Since there
32781 may be too many active threads to fit into one reply packet, this query
32782 works iteratively: it may require more than one query/reply sequence to
32783 obtain the entire list of threads. The first query of the sequence will
32784 be the @samp{qfThreadInfo} query; subsequent queries in the
32785 sequence will be the @samp{qsThreadInfo} query.
32786
32787 NOTE: This packet replaces the @samp{qL} query (see below).
32788
32789 Reply:
32790 @table @samp
32791 @item m @var{thread-id}
32792 A single thread ID
32793 @item m @var{thread-id},@var{thread-id}@dots{}
32794 a comma-separated list of thread IDs
32795 @item l
32796 (lower case letter @samp{L}) denotes end of list.
32797 @end table
32798
32799 In response to each query, the target will reply with a list of one or
32800 more thread IDs, separated by commas.
32801 @value{GDBN} will respond to each reply with a request for more thread
32802 ids (using the @samp{qs} form of the query), until the target responds
32803 with @samp{l} (lower-case ell, for @dfn{last}).
32804 Refer to @ref{thread-id syntax}, for the format of the @var{thread-id}
32805 fields.
32806
32807 @item qGetTLSAddr:@var{thread-id},@var{offset},@var{lm}
32808 @cindex get thread-local storage address, remote request
32809 @cindex @samp{qGetTLSAddr} packet
32810 Fetch the address associated with thread local storage specified
32811 by @var{thread-id}, @var{offset}, and @var{lm}.
32812
32813 @var{thread-id} is the thread ID associated with the
32814 thread for which to fetch the TLS address. @xref{thread-id syntax}.
32815
32816 @var{offset} is the (big endian, hex encoded) offset associated with the
32817 thread local variable. (This offset is obtained from the debug
32818 information associated with the variable.)
32819
32820 @var{lm} is the (big endian, hex encoded) OS/ABI-specific encoding of the
32821 the load module associated with the thread local storage. For example,
32822 a @sc{gnu}/Linux system will pass the link map address of the shared
32823 object associated with the thread local storage under consideration.
32824 Other operating environments may choose to represent the load module
32825 differently, so the precise meaning of this parameter will vary.
32826
32827 Reply:
32828 @table @samp
32829 @item @var{XX}@dots{}
32830 Hex encoded (big endian) bytes representing the address of the thread
32831 local storage requested.
32832
32833 @item E @var{nn}
32834 An error occurred. @var{nn} are hex digits.
32835
32836 @item
32837 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qGetTLSAddr} is not supported by the stub.
32838 @end table
32839
32840 @item qGetTIBAddr:@var{thread-id}
32841 @cindex get thread information block address
32842 @cindex @samp{qGetTIBAddr} packet
32843 Fetch address of the Windows OS specific Thread Information Block.
32844
32845 @var{thread-id} is the thread ID associated with the thread.
32846
32847 Reply:
32848 @table @samp
32849 @item @var{XX}@dots{}
32850 Hex encoded (big endian) bytes representing the linear address of the
32851 thread information block.
32852
32853 @item E @var{nn}
32854 An error occured. This means that either the thread was not found, or the
32855 address could not be retrieved.
32856
32857 @item
32858 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qGetTIBAddr} is not supported by the stub.
32859 @end table
32860
32861 @item qL @var{startflag} @var{threadcount} @var{nextthread}
32862 Obtain thread information from RTOS. Where: @var{startflag} (one hex
32863 digit) is one to indicate the first query and zero to indicate a
32864 subsequent query; @var{threadcount} (two hex digits) is the maximum
32865 number of threads the response packet can contain; and @var{nextthread}
32866 (eight hex digits), for subsequent queries (@var{startflag} is zero), is
32867 returned in the response as @var{argthread}.
32868
32869 Don't use this packet; use the @samp{qfThreadInfo} query instead (see above).
32870
32871 Reply:
32872 @table @samp
32873 @item qM @var{count} @var{done} @var{argthread} @var{thread}@dots{}
32874 Where: @var{count} (two hex digits) is the number of threads being
32875 returned; @var{done} (one hex digit) is zero to indicate more threads
32876 and one indicates no further threads; @var{argthreadid} (eight hex
32877 digits) is @var{nextthread} from the request packet; @var{thread}@dots{}
32878 is a sequence of thread IDs from the target. @var{threadid} (eight hex
32879 digits). See @code{remote.c:parse_threadlist_response()}.
32880 @end table
32881
32882 @item qOffsets
32883 @cindex section offsets, remote request
32884 @cindex @samp{qOffsets} packet
32885 Get section offsets that the target used when relocating the downloaded
32886 image.
32887
32888 Reply:
32889 @table @samp
32890 @item Text=@var{xxx};Data=@var{yyy}@r{[};Bss=@var{zzz}@r{]}
32891 Relocate the @code{Text} section by @var{xxx} from its original address.
32892 Relocate the @code{Data} section by @var{yyy} from its original address.
32893 If the object file format provides segment information (e.g.@: @sc{elf}
32894 @samp{PT_LOAD} program headers), @value{GDBN} will relocate entire
32895 segments by the supplied offsets.
32896
32897 @emph{Note: while a @code{Bss} offset may be included in the response,
32898 @value{GDBN} ignores this and instead applies the @code{Data} offset
32899 to the @code{Bss} section.}
32900
32901 @item TextSeg=@var{xxx}@r{[};DataSeg=@var{yyy}@r{]}
32902 Relocate the first segment of the object file, which conventionally
32903 contains program code, to a starting address of @var{xxx}. If
32904 @samp{DataSeg} is specified, relocate the second segment, which
32905 conventionally contains modifiable data, to a starting address of
32906 @var{yyy}. @value{GDBN} will report an error if the object file
32907 does not contain segment information, or does not contain at least
32908 as many segments as mentioned in the reply. Extra segments are
32909 kept at fixed offsets relative to the last relocated segment.
32910 @end table
32911
32912 @item qP @var{mode} @var{thread-id}
32913 @cindex thread information, remote request
32914 @cindex @samp{qP} packet
32915 Returns information on @var{thread-id}. Where: @var{mode} is a hex
32916 encoded 32 bit mode; @var{thread-id} is a thread ID
32917 (@pxref{thread-id syntax}).
32918
32919 Don't use this packet; use the @samp{qThreadExtraInfo} query instead
32920 (see below).
32921
32922 Reply: see @code{remote.c:remote_unpack_thread_info_response()}.
32923
32924 @item QNonStop:1
32925 @item QNonStop:0
32926 @cindex non-stop mode, remote request
32927 @cindex @samp{QNonStop} packet
32928 @anchor{QNonStop}
32929 Enter non-stop (@samp{QNonStop:1}) or all-stop (@samp{QNonStop:0}) mode.
32930 @xref{Remote Non-Stop}, for more information.
32931
32932 Reply:
32933 @table @samp
32934 @item OK
32935 The request succeeded.
32936
32937 @item E @var{nn}
32938 An error occurred. @var{nn} are hex digits.
32939
32940 @item
32941 An empty reply indicates that @samp{QNonStop} is not supported by
32942 the stub.
32943 @end table
32944
32945 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
32946 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
32947 Use of this packet is controlled by the @code{set non-stop} command;
32948 @pxref{Non-Stop Mode}.
32949
32950 @item QPassSignals: @var{signal} @r{[};@var{signal}@r{]}@dots{}
32951 @cindex pass signals to inferior, remote request
32952 @cindex @samp{QPassSignals} packet
32953 @anchor{QPassSignals}
32954 Each listed @var{signal} should be passed directly to the inferior process.
32955 Signals are numbered identically to continue packets and stop replies
32956 (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets}). Each @var{signal} list item should be
32957 strictly greater than the previous item. These signals do not need to stop
32958 the inferior, or be reported to @value{GDBN}. All other signals should be
32959 reported to @value{GDBN}. Multiple @samp{QPassSignals} packets do not
32960 combine; any earlier @samp{QPassSignals} list is completely replaced by the
32961 new list. This packet improves performance when using @samp{handle
32962 @var{signal} nostop noprint pass}.
32963
32964 Reply:
32965 @table @samp
32966 @item OK
32967 The request succeeded.
32968
32969 @item E @var{nn}
32970 An error occurred. @var{nn} are hex digits.
32971
32972 @item
32973 An empty reply indicates that @samp{QPassSignals} is not supported by
32974 the stub.
32975 @end table
32976
32977 Use of this packet is controlled by the @code{set remote pass-signals}
32978 command (@pxref{Remote Configuration, set remote pass-signals}).
32979 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
32980 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
32981
32982 @item qRcmd,@var{command}
32983 @cindex execute remote command, remote request
32984 @cindex @samp{qRcmd} packet
32985 @var{command} (hex encoded) is passed to the local interpreter for
32986 execution. Invalid commands should be reported using the output
32987 string. Before the final result packet, the target may also respond
32988 with a number of intermediate @samp{O@var{output}} console output
32989 packets. @emph{Implementors should note that providing access to a
32990 stubs's interpreter may have security implications}.
32991
32992 Reply:
32993 @table @samp
32994 @item OK
32995 A command response with no output.
32996 @item @var{OUTPUT}
32997 A command response with the hex encoded output string @var{OUTPUT}.
32998 @item E @var{NN}
32999 Indicate a badly formed request.
33000 @item
33001 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qRcmd} is not recognized.
33002 @end table
33003
33004 (Note that the @code{qRcmd} packet's name is separated from the
33005 command by a @samp{,}, not a @samp{:}, contrary to the naming
33006 conventions above. Please don't use this packet as a model for new
33007 packets.)
33008
33009 @item qSearch:memory:@var{address};@var{length};@var{search-pattern}
33010 @cindex searching memory, in remote debugging
33011 @cindex @samp{qSearch:memory} packet
33012 @anchor{qSearch memory}
33013 Search @var{length} bytes at @var{address} for @var{search-pattern}.
33014 @var{address} and @var{length} are encoded in hex.
33015 @var{search-pattern} is a sequence of bytes, hex encoded.
33016
33017 Reply:
33018 @table @samp
33019 @item 0
33020 The pattern was not found.
33021 @item 1,address
33022 The pattern was found at @var{address}.
33023 @item E @var{NN}
33024 A badly formed request or an error was encountered while searching memory.
33025 @item
33026 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qSearch:memory} is not recognized.
33027 @end table
33028
33029 @item QStartNoAckMode
33030 @cindex @samp{QStartNoAckMode} packet
33031 @anchor{QStartNoAckMode}
33032 Request that the remote stub disable the normal @samp{+}/@samp{-}
33033 protocol acknowledgments (@pxref{Packet Acknowledgment}).
33034
33035 Reply:
33036 @table @samp
33037 @item OK
33038 The stub has switched to no-acknowledgment mode.
33039 @value{GDBN} acknowledges this reponse,
33040 but neither the stub nor @value{GDBN} shall send or expect further
33041 @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgments in the current connection.
33042 @item
33043 An empty reply indicates that the stub does not support no-acknowledgment mode.
33044 @end table
33045
33046 @item qSupported @r{[}:@var{gdbfeature} @r{[};@var{gdbfeature}@r{]}@dots{} @r{]}
33047 @cindex supported packets, remote query
33048 @cindex features of the remote protocol
33049 @cindex @samp{qSupported} packet
33050 @anchor{qSupported}
33051 Tell the remote stub about features supported by @value{GDBN}, and
33052 query the stub for features it supports. This packet allows
33053 @value{GDBN} and the remote stub to take advantage of each others'
33054 features. @samp{qSupported} also consolidates multiple feature probes
33055 at startup, to improve @value{GDBN} performance---a single larger
33056 packet performs better than multiple smaller probe packets on
33057 high-latency links. Some features may enable behavior which must not
33058 be on by default, e.g.@: because it would confuse older clients or
33059 stubs. Other features may describe packets which could be
33060 automatically probed for, but are not. These features must be
33061 reported before @value{GDBN} will use them. This ``default
33062 unsupported'' behavior is not appropriate for all packets, but it
33063 helps to keep the initial connection time under control with new
33064 versions of @value{GDBN} which support increasing numbers of packets.
33065
33066 Reply:
33067 @table @samp
33068 @item @var{stubfeature} @r{[};@var{stubfeature}@r{]}@dots{}
33069 The stub supports or does not support each returned @var{stubfeature},
33070 depending on the form of each @var{stubfeature} (see below for the
33071 possible forms).
33072 @item
33073 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qSupported} is not recognized,
33074 or that no features needed to be reported to @value{GDBN}.
33075 @end table
33076
33077 The allowed forms for each feature (either a @var{gdbfeature} in the
33078 @samp{qSupported} packet, or a @var{stubfeature} in the response)
33079 are:
33080
33081 @table @samp
33082 @item @var{name}=@var{value}
33083 The remote protocol feature @var{name} is supported, and associated
33084 with the specified @var{value}. The format of @var{value} depends
33085 on the feature, but it must not include a semicolon.
33086 @item @var{name}+
33087 The remote protocol feature @var{name} is supported, and does not
33088 need an associated value.
33089 @item @var{name}-
33090 The remote protocol feature @var{name} is not supported.
33091 @item @var{name}?
33092 The remote protocol feature @var{name} may be supported, and
33093 @value{GDBN} should auto-detect support in some other way when it is
33094 needed. This form will not be used for @var{gdbfeature} notifications,
33095 but may be used for @var{stubfeature} responses.
33096 @end table
33097
33098 Whenever the stub receives a @samp{qSupported} request, the
33099 supplied set of @value{GDBN} features should override any previous
33100 request. This allows @value{GDBN} to put the stub in a known
33101 state, even if the stub had previously been communicating with
33102 a different version of @value{GDBN}.
33103
33104 The following values of @var{gdbfeature} (for the packet sent by @value{GDBN})
33105 are defined:
33106
33107 @table @samp
33108 @item multiprocess
33109 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports multiprocess
33110 extensions to the remote protocol. @value{GDBN} does not use such
33111 extensions unless the stub also reports that it supports them by
33112 including @samp{multiprocess+} in its @samp{qSupported} reply.
33113 @xref{multiprocess extensions}, for details.
33114
33115 @item xmlRegisters
33116 This feature indicates that @value{GDBN} supports the XML target
33117 description. If the stub sees @samp{xmlRegisters=} with target
33118 specific strings separated by a comma, it will report register
33119 description.
33120
33121 @item qRelocInsn
33122 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports the
33123 @samp{qRelocInsn} packet (@pxref{Tracepoint Packets,,Relocate
33124 instruction reply packet}).
33125 @end table
33126
33127 Stubs should ignore any unknown values for
33128 @var{gdbfeature}. Any @value{GDBN} which sends a @samp{qSupported}
33129 packet supports receiving packets of unlimited length (earlier
33130 versions of @value{GDBN} may reject overly long responses). Additional values
33131 for @var{gdbfeature} may be defined in the future to let the stub take
33132 advantage of new features in @value{GDBN}, e.g.@: incompatible
33133 improvements in the remote protocol---the @samp{multiprocess} feature is
33134 an example of such a feature. The stub's reply should be independent
33135 of the @var{gdbfeature} entries sent by @value{GDBN}; first @value{GDBN}
33136 describes all the features it supports, and then the stub replies with
33137 all the features it supports.
33138
33139 Similarly, @value{GDBN} will silently ignore unrecognized stub feature
33140 responses, as long as each response uses one of the standard forms.
33141
33142 Some features are flags. A stub which supports a flag feature
33143 should respond with a @samp{+} form response. Other features
33144 require values, and the stub should respond with an @samp{=}
33145 form response.
33146
33147 Each feature has a default value, which @value{GDBN} will use if
33148 @samp{qSupported} is not available or if the feature is not mentioned
33149 in the @samp{qSupported} response. The default values are fixed; a
33150 stub is free to omit any feature responses that match the defaults.
33151
33152 Not all features can be probed, but for those which can, the probing
33153 mechanism is useful: in some cases, a stub's internal
33154 architecture may not allow the protocol layer to know some information
33155 about the underlying target in advance. This is especially common in
33156 stubs which may be configured for multiple targets.
33157
33158 These are the currently defined stub features and their properties:
33159
33160 @multitable @columnfractions 0.35 0.2 0.12 0.2
33161 @c NOTE: The first row should be @headitem, but we do not yet require
33162 @c a new enough version of Texinfo (4.7) to use @headitem.
33163 @item Feature Name
33164 @tab Value Required
33165 @tab Default
33166 @tab Probe Allowed
33167
33168 @item @samp{PacketSize}
33169 @tab Yes
33170 @tab @samp{-}
33171 @tab No
33172
33173 @item @samp{qXfer:auxv:read}
33174 @tab No
33175 @tab @samp{-}
33176 @tab Yes
33177
33178 @item @samp{qXfer:features:read}
33179 @tab No
33180 @tab @samp{-}
33181 @tab Yes
33182
33183 @item @samp{qXfer:libraries:read}
33184 @tab No
33185 @tab @samp{-}
33186 @tab Yes
33187
33188 @item @samp{qXfer:memory-map:read}
33189 @tab No
33190 @tab @samp{-}
33191 @tab Yes
33192
33193 @item @samp{qXfer:sdata:read}
33194 @tab No
33195 @tab @samp{-}
33196 @tab Yes
33197
33198 @item @samp{qXfer:spu:read}
33199 @tab No
33200 @tab @samp{-}
33201 @tab Yes
33202
33203 @item @samp{qXfer:spu:write}
33204 @tab No
33205 @tab @samp{-}
33206 @tab Yes
33207
33208 @item @samp{qXfer:siginfo:read}
33209 @tab No
33210 @tab @samp{-}
33211 @tab Yes
33212
33213 @item @samp{qXfer:siginfo:write}
33214 @tab No
33215 @tab @samp{-}
33216 @tab Yes
33217
33218 @item @samp{qXfer:threads:read}
33219 @tab No
33220 @tab @samp{-}
33221 @tab Yes
33222
33223
33224 @item @samp{QNonStop}
33225 @tab No
33226 @tab @samp{-}
33227 @tab Yes
33228
33229 @item @samp{QPassSignals}
33230 @tab No
33231 @tab @samp{-}
33232 @tab Yes
33233
33234 @item @samp{QStartNoAckMode}
33235 @tab No
33236 @tab @samp{-}
33237 @tab Yes
33238
33239 @item @samp{multiprocess}
33240 @tab No
33241 @tab @samp{-}
33242 @tab No
33243
33244 @item @samp{ConditionalTracepoints}
33245 @tab No
33246 @tab @samp{-}
33247 @tab No
33248
33249 @item @samp{ReverseContinue}
33250 @tab No
33251 @tab @samp{-}
33252 @tab No
33253
33254 @item @samp{ReverseStep}
33255 @tab No
33256 @tab @samp{-}
33257 @tab No
33258
33259 @item @samp{TracepointSource}
33260 @tab No
33261 @tab @samp{-}
33262 @tab No
33263
33264 @item @samp{QAllow}
33265 @tab No
33266 @tab @samp{-}
33267 @tab No
33268
33269 @end multitable
33270
33271 These are the currently defined stub features, in more detail:
33272
33273 @table @samp
33274 @cindex packet size, remote protocol
33275 @item PacketSize=@var{bytes}
33276 The remote stub can accept packets up to at least @var{bytes} in
33277 length. @value{GDBN} will send packets up to this size for bulk
33278 transfers, and will never send larger packets. This is a limit on the
33279 data characters in the packet, including the frame and checksum.
33280 There is no trailing NUL byte in a remote protocol packet; if the stub
33281 stores packets in a NUL-terminated format, it should allow an extra
33282 byte in its buffer for the NUL. If this stub feature is not supported,
33283 @value{GDBN} guesses based on the size of the @samp{g} packet response.
33284
33285 @item qXfer:auxv:read
33286 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:auxv:read} packet
33287 (@pxref{qXfer auxiliary vector read}).
33288
33289 @item qXfer:features:read
33290 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:features:read} packet
33291 (@pxref{qXfer target description read}).
33292
33293 @item qXfer:libraries:read
33294 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:libraries:read} packet
33295 (@pxref{qXfer library list read}).
33296
33297 @item qXfer:memory-map:read
33298 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:memory-map:read} packet
33299 (@pxref{qXfer memory map read}).
33300
33301 @item qXfer:sdata:read
33302 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:sdata:read} packet
33303 (@pxref{qXfer sdata read}).
33304
33305 @item qXfer:spu:read
33306 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:spu:read} packet
33307 (@pxref{qXfer spu read}).
33308
33309 @item qXfer:spu:write
33310 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:spu:write} packet
33311 (@pxref{qXfer spu write}).
33312
33313 @item qXfer:siginfo:read
33314 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:siginfo:read} packet
33315 (@pxref{qXfer siginfo read}).
33316
33317 @item qXfer:siginfo:write
33318 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:siginfo:write} packet
33319 (@pxref{qXfer siginfo write}).
33320
33321 @item qXfer:threads:read
33322 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:threads:read} packet
33323 (@pxref{qXfer threads read}).
33324
33325 @item QNonStop
33326 The remote stub understands the @samp{QNonStop} packet
33327 (@pxref{QNonStop}).
33328
33329 @item QPassSignals
33330 The remote stub understands the @samp{QPassSignals} packet
33331 (@pxref{QPassSignals}).
33332
33333 @item QStartNoAckMode
33334 The remote stub understands the @samp{QStartNoAckMode} packet and
33335 prefers to operate in no-acknowledgment mode. @xref{Packet Acknowledgment}.
33336
33337 @item multiprocess
33338 @anchor{multiprocess extensions}
33339 @cindex multiprocess extensions, in remote protocol
33340 The remote stub understands the multiprocess extensions to the remote
33341 protocol syntax. The multiprocess extensions affect the syntax of
33342 thread IDs in both packets and replies (@pxref{thread-id syntax}), and
33343 add process IDs to the @samp{D} packet and @samp{W} and @samp{X}
33344 replies. Note that reporting this feature indicates support for the
33345 syntactic extensions only, not that the stub necessarily supports
33346 debugging of more than one process at a time. The stub must not use
33347 multiprocess extensions in packet replies unless @value{GDBN} has also
33348 indicated it supports them in its @samp{qSupported} request.
33349
33350 @item qXfer:osdata:read
33351 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:osdata:read} packet
33352 ((@pxref{qXfer osdata read}).
33353
33354 @item ConditionalTracepoints
33355 The remote stub accepts and implements conditional expressions defined
33356 for tracepoints (@pxref{Tracepoint Conditions}).
33357
33358 @item ReverseContinue
33359 The remote stub accepts and implements the reverse continue packet
33360 (@pxref{bc}).
33361
33362 @item ReverseStep
33363 The remote stub accepts and implements the reverse step packet
33364 (@pxref{bs}).
33365
33366 @item TracepointSource
33367 The remote stub understands the @samp{QTDPsrc} packet that supplies
33368 the source form of tracepoint definitions.
33369
33370 @item QAllow
33371 The remote stub understands the @samp{QAllow} packet.
33372
33373 @item StaticTracepoint
33374 @cindex static tracepoints, in remote protocol
33375 The remote stub supports static tracepoints.
33376
33377 @end table
33378
33379 @item qSymbol::
33380 @cindex symbol lookup, remote request
33381 @cindex @samp{qSymbol} packet
33382 Notify the target that @value{GDBN} is prepared to serve symbol lookup
33383 requests. Accept requests from the target for the values of symbols.
33384
33385 Reply:
33386 @table @samp
33387 @item OK
33388 The target does not need to look up any (more) symbols.
33389 @item qSymbol:@var{sym_name}
33390 The target requests the value of symbol @var{sym_name} (hex encoded).
33391 @value{GDBN} may provide the value by using the
33392 @samp{qSymbol:@var{sym_value}:@var{sym_name}} message, described
33393 below.
33394 @end table
33395
33396 @item qSymbol:@var{sym_value}:@var{sym_name}
33397 Set the value of @var{sym_name} to @var{sym_value}.
33398
33399 @var{sym_name} (hex encoded) is the name of a symbol whose value the
33400 target has previously requested.
33401
33402 @var{sym_value} (hex) is the value for symbol @var{sym_name}. If
33403 @value{GDBN} cannot supply a value for @var{sym_name}, then this field
33404 will be empty.
33405
33406 Reply:
33407 @table @samp
33408 @item OK
33409 The target does not need to look up any (more) symbols.
33410 @item qSymbol:@var{sym_name}
33411 The target requests the value of a new symbol @var{sym_name} (hex
33412 encoded). @value{GDBN} will continue to supply the values of symbols
33413 (if available), until the target ceases to request them.
33414 @end table
33415
33416 @item qTBuffer
33417 @item QTBuffer
33418 @item QTDisconnected
33419 @itemx QTDP
33420 @itemx QTDPsrc
33421 @itemx QTDV
33422 @itemx qTfP
33423 @itemx qTfV
33424 @itemx QTFrame
33425 @xref{Tracepoint Packets}.
33426
33427 @item qThreadExtraInfo,@var{thread-id}
33428 @cindex thread attributes info, remote request
33429 @cindex @samp{qThreadExtraInfo} packet
33430 Obtain a printable string description of a thread's attributes from
33431 the target OS. @var{thread-id} is a thread ID;
33432 see @ref{thread-id syntax}. This
33433 string may contain anything that the target OS thinks is interesting
33434 for @value{GDBN} to tell the user about the thread. The string is
33435 displayed in @value{GDBN}'s @code{info threads} display. Some
33436 examples of possible thread extra info strings are @samp{Runnable}, or
33437 @samp{Blocked on Mutex}.
33438
33439 Reply:
33440 @table @samp
33441 @item @var{XX}@dots{}
33442 Where @samp{@var{XX}@dots{}} is a hex encoding of @sc{ascii} data,
33443 comprising the printable string containing the extra information about
33444 the thread's attributes.
33445 @end table
33446
33447 (Note that the @code{qThreadExtraInfo} packet's name is separated from
33448 the command by a @samp{,}, not a @samp{:}, contrary to the naming
33449 conventions above. Please don't use this packet as a model for new
33450 packets.)
33451
33452 @item QTSave
33453 @item qTsP
33454 @item qTsV
33455 @itemx QTStart
33456 @itemx QTStop
33457 @itemx QTinit
33458 @itemx QTro
33459 @itemx qTStatus
33460 @itemx qTV
33461 @itemx qTfSTM
33462 @itemx qTsSTM
33463 @itemx qTSTMat
33464 @xref{Tracepoint Packets}.
33465
33466 @item qXfer:@var{object}:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
33467 @cindex read special object, remote request
33468 @cindex @samp{qXfer} packet
33469 @anchor{qXfer read}
33470 Read uninterpreted bytes from the target's special data area
33471 identified by the keyword @var{object}. Request @var{length} bytes
33472 starting at @var{offset} bytes into the data. The content and
33473 encoding of @var{annex} is specific to @var{object}; it can supply
33474 additional details about what data to access.
33475
33476 Here are the specific requests of this form defined so far. All
33477 @samp{qXfer:@var{object}:read:@dots{}} requests use the same reply
33478 formats, listed below.
33479
33480 @table @samp
33481 @item qXfer:auxv:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
33482 @anchor{qXfer auxiliary vector read}
33483 Access the target's @dfn{auxiliary vector}. @xref{OS Information,
33484 auxiliary vector}. Note @var{annex} must be empty.
33485
33486 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
33487 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
33488
33489 @item qXfer:features:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
33490 @anchor{qXfer target description read}
33491 Access the @dfn{target description}. @xref{Target Descriptions}. The
33492 annex specifies which XML document to access. The main description is
33493 always loaded from the @samp{target.xml} annex.
33494
33495 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
33496 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
33497
33498 @item qXfer:libraries:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
33499 @anchor{qXfer library list read}
33500 Access the target's list of loaded libraries. @xref{Library List Format}.
33501 The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty
33502 (@pxref{qXfer read}).
33503
33504 Targets which maintain a list of libraries in the program's memory do
33505 not need to implement this packet; it is designed for platforms where
33506 the operating system manages the list of loaded libraries.
33507
33508 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
33509 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
33510
33511 @item qXfer:memory-map:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
33512 @anchor{qXfer memory map read}
33513 Access the target's @dfn{memory-map}. @xref{Memory Map Format}. The
33514 annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty
33515 (@pxref{qXfer read}).
33516
33517 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
33518 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
33519
33520 @item qXfer:sdata:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
33521 @anchor{qXfer sdata read}
33522
33523 Read contents of the extra collected static tracepoint marker
33524 information. The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must
33525 be empty (@pxref{qXfer read}). @xref{Tracepoint Actions,,Tracepoint
33526 Action Lists}.
33527
33528 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
33529 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
33530 (@pxref{qSupported}).
33531
33532 @item qXfer:siginfo:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
33533 @anchor{qXfer siginfo read}
33534 Read contents of the extra signal information on the target
33535 system. The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be
33536 empty (@pxref{qXfer read}).
33537
33538 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
33539 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
33540 (@pxref{qSupported}).
33541
33542 @item qXfer:spu:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
33543 @anchor{qXfer spu read}
33544 Read contents of an @code{spufs} file on the target system. The
33545 annex specifies which file to read; it must be of the form
33546 @file{@var{id}/@var{name}}, where @var{id} specifies an SPU context ID
33547 in the target process, and @var{name} identifes the @code{spufs} file
33548 in that context to be accessed.
33549
33550 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
33551 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
33552 (@pxref{qSupported}).
33553
33554 @item qXfer:threads:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
33555 @anchor{qXfer threads read}
33556 Access the list of threads on target. @xref{Thread List Format}. The
33557 annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty
33558 (@pxref{qXfer read}).
33559
33560 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
33561 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
33562
33563 @item qXfer:osdata:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
33564 @anchor{qXfer osdata read}
33565 Access the target's @dfn{operating system information}.
33566 @xref{Operating System Information}.
33567
33568 @end table
33569
33570 Reply:
33571 @table @samp
33572 @item m @var{data}
33573 Data @var{data} (@pxref{Binary Data}) has been read from the
33574 target. There may be more data at a higher address (although
33575 it is permitted to return @samp{m} even for the last valid
33576 block of data, as long as at least one byte of data was read).
33577 @var{data} may have fewer bytes than the @var{length} in the
33578 request.
33579
33580 @item l @var{data}
33581 Data @var{data} (@pxref{Binary Data}) has been read from the target.
33582 There is no more data to be read. @var{data} may have fewer bytes
33583 than the @var{length} in the request.
33584
33585 @item l
33586 The @var{offset} in the request is at the end of the data.
33587 There is no more data to be read.
33588
33589 @item E00
33590 The request was malformed, or @var{annex} was invalid.
33591
33592 @item E @var{nn}
33593 The offset was invalid, or there was an error encountered reading the data.
33594 @var{nn} is a hex-encoded @code{errno} value.
33595
33596 @item
33597 An empty reply indicates the @var{object} string was not recognized by
33598 the stub, or that the object does not support reading.
33599 @end table
33600
33601 @item qXfer:@var{object}:write:@var{annex}:@var{offset}:@var{data}@dots{}
33602 @cindex write data into object, remote request
33603 @anchor{qXfer write}
33604 Write uninterpreted bytes into the target's special data area
33605 identified by the keyword @var{object}, starting at @var{offset} bytes
33606 into the data. @var{data}@dots{} is the binary-encoded data
33607 (@pxref{Binary Data}) to be written. The content and encoding of @var{annex}
33608 is specific to @var{object}; it can supply additional details about what data
33609 to access.
33610
33611 Here are the specific requests of this form defined so far. All
33612 @samp{qXfer:@var{object}:write:@dots{}} requests use the same reply
33613 formats, listed below.
33614
33615 @table @samp
33616 @item qXfer:siginfo:write::@var{offset}:@var{data}@dots{}
33617 @anchor{qXfer siginfo write}
33618 Write @var{data} to the extra signal information on the target system.
33619 The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be
33620 empty (@pxref{qXfer write}).
33621
33622 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
33623 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
33624 (@pxref{qSupported}).
33625
33626 @item qXfer:spu:write:@var{annex}:@var{offset}:@var{data}@dots{}
33627 @anchor{qXfer spu write}
33628 Write @var{data} to an @code{spufs} file on the target system. The
33629 annex specifies which file to write; it must be of the form
33630 @file{@var{id}/@var{name}}, where @var{id} specifies an SPU context ID
33631 in the target process, and @var{name} identifes the @code{spufs} file
33632 in that context to be accessed.
33633
33634 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
33635 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
33636 @end table
33637
33638 Reply:
33639 @table @samp
33640 @item @var{nn}
33641 @var{nn} (hex encoded) is the number of bytes written.
33642 This may be fewer bytes than supplied in the request.
33643
33644 @item E00
33645 The request was malformed, or @var{annex} was invalid.
33646
33647 @item E @var{nn}
33648 The offset was invalid, or there was an error encountered writing the data.
33649 @var{nn} is a hex-encoded @code{errno} value.
33650
33651 @item
33652 An empty reply indicates the @var{object} string was not
33653 recognized by the stub, or that the object does not support writing.
33654 @end table
33655
33656 @item qXfer:@var{object}:@var{operation}:@dots{}
33657 Requests of this form may be added in the future. When a stub does
33658 not recognize the @var{object} keyword, or its support for
33659 @var{object} does not recognize the @var{operation} keyword, the stub
33660 must respond with an empty packet.
33661
33662 @item qAttached:@var{pid}
33663 @cindex query attached, remote request
33664 @cindex @samp{qAttached} packet
33665 Return an indication of whether the remote server attached to an
33666 existing process or created a new process. When the multiprocess
33667 protocol extensions are supported (@pxref{multiprocess extensions}),
33668 @var{pid} is an integer in hexadecimal format identifying the target
33669 process. Otherwise, @value{GDBN} will omit the @var{pid} field and
33670 the query packet will be simplified as @samp{qAttached}.
33671
33672 This query is used, for example, to know whether the remote process
33673 should be detached or killed when a @value{GDBN} session is ended with
33674 the @code{quit} command.
33675
33676 Reply:
33677 @table @samp
33678 @item 1
33679 The remote server attached to an existing process.
33680 @item 0
33681 The remote server created a new process.
33682 @item E @var{NN}
33683 A badly formed request or an error was encountered.
33684 @end table
33685
33686 @end table
33687
33688 @node Architecture-Specific Protocol Details
33689 @section Architecture-Specific Protocol Details
33690
33691 This section describes how the remote protocol is applied to specific
33692 target architectures. Also see @ref{Standard Target Features}, for
33693 details of XML target descriptions for each architecture.
33694
33695 @subsection ARM
33696
33697 @subsubsection Breakpoint Kinds
33698
33699 These breakpoint kinds are defined for the @samp{Z0} and @samp{Z1} packets.
33700
33701 @table @r
33702
33703 @item 2
33704 16-bit Thumb mode breakpoint.
33705
33706 @item 3
33707 32-bit Thumb mode (Thumb-2) breakpoint.
33708
33709 @item 4
33710 32-bit ARM mode breakpoint.
33711
33712 @end table
33713
33714 @subsection MIPS
33715
33716 @subsubsection Register Packet Format
33717
33718 The following @code{g}/@code{G} packets have previously been defined.
33719 In the below, some thirty-two bit registers are transferred as
33720 sixty-four bits. Those registers should be zero/sign extended (which?)
33721 to fill the space allocated. Register bytes are transferred in target
33722 byte order. The two nibbles within a register byte are transferred
33723 most-significant - least-significant.
33724
33725 @table @r
33726
33727 @item MIPS32
33728
33729 All registers are transferred as thirty-two bit quantities in the order:
33730 32 general-purpose; sr; lo; hi; bad; cause; pc; 32 floating-point
33731 registers; fsr; fir; fp.
33732
33733 @item MIPS64
33734
33735 All registers are transferred as sixty-four bit quantities (including
33736 thirty-two bit registers such as @code{sr}). The ordering is the same
33737 as @code{MIPS32}.
33738
33739 @end table
33740
33741 @node Tracepoint Packets
33742 @section Tracepoint Packets
33743 @cindex tracepoint packets
33744 @cindex packets, tracepoint
33745
33746 Here we describe the packets @value{GDBN} uses to implement
33747 tracepoints (@pxref{Tracepoints}).
33748
33749 @table @samp
33750
33751 @item QTDP:@var{n}:@var{addr}:@var{ena}:@var{step}:@var{pass}[:F@var{flen}][:X@var{len},@var{bytes}]@r{[}-@r{]}
33752 Create a new tracepoint, number @var{n}, at @var{addr}. If @var{ena}
33753 is @samp{E}, then the tracepoint is enabled; if it is @samp{D}, then
33754 the tracepoint is disabled. @var{step} is the tracepoint's step
33755 count, and @var{pass} is its pass count. If an @samp{F} is present,
33756 then the tracepoint is to be a fast tracepoint, and the @var{flen} is
33757 the number of bytes that the target should copy elsewhere to make room
33758 for the tracepoint. If an @samp{X} is present, it introduces a
33759 tracepoint condition, which consists of a hexadecimal length, followed
33760 by a comma and hex-encoded bytes, in a manner similar to action
33761 encodings as described below. If the trailing @samp{-} is present,
33762 further @samp{QTDP} packets will follow to specify this tracepoint's
33763 actions.
33764
33765 Replies:
33766 @table @samp
33767 @item OK
33768 The packet was understood and carried out.
33769 @item qRelocInsn
33770 @xref{Tracepoint Packets,,Relocate instruction reply packet}.
33771 @item
33772 The packet was not recognized.
33773 @end table
33774
33775 @item QTDP:-@var{n}:@var{addr}:@r{[}S@r{]}@var{action}@dots{}@r{[}-@r{]}
33776 Define actions to be taken when a tracepoint is hit. @var{n} and
33777 @var{addr} must be the same as in the initial @samp{QTDP} packet for
33778 this tracepoint. This packet may only be sent immediately after
33779 another @samp{QTDP} packet that ended with a @samp{-}. If the
33780 trailing @samp{-} is present, further @samp{QTDP} packets will follow,
33781 specifying more actions for this tracepoint.
33782
33783 In the series of action packets for a given tracepoint, at most one
33784 can have an @samp{S} before its first @var{action}. If such a packet
33785 is sent, it and the following packets define ``while-stepping''
33786 actions. Any prior packets define ordinary actions --- that is, those
33787 taken when the tracepoint is first hit. If no action packet has an
33788 @samp{S}, then all the packets in the series specify ordinary
33789 tracepoint actions.
33790
33791 The @samp{@var{action}@dots{}} portion of the packet is a series of
33792 actions, concatenated without separators. Each action has one of the
33793 following forms:
33794
33795 @table @samp
33796
33797 @item R @var{mask}
33798 Collect the registers whose bits are set in @var{mask}. @var{mask} is
33799 a hexadecimal number whose @var{i}'th bit is set if register number
33800 @var{i} should be collected. (The least significant bit is numbered
33801 zero.) Note that @var{mask} may be any number of digits long; it may
33802 not fit in a 32-bit word.
33803
33804 @item M @var{basereg},@var{offset},@var{len}
33805 Collect @var{len} bytes of memory starting at the address in register
33806 number @var{basereg}, plus @var{offset}. If @var{basereg} is
33807 @samp{-1}, then the range has a fixed address: @var{offset} is the
33808 address of the lowest byte to collect. The @var{basereg},
33809 @var{offset}, and @var{len} parameters are all unsigned hexadecimal
33810 values (the @samp{-1} value for @var{basereg} is a special case).
33811
33812 @item X @var{len},@var{expr}
33813 Evaluate @var{expr}, whose length is @var{len}, and collect memory as
33814 it directs. @var{expr} is an agent expression, as described in
33815 @ref{Agent Expressions}. Each byte of the expression is encoded as a
33816 two-digit hex number in the packet; @var{len} is the number of bytes
33817 in the expression (and thus one-half the number of hex digits in the
33818 packet).
33819
33820 @end table
33821
33822 Any number of actions may be packed together in a single @samp{QTDP}
33823 packet, as long as the packet does not exceed the maximum packet
33824 length (400 bytes, for many stubs). There may be only one @samp{R}
33825 action per tracepoint, and it must precede any @samp{M} or @samp{X}
33826 actions. Any registers referred to by @samp{M} and @samp{X} actions
33827 must be collected by a preceding @samp{R} action. (The
33828 ``while-stepping'' actions are treated as if they were attached to a
33829 separate tracepoint, as far as these restrictions are concerned.)
33830
33831 Replies:
33832 @table @samp
33833 @item OK
33834 The packet was understood and carried out.
33835 @item qRelocInsn
33836 @xref{Tracepoint Packets,,Relocate instruction reply packet}.
33837 @item
33838 The packet was not recognized.
33839 @end table
33840
33841 @item QTDPsrc:@var{n}:@var{addr}:@var{type}:@var{start}:@var{slen}:@var{bytes}
33842 @cindex @samp{QTDPsrc} packet
33843 Specify a source string of tracepoint @var{n} at address @var{addr}.
33844 This is useful to get accurate reproduction of the tracepoints
33845 originally downloaded at the beginning of the trace run. @var{type}
33846 is the name of the tracepoint part, such as @samp{cond} for the
33847 tracepoint's conditional expression (see below for a list of types), while
33848 @var{bytes} is the string, encoded in hexadecimal.
33849
33850 @var{start} is the offset of the @var{bytes} within the overall source
33851 string, while @var{slen} is the total length of the source string.
33852 This is intended for handling source strings that are longer than will
33853 fit in a single packet.
33854 @c Add detailed example when this info is moved into a dedicated
33855 @c tracepoint descriptions section.
33856
33857 The available string types are @samp{at} for the location,
33858 @samp{cond} for the conditional, and @samp{cmd} for an action command.
33859 @value{GDBN} sends a separate packet for each command in the action
33860 list, in the same order in which the commands are stored in the list.
33861
33862 The target does not need to do anything with source strings except
33863 report them back as part of the replies to the @samp{qTfP}/@samp{qTsP}
33864 query packets.
33865
33866 Although this packet is optional, and @value{GDBN} will only send it
33867 if the target replies with @samp{TracepointSource} @xref{General
33868 Query Packets}, it makes both disconnected tracing and trace files
33869 much easier to use. Otherwise the user must be careful that the
33870 tracepoints in effect while looking at trace frames are identical to
33871 the ones in effect during the trace run; even a small discrepancy
33872 could cause @samp{tdump} not to work, or a particular trace frame not
33873 be found.
33874
33875 @item QTDV:@var{n}:@var{value}
33876 @cindex define trace state variable, remote request
33877 @cindex @samp{QTDV} packet
33878 Create a new trace state variable, number @var{n}, with an initial
33879 value of @var{value}, which is a 64-bit signed integer. Both @var{n}
33880 and @var{value} are encoded as hexadecimal values. @value{GDBN} has
33881 the option of not using this packet for initial values of zero; the
33882 target should simply create the trace state variables as they are
33883 mentioned in expressions.
33884
33885 @item QTFrame:@var{n}
33886 Select the @var{n}'th tracepoint frame from the buffer, and use the
33887 register and memory contents recorded there to answer subsequent
33888 request packets from @value{GDBN}.
33889
33890 A successful reply from the stub indicates that the stub has found the
33891 requested frame. The response is a series of parts, concatenated
33892 without separators, describing the frame we selected. Each part has
33893 one of the following forms:
33894
33895 @table @samp
33896 @item F @var{f}
33897 The selected frame is number @var{n} in the trace frame buffer;
33898 @var{f} is a hexadecimal number. If @var{f} is @samp{-1}, then there
33899 was no frame matching the criteria in the request packet.
33900
33901 @item T @var{t}
33902 The selected trace frame records a hit of tracepoint number @var{t};
33903 @var{t} is a hexadecimal number.
33904
33905 @end table
33906
33907 @item QTFrame:pc:@var{addr}
33908 Like @samp{QTFrame:@var{n}}, but select the first tracepoint frame after the
33909 currently selected frame whose PC is @var{addr};
33910 @var{addr} is a hexadecimal number.
33911
33912 @item QTFrame:tdp:@var{t}
33913 Like @samp{QTFrame:@var{n}}, but select the first tracepoint frame after the
33914 currently selected frame that is a hit of tracepoint @var{t}; @var{t}
33915 is a hexadecimal number.
33916
33917 @item QTFrame:range:@var{start}:@var{end}
33918 Like @samp{QTFrame:@var{n}}, but select the first tracepoint frame after the
33919 currently selected frame whose PC is between @var{start} (inclusive)
33920 and @var{end} (inclusive); @var{start} and @var{end} are hexadecimal
33921 numbers.
33922
33923 @item QTFrame:outside:@var{start}:@var{end}
33924 Like @samp{QTFrame:range:@var{start}:@var{end}}, but select the first
33925 frame @emph{outside} the given range of addresses (exclusive).
33926
33927 @item QTStart
33928 Begin the tracepoint experiment. Begin collecting data from
33929 tracepoint hits in the trace frame buffer. This packet supports the
33930 @samp{qRelocInsn} reply (@pxref{Tracepoint Packets,,Relocate
33931 instruction reply packet}).
33932
33933 @item QTStop
33934 End the tracepoint experiment. Stop collecting trace frames.
33935
33936 @item QTinit
33937 Clear the table of tracepoints, and empty the trace frame buffer.
33938
33939 @item QTro:@var{start1},@var{end1}:@var{start2},@var{end2}:@dots{}
33940 Establish the given ranges of memory as ``transparent''. The stub
33941 will answer requests for these ranges from memory's current contents,
33942 if they were not collected as part of the tracepoint hit.
33943
33944 @value{GDBN} uses this to mark read-only regions of memory, like those
33945 containing program code. Since these areas never change, they should
33946 still have the same contents they did when the tracepoint was hit, so
33947 there's no reason for the stub to refuse to provide their contents.
33948
33949 @item QTDisconnected:@var{value}
33950 Set the choice to what to do with the tracing run when @value{GDBN}
33951 disconnects from the target. A @var{value} of 1 directs the target to
33952 continue the tracing run, while 0 tells the target to stop tracing if
33953 @value{GDBN} is no longer in the picture.
33954
33955 @item qTStatus
33956 Ask the stub if there is a trace experiment running right now.
33957
33958 The reply has the form:
33959
33960 @table @samp
33961
33962 @item T@var{running}@r{[};@var{field}@r{]}@dots{}
33963 @var{running} is a single digit @code{1} if the trace is presently
33964 running, or @code{0} if not. It is followed by semicolon-separated
33965 optional fields that an agent may use to report additional status.
33966
33967 @end table
33968
33969 If the trace is not running, the agent may report any of several
33970 explanations as one of the optional fields:
33971
33972 @table @samp
33973
33974 @item tnotrun:0
33975 No trace has been run yet.
33976
33977 @item tstop:0
33978 The trace was stopped by a user-originated stop command.
33979
33980 @item tfull:0
33981 The trace stopped because the trace buffer filled up.
33982
33983 @item tdisconnected:0
33984 The trace stopped because @value{GDBN} disconnected from the target.
33985
33986 @item tpasscount:@var{tpnum}
33987 The trace stopped because tracepoint @var{tpnum} exceeded its pass count.
33988
33989 @item terror:@var{text}:@var{tpnum}
33990 The trace stopped because tracepoint @var{tpnum} had an error. The
33991 string @var{text} is available to describe the nature of the error
33992 (for instance, a divide by zero in the condition expression).
33993 @var{text} is hex encoded.
33994
33995 @item tunknown:0
33996 The trace stopped for some other reason.
33997
33998 @end table
33999
34000 Additional optional fields supply statistical and other information.
34001 Although not required, they are extremely useful for users monitoring
34002 the progress of a trace run. If a trace has stopped, and these
34003 numbers are reported, they must reflect the state of the just-stopped
34004 trace.
34005
34006 @table @samp
34007
34008 @item tframes:@var{n}
34009 The number of trace frames in the buffer.
34010
34011 @item tcreated:@var{n}
34012 The total number of trace frames created during the run. This may
34013 be larger than the trace frame count, if the buffer is circular.
34014
34015 @item tsize:@var{n}
34016 The total size of the trace buffer, in bytes.
34017
34018 @item tfree:@var{n}
34019 The number of bytes still unused in the buffer.
34020
34021 @item circular:@var{n}
34022 The value of the circular trace buffer flag. @code{1} means that the
34023 trace buffer is circular and old trace frames will be discarded if
34024 necessary to make room, @code{0} means that the trace buffer is linear
34025 and may fill up.
34026
34027 @item disconn:@var{n}
34028 The value of the disconnected tracing flag. @code{1} means that
34029 tracing will continue after @value{GDBN} disconnects, @code{0} means
34030 that the trace run will stop.
34031
34032 @end table
34033
34034 @item qTV:@var{var}
34035 @cindex trace state variable value, remote request
34036 @cindex @samp{qTV} packet
34037 Ask the stub for the value of the trace state variable number @var{var}.
34038
34039 Replies:
34040 @table @samp
34041 @item V@var{value}
34042 The value of the variable is @var{value}. This will be the current
34043 value of the variable if the user is examining a running target, or a
34044 saved value if the variable was collected in the trace frame that the
34045 user is looking at. Note that multiple requests may result in
34046 different reply values, such as when requesting values while the
34047 program is running.
34048
34049 @item U
34050 The value of the variable is unknown. This would occur, for example,
34051 if the user is examining a trace frame in which the requested variable
34052 was not collected.
34053 @end table
34054
34055 @item qTfP
34056 @itemx qTsP
34057 These packets request data about tracepoints that are being used by
34058 the target. @value{GDBN} sends @code{qTfP} to get the first piece
34059 of data, and multiple @code{qTsP} to get additional pieces. Replies
34060 to these packets generally take the form of the @code{QTDP} packets
34061 that define tracepoints. (FIXME add detailed syntax)
34062
34063 @item qTfV
34064 @itemx qTsV
34065 These packets request data about trace state variables that are on the
34066 target. @value{GDBN} sends @code{qTfV} to get the first vari of data,
34067 and multiple @code{qTsV} to get additional variables. Replies to
34068 these packets follow the syntax of the @code{QTDV} packets that define
34069 trace state variables.
34070
34071 @item qTfSTM
34072 @itemx qTsSTM
34073 These packets request data about static tracepoint markers that exist
34074 in the target program. @value{GDBN} sends @code{qTfSTM} to get the
34075 first piece of data, and multiple @code{qTsSTM} to get additional
34076 pieces. Replies to these packets take the following form:
34077
34078 Reply:
34079 @table @samp
34080 @item m @var{address}:@var{id}:@var{extra}
34081 A single marker
34082 @item m @var{address}:@var{id}:@var{extra},@var{address}:@var{id}:@var{extra}@dots{}
34083 a comma-separated list of markers
34084 @item l
34085 (lower case letter @samp{L}) denotes end of list.
34086 @item E @var{nn}
34087 An error occurred. @var{nn} are hex digits.
34088 @item
34089 An empty reply indicates that the request is not supported by the
34090 stub.
34091 @end table
34092
34093 @var{address} is encoded in hex.
34094 @var{id} and @var{extra} are strings encoded in hex.
34095
34096 In response to each query, the target will reply with a list of one or
34097 more markers, separated by commas. @value{GDBN} will respond to each
34098 reply with a request for more markers (using the @samp{qs} form of the
34099 query), until the target responds with @samp{l} (lower-case ell, for
34100 @dfn{last}).
34101
34102 @item qTSTMat:@var{address}
34103 This packets requests data about static tracepoint markers in the
34104 target program at @var{address}. Replies to this packet follow the
34105 syntax of the @samp{qTfSTM} and @code{qTsSTM} packets that list static
34106 tracepoint markers.
34107
34108 @item QTSave:@var{filename}
34109 This packet directs the target to save trace data to the file name
34110 @var{filename} in the target's filesystem. @var{filename} is encoded
34111 as a hex string; the interpretation of the file name (relative vs
34112 absolute, wild cards, etc) is up to the target.
34113
34114 @item qTBuffer:@var{offset},@var{len}
34115 Return up to @var{len} bytes of the current contents of trace buffer,
34116 starting at @var{offset}. The trace buffer is treated as if it were
34117 a contiguous collection of traceframes, as per the trace file format.
34118 The reply consists as many hex-encoded bytes as the target can deliver
34119 in a packet; it is not an error to return fewer than were asked for.
34120 A reply consisting of just @code{l} indicates that no bytes are
34121 available.
34122
34123 @item QTBuffer:circular:@var{value}
34124 This packet directs the target to use a circular trace buffer if
34125 @var{value} is 1, or a linear buffer if the value is 0.
34126
34127 @end table
34128
34129 @subsection Relocate instruction reply packet
34130 When installing fast tracepoints in memory, the target may need to
34131 relocate the instruction currently at the tracepoint address to a
34132 different address in memory. For most instructions, a simple copy is
34133 enough, but, for example, call instructions that implicitly push the
34134 return address on the stack, and relative branches or other
34135 PC-relative instructions require offset adjustment, so that the effect
34136 of executing the instruction at a different address is the same as if
34137 it had executed in the original location.
34138
34139 In response to several of the tracepoint packets, the target may also
34140 respond with a number of intermediate @samp{qRelocInsn} request
34141 packets before the final result packet, to have @value{GDBN} handle
34142 this relocation operation. If a packet supports this mechanism, its
34143 documentation will explicitly say so. See for example the above
34144 descriptions for the @samp{QTStart} and @samp{QTDP} packets. The
34145 format of the request is:
34146
34147 @table @samp
34148 @item qRelocInsn:@var{from};@var{to}
34149
34150 This requests @value{GDBN} to copy instruction at address @var{from}
34151 to address @var{to}, possibly adjusted so that executing the
34152 instruction at @var{to} has the same effect as executing it at
34153 @var{from}. @value{GDBN} writes the adjusted instruction to target
34154 memory starting at @var{to}.
34155 @end table
34156
34157 Replies:
34158 @table @samp
34159 @item qRelocInsn:@var{adjusted_size}
34160 Informs the stub the relocation is complete. @var{adjusted_size} is
34161 the length in bytes of resulting relocated instruction sequence.
34162 @item E @var{NN}
34163 A badly formed request was detected, or an error was encountered while
34164 relocating the instruction.
34165 @end table
34166
34167 @node Host I/O Packets
34168 @section Host I/O Packets
34169 @cindex Host I/O, remote protocol
34170 @cindex file transfer, remote protocol
34171
34172 The @dfn{Host I/O} packets allow @value{GDBN} to perform I/O
34173 operations on the far side of a remote link. For example, Host I/O is
34174 used to upload and download files to a remote target with its own
34175 filesystem. Host I/O uses the same constant values and data structure
34176 layout as the target-initiated File-I/O protocol. However, the
34177 Host I/O packets are structured differently. The target-initiated
34178 protocol relies on target memory to store parameters and buffers.
34179 Host I/O requests are initiated by @value{GDBN}, and the
34180 target's memory is not involved. @xref{File-I/O Remote Protocol
34181 Extension}, for more details on the target-initiated protocol.
34182
34183 The Host I/O request packets all encode a single operation along with
34184 its arguments. They have this format:
34185
34186 @table @samp
34187
34188 @item vFile:@var{operation}: @var{parameter}@dots{}
34189 @var{operation} is the name of the particular request; the target
34190 should compare the entire packet name up to the second colon when checking
34191 for a supported operation. The format of @var{parameter} depends on
34192 the operation. Numbers are always passed in hexadecimal. Negative
34193 numbers have an explicit minus sign (i.e.@: two's complement is not
34194 used). Strings (e.g.@: filenames) are encoded as a series of
34195 hexadecimal bytes. The last argument to a system call may be a
34196 buffer of escaped binary data (@pxref{Binary Data}).
34197
34198 @end table
34199
34200 The valid responses to Host I/O packets are:
34201
34202 @table @samp
34203
34204 @item F @var{result} [, @var{errno}] [; @var{attachment}]
34205 @var{result} is the integer value returned by this operation, usually
34206 non-negative for success and -1 for errors. If an error has occured,
34207 @var{errno} will be included in the result. @var{errno} will have a
34208 value defined by the File-I/O protocol (@pxref{Errno Values}). For
34209 operations which return data, @var{attachment} supplies the data as a
34210 binary buffer. Binary buffers in response packets are escaped in the
34211 normal way (@pxref{Binary Data}). See the individual packet
34212 documentation for the interpretation of @var{result} and
34213 @var{attachment}.
34214
34215 @item
34216 An empty response indicates that this operation is not recognized.
34217
34218 @end table
34219
34220 These are the supported Host I/O operations:
34221
34222 @table @samp
34223 @item vFile:open: @var{pathname}, @var{flags}, @var{mode}
34224 Open a file at @var{pathname} and return a file descriptor for it, or
34225 return -1 if an error occurs. @var{pathname} is a string,
34226 @var{flags} is an integer indicating a mask of open flags
34227 (@pxref{Open Flags}), and @var{mode} is an integer indicating a mask
34228 of mode bits to use if the file is created (@pxref{mode_t Values}).
34229 @xref{open}, for details of the open flags and mode values.
34230
34231 @item vFile:close: @var{fd}
34232 Close the open file corresponding to @var{fd} and return 0, or
34233 -1 if an error occurs.
34234
34235 @item vFile:pread: @var{fd}, @var{count}, @var{offset}
34236 Read data from the open file corresponding to @var{fd}. Up to
34237 @var{count} bytes will be read from the file, starting at @var{offset}
34238 relative to the start of the file. The target may read fewer bytes;
34239 common reasons include packet size limits and an end-of-file
34240 condition. The number of bytes read is returned. Zero should only be
34241 returned for a successful read at the end of the file, or if
34242 @var{count} was zero.
34243
34244 The data read should be returned as a binary attachment on success.
34245 If zero bytes were read, the response should include an empty binary
34246 attachment (i.e.@: a trailing semicolon). The return value is the
34247 number of target bytes read; the binary attachment may be longer if
34248 some characters were escaped.
34249
34250 @item vFile:pwrite: @var{fd}, @var{offset}, @var{data}
34251 Write @var{data} (a binary buffer) to the open file corresponding
34252 to @var{fd}. Start the write at @var{offset} from the start of the
34253 file. Unlike many @code{write} system calls, there is no
34254 separate @var{count} argument; the length of @var{data} in the
34255 packet is used. @samp{vFile:write} returns the number of bytes written,
34256 which may be shorter than the length of @var{data}, or -1 if an
34257 error occurred.
34258
34259 @item vFile:unlink: @var{pathname}
34260 Delete the file at @var{pathname} on the target. Return 0,
34261 or -1 if an error occurs. @var{pathname} is a string.
34262
34263 @end table
34264
34265 @node Interrupts
34266 @section Interrupts
34267 @cindex interrupts (remote protocol)
34268
34269 When a program on the remote target is running, @value{GDBN} may
34270 attempt to interrupt it by sending a @samp{Ctrl-C}, @code{BREAK} or
34271 a @code{BREAK} followed by @code{g},
34272 control of which is specified via @value{GDBN}'s @samp{interrupt-sequence}.
34273
34274 The precise meaning of @code{BREAK} is defined by the transport
34275 mechanism and may, in fact, be undefined. @value{GDBN} does not
34276 currently define a @code{BREAK} mechanism for any of the network
34277 interfaces except for TCP, in which case @value{GDBN} sends the
34278 @code{telnet} BREAK sequence.
34279
34280 @samp{Ctrl-C}, on the other hand, is defined and implemented for all
34281 transport mechanisms. It is represented by sending the single byte
34282 @code{0x03} without any of the usual packet overhead described in
34283 the Overview section (@pxref{Overview}). When a @code{0x03} byte is
34284 transmitted as part of a packet, it is considered to be packet data
34285 and does @emph{not} represent an interrupt. E.g., an @samp{X} packet
34286 (@pxref{X packet}), used for binary downloads, may include an unescaped
34287 @code{0x03} as part of its packet.
34288
34289 @code{BREAK} followed by @code{g} is also known as Magic SysRq g.
34290 When Linux kernel receives this sequence from serial port,
34291 it stops execution and connects to gdb.
34292
34293 Stubs are not required to recognize these interrupt mechanisms and the
34294 precise meaning associated with receipt of the interrupt is
34295 implementation defined. If the target supports debugging of multiple
34296 threads and/or processes, it should attempt to interrupt all
34297 currently-executing threads and processes.
34298 If the stub is successful at interrupting the
34299 running program, it should send one of the stop
34300 reply packets (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets}) to @value{GDBN} as a result
34301 of successfully stopping the program in all-stop mode, and a stop reply
34302 for each stopped thread in non-stop mode.
34303 Interrupts received while the
34304 program is stopped are discarded.
34305
34306 @node Notification Packets
34307 @section Notification Packets
34308 @cindex notification packets
34309 @cindex packets, notification
34310
34311 The @value{GDBN} remote serial protocol includes @dfn{notifications},
34312 packets that require no acknowledgment. Both the GDB and the stub
34313 may send notifications (although the only notifications defined at
34314 present are sent by the stub). Notifications carry information
34315 without incurring the round-trip latency of an acknowledgment, and so
34316 are useful for low-impact communications where occasional packet loss
34317 is not a problem.
34318
34319 A notification packet has the form @samp{% @var{data} #
34320 @var{checksum}}, where @var{data} is the content of the notification,
34321 and @var{checksum} is a checksum of @var{data}, computed and formatted
34322 as for ordinary @value{GDBN} packets. A notification's @var{data}
34323 never contains @samp{$}, @samp{%} or @samp{#} characters. Upon
34324 receiving a notification, the recipient sends no @samp{+} or @samp{-}
34325 to acknowledge the notification's receipt or to report its corruption.
34326
34327 Every notification's @var{data} begins with a name, which contains no
34328 colon characters, followed by a colon character.
34329
34330 Recipients should silently ignore corrupted notifications and
34331 notifications they do not understand. Recipients should restart
34332 timeout periods on receipt of a well-formed notification, whether or
34333 not they understand it.
34334
34335 Senders should only send the notifications described here when this
34336 protocol description specifies that they are permitted. In the
34337 future, we may extend the protocol to permit existing notifications in
34338 new contexts; this rule helps older senders avoid confusing newer
34339 recipients.
34340
34341 (Older versions of @value{GDBN} ignore bytes received until they see
34342 the @samp{$} byte that begins an ordinary packet, so new stubs may
34343 transmit notifications without fear of confusing older clients. There
34344 are no notifications defined for @value{GDBN} to send at the moment, but we
34345 assume that most older stubs would ignore them, as well.)
34346
34347 The following notification packets from the stub to @value{GDBN} are
34348 defined:
34349
34350 @table @samp
34351 @item Stop: @var{reply}
34352 Report an asynchronous stop event in non-stop mode.
34353 The @var{reply} has the form of a stop reply, as
34354 described in @ref{Stop Reply Packets}. Refer to @ref{Remote Non-Stop},
34355 for information on how these notifications are acknowledged by
34356 @value{GDBN}.
34357 @end table
34358
34359 @node Remote Non-Stop
34360 @section Remote Protocol Support for Non-Stop Mode
34361
34362 @value{GDBN}'s remote protocol supports non-stop debugging of
34363 multi-threaded programs, as described in @ref{Non-Stop Mode}. If the stub
34364 supports non-stop mode, it should report that to @value{GDBN} by including
34365 @samp{QNonStop+} in its @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
34366
34367 @value{GDBN} typically sends a @samp{QNonStop} packet only when
34368 establishing a new connection with the stub. Entering non-stop mode
34369 does not alter the state of any currently-running threads, but targets
34370 must stop all threads in any already-attached processes when entering
34371 all-stop mode. @value{GDBN} uses the @samp{?} packet as necessary to
34372 probe the target state after a mode change.
34373
34374 In non-stop mode, when an attached process encounters an event that
34375 would otherwise be reported with a stop reply, it uses the
34376 asynchronous notification mechanism (@pxref{Notification Packets}) to
34377 inform @value{GDBN}. In contrast to all-stop mode, where all threads
34378 in all processes are stopped when a stop reply is sent, in non-stop
34379 mode only the thread reporting the stop event is stopped. That is,
34380 when reporting a @samp{S} or @samp{T} response to indicate completion
34381 of a step operation, hitting a breakpoint, or a fault, only the
34382 affected thread is stopped; any other still-running threads continue
34383 to run. When reporting a @samp{W} or @samp{X} response, all running
34384 threads belonging to other attached processes continue to run.
34385
34386 Only one stop reply notification at a time may be pending; if
34387 additional stop events occur before @value{GDBN} has acknowledged the
34388 previous notification, they must be queued by the stub for later
34389 synchronous transmission in response to @samp{vStopped} packets from
34390 @value{GDBN}. Because the notification mechanism is unreliable,
34391 the stub is permitted to resend a stop reply notification
34392 if it believes @value{GDBN} may not have received it. @value{GDBN}
34393 ignores additional stop reply notifications received before it has
34394 finished processing a previous notification and the stub has completed
34395 sending any queued stop events.
34396
34397 Otherwise, @value{GDBN} must be prepared to receive a stop reply
34398 notification at any time. Specifically, they may appear when
34399 @value{GDBN} is not otherwise reading input from the stub, or when
34400 @value{GDBN} is expecting to read a normal synchronous response or a
34401 @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgment to a packet it has sent.
34402 Notification packets are distinct from any other communication from
34403 the stub so there is no ambiguity.
34404
34405 After receiving a stop reply notification, @value{GDBN} shall
34406 acknowledge it by sending a @samp{vStopped} packet (@pxref{vStopped packet})
34407 as a regular, synchronous request to the stub. Such acknowledgment
34408 is not required to happen immediately, as @value{GDBN} is permitted to
34409 send other, unrelated packets to the stub first, which the stub should
34410 process normally.
34411
34412 Upon receiving a @samp{vStopped} packet, if the stub has other queued
34413 stop events to report to @value{GDBN}, it shall respond by sending a
34414 normal stop reply response. @value{GDBN} shall then send another
34415 @samp{vStopped} packet to solicit further responses; again, it is
34416 permitted to send other, unrelated packets as well which the stub
34417 should process normally.
34418
34419 If the stub receives a @samp{vStopped} packet and there are no
34420 additional stop events to report, the stub shall return an @samp{OK}
34421 response. At this point, if further stop events occur, the stub shall
34422 send a new stop reply notification, @value{GDBN} shall accept the
34423 notification, and the process shall be repeated.
34424
34425 In non-stop mode, the target shall respond to the @samp{?} packet as
34426 follows. First, any incomplete stop reply notification/@samp{vStopped}
34427 sequence in progress is abandoned. The target must begin a new
34428 sequence reporting stop events for all stopped threads, whether or not
34429 it has previously reported those events to @value{GDBN}. The first
34430 stop reply is sent as a synchronous reply to the @samp{?} packet, and
34431 subsequent stop replies are sent as responses to @samp{vStopped} packets
34432 using the mechanism described above. The target must not send
34433 asynchronous stop reply notifications until the sequence is complete.
34434 If all threads are running when the target receives the @samp{?} packet,
34435 or if the target is not attached to any process, it shall respond
34436 @samp{OK}.
34437
34438 @node Packet Acknowledgment
34439 @section Packet Acknowledgment
34440
34441 @cindex acknowledgment, for @value{GDBN} remote
34442 @cindex packet acknowledgment, for @value{GDBN} remote
34443 By default, when either the host or the target machine receives a packet,
34444 the first response expected is an acknowledgment: either @samp{+} (to indicate
34445 the package was received correctly) or @samp{-} (to request retransmission).
34446 This mechanism allows the @value{GDBN} remote protocol to operate over
34447 unreliable transport mechanisms, such as a serial line.
34448
34449 In cases where the transport mechanism is itself reliable (such as a pipe or
34450 TCP connection), the @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgments are redundant.
34451 It may be desirable to disable them in that case to reduce communication
34452 overhead, or for other reasons. This can be accomplished by means of the
34453 @samp{QStartNoAckMode} packet; @pxref{QStartNoAckMode}.
34454
34455 When in no-acknowledgment mode, neither the stub nor @value{GDBN} shall send or
34456 expect @samp{+}/@samp{-} protocol acknowledgments. The packet
34457 and response format still includes the normal checksum, as described in
34458 @ref{Overview}, but the checksum may be ignored by the receiver.
34459
34460 If the stub supports @samp{QStartNoAckMode} and prefers to operate in
34461 no-acknowledgment mode, it should report that to @value{GDBN}
34462 by including @samp{QStartNoAckMode+} in its response to @samp{qSupported};
34463 @pxref{qSupported}.
34464 If @value{GDBN} also supports @samp{QStartNoAckMode} and it has not been
34465 disabled via the @code{set remote noack-packet off} command
34466 (@pxref{Remote Configuration}),
34467 @value{GDBN} may then send a @samp{QStartNoAckMode} packet to the stub.
34468 Only then may the stub actually turn off packet acknowledgments.
34469 @value{GDBN} sends a final @samp{+} acknowledgment of the stub's @samp{OK}
34470 response, which can be safely ignored by the stub.
34471
34472 Note that @code{set remote noack-packet} command only affects negotiation
34473 between @value{GDBN} and the stub when subsequent connections are made;
34474 it does not affect the protocol acknowledgment state for any current
34475 connection.
34476 Since @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgments are enabled by default when a
34477 new connection is established,
34478 there is also no protocol request to re-enable the acknowledgments
34479 for the current connection, once disabled.
34480
34481 @node Examples
34482 @section Examples
34483
34484 Example sequence of a target being re-started. Notice how the restart
34485 does not get any direct output:
34486
34487 @smallexample
34488 -> @code{R00}
34489 <- @code{+}
34490 @emph{target restarts}
34491 -> @code{?}
34492 <- @code{+}
34493 <- @code{T001:1234123412341234}
34494 -> @code{+}
34495 @end smallexample
34496
34497 Example sequence of a target being stepped by a single instruction:
34498
34499 @smallexample
34500 -> @code{G1445@dots{}}
34501 <- @code{+}
34502 -> @code{s}
34503 <- @code{+}
34504 @emph{time passes}
34505 <- @code{T001:1234123412341234}
34506 -> @code{+}
34507 -> @code{g}
34508 <- @code{+}
34509 <- @code{1455@dots{}}
34510 -> @code{+}
34511 @end smallexample
34512
34513 @node File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension
34514 @section File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension
34515 @cindex File-I/O remote protocol extension
34516
34517 @menu
34518 * File-I/O Overview::
34519 * Protocol Basics::
34520 * The F Request Packet::
34521 * The F Reply Packet::
34522 * The Ctrl-C Message::
34523 * Console I/O::
34524 * List of Supported Calls::
34525 * Protocol-specific Representation of Datatypes::
34526 * Constants::
34527 * File-I/O Examples::
34528 @end menu
34529
34530 @node File-I/O Overview
34531 @subsection File-I/O Overview
34532 @cindex file-i/o overview
34533
34534 The @dfn{File I/O remote protocol extension} (short: File-I/O) allows the
34535 target to use the host's file system and console I/O to perform various
34536 system calls. System calls on the target system are translated into a
34537 remote protocol packet to the host system, which then performs the needed
34538 actions and returns a response packet to the target system.
34539 This simulates file system operations even on targets that lack file systems.
34540
34541 The protocol is defined to be independent of both the host and target systems.
34542 It uses its own internal representation of datatypes and values. Both
34543 @value{GDBN} and the target's @value{GDBN} stub are responsible for
34544 translating the system-dependent value representations into the internal
34545 protocol representations when data is transmitted.
34546
34547 The communication is synchronous. A system call is possible only when
34548 @value{GDBN} is waiting for a response from the @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}
34549 or @samp{s} packets. While @value{GDBN} handles the request for a system call,
34550 the target is stopped to allow deterministic access to the target's
34551 memory. Therefore File-I/O is not interruptible by target signals. On
34552 the other hand, it is possible to interrupt File-I/O by a user interrupt
34553 (@samp{Ctrl-C}) within @value{GDBN}.
34554
34555 The target's request to perform a host system call does not finish
34556 the latest @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S} or @samp{s} action. That means,
34557 after finishing the system call, the target returns to continuing the
34558 previous activity (continue, step). No additional continue or step
34559 request from @value{GDBN} is required.
34560
34561 @smallexample
34562 (@value{GDBP}) continue
34563 <- target requests 'system call X'
34564 target is stopped, @value{GDBN} executes system call
34565 -> @value{GDBN} returns result
34566 ... target continues, @value{GDBN} returns to wait for the target
34567 <- target hits breakpoint and sends a Txx packet
34568 @end smallexample
34569
34570 The protocol only supports I/O on the console and to regular files on
34571 the host file system. Character or block special devices, pipes,
34572 named pipes, sockets or any other communication method on the host
34573 system are not supported by this protocol.
34574
34575 File I/O is not supported in non-stop mode.
34576
34577 @node Protocol Basics
34578 @subsection Protocol Basics
34579 @cindex protocol basics, file-i/o
34580
34581 The File-I/O protocol uses the @code{F} packet as the request as well
34582 as reply packet. Since a File-I/O system call can only occur when
34583 @value{GDBN} is waiting for a response from the continuing or stepping target,
34584 the File-I/O request is a reply that @value{GDBN} has to expect as a result
34585 of a previous @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S} or @samp{s} packet.
34586 This @code{F} packet contains all information needed to allow @value{GDBN}
34587 to call the appropriate host system call:
34588
34589 @itemize @bullet
34590 @item
34591 A unique identifier for the requested system call.
34592
34593 @item
34594 All parameters to the system call. Pointers are given as addresses
34595 in the target memory address space. Pointers to strings are given as
34596 pointer/length pair. Numerical values are given as they are.
34597 Numerical control flags are given in a protocol-specific representation.
34598
34599 @end itemize
34600
34601 At this point, @value{GDBN} has to perform the following actions.
34602
34603 @itemize @bullet
34604 @item
34605 If the parameters include pointer values to data needed as input to a
34606 system call, @value{GDBN} requests this data from the target with a
34607 standard @code{m} packet request. This additional communication has to be
34608 expected by the target implementation and is handled as any other @code{m}
34609 packet.
34610
34611 @item
34612 @value{GDBN} translates all value from protocol representation to host
34613 representation as needed. Datatypes are coerced into the host types.
34614
34615 @item
34616 @value{GDBN} calls the system call.
34617
34618 @item
34619 It then coerces datatypes back to protocol representation.
34620
34621 @item
34622 If the system call is expected to return data in buffer space specified
34623 by pointer parameters to the call, the data is transmitted to the
34624 target using a @code{M} or @code{X} packet. This packet has to be expected
34625 by the target implementation and is handled as any other @code{M} or @code{X}
34626 packet.
34627
34628 @end itemize
34629
34630 Eventually @value{GDBN} replies with another @code{F} packet which contains all
34631 necessary information for the target to continue. This at least contains
34632
34633 @itemize @bullet
34634 @item
34635 Return value.
34636
34637 @item
34638 @code{errno}, if has been changed by the system call.
34639
34640 @item
34641 ``Ctrl-C'' flag.
34642
34643 @end itemize
34644
34645 After having done the needed type and value coercion, the target continues
34646 the latest continue or step action.
34647
34648 @node The F Request Packet
34649 @subsection The @code{F} Request Packet
34650 @cindex file-i/o request packet
34651 @cindex @code{F} request packet
34652
34653 The @code{F} request packet has the following format:
34654
34655 @table @samp
34656 @item F@var{call-id},@var{parameter@dots{}}
34657
34658 @var{call-id} is the identifier to indicate the host system call to be called.
34659 This is just the name of the function.
34660
34661 @var{parameter@dots{}} are the parameters to the system call.
34662 Parameters are hexadecimal integer values, either the actual values in case
34663 of scalar datatypes, pointers to target buffer space in case of compound
34664 datatypes and unspecified memory areas, or pointer/length pairs in case
34665 of string parameters. These are appended to the @var{call-id} as a
34666 comma-delimited list. All values are transmitted in ASCII
34667 string representation, pointer/length pairs separated by a slash.
34668
34669 @end table
34670
34671
34672
34673 @node The F Reply Packet
34674 @subsection The @code{F} Reply Packet
34675 @cindex file-i/o reply packet
34676 @cindex @code{F} reply packet
34677
34678 The @code{F} reply packet has the following format:
34679
34680 @table @samp
34681
34682 @item F@var{retcode},@var{errno},@var{Ctrl-C flag};@var{call-specific attachment}
34683
34684 @var{retcode} is the return code of the system call as hexadecimal value.
34685
34686 @var{errno} is the @code{errno} set by the call, in protocol-specific
34687 representation.
34688 This parameter can be omitted if the call was successful.
34689
34690 @var{Ctrl-C flag} is only sent if the user requested a break. In this
34691 case, @var{errno} must be sent as well, even if the call was successful.
34692 The @var{Ctrl-C flag} itself consists of the character @samp{C}:
34693
34694 @smallexample
34695 F0,0,C
34696 @end smallexample
34697
34698 @noindent
34699 or, if the call was interrupted before the host call has been performed:
34700
34701 @smallexample
34702 F-1,4,C
34703 @end smallexample
34704
34705 @noindent
34706 assuming 4 is the protocol-specific representation of @code{EINTR}.
34707
34708 @end table
34709
34710
34711 @node The Ctrl-C Message
34712 @subsection The @samp{Ctrl-C} Message
34713 @cindex ctrl-c message, in file-i/o protocol
34714
34715 If the @samp{Ctrl-C} flag is set in the @value{GDBN}
34716 reply packet (@pxref{The F Reply Packet}),
34717 the target should behave as if it had
34718 gotten a break message. The meaning for the target is ``system call
34719 interrupted by @code{SIGINT}''. Consequentially, the target should actually stop
34720 (as with a break message) and return to @value{GDBN} with a @code{T02}
34721 packet.
34722
34723 It's important for the target to know in which
34724 state the system call was interrupted. There are two possible cases:
34725
34726 @itemize @bullet
34727 @item
34728 The system call hasn't been performed on the host yet.
34729
34730 @item
34731 The system call on the host has been finished.
34732
34733 @end itemize
34734
34735 These two states can be distinguished by the target by the value of the
34736 returned @code{errno}. If it's the protocol representation of @code{EINTR}, the system
34737 call hasn't been performed. This is equivalent to the @code{EINTR} handling
34738 on POSIX systems. In any other case, the target may presume that the
34739 system call has been finished --- successfully or not --- and should behave
34740 as if the break message arrived right after the system call.
34741
34742 @value{GDBN} must behave reliably. If the system call has not been called
34743 yet, @value{GDBN} may send the @code{F} reply immediately, setting @code{EINTR} as
34744 @code{errno} in the packet. If the system call on the host has been finished
34745 before the user requests a break, the full action must be finished by
34746 @value{GDBN}. This requires sending @code{M} or @code{X} packets as necessary.
34747 The @code{F} packet may only be sent when either nothing has happened
34748 or the full action has been completed.
34749
34750 @node Console I/O
34751 @subsection Console I/O
34752 @cindex console i/o as part of file-i/o
34753
34754 By default and if not explicitly closed by the target system, the file
34755 descriptors 0, 1 and 2 are connected to the @value{GDBN} console. Output
34756 on the @value{GDBN} console is handled as any other file output operation
34757 (@code{write(1, @dots{})} or @code{write(2, @dots{})}). Console input is handled
34758 by @value{GDBN} so that after the target read request from file descriptor
34759 0 all following typing is buffered until either one of the following
34760 conditions is met:
34761
34762 @itemize @bullet
34763 @item
34764 The user types @kbd{Ctrl-c}. The behaviour is as explained above, and the
34765 @code{read}
34766 system call is treated as finished.
34767
34768 @item
34769 The user presses @key{RET}. This is treated as end of input with a trailing
34770 newline.
34771
34772 @item
34773 The user types @kbd{Ctrl-d}. This is treated as end of input. No trailing
34774 character (neither newline nor @samp{Ctrl-D}) is appended to the input.
34775
34776 @end itemize
34777
34778 If the user has typed more characters than fit in the buffer given to
34779 the @code{read} call, the trailing characters are buffered in @value{GDBN} until
34780 either another @code{read(0, @dots{})} is requested by the target, or debugging
34781 is stopped at the user's request.
34782
34783
34784 @node List of Supported Calls
34785 @subsection List of Supported Calls
34786 @cindex list of supported file-i/o calls
34787
34788 @menu
34789 * open::
34790 * close::
34791 * read::
34792 * write::
34793 * lseek::
34794 * rename::
34795 * unlink::
34796 * stat/fstat::
34797 * gettimeofday::
34798 * isatty::
34799 * system::
34800 @end menu
34801
34802 @node open
34803 @unnumberedsubsubsec open
34804 @cindex open, file-i/o system call
34805
34806 @table @asis
34807 @item Synopsis:
34808 @smallexample
34809 int open(const char *pathname, int flags);
34810 int open(const char *pathname, int flags, mode_t mode);
34811 @end smallexample
34812
34813 @item Request:
34814 @samp{Fopen,@var{pathptr}/@var{len},@var{flags},@var{mode}}
34815
34816 @noindent
34817 @var{flags} is the bitwise @code{OR} of the following values:
34818
34819 @table @code
34820 @item O_CREAT
34821 If the file does not exist it will be created. The host
34822 rules apply as far as file ownership and time stamps
34823 are concerned.
34824
34825 @item O_EXCL
34826 When used with @code{O_CREAT}, if the file already exists it is
34827 an error and open() fails.
34828
34829 @item O_TRUNC
34830 If the file already exists and the open mode allows
34831 writing (@code{O_RDWR} or @code{O_WRONLY} is given) it will be
34832 truncated to zero length.
34833
34834 @item O_APPEND
34835 The file is opened in append mode.
34836
34837 @item O_RDONLY
34838 The file is opened for reading only.
34839
34840 @item O_WRONLY
34841 The file is opened for writing only.
34842
34843 @item O_RDWR
34844 The file is opened for reading and writing.
34845 @end table
34846
34847 @noindent
34848 Other bits are silently ignored.
34849
34850
34851 @noindent
34852 @var{mode} is the bitwise @code{OR} of the following values:
34853
34854 @table @code
34855 @item S_IRUSR
34856 User has read permission.
34857
34858 @item S_IWUSR
34859 User has write permission.
34860
34861 @item S_IRGRP
34862 Group has read permission.
34863
34864 @item S_IWGRP
34865 Group has write permission.
34866
34867 @item S_IROTH
34868 Others have read permission.
34869
34870 @item S_IWOTH
34871 Others have write permission.
34872 @end table
34873
34874 @noindent
34875 Other bits are silently ignored.
34876
34877
34878 @item Return value:
34879 @code{open} returns the new file descriptor or -1 if an error
34880 occurred.
34881
34882 @item Errors:
34883
34884 @table @code
34885 @item EEXIST
34886 @var{pathname} already exists and @code{O_CREAT} and @code{O_EXCL} were used.
34887
34888 @item EISDIR
34889 @var{pathname} refers to a directory.
34890
34891 @item EACCES
34892 The requested access is not allowed.
34893
34894 @item ENAMETOOLONG
34895 @var{pathname} was too long.
34896
34897 @item ENOENT
34898 A directory component in @var{pathname} does not exist.
34899
34900 @item ENODEV
34901 @var{pathname} refers to a device, pipe, named pipe or socket.
34902
34903 @item EROFS
34904 @var{pathname} refers to a file on a read-only filesystem and
34905 write access was requested.
34906
34907 @item EFAULT
34908 @var{pathname} is an invalid pointer value.
34909
34910 @item ENOSPC
34911 No space on device to create the file.
34912
34913 @item EMFILE
34914 The process already has the maximum number of files open.
34915
34916 @item ENFILE
34917 The limit on the total number of files open on the system
34918 has been reached.
34919
34920 @item EINTR
34921 The call was interrupted by the user.
34922 @end table
34923
34924 @end table
34925
34926 @node close
34927 @unnumberedsubsubsec close
34928 @cindex close, file-i/o system call
34929
34930 @table @asis
34931 @item Synopsis:
34932 @smallexample
34933 int close(int fd);
34934 @end smallexample
34935
34936 @item Request:
34937 @samp{Fclose,@var{fd}}
34938
34939 @item Return value:
34940 @code{close} returns zero on success, or -1 if an error occurred.
34941
34942 @item Errors:
34943
34944 @table @code
34945 @item EBADF
34946 @var{fd} isn't a valid open file descriptor.
34947
34948 @item EINTR
34949 The call was interrupted by the user.
34950 @end table
34951
34952 @end table
34953
34954 @node read
34955 @unnumberedsubsubsec read
34956 @cindex read, file-i/o system call
34957
34958 @table @asis
34959 @item Synopsis:
34960 @smallexample
34961 int read(int fd, void *buf, unsigned int count);
34962 @end smallexample
34963
34964 @item Request:
34965 @samp{Fread,@var{fd},@var{bufptr},@var{count}}
34966
34967 @item Return value:
34968 On success, the number of bytes read is returned.
34969 Zero indicates end of file. If count is zero, read
34970 returns zero as well. On error, -1 is returned.
34971
34972 @item Errors:
34973
34974 @table @code
34975 @item EBADF
34976 @var{fd} is not a valid file descriptor or is not open for
34977 reading.
34978
34979 @item EFAULT
34980 @var{bufptr} is an invalid pointer value.
34981
34982 @item EINTR
34983 The call was interrupted by the user.
34984 @end table
34985
34986 @end table
34987
34988 @node write
34989 @unnumberedsubsubsec write
34990 @cindex write, file-i/o system call
34991
34992 @table @asis
34993 @item Synopsis:
34994 @smallexample
34995 int write(int fd, const void *buf, unsigned int count);
34996 @end smallexample
34997
34998 @item Request:
34999 @samp{Fwrite,@var{fd},@var{bufptr},@var{count}}
35000
35001 @item Return value:
35002 On success, the number of bytes written are returned.
35003 Zero indicates nothing was written. On error, -1
35004 is returned.
35005
35006 @item Errors:
35007
35008 @table @code
35009 @item EBADF
35010 @var{fd} is not a valid file descriptor or is not open for
35011 writing.
35012
35013 @item EFAULT
35014 @var{bufptr} is an invalid pointer value.
35015
35016 @item EFBIG
35017 An attempt was made to write a file that exceeds the
35018 host-specific maximum file size allowed.
35019
35020 @item ENOSPC
35021 No space on device to write the data.
35022
35023 @item EINTR
35024 The call was interrupted by the user.
35025 @end table
35026
35027 @end table
35028
35029 @node lseek
35030 @unnumberedsubsubsec lseek
35031 @cindex lseek, file-i/o system call
35032
35033 @table @asis
35034 @item Synopsis:
35035 @smallexample
35036 long lseek (int fd, long offset, int flag);
35037 @end smallexample
35038
35039 @item Request:
35040 @samp{Flseek,@var{fd},@var{offset},@var{flag}}
35041
35042 @var{flag} is one of:
35043
35044 @table @code
35045 @item SEEK_SET
35046 The offset is set to @var{offset} bytes.
35047
35048 @item SEEK_CUR
35049 The offset is set to its current location plus @var{offset}
35050 bytes.
35051
35052 @item SEEK_END
35053 The offset is set to the size of the file plus @var{offset}
35054 bytes.
35055 @end table
35056
35057 @item Return value:
35058 On success, the resulting unsigned offset in bytes from
35059 the beginning of the file is returned. Otherwise, a
35060 value of -1 is returned.
35061
35062 @item Errors:
35063
35064 @table @code
35065 @item EBADF
35066 @var{fd} is not a valid open file descriptor.
35067
35068 @item ESPIPE
35069 @var{fd} is associated with the @value{GDBN} console.
35070
35071 @item EINVAL
35072 @var{flag} is not a proper value.
35073
35074 @item EINTR
35075 The call was interrupted by the user.
35076 @end table
35077
35078 @end table
35079
35080 @node rename
35081 @unnumberedsubsubsec rename
35082 @cindex rename, file-i/o system call
35083
35084 @table @asis
35085 @item Synopsis:
35086 @smallexample
35087 int rename(const char *oldpath, const char *newpath);
35088 @end smallexample
35089
35090 @item Request:
35091 @samp{Frename,@var{oldpathptr}/@var{len},@var{newpathptr}/@var{len}}
35092
35093 @item Return value:
35094 On success, zero is returned. On error, -1 is returned.
35095
35096 @item Errors:
35097
35098 @table @code
35099 @item EISDIR
35100 @var{newpath} is an existing directory, but @var{oldpath} is not a
35101 directory.
35102
35103 @item EEXIST
35104 @var{newpath} is a non-empty directory.
35105
35106 @item EBUSY
35107 @var{oldpath} or @var{newpath} is a directory that is in use by some
35108 process.
35109
35110 @item EINVAL
35111 An attempt was made to make a directory a subdirectory
35112 of itself.
35113
35114 @item ENOTDIR
35115 A component used as a directory in @var{oldpath} or new
35116 path is not a directory. Or @var{oldpath} is a directory
35117 and @var{newpath} exists but is not a directory.
35118
35119 @item EFAULT
35120 @var{oldpathptr} or @var{newpathptr} are invalid pointer values.
35121
35122 @item EACCES
35123 No access to the file or the path of the file.
35124
35125 @item ENAMETOOLONG
35126
35127 @var{oldpath} or @var{newpath} was too long.
35128
35129 @item ENOENT
35130 A directory component in @var{oldpath} or @var{newpath} does not exist.
35131
35132 @item EROFS
35133 The file is on a read-only filesystem.
35134
35135 @item ENOSPC
35136 The device containing the file has no room for the new
35137 directory entry.
35138
35139 @item EINTR
35140 The call was interrupted by the user.
35141 @end table
35142
35143 @end table
35144
35145 @node unlink
35146 @unnumberedsubsubsec unlink
35147 @cindex unlink, file-i/o system call
35148
35149 @table @asis
35150 @item Synopsis:
35151 @smallexample
35152 int unlink(const char *pathname);
35153 @end smallexample
35154
35155 @item Request:
35156 @samp{Funlink,@var{pathnameptr}/@var{len}}
35157
35158 @item Return value:
35159 On success, zero is returned. On error, -1 is returned.
35160
35161 @item Errors:
35162
35163 @table @code
35164 @item EACCES
35165 No access to the file or the path of the file.
35166
35167 @item EPERM
35168 The system does not allow unlinking of directories.
35169
35170 @item EBUSY
35171 The file @var{pathname} cannot be unlinked because it's
35172 being used by another process.
35173
35174 @item EFAULT
35175 @var{pathnameptr} is an invalid pointer value.
35176
35177 @item ENAMETOOLONG
35178 @var{pathname} was too long.
35179
35180 @item ENOENT
35181 A directory component in @var{pathname} does not exist.
35182
35183 @item ENOTDIR
35184 A component of the path is not a directory.
35185
35186 @item EROFS
35187 The file is on a read-only filesystem.
35188
35189 @item EINTR
35190 The call was interrupted by the user.
35191 @end table
35192
35193 @end table
35194
35195 @node stat/fstat
35196 @unnumberedsubsubsec stat/fstat
35197 @cindex fstat, file-i/o system call
35198 @cindex stat, file-i/o system call
35199
35200 @table @asis
35201 @item Synopsis:
35202 @smallexample
35203 int stat(const char *pathname, struct stat *buf);
35204 int fstat(int fd, struct stat *buf);
35205 @end smallexample
35206
35207 @item Request:
35208 @samp{Fstat,@var{pathnameptr}/@var{len},@var{bufptr}}@*
35209 @samp{Ffstat,@var{fd},@var{bufptr}}
35210
35211 @item Return value:
35212 On success, zero is returned. On error, -1 is returned.
35213
35214 @item Errors:
35215
35216 @table @code
35217 @item EBADF
35218 @var{fd} is not a valid open file.
35219
35220 @item ENOENT
35221 A directory component in @var{pathname} does not exist or the
35222 path is an empty string.
35223
35224 @item ENOTDIR
35225 A component of the path is not a directory.
35226
35227 @item EFAULT
35228 @var{pathnameptr} is an invalid pointer value.
35229
35230 @item EACCES
35231 No access to the file or the path of the file.
35232
35233 @item ENAMETOOLONG
35234 @var{pathname} was too long.
35235
35236 @item EINTR
35237 The call was interrupted by the user.
35238 @end table
35239
35240 @end table
35241
35242 @node gettimeofday
35243 @unnumberedsubsubsec gettimeofday
35244 @cindex gettimeofday, file-i/o system call
35245
35246 @table @asis
35247 @item Synopsis:
35248 @smallexample
35249 int gettimeofday(struct timeval *tv, void *tz);
35250 @end smallexample
35251
35252 @item Request:
35253 @samp{Fgettimeofday,@var{tvptr},@var{tzptr}}
35254
35255 @item Return value:
35256 On success, 0 is returned, -1 otherwise.
35257
35258 @item Errors:
35259
35260 @table @code
35261 @item EINVAL
35262 @var{tz} is a non-NULL pointer.
35263
35264 @item EFAULT
35265 @var{tvptr} and/or @var{tzptr} is an invalid pointer value.
35266 @end table
35267
35268 @end table
35269
35270 @node isatty
35271 @unnumberedsubsubsec isatty
35272 @cindex isatty, file-i/o system call
35273
35274 @table @asis
35275 @item Synopsis:
35276 @smallexample
35277 int isatty(int fd);
35278 @end smallexample
35279
35280 @item Request:
35281 @samp{Fisatty,@var{fd}}
35282
35283 @item Return value:
35284 Returns 1 if @var{fd} refers to the @value{GDBN} console, 0 otherwise.
35285
35286 @item Errors:
35287
35288 @table @code
35289 @item EINTR
35290 The call was interrupted by the user.
35291 @end table
35292
35293 @end table
35294
35295 Note that the @code{isatty} call is treated as a special case: it returns
35296 1 to the target if the file descriptor is attached
35297 to the @value{GDBN} console, 0 otherwise. Implementing through system calls
35298 would require implementing @code{ioctl} and would be more complex than
35299 needed.
35300
35301
35302 @node system
35303 @unnumberedsubsubsec system
35304 @cindex system, file-i/o system call
35305
35306 @table @asis
35307 @item Synopsis:
35308 @smallexample
35309 int system(const char *command);
35310 @end smallexample
35311
35312 @item Request:
35313 @samp{Fsystem,@var{commandptr}/@var{len}}
35314
35315 @item Return value:
35316 If @var{len} is zero, the return value indicates whether a shell is
35317 available. A zero return value indicates a shell is not available.
35318 For non-zero @var{len}, the value returned is -1 on error and the
35319 return status of the command otherwise. Only the exit status of the
35320 command is returned, which is extracted from the host's @code{system}
35321 return value by calling @code{WEXITSTATUS(retval)}. In case
35322 @file{/bin/sh} could not be executed, 127 is returned.
35323
35324 @item Errors:
35325
35326 @table @code
35327 @item EINTR
35328 The call was interrupted by the user.
35329 @end table
35330
35331 @end table
35332
35333 @value{GDBN} takes over the full task of calling the necessary host calls
35334 to perform the @code{system} call. The return value of @code{system} on
35335 the host is simplified before it's returned
35336 to the target. Any termination signal information from the child process
35337 is discarded, and the return value consists
35338 entirely of the exit status of the called command.
35339
35340 Due to security concerns, the @code{system} call is by default refused
35341 by @value{GDBN}. The user has to allow this call explicitly with the
35342 @code{set remote system-call-allowed 1} command.
35343
35344 @table @code
35345 @item set remote system-call-allowed
35346 @kindex set remote system-call-allowed
35347 Control whether to allow the @code{system} calls in the File I/O
35348 protocol for the remote target. The default is zero (disabled).
35349
35350 @item show remote system-call-allowed
35351 @kindex show remote system-call-allowed
35352 Show whether the @code{system} calls are allowed in the File I/O
35353 protocol.
35354 @end table
35355
35356 @node Protocol-specific Representation of Datatypes
35357 @subsection Protocol-specific Representation of Datatypes
35358 @cindex protocol-specific representation of datatypes, in file-i/o protocol
35359
35360 @menu
35361 * Integral Datatypes::
35362 * Pointer Values::
35363 * Memory Transfer::
35364 * struct stat::
35365 * struct timeval::
35366 @end menu
35367
35368 @node Integral Datatypes
35369 @unnumberedsubsubsec Integral Datatypes
35370 @cindex integral datatypes, in file-i/o protocol
35371
35372 The integral datatypes used in the system calls are @code{int},
35373 @code{unsigned int}, @code{long}, @code{unsigned long},
35374 @code{mode_t}, and @code{time_t}.
35375
35376 @code{int}, @code{unsigned int}, @code{mode_t} and @code{time_t} are
35377 implemented as 32 bit values in this protocol.
35378
35379 @code{long} and @code{unsigned long} are implemented as 64 bit types.
35380
35381 @xref{Limits}, for corresponding MIN and MAX values (similar to those
35382 in @file{limits.h}) to allow range checking on host and target.
35383
35384 @code{time_t} datatypes are defined as seconds since the Epoch.
35385
35386 All integral datatypes transferred as part of a memory read or write of a
35387 structured datatype e.g.@: a @code{struct stat} have to be given in big endian
35388 byte order.
35389
35390 @node Pointer Values
35391 @unnumberedsubsubsec Pointer Values
35392 @cindex pointer values, in file-i/o protocol
35393
35394 Pointers to target data are transmitted as they are. An exception
35395 is made for pointers to buffers for which the length isn't
35396 transmitted as part of the function call, namely strings. Strings
35397 are transmitted as a pointer/length pair, both as hex values, e.g.@:
35398
35399 @smallexample
35400 @code{1aaf/12}
35401 @end smallexample
35402
35403 @noindent
35404 which is a pointer to data of length 18 bytes at position 0x1aaf.
35405 The length is defined as the full string length in bytes, including
35406 the trailing null byte. For example, the string @code{"hello world"}
35407 at address 0x123456 is transmitted as
35408
35409 @smallexample
35410 @code{123456/d}
35411 @end smallexample
35412
35413 @node Memory Transfer
35414 @unnumberedsubsubsec Memory Transfer
35415 @cindex memory transfer, in file-i/o protocol
35416
35417 Structured data which is transferred using a memory read or write (for
35418 example, a @code{struct stat}) is expected to be in a protocol-specific format
35419 with all scalar multibyte datatypes being big endian. Translation to
35420 this representation needs to be done both by the target before the @code{F}
35421 packet is sent, and by @value{GDBN} before
35422 it transfers memory to the target. Transferred pointers to structured
35423 data should point to the already-coerced data at any time.
35424
35425
35426 @node struct stat
35427 @unnumberedsubsubsec struct stat
35428 @cindex struct stat, in file-i/o protocol
35429
35430 The buffer of type @code{struct stat} used by the target and @value{GDBN}
35431 is defined as follows:
35432
35433 @smallexample
35434 struct stat @{
35435 unsigned int st_dev; /* device */
35436 unsigned int st_ino; /* inode */
35437 mode_t st_mode; /* protection */
35438 unsigned int st_nlink; /* number of hard links */
35439 unsigned int st_uid; /* user ID of owner */
35440 unsigned int st_gid; /* group ID of owner */
35441 unsigned int st_rdev; /* device type (if inode device) */
35442 unsigned long st_size; /* total size, in bytes */
35443 unsigned long st_blksize; /* blocksize for filesystem I/O */
35444 unsigned long st_blocks; /* number of blocks allocated */
35445 time_t st_atime; /* time of last access */
35446 time_t st_mtime; /* time of last modification */
35447 time_t st_ctime; /* time of last change */
35448 @};
35449 @end smallexample
35450
35451 The integral datatypes conform to the definitions given in the
35452 appropriate section (see @ref{Integral Datatypes}, for details) so this
35453 structure is of size 64 bytes.
35454
35455 The values of several fields have a restricted meaning and/or
35456 range of values.
35457
35458 @table @code
35459
35460 @item st_dev
35461 A value of 0 represents a file, 1 the console.
35462
35463 @item st_ino
35464 No valid meaning for the target. Transmitted unchanged.
35465
35466 @item st_mode
35467 Valid mode bits are described in @ref{Constants}. Any other
35468 bits have currently no meaning for the target.
35469
35470 @item st_uid
35471 @itemx st_gid
35472 @itemx st_rdev
35473 No valid meaning for the target. Transmitted unchanged.
35474
35475 @item st_atime
35476 @itemx st_mtime
35477 @itemx st_ctime
35478 These values have a host and file system dependent
35479 accuracy. Especially on Windows hosts, the file system may not
35480 support exact timing values.
35481 @end table
35482
35483 The target gets a @code{struct stat} of the above representation and is
35484 responsible for coercing it to the target representation before
35485 continuing.
35486
35487 Note that due to size differences between the host, target, and protocol
35488 representations of @code{struct stat} members, these members could eventually
35489 get truncated on the target.
35490
35491 @node struct timeval
35492 @unnumberedsubsubsec struct timeval
35493 @cindex struct timeval, in file-i/o protocol
35494
35495 The buffer of type @code{struct timeval} used by the File-I/O protocol
35496 is defined as follows:
35497
35498 @smallexample
35499 struct timeval @{
35500 time_t tv_sec; /* second */
35501 long tv_usec; /* microsecond */
35502 @};
35503 @end smallexample
35504
35505 The integral datatypes conform to the definitions given in the
35506 appropriate section (see @ref{Integral Datatypes}, for details) so this
35507 structure is of size 8 bytes.
35508
35509 @node Constants
35510 @subsection Constants
35511 @cindex constants, in file-i/o protocol
35512
35513 The following values are used for the constants inside of the
35514 protocol. @value{GDBN} and target are responsible for translating these
35515 values before and after the call as needed.
35516
35517 @menu
35518 * Open Flags::
35519 * mode_t Values::
35520 * Errno Values::
35521 * Lseek Flags::
35522 * Limits::
35523 @end menu
35524
35525 @node Open Flags
35526 @unnumberedsubsubsec Open Flags
35527 @cindex open flags, in file-i/o protocol
35528
35529 All values are given in hexadecimal representation.
35530
35531 @smallexample
35532 O_RDONLY 0x0
35533 O_WRONLY 0x1
35534 O_RDWR 0x2
35535 O_APPEND 0x8
35536 O_CREAT 0x200
35537 O_TRUNC 0x400
35538 O_EXCL 0x800
35539 @end smallexample
35540
35541 @node mode_t Values
35542 @unnumberedsubsubsec mode_t Values
35543 @cindex mode_t values, in file-i/o protocol
35544
35545 All values are given in octal representation.
35546
35547 @smallexample
35548 S_IFREG 0100000
35549 S_IFDIR 040000
35550 S_IRUSR 0400
35551 S_IWUSR 0200
35552 S_IXUSR 0100
35553 S_IRGRP 040
35554 S_IWGRP 020
35555 S_IXGRP 010
35556 S_IROTH 04
35557 S_IWOTH 02
35558 S_IXOTH 01
35559 @end smallexample
35560
35561 @node Errno Values
35562 @unnumberedsubsubsec Errno Values
35563 @cindex errno values, in file-i/o protocol
35564
35565 All values are given in decimal representation.
35566
35567 @smallexample
35568 EPERM 1
35569 ENOENT 2
35570 EINTR 4
35571 EBADF 9
35572 EACCES 13
35573 EFAULT 14
35574 EBUSY 16
35575 EEXIST 17
35576 ENODEV 19
35577 ENOTDIR 20
35578 EISDIR 21
35579 EINVAL 22
35580 ENFILE 23
35581 EMFILE 24
35582 EFBIG 27
35583 ENOSPC 28
35584 ESPIPE 29
35585 EROFS 30
35586 ENAMETOOLONG 91
35587 EUNKNOWN 9999
35588 @end smallexample
35589
35590 @code{EUNKNOWN} is used as a fallback error value if a host system returns
35591 any error value not in the list of supported error numbers.
35592
35593 @node Lseek Flags
35594 @unnumberedsubsubsec Lseek Flags
35595 @cindex lseek flags, in file-i/o protocol
35596
35597 @smallexample
35598 SEEK_SET 0
35599 SEEK_CUR 1
35600 SEEK_END 2
35601 @end smallexample
35602
35603 @node Limits
35604 @unnumberedsubsubsec Limits
35605 @cindex limits, in file-i/o protocol
35606
35607 All values are given in decimal representation.
35608
35609 @smallexample
35610 INT_MIN -2147483648
35611 INT_MAX 2147483647
35612 UINT_MAX 4294967295
35613 LONG_MIN -9223372036854775808
35614 LONG_MAX 9223372036854775807
35615 ULONG_MAX 18446744073709551615
35616 @end smallexample
35617
35618 @node File-I/O Examples
35619 @subsection File-I/O Examples
35620 @cindex file-i/o examples
35621
35622 Example sequence of a write call, file descriptor 3, buffer is at target
35623 address 0x1234, 6 bytes should be written:
35624
35625 @smallexample
35626 <- @code{Fwrite,3,1234,6}
35627 @emph{request memory read from target}
35628 -> @code{m1234,6}
35629 <- XXXXXX
35630 @emph{return "6 bytes written"}
35631 -> @code{F6}
35632 @end smallexample
35633
35634 Example sequence of a read call, file descriptor 3, buffer is at target
35635 address 0x1234, 6 bytes should be read:
35636
35637 @smallexample
35638 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
35639 @emph{request memory write to target}
35640 -> @code{X1234,6:XXXXXX}
35641 @emph{return "6 bytes read"}
35642 -> @code{F6}
35643 @end smallexample
35644
35645 Example sequence of a read call, call fails on the host due to invalid
35646 file descriptor (@code{EBADF}):
35647
35648 @smallexample
35649 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
35650 -> @code{F-1,9}
35651 @end smallexample
35652
35653 Example sequence of a read call, user presses @kbd{Ctrl-c} before syscall on
35654 host is called:
35655
35656 @smallexample
35657 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
35658 -> @code{F-1,4,C}
35659 <- @code{T02}
35660 @end smallexample
35661
35662 Example sequence of a read call, user presses @kbd{Ctrl-c} after syscall on
35663 host is called:
35664
35665 @smallexample
35666 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
35667 -> @code{X1234,6:XXXXXX}
35668 <- @code{T02}
35669 @end smallexample
35670
35671 @node Library List Format
35672 @section Library List Format
35673 @cindex library list format, remote protocol
35674
35675 On some platforms, a dynamic loader (e.g.@: @file{ld.so}) runs in the
35676 same process as your application to manage libraries. In this case,
35677 @value{GDBN} can use the loader's symbol table and normal memory
35678 operations to maintain a list of shared libraries. On other
35679 platforms, the operating system manages loaded libraries.
35680 @value{GDBN} can not retrieve the list of currently loaded libraries
35681 through memory operations, so it uses the @samp{qXfer:libraries:read}
35682 packet (@pxref{qXfer library list read}) instead. The remote stub
35683 queries the target's operating system and reports which libraries
35684 are loaded.
35685
35686 The @samp{qXfer:libraries:read} packet returns an XML document which
35687 lists loaded libraries and their offsets. Each library has an
35688 associated name and one or more segment or section base addresses,
35689 which report where the library was loaded in memory.
35690
35691 For the common case of libraries that are fully linked binaries, the
35692 library should have a list of segments. If the target supports
35693 dynamic linking of a relocatable object file, its library XML element
35694 should instead include a list of allocated sections. The segment or
35695 section bases are start addresses, not relocation offsets; they do not
35696 depend on the library's link-time base addresses.
35697
35698 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
35699 library lists. @xref{Expat}.
35700
35701 A simple memory map, with one loaded library relocated by a single
35702 offset, looks like this:
35703
35704 @smallexample
35705 <library-list>
35706 <library name="/lib/libc.so.6">
35707 <segment address="0x10000000"/>
35708 </library>
35709 </library-list>
35710 @end smallexample
35711
35712 Another simple memory map, with one loaded library with three
35713 allocated sections (.text, .data, .bss), looks like this:
35714
35715 @smallexample
35716 <library-list>
35717 <library name="sharedlib.o">
35718 <section address="0x10000000"/>
35719 <section address="0x20000000"/>
35720 <section address="0x30000000"/>
35721 </library>
35722 </library-list>
35723 @end smallexample
35724
35725 The format of a library list is described by this DTD:
35726
35727 @smallexample
35728 <!-- library-list: Root element with versioning -->
35729 <!ELEMENT library-list (library)*>
35730 <!ATTLIST library-list version CDATA #FIXED "1.0">
35731 <!ELEMENT library (segment*, section*)>
35732 <!ATTLIST library name CDATA #REQUIRED>
35733 <!ELEMENT segment EMPTY>
35734 <!ATTLIST segment address CDATA #REQUIRED>
35735 <!ELEMENT section EMPTY>
35736 <!ATTLIST section address CDATA #REQUIRED>
35737 @end smallexample
35738
35739 In addition, segments and section descriptors cannot be mixed within a
35740 single library element, and you must supply at least one segment or
35741 section for each library.
35742
35743 @node Memory Map Format
35744 @section Memory Map Format
35745 @cindex memory map format
35746
35747 To be able to write into flash memory, @value{GDBN} needs to obtain a
35748 memory map from the target. This section describes the format of the
35749 memory map.
35750
35751 The memory map is obtained using the @samp{qXfer:memory-map:read}
35752 (@pxref{qXfer memory map read}) packet and is an XML document that
35753 lists memory regions.
35754
35755 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
35756 memory maps. @xref{Expat}.
35757
35758 The top-level structure of the document is shown below:
35759
35760 @smallexample
35761 <?xml version="1.0"?>
35762 <!DOCTYPE memory-map
35763 PUBLIC "+//IDN gnu.org//DTD GDB Memory Map V1.0//EN"
35764 "http://sourceware.org/gdb/gdb-memory-map.dtd">
35765 <memory-map>
35766 region...
35767 </memory-map>
35768 @end smallexample
35769
35770 Each region can be either:
35771
35772 @itemize
35773
35774 @item
35775 A region of RAM starting at @var{addr} and extending for @var{length}
35776 bytes from there:
35777
35778 @smallexample
35779 <memory type="ram" start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}"/>
35780 @end smallexample
35781
35782
35783 @item
35784 A region of read-only memory:
35785
35786 @smallexample
35787 <memory type="rom" start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}"/>
35788 @end smallexample
35789
35790
35791 @item
35792 A region of flash memory, with erasure blocks @var{blocksize}
35793 bytes in length:
35794
35795 @smallexample
35796 <memory type="flash" start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}">
35797 <property name="blocksize">@var{blocksize}</property>
35798 </memory>
35799 @end smallexample
35800
35801 @end itemize
35802
35803 Regions must not overlap. @value{GDBN} assumes that areas of memory not covered
35804 by the memory map are RAM, and uses the ordinary @samp{M} and @samp{X}
35805 packets to write to addresses in such ranges.
35806
35807 The formal DTD for memory map format is given below:
35808
35809 @smallexample
35810 <!-- ................................................... -->
35811 <!-- Memory Map XML DTD ................................ -->
35812 <!-- File: memory-map.dtd .............................. -->
35813 <!-- .................................... .............. -->
35814 <!-- memory-map.dtd -->
35815 <!-- memory-map: Root element with versioning -->
35816 <!ELEMENT memory-map (memory | property)>
35817 <!ATTLIST memory-map version CDATA #FIXED "1.0.0">
35818 <!ELEMENT memory (property)>
35819 <!-- memory: Specifies a memory region,
35820 and its type, or device. -->
35821 <!ATTLIST memory type CDATA #REQUIRED
35822 start CDATA #REQUIRED
35823 length CDATA #REQUIRED
35824 device CDATA #IMPLIED>
35825 <!-- property: Generic attribute tag -->
35826 <!ELEMENT property (#PCDATA | property)*>
35827 <!ATTLIST property name CDATA #REQUIRED>
35828 @end smallexample
35829
35830 @node Thread List Format
35831 @section Thread List Format
35832 @cindex thread list format
35833
35834 To efficiently update the list of threads and their attributes,
35835 @value{GDBN} issues the @samp{qXfer:threads:read} packet
35836 (@pxref{qXfer threads read}) and obtains the XML document with
35837 the following structure:
35838
35839 @smallexample
35840 <?xml version="1.0"?>
35841 <threads>
35842 <thread id="id" core="0">
35843 ... description ...
35844 </thread>
35845 </threads>
35846 @end smallexample
35847
35848 Each @samp{thread} element must have the @samp{id} attribute that
35849 identifies the thread (@pxref{thread-id syntax}). The
35850 @samp{core} attribute, if present, specifies which processor core
35851 the thread was last executing on. The content of the of @samp{thread}
35852 element is interpreted as human-readable auxilliary information.
35853
35854 @include agentexpr.texi
35855
35856 @node Trace File Format
35857 @appendix Trace File Format
35858 @cindex trace file format
35859
35860 The trace file comes in three parts: a header, a textual description
35861 section, and a trace frame section with binary data.
35862
35863 The header has the form @code{\x7fTRACE0\n}. The first byte is
35864 @code{0x7f} so as to indicate that the file contains binary data,
35865 while the @code{0} is a version number that may have different values
35866 in the future.
35867
35868 The description section consists of multiple lines of @sc{ascii} text
35869 separated by newline characters (@code{0xa}). The lines may include a
35870 variety of optional descriptive or context-setting information, such
35871 as tracepoint definitions or register set size. @value{GDBN} will
35872 ignore any line that it does not recognize. An empty line marks the end
35873 of this section.
35874
35875 @c FIXME add some specific types of data
35876
35877 The trace frame section consists of a number of consecutive frames.
35878 Each frame begins with a two-byte tracepoint number, followed by a
35879 four-byte size giving the amount of data in the frame. The data in
35880 the frame consists of a number of blocks, each introduced by a
35881 character indicating its type (at least register, memory, and trace
35882 state variable). The data in this section is raw binary, not a
35883 hexadecimal or other encoding; its endianness matches the target's
35884 endianness.
35885
35886 @c FIXME bi-arch may require endianness/arch info in description section
35887
35888 @table @code
35889 @item R @var{bytes}
35890 Register block. The number and ordering of bytes matches that of a
35891 @code{g} packet in the remote protocol. Note that these are the
35892 actual bytes, in target order and @value{GDBN} register order, not a
35893 hexadecimal encoding.
35894
35895 @item M @var{address} @var{length} @var{bytes}...
35896 Memory block. This is a contiguous block of memory, at the 8-byte
35897 address @var{address}, with a 2-byte length @var{length}, followed by
35898 @var{length} bytes.
35899
35900 @item V @var{number} @var{value}
35901 Trace state variable block. This records the 8-byte signed value
35902 @var{value} of trace state variable numbered @var{number}.
35903
35904 @end table
35905
35906 Future enhancements of the trace file format may include additional types
35907 of blocks.
35908
35909 @node Target Descriptions
35910 @appendix Target Descriptions
35911 @cindex target descriptions
35912
35913 @strong{Warning:} target descriptions are still under active development,
35914 and the contents and format may change between @value{GDBN} releases.
35915 The format is expected to stabilize in the future.
35916
35917 One of the challenges of using @value{GDBN} to debug embedded systems
35918 is that there are so many minor variants of each processor
35919 architecture in use. It is common practice for vendors to start with
35920 a standard processor core --- ARM, PowerPC, or MIPS, for example ---
35921 and then make changes to adapt it to a particular market niche. Some
35922 architectures have hundreds of variants, available from dozens of
35923 vendors. This leads to a number of problems:
35924
35925 @itemize @bullet
35926 @item
35927 With so many different customized processors, it is difficult for
35928 the @value{GDBN} maintainers to keep up with the changes.
35929 @item
35930 Since individual variants may have short lifetimes or limited
35931 audiences, it may not be worthwhile to carry information about every
35932 variant in the @value{GDBN} source tree.
35933 @item
35934 When @value{GDBN} does support the architecture of the embedded system
35935 at hand, the task of finding the correct architecture name to give the
35936 @command{set architecture} command can be error-prone.
35937 @end itemize
35938
35939 To address these problems, the @value{GDBN} remote protocol allows a
35940 target system to not only identify itself to @value{GDBN}, but to
35941 actually describe its own features. This lets @value{GDBN} support
35942 processor variants it has never seen before --- to the extent that the
35943 descriptions are accurate, and that @value{GDBN} understands them.
35944
35945 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
35946 target descriptions. @xref{Expat}.
35947
35948 @menu
35949 * Retrieving Descriptions:: How descriptions are fetched from a target.
35950 * Target Description Format:: The contents of a target description.
35951 * Predefined Target Types:: Standard types available for target
35952 descriptions.
35953 * Standard Target Features:: Features @value{GDBN} knows about.
35954 @end menu
35955
35956 @node Retrieving Descriptions
35957 @section Retrieving Descriptions
35958
35959 Target descriptions can be read from the target automatically, or
35960 specified by the user manually. The default behavior is to read the
35961 description from the target. @value{GDBN} retrieves it via the remote
35962 protocol using @samp{qXfer} requests (@pxref{General Query Packets,
35963 qXfer}). The @var{annex} in the @samp{qXfer} packet will be
35964 @samp{target.xml}. The contents of the @samp{target.xml} annex are an
35965 XML document, of the form described in @ref{Target Description
35966 Format}.
35967
35968 Alternatively, you can specify a file to read for the target description.
35969 If a file is set, the target will not be queried. The commands to
35970 specify a file are:
35971
35972 @table @code
35973 @cindex set tdesc filename
35974 @item set tdesc filename @var{path}
35975 Read the target description from @var{path}.
35976
35977 @cindex unset tdesc filename
35978 @item unset tdesc filename
35979 Do not read the XML target description from a file. @value{GDBN}
35980 will use the description supplied by the current target.
35981
35982 @cindex show tdesc filename
35983 @item show tdesc filename
35984 Show the filename to read for a target description, if any.
35985 @end table
35986
35987
35988 @node Target Description Format
35989 @section Target Description Format
35990 @cindex target descriptions, XML format
35991
35992 A target description annex is an @uref{http://www.w3.org/XML/, XML}
35993 document which complies with the Document Type Definition provided in
35994 the @value{GDBN} sources in @file{gdb/features/gdb-target.dtd}. This
35995 means you can use generally available tools like @command{xmllint} to
35996 check that your feature descriptions are well-formed and valid.
35997 However, to help people unfamiliar with XML write descriptions for
35998 their targets, we also describe the grammar here.
35999
36000 Target descriptions can identify the architecture of the remote target
36001 and (for some architectures) provide information about custom register
36002 sets. They can also identify the OS ABI of the remote target.
36003 @value{GDBN} can use this information to autoconfigure for your
36004 target, or to warn you if you connect to an unsupported target.
36005
36006 Here is a simple target description:
36007
36008 @smallexample
36009 <target version="1.0">
36010 <architecture>i386:x86-64</architecture>
36011 </target>
36012 @end smallexample
36013
36014 @noindent
36015 This minimal description only says that the target uses
36016 the x86-64 architecture.
36017
36018 A target description has the following overall form, with [ ] marking
36019 optional elements and @dots{} marking repeatable elements. The elements
36020 are explained further below.
36021
36022 @smallexample
36023 <?xml version="1.0"?>
36024 <!DOCTYPE target SYSTEM "gdb-target.dtd">
36025 <target version="1.0">
36026 @r{[}@var{architecture}@r{]}
36027 @r{[}@var{osabi}@r{]}
36028 @r{[}@var{compatible}@r{]}
36029 @r{[}@var{feature}@dots{}@r{]}
36030 </target>
36031 @end smallexample
36032
36033 @noindent
36034 The description is generally insensitive to whitespace and line
36035 breaks, under the usual common-sense rules. The XML version
36036 declaration and document type declaration can generally be omitted
36037 (@value{GDBN} does not require them), but specifying them may be
36038 useful for XML validation tools. The @samp{version} attribute for
36039 @samp{<target>} may also be omitted, but we recommend
36040 including it; if future versions of @value{GDBN} use an incompatible
36041 revision of @file{gdb-target.dtd}, they will detect and report
36042 the version mismatch.
36043
36044 @subsection Inclusion
36045 @cindex target descriptions, inclusion
36046 @cindex XInclude
36047 @ifnotinfo
36048 @cindex <xi:include>
36049 @end ifnotinfo
36050
36051 It can sometimes be valuable to split a target description up into
36052 several different annexes, either for organizational purposes, or to
36053 share files between different possible target descriptions. You can
36054 divide a description into multiple files by replacing any element of
36055 the target description with an inclusion directive of the form:
36056
36057 @smallexample
36058 <xi:include href="@var{document}"/>
36059 @end smallexample
36060
36061 @noindent
36062 When @value{GDBN} encounters an element of this form, it will retrieve
36063 the named XML @var{document}, and replace the inclusion directive with
36064 the contents of that document. If the current description was read
36065 using @samp{qXfer}, then so will be the included document;
36066 @var{document} will be interpreted as the name of an annex. If the
36067 current description was read from a file, @value{GDBN} will look for
36068 @var{document} as a file in the same directory where it found the
36069 original description.
36070
36071 @subsection Architecture
36072 @cindex <architecture>
36073
36074 An @samp{<architecture>} element has this form:
36075
36076 @smallexample
36077 <architecture>@var{arch}</architecture>
36078 @end smallexample
36079
36080 @var{arch} is one of the architectures from the set accepted by
36081 @code{set architecture} (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
36082
36083 @subsection OS ABI
36084 @cindex @code{<osabi>}
36085
36086 This optional field was introduced in @value{GDBN} version 7.0.
36087 Previous versions of @value{GDBN} ignore it.
36088
36089 An @samp{<osabi>} element has this form:
36090
36091 @smallexample
36092 <osabi>@var{abi-name}</osabi>
36093 @end smallexample
36094
36095 @var{abi-name} is an OS ABI name from the same selection accepted by
36096 @w{@code{set osabi}} (@pxref{ABI, ,Configuring the Current ABI}).
36097
36098 @subsection Compatible Architecture
36099 @cindex @code{<compatible>}
36100
36101 This optional field was introduced in @value{GDBN} version 7.0.
36102 Previous versions of @value{GDBN} ignore it.
36103
36104 A @samp{<compatible>} element has this form:
36105
36106 @smallexample
36107 <compatible>@var{arch}</compatible>
36108 @end smallexample
36109
36110 @var{arch} is one of the architectures from the set accepted by
36111 @code{set architecture} (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
36112
36113 A @samp{<compatible>} element is used to specify that the target
36114 is able to run binaries in some other than the main target architecture
36115 given by the @samp{<architecture>} element. For example, on the
36116 Cell Broadband Engine, the main architecture is @code{powerpc:common}
36117 or @code{powerpc:common64}, but the system is able to run binaries
36118 in the @code{spu} architecture as well. The way to describe this
36119 capability with @samp{<compatible>} is as follows:
36120
36121 @smallexample
36122 <architecture>powerpc:common</architecture>
36123 <compatible>spu</compatible>
36124 @end smallexample
36125
36126 @subsection Features
36127 @cindex <feature>
36128
36129 Each @samp{<feature>} describes some logical portion of the target
36130 system. Features are currently used to describe available CPU
36131 registers and the types of their contents. A @samp{<feature>} element
36132 has this form:
36133
36134 @smallexample
36135 <feature name="@var{name}">
36136 @r{[}@var{type}@dots{}@r{]}
36137 @var{reg}@dots{}
36138 </feature>
36139 @end smallexample
36140
36141 @noindent
36142 Each feature's name should be unique within the description. The name
36143 of a feature does not matter unless @value{GDBN} has some special
36144 knowledge of the contents of that feature; if it does, the feature
36145 should have its standard name. @xref{Standard Target Features}.
36146
36147 @subsection Types
36148
36149 Any register's value is a collection of bits which @value{GDBN} must
36150 interpret. The default interpretation is a two's complement integer,
36151 but other types can be requested by name in the register description.
36152 Some predefined types are provided by @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Predefined
36153 Target Types}), and the description can define additional composite types.
36154
36155 Each type element must have an @samp{id} attribute, which gives
36156 a unique (within the containing @samp{<feature>}) name to the type.
36157 Types must be defined before they are used.
36158
36159 @cindex <vector>
36160 Some targets offer vector registers, which can be treated as arrays
36161 of scalar elements. These types are written as @samp{<vector>} elements,
36162 specifying the array element type, @var{type}, and the number of elements,
36163 @var{count}:
36164
36165 @smallexample
36166 <vector id="@var{id}" type="@var{type}" count="@var{count}"/>
36167 @end smallexample
36168
36169 @cindex <union>
36170 If a register's value is usefully viewed in multiple ways, define it
36171 with a union type containing the useful representations. The
36172 @samp{<union>} element contains one or more @samp{<field>} elements,
36173 each of which has a @var{name} and a @var{type}:
36174
36175 @smallexample
36176 <union id="@var{id}">
36177 <field name="@var{name}" type="@var{type}"/>
36178 @dots{}
36179 </union>
36180 @end smallexample
36181
36182 @cindex <struct>
36183 If a register's value is composed from several separate values, define
36184 it with a structure type. There are two forms of the @samp{<struct>}
36185 element; a @samp{<struct>} element must either contain only bitfields
36186 or contain no bitfields. If the structure contains only bitfields,
36187 its total size in bytes must be specified, each bitfield must have an
36188 explicit start and end, and bitfields are automatically assigned an
36189 integer type. The field's @var{start} should be less than or
36190 equal to its @var{end}, and zero represents the least significant bit.
36191
36192 @smallexample
36193 <struct id="@var{id}" size="@var{size}">
36194 <field name="@var{name}" start="@var{start}" end="@var{end}"/>
36195 @dots{}
36196 </struct>
36197 @end smallexample
36198
36199 If the structure contains no bitfields, then each field has an
36200 explicit type, and no implicit padding is added.
36201
36202 @smallexample
36203 <struct id="@var{id}">
36204 <field name="@var{name}" type="@var{type}"/>
36205 @dots{}
36206 </struct>
36207 @end smallexample
36208
36209 @cindex <flags>
36210 If a register's value is a series of single-bit flags, define it with
36211 a flags type. The @samp{<flags>} element has an explicit @var{size}
36212 and contains one or more @samp{<field>} elements. Each field has a
36213 @var{name}, a @var{start}, and an @var{end}. Only single-bit flags
36214 are supported.
36215
36216 @smallexample
36217 <flags id="@var{id}" size="@var{size}">
36218 <field name="@var{name}" start="@var{start}" end="@var{end}"/>
36219 @dots{}
36220 </flags>
36221 @end smallexample
36222
36223 @subsection Registers
36224 @cindex <reg>
36225
36226 Each register is represented as an element with this form:
36227
36228 @smallexample
36229 <reg name="@var{name}"
36230 bitsize="@var{size}"
36231 @r{[}regnum="@var{num}"@r{]}
36232 @r{[}save-restore="@var{save-restore}"@r{]}
36233 @r{[}type="@var{type}"@r{]}
36234 @r{[}group="@var{group}"@r{]}/>
36235 @end smallexample
36236
36237 @noindent
36238 The components are as follows:
36239
36240 @table @var
36241
36242 @item name
36243 The register's name; it must be unique within the target description.
36244
36245 @item bitsize
36246 The register's size, in bits.
36247
36248 @item regnum
36249 The register's number. If omitted, a register's number is one greater
36250 than that of the previous register (either in the current feature or in
36251 a preceeding feature); the first register in the target description
36252 defaults to zero. This register number is used to read or write
36253 the register; e.g.@: it is used in the remote @code{p} and @code{P}
36254 packets, and registers appear in the @code{g} and @code{G} packets
36255 in order of increasing register number.
36256
36257 @item save-restore
36258 Whether the register should be preserved across inferior function
36259 calls; this must be either @code{yes} or @code{no}. The default is
36260 @code{yes}, which is appropriate for most registers except for
36261 some system control registers; this is not related to the target's
36262 ABI.
36263
36264 @item type
36265 The type of the register. @var{type} may be a predefined type, a type
36266 defined in the current feature, or one of the special types @code{int}
36267 and @code{float}. @code{int} is an integer type of the correct size
36268 for @var{bitsize}, and @code{float} is a floating point type (in the
36269 architecture's normal floating point format) of the correct size for
36270 @var{bitsize}. The default is @code{int}.
36271
36272 @item group
36273 The register group to which this register belongs. @var{group} must
36274 be either @code{general}, @code{float}, or @code{vector}. If no
36275 @var{group} is specified, @value{GDBN} will not display the register
36276 in @code{info registers}.
36277
36278 @end table
36279
36280 @node Predefined Target Types
36281 @section Predefined Target Types
36282 @cindex target descriptions, predefined types
36283
36284 Type definitions in the self-description can build up composite types
36285 from basic building blocks, but can not define fundamental types. Instead,
36286 standard identifiers are provided by @value{GDBN} for the fundamental
36287 types. The currently supported types are:
36288
36289 @table @code
36290
36291 @item int8
36292 @itemx int16
36293 @itemx int32
36294 @itemx int64
36295 @itemx int128
36296 Signed integer types holding the specified number of bits.
36297
36298 @item uint8
36299 @itemx uint16
36300 @itemx uint32
36301 @itemx uint64
36302 @itemx uint128
36303 Unsigned integer types holding the specified number of bits.
36304
36305 @item code_ptr
36306 @itemx data_ptr
36307 Pointers to unspecified code and data. The program counter and
36308 any dedicated return address register may be marked as code
36309 pointers; printing a code pointer converts it into a symbolic
36310 address. The stack pointer and any dedicated address registers
36311 may be marked as data pointers.
36312
36313 @item ieee_single
36314 Single precision IEEE floating point.
36315
36316 @item ieee_double
36317 Double precision IEEE floating point.
36318
36319 @item arm_fpa_ext
36320 The 12-byte extended precision format used by ARM FPA registers.
36321
36322 @item i387_ext
36323 The 10-byte extended precision format used by x87 registers.
36324
36325 @item i386_eflags
36326 32bit @sc{eflags} register used by x86.
36327
36328 @item i386_mxcsr
36329 32bit @sc{mxcsr} register used by x86.
36330
36331 @end table
36332
36333 @node Standard Target Features
36334 @section Standard Target Features
36335 @cindex target descriptions, standard features
36336
36337 A target description must contain either no registers or all the
36338 target's registers. If the description contains no registers, then
36339 @value{GDBN} will assume a default register layout, selected based on
36340 the architecture. If the description contains any registers, the
36341 default layout will not be used; the standard registers must be
36342 described in the target description, in such a way that @value{GDBN}
36343 can recognize them.
36344
36345 This is accomplished by giving specific names to feature elements
36346 which contain standard registers. @value{GDBN} will look for features
36347 with those names and verify that they contain the expected registers;
36348 if any known feature is missing required registers, or if any required
36349 feature is missing, @value{GDBN} will reject the target
36350 description. You can add additional registers to any of the
36351 standard features --- @value{GDBN} will display them just as if
36352 they were added to an unrecognized feature.
36353
36354 This section lists the known features and their expected contents.
36355 Sample XML documents for these features are included in the
36356 @value{GDBN} source tree, in the directory @file{gdb/features}.
36357
36358 Names recognized by @value{GDBN} should include the name of the
36359 company or organization which selected the name, and the overall
36360 architecture to which the feature applies; so e.g.@: the feature
36361 containing ARM core registers is named @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.core}.
36362
36363 The names of registers are not case sensitive for the purpose
36364 of recognizing standard features, but @value{GDBN} will only display
36365 registers using the capitalization used in the description.
36366
36367 @menu
36368 * ARM Features::
36369 * i386 Features::
36370 * MIPS Features::
36371 * M68K Features::
36372 * PowerPC Features::
36373 @end menu
36374
36375
36376 @node ARM Features
36377 @subsection ARM Features
36378 @cindex target descriptions, ARM features
36379
36380 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.core} feature is required for non-M-profile
36381 ARM targets.
36382 It should contain registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r13}, @samp{sp},
36383 @samp{lr}, @samp{pc}, and @samp{cpsr}.
36384
36385 For M-profile targets (e.g. Cortex-M3), the @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.core}
36386 feature is replaced by @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.m-profile}. It should contain
36387 registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r13}, @samp{sp}, @samp{lr}, @samp{pc},
36388 and @samp{xpsr}.
36389
36390 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.fpa} feature is optional. If present, it
36391 should contain registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f7} and @samp{fps}.
36392
36393 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.xscale.iwmmxt} feature is optional. If present,
36394 it should contain at least registers @samp{wR0} through @samp{wR15} and
36395 @samp{wCGR0} through @samp{wCGR3}. The @samp{wCID}, @samp{wCon},
36396 @samp{wCSSF}, and @samp{wCASF} registers are optional.
36397
36398 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.vfp} feature is optional. If present, it
36399 should contain at least registers @samp{d0} through @samp{d15}. If
36400 they are present, @samp{d16} through @samp{d31} should also be included.
36401 @value{GDBN} will synthesize the single-precision registers from
36402 halves of the double-precision registers.
36403
36404 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.neon} feature is optional. It does not
36405 need to contain registers; it instructs @value{GDBN} to display the
36406 VFP double-precision registers as vectors and to synthesize the
36407 quad-precision registers from pairs of double-precision registers.
36408 If this feature is present, @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.vfp} must also
36409 be present and include 32 double-precision registers.
36410
36411 @node i386 Features
36412 @subsection i386 Features
36413 @cindex target descriptions, i386 features
36414
36415 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.core} feature is required for i386/amd64
36416 targets. It should describe the following registers:
36417
36418 @itemize @minus
36419 @item
36420 @samp{eax} through @samp{edi} plus @samp{eip} for i386
36421 @item
36422 @samp{rax} through @samp{r15} plus @samp{rip} for amd64
36423 @item
36424 @samp{eflags}, @samp{cs}, @samp{ss}, @samp{ds}, @samp{es},
36425 @samp{fs}, @samp{gs}
36426 @item
36427 @samp{st0} through @samp{st7}
36428 @item
36429 @samp{fctrl}, @samp{fstat}, @samp{ftag}, @samp{fiseg}, @samp{fioff},
36430 @samp{foseg}, @samp{fooff} and @samp{fop}
36431 @end itemize
36432
36433 The register sets may be different, depending on the target.
36434
36435 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.sse} feature is optional. It should
36436 describe registers:
36437
36438 @itemize @minus
36439 @item
36440 @samp{xmm0} through @samp{xmm7} for i386
36441 @item
36442 @samp{xmm0} through @samp{xmm15} for amd64
36443 @item
36444 @samp{mxcsr}
36445 @end itemize
36446
36447 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.avx} feature is optional and requires the
36448 @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.sse} feature. It should
36449 describe the upper 128 bits of @sc{ymm} registers:
36450
36451 @itemize @minus
36452 @item
36453 @samp{ymm0h} through @samp{ymm7h} for i386
36454 @item
36455 @samp{ymm0h} through @samp{ymm15h} for amd64
36456 @end itemize
36457
36458 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.linux} feature is optional. It should
36459 describe a single register, @samp{orig_eax}.
36460
36461 @node MIPS Features
36462 @subsection MIPS Features
36463 @cindex target descriptions, MIPS features
36464
36465 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.cpu} feature is required for MIPS targets.
36466 It should contain registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r31}, @samp{lo},
36467 @samp{hi}, and @samp{pc}. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending
36468 on the target.
36469
36470 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.cp0} feature is also required. It should
36471 contain at least the @samp{status}, @samp{badvaddr}, and @samp{cause}
36472 registers. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
36473
36474 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.fpu} feature is currently required, though
36475 it may be optional in a future version of @value{GDBN}. It should
36476 contain registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f31}, @samp{fcsr}, and
36477 @samp{fir}. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
36478
36479 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.linux} feature is optional. It should
36480 contain a single register, @samp{restart}, which is used by the
36481 Linux kernel to control restartable syscalls.
36482
36483 @node M68K Features
36484 @subsection M68K Features
36485 @cindex target descriptions, M68K features
36486
36487 @table @code
36488 @item @samp{org.gnu.gdb.m68k.core}
36489 @itemx @samp{org.gnu.gdb.coldfire.core}
36490 @itemx @samp{org.gnu.gdb.fido.core}
36491 One of those features must be always present.
36492 The feature that is present determines which flavor of m68k is
36493 used. The feature that is present should contain registers
36494 @samp{d0} through @samp{d7}, @samp{a0} through @samp{a5}, @samp{fp},
36495 @samp{sp}, @samp{ps} and @samp{pc}.
36496
36497 @item @samp{org.gnu.gdb.coldfire.fp}
36498 This feature is optional. If present, it should contain registers
36499 @samp{fp0} through @samp{fp7}, @samp{fpcontrol}, @samp{fpstatus} and
36500 @samp{fpiaddr}.
36501 @end table
36502
36503 @node PowerPC Features
36504 @subsection PowerPC Features
36505 @cindex target descriptions, PowerPC features
36506
36507 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.core} feature is required for PowerPC
36508 targets. It should contain registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r31},
36509 @samp{pc}, @samp{msr}, @samp{cr}, @samp{lr}, @samp{ctr}, and
36510 @samp{xer}. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
36511
36512 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.fpu} feature is optional. It should
36513 contain registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f31} and @samp{fpscr}.
36514
36515 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.altivec} feature is optional. It should
36516 contain registers @samp{vr0} through @samp{vr31}, @samp{vscr},
36517 and @samp{vrsave}.
36518
36519 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.vsx} feature is optional. It should
36520 contain registers @samp{vs0h} through @samp{vs31h}. @value{GDBN}
36521 will combine these registers with the floating point registers
36522 (@samp{f0} through @samp{f31}) and the altivec registers (@samp{vr0}
36523 through @samp{vr31}) to present the 128-bit wide registers @samp{vs0}
36524 through @samp{vs63}, the set of vector registers for POWER7.
36525
36526 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.spe} feature is optional. It should
36527 contain registers @samp{ev0h} through @samp{ev31h}, @samp{acc}, and
36528 @samp{spefscr}. SPE targets should provide 32-bit registers in
36529 @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.core} and provide the upper halves in
36530 @samp{ev0h} through @samp{ev31h}. @value{GDBN} will combine
36531 these to present registers @samp{ev0} through @samp{ev31} to the
36532 user.
36533
36534 @node Operating System Information
36535 @appendix Operating System Information
36536 @cindex operating system information
36537
36538 @menu
36539 * Process list::
36540 @end menu
36541
36542 Users of @value{GDBN} often wish to obtain information about the state of
36543 the operating system running on the target---for example the list of
36544 processes, or the list of open files. This section describes the
36545 mechanism that makes it possible. This mechanism is similar to the
36546 target features mechanism (@pxref{Target Descriptions}), but focuses
36547 on a different aspect of target.
36548
36549 Operating system information is retrived from the target via the
36550 remote protocol, using @samp{qXfer} requests (@pxref{qXfer osdata
36551 read}). The object name in the request should be @samp{osdata}, and
36552 the @var{annex} identifies the data to be fetched.
36553
36554 @node Process list
36555 @appendixsection Process list
36556 @cindex operating system information, process list
36557
36558 When requesting the process list, the @var{annex} field in the
36559 @samp{qXfer} request should be @samp{processes}. The returned data is
36560 an XML document. The formal syntax of this document is defined in
36561 @file{gdb/features/osdata.dtd}.
36562
36563 An example document is:
36564
36565 @smallexample
36566 <?xml version="1.0"?>
36567 <!DOCTYPE target SYSTEM "osdata.dtd">
36568 <osdata type="processes">
36569 <item>
36570 <column name="pid">1</column>
36571 <column name="user">root</column>
36572 <column name="command">/sbin/init</column>
36573 <column name="cores">1,2,3</column>
36574 </item>
36575 </osdata>
36576 @end smallexample
36577
36578 Each item should include a column whose name is @samp{pid}. The value
36579 of that column should identify the process on the target. The
36580 @samp{user} and @samp{command} columns are optional, and will be
36581 displayed by @value{GDBN}. The @samp{cores} column, if present,
36582 should contain a comma-separated list of cores that this process
36583 is running on. Target may provide additional columns,
36584 which @value{GDBN} currently ignores.
36585
36586 @include gpl.texi
36587
36588 @node GNU Free Documentation License
36589 @appendix GNU Free Documentation License
36590 @include fdl.texi
36591
36592 @node Index
36593 @unnumbered Index
36594
36595 @printindex cp
36596
36597 @tex
36598 % I think something like @colophon should be in texinfo. In the
36599 % meantime:
36600 \long\def\colophon{\hbox to0pt{}\vfill
36601 \centerline{The body of this manual is set in}
36602 \centerline{\fontname\tenrm,}
36603 \centerline{with headings in {\bf\fontname\tenbf}}
36604 \centerline{and examples in {\tt\fontname\tentt}.}
36605 \centerline{{\it\fontname\tenit\/},}
36606 \centerline{{\bf\fontname\tenbf}, and}
36607 \centerline{{\sl\fontname\tensl\/}}
36608 \centerline{are used for emphasis.}\vfill}
36609 \page\colophon
36610 % Blame: doc@cygnus.com, 1991.
36611 @end tex
36612
36613 @bye
This page took 1.54224 seconds and 4 git commands to generate.